advertisement
OPERATION GUIDE
MAKE A COPY
PRINT A DOCUMENT
SEND A FAX
SCAN AN IMAGE /
SEND AN INTERNET FAX
SAVE A JOB AND
REUSE IT LATER
MAINTAIN
THE MACHINE
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
COPIER
PRINTER
FACSIMILE
SCANNER / INTERNET FAX
DOCUMENT FILING
SYSTEM SETTINGS
TROUBLESHOOTING
About Operation Guide
MAKE A COPY
Conserve
Reduce copy mistakes
Make a copy of this type of original
Make a copy on this type of paper
Add the date or page numbers
Assemble output into a pamphlet
Other convenient functions
Conserve
Copy on both sides of the paper
Copy on the front and back of a card
Copy multiple pages on one side of one sheet of paper
Reduce copy mistakes
Print one set of copies for proofing
Check the number of scanned pages before making copies
Make a copy of this type of original
Mixed colour and black & white originals
Mixed-size originals
Bound original such as a book (one page at a time)
More original pages than can be loaded at once
Bulky original (shadows appear at edges)
Book or pamphlet (make facing page copies)
Make a copy on this type of paper
Envelopes and other special media
Tab Paper
A3 wide paper
Transparency film
Add the date or page numbers
Add the date
Add the page number
Add a stamp
Add text
Assemble output into a pamphlet
Create a stapled pamphlet
Create a blank margin for punching
Staple output
Punch holes in output
Other convenient functions
Functions used for specific purposes
Make a copy of arranged photos
Create a large poster
Make a mirror-image copy
Copy onto the centre of the paper
Make a negative copy
Convenient functions
Use two machines simultaneously
Give priority to a copy job
Check the status of a reserved job
Insert covers/inserts in copy output
Copy a thin original
z
Adjust the colour
PRINT A DOCUMENT
Conserve
Print without a computer
Print attractive output
Assemble output into a pamphlet
Print on this type of paper
Add text or an image
Other convenient functions
Conserve
Print on both sides of the paper
Print multiple pages on one side of the paper
Print without a computer
Print a file on an FTP
Print a file in a network folder
Print a file in a USB memory device
Print a file stored in the machine
Print attractive output
Print matching the size of the paper
Print using colour settings suitable for the data
Select the print mode
Adjust the brightness and contrast
Bring out faint text and lines
Assemble output into a pamphlet
Create a stapled pamphlet
Create a blank margin for punching
Print specific pages on the front side of the paper
Staple output
Punch holes in output
Print on this type of paper
Envelopes
Transparency film
Rotate the image 180 degrees
Tab Paper
Print specific pages on different paper
Add text or an image
Add a watermark to print data
Overlay a fixed form on the print data
Overlay an image on the print data
Other convenient functions
Correct the size or orientation of the print data
Enlarge or reduce the print image
Print a mirror-image
Security is important
Print confidentially
Print an encrypted PDF file
Functions used for specific purposes
Print an "invoice copy"
Create a large poster
Convenient functions
Give priority to a print job
Use two machines simultaneously
Store frequently used print settings
z
Store a print job
SEND A FAX
Conserve
Send this type of document
Prevent transmission to the wrong destination
Send a clear document
Save trouble
Security is important
Other convenient functions
Conserve
Send when the rate is lowest
Send two original pages as a single page
Check received data before printing
Relay a transmission through a branch office
Send this type of document
Bulky original (shadows appear at edges)
More original pages than can be loaded at once
Original printed on both sides
Bound original such as a book (one page at a time)
Mixed-size originals
ID card or other card
Prevent transmission to the wrong destination
Check the destination once more before sending
Check the log of previous transmissions
Check the result of transmission
Stamp scanned original pages
Send a clear document
Adjust the exposure
Specify the size before sending
Adjust the image quality
Send without shadows at the edges
Save trouble
Store frequently used settings
View the transmission log
Bound original such as a book (one page at a time)
Send to multiple destinations
Easily specify an address
(search number)
Security is important
Check the destination once more before sending
Print protected reception data
Send a document at the other machine's request
Send confidentially
Initiate reception of a document from a sending machine
Other convenient functions
Convenient management functions
Forward a received fax to a network address
Print a list of addresses
Convenient functions
Send a thin original
Select a transmission destination from a global address book
Give priority to a transmission
z
Use an extension phone
SCAN AN IMAGE / SEND AN INTERNET FAX
Send a clear image
Send this type of document
Prevent transmission to the wrong destination
Send a smaller file
Save trouble
Scan from my computer
Other convenient functions
Send a clear image
Adjust the contrast or image quality
Send without shadows at the edges
Adjust the resolution before sending
Suppress the background of a transmitted document
Send this type of document
Bulky original (shadows appear at edges)
More original pages than can be loaded at once
Original printed on both sides
Bound original such as a book (one page at a time)
Mixed-size originals
Original with background
Prevent transmission to the wrong destination
Check the result of transmission
Stamp scanned original pages
Check the log of previous transmissions
Send a smaller file
Send at low resolution
Reduce an image before sending
Send two original pages as a single page
Compress a file before sending
Send an image in black & white
ID or other card
Save trouble
Store frequently used settings
View the transmission log
Send an Internet fax from a computer
Send to multiple destinations
a a a @ a a . a a . c b b b @ b b . b b .
c c c @ c c . c c . c d d d @ d d . d d .
Easily specify an address
(search number)
Bound original such as a book (one page at a time)
Other convenient functions
Convenient management functions
Forward a received fax to a network address
Print a list of transmission destinations
Convenient functions
Scan a thin original
Select a transmission destination from a global address book
Send at a specified time
Give priority to a transmission
z
Send in USB memory mode
SAVE A JOB AND REUSE IT LATER
Search for a file
Organize my files
Save an important document
Print a batch of files
Search for a file
Search for a file using a keyword
Search by checking the contents of files
Organize my files
Delete a file
Periodically delete files
Delete all files
Change the folder
MAINTAIN THE MACHINE
Clean the machine
Replace a toner cartridge
Replace the staple cartridge
Replace the stamp cartridge
Replace the waste toner box
Dispose of punch waste
Clean the machine
Clean the document glass and automatic document feeder
Clean the original feed roller
Clean the laser unit
Clean the main charger of the photoconductive drum
Clean the bypass feed roller
ABOUT OPERATION GUIDE
There are two ways to search for a topic in this guide: you can use an "I want to..." menu, or you can use a regular table of contents.
The following explanation assumes that Adobe Reader 8.0 is being used (Some buttons do not appear in the default state.).
Return to top page ( ) Return to previously displayed page ( )
Search based on what you want to do
Menu page
Search using the table of contents
Table of contents page
Body page
3
4
5
1
2 i
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
Click a button below to move to the page that you wish to view.
(1) (2) (3) (4)
(5)
(6)
(1) Return to top page button
If an operation does not proceed as expected, click this button to start over again.
(2) Back one page button
Displays the previous page.
(3) Forward one page button
Displays the next page.
(4) Return to previously displayed page button
Displays the page that was displayed before the current page.
(5)
(6)
Adobe Reader Help button
Opens Adobe Reader Help.
Contents button
Displays the contents of each chapter.
For example, if the current page is a page in the body of the printer chapter, this button shows the contents of the printer chapter.
• If a button does not appear, refer to Adobe Reader Help to display the button.
• Caution when printing
If all pages are printed, the menu pages of the "I want to..." menu will also be printed. To print only the pages that contain the explanation of a function, specify a page range.
ii
MANUALS PROVIDED WITH THE MACHINE
Operation manuals in PDF format (this manual)
The manuals in PDF format provide detailed explanations of the procedures for using the machine in each mode. To view the PDF manuals, download them from the hard drive in the machine. The procedure for downloading the manuals is explained in "How to read the Operation Guide" in the Start Guide.
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
This chapter provides information, such as basic operation procedures, how to load paper, and machine maintenance.
2. COPIER
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the copy function.
3. PRINTER
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the print function.
4. FACSIMILE
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the fax function.
5. SCANNER / INTERNET FAX
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the scanner function and the Internet fax function.
6. DOCUMENT FILING
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the document filing function. The document filing function allows you to save the document data of a copy or fax job, or the data of a print job, as a file on the machine's hard drive. The file can be called up as needed.
7. SYSTEM SETTINGS
This chapter explains the "System Settings", which are used to configure a variety of parameters to suit the aims and the needs of your workplace. Current settings can be displayed or printed out from the "System Settings".
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
This chapter explains how to remove paper misfeeds and provides answers to frequently asked questions regarding the operation of the machine in each mode. Refer to this manual when you have difficulty using the machine.
Printed manual
Manual name
Start Guide
Contents
This manual contains instructions for using the machine safely, describes preparations that must be made before using the machine, and lists the specifications of the machine and its peripheral devices.
iii
ABOUT OPERATION MANUAL
This manual explains how to use the MX-2010U/MX-2310U digital full colour multifunctional system.
Please note
• For information on installing the drivers and software cited in this manual, please refer to the Software Setup Guide.
• For information on your operating system, please refer to your operating system manual or the online Help function.
• The explanations of screens and procedures in a Windows environment are primarily for Windows Vista ® . The screens may vary depending on the version of the operating system or the software application.
• The explanations of screens and procedures in a Macintosh environment are based on Mac OS X v10.4 in the case of Mac OS
X. The screens may vary depending on the version of the operating system or the software application.
• Wherever "MX-xxxx" appears in this manual, please substitute your model name for "xxxx".
• This manual contains references to the fax function. However, please note that the fax function is not available in some countries and regions.
• Considerable care has been taken in preparing this manual. If you have any comments or concerns about the manual, please contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
• This product has undergone strict quality control and inspection procedures. In the unlikely event that a defect or other problem is discovered, please contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
• Aside from instances provided for by law, SHARP is not responsible for failures occurring during the use of the product or its options, or failures due to incorrect operation of the product and its options, or other failures, or for any damage that occurs due to use of the product.
Warning
• Reproduction, adaptation or translation of the contents of the manual without prior written permission is prohibited, except as allowed under copyright laws.
• All information in this manual is subject to change without notice.
Illustrations and the operation panel and touch panel shown in this manual
The peripheral devices are generally optional, however, some models include certain peripheral devices as standard equipment.
The explanations in this manual assume that a right tray and paper drawer are installed on the MX-2310U.
For some functions and procedures, the explanations assume that devices other than the above are installed.
The display screens, messages, and key names shown in the manual may differ from those on the actual machine due to product improvements and modifications.
Icons used in the manuals
The icons in the manuals indicate the following types of information:
Warning
Caution
This alerts you to a situation where there is a risk of human death or injury.
This alerts you to a situation where there is a risk of human injury or property damage.
This alerts you to a situation where there is a risk of machine damage or failure.
This provides a supplemental explanation of a function or procedure.
This explains how to cancel or correct an operation.
This indicates the name of a system setting and provides a brief explanation of the setting.
When "System Settings:" appears:
A general setting is explained.
When "System Settings (Administrator):" appears:
A setting that can only be configured by an administrator is explained.
iv
CHAPTER 1
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
This chapter provides information, such as basic operation procedures, how to load paper, and machine maintenance.
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
PART NAMES AND FUNCTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
• EXTERIOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
• INTERIOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
• AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER AND
DOCUMENT GLASS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
• SIDE AND BACK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
• OPERATION PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
TOUCH PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
• STATUS DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
• SYSTEM BAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF . . . . . . . . . 1-15
• ENERGY SAVE FUNCTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
• [POWER SAVE] KEY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
USER AUTHENTICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
• AUTHENTICATION BY USER NUMBER. . . . . 1-17
• AUTHENTICATION BY LOGIN NAME /
PASSWORD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19
HOME SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
REMOTE OPERATION OF THE MACHINE. . . . . . 1-23
ITEMS RECORDED IN THE JOB LOG . . . . . . . . . 1-24
LOADING PAPER
IMPORTANT POINTS ABOUT PAPER . . . . . . . . . 1-27
• NAMES AND LOCATIONS OF TRAYS . . . . . . 1-27
• THE MEANING OF "R" IN PAPER SIZES . . . . 1-27
• USEABLE PAPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28
TRAY SETTINGS FOR TRAY 1 TO 4 . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
• LOADING PAPER AND CHANGING THE
PAPER SIZE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
LOADING PAPER IN THE BYPASS TRAY . . . . . . 1-32
• IMPORTANT POINTS WHEN USING THE
BYPASS TRAY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-33
ORIGINALS
PLACING THE ORIGINAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-35
AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER . . . . . . . . 1-35
DOCUMENT GLASS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-37
PERIPHERAL DEVICES
PERIPHERAL DEVICES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-39
FINISHER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-41
• PART NAMES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-41
• SUPPLIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-41
• FINISHER MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-42
PUNCH MODULE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-44
• DISCARDING PUNCH WASTE . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-44
SHARP OSA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-46
MODULE (MX-AMX2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-46
(MX-AMX3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-47
1-1
MAINTENANCE
REGULAR MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-49
AND AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER . . . 1-49
• CLEANING THE MAIN CHARGER OF
THE PHOTOCONDUCTIVE DRUM . . . . . . . . . 1-51
• CLEANING THE PT CHARGER OF THE
PRIMARY TRANSFER BELT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-54
• CLEANING THE BYPASS FEED ROLLER . . . 1-56
ROLLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-56
• CLEANING THE LASER UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-57
REPLACING THE TONER CARTRIDGES. . . . . . . 1-61
REPLACING THE WASTE TONER BOX. . . . . . . . 1-64
REPLACING THE STAMP CARTRIDGE . . . . . . . . 1-66
ENTERING TEXT
FUNCTIONS OF THE MAIN KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-67
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
1-2
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
This section provides basic information about the machine. Please read this chapter before using the machine.
PART NAMES AND FUNCTIONS
EXTERIOR
(1)-a
(1)-b (2) (3) (4) (5)
(6)
When a finisher is installed
(1)-a Document cover*
Place an original on the document glass and close the document cover before copying starts.
(1)-b Automatic document feeder*
This automatically feeds and scans multiple originals. Both sides of 2-sided originals can be automatically scanned.
☞
PLACING THE ORIGINAL (page 1-35)
(2) Front cover
Open this cover to switch the main power switch to "On" or "Off" or to replace a toner cartridge.
☞
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF (page 1-15)
☞
REPLACING THE TONER CARTRIDGES
(page
(3) Output tray (centre tray)
Output is delivered to this tray.
* Peripheral device.
(4) Operation panel
This is used to select functions and enter the number of copies.
☞
(5) Exit tray unit (right tray) *
When installed, output can be delivered to this tray.
(6) Finisher*
This can be used to staple output. A punch module can also be installed to punch holes in output.
☞
1-3
(7)
(7) USB connector (A type)
Supports USB 2.0 (Hi-Speed).
This is used to connect a USB device such as USB memory to the machine.
For the USB cable, use a shielded cable.
(8) Tray 1
This holds paper.
☞
TRAY SETTINGS FOR TRAY 1 TO 4 (page 1-30)
(9) Tray 2 (when a paper drawer is installed)*
This holds paper.
☞
TRAY SETTINGS FOR TRAY 1 TO 4 (page 1-30)
* Peripheral device.
(8) (9) (10) (11)
(10) Tray 3 (when a paper drawer is installed)*
This holds paper.
☞
TRAY SETTINGS FOR TRAY 1 TO 4 (page 1-30)
(11) Tray 4 (when a paper drawer is installed)*
This holds paper.
☞
TRAY SETTINGS FOR TRAY 1 TO 4 (page 1-30)
1-4
INTERIOR
(12)
(13) (14) (15) (16) (17)
(18) (19) (20)
(12) Toner cartridges
These contain toner for printing. When the toner runs out in a cartridge, the cartridge of the colour that ran out must be replaced.
☞
REPLACING THE TONER CARTRIDGES (page 1-61)
(13) Fusing unit
Heat is applied here to fuse the transferred image onto the paper.
Caution
The fusing unit is hot. Take care not to burn yourself when removing a paper misfeed.
(14) Transfer belt
During full colour printing, the toner images of each of the four colours on each of the photoconductive drums are combined together on the transfer belt. During black and white printing, only the black toner image is transferred onto the transfer belt.
Do not touch or damage the transfer belt. This may cause a defective image.
(15) Right side cover
Open this cover to remove a misfeed.
(16) Paper reversing section cover
This is used when 2-sided printing is performed. Open this cover to remove a paper misfeed.
(17) Bypass tray
Use this tray to feed paper manually.
When loading a large sheet of paper, be sure to pull out the bypass tray extension.
☞
LOADING PAPER IN THE BYPASS TRAY (page 1-32)
(21) (22) (23) (24)
(18) Main power switch
This is used to power on the machine.
When using the fax or Internet fax functions, keep this switch in the "on" position.
☞
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF (page 1-15)
(19) Waste toner box
This collects excess toner that remains after printing.
☞
REPLACING THE WASTE TONER BOX (page 1-64)
Your service technician will collect the waste toner box.
(20) Waste toner box release lever
Move this lever when you need to release the waste toner box lock to replace the waste toner box or clean the laser unit.
☞
CLEANING THE LASER UNIT (page 1-57)
☞
REPLACING THE WASTE TONER BOX (page 1-64)
(21) Handle
Pull this out and grasp it when moving the machine.
(22) Right cover of paper drawer
(when a paper drawer is installed)
Open this to remove a paper misfeed in tray 2, tray 3 or tray 4.
(23) Paper tray right side cover
Open this to remove a paper misfeed in tray 1.
(24) Right side cover release lever
To remove a paper misfeed, pull and hold this lever up to open the right side cover.
1-5
AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER AND DOCUMENT
GLASS
Automatic document feeder
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7)
(8)
Document glass
(9)
(1) Paper feed roller
This roller rotates to automatically feed the original.
(2) Document feeding area cover
Open this cover to remove an original misfeed or clean the paper feed roller.
(3) Original guides
These help ensure that the original is scanned correctly.
Adjust the guides to the width of the original.
☞
PLACING THE ORIGINAL (page 1-35)
(4) Document feeder tray
Place originals in this tray. 1-sided originals must be placed face up.
☞
PLACING THE ORIGINAL (page 1-35)
(5) Original exit tray
Originals are delivered to this tray after scanning.
(8)
(6) Scanning area
Originals placed in the document feeder tray are scanned here.
☞
REGULAR MAINTENANCE (page 1-49)
(7) Original size detector
This detects the size of an original placed on the document glass.
☞
PLACING THE ORIGINAL ON THE DOCUMENT
(8) Document glass
Use this to scan a book or other thick original that cannot be fed through the automatic document feeder.
☞
PLACING THE ORIGINAL ON THE DOCUMENT
(9) Original stocker
A space to stock documents.
1-6
SIDE AND BACK
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(1) USB connector (A type)
Supports USB 2.0 (Hi-Speed).
This is used to connect a USB device such as USB memory to the machine.
(2) USB connector (B type )
Supports USB 2.0 (Hi-Speed).
A computer can be connected to this connector to use the machine as a printer.
For the USB cable, use a shielded cable.
(3) LAN connector
Connect the LAN cable to this connector when the machine is used on a network.
For the LAN cable, use a shielded type cable.
(4) Service-only connector
Caution
This connector is for use only by service technicians.
Connecting a cable to this connector may cause the machine to malfunction.
Important note for service technicians:
The cable connected to the service connector must be less than 3 m (118") in length.
(5) Power plug
(6) Extension phone socket
When the fax function of the machine is used, an extension phone can be connected to this socket.
(7) Telephone line socket
When the fax function of the machine is used, the telephone line is connected to this socket.
When the fax expansion kit is installed
(6)
(7)
1-7
OPERATION PANEL
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
JOB STATUS PRINT
READY
DATA
SYSTEM
SETTINGS IMAGE SEND
LINE
DATA
HOME
LOGOUT
(7) (8)
(9)
(1) Touch panel
Messages and keys appear in the touch panel display.
Touch the displayed keys to perform a variety of operations.
When a key is touched, a beep sounds and the selected item is highlighted. This provides confirmation as you perform an operation.
☞
(2) [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key
Press this key to display the system settings menu screen. The system settings are used to configure paper tray settings, store addresses for transmission operations, and adjust parameters to make the machine easier to use.
(3) [JOB STATUS] key
Press this key to display the job status screen. The job status screen is used to check information on jobs and to cancel jobs.
For details, see the chapters for each of the functions in this manual.
(4) PRINT mode indicators
• READY indicator
Print jobs can be received when this indicator is lit.
• DATA indicator
This blinks while print data is being received and lights steadily while printing is taking place.
(5) Numeric keys
These are used to enter the number of copies, fax numbers, and other numerical values. These keys are also used to enter numeric value settings (except for the system settings).
(6) [CLEAR] key ( )
Press this key to return the number of copies to "0".
(7) [HOME] key
Touch this key to display the home screen. Frequently used settings can be registered in the home screen to enable quick and easy operation of the machine.
☞
(8) IMAGE SEND mode indicators
• LINE indicator
This lights up during transmission or reception of a fax or Internet fax. This also lights during transmission of an image in scan mode.
• DATA indicator
This blinks when a received fax or Internet fax cannot be printed because of a problem such as out of paper.
This lights up when there is a transmission job that has not been sent.
(9) Stylus pen
This can be used to touch a key displayed on the touch panel.
1-8
(10) (11) (12) (13)
JOB STATUS PRINT
READY
DATA
SYSTEM
SETTINGS IMAGE SEND
LINE
DATA
HOME
LOGOUT
(10) [COLOUR START] key
Press this key to copy or scan an original in colour.
This key cannot be used for fax or Internet fax.
(11) [BLACK & WHITE START] key
Press this key to copy or scan an original in black and white. This key is also used to send a fax in fax mode.
(12) Main power indicator
This lights up when the machine's main power switch is in the "on" position.
☞
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF (page 1-15)
(13) [POWER] key ( )
Use this key to turn the machine power on and off.
☞
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF (page 1-15)
(14) [LOGOUT] key ( )
Press this key to log out after you have logged in and used the machine. When using the fax function, this key can also be pressed to send tone signals on a pulse dial line.
☞
USER AUTHENTICATION (page 1-17)
(14) (15) (16) (17) (18)
(15) [#/P] key ( )
When using the copy function, press this key to use a job program. When using the fax function, this key can be used when dialling.
(16) [CLEAR ALL] key ( )
Press this key to return to the initial operation state.
Use this key when you wish to cancel all settings that have been selected and start operation from the initial state.
(17) [STOP] key ( )
Press this key to stop a copy job or scanning of an original.
(18) [POWER SAVE] key ( ) / indicator
Use this key to put the machine into auto power shut-off mode to save energy.
The [POWER SAVE] key ( ) blinks when the machine is in auto power shut-off mode.
☞
The indicators of the operation panel may differ depending on the country and region.
1-9
TOUCH PANEL
This section explains how to use the touch panel.
• To enter text, see "
• For information on the screens and procedures for using the system settings, see "
"
(page 7-4) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS".
Using the touch panel
Example 1
(1)
COPY
Job status screen.
IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
(2)
1
2
3
4
Print Job
Job Queue
Copy
Copy
Computer01
0312345678
Scan to
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
002 / 000
Fax Job
Status
Copying
Waiting
Tone
001 / 000
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(3)
(1) Mode select keys
Use these keys to switch between copy, image send, and document filing modes.
(2) Settings for each function are easily selected and cancelled by touching the keys on the screen with your finger.
When an item is selected, a beep will sound and the item will be highlighted to confirm the selection.
(3) Keys that are greyed out cannot be selected.
If you touch a key that cannot be selected, a double beep will sound.
Example 2
(1)
Special Modes
Margin Shift
Right Left Down
(2) (3)
Cancel
OK
OK
(4)
Side 1
10
(0~20) mm
Side 2
10
(0~20) mm
(1) If the initial state of a key in a screen is highlighted, the key is selected. To change the selection, touch one of the other keys to highlight that key.
(2) The keys can be used to increase or decrease a value. To make a value change quickly, keep your finger on the key.
(3) Touch this key to cancel a setting.
(4) Touch the [OK] key to enter and save a setting.
Example 3
(1) (2)
Special Modes
Margin Shift
Pamphlet Copy
Covers/Inserts
Book Copy
Erase
Job
Build
Transparency
Inserts
Tab Copy
Dual Page
Copy
Tandem
Copy
Multi Shot
Card Shot
OK
1
2
(1) Some items in the special modes screen are selected by simply touching the key of the item.
To cancel a selected item, touch the highlighted key once again so that it is no longer highlighted.
(2) When settings extend over multiple screens, touch the key or the key to switch through the screens.
1-10
Example 4
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
When at least one special mode is selected, the key appears in the base screen.
Example 5
Original
Size Input Cancel
X 420
(25 432) mm
Y 297
(25 297) mm
OK
OK
Function Review
Margin Shift
Erase
Shift:Right
Front:10mm/Back:10mm
Edge:10mm
Centre:10mm
Covers/Inserts
Front:2-Sided/Back:Insert
Insertion A:10 Page/B:10 Page
OK
1
1
The key can be touched to display a list of the selected special modes.
Enter value via the 10-key.
297
Cancel
(25-297)
OK
Touch a numeric value display key to directly enter a value with the numeric keys.
Press the numeric keys to enter any numeric value and then touch the [OK] key.
The touch panel (screen) shown in this manual is a descriptive image. The actual screen is slightly different.
System Settings (Administrator): Keys Touch Sound
This is used to adjust the volume of the beep that sounds when keys are touched. The key touch sound can also be turned off.
1-11
STATUS DISPLAY
When the base screen of a mode appears, the right side of the touch panel shows the machine's status.
The information shown is explained below.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Example: Basic screen of copy mode
Copies in progress from tray 1.
Ready to scan for next copy job.
Interrupt
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Job Status
MFP Status
020/015
Copying
Output
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
File
020/015
Waiting
Quick File
020/015
Waiting
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
020/015
Waiting
(1)
Job Status
MFP Status
Maintenance
Information
DC DC DC
DC DC DC
DC DC DC
(1) Display selection key
The status display can be switched between "Job Status" and "MFP Status".
If the job status screen is displayed, the status display automatically changes to "MFP Status".
(2) "Job Status" display
This shows the first 4 print jobs in the print queue (the job in progress and jobs waiting to be printed). The type of job, the set number of copies, the number of copies completed, and the job status appear.
Jobs cannot be manipulated in this screen. Jobs can only be manipulated in the job status screen.
For details, see the chapters for each of the functions in this manual.
(2) (3)
(3) "MFP Status" display
This shows machine system information.
"Maintenance Information"
This shows machine maintenance information by means of codes.
1-12
SYSTEM BAR
The system bar appears at the bottom of the touch panel.
The items that appear in the system bar are explained below.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Plain
A4
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Tray1
(1)
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Preview
(2)
(1) Job status display
The job in progress or reserved are indicated by icons.
The icons are as follows.
Print job Copy job
Scan to E-mail job
Scan to
Network Folder job
Fax transmission job
PC-Fax transmission job
Scan to FTP job
Scan to
Desktop job
Fax reception job
Internet Fax reception job
(Including
Direct SMTP)
Broadcast job*
Inbound routing job
Internet fax transmission job
(Including
Direct SMTP)
PC-I-Fax transmission job
Scan to HDD file print job
Tandem copy/print job
Metadata send job
* This appears in a multi-mode broadcast job.
MFP Status
020/015
Copying
020/015
Waiting
020/015
Waiting
020/015
Waiting
(3)
When a base screen other than that of image send mode appears, the number of the tray being used to feed paper appears during paper feeding. The colour appearing in the job status display depends on the job status as indicated in the table below.
The job status display can be touched to show the job status screen.
Job status display
Machine Configuration
Green
Yellow
Red
Grey
A print, scan or other job is being executed normally.
The machine is warming up or on standby, or a job is being cancelled.
A paper misfeed or other error condition has occurred.
The machine has no jobs.
(2) Icon display
This icon appears when data is being sent or received.
This icon appears when fax, scan, or
Internet fax data is stored in the machine's memory. When data to be transmitted is stored, appears. When received data is stored, appears. When both data to be transmitted and received data are stored,
appears.
This appears when a service technician has activated simulation mode.
This appears when a USB memory or other
USB device is connected to the machine.
1-13
This appears when the data security kit is being used.
The icon appears when the machine is communicating with an external application.
(3) Brightness adjustment key
Touch this key to adjust the brightness of the touch panel.
When touched, the following screen appears next to the key.
Touch the [+] key or the [-] key to adjust the brightness.
When finished, touch the brightness adjustment key again to close the screen.
1-14
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF
The machine has two power switches. The main power switch is at the lower left after the front cover is opened. The other power switch is the [POWER] key ( ) on the operation panel at the top right.
Main power switch
When the main power switch is switched on, the main power indicator on the operation panel lights up.
[POWER] key
Main power indicator
[POWER] key
"On" position
"Off" position
Turning on the power
(1) Switch the main power switch to the "on" position.
(2) Press the [POWER] key ( ) to turn on the power.
Turning off the power
(1) Press the [POWER] key ( ) to turn off the power.
(2) Switch the main power switch to the "off" position.
• When turning off the main power switch, ensure that each of the lamps on the operation panel has been turned off.
• In the event that the main power is suddenly interrupted due to a power failure or other reason, turn the machine power back on and then turn it off in the correct order. If the machine is left for a long time with the main power having been turned off prior to the [POWER] key ( ), abnormal noises, degraded image quality, and other problems may result.
Switching off the main power switch or removing the power cord from the outlet while any of the indicators are lit or blinking may damage the hard drive and cause data to be lost.
• Switch off both the [POWER] key ( ) and the main power switch and unplug the power cord if you suspect a machine failure, if there is a bad thunderstorm nearby, or when you are moving the machine.
When using the fax or Internet fax function, always keep the main power switch in the "on" position.
Restarting the machine
In order for some settings to take effect, the machine must be restarted.
If a message in the touch panel prompts you to restart the machine, press the [POWER] key ( ) to turn off the power and then press the key again to turn the power back on.
In some states of the machine, pressing the [POWER] key ( ) to restart will not make the settings take effect. In this case, use the main power switch to switch the power off and then on.
1-15
ENERGY SAVE FUNCTIONS
This product has the following two energy save functions that conform to the Energy Star guidelines to help conserve natural resources and reduce environmental pollution.
Preheat Mode (Low power mode)
Preheat mode automatically lowers the temperature of the fusing unit and thereby reduces power consumption if the machine remains in the standby state for the interval of time set in "Preheat Mode Setting" in the system settings
(administrator).
This keeps the fusing unit at a lower temperature and reduces power consumption while the machine is on standby.
The machine automatically wakes up and returns to normal operation when a print job is received, a key is pressed on the operation panel, or an original is placed.
Auto power shut-off mode (Sleep mode)
Auto power shut-off mode automatically shuts off power to the display and the fusing unit if the machine remains in the standby state for the interval of time set in "Auto Power Shut-Off Timer" in the system settings (administrator). This mode provides the lowest level of power consumption. Considerably more power is saved than in preheat mode, however, the wakeup time is longer. This mode can be disabled in the system settings (administrator).
The machine automatically wakes up and resumes normal operation when a print job is received or when the blinking
[POWER SAVE] key ( ) is pressed.
[POWER SAVE] KEY
Press the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) to put the machine in auto power shut-off mode or wake it up from auto power shut-off mode. The [POWER SAVE] key ( ) has an indicator that indicates whether or not the machine is in auto power shut-off mode.
When the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) indicator is off in the standby state
The machine is ready to be used.
If the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) is pressed when the indicator is off, the indicator will blink and the machine will enter auto power shut-off mode after a brief interval.
When the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) indicator is blinking
The machine is in auto power shut-off mode.
If the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) is pressed when the indicator is blinking, the indicator will turn off and the machine will return to the ready state after a brief interval.
[POWER SAVE] key / indicator
1-16
USER AUTHENTICATION
User authentication restricts the use of the machine to users that have been registered. The functions that each user is allowed to use can be specified, allowing the machine to be customized to meet the needs of your workplace.
When the administrator of the machine has enabled user authentication, each user must log in to use the machine.
There are different types of user authentication, and each type has a different login method.
For more information, see the explanations of the login methods.
☞
(see below)
☞
AUTHENTICATION BY LOGIN NAME / PASSWORD (page 1-19)
AUTHENTICATION BY USER NUMBER
The following procedure is used to log in using a user number received from the administrator of the machine.
OK User Authentication
Admin Login
When controlled by user number
Enter your user number (5 to 8 digits) with the numeric keys.
Each entered digit will be displayed as " ".
1
1-17
2
User Authentication OK
Touch the [OK] key.
After the entered user number is authenticated, the user count screen will appear briefly.
Usage status: used/remaining pages
Black-white : 87,654,321/12,345,678
Full colour : 87,654,321/12,345,678
2-colour : 87,654,321/12,345,678
Single colour: 87,654,321/12,345,678
Admin Login
When page limits have been set in "Pages Limit Group List" in the system settings (administrator), the number of pages remaining will appear. (The remaining number of pages that the user can use in each mode (copy, scan, etc.) appears.) The amount of time that this screen appears can be changed using
"Message Time Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
When the user number is an 8-digit number, this step is not necessary. (Login takes place automatically after the user number is entered.)
3
When you have finished using the machine and are ready to log out, press the [LOGOUT] key ( ).
LOGOUT
• However, note that the [LOGOUT] key ( ) cannot be used to log out when a fax number is being entered in fax mode, as the key is used for fax number entry.
• If a preset duration of time elapses after the machine is last used, the Auto Clear function will activate. When Auto
Clear activates, logout takes place automatically. However, when PC Scan mode is used, logout does not take place when the [LOGOUT] key ( ) is pressed and Auto Clear does not operate. Change to a different mode on the machine and then log out.
If an incorrect user number is entered 3 times in a row...
If "A Warning when Login Fails" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), the machine will lock for 5 minutes if an incorrect user number is entered 3 times in a row.
Verify the user number that you should use with the administrator of the machine.
The administrator can clear the locked state.
This is done from [User Control] and then [Default Settings] in the Web page menu.
1-18
AUTHENTICATION BY LOGIN NAME / PASSWORD
The following procedure is used to log in using a login name and password received from the administrator of the machine or the administrator of the LDAP server.
The LDAP certification requires the hard disk drive.
User Authentication OK
Login Name
User Name
Password
Auth to: Login Locally
When controlled by login name and password
(Different items will appear in the screen when LDAP authentication is used.)
1
User Authentication
Login Name
User Name
Password
Auth to: Login Locally
OK
Touch the [Login Name] key or the key.
If the [Login Name] key is touched, a screen for selecting the user name appears. Go to the next step.
If the key is touched, an area for entering a "Registration
No." appears [---].
Use the numeric keys to enter your registration number that has been stored in "User List" in the system settings
(administrator). After entering the registration number, go to step 3.
2
(A) (B) (C)
Device Account Mode User Selection
6 12 18
Admin Login
Direct Entry
User 0001
User 0003
User 0005
User 0007
User 0009
User 0011
All ABCD
ABC
User
Back
EFGH
User 0002
User 0004
User 0006
User 0008
User 0010
User 0012
IJKL
1
2
MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
(D)
Select the user name.
(A) [Direct Entry] key
Use this key if you have not been stored in "User List" in the system settings (administrator) and are only using
LDAP authentication.
A text entry screen will appear. Enter your login name.
(B) User selection keys
Touch your user name that has been stored in "User List" in the system settings (administrator).
(C) [Back] key
Touch this key to return to the login screen.
(D) Index tabs
All users appear on the [All] tab. Users are grouped on the other tabs according to the search characters entered when each user was stored.
LDAP authentication can be used when the administrator of the server provides LDAP service on the LAN (local area network).
1-19
3
User Authentication
Login Name
User Name User 0001
Password
Auth to: Login Locally
OK
Touch the [Password] key.
A text entry screen for entering the password will appear.
Enter your password that is stored in "User List" in the system settings (administrator).
If you are logging in to an LDAP server, enter the password that is stored with your LDAP server login name.
Each entered character will be displayed as " ". When you have finished entering the password, touch the [OK] key.
When authentication is by LDAP server and you have different passwords stored in "User List" in the system settings
(administrator) and in the LDAP server, use the password stored in the LDAP server.
• When an LDAP server has been stored, [Auth to:] can be changed.
• If you are logging in using a user selection key...
The LDAP server was stored when your user information was stored, and thus the LDAP server will appear as the authentication server when you select your login name. Go to step 4.
• When logging in using the [Direct Entry] key...
Touch the [Auth to:] key.
User Authentication OK
Login Name
User Name Direct Entry
Password
Auth to: Login Locally
Select the LDAP server and touch the [OK] key.
Authenticate to:
Login Locally
Server 1
Server 2
Server 3
Server 4
Server 5
Server 6
Server 7
OK
1-20
User Authentication OK
Login Name
User Name User 0001
Password
Auth to: Login Locally
4
(Different items will appear in the screen when LDAP authentication is used.)
5
Touch the [OK] key.
After the entered login name and password are authenticated, the user count screen will appear briefly.
Usage status: used/remaining pages
Black-white : 87,654,321/12,345,678
Full colour : 87,654,321/12,345,678
2-colour : 87,654,321/12,345,678
Single colour: 87,654,321/12,345,678
When page limits have been set in "Pages Limit Group List" in the system settings (administrator), the number of pages remaining will appear. (The remaining number of pages that the user can use in each mode (copy, scan, etc.) appears.) The amount of time that this screen appears can be changed using
"Message Time Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
When you have finished using the machine and are ready to log out, press the [LOGOUT] key ( ).
LOGOUT
• However, note that the [LOGOUT] key ( ) cannot be used to log out when a fax number is being entered in fax mode, as the key is used for fax number entry.
• If a preset duration of time elapses after the machine is last used, the Auto Clear function will activate. When Auto
Clear activates, logout takes place automatically. However, when PC Scan mode is used, logout does not take place when the [LOGOUT] key ( ) is pressed and Auto Clear does not operate. Change to a different mode on the machine and then log out.
If an incorrect login name or password is entered 3 times in a row...
If "A Warning when Login Fails" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), the machine will lock for 5 minutes if an incorrect login name or password is entered 3 times in a row.
Verify the login name and password that you should use with the administrator of the machine.
• The administrator can clear the locked state.
This is done from [User Control] and then [Default Settings] in the Web page menu.
• When LDAP authentication is used, the [E-mail Address] key may appear, depending on the authentication method. If the
[E-mail Address] key appears in step 3, touch the key.
A text entry screen will appear. Enter your e-mail address.
User Authentication OK
Login Name
User Name
E-mail Address
User 0002
Password
Auth to: Server 2
System Settings (Administrator): User List
This is used to store names of users of the machine. Detailed information such as the login name, user number, and password are also stored. Ask the administrator of the machine for the information that you need to use the machine.
1-21
HOME SCREEN
When the [HOME] key is pressed on the operation panel, the home screen appears in the touch panel. Mode selection keys appear in the home screen. These keys can be touched to open the base screen of each mode. The [My Menu] key can be touched to display shortcuts to functions stored in "My Menu".
1st screen
(1)
2nd screen
(1) (2) (3)
IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
COPY
My Menu COPY IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
Total Count
Document Filing
Control
Address Control
Paper Tray Settings
My Menu App 01 App 02 App 03 App 04
(4)
(1) Mode select keys
Use these keys to switch between copy, image send, document filing, and Sharp OSA modes. Key names and images can be changed. (1st screen only)
(2) Background Image
Background image of the home screen. The background image can be changed.
(3) [My Menu] key
Touch to go to your my menu screen. Key names and images can be changed.
(4) Application Keys*
It is possible to display a combined total of eight Sharp
OSA application shortcuts and my menu shortcuts.
(5) (6)
04/04/2010 11:40
(7)
(5) Title
This shows the title of the my menu screen.
(6) Shortcut key
A registered function appears as a shortcut key.
The key can be touched to select the registered function.
(7) User name
This shows the name of the logged in user.
The user name appears when user authentication is enabled on the machine.
* This function requires the hard disk drive.
Shortcuts to functions can be registered as keys in the my menu screen. When a shortcut key is touched, the screen for that function appears. Register frequently used functions in the my menu screen to quickly and conveniently access those functions. When user authentication is used, the my menu screen of "Favourite Operation Group" can be displayed.
Use the Web page to configure the following settings:
• Changing the name of the home screen key, changing the image, storing an application key
• Storing keys that appear in the my menu screen.
• System Settings (Administrator): My Menu Settings
Registration is performed in [System Settings] - [Operation Settings] - [My Menu Settings] in the Web page menu.
• System Settings (Administrator): My Menu List
When user authentication is enabled, a my menu screen can be set for each "Favourite Operation Group List".
Registration is performed in "My Menu List" in [User Control] in the Web page menu.
1-22
REMOTE OPERATION OF THE MACHINE
The remote operation function allows you to operate the machine from your computer.
When this function is added, the same screen as the operation panel screen appears on your computer. This allows you to operate the machine from your computer in the same way as if you were standing in front of the machine.
The machine
Your computer
Operation panel
Network
The remote operation function can only be used on one computer at a time.
How to use the remote operation function
Before using this function, set "Operational Authority" to "Allowed" in "Remote Software Operation" of "Remote
Operation Settings" in the system settings (administrator).
☞
7. SYSTEM SETTINGS " Remote Operation Settings " (page 7-66)
To use the remote operation function, the machine must be connected to a network and a VNC application must be installed on your computer (recommended VNC software: RealVNC).
The procedure for using this function is as follows:
Example: RealVNC
1
(3) (2)
Connect from the computer to the machine.
(1) Start the VNC viewer
(2) Enter the IP address of the machine in the
"Server" entry box.
(3) Click the [OK] button.
2
Follow the prompts on the operation panel of the machine to permit the connection.
When the machine is connected to the remote software, appears on the system bar of the machine's touch panel.
If you wish to disconnect, exit the remote software or touch .
Use the operation panel in the same way as you would on the machine. Note that a key cannot be held down to continuously change a value being entered. For detailed procedures, see the chapters for each of the functions in this manual.
System Settings (Administrator): Remote Operation Settings
Set the operation authority for the remote operation function.
1-23
10
11
12
13
14
15
ITEMS RECORDED IN THE JOB LOG
This function requires the hard disk drive.
The machine records the jobs that are performed in the job log.
The main information that is recorded in the job log is described below.
• To make it easy to total the usage counts of differently configured machines, the items recorded in the job log are fixed, regardless of what peripheral devices are installed or the objective of the recording.
• In some cases, job information may not be correctly recorded, such as when a power failure occurs during a job.
No.
1 Main items
5
6
7
2
3
4
8
9
Item name Description
Job ID The job ID is recorded.
Job IDs appear in the log as consecutive numbers up to a maximum of 999999, after which the count resets to 1.
The job mode, such as copy or print.
Job Mode
Computer Name
User Name
Login Name
Starting Date & Time
Completing Date &
Time
Black & White Total
Count
The name of the computer that sent a print job.*
The user name when the user authentication function is used.
The login name when the user authentication function is used.
The date and time the job was started.
The date and time the job was completed.
For a print job, the total count is recorded.
For a send job, the number of transmitted black & white pages is recorded. When a broadcast transmission is summarized, the total number of pages is recorded.
For a scan to HDD job, the number of stored black & white pages is recorded.
Full Colour Total Count For a print job, the total count is recorded.
For a send job, the total number of transmitted full colour pages is recorded. When a broadcast transmission is summarized, the total number of pages is recorded.
For a scan to HDD job, the number of stored full colour pages is recorded.
2-Colour Total Count Indicates the total 2-colour count.
Single Colour Total
Count
Indicates the total single colour count.
Count according to size Counts by original/paper size in colour mode and black & white mode.
Indicates the sheet count by paper type.
Number of sheets according to size
Invalid Paper
Count(Black & White)
Indicates the black & white invalid sheet count.
Invalid Paper
Count(Colour)
Indicates the colour invalid sheet count.
1-24
39
40
41
42
36
37
38
43
44
23
24
25
26
20
21
22
27
28
29
30
31
No.
16
17
18
19
32
33
34
35
Main items
Item name
Number of Reserved
Sets
Description
Number of specified sets or reserved destinations.
Print Job Related Item
Image Send Related
Item
Number of Completed
Sets
Number of Reserved
Pages
Number of completed sets or number of destinations to which transmission was successfully completed.
Number of reserved original pages of a copy, print, scan job, or other job.
Number of completed pages of a set.
Number of Completed
Pages
Result
Error Cause
Output
Staple
Staple Count
Punch Count
Printer Tone
Direct Address
Sender Name
Sender Address
Transmission Type
The result of a job.
When an error occurs during a job, the cause of the error.
The output mode of a printed job.
The status of stapling.
The staple count.
The punch count.
The tone used for a print job.
Address of an image send job.
Sender name of an image send job.
Sender address of an image send job.
Transmission type of an image send job.
Administrative serial number of an image send job.
Administrative Serial
Number
Broadcast number Broadcast number of an image send job.
Entry Order
File Type
Reservation order for broadcast transmission of an image send job.
For a serial polling job, this is used to correlate communication with printing.
File format of an image send job.
Compression
Mode/Compression
Ratio
Compression mode and compression ratio of the file of an image send job.
Communication Time Indicates the communication time of image send jobs.
Document Filing
Related Item
Fax No.
Document Filing
Storing Mode
File Name 2
Data Size [KB]
Common Functionality Colour Setting
Special Modes
File Name 2
Indicates the stored sender's number.
Status of document filing.
Document filing storing mode.
File name of a file stored by document filing or retention print.*
File size.
Colour mode selected by user.
Special modes selected when the job was executed.
Records the file names of print jobs.*
1-25
56
57
58
53
54
55
No.
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
Detailed Items
Machine Item
Item name
Original Size
Original Type
Paper Size
Description
Size of scanned original.
For a document filing print job, the paper size of the file.
Original type (text, printed photo, etc.) set in the exposure settings screen.
For a print job, the paper size.
For a send job, the transmitted paper size.
For a Scan to HDD job, the paper size of the stored file.
The paper type used for printing.
Indicates that duplex was disabled in "Paper Type".
Paper Type
Paper Property:
Disable Duplex
Paper Property: Fixed
Paper Side
Paper Property:
Disable Staple
Paper Property:
Disable Punch
Duplex Setup
Resolution
Model Name
Unit Serial Number
Name
Machine Location
Indicates that fixed side was specified in "Paper Type".
Indicates that stapling was disabled in "Paper Type".
Indicates that punching was disabled in "Paper Type".
Indicates the duplex setting.
Indicates the scanning resolution.
Indicates the model name of the machine.
Indicates the serial number of the machine.
Indicates the name of the machine that is set in the Web pages.
Indicates the installation location of the machine that is set in the Web pages.
*In some environments this is not recorded.
1-26
LOADING PAPER
IMPORTANT POINTS ABOUT PAPER
This section provides information that you should know before loading paper in the paper trays.
Be sure to read this section before loading paper.
NAMES AND LOCATIONS OF TRAYS
The names of the trays are as follows.
Bypass tray
Tray 1
Tray 2*
Tray 3*
Tray 4*
*Optional paper drawer is installed.
THE MEANING OF "R" IN PAPER SIZES
Some original and paper sizes can be placed in either the vertical or the horizontal orientation. To differentiate between vertical and horizontal orientations, paper sizes in the horizontal orientation will be followed by an "R" (for example, A4R,
8-1/2" x 11"R).
Sizes that can be placed only in the horizontal orientation (A3W, A3, B4, 12" x 18", 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 13") do not include the "R" in their size indication.
A4R
(8-½" x 11"R)
Horizontal orientation
"R" is appended.
A4
(8-½" x 11")
Vertical orientation
"R" is not appended.
1-27
A3
(11" x 17")
Can be placed only in the horizontal orientation
"R" is not appended.
USEABLE PAPER
Various types of paper are sold. This section explains what plain paper and what special media can be used with the machine. For detailed information on the sizes and types of paper that can be loaded in each tray of the machine, see the specifications in the Start Guide and "
Paper Tray Settings " (page 7-13) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS".
Plain paper, special media
Plain paper that can be used
• SHARP standard plain paper (80 g /m 2 (21 lbs.)). For paper specifications, see the specifications in the Start Guide.
• Pain paper other than SHARP standard paper (60 g /m 2 to 105 g /m 2 (16 lbs. to 28 lbs.))
Recycled paper, coloured paper and pre-punched paper must meet the same specifications as plain paper. Contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative for advice on using these types of paper.
Types of paper that can be used in each tray
The following types of paper can be loaded in each tray.
Plain paper
Pre-printed
Recycle Paper
Letter head
Pre-punched
Colour
Heavy paper 1*
Heavy paper 2*
Labels
Glossy paper
1
1
Transparency film
Tab paper
Trays 1 to 4
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
–
–
–
–
–
Bypass tray
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Permitted
Envelopes – Permitted
Thin paper* 2 – Permitted
*1 "Heavy paper 1" is heavy paper up to 209 g /m 2 (110 lbs. index), and "Heavy paper 2" is heavy paper up to 256 g /m 2 (140 lbs. index).
*2 Thin paper from 55 g /m 2 to 59 g /m 2 (13 lbs. to 16 lbs.) can be used.
1-28
Print side face up or face down
Paper is loaded with the print side face up or face down depending on the paper type and tray.
Trays 1 to 4
Load the paper with the print side face up.
However, if the paper type is "Letter Head" or "Pre-Printed", load the paper with the print side face down*.
Bypass tray
Load the paper with the print side face down.
However, if the paper type is "Letter Head" or "Pre-Printed", load the paper with the print side face up*.
* If "Disabling of Duplex" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), load the paper in the normal way (face up in trays 1 to 4; face down in the bypass tray).
Paper that cannot be used
• Special media for inkjet printers
(fine paper, glossy paper, glossy film, etc.)
• Carbon paper or thermal paper
• Pasted paper
• Paper with clips
• Paper with fold marks
• Torn paper
• Oil-feed transparency film
• Thin paper less than 55 g /m 2 (15 lbs.)
• Paper that is 257 g /m 2 (69 lbs.) or heavier
• Irregularly shaped paper
• Stapled paper
• Damp paper
• Curled paper
• Paper on which either the print side or the reverse side has been printed on by another printer or multifunction device.
• Paper with a wave-like pattern due to moisture absorption
Non-recommended paper
• Iron-on transfer paper
• Japanese paper
• Perforated paper
• Various types of plain paper and special media are sold. Some types cannot be used with the machine. Contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative for advice on using these types of paper.
• The image quality and toner fusibility of paper may change due to ambient conditions, operating conditions, and paper characteristics, resulting in image quality inferior to that of SHARP standard paper. Contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative for advice on using these types of paper.
• The use of non-recommended or prohibited paper may result in skewed feeding, misfeeds, poor toner fusing (the toner does not adhere to the paper well and can be rubbed off), or machine failure.
• The use of non-recommended paper may result in misfeeds or poor image quality. Before using non-recommended paper, check if printing can be performed properly.
1-29
TRAY SETTINGS FOR TRAY 1 TO 4
LOADING PAPER AND CHANGING THE PAPER SIZE
A maximum of 500 sheets of paper from size A5R to A3 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R to 11" x 17") can be loaded in trays 1 to 4.
1
Pull out the paper tray.
Gently pull the tray out until it stops.
To load paper, go to step 3. To load a different size of paper, go to the next step.
2
A
B
3
Adjust the guide plates A and B by squeezing their lock levers and sliding them to match the vertical and horizontal dimensions of the paper to be loaded.
The guide plates A and B are slidable. Slide each guide plate while squeezing its lock lever.
Fan the paper.
Fan the paper well before loading it. If the paper is not fanned, multiple sheets may feed at once and cause a misfeed.
4
Indicator line
Insert the paper into the tray.
Load the paper with the print side face up. The stack must not be higher than the indicator line (maximum of 500 sheets).
1-30
Gently push the paper tray into the machine.
Push the tray firmly all the way into the machine.
5
If you loaded a different type or size of paper than was loaded previously, be sure to change the "Paper Tray Settings" in the system settings. If these settings are not configured correctly, automatic paper selection will not operate correctly and printing may take place on the wrong size or type of paper, or a misfeed may occur.
Do not place heavy objects on the tray or press down on the tray.
System Settings:
Paper Tray Settings (page 7-13)
Change these settings when you change the size or type of paper loaded in a tray.
1-31
LOADING PAPER IN THE BYPASS TRAY
The bypass tray can be used to print on plain paper, envelopes, label sheets, tab paper, and other special media. Up to
100 sheets of paper can be loaded (up to 40 sheets of heavy paper) for continuous printing similar to the other trays.
Open the bypass tray.
1
When loading a large sheet of paper, be sure to pull out the bypass tray extension. Pull the bypass tray extension all the way out.
2
Do not place heavy objects on the bypass tray or press down on the tray.
Set the bypass tray guides to the width of the paper.
3
Insert the paper along the bypass tray guides all the way into the bypass tray until it stops.
Load the paper with the print side face down.
• Do not force the paper in.
• If the bypass tray guides are set wider than the paper, move the bypass tray guides in until they correctly fit the width of the paper. If the bypass guides are set too wide, the paper may skew or be creased.
1-32
IMPORTANT POINTS WHEN USING THE BYPASS TRAY
• When using plain paper other than SHARP standard paper or special media other than SHARP-recommended transparency film, or when printing on the reverse side of previously used paper, the paper must be loaded one sheet at a time. Loading more than one sheet at a time will cause misfeeds.
• Before loading paper, straighten any curling in the paper.
• When adding paper, remove any paper remaining in the bypass tray, combine it with the paper to be added, and reload as a single stack. If paper is added without removing the remaining paper, a misfeed may result.
Inserting paper
Place paper that is A5 (7-1/4" x 10-1/2") or smaller in the horizontal orientation.
Inserting tab paper
To print on tab paper, load tab paper in the bypass tray with the print side face down.
Face down
• Use only tab paper that is made of paper. Tab paper made of a material other than paper (film, etc.) cannot be used.
• To print on the tabs of tab paper...
In copy mode, use "Tab Copy" in the special modes. In print mode, use the tab print function.
Inserting transparency film
Horizontally Vertically
• Use SHARP-recommended transparency film. When inserting transparency film in the bypass tray, the rounded corner should be at the front left when the film is oriented horizontally, or at the far left when the film is oriented vertically.
• When loading multiple sheets of transparency film in the bypass tray, be sure to fan the sheets several times before loading.
• When printing on transparency film, be sure to remove each sheet as it exits the machine. Allowing sheets to stack in the output tray may result in curling.
1-33
Loading envelopes
When inserting envelopes in the bypass tray, place them aligned to the left side in the orientation shown below.
Only the front side of envelopes can be printed on. Be sure to place the front side face down.
Important points when using envelopes
• Do not print on both sides of an envelope. This may result in misfeeds or poor print quality.
• Restrictions apply to some types of envelopes. For more information, consult a qualified service technician.
• Some operating environments may cause creasing, smudging, misfeeds, poor toner fusing, or machine failure.
• Do not use the following envelopes:
Envelopes with metal clasps, plastic hooks, or ribbon hooks; envelopes closed with string, envelopes with windows or backing, envelopes with an uneven front surface due to embossing, double-layer envelopes, envelopes with an adhesive for sealing, hand-made envelopes, envelopes with air inside, envelopes with creases or fold marks, torn or damaged envelopes
• Envelopes with an incorrectly aligned corner gluing position on the back cannot be used as creasing may result.
• Print quality is not guaranteed in the area 10 mm (13/32") around the edges of the envelope.
• Print quality is not guaranteed on parts of envelopes where there is a large step-like change of thickness, such as on four-layer parts or parts less than three layers.
• Print quality is not guaranteed on envelopes having peel off flaps for sealing the envelopes.
Can be used
Cannot be used
1-34
ORIGINALS
This section explains how to place originals in the automatic document feeder and on the document glass.
PLACING THE ORIGINAL
PLACING ORIGINALS IN THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT
FEEDER
This section explains how to place originals in the automatic document feeder.
Allowed original sizes
Minimum original size Maximum original size
Standard sizes
(Minimum size that can be automatically detected)
A5: 148 mm (height) x 210 mm (width)
5-1/2" (height) x 8-1/2" (width)
Non-standard sizes
(Minimum size that can be specified manually)
131 mm (height) x 140 mm (width)
5-1/8" (height) x 5-1/2" (width)
Standard sizes
(Maximum size that can be automatically detected)
A3: 297 mm (height) x 420 mm (width)
12" x 18" size paper (A3W) cannot be used.
11" (height) x 17" (width)
Non-standard sizes
(Maximum size that can be specified manually)
Copy mode: 297 mm (height) x 432 mm (width)
11-5/8" (height) x 17" (width)
Image send mode: 297 mm (height) x 1000 mm (width)
11" (height) x 39-3/8" (width)
When the original is a non-standard size, see the appropriate explanation below for the mode you are using.
☞
2. COPIER "
SPECIFYING THE ORIGINAL SIZE " (page 2-29)
☞
4. FACSIMILE "
☞
5. SCANNER / INTERNET FAX "
Allowed original weights
1-sided copying: 35 g /m 2 to 128 g /m 2 (9 lbs. to 34 lbs.)
2-sided copying: 50 g /m 2 to 105 g /m 2 (15 lbs. to 28 lbs.)
To scan originals from 35 g /m 2 to 49 g /m 2 (9 lbs. to 14 lbs.), use "Slow Scan Mode" in the special modes. Scanning without using "Slow Scan Mode" may result in original misfeeds.
When "Slow Scan Mode" is selected, automatic 2-sided scanning is not possible.
1-35
Make sure an original does not remain on the document glass.
Open the automatic document feeder, make sure that an original is not on the document glass, and then gently close the automatic document feeder.
1
Adjust the original guides to the size of the originals.
2
3
Indicator line
Place the original.
Make sure the edges of the originals are even.
Insert the originals face up all the way into the document feeder tray.
Insert a number of originals that does not exceed the indicator line on the document feeder tray.
Up to 100 sheets can be inserted.
Be sure to remove originals that have been finished scanning from the original exit tray.
• Originals of different sizes can be placed together in the automatic document feeder. In this case, select "Mixed Size
Original" in the special modes of the mode you are using.
• Before inserting originals into the document feeder tray, be sure to remove any staples or paper clips.
• If originals have damp spots due to correction fluid, ink or pasteup glue, wait until the originals are dry before making copies. Otherwise the interior of the document feeder or the document glass may be soiled.
• Do not use the following originals. Incorrect original size detection, original misfeeds, and smudges may result.
Transparency film, tracing paper, carbon paper, thermal paper or originals printed with thermal transfer ink ribbon should not be fed through the document feeder. Originals to be fed through the feeder should not be damaged, crumpled, folded, loosely pasted together, or have cut-out holes. Originals with multiple punched holes other than two-hole or three-hole punched paper may not feed correctly.
• When using originals with two or three holes, place them so that the punched edge is at a position away from the feed slot of the document feeder tray.
Feed slot
Hole positions
1-36
PLACING THE ORIGINAL ON THE DOCUMENT GLASS
This section explains how to place the original on the document glass.
Allowed original sizes
Maximum original size
Standard sizes
A3: 297 mm (height) x 420 mm (width)
11" (height) x 17" (width)
Non-standard sizes
297 mm (height) x 432 mm (width)
11-5/8" (height) x 17" (width)
When the original is a non-standard size, see the appropriate explanation below for the mode you are using.
☞
2. COPIER "
"
☞
4. FACSIMILE "
☞
5. SCANNER / INTERNET FAX "
Open the automatic document feeder.
1
2
Place the original.
Place the original face down in the far left corner of the document glass.
Document glass scale
mark
Document glass scale
mark
Original size detector
A5
(5-1/2" x 8-1/2")
B5
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
B5R
A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R)
B4 (8-1/2" x 14")
A3 (11" x 17")
The original should always be placed in the far left corner, regardless of its size.
Align the top left corner of the original with the tip of the mark.
Do not place any objects under the original size detector.
Closing the automatic document feeder with an object underneath may damage the original size detector and prevent correct detection of the original size.
If you are placing a small non-standard size original on the document glass, it is convenient to place a blank sheet of
A4 or B5 (8-1/2" x 11" or 5-1/2" x 8-1/2") paper on top of the original to facilitate detection of the original size.
1-37
Close the automatic document feeder.
After placing the original, be sure to close the automatic document feeder. If left open, parts outside of the original will be copied black, causing excessive use of toner.
3
Placing a thick book
When scanning a thick book or other thick original, follow the steps below to press the book down.
(1)
(2)
(1) Push up the far side of the automatic document feeder.
The hinges supporting the automatic document feeder will release and the rear side of the automatic document feeder will rise.
(2) Slowly close the automatic document feeder.
Caution
• Close the automatic document feeder slowly. Abruptly closing the automatic document feeder may damage it.
• Take care that your fingers are not pinched when closing the automatic document feeder.
The automatic document feeder cannot be closed correctly in this state. To return the automatic document feeder to its normal state, open it completely and then close it.
1-38
PERIPHERAL DEVICES
This section describes the peripheral devices that can be used with the machine and explains how to use the finisher, as well as Sharp OSA (application communication module and external account module).
PERIPHERAL DEVICES
Peripheral devices can be installed on the machine to increase its range of functionality.
The peripheral devices are generally optional, however, some models include certain peripheral devices as standard equipment.
(As of August, 2010)
Product name
Document cover
Reversing single pass feeder
(Automatic document feeder)
Stand/1x500 sheet paper drawer
Stand/2x500 sheet paper drawer
Stand/3x500 sheet paper drawer
Exit tray unit
(Right tray)
Product number
MX-VR11
MX-RP12
MX-DE12
MX-DE13
MX-DE14
MX-TR12
Description
This holds down the original.
This automatically turns the original over to enable scanning of both sides.
Additional tray. A maximum 500 sheets of paper can be loaded in each tray.
This can be added to the right side of the machine.
Finisher MX-FN17
Output device that enables the use of the staple function and offset function.
Punch module
MX-PN11A
MX-PN11B
MX-PN11C
MX-PN11D
Punches holes in copies and other output. Requires a finisher.
Printer expansion kit
Barcode font kit
PS3 expansion kit
XPS expansion kit
Expansion memory board
Internet fax expansion kit
Facsimile expansion kit
Application integration module
Application communication module
MX-PB14
MX-PF10
MX-PK11
MX-PUX1
MX-SM10
MX-FWX1
MX-FX11
MX-AMX1
MX-AMX2
Adds a PCL6 printer function. To install this kit, the hard disk drive is required.
Adds barcode fonts to the machine. To use the Barcode font kit, the printer expansion kit (MX-PB14) is required.
Enables the machine to be used as a Postscript compatible printer. To use the PS3 expansion kit, the printer expansion kit
(MX-PB14) is required.
The machine can be used as an XPS compatible printer. For details, consult your dealer.
To install this kit, a 1 GB expansion memory board (MX-SM10) and printer expansion kit (MX-PB14) are required.
This expands the memory that can be used on the machine.
Enables Internet Fax.
Adds a fax function.
The application integration module can be combined with the network scanner function to append a metadata file to a scanned image file.
This allows the machine to be linked over a network to an external software application.
1-39
Product name
External account module
Sharpdesk 1 licence kit
Sharpdesk 5 licence kit
Sharpdesk 10 licence kit
Sharpdesk 50 licence kit
Sharpdesk 100 licence kit
Stamp unit
Hard disk expansion kit
Some options may not be available in some countries and regions.
Product number
MX-AMX3
MX-USX1
MX-USX5
MX-US10
MX-US50
MX-USA0
AR-SU1
MX-HD10
Description
This is required to use an external account application on the machine.
This software enables integrated management of documents and computer files.
This stamps each original page after it is scanned in image send mode.
Add a hard disk drive and add functions.
1-40
FINISHER
The finisher is equipped with the offset function, which offsets each set of output from the previous set.
In addition, each set of sorted output can be stapled.
An optional hole punching unit can also be installed to punch holes in output.
PART NAMES
The following parts can be accessed when the finisher is open.
(1) (2) (3) (4)
(5)
(1) Output tray
Stapled and offset output is delivered to this tray.
The tray is slidable. Extend the tray for large output
(A3W, A3, A4R, B4, B5R, 12" x 18", 11" x 17",
8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 13", 8-1/2" x 13-1/2",
8-1/2" x 13-2/5", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 7-1/4" x 10-1/2"R, 8K and
16KR sizes).
(2) Lever
Use this to move the finisher in order to remove a paper misfeed, replace staples, or remove a staple jam.
(3) Staple case
This holds the staple cartridge. Pull the case out to replace the staple cartridge, remove a staple jam, or remove the punch scrap case.
(6)
(4) Staple case release lever
Use this to remove the staple case.
(5) Punch waste box (when a punch module is installed)
This holds punch waste.
(6) Front cover
Open this cover to remove a paper misfeed, replace staples, remove a staple jam, or remove the punch scrap case.
Use caution when you turn on the power and when printing is taking place, as the tray may move up and down.
SUPPLIES
The finisher requires the following staple cartridge:
Staple cartridge
(approx. 5000 staples per cartridge x 3 cartridges)
MX-SCX1
1-41
FINISHER MAINTENANCE
When the staple cartridge runs out of staples, a message will appear in the operation panel. Follow the procedure below to replace the staple cartridge.
Replacing the staple cartridge
Open the cover.
1
While pressing the lever over to the left, slide the finisher to the left until it stops.
Gently slide the finisher until it stops.
2
Lower the staple case release lever and remove the staple case.
Pull the staple case out to the right.
3
Remove the empty staple cartridge from the staple case.
4
Insert a new staple cartridge into the staple case as shown.
Push the staple cartridge in until it clicks into place.
5
1-42
6
7
8
Replace the staple case.
Push the staple case in until it clicks into place.
Slide the finisher back to the right.
Gently slide the finisher back to the right until it locks into its original position.
Close the cover.
Make a test print or copy in staple sort mode to verify that stapling takes place correctly.
1-43
PUNCH MODULE
A punch module can be installed to punch holes in output. To install a punch module, a finisher is required.
DISCARDING PUNCH WASTE
Punch waste from punched holes is collected in the punch waste box.
Follow the steps below to discard the punch waste.
Finisher
Open the cover.
1
While pressing the lever over to the left, slide the finisher to the left until it stops.
Gently slide the finisher until it stops.
2
Grasp the punch waste box handle, gently pull out the box, and discard the punch waste.
Discard the punch waste in a plastic bag or other container, taking care not to let the waste scatter.
3
Gently push the box back in.
4
1-44
5
6
Slide the finisher back to the right.
Gently slide the finisher back to the right until it locks into its original position.
Close the cover.
1-45
SHARP OSA
This function requires the hard disk drive.
Sharp OSA (Open Systems Architecture) is an architecture that enables external applications to be directly connected to a digital multifunction machine over a network.
When a digital multifunction machine that supports Sharp OSA is used, the operation panel controls and functions of the machine such as scan send can be linked to an external application.
There are two types of external applications: "standard application" and "external account application". An "external account application" is used for centralized account management of a multifunction machine on a network. A "standard application" refers to all other applications.
APPLICATION COMMUNICATION MODULE (MX-AMX2)
The application communication module is required to use a "standard application" on the machine.
When a previously registered standard application is selected in the Web pages of the machine, the machine retrieves the operation screen from the registered URL. Control of the operation screen is performed by the standard application, and Scan to FTP, Scan to Network Folder, and HTTPS transmission can be executed.
Standard application setup
To enable a general application in the Web pages of the machine, click [Application Settings] in the administrator menu frame, and then [External Applications Settings] and [Standard Applications]. Configure settings for the standard application in the screen that appears.
Selecting a standard application
The procedure for selecting a general application that has been enabled in the Web pages of the machine is explained below.
1
COPY IMAGE SEND
Ready to scan for copy.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
DOCUMENT
FILING
Plain
A4
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
0
Preview
Touch the [Sharp OSA] key in the mode select keys.
If no standard applications have been stored in the Web pages, the key cannot be touched.
1-46
Select External Application
App 01 App 02
2
App 00
App 04 App 05 App 06
App 03
App 07
Select the standard application.
If two or more standard applications have been stored in the
Web pages, the screen to select the standard application will appear. Touch the standard application that you wish to use.
If only one standard application has been stored in the Web pages, connection to the standard application will begin.
3
The machine connects to the standard application.
The message "Connecting to the external application." appears while the machine communicates with the standard application.
The mode select key cannot be used during scanning.
EXTERNAL ACCOUNT MODULE (MX-AMX3)
The external account module is required to use a "external account application" on the machine.
An external account application can be used in "external authentication mode" or "external count mode". When external authentication mode is used, the login screen is retrieved from the application when the machine is started. When a job ends, a job notification screen is sent to the application to enable counts to be kept for each authenticated user.
When "external count mode" is used, the login screen is not displayed when the machine is started. Only a job result notification is sent to the application. User authentication by the external account application cannot be used, however, the external account application can be used in combination with the internal account function.
External account application setup
To enable an external account application in the Web pages of the machine, click [Application Settings] in the administrator menu frame, and then [External Applications Settings] and [External Accounting Application Settings].
Configure settings for the external account application in the screen that appears. The setting change will take effect after the machine is restarted. To restart the machine, see "
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF " (page 1-15).
Operation in external account mode
The two modes for using an external account application operate as explained below.
External authentication mode
When the [Enable Authentication by External Server] checkbox is selected in "External Account Setting" of "Sharp OSA
Settings" in the system settings (administrator), the machine enters external authentication mode. When the machine is powered on in external authentication mode, the machine accesses the external account application and displays the login screen. The login screen also appears when the [Call] key is touched to run a job in the job status complete screen.
(The login screen does not appear if the user has already logged in by the normal method.)
The [JOB STATUS] key can be pressed while the login screen appears to show the job status screen. To return to the previous state, press the mode select key.
• The user control function of the machine cannot be used in external authentication mode.
However, "User Registration", "User Count Display", "User Count Reset", "User Information Print", and "The Number of
User Name Displayed Setting" can be used.
• The mode select key cannot be used while the login screen appears.
1-47
If login fails
If the login screen fails to appear or the application does not operate correctly, the machine may also stop operating correctly. In this event, it is recommended that you quit external account mode from the Web pages of the machine. For more information, see [Help] in the Web pages.
If it is necessary to forcibly terminate external account mode using the operation panel of the machine, follow the steps below.
Press the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key and change "External Account Setting" in the system settings (administrator). The
External count mode
When only the [External Account Control] setting is enabled in "External Account Setting" of "Sharp OSA Settings" in the system settings (administrator), the machine enters external count mode.
Unlike external authentication mode, when the machine is started in "external count mode", the login screen of the external account application is not displayed. Only the job result is sent to the external account application. External count mode can be used together with the user control function of the machine. (External count mode can also be used when the user control function is disabled.)
1-48
MAINTENANCE
This section explains how to clean the machine and replace the toner cartridges and the waste toner box.
REGULAR MAINTENANCE
To ensure that the machine continues to provide top quality performance, periodically clean the machine.
Warning
Do not use a flammable spray to clean the machine. If gas from the spray comes in contact with hot electrical components or the fusing unit inside the machine, fire or electrical shock may result.
• Do not use thinner, benzene, or similar volatile cleaning agents to clean the machine. These may degrade or discolour the housing.
• Use a soft cloth to gently wipe off dirt from the area on the operation panel with a mirror-like finish (shown at right). If you use a stiff cloth or rub hard, the surface may be damaged.
The area with a mirror-like finish is the area that is .
CLEANING THE DOCUMENT GLASS AND AUTOMATIC
DOCUMENT FEEDER
If the document glass or document backplate sheet becomes dirty, the dirt will appear as dirty spots, coloured lines, or white lines in the scanned image. Always keep these parts clean.
Wipe the parts with a clean, soft cloth.
If necessary, moisten the cloth with water or a small amount of neutral detergent. After wiping with the moistened cloth, wipe the parts dry with a clean dry cloth.
Document glass Document backplate sheet
Scanning area
If coloured lines or white lines appear in images scanned using the automatic document feeder, clean the scanning area (the thin long glass next to the document glass).
To clean this area, use the glass cleaner that is stored in the automatic document feeder. After using the glass cleaner, be sure to return it to its storage position.
Examples of lines in the image
Black lines White lines
1-49
1
2
3
Open the automatic document feeder and remove the glass cleaner.
Clean the document scanning area on the document glass with the glass cleaner.
Replace the glass cleaner.
1-50
CLEANING THE MAIN CHARGER OF THE
PHOTOCONDUCTIVE DRUM
If black lines or coloured lines appear even after you have cleaned the document glass and automatic document feeder, use the charger cleaner to clean the main charger that charges the drum.
Open the front cover.
1
Release the waste toner box.
Move the lock of the waste toner box to the release position.
2
Release the lock of the waste toner box and let it fall forward as far as it will go as shown in the figure.
3
Remove the waste toner box.
Hold the box by both hands and lift it up slowly.
If the waste toner box falls too far forward, it will not be possible to remove it. (Remove the box when it is at an angle of about
30 degrees.)
1-51
4
(3) Boss
(2)
(1)
5
Remove the charger cleaner
The charger cleaner is attached to the front cover of the machine.
(1) Unfasten it from the claw by pressing the right side of the charger cleaner.
(2) Place it in the front spread across the top of the claw.
(3) Unfasten the charger cleaner rotating around the boss from the claw on the left side.
Clean the main charger.
(1) Gently push the charger cleaner all the way in.
(2) Gently pull the charger cleaner out.
Insert so that the cleaning location label (A) and the charger cleaner label (B) are oriented as shown.
(A)
Repeat step 4 with each of the other main chargers.
There are a total of 4 places to be cleaned in the machine as shown.
6
Main charger
1-52
7
8
9
(1) Boss
(2)
(3)
Replace the charger cleaner in its original position.
(1) Rotate the charger cleaner after putting it on the boss and hook its edge (the side that does not have a handle) to the claw on the left side.
(2) Place the right-hand side of the charger cleaner on the inner side, spread across the top of the claw.
(3) Hook the charger cleaner to the claw.
Mount the waste toner box.
Insert it in a direction slanting from the top towards the bottom.
(A direction opposite to that at the time of mounting it.)
Push the waste toner box into the machine.
Push the waste toner box firmly in until it clicks into place.
Lock the waste toner box.
Move the lock of the waste toner box to the lock position.
10
Close the front cover.
11
• If this does not solve the problem, pull the knob out and push it back in 3 more times.
• When pulling and pushing the knob to clean the charger, pull and push the knob slowly from one end to the other.
1-53
CLEANING THE PT CHARGER OF THE PRIMARY
TRANSFER BELT
If black lines or coloured lines appear even after you have cleaned the document glass, automatic document feeder and the main charger, use the PT charger cleaner to clean the PT charger.
Open the front cover.
1
Release the lock of the waste toner box.
Move the lock of the waste toner box to the release position.
2
Release the lock of the waste toner box and let it fall forward as far as it will go as shown in the figure.
3
4
Remove the waste toner box.
Hold the box by both hands and lift it up slowly.
If the waste toner box falls too far forward, it will not be possible to remove it. (Remove the box when it is at an angle of about
30 degrees.)
Clean the PT charger
(1) Slowly pull out the PT charger cleaner till a point where it offers resistance.
(2) Slowly push the PT charger cleaner back till the end.
(3) Repeat the steps (1) and (2) three times.
1-54
5
6
7
8
Mount the waste toner box.
Insert it in a direction slanting from the top towards the bottom.
(A direction opposite to that at the time of mounting it.)
Push the waste toner box in till the innermost point.
Push it in until it clicks into place.
Lock the waste toner box.
Move the lock of the waste toner box to the lock position.
Close the front cover.
1-55
CLEANING THE BYPASS FEED ROLLER
If paper misfeeds frequently occur when feeding envelopes or heavy paper through the bypass tray, wipe the surface of the feed roller with a clean soft cloth moistened with water or a neutral detergent.
CLEANING THE ORIGINAL FEED ROLLER
If lines or other dirt appear on the scanned original when the automatic document feeder is used, wipe the surface of the roller with a clean soft cloth moistened with water or a neutral detergent.
1-56
CLEANING THE LASER UNIT
When the laser unit inside the machine becomes dirty, line patterns (coloured lines) may form in the printed image.
Identifying lines (coloured lines) caused by a dirty laser unit
• Coloured lines always appear in the same place. (The lines are never black.)
• The coloured lines are parallel to the direction of paper feeding.
• Coloured lines appear not only on copies but also on print jobs from a computer. (The same lines appear on both copies and print jobs.)
If the above problems occur, follow the steps below to clean the laser unit.
Open the front cover.
1
2
(3)
Boss
(2)
(1)
Take out the cleaning tool for the laser unit.
The cleaning tool is attached to the front cover.
(1) Pull the right side of the cleaning instrument and unfasten it from the claw.
(2) Place it in the front spread across the top of the claw.
(3) Unfasten the cleaning instrument rotating around the boss from the claw on the left side.
3
Cleaner
Make sure that the cleaner at the tip of the cleaning tool is not dirty.
If the cleaner is dirty, remove the cleaner and replace it with a clean one. For the procedure for replacing the cleaner, see steps 4 through 6. If the cleaner is not dirty, go to step 7.
1-57
4
5
Open the inner cover and take out a replacement cleaner.
Replacement cleaners are stored on the inner cover.
Grasp the end of the cleaner and pull it out of the cover.
Remove the dirty cleaner from the tip of the cleaning tool.
(1) Firmly grasp the tool close to where the cleaner is attached.
(2) Use your other hand to press down on the hook that secures the cleaner and remove the cleaner.
6
Put the removed cleaner back on the inner cover. After replacing the cleaner, be sure to close the inner cover.
Attach the new cleaner to the cleaning tool.
(1) Align the cleaner hook with the attachment hole in the cleaning tool.
(2) Hold the cleaner firmly and push the cleaning tool in.
1-58
7
8
Holes to be cleaned
(A)
Clean the laser unit.
(1) Point the cleaner down and slowly insert the tool into the hole that you wish to clean.
Be sure to point the cleaner down.
Labels similar to (A) are attached to areas that require cleaning.
(2) Insert the cleaning tool all the way into the hole and then pull it back out.
Pull the cleaning tool out until you feel the tip of the tool leave the cleaning surface of the laser unit.
(3) Repeat step (2) two or three times and then remove the cleaning tool.
Repeat step 7 to clean all holes in the laser unit (4 holes).
There are a total of 4 holes to be cleaned in the laser unit, including the hole cleaned in step 7. Clean all holes.
1-59
9
(1)
Boss
(2)
(3)
Replace the cleaning tool.
(1) Rotate the cleaning instrument after putting it on the boss and hook its edge (the side where the cleaner is fixed) to the claw on the left side.
(2) Place the right-hand side of the cleaning instrument on the front side, spread across the top of the claw.
(3) Hook the cleaning instrument to the claw.
Close the front cover.
10
1-60
REPLACING THE TONER CARTRIDGES
Be sure to replace the toner cartridge when the message "Change the toner cartridge." appears.
In copy mode
If you continue to use the machine without replacing the cartridge, the following message will appear when the toner runs out.
Colours that are running low or have run out of toner are indicated in (
Y : Yellow toner, M : Magenta toner, C : Cyan toner, Bk : Black toner
Replace the toner cartridges of the indicated colours.
).
• If any one of the toner colours runs out (including black toner), colour printing will not be possible. If Y, M, or C toner runs out but Bk toner remains, black and white printing will still be possible.
• Be sure to install 4 toner cartridges (Y/M/C/Bk).
1-61
Open the front cover.
Locations of colour toner cartridges
(A) (B) (C) (D)
1
(A): Yellow (B): Magenta
(C): Cyan (D): Black
Pull the toner cartridge toward you.
Gently pull the toner cartridge horizontally toward you.
If the cartridge is pulled out abruptly, toner may spill out.
2
Example: Replacing the yellow toner cartridge
Hold the toner cartridge with both hands as shown and pull it out of the machine.
3
Remove a new toner cartridge from its package and shake it horizontally five or six times.
Gently insert the new toner cartridge horizontally.
4
A toner cartridge of a different colour cannot be installed. Be sure to install a toner cartridge of the same colour.
1-62
5
Push the cartridge in until it locks securely in place.
Push the cartridge firmly in until it clicks into place.
Close the front cover.
After the toner cartridge is replaced, the machine automatically enters image adjustment mode.
6
Caution
• Do not throw a toner cartridge into a fire. Toner may fly and cause burns.
• Store toner cartridges out of the reach of small children.
• If a toner cartridge is stored on end, the toner may harden and become unusable. Always store toner cartridges on their side.
• If a toner cartridge other than a SHARP-recommended toner cartridge is used, the machine may not attain full quality and performance and there is a risk of damage to the machine. Be sure to use a SHARP-recommended toner cartridge.
• Keep the used toner cartridge in a plastic bag (do not discard it). Your service technician will collect the used toner cartridge.
• To view the approximate amount of toner remaining, continually touch the [COPY] key during printing or when the machine is idle. The percentage of toner remaining will appear in the display while the key is touched. When the percentage falls to
"25-0%", obtain a new toner cartridge and keep it ready for replacement.
• Depending on your conditions of use, the colour may become faint or the image blurred.
1-63
REPLACING THE WASTE TONER BOX
The waste toner box collects excess toner that is produced during printing. When the waste toner box becomes full,
"Replace used toner container." will appear. Follow the procedure below to replace the waste toner box.
Open the front cover.
1
Release the used waste toner box.
Move the lock of the waste toner box to the release position.
Release the lock of the waste toner box and let it fall forward as far as it will go as shown in the figure.
2
Keep the replacement cleaner that has not been used.
Store it on the left of the new waste toner box.
3
Remove the waste toner box.
Hold the box by both hands and lift it up slowly.
If the waste toner box falls too far forward, it will not be possible to remove it. (Remove the box when it is at an angle of about
30 degrees.)
1-64
Place the box on a flat surface.
Place a sheet of newspaper on the surface before placing the box.
4
5
• Do not point the holes down as used toner will spill out.
• Do not discard the removed waste toner box. Store it in a plastic bag. The person in charge shall collect it for maintenance.
Install the new waste toner box.
Insert the box from above at a slant. (The direction opposite to when you removed it.)
Push the waste toner box into the machine.
Push the box in until it clicks into place.
6
Lock the waste toner box.
Move the lock of the waste toner box to the lock position.
7
Close the front cover.
8
Caution
• Do not throw the waste toner box into a fire. Toner may fly and cause burns.
• Store the waste toner box out of the reach of small children.
When replacing the waste toner box, be aware that it may soil your clothes or the immediate surroundings.
1-65
REPLACING THE STAMP CARTRIDGE
If a stamp unit (AR-SU1) is installed on the automatic document feeder and the stamp has become faint, replace the stamp cartridge (AR-SV1).
Supplies
Stamp cartridge (2 in package) AR-SV1
Open the document feeder tray
1
Remove the stamp cartridge while pushing it downwards
2
Install a new stamp cartridge.
3
Close the document feeder tray.
4
1-66
ENTERING TEXT
This section explains the text entry screen.
FUNCTIONS OF THE MAIN KEYS
Enter
Key
Caps
Shift
Other Language
Space
AltGr
Characters
Symbols
Pre-Set Select
Description
This changes the text entry screen from the lower case screen to the upper case screen. The upper case screen will continue to appear until the [Caps] key is touched again so that it is no longer highlighted. The
[Caps] key is convenient when you wish to enter all capital letters. (This key will vary depending on your country or region.)
This key temporarily changes the keys in the text entry screen to upper case when lower case letters appear, or to lower case when upper case letters appear.
Touch a letter key after touching the [Shift] key to enter that letter. After the letter is entered, the [Shift] key will no longer be highlighted and the original text entry screen will appear.
The [Shift] key is convenient when you only need to enter one upper case letter or one lower case letter, or when you need to enter one of the symbols assigned to the numeric keys.
To cancel selection of the [Shift] key, touch the [Shift] key again. The [Shift] key will no longer be highlighted.
(This key will vary depending on your country or region.)
Touch this key to enter a line break when entering the body text of an e-mail message. (This key will vary depending on your country or region.)
Touch this key to delete the characters to the left of the cursor one character at a time.
Touch this key to temporarily change the key layout of character entry mode to a different language. Select the key layout that you wish to use.
Touch this key to enter a space between letters.
This temporarily changes the entry screen to the accented letter and symbol entry screen. Touch a letter key after touching the [AltGr] key to enter that letter. After the letter is entered, the [AltGr] key will no longer be highlighted and the original text entry screen will appear.
To cancel selection of the [AltGr] key, touch the [AltGr] key again. The [AltGr] key will no longer be highlighted.
These keys move the cursor left and right.
These keys move the cursor to the line above or below the current line during entry of the body text of an e-mail message.
Touch this key to select character entry mode.
Touch this key to select symbol entry mode. Symbol mode is used to enter symbols and accented letters.
Use this to retrieve a previously stored subject for e-mail or other pre-set text.
1-67
Key Description
Help
Shows explanations of each key.
.com
.net
.org
.biz
.info
http:
Use this to enter a previously stored text string such as ".com".
Text strings are stored in the system settings.
☞
7. SYSTEM SETTINGS " Soft Keyboard Template Setting " (page 7-66)
Cancel
Touch this key to return to the previous setting screen without entering text.
OK
Touch this key to enter the text that currently appears and return to the previous setting screen.
Search
Search results will appear based on the entered characters.
• Some keys described above may not appear in certain key layouts or in the keyboards of certain countries or regions.
• " " in the text entry screen indicates how many characters can be entered. A number of characters greater than " " cannot be entered.
• On some keyboards that show the English alphabet, the [AltGr] screen continues to appear until the [AltGr] key is touched to remove the highlighting.
• The ABC/abc key is only displayed in limited countries and regions. The keyboard between the language of your region and English.
ABC/abc key is a shortcut key to switch the
• The key layouts that can be selected vary depending on the language selected in "Display Language Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
• The following symbols cannot be used when entering a file name or folder name.
\ ? / " ; : , < > ! * | & #
Some computer environments may not allow the use of spaces and the symbols indicated below. For example, hyperlinks will not operate correctly or nonsense characters may appear.
$ % ' ( ) + - . = @ [ ] ^ ` { } _ ~
1-68
CHAPTER 2
COPIER
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the copy function.
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE AS A
COPIER
BASE SCREEN OF COPY MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
COPYING SEQUENCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
ORIGINALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
• CHECKING THE ORIGINAL SIZE . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
PAPER TRAYS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
OUTPUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
• OUTPUT MODES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
MAKING COPIES USING THE BYPASS
TRAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
BASIC PROCEDURE FOR MAKING
COPIES
MAKING COPIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
• USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT
FEEDER TO MAKE COPIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
DOCUMENT GLASS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
AUTOMATIC 2-SIDED COPYING . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16
• USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT
FEEDER TO MAKE 2-SIDED COPIES . . . . . . 2-16
• AUTOMATIC 2-SIDED COPYING USING
THE DOCUMENT GLASS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
COPY COLOUR MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
ORIGINAL IMAGE TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
EXPOSURE AND ORIGINAL TYPE . . . . . . . . 2-23
• SELECTING THE ORIGINAL TYPE AND
EXPOSURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
REDUCTION/ENLARGEMENT/ZOOM . . . . . . . . . 2-25
• AUTOMATIC RATIO SELECTION (Auto
Image) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
• MANUALLY SELECTING THE RATIO
(Preset ratios/Zoom) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
• ENLARGING/REDUCING THE LENGTH
AND WIDTH SEPARATELY (XY Zoom) . . . . . 2-28
ORIGINAL SIZES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
• SPECIFYING THE ORIGINAL SIZE . . . . . . . . 2-29
ORIGINAL SIZES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
SPECIAL MODES
SPECIAL MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
ADDING MARGINS (Margin Shift) . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS (Erase) . . . . . 2-46
BOUND DOCUMENT (Dual Page Copy). . . . . . . . 2-48
MAKING COPIES IN PAMPHLET FORMAT
(Pamphlet Copy) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50
ORIGINALS AT ONCE (Job Build) . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53
USING TWO MACHINES TO MAKE A LARGE
NUMBER OF COPIES (Tandem Copy) . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56
USING A DIFFERENT PAPER TYPE FOR
COVERS (Covers/Inserts). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59
• INSERTING COVERS IN COPIES (Cover
Settings) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60
• INSERTING INSERT SHEETS IN COPIES
(Insert Settings) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63
• CHANGING COVER/INSERT SETTINGS
(Page Layout) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-67
ADDING INSERTS WHEN COPYING ON
TRANSPARENCY FILM (Transparency
Inserts) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
COPYING MULTIPLE ORIGINALS ONTO
ONE SHEET (Multi Shot). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
COPYING A PAMPHLET (Book Copy) . . . . . . . . . 2-74
COPYING CAPTIONS ONTO TAB PAPER
(Tab Copy) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78
• RELATION BETWEEN THE ORIGINALS
AND THE TAB PAPER. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78
2-1
COPYING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD ON ONE
SHEET OF PAPER (Card Shot) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-81
PRINTING THE DATE AND A STAMP ON
COPIES (Stamp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-84
STAMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-85
• ADDING THE DATE TO COPIES (Date) . . . . . 2-88
• STAMPING COPIES (Stamp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-90
• PRINTING PAGE NUMBERS ON COPIES
(Page Numbering) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-92
• PRINTING TEXT ON COPIES (Text) . . . . . . . . 2-96
(Layout) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-100
• ADDING A WATERMARK TO A COPY
(Watermark) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-102
[Image Edit] KEY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-104
(Photo Repeat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-105
(Multi-Page Enlargement). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-107
• REVERSING THE IMAGE (Mirror Image) . . . 2-110
• COPYING A3 (11" x 17") ORIGINALS
WITH NO EDGE CUT-OFF (A3 (11" x 17")
Full Bleed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-111
• COPYING IN THE CENTRE OF THE
PAPER (Centring) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-113
• REVERSING WHITE AND BLACK IN A
COPY (B/W Reverse) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-115
[Colour Adjustments] KEY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-117
COPIES (RGB Adjust) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-118
• ADJUSTING THE SHARPNESS OF AN
IMAGE (Sharpness) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-119
COPIES (Suppress Background) . . . . . . . . . . 2-120
• ADJUSTING THE COLOUR (Colour
Balance) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-122
• ADJUSTING THE BRIGHTNESS OF A
COPY (Brightness) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-124
• ADJUSTING THE INTENSITY OF A COPY
(Intensity) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-125
CHECKING COPIES BEFORE PRINTING
(Proof Copy) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-126
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
ORIGINAL SHEETS BEFORE COPYING
(Original Count) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-129
COPYING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT
SIZES (Mixed Size Original) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-131
COPYING THIN ORIGINALS (Slow Scan
Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-134
CONVENIENT COPY FUNCTIONS
CHECKING A PREVIEW IMAGE OF A COPY
(Preview) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-138
• PREVIEW SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-140
JOB STATUS SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-141
• JOB QUEUE SCREEN AND COMPLETED
JOB SCREEN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-142
• CANCELLING A JOB THAT IS WAITING
IN THE QUEUE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-144
• GIVING PRIORITY TO A JOB IN THE
QUEUE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-145
• CHECKING INFORMATION ON A COPY
JOB WAITING IN THE QUEUE . . . . . . . . . . . 2-146
Programs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-147
• STORING (EDITING/DELETING) A JOB
PROGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-148
APPENDIX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-150
2-2
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE AS A
COPIER
This section provides information that you should know before using the machine as a copier.
BASE SCREEN OF COPY MODE
Touch the [COPY] key in the touch panel to open the base screen of copy mode.
The base screen shows messages and keys necessary for copying, and settings that have been selected.
(8) (9)
DOCUMENT
FILING
(1)
COPY IMAGE SEND
Ready to scan for copy.
(2)
(3)
(4)
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
5.
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
0 (10)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(5)
(6)
(7)
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
(15)
(1) Mode Select keys
Use these keys to switch between copy, image send, and document filing modes.
If you wish to switch to copy mode, touch the [COPY] key.
(2) [Colour Mode] key
Touch this to change the colour mode.
☞
(3) Output display
When one or more output functions such as sort, group, or staple sort have been selected, this shows the icons of the selected functions.
☞
(4) [Exposure] key
This shows the current copy exposure and original type settings. Touch this key to change the exposure or original type setting.
☞
CHANGING THE EXPOSURE AND ORIGINAL
(5) [Copy Ratio] key
This shows the current copy ratio. Touch this key to adjust the copy ratio.
☞
REDUCTION/ENLARGEMENT/ZOOM (page 2-25)
2-3
(6) [Original] key
Touch this key to enter the original size manually.
When an original is placed, the detected original size is displayed. If the original size is set manually, the set size appears.
☞
(7) [Paper Select] key
Touch this key to change the paper (tray) that is used.
The tray, paper size, and paper type will appear. Trays 1 to 4 can also be touched in the paper size display to open the same screen.
☞
(8) Original feed display
This appears when an original is inserted in the automatic document feeder.
(9) Paper select display
This shows the size of paper loaded in each tray.
For the bypass tray, the paper type appears above the paper size.
The selected tray is highlighted.
The approximate amount of paper in each tray is indicated by . Trays 1 to 4 can be touched to open the same screen as when the [Paper Select] key is touched.
☞
(10) Number of copies display
This shows the number of copies set.
(11) [Special Modes] key
Touch this key to select special modes such as Margin
Shift, Edge Erase, and Dual Page Copy.
☞
(12) [2-Sided Copy] key
Touch this key to select the 2-sided copying function.
☞
AUTOMATIC 2-SIDED COPYING (page 2-16)
(13) [Output] key
Touch this to select an output function such as sort, group, offset, staple sort, or punch.
☞
(14) Customized keys
The keys that appear here can be changed to show settings or functions that you prefer. The following keys appear by factory default:
☞
Customizing displayed keys (page 2-5)
[File] key, [Quick File] key
Touch one of these keys to use the File function or Quick
File function of document filing mode. These are the same [File] and [Quick File] keys that appear when the
[Special Modes] key is touched. For information on the document filing function, see "6. DOCUMENT FILING".
The hard disk drive is required.
(15) [Preview] key
Touch to view a preview image of a copy in the touch panel before printing the copy.
☞
CHECKING A PREVIEW IMAGE OF A COPY
The screen explained in this section appears when a paper drawer, right tray, finisher, and punch module are installed. The image will vary depending on the equipment installed.
Tray during paper feeding
Do not pull out a tray while paper is being fed from the tray. This will cause a paper misfeed.
Identifying the tray that is being used to feed paper
(1) While paper is feeding, the job status display of the system bar on the touch panel screen will show the number of the tray that is being used to feed paper.
(2) The tray being used to feed paper also appears in green in the paper size display in the base screen on the touch panel.
Base screen
(1) Job status display on the system bar
Shows the number of the tray being used to feed paper.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
(2) Paper size display
Shows the tray being used to feed paper in green.
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
Tray2
2-4
Customizing displayed keys
Special mode keys and other keys can be displayed in the base screen. By assigning frequently used functions to these keys, you can access the functions with a single touch. To change the function that is assigned to a key, use "Customize
Key Setting" in the Web pages.
When "Erase", "Margin Shift", and "Brightness" are assigned to the customized keys
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
Erase
Margin Shift
Brightness
Preview
These 3 keys can be changed as desired.
System Settings (Administrator): Customize Key Setting
Registration is performed in [System Settings] - [Operation Settings] - "Customize Key Setting" in the Web page menu.
Checking what special modes are selected
The key appears in the base screen when one or more special modes are selected.
The key can be touched to display the selected special modes. To close the screen, touch the [OK] key.
OK
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Function Review
Margin Shift
Shift:Right
Front:10mm/Back:10mm
Erase
Edge:10mm
Centre:10mm
Covers/Inserts
Front:2-Sided/Back:Insert
Insertion A:10 Page/B:10 Page
1
1
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
2-5
COPYING SEQUENCE
This section explains the basic procedure for copying. Select settings in the order shown below to ensure that the copy operation takes place smoothly.
For detailed procedures for selecting the settings, see the explanation of each setting in this chapter.
Place the original.
Place the original in the document feeder tray of the automatic document feeder, or on the document glass.
* Depending on the copy functions used, there are also cases where functions are selected before the original is placed.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Plain
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Basic copy settings
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Select the basic copy settings.
The main settings are as follows:
• Colour mode
• Exposure and original type
☞
EXPOSURE AND ORIGINAL IMAGE TYPE (page 2-23)
• Copy ratio
☞
• Original size
• Paper Settings
☞
Preview
2-Sided Copy
2-sided copy settings
OK
Select settings as needed for 2-sided copying and 2-sided scanning of the original.
☞
AUTOMATIC 2-SIDED COPYING (page 2-16)
2-6
Saddle
Stitch
Output settings
OK
Right Tray
Punch
Select copy output settings.
The main settings are as follows:
• Sort mode
• Group mode
• Offset mode
☞
☞
• Staple sort mode
Staple sort function (page 2-36)
• Punch function
Fold
Output
Offset
Tray
Offset
Sort
Staple
Sort
Group
Special Modes
Margin Shift
Pamphlet Copy
Covers/Inserts
Book Copy
Erase
Job
Build
Transparency
Inserts
Tab Copy
Dual Page
Copy
Tandem
Copy
Multi Shot
Special mode settings
OK
Select special modes such as "Margin Shift" and "Erase".
☞
1
2
Card Shot
Plain
A4
Number of copies (sets) setting
Set the number of copies (number of sets).
7
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Start copying.
Start scanning the original(s) and making copies.
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
2-7
• When one or more special modes are selected, the key appears in the base screen. Touch the key to display a list of the selected special modes. This lets you check what special modes are selected and the settings of each mode.
☞
Checking what special modes are selected (page 2-5)
• To store a copy job using the document filing function, select copy settings and then touch the [File] key or the [Quick File] key.
To cancel all settings, press the [CLEAR ALL] key ( ).
When the [CLEAR ALL] key ( ) is pressed, all settings selected to that point are cleared and you will return to the base screen.
To stop scanning of the original and copying, press the [STOP] key ( ).
When the [STOP] key ( ) is pressed, a message will appear asking you if you want to cancel the job. Touch the [Yes] key in the message screen.
2-8
ORIGINALS
CHECKING THE ORIGINAL SIZE
When [Auto] appears in the [Original] key, the size of the placed original is automatically detected. The machine automatically detects the original size when an original is placed and displays the size in the [Original] key in the base screen.
Example of base screen
The original size is displayed.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Copy Ratio
100%
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
(A) "Auto" appears when the automatic original detection function is operating.
(B) The original size is displayed. An icon shows the orientation of the original.
(A) (B)
Standard sizes
Standard sizes are sizes that the machine can automatically detect. The standard sizes are set in "Original Size
Detector Setting" in the system settings (administrator). The factory default setting is "AB-1 (Inch-1)".
List of original size detector settings
Selections
AB-1
AB-2
AB-3
AB-4
AB-5
Inch-1
Inch-2
Inch-3
Standard sizes (detected original sizes)
Document glass
Document feeder tray
(automatic document feeder)
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 330 mm
(8-1/2" x 13")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
8-1/2" x 14", 11" x 17"
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")
A4, A4R, A5, B4, 8K, 16K, 16KR
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R,
216 mm x 340 mm (8-1/2" x 13-2/5")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R,
216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R,
5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13" (216 mm x 330 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, 8K, 16K, 16KR, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 340 mm (8-1/2" x 13-2/5")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R,
5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A4, A3
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13" (216 mm x 330 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A4, A3
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A3, A4
• When the automatic original detection function is operating and the original is a non-standard size (an inch size or special size), the closest standard size may be displayed or the original size may not appear. In this event, manually set the correct original size.
☞
SPECIFYING THE ORIGINAL SIZE (page 2-29)
• When placing a non-standard size original on the document glass, you can make it easier for the size to be detected by placing a blank sheet of A4 (8-1/2" x 11"), B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2"), or other standard size of paper on top of the original.
2-9
Standard original placement orientations
Place originals in the document feeder tray or on the document glass so that the top and bottom of the original are oriented as shown in the illustration. If the original is not oriented correctly and a function such as stapling is selected,
"1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
[Example 1]
Document feeder tray Document glass
Place the originals with the corners aligned here.
abc abc
[Example 2]
Document feeder tray
Place the originals with the corners aligned here.
Document glass
Automatic copy image rotation (Rotation Copy)
If the orientation of the original and paper are different, the original image will be automatically rotated 90 degrees to match the paper. (When an image is rotated, a message is displayed.)
[Example]
Orientation of placed original
Orientation of paper
The image is rotated
90 degrees
The original seen from behind
The paper seen from behind
This function operates in both auto paper selection mode and auto image mode. Rotation can be disabled using
"Rotation Copy Setting" in the System Settings (Administrator).
2-10
PAPER TRAYS
The machine is set to automatically select a tray that has the same size of paper as the size of the placed original
(automatic paper tray selection).
If the correct paper size is not selected or you wish to change the paper size, you can select the paper tray manually.
Touch the [Paper Select] key.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
1
You can also touch the paper size display (A) to open the paper tray settings.
(A)
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
2
(1)
Paper Select
1.
A4
2. A4R
3. B4
4. A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Bypass Tray
A4
Plain
(2)
OK
Select the tray that you want to use.
(1) Touch the key of the desired tray.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen and the selected tray will be highlighted.
If the selected tray runs out of paper during a copy job and there is another tray that has the same size and type of paper, that tray will be automatically selected and the copy job will continue.
To return to automatic paper tray selection after selecting a tray manually, press the [CLEAR ALL] key ( ).
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Status Settings (Paper Tray)
Use this setting to change the tray that is selected by default.
2-11
BASIC PROCEDURE FOR MAKING
COPIES
This section explains the basic procedures for making copies, including selection of the copy ratio and other copy settings.
MAKING COPIES
USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER TO
MAKE COPIES
This section explains how to make copies (1-sided copies of 1-sided originals) using the automatic document feeder.
1
2
Indicator line
Place the originals face up in the document feeder tray with the edges aligned evenly.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
Check the paper to be used and the colour mode.
Make sure that the desired paper (tray) and colour mode are selected.
• To change the paper (tray), touch the [Paper Select] key.
☞
• To change the colour mode, touch the [Colour Mode] key.
☞
Depending on the size of the placed original, there may be cases where the same size of paper as the original is not selected automatically. In this event, change the paper size manually.
2-12
3
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
7
Set the number of copies (number of sets) with the numeric keys.
Plain
A4
• Up to 999 copies (sets) can be set.
• A single copy can be made even if "0" appears for the number of copies.
If an incorrect number of copies is set...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Even if a colour mode is selected, copying will take place in black and white if the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed.
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-13
MAKING A COPY USING THE DOCUMENT GLASS
To make a copy of a book or other thick original that cannot be scanned with the automatic document feeder, open the automatic document feeder and place the original on the document glass. This section explains how to make a copy
(1-sided copy of a 1-sided original) using the document glass.
Original size detector
Open the automatic document feeder, place the original face down on the document glass, and then gently close the automatic document feeder.
Document glass scale
mark
Document glass scale
mark
1
2
A5
(5-1/2" x 8-1/2")
B5
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
B5R
A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R)
B4 (8-1/2" x 14")
A3 (11" x 17")
• Align the corner of the original with the tip of the arrow mark
on the document glass scale.
• Place the original in the appropriate position for its size as shown above.
• After placing the original, be sure to close the automatic document feeder. If left open, parts outside of the original will be copied black, causing excessive use of toner.
Do not place any objects under the original size detector. Closing the automatic document feeder with an object underneath may damage the original size detector plate and prevent correct detection of the document size.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
Check the paper to be used and the colour mode.
Make sure that the desired paper (tray) and colour mode are selected.
• To change the paper (tray), touch the [Paper Select] key.
☞
• To change the colour mode, touch the [Colour Mode] key.
☞
Depending on the size of the placed original, there may be cases where the same size of paper as the original is not selected automatically. In this event, change the paper size manually.
2-14
3
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
7
Set the number of copies (number of sets) with the numeric keys.
Plain
A4
• Up to 999 copies (sets) can be set.
• A single copy can be made even if "0" appears for the number of copies.
If an incorrect number of copies is set...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Normally copying will start.
Depending on the copy settings (2-sided copying, etc.), copying may not begin until all originals have been scanned. In this case, go to the next step.
Even if a colour mode is selected, copying will take place in black and white if the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed.
5
Remove the original and place the next original, and then press the [COLOUR
START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat this step until all originals have been scanned.
For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Place next original. Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
6 Read-End
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-15
AUTOMATIC 2-SIDED COPYING
USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER TO
MAKE 2-SIDED COPIES
Originals Copies Originals Originals Copies Copies
Automatic 2-sided copying of 1-sided originals
Automatic 2-sided copying of 2-sided originals
Copying onto both sides of a sheet saves paper.
1-sided copying of 2-sided originals
1
Indicator line
Place the originals face up in the document feeder tray with the edges aligned evenly.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
Touch the [2-Sided Copy] key.
2
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
3
2-Sided Copy
(1) (2)
OK
Binding
Change
Select the 2-sided copy mode.
(1) Touch the key of the desired mode.
: Automatic 2-sided copying of 1-sided originals
: Automatic 2-sided copying of 2-sided originals
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
: 1-sided copying of 2-sided originals
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
To make 2-sided copies of a 1-sided portrait original placed horizontally, or to invert the reverse side with respect to the front side when copying a 2-sided original, touch the [Binding Change] key.
☞
Using the [Binding Change] key (page 2-17)
2-16
4
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
Check the paper to be used and the colour mode.
Make sure that the desired paper (tray) and colour mode are selected.
• To change the paper (tray), touch the [Paper Select] key.
☞
• To change the colour mode, touch the [Colour Mode] key.
☞
Depending on the size of the placed original, there may be cases where the same size of paper as the original is not selected automatically. In this event, change the paper size manually.
5
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
7
Set the number of copies (number of sets) with the numeric keys.
Plain
A4
• Up to 999 copies (sets) can be set.
• If you are only making a single copy, the copy can be made with the copy number display showing "0".
If an incorrect number of copies is set...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
6
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
Using the [Binding Change] key
Originals Binding Change is used
A
The reverse side is upside down.
Binding Change is not used
A
The reverse side is not upside down.
A
1 2
A
3
Select this when the pages will be bound into a tablet.
A
Select this when the pages will be bound into a booklet.
2-17
AUTOMATIC 2-SIDED COPYING USING THE
DOCUMENT GLASS
Originals Copies
Automatic 2-sided copying of 1-sided originals
1
2
Original size detector
Open the automatic document feeder, place the original face down on the document glass, and then gently close the automatic document feeder.
Document glass scale
mark
Document glass scale
mark
A5
(5-1/2" x 8-1/2")
B5
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
B5R
A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R)
B4 (8-1/2" x 14")
A3 (11" x 17")
• Align the corner of the original with the tip of the arrow mark
on the document glass scale.
• Place the original in the appropriate position for its size as shown above.
• After placing the original, be sure to close the automatic document feeder. If left open, parts outside of the original will be copied black, causing excessive use of toner.
Do not place any objects under the original size detector. Closing the automatic document feeder with an object underneath may damage the original size detector plate and prevent correct detection of the document size.
Touch the [2-Sided Copy] key.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
2-18
2-Sided Copy
(1) (2)
OK
Select the 2-sided copy mode.
(1) Touch the [1-Sided to 2-Sided] key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
3
Binding
Change
4
• When the document cover is installed, the [2-Sided to 2-Sided] key and the [2-Sided to 1-Sided] key is not displayed.
• The [2-Sided to 2-Sided] key and [2-Sided to 1-Sided] key cannot be used when copying from the document glass.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
Check the paper to be used and the colour mode.
Make sure that the desired paper (tray) and colour mode are selected.
• To change the paper (tray), touch the [Paper Select] key.
☞
• To change the colour mode, touch the [Colour Mode] key.
☞
Depending on the size of the placed original, there may be cases where the same size of paper as the original is not selected automatically. In this event, change the paper size manually.
5
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
7
Set the number of copies (number of sets) with the numeric keys.
Plain
A4
• Up to 999 copies (sets) can be set.
• A single copy can be made even if "0" appears for the number of copies.
If an incorrect number of copies is set...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
6
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
2-19
7
Remove the original and place the next original, and then press the [COLOUR
START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat this step until all originals have been scanned.
For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Place next original. Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Read-End
8
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Status Settings (2-Sided Copy)
The default 2-sided copy mode can be changed.
2-20
COPY COLOUR MODES
The colour mode of the [COLOUR START] key is normally set to [Full Colour] so that copying takes place in full colour mode when the [COLOUR START] key is pressed. If colour originals are mixed together with black & white originals, set the colour mode to [Auto] to have the colour mode change appropriately for each original.
Touch the [Colour Mode] key in the base screen to open the following screen.
OK Colour Mode
Full Colour
Auto
Single Colour
2 Colour
Touch the key of the desired colour mode and then touch the [OK] key.
The original is copied in full colour.
Full Colour
Auto
Single Colour
2 Colour
The machine automatically detects whether each original is colour or black & white and switches the mode appropriately (full colour for a colour original or black & white for a black & white original).
The original is copied in the selected colour only.
All colours in the original are changed to the selected colour, which can be selected from red, green, blue, cyan, magenta, or yellow.
Only the red areas of the original are changed to the selected colour; colours other than red are copied in black. This lets you make copies that are more expressive than black and white copies.
Red, green, blue, cyan, magenta, or yellow can be selected.
2-21
Selecting single colour copying
When [Single Colour] is selected for the colour mode, the following screen appears. Touch the desired colour and touch the [OK] key.
Colour Mode
Single Colour
OK
OK
R(Red)
C(Cyan)
G(Green)
M(Magenta)
B(Blue)
Y(Yellow)
Selecting 2 colour copying
When [2 Colour] is selected for the colour mode, the following screen appears. Touch the desired colour and touch the
[OK] key.
Colour Mode
2 Colour
Select a colour other than black.
OK
OK
R(Red)
C(Cyan)
G(Green)
M(Magenta)
B(Blue)
Y(Yellow)
• When auto mode is used, there may be some originals for which switching between colour and black & white does not take place correctly. In this event, press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key as appropriate to manually switch between colour and black & white.
• Copying takes place in black & white when the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed, regardless of the colour mode setting.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Status Settings (Colour Mode)
This is used to change the default colour mode setting.
System Settings (Administrator): Detect Standard in Auto Colour Mode
When the colour mode is set to auto, the discrimination point for detecting whether originals are colour or black and white can be set to one of 5 levels.
2-22
CHANGING THE EXPOSURE AND ORIGINAL
IMAGE TYPE
The exposure and original image type can be selected to obtain a clear copy.
AUTOMATIC ADJUSTMENT OF THE EXPOSURE AND
ORIGINAL TYPE
Automatic exposure adjustment operates by default to automatically adjust the exposure level and original type as appropriate for the original being copied. ("Auto" is displayed.)
This function automatically adjusts the image during black & white copying and full colour copying to obtain the most suitable copy.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
SELECTING THE ORIGINAL TYPE AND MANUALLY
ADJUSTING THE EXPOSURE
If you wish to select the original type or manually adjust the exposure, touch the [Exposure] key in the base screen of copy mode and follow the steps below.
Exposure
Auto
1
Manual
3 5
Original Image Type
Text
Text/
Prtd.Photo
Printed
Photo
Light
Original
Photo
OK
Text/Photo
Map
Scan
Resolution
Select the original image type.
Touch the appropriate original image type key for the original.
1
●
Original image type select keys
Mode
Text
Text/Prtd. Photo
Text/Photo
Printed photo
Photo
Map
Light Original
Description
Use this mode for regular text documents.
This mode provides the best balance for copying an original which contains both text and printed photographs, such as a magazine or catalogue.
This mode provides the best balance for copying an original which contains both text and photographs, such as a text document with a photo pasted on.
This mode is best for copying printed photographs, such as photos in a magazine or catalogue.
Use this mode to copy photos.
This mode is best for copying the light colour shading and fine text found on most maps.
Use this mode for originals with light pencil writing.
2-23
Exposure
Auto
1
Manual
3 5
Copy of Copy
Original Image Type
Text
Text/
Prtd.Photo
Printed
Photo
Light
Original
Photo
Colour Tone
Enhancement
Text/Photo
Map
OK
Scan
Resolution
Adjust the exposure level.
Touch the
Touch the
key to make the copy darker.
key to make the copy lighter.
• Using a copy or printed page as an original
When using a copy or printed page from the machine as an original, touch the [Copy of Copy] checkbox so that a
When [Copy of Copy] is selected, only the [Text], [Printed
Photo], and [Text/Printed Photo] original image type keys can be selected.
• To enhance the colour of a colour copy...
Touch the [Colour Tone Enhancement] checkbox so that a 2
• Guidelines for the exposure level when [Text] is selected:
1 to 2: Dark originals such as a newspaper
3: Normal density originals
4 to 5: Originals written in pencil or light coloured text
• Restrictions when Colour Tone Enhancement is selected
When "Colour Tone Enhancement" is selected, the following functions cannot be used:
- [Copy of Copy]
- [Auto] and [Light Original] cannot be selected for the original image type.
- [Intensity] (in the special modes)
Touch the [OK] key.
3
Exposure
Auto
1
Manual
3 5
Copy of Copy
Original Image Type
Text
Text/
Prtd.Photo
Printed
Photo
Light
Original
Photo
Colour Tone
Enhancement
Text/Photo
Map
OK
Scan
Resolution
• If [Auto] is selected but the darkness or lightness of the image does not seem quite right...
If the image seems too light or too dark when [Auto] is selected, the exposure level can be adjusted using "Copy Exposure
Adjustment" in the system settings (administrator).
• To change the resolution...
When making a full-size black & white copy, you can press the [Scan Resolution] key to select the scanning resolution.
Numbers that can be selected for the document glass are different from numbers that can be selected for the automatic document feeder.
• System Settings (Administrator): Initial Status Settings (Exposure Type)
This is used to change the default original image type.
• System Settings (Administrator): Copy Exposure Adjustment
The exposure level used for automatic exposure adjustment can be adjusted.
• System Settings (Administrator): B/W 600dpi x 600dpi Scanning Mode for Document Feeder / B/W Quick Scan from Document Glass
The default resolution setting can be changed.
2-24
REDUCTION/ENLARGEMENT/ZOOM
AUTOMATIC RATIO SELECTION (Auto Image)
This section explains the automatic ratio selection function (Auto Image), which automatically selects the ratio to match the paper size.
When the paper tray is manually changed, the [Auto Image] key appears in the base screen of copy mode. Touch the
[Auto Image] key to have the reduction or enlargement ratio automatically selected based on the original size and the selected paper size.
First place the original and select the paper tray, and then touch the [Auto Image] key.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Copy Ratio
100%
Auto Image
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
The selected ratio will appear in the ratio display.
• If the message "Rotate original from to " is displayed, change the orientation of the original as indicated in the message.
• For a non-standard size original, the size must be entered in order to use Auto Image.
• To cancel automatic ratio selection...
Touch the [Auto Image] key so that it is no longer highlighted.
• To return the ratio to 100%...
To return the ratio setting to 100%, touch the [Copy Ratio] key to display the ratio menu and then touch the [100%] key.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Status Settings (Copy Ratio)
This is used to change the default copy ratio.
2-25
MANUALLY SELECTING THE RATIO (Preset ratios/Zoom)
Touch the [Copy Ratio] key in the base screen of copy mode to select one of five preset enlargement ratios or five (four) preset reduction ratios (maximum 400%, minimum 25%).
In addition, the zoom keys can be used to select any ratio from 25% to 400% in increments of 1%.
Copy Ratio
B4 B5
A3 A4
B5 A5
B4 A4
A4 B5
A3 B4
70%
81%
86%
Auto Image XY Zoom
OK
100
%
Zoom
100%
115%
122%
141%
B5 A4
B4 A3
A5 B5
A4 B4
B5 B4
A4 A3
1
2
Set the ratio.
Touch a preset ratio key and/or the zoom keys to set the ratio.
There are two setting screens. Use the keys to switch between the screens.
●
1st screen
• Enlargement keys:
115%, 122% and 141% (for the AB system).
121% and 129% (for the inch system).
• Reduction keys:
70%, 81% and 86% (for the AB system).
64% and 77% (for the inch system).
• [100%] key
1
(A)
Copy Ratio
Auto Image
25%
50%
75%
99%
XY Zoom
100
%
Zoom
100%
200%
400%
300%
350%
OK
2
2
●
2nd screen
• Enlargement keys (2 to 4 ratios)
200%, 400%, any ratio (max. of two)
• Reduction keys (2 to 4 ratios)
25%, 50%, any ratio (max. of two)
• [100%] key
• (A) keys
The keys marked (A) can be set to show any ratio using "Add or Change Extra Preset Ratios" in the system settings
(administrator).
• To quickly select a ratio, touch a reduction or enlargement key to select a ratio close to the desired ratio and then use the zoom keys for fine adjustment.
• The zoom keys can be used to select any ratio from 25% to 400% in increments of 1%.
Touch the key to increase the ratio, or the key to decrease the ratio. (If you continue to touch the / key, the ratio will change automatically. After 3 seconds, the ratio will change rapidly.)
• As an alternative to touching the keys, you can also directly touch the numeric value display key and change the value with the numeric keys.
• If the message "Image is larger than the copy paper." appears when an enlargement ratio is selected, the image may not fit on the paper.
2-26
2
Copy Ratio
B4 B5
A3 A4
B5 A5
B4 A4
A4 B5
A3 B4
70%
81%
86%
Auto Image XY Zoom
OK
75
%
Zoom
100%
115%
122%
141%
B5 A4
B4 A3
A5 B5
A4 B4
B5 B4
A4 A3
1
2
Touch the [OK] key.
After touching the [OK] key, make sure that a paper size suitable for the ratio is selected.
When the automatic document feeder is used, the selectable ratio ranges from 25% to 200%.
To return the ratio to 100%...
To return the ratio setting to 100%, touch the [Copy Ratio] key to display the ratio menu and then touch the [100%] key.
System Settings (Administrator): Add or Change Extra Preset Ratios
Two enlargement preset ratios (101% to 400%) and two reduction preset ratios (25% to 99%) can be added. An added preset ratio can also be changed.
2-27
ENLARGING/REDUCING THE LENGTH AND WIDTH
SEPARATELY (XY Zoom)
The XY Zoom feature allows the horizontal and vertical copy ratios to be changed separately.
Both the horizontal and vertical ratios can be set from 25% to 400% in increments of 1%.
Touch the [Copy Ratio] key in the base screen of copy mode and then follow the steps below.
When 50% is selected for the horizontal ratio and 70% is selected for the vertical ratio
Original Copy
1
Copy Ratio
B4 B5
A3 A4
B5 A5
B4 A4
A4 B5
A3 B4
70%
81%
86%
Auto Image XY Zoom
OK
100
%
Zoom
100%
115%
122%
141%
B5 A4
B4 A3
A5 B5
A4 B4
B5 B4
A4 A3
1
2
Touch the [XY Zoom] key.
2
Copy Ratio
XY Zoom
(2)
50%
64%
77%
(A) (B)
(1), (3)
X
Y
Zoom
50
%
70
%
129%
200%
400%
100%
(A)
(4)
OK
Cancel
Set the horizontal and vertical ratios.
(1) Touch the [X] key.
The [X] key will be highlighted and the horizontal ratio can be set.
(2) Touch one of the preset ratio keys (A) and the zoom keys (B) to set the X (horizontal) ratio.
(A) A touched preset ratio key will not be highlighted.
(B) The zoom keys can be touched to set the ratio from
25% to 400% in increments of 1%.
(3) Touch the [Y] key and set the Y (vertical) ratio in the same way as the [X] key.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
After touching the [OK] key, make sure that a paper size suitable for the ratio is selected.
• To quickly select a ratio, touch a preset ratio key (A) to select a ratio close to the desired ratio and then use the zoom keys (B) for fine adjustment.
• As an alternative to touching the keys, you can also directly touch the numeric value display key and change the value with the numeric keys.
When the automatic document feeder is used, the vertical and horizontal ratio selection ranges are both 25% to 200%.
To cancel an XY zoom setting...
To cancel an XY Zoom setting, touch the [XY Zoom] key or the [Cancel] key.
2-28
ORIGINAL SIZES
SPECIFYING THE ORIGINAL SIZE
When the original size is a non-standard size or is not detected correctly, manually specify the original size.
Touch the [Original] key in the base screen of copy mode and then follow the steps below.
Specifying an AB original size
(1) (2)
OK Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Size Input
Manual
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
B4
A3
Custom Size
AB
Inch
Specifying an inch original size
(2) (1) (3)
OK Original
Auto
Manual
5½x8½
5½x8½R
8½x11
Manual
8½x11R
8½x13
8½x14
11x17
8½x13
AB
Inch
Size Input Custom Size
(1) Touch the appropriate original size key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
(1) Touch the [AB Inch] key.
(2) Touch the appropriate original size key.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
Specifying a non-standard original size
Touch the [Size Input] key.
OK
1
Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Size Input
A4
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
B4
A3
Custom Size
AB
Inch
2-29
2
Original
Size Input
(1)
Cancel
X 420
Y 297
(25~432) mm
(25~297) mm
(2)
You can also touch the
(3)
OK
OK
Enter the original size.
(1) Enter the X (horizontal) dimension of the original.
Touch the X (width) numeric value display key to open a number entry screen. Enter the width of the original with the numeric keys, and touch the [OK] key in the number entry screen. When the document glass is used, a number from 25 mm to 432 mm (1" to 17") can be entered.
When the automatic document feeder is used, a number from 140 mm to 432 mm (5-1/2" to 17") can be entered.
If the horizontal dimension of the original is less than 140 mm (5-1/2"), use the document glass.
(2) Enter the Y (vertical) dimension of the original.
Touch the Y (height) numeric value display key to open a number entry screen. Enter the height of the original with the numeric keys, and touch the [OK] key in the number entry screen. When the document glass is used, a number from 25 mm to 297 mm (1" to 11-5/8") can be entered.
When the automatic document feeder is used, a number from 131 mm to 297 mm (5-1/8" to 11-5/8") can be entered.
If the vertical dimension of the original is less than
131 mm (5-1/8"), use the document glass.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen.
Make sure that the entered dimensions appear in the
[Original] key.
keys to change the number.
STORING FREQUENTLY USED ORIGINAL SIZES
You can save special original sizes that you frequently use. This section explains how to store, retrieve, change, and delete special original sizes.
Storing original sizes (editing/clearing)
Up to 12 special original sizes can be stored.
Touch the [Original] key in the base screen of copy mode and then follow the steps below.
Touch the [Custom Size] key.
OK
1
Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Size Input
A4
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
B4
A3
Custom Size
AB
Inch
2-30
2
Original
Custom Size
X254 Y210
OK
OK
Store the original size.
(1) Touch the [Store/Delete] tab.
(2) Touch a key for storing a custom original size.
Touch a key that does not show a size ( ).
Recall Store/Delete
(1) (2)
If you wish to edit or clear a previously stored key...
Touch the key that you want to edit or clear. The following screen will appear.
A custom size has already been stored in this location.
Cancel Delete Amend
• To edit the key, touch the [Amend] key and go to the next step.
• To clear the key, touch the [Delete] key. Make sure that the original size has been cleared and touch the [OK] key.
3
Original
Size Input
(1)
Cancel
X 420
Y 297
(25~432) mm
(25~297) mm
(2)
You can also touch the
(3)
OK
OK
Enter the original size.
(1) Enter the X (horizontal) dimension of the original.
Touch the X (width) numeric value display key to open a number entry screen. Enter the width of the original with the numeric keys, and touch the [OK] key in the number entry screen. A dimension from 25 mm to 432 mm (1" to
17") can be entered.
(2) Enter the Y (vertical) dimension of the original.
Touch the Y (height) numeric value display key to open a number entry screen. Enter the height of the original with the numeric keys, and touch the [OK] key in the number entry screen. A dimension from 25 mm to 297 mm (1" to
11-5/8") can be entered.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
keys to change the number.
The stored original size will be retained even if the main power is turned off.
To cancel the operation...
Press the [CLEAR ALL] key ( ).
2-31
Retrieving a stored original size
To retrieve a stored original size, touch the [Original] key in the base screen of copy mode and perform the steps below.
Touch the [Custom Size] key.
OK
1
Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Size Input
A4
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
B4
A3
Custom Size
AB
Inch
2
Original
Custom Size
(2) (1)
X254 Y210
Recall Store/Delete
(3)
OK
OK
Retrieve the desired stored original size.
(1) Touch the [Recall] tab.
(2) Touch the key of the original size that you wish to retrieve.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
To cancel the operation...
Press the [CLEAR ALL] key ( ).
2-32
OUTPUT
To select output functions and the output tray, touch the [Output] key in the base screen of copy mode. Output functions that can be selected are sort, group, offset, staple sort, and punch. All explanations of the settings below assume that a finisher and punch module are installed.
(6) (7) (8)
(1)
(2)
Output
Offset
Tray
Offset
OK
Right Tray
(3)
(4)
(5)
Sort
Staple
Sort
Group
(1) [Offset Tray] key ([Centre Tray] key*)
Output is delivered to the offset tray. The [Offset Tray] key is automatically selected when the [Staple Sort] key is selected.
* When a finisher is not installed, this key is the [Centre
Tray] key.
(2) [Offset] key
This is used to offset each set of output from the previous set.
The offset function operates when the checkbox is selected and does not operate when the checkbox is not selected . (The offset checkmark is automatically cleared when the staple sort function is selected.)
☞
(3) [Sort] key
This is used to sort (collate) output into sets.
☞
(4) [Staple Sort] key
This is used to sort output into sets, staple each set, and deliver the sets to the tray. (Note that the sets will not be offset in the output tray.) When this function is selected, three keys will appear for selecting the staple position.
☞
Staple sort function (page 2-36)
(5) [Group] key
This is used to group copies by page.
☞
(6) Output display
An icon will appear to indicate the output mode.
Punch
(9)
(7) [Right Tray] key
Select this key to have output delivered to the right tray.
When the right tray is selected, offset, staple sort, and punch cannot be selected.
(8) [OK] key
Touch this key to close the output screen and return to the base screen.
(9) [Punch] key
This is used to punch holes in the output.
☞
2-33
The above screen shows the keys that appear when a finisher and punch module are installed. The keys that appear will vary depending on what peripheral devices are installed.
In addition, it may not be possible to select some keys depending what peripheral devices are installed. If your screen is different from the screen of previous page, see the screens that follow.
Example
The screen when a finisher is not installed.
Output
Offset
Tray
Offset
OK
Right Tray
Sort
Group
2-34
OUTPUT MODES
This section explains the output modes.
Sort mode
This is used to sort (collate) output into sets.
Example: Sorting the output into 5 sets
Originals Output
Group mode
This function groups copies by page.
Example: Groups of 5 copies of each page
Originals Output
Set the number of copies (5).
Set the number of copies (5).
Output Touch the [Output] key.
Output Touch the [Output] key.
Group Touch the [Group] key.
Sort Touch the [Sort] key.
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key.
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key.
• The sort function is automatically selected when originals are placed in the automatic document feeder.
• When the Quick File Folder for document filing is full, copying of a large number of originals using the sort function will be impeded. Delete unneeded files from the Quick File Folder.
The group function is automatically selected when an original is placed on the document glass.
Offset function
This function offsets each set of copies from the previous set in the output tray, making it easy to separate sets of copies.
Offset function "ON" Offset function "OFF"
• The offset function cannot be used in the right tray.
• The offset function cannot be selected when the staple sort function is selected.
2-35
Staple sort function
The staple sort function sorts output into sets, staples each set, and delivers the sets to the tray.
The relations between the stapling positions, paper orientation, permitted paper sizes for stapling, and number of sheets that can be stapled are shown below.
For original placement orientations, see "
Original placement orientation (for the staple sort and punch functions) " (page
Stapling positions
1 staple at top left corner
Staple sort
Vertically-oriented paper
1 staple at bottom left corner
Applicable paper sizes
A4, B5, 8-1/2" x 11", 16K
Number of sheets that can be stapled:
Max. 50 sheets*
Horizontally-oriented paper
• Finisher
Applicable paper sizes
A3, B4, A4R, 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14",
8-1/2" x 13-1/2", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5",
8-1/2" x 13", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 8K, 16KR
Number of sheets that can be stapled
A3, B4, 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14",
8-1/2" x 13-1/2", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5",
8-1/2" x 13", 8K:
Max. 30 sheets*
A4R, 8-1/2" x 11"R, 16KR:
Max. 50 sheets*
2 staples at left edge
* You can insert 2 sheets of maximum 256 g /m 2 as cover sheets and staple them. In such cases, you can subtract 2 from the maximum number of sheets that can be stapled and use those many sheets.
• The number of sheets that can be stapled at once includes any covers and/or inserts that are inserted.
• When Mixed Size Original in the special modes is used with the "Same Width" setting, the maximum number of sheets that can be stapled is 30 for a finisher regardless of the paper size.
2-36
Punch function
If an optional punch module is installed, holes can be punched in output.
Paper size that can be punched is B5R to A3 (7-1/4" x 10-1/2"R to 11" x 17"). However, A3W (12" x 18") sized paper and special media such as transparency film and tab paper cannot be used.
[Examples]
[Original 1] [Punch positions]
[Original 2] [Punch positions]
Original placement orientation (for the staple sort and punch functions)
When using the staple sort function or the punch function, the original must be placed as shown below to enable stapling or punching in the desired position on the paper.
Staple sort
Document feeder tray Document glass
One staple (top)
Document feeder tray
Punch
Document glass abc abc
Two staples abc abc abc abc
One staple (bottom) abc abc
2-37
MAKING COPIES USING THE BYPASS TRAY
In addition to plain paper, the bypass tray allows you to make copies on transparency film, envelopes, tab paper, and other special media.
"
" LOADING PAPER IN THE BYPASS TRAY " (page 1-32) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
1
2
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
When placing the originals on the document glass...
After placing the original, be sure to close the automatic document feeder. If left open, parts outside of the original will be copied black, causing excessive use of toner.
Place paper in the bypass tray.
Insert the paper with print side face down.
However, if the paper type is "Letter Head" or "Pre-Printed", load the paper with the print side face up*.
* If "Disabling of Duplex" is enabled in the system settings
(administrator), load the paper in the normal way (face up in trays 1 to 5; face down in the bypass tray).
When loading a large sheet of paper, be sure to pull out the bypass tray extension. Pull the bypass tray extension all the way out. If the bypass tray extension is not pulled all the way out, the size of the loaded paper will not be correctly displayed.
3
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Plain
A4
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Preview
Touch the [Paper Select] key.
2-38
4
Paper Select
1.
A4
2. A4R
3.
B4
4.
A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Bypass Tray
A4
Plain
OK
Check the paper type setting for the bypass tray. If you need to change the setting, touch the paper type key.
If you do not need to change the paper size and type that appear under "Bypass Tray", go to step 7.
5
Paper Select
Bypass Tray Type/Size Setting
Select the paper type.
Plain
Pre-Punched
Heavy Paper 1
Envelope
Pre-Printed
Colour
Heavy Paper 2
Glossy Paper
Recycled
Thin Paper
Transparency
Letter Head
Labels
Tab Paper
Heavy Paper 1: 106 - 209 g /m 2 (28 lbs.bond, -110 lbs.index)
Heavy Paper 2: 210 - 256 g /m 2 (110 - 140 lbs.index)
Cancel
1
2
Select the type of paper used in the bypass tray.
Select the paper type that you will use.
6
Paper Select
Bypass Tray Type/Size Setting
Type
Recycled Auto-Inch
Auto-AB
Custom Size
Size
12x18(A3W),11x17,8½x14
8½x11,8½x11R,5½x8½R
7¼x10½R,A3,A4,B4,B5
A3W(12x18),A3,A4,A4R,A5R
B4,B5,B5R,216x330(8½x13)
11x17,8½x11
X420 Y297
OK
Manual
Set the paper size.
(1) Select the paper size.
[Auto-Inch] key
When the paper placed in the bypass tray is an inch size
(8-1/2" x 11", etc.), the paper size will be detected automatically and an appropriate size set.
[Auto-AB] key
When the paper inserted in the bypass tray is an AB size
(A4, etc.), the paper size will be detected automatically and an appropriate size set.
[Custom Size] key
Touch this key if you wish to enter numeric values for the size of the loaded paper.
☞
Enter the paper size of the bypass tray (page 2-40)
[Manual] key
This key can be touched to display the [16K], [16KR], and
[8K] keys. Touch one of these keys if you loaded the corresponding size of paper.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
• When [Envelope] is selected, specify the size of the envelope. When finished, touch the [OK] key.
• If tab paper is selected, check the size. Touch the [Auto-Inch] key or the [Auto-AB] key. When you have finished checking/changing the setting, touch the [OK] key.
2-39
7
Paper Select
1.
A4
2. A4R
3. B4
4. A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
(1)
Bypass Tray
A4
Plain
(2)
OK
Select the bypass tray.
(1) Touch the paper size key of the bypass tray.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
8
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If the originals were placed in the document feeder tray, the originals are copied.
• If you placed the originals on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When using sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then press the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
Enter the paper size of the bypass tray
When the [Custom Size] key is touched, the paper size entry screen appears.
Bypass Tray Type/Size Setting
Size Input
X420 Y297
X420 Y297
X420 Y297
X 420
Y 297
(148~432) mm
(100~297) mm
AB
Inch
OK
OK
Touch the X (width) numeric value display key to open a number entry screen. Enter the width of the paper with the numeric keys, and touch the [OK] key in the number entry screen.
Touch the Y (height) numeric value display key to open a number entry screen. Enter the height of the paper with the numeric keys, and touch the [OK] key in the number entry screen.
• You can also touch the keys to change the number.
• Stored custom paper sizes appear in the keys on the left side of the screen. Custom paper sizes are stored in the system settings. For details, see "
Paper Tray Settings " (page 7-13) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS". If the key for the size that you
wish to enter appears, touch that key.
2-40
SPECIAL MODES
This chapter explains Margin Shift, Erase, Dual Page Copy, and other special modes.
SPECIAL MODES
When the [Special Modes] key is pressed in the base screen, the special modes menu screen appears. The special modes menu consists of two screens. Touch the keys to move between the screens. After selecting special mode settings, touch the [OK] key in the special modes menu screen to complete the settings and return to the base screen of copy mode.
Special modes menu (1st screen)
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Special Modes
(1)
Margin Shift
(2) (3)
Erase
Dual Page
Copy
(4)
Pamphlet Copy
(5) (6)
Job
Build
Tandem
Copy
(7)
Covers/Inserts
(8)
Transparency
Inserts
(10)
Book Copy
(11)
Tab Copy
(9)
Multi Shot
(12)
Card Shot
OK
1
2
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
(1) [Margin Shift] key
☞
ADDING MARGINS (Margin Shift) (page 2-44)
(2) [Erase] key
☞
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS (Erase)
(page
(3) [Dual Page Copy] key
☞
COPYING EACH FACING PAGE OF A BOUND
DOCUMENT (Dual Page Copy) (page 2-48)
(4) [Pamphlet Copy] key
☞
MAKING COPIES IN PAMPHLET FORMAT
(5) [Job Build] key
☞
COPYING A LARGE NUMBER OF ORIGINALS AT
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(6) [Tandem Copy] key
☞
USING TWO MACHINES TO MAKE A LARGE
NUMBER OF COPIES (Tandem Copy) (page 2-56)
The hard disk drive is required.
(7) [Covers/Inserts] key
☞
USING A DIFFERENT PAPER TYPE FOR COVERS
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
2-41
(8) [Transparency Inserts] key
☞
ADDING INSERTS WHEN COPYING ON
TRANSPARENCY FILM (Transparency Inserts)
(9) [Multi Shot] key
☞
COPYING MULTIPLE ORIGINALS ONTO ONE
SHEET (Multi Shot) (page 2-72)
(10) [Book Copy] key
☞
COPYING A PAMPHLET (Book Copy) (page 2-74)
(11) [Tab Copy] key
☞
COPYING CAPTIONS ONTO TAB PAPER (Tab
(12) [Card Shot] key
☞
COPYING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD ON ONE
SHEET OF PAPER (Card Shot) (page 2-81)
Special modes menu (2nd screen)
Special Modes
(1)
(4)
(7)
Stamp
(2)
Image Edit
(5)
Quick File File
Original
Count
(8)
Mixed Size
Original
(3)
Colour
Adjustments
(6)
Proof Copy
(9)
Slow Scan
Mode
OK
2
2
(1) [Stamp] key
☞
PRINTING THE DATE AND A STAMP ON COPIES
(2) [Image Edit] key
☞
(3) [Colour Adjustments] key
☞
[Colour Adjustments] KEY (page 2-117)
(4) [File] key
This saves a job in a folder of the document filing function.
The hard disk drive is required.
(5) [Quick File] key
This saves a job in the Quick File folder of the document filing function.
The hard disk drive is required.
(6) [Proof Copy] key
☞
CHECKING COPIES BEFORE PRINTING (Proof
The hard disk drive is required.
(7) [Original Count] key
☞
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
ORIGINAL SHEETS BEFORE COPYING (Original
(8) [Mixed Size Original] key
☞
COPYING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT SIZES
(Mixed Size Original) (page 2-131)
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(9) [Slow Scan Mode] key
☞
COPYING THIN ORIGINALS (Slow Scan Mode)
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
• Special modes can generally be combined with other special modes, however, there are some combinations that are not possible. In this case, a message indicating that the combination is not possible will be displayed.
• The displayed menu will vary depending on the country and regions.
2-42
[OK] key and [Cancel] key
In some cases two [OK] keys and one [Cancel] key will appear in the special mode screens. The keys are used as follows:
Special Modes
Margin Shift Cancel
OK
OK
(A)
(B)
(C)
Right Left Down Side 1
10
(0~20) mm
Side 2
10
(0~20) mm
(A) Enter the selected special mode settings and return to the base screen of copy mode.
(B) Enter the selected special mode settings and return to the special modes menu screen. Touch this key when you wish to continue selecting other special mode settings.
(C) During selection of special mode settings, this key returns you to the special modes menu screen without saving the settings. When settings have been completed, this cancels the settings and returns you to the special modes menu screen.
2-43
ADDING MARGINS (Margin Shift)
This function is used to shift the copy image right, left or down to adjust the margin.
This is convenient when you wish to bind the copies with a string or in a binder.
Shifting the image to the right so the copies can be bound at the left edge with a string
Not using margin shift Using margin shift
1
Margin shift positions
Left edge
1
1
The punch holes cut off part of the image
1
The image is moved to allow space for the string holes so the image is not cut off.
Top edge
Right edge
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Margin Shift] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
3
Special Modes
Margin Shift
(1)
Right Left Down
(2)
Cancel
(3)
OK
OK
Side 1
10
(0~20) mm
Side 2
10
(0~20) mm
Set the margin shift.
(1) Touch the margin shift position.
Select one of the three positions.
(2) Set the amount of the margin shift with
.
0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 1") can be entered.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
2-44
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.)
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
Rotation copy cannot be used in combination with margin shift.
To cancel the margin shift setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Margin Shift Setting
The default margin shift setting can be set from 0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 1"). The factory default setting is 10 mm (1/2").
2-45
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS (Erase)
The erase function is used to erase shadows around the edges of copies that occur when copying thick originals or books.
When a thick book is copied
Not using the erase function
Using the erase function
Shadows appear here
Erase modes
Edge Erase Centre Erase
Shadows appear on the copy.
Shadows do not appear on the copy.
Edge + Centre Erase Side Erase
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Erase] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
2-46
3
Special Modes
Erase
(1) (2)
Cancel
(3)
OK
OK
Edge
Erase
Centre
Erase
Edge+Centre
Erase
Edge
10
(0~20) mm
Centre
10
(0~20) mm
Side Erase
Select the erase settings.
(1) Touch the desired erase mode.
Select one of the four positions.
Touch the [Side Erase] key to open the following screen.
Erase
Side Erase
Up
Cancel OK
Erase position for Side 2
Left Right
Same Side as
Side 1
Different Side from Side 1
Down
Touch the checkbox of the edge that you wish to erase and make sure that a checkmark appears.
When performing 1-sided to 2-sided copying or 2-sided to
2-sided copying, set the erase edge on the reverse side.
• If you touch the [Same Side as Side 1] key, the edge in the same position as on the front side will be erased.
• If you touch the [Different Side from Side 1], the edge in the position opposite to the erased edge on the front side will be erased.
When you have completed the erase edge settings, touch the [OK] key.
(2) Set the erasure width with
0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 1") can be entered.
.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.)
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
If a ratio setting is used in combination with an erase setting, the erase width will change according to the selected ratio.
For example, if the erase width setting is 20 mm (1") and the image is reduced to 50%, the erase width will be 10 mm (1/2").
To cancel the erase setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
System Settings (Administrator): Erase Width Adjustment
The default erase width can be set from 0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 1"). The factory default setting is 10 mm (1/2").
2-47
COPYING EACH FACING PAGE OF A
BOUND DOCUMENT (Dual Page Copy)
The dual page copy function produces separate copies of two document pages that are placed side by side on the document glass. This function is useful when making copies of the facing pages of a book or other bound document.
Copying the facing pages of a book or bound document
1
5
6
Book or bound document
5 6
The facing pages are copied onto 2 separate pages.
Place the original on the document glass.
Align the centre of the original with the appropriate size mark .
Size mark
Centreline of
A3 original
Centreline of
11" x 17" original
A3
(11" x 17")
The page on this side is copied first.
Centreline of original
2
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A3
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A3
Plain
Preview
Select A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size paper.
Select the paper as explained in "
2-48
3
(2)
Special Modes
Margin Shift
Pamphlet Copy
Covers/Inserts
Book Copy
Erase
Job
Build
Transparency
Inserts
Tab Copy
Dual Page
Copy
Tandem
Copy
Multi Shot
Card Shot
(3)
OK
1
2
Select Dual Page Copy.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [Dual Page Copy] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.)
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• When using dual page copy, the original must be placed on the document glass.
• To erase shadows caused by the binding of a book or other bound document, use the erase function.
However, note that [Centre Erase] and [Edge + Centre Erase] cannot be used.
To cancel dual page copy...
Touch the [Dual Page Copy] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
2-49
MAKING COPIES IN PAMPHLET FORMAT
(Pamphlet Copy)
This function copies 2 original pages onto the front side and 2 original pages onto the reverse side of each sheet of paper so that the copies can be folded at the centreline to form a pamphlet.
This function is convenient for arranging copies into an attractive booklet or pamphlet.
Pamphlet copy using 8 original pages
Originals In pamphlet form
2 3 4
1st page 2nd page 3rd page 4th page
Binding side
5
5th page
6 7
6th page 7th page 8th page
Left binding
2
4
5
7
3
5
7
5
7
4
2
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
If the originals are 2-sided, place them in the document feeder tray.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Pamphlet Copy] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
4
2
5
7
Right binding
7
5
3
3
5
7
2-50
3
Special Modes
Pamphlet Copy Cancel
Original
1-Sided 2-Sided
Left
Binding
Right
Binding
(1) (2)
Cover
Setting
(3)
OK
OK
Select pamphlet copy settings.
(1) If the original is 1-sided, touch the [1-Sided] key. If the original is 2-sided, touch the
[2-Sided] key.
When the document cover is mounted, the [2-Sided] key is not displayed.
(2) Select the binding edge ([Left Binding] or
[Right Binding]).
(3) To insert a cover, touch the [Cover Setting] key.
If you do not want to add a cover, go to step 5.
When the document cover is mounted, it is not possible to touch the [Cover Setting] key.
4
(2)
Pamphlet Copy
Cover Setting
Paper Tray
Bypass
Tray
A3
Plain
(A)
(B)
(1) (3)
Cancel OK
Print on Cover(2-Sided)
Yes No
Select cover settings.
(1) If the cover sheet will be copied on, touch the [Yes] key. Otherwise, touch the [No] key.
(2) Select paper settings for the cover.
(A) The currently selected paper tray for the cover is displayed.
(B) The size and type of paper in the currently selected tray is displayed.
To change the paper tray for the cover, touch the "Paper
Tray" key.
When the "Paper Tray" key is touched, a tray selection screen appears. Select the paper tray for the cover in the tray selection screen and touch the [OK] key.
Pamphlet Copy
Cover Setting
1. A4
2. A4R
3. B4
4. A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Bypass Tray
A3
Plain
OK
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
If the cover will be copied on, label sheets, transparency film, and tab paper cannot be used.
To cancel cover settings...
Touch the [Cancel] key.
2-51
Special Modes
Pamphlet Copy Cancel
OK
OK
5
Original
1-Sided 2-Sided
Left
Binding
Right
Binding
Cover
Setting
Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
6
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.)
To cancel scanning of the original and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• To make pamphlet copies of a book or other bound original, use the book copy function.
• When the pamphlet copy function is selected, 2-sided copying mode is automatically selected. When settings are selected that prevent 2-sided copying, the pamphlet copy function cannot be used.
• Scan the originals in order from the first page to the last page. The order of copying will be automatically adjusted by the machine. Four original pages will be copied onto each sheet of paper. Blank pages will be automatically produced at the end if the number of original pages is not a multiple of four.
To cancel pamphlet copy...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-52
COPYING A LARGE NUMBER OF
ORIGINALS AT ONCE (Job Build)
This function requires the automatic document feeder to be installed.
When copying a very large number of originals, this function allows you to divide the originals into sets and feed each set through the automatic document feeder one set at a time.
Use this function when you wish to copy all of the originals as a single job but the number of originals exceeds the maximum number that can be inserted.
This function is convenient when you wish to sort copies of a large number of originals into multiple sets. Because all originals are copied as a single job, you are saved the trouble of sorting the copies that would be required if the originals were divided into separate copy jobs.
When scanning originals in sets, divide the sheets so that no set has more than the number of paper that can be loaded, and then scan from the set with the first page. The settings that you select for the first set can be used for all remaining sets.
Sorting the copies of a large number of originals into 2 sets
Originals
Originals are scanned in separate sets
1
1
1
1
101
1
Indicator line
2
(2)
Special Modes
Margin Shift
Pamphlet Copy
Covers/Inserts
Book Copy
Erase
Job
Build
Transparency
Inserts
Tab Copy
Dual Page
Copy
Tandem
Copy
Multi Shot
Card Shot
(3)
OK
1
2
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
Select Job Build.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [Job Build] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
2-53
3
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to scan the first set of originals.
Scanning begins.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
4
Insert the next set of originals and press the [COLOUR START] key or the
[BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat this step until all originals have been scanned.
The copy settings (Exposure, Paper Select, and Copy Ratio only) can be changed for each set of originals. If you need to change the copy setting, follow the steps in "Changing the copy settings for each set of originals".
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ). All scanned data will be cleared.
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Place next original and press [Start].
to change copy settings, press [Change].
Change Read-End
5
To cancel copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
If the Quick File Folder of document filing mode is full, copying in job build mode will be impeded. Delete unneeded files from the Quick File Folder.
To cancel job build mode....
Touch the [Job Build] key in the screen of step 2 so that it is not highlighted.
2-54
Changing the copy settings for each set of originals
The copy settings (Exposure, Paper Select, and Copy Ratio only) can be changed for each set of originals.
Perform the step below before pressing the [Start] key to scan the originals in step 4 above.
Touch the [Change] key.
1
Place next original and press [Start].
to change copy settings, press [Change].
Change Read-End
2
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Plain
A4
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Read-End
Change the desired copy settings in the screen that appears and press the [Start] key.
Scanning of the originals will begin using the changed copy settings.
To cancel the copy setting changes and begin copying without scanning the new originals, touch the [Read-End] key.
• The colour mode cannot be changed with the [Colour Mode] key.
• The original size cannot be changed manually with the [Original] key. If the automatic original detection function is operating, the original size will be detected for each set of originals placed.
• When the bypass tray is selected, it is not possible to change the paper type.
• If "XY Zoom" was set for the ratio when the previous original was scanned, it will not be possible to change the ratio.
• When "Job Build" is used in combination with the functions below, the [Change] key will not appear in the screen of step 1 above.
Pamphlet copy, tandem copy, covers/inserts, transparency inserts, multi-shot, book copy, tab copy, staple sort
2-55
USING TWO MACHINES TO MAKE A LARGE
NUMBER OF COPIES (Tandem Copy)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
This function requires the hard disk expansion kit to be installed.
Two machines connected to the same network can be used to run a large copy job in parallel.
Each machine prints half of the copies, reducing the time required to complete the job.
Master machine and slave machine
In the following explanation, the master machine is the machine that is used to scan the originals. The slave machine is another machine specified in the master machine that only helps print the copies; it is not used to scan the originals.
Master machine
2 sets of copies
4 sets of copies are made
2 sets of copies
Slave machine
Network environment
Before using tandem copy
• To use this function, two machines must be connected to your network. Even if more machines are connected to the network, this function can only be used to have one other machine share a job.
• To use the tandem copy function, "Tandem Connection Setting" must be configured in the system settings
(administrator).
• When configuring the system settings in the master machine, the IP address of the slave machine is required. For the port number, it is best to use the initial setting (50001). Unless you experience difficulty with this setting, do not change the port number. The tandem settings should be configured by your network administrator. If the master machine and slave machine will switch roles, configure the IP address of the master machine in the slave machine.
The same port number can be used for both machines.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
(2)
Special Modes
Margin Shift
Pamphlet Copy
Covers/Inserts
Book Copy
Erase
Job
Build
Transparency
Inserts
Tab Copy
Dual Page
Copy
Tandem
Copy
Multi Shot
Card Shot
(3)
OK
1
2
Select tandem copy.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [Tandem Copy] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
2-56
3
Set the number of copies (number of sets) with the numeric keys.
Up to 999 copies (sets) can be set. When the [COLOUR
START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed, the copies will automatically be divided between the master and slave machines.
If an odd number of copies is set, the master machine will print the extra set.
If an incorrect number of copies is set...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.)
The following screen appears when the [START] key is pressed.
Starting tandem operation.
Please wait.
4
After the message appears, tandem copying begins.
If tandem copying is not possible, the following screen appears.
Tandem output is not allowed.
Output all sets using master machine?
(Cancel will delete the job.)
OK Cancel
To have the master machine make all copies, touch the [OK] key. To cancel the job, touch the [Cancel] key.
• To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• To cancel tandem copying...
Touch the [STOP] keys ( ) on both the master machine and the slave machine.
2-57
In this situation...
If a machine runs out of paper
If either the master machine or the slave machine run out of paper, the machine that ran out of paper will hold the job while the machine that still has paper continues the job. When paper is added to the machine that ran out, the job resumes.
When user authentication is enabled
User authentication is enabled in the master machine: tandem copying is possible.
User authentication is enabled in the slave machine but not in the master machine: tandem copying is not possible.
If tandem copying is performed without setting the number of copies
A message will appear and the master machine and slave machine will each make one set of copies (total of two sets).
To cancel tandem copy...
Touch the [Tandem Copy] key in the screen of step 2 so that it is not highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Tandem Connection Setting
This must be configured to use the tandem function. This can also be used to disable the tandem function.
2-58
USING A DIFFERENT PAPER TYPE FOR
COVERS (Covers/Inserts)
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
A different type of paper can be inserted in positions corresponding to front and back covers of a copy job when the automatic document feeder is used. A different type of paper can also be automatically added as an insert at specified pages.
Example of adding covers
Originals
Example of adding inserts
Originals
Back cover
Front cover
Inserts
Example of adding covers/inserts
Originals About the explanations of covers and inserts
There are various ways of using covers and inserts. To keep the explanations simple, covers and inserts are explained separately. For specific examples, see
"
Examples of covers and inserts " (page 2-150).
Front cover
Back cover
Inserts
Preparations for using covers and inserts
• Load the cover/insert paper in the tray before using the cover/insert function.
• Before selecting the cover/insert function, place the originals in the document feeder tray, select 1-sided or 2-sided copying, and select the number of copies and any other desired copy settings. When these settings have been completed, perform the procedure to select covers/inserts.
• The originals must be scanned using the automatic document feeder. The document glass cannot be used.
• For covers, only one sheet can be inserted for the front cover and only one sheet can be inserted for the back cover.
For inserts, up to 100 sheets can be inserted. Note that two insert sheets cannot be inserted between the same two pages.
• When performing 2-sided copying of 2-sided originals, an insert cannot be inserted between the front and reverse sides of an original.
2-59
INSERTING COVERS IN COPIES (Cover Settings)
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
A different type of paper can be inserted at the positions corresponding to the front and back covers of a copy job.
This is useful for arranging documents in an attractive format and for using a different type of paper as a cover on an estimate sheet or similar document.
Covers can be used in combination with inserts.
Copying on a front cover and inserting together with a back cover
AAA
AAA Front cover
1 2 3
Originals
4 5
1
2
3
4
5
Back cover
Front cover paper Back cover paper
Copies
1
Indicator line
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
The document glass cannot be used.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Covers/Inserts] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
3
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
Touch the [Front Cover] key.
2-60
4
5
(3)
Covers/Inserts
Front Cover Setting
Paper Tray
Bypass
Tray
A4
Plain
(2)
(A)
(B)
(1) (4)
Cancel
Print on Front Cover
Yes No
OK
1-Sided 2-Sided
Select cover settings.
(1) If the cover sheet will be copied on, touch the [Yes] key. Otherwise, touch the [No] key.
If the [No] key is touched, only cover insertion will be performed.
In this case, go to step (3).
(2) To copy on one side of the cover, touch the
[1-Sided] key. To copy on both sides of the cover, touch the [2-Sided] key.
(3) Select paper settings for the cover.
(A) The currently selected paper tray for the cover is displayed.
(B) The size and type of paper in the currently selected tray is displayed.
To change the paper tray for the cover, touch the "Paper
Tray" key.
When the "Paper Tray" key is touched, a tray selection screen appears. Select the paper tray for the cover in the tray selection screen and touch the [OK] key.
Covers/Inserts
Front Cover
1. A4
2. A4R
3. B4
4. A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Bypass Tray
A4
Plain
OK
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
If the cover will be copied on, label sheets, transparency film, and tab paper cannot be used. If not copied on, tab paper can be inserted.
To cancel cover settings...
Touch the [Cancel] key.
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
If you wish to insert a back cover, touch the [Back Cover] key.
The screen of step 4 appears. The procedures are the same as for the front cover. Follow the procedures in step 4.
When following the procedures, substitute "Back Cover" for
"Front Cover".
2-61
6
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
You can touch the [Insertion Type A] key or the [Insertion Type
B] key to select insert settings.
☞
INSERTING INSERT SHEETS IN COPIES (Insert
To check your settings, touch the [Page Layout] key.
☞
CHANGING COVER/INSERT SETTINGS (Page Layout)
7
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying of the originals in the document feeder tray begins.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• The document glass cannot be used.
• Cover settings cannot be selected if insertion of covers and inserts is disabled in the system settings (administrator).
To cancel cover sheet insertion...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-62
INSERTING INSERT SHEETS IN COPIES
(Insert Settings)
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
You can have different paper automatically inserted as inserts at specified pages of copies. Two types of paper can be used as inserts, and the insertion positions can be specified separately for each.
Covers can be used in combination with inserts.
Example: Insert A after page 3 and insert B after page 5.
1
Originals
2 3 4 5
Indicator line
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
Copies
Insert A
Insert B
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
The document glass cannot be used.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Covers/Inserts] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
3
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
Touch the [Insertion Type A] key.
2-63
4
(3)
Covers/Inserts
Insertion Type A Settings
Paper Tray
(2) (1) (4)
Cancel OK
Print on Insert Sheets
Yes No
Bypass
Tray
A4
Plain
(A)
(B) 1-Sided 2-Sided
Select insert settings.
(1) If the insert will be copied on, touch the
[Yes] key. Otherwise, touch the [No] key.
If the [No] key is touched, only insert sheet insertion will be performed.
In this case, go to step (3).
(2) To copy on one side of the insert, touch the
[1-Sided] key. To copy on both sides, touch the [2-Sided] key.
(3) Select insert paper settings.
(A) The currently selected paper tray for the insert is displayed.
(B) The size and type of paper in the currently selected tray is displayed.
To change the paper tray for the inserts, touch the "Paper
Tray" key.
When the "Paper Tray" key is touched, a tray selection screen appears. Select the desired paper tray in the tray selection screen and touch the [OK] key.
Covers/Inserts
Insertion Type A
1. A4
2. A4R
3. B4
4. A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Bypass Tray
A4
Plain
OK
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
If both sides of the insert will be copied on, label sheets, transparency film, and tab paper cannot be used. If not copied on, tab paper can be inserted.
5
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
If you wish to insert a different type of insert sheet, touch the [Insertion Type B] key.
The screen of step 4 appears. Settings are selected in the same way as for insert type A. Follow the procedures in step 4.
When following the procedures, substitute "Insert Type B" for
"Insert Type A".
2-64
Touch the [Insertion Settings] key.
6
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
7
(1)
Covers/Inserts
Insertion Settings
Insertion
Type A
Tray 1
A4
Plain
(A)
Insertion
Type B
Bypass
Tray
A4
Plain
(B)
(2)
OK
Insertion Page
10
Insertion
Total:4
Enter
(3)
(5)
(C)
Specify the pages where inserts A and B will be inserted.
(1) Touch the [Insertion Type A] key or the
[Insertion Type B] key.
Specify the page where the highlighted insert will be inserted.
(A) This shows the tray selected for insert type A and the paper size and type.
(B) This shows the tray selected for insert type B and the paper size and type.
When the [Insertion Type A] key is highlighted, the insert sheet insertion settings are applied to [Insertion Type A].
When the [Insertion Type B] key is highlighted, the insert settings are applied to [Insertion Type B].
(2) Enter the page number where the insert sheet will be inserted with the numeric keys.
For more information, see "
The [CLEAR] key ( ) can be pressed to return the setting of the selected item to the default value. If you make a mistake, press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
(3) Touch the [Enter] key.
(C) This shows the total number of inserts. Up to 100 insert sheets can be inserted. To insert multiple inserts, touch the [Enter] key after entering each insertion page number (insertion position) with the numeric keys.
(4) To insert another insert sheet, repeat steps
(1) to (3).
(5) Touch the [OK] key.
If both sides of the insert will be copied on, label sheets, transparency film, and tab paper cannot be used. If not copied on, tab paper can be inserted.
2-65
8
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
To select cover settings, touch the [Front Cover] key or the
[Back Cover] key.
☞
INSERTING COVERS IN COPIES (Cover Settings) (page
To check your settings, touch the [Page Layout] key.
☞
CHANGING COVER/INSERT SETTINGS (Page Layout)
9
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying of the originals in the document feeder tray begins.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• Use the same size of paper for the inserts as for the copies.
• Up to 100 insert sheets can be added. Note that two insert sheets cannot be inserted between the same two pages.
• When performing 2-sided copying of 2-sided originals, an insert cannot be added between the front and reverse sides of an original page.
• Cover/insert settings cannot be selected if insertion of covers and inserts is disabled in the system settings (administrator).
To cancel cover sheet insertion...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-66
CHANGING COVER/INSERT SETTINGS (Page Layout)
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
Cover settings and insert settings can be combined.
This section explains how to check completed cover and insert insertion page settings, and change or delete insertion pages.
Changing insert A from page 4 to page 5
1
2
3
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
4
4th page, insert A
7th page, insert B
9th page, insert B
12th page, insert A
1
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Covers/Inserts] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
2
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
3
4
1
2
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
5
5th page, insert A
7th page, insert B
9th page, insert B
12th page, insert A
Touch the [Page Layout] key.
2-67
3
Example: Touch insert A at page 4
Covers/Inserts
Page Layout OK
Insertion
Type A
4/-
Insertion
Type B
7/-
Insertion
Type B
9/-
Insertion
Type A
12/-
1
1
Touch the key of the page that you wish to delete or change.
If you do not need to change the setting, touch the [OK] key and go to step 6.
• Each key shows a print image icon and the insertion page.
• If there are multiple screens, touch the keys to move through the screens.
To edit a cover, touch the [Front Cover] key or the [Back Cover] key and go to step 4.
Touch the key of the insertion page that you want to edit or clear. The following screen will appear.
Amend the insertion?
Cancel Delete Amend
• To delete the page, touch the [Delete] key. After deleting the key, touch the [OK] key and go to step 6.
• To edit the page, touch the [Amend] key.
To edit an insert, touch the [Insertion Type A] key or the
[Insertion Type B] key and go to step 5.
• To cancel, touch the [Cancel] key.
Icons
: Copy on front side only
: Copy on reverse side only
: 2-sided copy
: Do not copy
For inserts, the insertion page also appears.
* represents a page number.
*/-: Copy only on front side at page *
*/*: 2-sided copy at page */*
<*: Insert without copying at page *
4
Covers/Inserts
Front Cover Setting
Paper Tray
Bypass
Tray
A4
Plain
Cancel
Print on Front Cover
Yes No
OK
1-Sided 2-Sided
Change the front/back cover settings.
The settings are changed in the same way as they are initially configured. See step 4 of "
(Cover Settings) " (page 2-60) to change the cover settings.
After changing the settings, touch the [OK] key and return to step 3.
To cancel cover settings...
Touch the [Cancel] key.
2-68
5
Covers/Inserts
Insertion Amend
Insertion
Type A
Tray 1
A4
Plain
Insertion
Type B
Bypass
Tray
A4
Plain
OK
Insertion Page
5
Insertion
Total:4
Enter
Change the settings for insert type A/B.
The settings are changed in the same way as they are initially configured. See step 7 of "
COPIES (Insert Settings) " (page 2-63) to change the insert
settings.
After changing the settings, touch the [OK] key and return to step 3.
6
Special Modes
Covers/Inserts
Cover Setting
Front
Cover
Back
Cover
Cancel
Inserts Setting
Insertion
Type A
Insertion
Settings
Insertion
Type B
OK
OK
Tray Settings Page Layout
Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
2-69
ADDING INSERTS WHEN COPYING ON
TRANSPARENCY FILM
(Transparency Inserts)
When copying on transparency film, the sheets may stick together due to static electricity. The transparency inserts function can be used to automatically insert a sheet of paper between each sheet of transparency film, making the sheets easy to handle.
It is also possible to copy on the inserts.
A
B C
1
Oriented horizontally
Oriented vertically
Inserts
Place the transparency film in the bypass tray.
• Transparency film can only be placed in the bypass tray.
• Place the transparency film face down on the bypass tray.
When placing the transparency film, the rounded corner of the film should be:
- At the front and left if the film is oriented horizontally.
- At the back and left if the film is oriented vertically.
• After loading the transparency film, configure the bypass tray settings as explained in "
2
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Transparency Inserts] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
2-70
4
(1)
Special Modes
Transparency Inserts
Paper Tray
Tray1
A4
Plain
Cancel
Print on Insert Sheets
Yes No
(2)
OK
OK
Select insert settings.
(1) Select whether or not the insert paper will be copied on ([Yes] or [No]).
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
Explanation of (A)
When transparency inserts is selected, paper suitable for the inserts is automatically selected. The automatically selected paper tray, paper size, and paper type are indicated here.
(A)
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• The number of copies cannot be selected in this mode.
• When performing 2-sided copying, only "2-sided to 1-sided" mode can be used.
To cancel the transparency inserts setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
2-71
COPYING MULTIPLE ORIGINALS ONTO
ONE SHEET (Multi Shot)
Multiple original pages can be copied onto a single sheet of paper in a uniform layout. Select 2in1 to copy two original pages onto one sheet, or 4in1 to copy four original pages onto one sheet. This function is convenient when you wish to present multiple pages in a compact format, or show a view of all pages in a document.
2in1 copying 4in1 copying
A
B
A B
A
B
C
D
A B
C D
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Multi Shot] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
2-72
3
Special Modes
Multi Shot
(1)
2in1 4in1
(3) (2)
Cancel
Layout
(4)
OK
OK
Border
Select the number of originals to be copied onto one sheet of paper, the layout, and the border.
(1) Touch the [2in1] key or the [4in1] key.
If needed, the images will be rotated.
(2) Select the layout.
Select the order in which the originals will be arranged on the copy.
Number of pages
Layout
2in1
4in1
The arrows in the above diagram indicate how the images are arranged.
(3) Select the border.
Solid lines, broken lines, or no lines can be selected.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.)
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
When using the multi shot function, the appropriate copy ratio will be automatically set based on the original size, paper size, and the number of originals to be copied onto one sheet. The minimum possible reduction ratio is 25%. The original size, paper size, and selected number of original pages may require that the ratio be less than 25%. As copying will take place at
25% in this case, part of the original images may be cut off.
To cancel a multi shot setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-73
COPYING A PAMPHLET (Book Copy)
This function is used to make a copy of the two facing pages of an open book or other bound document.
Copies made with this function can be folded at the centre to create a booklet.
This function is convenient for arranging copies into an attractive booklet or pamphlet.
How to place the original
Originals
A C
B D
Back cover Cover
1
Inside of cover
1st page
2
2nd page
3
3rd page
4
4th page Inside of back cover
Place the original
A C B D
1 3 2 4
1
3
The copies are in the same layout as the original.
1
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Book Copy] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
2-74
2
Special Modes
Book Copy
(1)
Left
Binding
Right
Binding
(2)
Cancel
OK
OK
Select book copy settings.
(1) Select the binding position ([Left Binding] or [Right Binding]).
(2) To insert a cover, touch the [Cover Setting] key.
If a cover will not be added, go to step 4.
Cover
Setting
Cover settings cannot be selected if insertion of covers and inserts is disabled in the system settings (administrator).
3
Book Copy
Cover Setting
Paper Tray
Bypass
Tray
A3
Plain
(2)
(A)
(B)
(1) (3)
Cancel OK
Print on Cover (2-sided)
Yes No
Select cover settings.
(1) If the cover sheet will be copied on, touch the [Yes] key. Otherwise, touch the [No] key.
(2) Select paper settings for the cover.
(A) The currently selected paper tray for the cover is displayed.
(B) The size and type of paper in the currently selected tray is displayed.
In the example screen, A3 (11" x 17") size plain paper is loaded in the bypass tray.
To change the paper tray for the cover, touch the "Paper
Tray" key.
When the "Paper Tray" key is touched, a tray selection screen appears. Select the desired paper tray in the tray selection screen and touch the [OK] key.
Book Copy
Cover Setting
1. A4
2. A4R
3. B4
4. A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Bypass Tray
A3
Plain
OK
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
If the cover will be copied on, label sheets, transparency film, and tab paper cannot be used.
To cancel cover settings...
Touch the [Cancel] key.
2-75
4
Special Modes
Book Copy
Left
Binding
Right
Binding
Cancel
OK
OK
Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
Cover
Setting
Place the original face down on the document glass.
Place the opened front cover and back cover face down.
5
6
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to scan the first original.
Scanning begins.
Scan the remaining original pages in the following order:
Opened inside of front cover and 1st page
Opened 2nd and 3rd page
·
·
·
Opened last page and inside of back cover
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
7
Place the next pair of opened pages and press the [COLOUR START] key or the
[BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat this step until all original pages have been scanned.
For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-76
8
Place next original. Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Read-End
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Copying will begin.
• Four original pages will be copied onto each sheet of paper. Blank pages will be automatically added at the end if the total number of original pages is not a multiple of four.
• When book copy is selected, 2-sided copying is automatically selected. When settings are selected that prevent 2-sided copying, the book copy function cannot be used.
To cancel book copy...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 2.
2-77
COPYING CAPTIONS ONTO TAB PAPER
(Tab Copy)
Captions can be copied onto the tabs of tab paper. Prepare appropriate originals for the tab captions.
Tab copy is possible from the bypass tray.
Prepare originals that match the tab positions.
The image is shifted by the width of the tab
RELATION BETWEEN THE ORIGINALS AND THE TAB
PAPER
Tab copying with a left binding
Originals Loading tab paper
Originals
Placing the originals
• Document feeder tray
1
1
Reverse side
Insert the originals so that the side with no tab text enters first.
• Document glass
Final image
1
Place so that the side with the tab text is on the left.
Load the tab paper so that the tab on the first sheet is toward you.
2-78
Tab copying with a right binding
Originals
Originals
Placing the originals
• Document feeder tray
1
1
Final image
Loading tab paper
Insert the originals so that the side with no tab text enters first.
• Document glass
1
Reverse side
Load the tab paper so that the tab on the first sheet is away from you.
Place so that the side with the tab text is on the left.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Tab Copy] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
3
Special Modes
Tab Copy
Original Copy
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
OK
Image Shift
10
(0~20) mm
Set the tab width.
(1) Set the image shift width (tab width) with
0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 5/8") can be entered.
You can also directly touch a numeric value display key to change a number with the numeric keys.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
2-79
4
Reverse side
Load the tab paper.
When using the bypass tray, place the paper with the print side down.
Place the paper so that the sides with the tabs enter the machine last.
After loading the tab paper, configure the bypass tray settings as explained in "
MAKING COPIES USING THE BYPASS
The width of the tab paper can be as wide as A4 width (210 mm) plus 20 mm (or 8-1/2" x 11" paper (8-1/2") plus 5/8").
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.)
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel tab copy...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Tab Copy Setting
The default image shift width can be set from 0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 5/8"). The factory default setting is "10 mm (1/2")".
2-80
COPYING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD ON ONE
SHEET OF PAPER (Card Shot)
When copying a card, this function allows you to copy the front and reverse sides together onto a single sheet of paper.
This function is convenient for making copies for identification purposes and helps save paper.
Copies
Originals
Front
Back
1
Example of an A4
(8-1/2" x 11") size portrait copy
Example of an A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size landscape copy
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
Select the paper to be used for card shot.
Select the paper as explained in "
Place the original face down on the document glass.
2
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Card Shot] key.
☞
Special modes menu (1st screen) (page 2-41)
2-81
4
Special Modes
Card Shot
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
OK
X
Y
86
54
(25~210) mm
(25~210) mm
Fit to
Page
Size Reset
(A)
(B)
Select card shot settings.
(1) Enter the original size.
With the [X] key highlighted, enter the X (horizontal) dimension of the original with the keys.
Touch the [Y] key and enter the Y (vertical) dimension of the original with the keys.
You can also directly touch a numeric value display key to change a number with the numeric keys.
(A) To enlarge or reduce the images to fit the paper based on the entered original size, touch the [Fit to
Page] key.
(B) The [Size Reset] key can be pressed to return the horizontal and vertical dimensions to the values set in
"Card Shot Settings" in the system settings
(administrator).
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode. Make sure that the entered dimensions appear in the [Original] key.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to scan the front side of the card.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
6
Turn the card over and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key to scan the reverse side of the card.
Use the same [START] key that you used for the front side of the card.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
Place next original. Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Copying will begin.
7 Read-End
To cancel copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-82
• The original must be placed on the document glass.
• Copying is only possible on standard size paper.
• XY Zoom cannot be used when using this function.
• The image cannot be rotated when using this function.
To cancel card shot...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
System Settings (Administrator): Card Shot Settings
This is used to set the values to which the size returns when the [Size Reset] key is pressed. 25 mm to 210 mm (1" to 8-1/2") can be entered for both the horizontal and vertical dimensions.
The factory default settings are 86 mm (3-3/8") for X (the width) and 54 mm (2-1/8") for Y (the height).
2-83
PRINTING THE DATE AND A STAMP ON
COPIES (Stamp)
Use this function to print the date, a stamp, the page number, and text on copies. In addition, specific text can be added to a copy as a watermark. (Watermark)*
Six printing positions are available: top left, top centre, top right, bottom left, bottom centre, and bottom right.
The printing positions are separated into areas that are used for the date, page number and text (A below), and areas that are used for a stamp (B below). The watermark is printed at the centre of the paper.
Top centre
A
Top left Top right
B
Print area
A
B
A
A
Centre of paper
Maximum number of positions
1 position only
6 positions
1 position only
6 positions
—
Bottom left
Watermark print position
Bottom centre
Bottom right
Stamp
Date
Stamp
Page
Numbering
Text
Watermark*
* when equipped with the hard disk drive.
• If the selected stamp content of one position overlaps the stamp content of another position, priority will be given in the following order: watermark, right side, left side, centre. Content that is hidden due to overlapping will not be printed.
• Text will be printed at the preset size regardless of the copy ratio or paper size setting.
• Text will be printed at the preset exposure regardless of the exposure setting.
• Depending on the size of the paper, some printed content may be cut off or shifted out of position.
When used in combination with other special modes
When Stamp is used in combination with the following special modes, the special modes are reflected in the stamp content.
Special Modes
Margin Shift
Tab Copy
Centring
Dual Page Copy
Card Shot
Multi Shot
Pamphlet Copy
Book Copy
Printing
Together with the image, the stamp content is shifted the amount of the margin width.
Unlike a copy image that moves, the image will be printed in the position set in the stamp.
The stamp is printed on each copy sheet.
The print content is printed on each original page.
The stamp is printed on each page of the resulting pamphlet or book.
Covers/Inserts
Use the stamp settings to select whether or not the item is printed on inserted covers and inserts.
2-84
GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP
To select stamp settings, follow the steps below.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Stamp] key.
☞
Special modes menu (2nd screen) (page 2-42)
3
Special Modes
Stamp
Date
Page
Numbering
Watermark
Stamp
Text
Cancel
Layout
OK
OK
1
2
Select the print position.
Select from 6 positions: top left, top centre, top right, bottom left, bottom centre, bottom right.
You can also skip this step and go directly to the next step. In this case, the stamp items will be printed in the following positions:
Date: Top right
Page number: Bottom centre
Stamp: Top left
Text: Top left
The position of a watermark cannot be selected. Proceed to the next step.
Print positions
The keys that show the print positions will appear as follows depending on the state of the settings.
Not selected, stamp setting has not been selected.
Selected during selection of the stamp setting.
Not available, stamp setting has already been allocated.
The above key is the top left key. The appearance of each key varies depending on the position of the key.
• "Date" and "Page Numbering" cannot be selected in multiple positions. If the [Date] key or [Page Numbering] key is touched when "Date" or "Page Numbering" has already been selected for a position, a message will appear asking you if you wish to move that item to the selected position. To move the item, touch the [Yes] key. Otherwise, press the [No] key.
• If you attempt to set "Date", "Text", or "Page Numbering" in a position where one of these items is already set, a message will appear. To change the previously selected item to the new item, touch the [Yes] key. To keep the previous item, touch the [No] key.
2-85
4
Special Modes
Stamp
Date
Page
Numbering
Stamp
Text
Watermark
Cancel
OK
OK
1
2
Layout
Cancel
OK
OK
1
2
Select Stamp.
For detailed information on each of the stamp items, see the following sections:
Date:
ADDING THE DATE TO COPIES (Date)
Stamp:
STAMPING COPIES (Stamp) (page 2-90)
Page numbering:
PRINTING PAGE NUMBERS ON COPIES
Text:
PRINTING TEXT ON COPIES (Text)
(page
Watermark :
When you have finished selecting stamp settings, touch the key.
5
Special Modes
Stamp
Date
Page
Numbering
Stamp
Text
Watermark Layout
6
Special Modes
Stamp
Original Orientation
(3)
Cancel
2-Sided Original Type
OK
OK
2
2
Print on Covers/Inserts when Copying on Covers/Inserts
Layout
(2) (1)
Select settings for the original and covers/inserts.
(1) Touch the [Original Orientation] key and specify the orientation of the placed original.
If 2-sided originals have been placed, touch the key and specify the binding position (booklet binding or tablet binding) of the originals.
(2) Select stamp settings for covers/inserts.
If you do not want to print the stamp items on covers/inserts, touch the checkbox to remove the checkmark .
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
To edit a stamp position or delete a stamp item, touch the
[Layout] key.
☞
CHECKING THE STAMP LAYOUT (Layout)
(page
• When copying on covers/inserts is not selected, printing will not take place even if a checkmark appears.
• This setting cannot be selected if insertion of covers and inserts is disabled in the system settings (administrator).
2-86
7
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
• If you selected printing in colour, press the [COLOUR START] key. Even if a colour is selected, pressing the
[BLACK & WHITE START] key will print the stamp items in black and white.
• If a colour print setting is selected, the copy will be counted as a full colour copy even if it is black & white.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel Stamp...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-87
ADDING THE DATE TO COPIES (Date)
The date can be printed on copies. The position of the date, colour, format, and page (first page only or all pages) can be selected.
Example: Printing APRIL 4, 2010 in the top right corner of the paper.
04/APR/2010
1
Touch the [Date] key in the stamp selection screen.
See steps 1 to 4 of " GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85).
2
Stamp
Date
YYYY/MM/DD
MM/DD/YYYY
DD/MM/YYYY
MM DD, YYYY
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
All Pages
04/APR/2010
Date Change
Set the date format.
(1) Touch the key that shows the desired date format.
(2) If you selected [YYYY/MM/DD],
[MM/DD/YYYY], or [DD/MM/YYYY], touch the
[/], [.], [-], or [ ] key to select the separator.
(1) (2)
3
Stamp
Date
YYYY/MM/DD
MM/DD/YYYY
DD/MM/YYYY
MM DD, YYYY
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
All Pages
04/APR/2010
Date Change
Touch the [Print Colour] key and select the print colour.
Touch the desired colour and touch the [OK] key.
Stamp
Print Colour OK
Bk(Black)
R(Red)
C(Cyan)
G(Green)
M(Magenta)
B(Blue)
Y(Yellow)
• If you selected a colour other than [Bk (Black)], press the [COLOUR START] key. Pressing the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key will print the date in black and white.
• If the date is printed in colour on a black and white copy, the copy will be included in the full colour count.
2-88
Stamp
Date
YYYY/MM/DD
MM/DD/YYYY
DD/MM/YYYY
MM DD, YYYY
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
All Pages
04/APR/2010
Date Change
Check the displayed date. If you need to change the date, touch the [Date
Change] key.
Set the date that you wish to use and touch the [OK] key.
Stamp
Date Change OK
Year
2010
Month
04
Day
04 4
5
As an alternative to touching the keys, you can also directly touch the numeric value display key and change the value with the numeric keys.
• If you select a date that does not exist (such as Feb. 30), the [OK] key will be greyed out to prevent entry.
• Changing the date here will not change the date that is set in the machine using "Clock" in the system settings.
Stamp
Date
YYYY/MM/DD
MM/DD/YYYY
DD/MM/YYYY
MM DD, YYYY
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
All Pages
04/APR/2010
Date Change
Select the pages that the date will be printed on and touch the [OK] key.
Select printing on the first page only, or printing on all pages.
After touching the [OK] key, continue from step 5 of "
PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85) to complete
the copy procedure.
To cancel the date print setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 2.
2-89
STAMPING COPIES (Stamp)
Text such as "CONFIDENTIAL" can be printed in white on a dark background as a "stamp" on copies.
The position, colour, size, density, and pages (first page only or all pages) can be selected for a stamp.
Printing "CONFIDENTIAL" in the top left corner of a copy
CONFIDENTIAL
The following 12 selections are available for the stamp text.
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
Three levels can be selected for the density of the stamp background.
Seven colours can be selected for the stamp colour.
Two stamp sizes can be selected.
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
1
Touch the [Stamp] key in the stamp selection screen.
See steps 1 to 4 of " GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85).
Touch the key of the stamp that you wish to use.
2
Stamp
Stamp
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk 1 2 3
Size
Larger
Smaller
All Pages
2-90
3
Stamp
Stamp
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk 1 2 3
Size
Larger
Smaller
All Pages
Touch the [Print Colour] key and set the colour and density.
Touch the colour that you wish to use.
If you wish to darken the selected colour, touch the
If you wish to lighten the selected colour, touch the
key.
key.
When you have finished selecting the settings, touch the [OK] key.
Stamp
Print Colour OK
Bk(Black)
R(Red)
C(Cyan)
G(Green)
M(Magenta)
B(Blue)
Y(Yellow)
1
Exposure
2 3
• If you selected a colour other than [Bk (Black)], press the [COLOUR START] key. Pressing the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key will print the stamp in black and white.
• If the stamp is printed in colour on a black and white copy, the copy will be included in the full colour count.
Touch the [Larger Smaller] key to select the size of the stamp.
4
Stamp
Stamp
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk 1 2 3
Size
Larger
Smaller
All Pages
5
Stamp
Stamp
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk 1 2 3
Size
Larger
Smaller
All Pages
Select the pages that the date will be printed on and touch the [OK] key.
Select printing on the first page only, or printing on all pages.
After touching the [OK] key, continue from step 5 of "
PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85) to complete
the copy procedure.
The stamp text cannot be edited.
To cancel a stamp setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 2.
2-91
PRINTING PAGE NUMBERS ON COPIES
(Page Numbering)
Page numbers can be printed on copies.
The position, colour, format, and page number can be selected for page numbering.
Printing the page number at the bottom centre of the paper.
1
2
3
1
Touch the [Page Numbering] key in the stamp selection screen.
See steps 1 to 4 of " GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85).
2
Stamp
Page Numbering
Page Numbering Format
1,2,3..
(1),(2),(3)..
-1-,-2-,-3-..
<1>,<2>,<3>..
P.1,P.2,P.3..
1/5,2/5,3/5..
Cancel OK
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Total Page
Auto
Manual
1
Page
Page Number
Select a format for the page number.
If the [1/5, 2/5, 3/5] key is selected,
"Page number / total pages" will be printed. "Auto" is initially selected for the total pages, which means that the number of scanned original pages is automatically set as the total pages.
If you need to set the total pages manually, such as when a large number of originals are divided into sets for scanning, touch the [Manual] key to display the total pages entry screen.
Stamp
Page Numbering
Page Numbering Format
1,2,3..
(1),(2),(3)..
-1-,-2-,-3-..
<1>,<2>,<3>..
P.1,P.2,P.3..
1/5,2/5,3/5..
Cancel OK
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Total Page
Auto
Manual
1
Page
Page Number
Enter the total pages (1 to 999) with the numeric keys and touch the [OK] key.
The [CLEAR] key ( ) can be pressed to return the setting of the selected item to the default value. If you make a mistake, press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
• When 2-sided copying is performed, the total pages is the total number of sides of the paper. If the final page is blank, it is not counted. However, if a back cover will be added and the [Count Back Cover] checkbox is selected
, the final page is counted. (See step 7.)
• When used in combination with "Dual Page Copy", "Multi Shot", or "Card Shot", the number of sides of the paper copied on is the total pages.
• When used in combination with "Pamphlet Copy" or "Book Copy", the total number of pages in the resulting pamphlet or booklet is the total pages.
2-92
3
Stamp
Page Numbering
Page Numbering Format
1,2,3..
(1),(2),(3)..
-1-,-2-,-3-..
P.1,P.2,P.3..
<1>,<2>,<3>..
1/5,2/5,3/5..
Cancel OK
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Total Page
Auto
Manual
1
Page
Page Number
Touch the [Print Colour] key.
Touch the colour that you wish to use.
When you have finished selecting the settings, touch the [OK] key.
Stamp
Print Colour OK
Bk(Black)
R(Red)
C(Cyan)
G(Green)
M(Magenta)
B(Blue)
Y(Yellow)
4
• If you selected a colour other than [Bk (Black)], press the [COLOUR START] key. Pressing the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key will print the page numbers in black and white.
• If page numbers are printed in colour on black and white copies, the copies will be included in the full colour count.
Stamp
Page Numbering
Page Numbering Format
1,2,3..
(1),(2),(3)..
-1-,-2-,-3-..
<1>,<2>,<3>..
P.1,P.2,P.3..
1/5,2/5,3/5..
Cancel OK
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Total Page
Auto
Manual
1
Page
Page Number
To configure page number settings, touch the [Page Number] key.
If you do not need to configure page number settings, go to step 9.
5
Stamp
Page Number
Auto
Manual
(1)
First Number
1
Last Number
Auto
Printing Starts from Page
1
Covers/Inserts
Counting
(2)
OK
Select page number settings.
(1) Touch the [Manual] key.
(2) Set the first number, the last number, and the "Printing Starts from Page" number.
Touch each key and enter a number with the numeric keys (1 to 999).
The [CLEAR] key ( ) can be pressed to return the setting of the selected item to the default value. If you make a mistake, press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
• A "Last Number" smaller than the "First Number" cannot be set.
• The "Last Number" is initially set to "Auto", which means that page numbers are automatically printed through the last page based on the "First Number" and "Printing Start from Page" settings.
• If the "Last Number" is set to a number smaller than the "Total Pages", page numbers are not printed on pages after the page set as the "Last Number".
• "Printing Starts from Page" is used to set the page number from which you want to begin printing page numbers.
For example, if "3" is set and 1-sided copying is being performed, page numbers will be printed beginning from the
3rd copy sheet (the 3rd original page). If 2-sided copying is being performed, page numbers will be printed beginning from the front side of the 2nd copy sheet (the 3rd original page).
2-93
6
Stamp
Page Number
Auto
Manual
OK
First Number
1
Last Number
Auto
Printing Starts from Page
1
Covers/Inserts
Counting
If covers/inserts will be inserted, touch the [Covers/Inserts Counting] key if you want to include the covers/inserts in the page number count and want page numbers printed on the covers/inserts.
7
Stamp
Covers/Inserts Counting
(1)
Count Front Cover
Count Inserts
Count Back Cover
(2)
OK
Touch each item that you want counted in the page numbers so that a checkmark appears , and then touch the [OK] key.
Items with a checkmark will be reflected in the print image on the right side of the screen.
(A): Front cover image
(B): Insert image
(C): Back cover image
(A) (B) (C)
• When the checkboxes are selected , each inserted sheet of paper (front cover, insert, or back cover) will be counted as one page in the case of 1-sided copying, or two pages in the case of 2-sided copying. However, when the body sheets are 1-sided copies and the inserted sheets are 2-sided copies, each body sheet is counted as one page and each inserted sheet is counted as two pages.
• Page numbers are printed on covers/inserts if the covers/inserts are counted and if they are copied on.
Touch the [OK] key.
8
Stamp
Page Number
Auto
Manual
OK
First Number
1
Last Number
Auto
Printing Starts from Page
1
Covers/Inserts
Counting
9
Stamp
Page Numbering
Page Numbering Format
1,2,3..
(1),(2),(3)..
-1-,-2-,-3-..
P.1,P.2,P.3..
<1>,<2>,<3>..
1/5,2/5,3/5..
Cancel OK
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Total Page
Auto
Manual
1
Page
Page Number
Touch the [OK] key.
After touching the [OK] key, continue from step 5 of "
PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85) to complete
the copy procedure.
2-94
• When Page Numbering is selected, copying in group mode is not possible. The mode automatically changes to sort mode.
• When the page number printing position is set to the right side or left side and pamphlet copy or book copy is used, the print position is changed so that the page numbers always appear on the outer side of each opened page (the left and right sides of the opened pages). If a stamp is set in the area where page numbering is set, the position of the stamp changes in the same way as the page number.
If another stamp item is set in this changing position, the page numbers will alternate sides with this stamp item.
A stamp item that is in a position not affected by the changing page number position will be printed in its original set position.
Example: When four pages are copied using pamphlet copy and the page number format is "1, 2, 3...", the result is as follows:
In this example, the page number is set at the bottom of the page and the date is set at the top, and thus the date does not move.
Print settings Side 1 Side 2
Date 04/APR/2010 04/APR/2010 04/APR/2010 04/APR/2010
Stamp
No.
Text
CONFIDENTIAL
4 AAA AAA
CONFIDENTIAL
1
To cancel the page numbering setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 2.
CONFIDENTIAL
2 AAA AAA
CONFIDENTIAL
3
2-95
PRINTING TEXT ON COPIES (Text)
Entered text can be printed on copies. Up to 30 frequently used text strings can be stored.
Example: Printing "April 2010 Planning Meeting" in the top left corner of the paper
April 2010 Planning Meeting
1
Touch the [Text] key in the stamp selection screen.
See steps 1 to 4 of " GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85).
2
Stamp
Text
Recall
Pre-Set
Store/Delete
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Direct Entry
All Pages
Touch the [Recall] key.
The [Direct Entry] key can be touched to display the text entry screen. When all characters have been entered, touch the [OK] key.
To store or delete a text string, touch the [Store/Delete] key.
☞
Storing, editing, and deleting text strings (page 2-98)
3
Stamp
Text
5 10
Recall
No.01 AAA AAA
No.03 CCC CCC
No.05
No.07
No.09
(1)
No.02 BBB BBB
No.04 DDD DDD
No.06
No.08
No.10
(2)
Cancel OK
1
3
Specify the text to be printed.
(1) Touch the text string that you wish to select.
You can touch the [5 10] key to switch the number of keys displayed in the screen between 5 and 10. When
5-key display is selected, the entire text string appears in each key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
2-96
4
Stamp
Text
AAA AAA
Recall
Pre-Set
Store/Delete
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Direct Entry
All Pages
Touch the [Print Colour] key.
Touch the colour that you wish to use. When you have finished selecting the settings, touch the [OK] key.
Stamp
Print Colour OK
Bk(Black)
R(Red)
C(Cyan)
G(Green)
M(Magenta)
B(Blue)
Y(Yellow)
5
• If you selected a colour other than [Bk (Black)], press the [COLOUR START] key. Pressing the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key will print the page numbers in black and white.
• If the text is printed in colour on a black and white copies, the copies will be included in the full colour count.
Stamp
Text
AAA AAA
Recall
Pre-Set
Store/Delete
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Direct Entry
All Pages
Select the pages to be printed on and touch the [OK] key.
Select printing on the first page only, or printing on all pages.
After touching the [OK] key, continue from step 5 of "
PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85) to complete
the copy procedure.
Text settings can also be configured in the Web pages. Click [Application Settings], [Copy settings] and then [Text Settings
(Stamp)] in the Web page menu.
To cancel a text setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 2.
2-97
Storing, editing, and deleting text strings
1
Touch the [Text] key in the stamp selection screen.
See steps 1 to 4 of " GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85).
Touch the [Store/Delete] key.
2
Stamp
Text
Recall
Pre-Set
Store/Delete
Cancel OK
First Page
Print Colour
Bk(Black)
Direct Entry
All Pages
3
Stamp
Text
5 10
Store/Delete
No.01 AAA AAA
No.03 CCC CCC
No.05
No.07
No.09
No.02 BBB BBB
No.04 DDD DDD
No.06
No.08
No.10
Back
1
3
Store a text string, or edit/delete a stored text string.
• To store a text string, touch a key with no text stored.
A text entry screen will appear. A maximum of 50 characters can be entered. When you have finished entering the text, touch the [OK] key. The text entry screen will close.
• To edit or delete a text string, follow the instructions below.
To edit or delete a text string...
• When the key with the text string is touched, the following screen appears.
When the [Amend] key is touched, a text entry screen appears. The stored text string appears in the text entry screen. Edit the text. When you have finished entering the text, touch the [OK] key. The text entry screen will close.
• When the [Delete] key is touched, the stored text is deleted.
A text has been already stored to this location. Change the text?
Cancel Delete Amend
• Text settings can also be configured in the Web pages. Click [Application Settings], [Copy settings] and then [Text
Settings (Stamp)] in the Web page menu.
2-98
4
No.01 AAA AAA
No.03 CCC CCC
No.05
No.07
No.09
No.02 BBB BBB
No.04
No.06
No.08
No.10
Back
1
3
Touch the [Back] key.
You will return to the screen of step 2.
To copy using a stored text string, continue from step 2 of
"
PRINTING TEXT ON COPIES (Text) " (page 2-96).
2-99
CHECKING THE STAMP LAYOUT (Layout)
After stamp items have been selected, you can check the print layout, change the print position, and delete stamp items.
Touch the [Layout] key.
1
Special Modes
Special Modes
Date
Page
Numbering
Stamp
Text
Watermark
Cancel
Layout
OK
OK
1
2
2
Stamp
Layout
The [Layout] key can only be touched when stamp items have been selected.
OK
If the layout is correct, touch the [OK] key.
Touch the key of the stamp item that you want to delete or whose position you want to change.
AAA AAA
CONFIDENTIAL DO NOT COPY
1,2,3..
A maximum of 14 characters appear in each key.
3
Do you want to move or delete the selected item?
Cancel Delete Move
To change the position of the item, touch the [Move] key. To delete the item, touch the [Delete] key.
• If the [Move] key is touched, a screen for selecting the destination position appears.
• If the [Delete] key is touched, the item is deleted. (Go to step
6.)
2-100
4
Stamp
Move
Select the location to move the selected item.
OK
Touch the key of the desired destination position.
The touched position key is highlighted and the print position changes.
The keys that show the print positions will appear as follows depending on the state of the settings.
Not selected, stamp setting has not been selected.
Selected during selection of the stamp setting.
Not available, stamp setting has already been allocated.
The above key is the top left key. The appearance of each key varies depending on the position of the key.
If you wish to swap the position of the selected stamp item with the position of another stamp item, temporarily move either one of the items to an unoccupied position and then switch the print positions.
5
Stamp
Move
Select the location to move the selected item.
OK
Touch the [OK] key.
If you attempt to move the stamp item to a position that is already occupied by another stamp item, a message will appear asking you if you wish to overwrite the other stamp item. To overwrite the other stamp item, touch the [Yes] key. To cancel the move, touch the [No] key.
An item has been already selected to this location. Overwrite the item?
No Yes
Touch the [OK] key.
Stamp
Layout
6
OK
AAA AAA
CONFIDENTIAL DO NOT COPY
1,2,3..
2-101
ADDING A WATERMARK TO A COPY (Watermark)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
When making a copy, specific text can be added to the copy as a watermark. The colour, density, angle, and pages (first page only or all pages) can be selected for a watermark. The watermark is printed at the centre of the paper.
Printing "CONFIDENTIAL" on the paper
CONFIDENTIAL
The following 12 selections are available for the stamp text.
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Three levels can be selected for the density of the watermark.
Seven colours can be selected for the watermark colour.
The angle of a watermark can be selected in the range +90 degrees to -90 degrees in increments of 45 degrees.
1
Touch the [Watermark] key in the stamp selection screen.
See steps 1 to 4 of " GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85).
Touch the key of the watermark that you wish to use.
2
Stamp
Watermark
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Cancel
Print Colour
Bk 1 2 3
Angle
(+90 -90)
45
OK
First Page
All Pages
2-102
3
Stamp
Watermark
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Cancel
Print Colour
Bk 1 2 3
Angle
(+90 -90)
45
OK
First Page
All Pages
Touch the [Print Colour] key and set the colour and density.
Touch the colour that you wish to use.
If you wish to darken the selected colour, touch the
If you wish to lighten the selected colour, touch the
key.
key.
When you have finished selecting the settings, touch the [OK] key.
Stamp
Print Colour OK
Bk(Black)
R(Red)
C(Cyan)
G(Green)
M(Magenta)
B(Blue)
Y(Yellow)
1
Exposure
2 3
• If you selected a colour other than [Bk (Black)], press the [COLOUR START] key. Pressing the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key will print the stamp in black and white.
• If the stamp is printed in colour on a black and white copy, the copy will be included in the full colour count.
Touch the the watermark.
keys to set the angle of
4
Stamp
Watermark
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Cancel
Print Colour
Bk 1 2 3
Angle
(+90 -90)
45
OK
First Page
All Pages
5
Stamp
Watermark
CONFIDENTIAL
FOR YOUR INFO.
URGENT
PRELIMINARY
IMPORTANT
TOP SECRET
PRIORITY
DO NOT COPY
DRAFT
FINAL
COPY
PLEASE REPLY
Cancel
Print Colour
Bk 1 2 3
Angle
(+90 -90)
45
OK
First Page
All Pages
Select the pages that the watermark will be printed on and touch the [OK] key.
Select printing on the first page only, or printing on all pages.
After touching the [OK] key, continue from step 5 of "
PROCEDURE FOR USING STAMP " (page 2-85) to complete
the copy procedure.
The watermark text cannot be edited.
To cancel a watermark setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 2.
2-103
[Image Edit] KEY
When the [Image Edit] key is touched in the 2nd special modes menu screen, the image edit menu screen opens.
Image edit menu screen
Special Modes
Stamp
File
Original
Count
Image Edit
Quick File
Mixed Size
Original
Colour
Adjustments
Proof Copy
Slow Scan
Mode
OK
2
2
Special Modes
Image Edit
(1)
Photo Repeat
(2)
Multi-Page
Enlargement
(3)
(4)
A3
Full Bleed
(5)
Centring
(6)
Mirror
Image
B/W
Reverse
OK
OK
(1) [Photo Repeat] key
☞
REPEATING PHOTOS ON A COPY (Photo Repeat)
(2) [Multi-Page Enlargement] key
☞
CREATING A LARGE POSTER (Multi-Page
(3) [Mirror Image] key
☞
REVERSING THE IMAGE (Mirror Image) (page
(4) [A3 Full Bleed] key ([11x17 Full Bleed] key)
☞
COPYING A3 (11" x 17") ORIGINALS WITH NO
EDGE CUT-OFF (A3 (11" x 17") Full Bleed) (page
(5) [Centring] key
☞
COPYING IN THE CENTRE OF THE PAPER
(6) [B/W Reverse] key
☞
REVERSING WHITE AND BLACK IN A COPY (B/W
2-104
REPEATING PHOTOS ON A COPY (Photo Repeat)
Photo Repeat is used to create repeated images of a photo-size original (130 mm x 90 mm size, 100 mm x 150 mm size, 70 mm x 100 mm size, 65 mm x 70 mm size or 57 mm x 100 mm size (3" x 5" size, 5" x 7" size, 2-1/2" x 4" size,
2-1/2" x 2-1/2" size or 2-1/8" x 3-5/8" size)) on a single sheet of copy paper as shown below. Up to 24 images (when the image is 65 mm x 70 mm size (2-1/2" x 2-1/2" size)) can be repeated on a single sheet of paper.
• Original sizes up to 130 mm x 90 mm (3" x 5") • Original sizes up to 100 mm x 150 mm (5" x 7")
Copying on A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size paper
4 copies are made.
Copying on A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size paper
2 copies are made.
Copying on A3
(11" x 17") size paper
8 copies are made.
• Original sizes up to 70 mm x 100 mm (2-1/2" x 4")
Copying on A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size paper
8 copies are made.
Copying on A3
(11" x 17") size paper
16 copies are made.
• Original sizes up to 57 mm x 100 mm
(2-1/8" x 3-5/8")
Copying on A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size paper (Ratio 95%)
10 copies are made.
Copying on A3
(11" x 17") size paper
4 copies are made.
• Original sizes up to 65 mm x 70 mm
(2-1/2" x 2-1/2")
Copying on A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size paper
12 copies are made.
Copying on A3
(11" x 17") size paper
24 copies are made.
1
Place the original face down on the document glass.
• When placing a 130 mm x 90 mm, 100 mm x 150 mm,
70 mm x 100 mm, 65 mm x 70 mm or 57 mm x 100 mm
(3" x 5", 5" x 7", 2-1/2" x 4", 2-1/2" x 2-1/2" or 2-1/8" x 3-5/8") photo size original, place the original with the long side aligned against the left side of the document glass.
• When placing a business card size original, place the original with the long side aligned against the far side of the document glass.
2-105
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Image Edit] key.
(4) Touch the [Photo Repeat] key.
☞
3
Image Edit
Photo Repeat
Original Size
130x 90mm
3x 5"
(1)
Cancel
Repeat Type
A4/8½x11
4
A3/11x17
8
(2)
OK
OK
1
5
Select Photo Repeat settings.
(1) Touch the key showing the original type and paper size combination that you want to use.
Touch the keys to switch through the screens and touch the desired repeat type key (A4 or A3 (8-1/2" x 11" or 11" x 17")).
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
When making repeat copies of a business card size original (up to 57 mm x 100 mm (2-1/8" x 3-5/8")), only A4
(8-1/2" x 11") can be selected for the paper size.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• The original must be placed on the document glass.
• Only A4 (8-1/2" x 11") or A3 (11" x 17") size paper can be used.
• The copy ratio is 100% when this function is used. (The ratio cannot be changed.) However, for a business card size original (up to 57 mm x 100 mm (2-1/8" x 3-5/8")), the images are reduced to 95%.
To cancel the photo repeat setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-106
CREATING A LARGE POSTER (Multi-Page
Enlargement)
This function is used to enlarge an image of an original and print it as a composite image using multiple sheets of paper.
Original
(A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size)
Copy (enlarged image on 8 sheets of A3 (11" x 17") paper)
1
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Image Edit] key.
(4) Touch the [Multi-Page Enlargement] key.
☞
2-107
2
(B)
Ready to scan for copy. Copies will be delivered in 2 parts.
Image Edit
Multi-Page Enlargement Border Print
Enlargement Size
(A Size)
A2
A1
A0
A0x2
Original Size
A5
A4
A3
Cancel
Original Orientation
OK
OK
1
3
(2) (3) (A) (1)
Set the enlargement size and the original size.
(1) Select the size system that you wish to use for multi-page enlargement.
Touch the keys to display the screen that shows the desired group of sizes.
• 1st screen: A system
• 2nd screen: B system
• 3rd screen: Inch system
(2) Select the enlargement size.
(3) Select the size of the original to be used.
A suitable original placement orientation (A) and the number of sheets of paper required for the enlarged image (B) are displayed based on the selected original size and enlargement size.
Check the placement orientation and number of sheets.
The combinations of original sizes and enlargement sizes shown in the table at left are possible for multi-page enlargement.
Enlargement size Original size
A2 A3, A4, A5
A1 A3, A4, A5
A0 A3, A4
A0 x 2* A3
B3 B4, B5
B2 B4, B5
B1 B4, B5
B0 B4
22" x 17" 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11"
22" x 34" 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11"
34" x 44" 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11"
44" x 68" 11" x 17"
* The size that is twice A0 size.
• An A size original cannot be enlarged to a B size, and a B size original cannot be enlarged to an A size.
• To print a borderline around the copy image, touch the [Border Print] key so that it is highlighted.
Place the original face down on the document glass in the orientation indicated in the screen.
3
2-108
4
Image Edit
Multi-Page Enlargement
Enlargement Size
(A Size)
A2
A1
A0
A0x2
Border Print Cancel
OK
OK
Original Size
A5
A4
A3
Original Orientation
1
3
Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the [OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• The original must be placed on the document glass.
• Overlap of sections of image
- There will be a margin around the edges of each copy.
- Areas for overlapping the copies will be created at the leading and trailing edges of each copy.
• If an original size is selected first, a message will appear indicating the enlargement sizes that can be selected. If an enlargement size is selected first, a message will appear indicating the original sizes that can be selected.
• If a combination of settings is selected for which multi-page enlargement is not possible, invalid selection beeps will sound.
• The paper size, number of sheets required for the enlarged image, and the ratio are automatically selected based on the selected original size and enlargement size.
(The paper size and ratio cannot be selected manually.)
• If no paper trays have the size of paper that was automatically selected, "Load XXX paper" will appear. Change the paper in one of the trays or the bypass tray to the indicated size of paper.
• To cancel the multi-page enlargement setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 2.
Although the multi-page enlargement setting is cancelled, the ratio selected automatically is kept valid.
• To return the ratio to 100%...
To return the ratio setting to 100%, touch the [Copy Ratio] key to display the ratio menu and then touch the [100%] key.
2-109
REVERSING THE IMAGE (Mirror Image)
This feature is used to make a copy that is a mirror image of the original.
Original Mirror image copy
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Image Edit] key.
☞
3
Special Modes
Image Edit
Photo Repeat
A3
Full Bleed
Multi-Page
Enlargement
Centring
(1) (2)
Mirror
Image
B/W
Reverse
OK
OK
Select Mirror Image.
(1) Touch the [Mirror Image] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the
[Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel a mirror image setting...
Touch the [Mirror Image] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
2-110
COPYING A3 (11" x 17") ORIGINALS WITH NO EDGE
CUT-OFF (A3 (11" x 17") Full Bleed)
This feature lets you copy an entire A3 (11" x 17") size original at full size with no image cut-off at the edges.
A3W (12" x 18") size paper is used, which is slightly larger than A3 (11" x 17") size.
A3 (11" x 17") size original A3 (12" x 18") full bleed copy
Place the original face down on the document glass.
1
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Image Edit] key.
☞
3
(1)
Special Modes
Image Edit
Photo Repeat
A3
Full Bleed
Multi-Page
Enlargement
Centring
Mirror
Image
B/W
Reverse
(2)
OK
OK
Select A3 (11x17) Full Bleed.
(1) Touch the [A3 Full Bleed] or [11x17 Full
Bleed] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
2-111
4
Place A3W (12" x 18") paper in the bypass tray.
Pull out the extension tray, adjust the guides to the width of
A3W (12" x 18") paper, and place the paper in the bypass tray.
After loading the paper, configure the bypass tray settings as explained in "
MAKING COPIES USING THE BYPASS TRAY
"
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.)
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• The original must be placed on the document glass.
• The copy ratio is 100% when this function is used. The ratio cannot be changed.
• The staple and punch function cannot be used.
To cancel A3 (11x17) Full Bleed...
Touch the [A3 Full Bleed] or [11x17 Full Bleed] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
2-112
COPYING IN THE CENTRE OF THE PAPER (Centring)
This is used to centre the copied image on the paper.
This lets you place the image in the centre of the paper when the original size is smaller than the paper size or when the image is reduced.
Not using the centring function Using the centring function
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Image Edit] key.
☞
3
Special Modes
Image Edit
Photo Repeat
A3
Full Bleed
Multi-Page
Enlargement
Centring
(1)
Mirror
Image
B/W
Reverse
(2)
OK
OK
Select Centring.
(1) Touch the [Centring] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-113
• The image can be reduced when using the centring function, but not enlarged.
• When the original size or the paper size is displayed as a special size, this function cannot be used.
To cancel centring...
Touch the [Centring] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
2-114
REVERSING WHITE AND BLACK IN A COPY (B/W Reverse)
This is used to reverse black and white in a copy to create a negative image. This function can only be used for black and white copying.
Originals with large black areas (which use a large amount of toner) can be copied using Black/White Reverse to reduce toner consumption.
Originals B/W Reverse copy
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Image Edit] key.
☞
3
Special Modes
Image Edit
Photo Repeat
A3
Full Bleed
Multi-Page
Enlargement
Centring
(1)
Mirror
Image
B/W
Reverse
(2)
OK
OK
Select B/W Reverse.
(1) Touch the [B/W Reverse] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
When using this function, the [COLOUR START] key cannot be used.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-115
• When this function is selected, the "Original Image Type" setting for exposure adjustment automatically changes to "Text".
• This function is not available in some countries and regions.
To cancel B/W reverse...
Touch the [B/W Reverse] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
2-116
[Colour Adjustments] KEY
When the [Colour Adjustments] key is touched in the 2nd special modes menu screen, the colour adjustments menu screen opens.
Colour adjustments menu screen
Special Modes OK OK
OK
Stamp
File
Original
Count
Image Edit
Quick File
Mixed Size
Original
Colour
Adjustments
Proof Copy
Slow Scan
Mode
2
2
Special Modes
Colour Adjustments
(1)
RGB Adjust
(2)
Sharpness
(4)
Colour Balance
(5)
Brightness
(3)
Suppress
Background
(6)
Intensity
(1) [RGB Adjust] key
☞
ADJUSTING RED/GREEN/BLUE IN COPIES (RGB
(2) [Sharpness] key
☞
ADJUSTING THE SHARPNESS OF AN IMAGE
(3) [Suppress background] key
☞
WHITENING FAINT COLOURS IN COPIES
(Suppress Background) (page 2-120)
(4) [Colour Balance] key
☞
ADJUSTING THE COLOUR (Colour Balance)
(page
(5) [Brightness] key
☞
ADJUSTING THE BRIGHTNESS OF A COPY
(6) [Intensity] key
☞
ADJUSTING THE INTENSITY OF A COPY
When any of the functions on the colour adjustments menu is selected, the "Original Image Type" setting for exposure adjustment automatically changes to "Text/Prtd.Photo".
2-117
ADJUSTING RED/GREEN/BLUE IN COPIES (RGB Adjust)
This feature is used to strengthen or weaken any one of the three colour components R (red), G (green), or B (blue).
R(Red)+
G(Green)+
B(Blue)+
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Colour Adjustments] key.
(4) Touch the [RGB Adjust] key.
☞
[Colour Adjustments] KEY (page 2-117)
3
(2) (1)
Colour Adjustments
RGB Adjust
Only one colour can be adjusted.
R(Red) G(Green)
-2 -1 0 1 2
Cancel
B(Blue)
(3)
OK
OK
Adjust red, green, or blue.
(1) Touch the key of the colour that you wish to adjust: [R (Red)], [G (Green)], or [B (Blue)].
Only one colour can be adjusted. (If you adjust one colour and then adjust another colour, the adjustment of the first colour is cancelled.)
(2) Adjust the selected colour.
Touch the [+] key to strengthen the selected colour, or touch the [-] key to weaken the colour.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [COLOUR START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel an RGB adjust setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-118
ADJUSTING THE SHARPNESS OF AN IMAGE (Sharpness)
This is used to sharpen an image or make it softer.
Soft
Sharp
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Colour Adjustments] key.
(4) Touch the [Sharpness] key.
☞
[Colour Adjustments] KEY (page 2-117)
3
Colour Adjustments
Sharpness
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
OK
Adjust the image.
(1) Touch the [Soft] key or the [Sharp] key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
Soft Sharp
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [COLOUR START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel the sharpness setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-119
WHITENING FAINT COLOURS IN COPIES (Suppress
Background)
This feature is used to suppress light background areas.
Level [+]
The lightness level at which suppression takes place can be adjusted.
Light areas are suppressed.
Level [-]
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Colour Adjustments] key.
(4) Touch the [Suppress Background] key.
☞
[Colour Adjustments] KEY (page 2-117)
3
Colour Adjustments
Suppress Background
Cancel
Light areas of the original may be suppressed as background.
OK
OK
1 3
Select the suppress background setting.
(1) Adjust the background suppression level.
Touch the [+] key to suppress only faint background.
Touch the [-] key to suppress faint to dark background.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
(1) (2)
2-120
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [COLOUR START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel a suppress background setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-121
ADJUSTING THE COLOUR (Colour Balance)
The colour, tone, and density of colour copies can be adjusted.
Light Dark
Each of the colours yellow, cyan, magenta, and black are divided into 8 gradations from light to dark, and the average density of each gradation can be adjusted, or all eight gradations can be adjusted at once.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Colour Adjustments
Colour Balance
Y
M
C
Bk
Cancel
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 All
OK
OK C Cyan+
Y Yellow+
M Magenta+
B Black+
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Colour Adjustments] key.
(4) Touch the [Colour Balance] key.
☞
[Colour Adjustments] KEY (page 2-117)
2-122
3
Colour Adjustments
Colour Balance
Y
M
C
Bk
(1) (2), (3)
Cancel
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 All
(5)
OK
OK
Examples of colour balance adjustment
The settings of all gradations are moved toward +
The settings of all gradations are moved toward -
Adjust the colour balance.
(1) Select the colour to be adjusted.
Select [Y] (yellow), [M] (magenta), [C] (cyan), or [Bk] (black).
If only the rectangular area around the letter in a key is highlighted, the settings have been changed from the factory default settings.
(2) Select the gradation to be adjusted.
Select the gradation with the keys.
Touch the keys to move the highlighting to one of gradations "1" to "8" or "All".
To adjust all eight gradations at once, move the highlighting to "All".
(3) Adjust the density.
To darken the density of the selected gradation, touch the
[+] key. To lighten the density, touch the [-] key. Each time one of the keys is touched, the indicator frame moves up or down one level.
(4) To adjust other colours, repeat steps (1) to
(3).
(5) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
To return the colour balance values to the default settings...
Touch the key. The values of all eight gradations will return to the default colour balance values.
The default colour balance values are set in "Initial Colour Balance Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [COLOUR START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel a colour balance setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Colour Balance Setting
This is used to set the default values to which the colour balance values return when the key is pressed.
2-123
ADJUSTING THE BRIGHTNESS OF A COPY (Brightness)
The brightness of colour images can be adjusted.
Darker Original Brighter
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Colour Adjustments] key.
(4) Touch the [Brightness] key.
☞
[Colour Adjustments] KEY (page 2-117)
3
Colour Adjustments
Brightness
-2
(1)
0 2
Cancel
(2)
OK
OK
Adjust the brightness.
(1) Adjust the brightness.
Touch the [+] key to make the image brighter, or the [-] key to make the image darker.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [COLOUR START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel a brightness setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-124
ADJUSTING THE INTENSITY OF A COPY (Intensity)
This is used to adjust the intensity (saturation) of colour images.
Weakening the intensity
Original Strengthening the intensity
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Colour Adjustments] key.
(4) Touch the [Intensity] key.
☞
[Colour Adjustments] KEY (page 2-117)
3
Colour Adjustments
Intensity
-2
(1)
0 2
Cancel
(2)
OK
OK
Adjust the intensity.
(1) Adjust the intensity setting.
Touch the [+] key to strengthen the intensity, or the [-] key to weaken the intensity.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the special modes screen. Touch the
[OK] key to return to the base screen of copy mode.
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key.
Copying will begin.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple original pages, copying will take place as you scan each original. If you have selected sort mode, change originals and press the [COLOUR START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
This function cannot be used in combination with "Colour Tone Enhancement" in the copy exposure settings.
To cancel an intensity setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
2-125
CHECKING COPIES BEFORE PRINTING
(Proof Copy)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
This feature prints only one set of copies, regardless of how many sets have been specified. After the first set is checked for errors, the remaining sets can be printed. Previously it was necessary to re-scan the original each time changes to settings were required. However, this feature makes it possible to change settings for the scanned original without scanning it again, allowing you perform copying more efficiently.
"Proof Copy" is selected and 5 sets of copies are executed
1 set of copies is printed for you to check
The remaining 4 sets are printed
If OK
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
Adjust the settings A
A
After adjustments are made, 1 set is printed for you to check
If OK
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
The remaining 4 sets are printed
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select copy settings in the base screen.
3
Special Modes
Stamp
File
Original
Count
Image Edit
Quick File
Mixed Size
Original
(3)
Colour
Adjustments
Proof Copy
Slow Scan
Mode
(2) (4)
OK
2
2
Select Proof Copy.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the screens.
keys to switch through the
(3) Touch the [Proof Copy] key so that it is highlighted.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
2-126
4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
7
Set the number of copies (number of sets) with the numeric keys.
If you will copy multiple originals using the document glass, switch to sort mode after this step.
☞
Plain
A4
Up to 999 copies (sets) can be set.
If an incorrect number of copies is set...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) and then enter the correct number.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
One set of copies is printed.
If you are using the document glass to copy multiple originals, change originals and press the [START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key. One set of copies will be printed. (For the second original and following originals, use the same [START] key as you did for the first original.
To cancel copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
6
Press [End] to continue.
To make a proof copy again, press
[Start].
Change End
Check the printed set of copies. If the copies are acceptable, touch the [End] key. If you need to change the settings, touch the [Change] key.
When the [End] key is touched, the remaining sets are printed.
If you touched the [Change] key, go to the next step.
To cancel copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-127
Proof Copy
(1) (2)
OK
Change the settings.
(1) Touch the key of the setting that you want to change.
The setting screen of the touched key opens. Change the settings and touch the [OK] key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
Colour Mode
Output
Paper Select
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
7
• To change the number of sets printed, set the desired number of copies (sets) with the numeric keys. After changing the number of sets, touch the [End] key in the touch panel (not the [START] key) to print the sets.
• Special modes that can be adjusted are Margin Shift, Pamphlet Copy, Tandem Copy, Covers/Inserts, Transparency
Inserts, Multi-Shot, and Stamp.
• For Pamphlet Copy, Covers/Inserts, and Multi Shot, only changes to the settings of the functions can be made; the functions cannot be newly added or deleted.
• When transparency film is used, the settings can be changed, new settings can be added, and the function can be cancelled. However, this is not possible when pamphlet copying is enabled.
8
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
One set of copies is printed again using the adjusted settings. Check the results. If further adjustments are needed, repeat steps 6 through 8. (Repeating Proof Copy does not decrease the remaining number of sets to be printed.)
Press [End] to continue.
To make a proof copy again, press
[Start].
Change End
Touch the [End] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode and the remaining sets will be printed.
9
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
If Proof Copy is executed while the machine is printing another job, the other job is interrupted and the proof copies are printed. The previous job will resume after the proof copies are printed.
However, if proof copy is executed during output of a job for which both two-sided printing and stapling are enabled, the proof copy will be output after the job in progress is finished.
If the [End] key is touched to execute printing of the remaining sets while the machine is printing another job, the remaining sets will be printed after all previously reserved jobs are completed.
2-128
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
ORIGINAL SHEETS BEFORE COPYING
(Original Count)
The number of scanned original sheets can be counted and displayed before copying is executed. By allowing you to check the number of original sheets that were scanned, this helps reduce the occurrence of copy mistakes.
1
Indicator line
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
2
(3)
Special Modes
Stamp
File
Original
Count
Image Edit
Quick File
Mixed Size
Original
Colour
Adjustments
Proof Copy
Slow Scan
Mode
(2) (4)
OK
2
2
Select Original Count.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the screens.
keys to switch through the
(3) Touch the [Original Count] key so that it is highlighted.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
3
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-129
4
130 pages of original have been scanned.
Copy the scanned data?
Cancel OK
After scanning is finished, check the number of sheets that were scanned and touch the [OK] key.
Copying will begin.
• When job build mode is used, the number of scanned sheets appears when the [Read-End] key is touched.
• The number that is displayed is the number of scanned original sheets, not the number of scanned original pages.
For example, when two-sided copying is performed using one original, the number "1" will appear to indicate that one original sheet was scanned, not "2" to indicate the front-side page and the reverse side page.
If the displayed number of original sheets is different from the actual number of original sheets...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
To cancel the original count mode setting...
Touch the [Original Count] key in the screen of step 2 so that it is not highlighted.
2-130
COPYING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT SIZES
(Mixed Size Original)
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
Even when B4 (8-1/2" x 14") originals are mixed in with A3 (11" x 17") originals, all originals can be copied at once. When scanning the originals, the machine automatically detects the size of each original and uses paper appropriate for that size.
When mixed size original is combined with auto ratio selection, the ratio is adjusted individually for each original according to the selected paper size, enabling output on a uniform paper size.
Copies Originals
B4
A3
When mixed size original is combined with auto ratio selection
(Auto ratio selection and A3 (11" x 17") are selected)
Originals
B4
A3
Copies
B4
A3
A3
A3
A B4 (8-1/2" x 14") size original will be enlarged to A3 (11" x 17") size.
There are two settings for mixed size originals.
Same Width
Different Width
Use this setting for originals that are different sizes but have sides that are the same length. The originals are inserted in the document feeder tray with the sides that are the same length aligned together on the left.
• A3 and A4 • B4 and B5 • A4R and A5
• 11" x 17" and 8-1/2" x 11" • 8-1/2" x 14" and 8-1/2" x 11"R • 8-1/2" x 14" and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
• 8-1/2" x 13" and 8-1/2" x 11"R • 8-1/2" x 13" and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2" • 8-1/2" x 11"R and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
Use this setting when the originals are different sizes and do not have sides that are the same length. This setting can only be used for the following combinations of sizes:
• A3 and B4 • A3 and B5 • B4 and A4 • A4 and B5 • B4 and A4R • B4 and A5
• B5 and A4R • B5 and A5
• 11" x 17" and 8-1/2" x 14" • 11" x 17" and 8-1/2" x 13" • 11" x 17" and 5-1/2 x 8-1/2"
2-131
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
●
When "Same Width" is used
Place the originals with the sides that are the same length aligned on the left.
A3 (11" x 17")
1
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
Place with the sides that are the same length aligned on the left.
B4
(8-1/2" x 14")
Place the originals aligned to the far left corner.
B4
(8-1/2" x 14")
A3 (11" x 17")
●
When "Different Width" is used
Place the originals with the corners aligned in the far left corner of the document feeder tray.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Mixed Size Original] key.
☞
Special modes menu (2nd screen) (page 2-42)
3
(1)
Special Modes
Mixed Size Original
Same Width
Different
Width
Cancel
Place the same width originals.
(2)
OK
OK
Select Mixed Size Original settings.
(1) Touch the [Same Width] key or the
[Different Width] key as appropriate for the originals.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
2-132
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• When [Different Width] is selected, automatic two-sided copying cannot be used.
• When [Different Width] is selected, the staple function cannot be used.
• The mixed size original function cannot be used to copy originals that are the same size but are placed in different orientations (A4 and A4R (8-1/2" x 11" and 8-1/2" x 11"R), etc.).
To cancel the mixed size original setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
System Settings (Administrator): Original Feeding Mode
The original feeding mode can be set to always scan mixed size originals.
2-133
COPYING THIN ORIGINALS (Slow Scan
Mode)
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
Use this function when you wish to scan thin originals using the automatic document feeder. This function helps prevent thin originals from misfeeding.
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
1
Indicator line
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
If the originals are inserted with too much force, they may crumple and misfeed.
2
Special Modes
Stamp
File
Original
Count
Image Edit
Quick File
Mixed Size
Original
(3)
Colour
Adjustments
Proof Copy
Slow Scan
Mode
(2) (4)
OK
2
2
Select Slow Scan Mode.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the screens.
keys to switch through the
(3) Touch the [Slow Scan Mode] key so that it is highlighted.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode.
3
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Copying will begin.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-134
The "2-Sided to 2-Sided" and "2-Sided to 1-Sided" modes of automatic 2-sided copying cannot be used.
To cancel the slow scan mode setting...
Touch the [Slow Scan Mode] key in the screen of step 2 so that it is not highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Original Feeding Mode
This is used to have scanning always take place in slow scan mode.
2-135
CONVENIENT COPY FUNCTIONS
This section explains convenient copy functions such as interrupting a copy run, changing the order of reserved copy jobs, and storing copy settings in a program.
INTERRUPTING A COPY RUN
(Interrupt copy)
When you need to make an urgent copy and the machine is busy with a long copy run or other job, use interrupt copy.
Interrupt copy temporarily stops the job in progress and lets you perform the interrupt copy job first.
1
Copies in progress from tray 1 .
Ready to scan for next copy job.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Interrupt
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
7
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
Touch the [Interrupt] key.
The [Interrupt] key does not appear while an original is being scanned.
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
3
Select copy settings and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key.
The interrupt copy job begins.
4
When the interrupt copy job is completed, the interrupted job resumes.
To cancel scanning and copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-136
• If user authentication is enabled, the login screen will appear when the [Interrupt] key is pressed. Enter your user name and password to log in. The number of copies made will be added to the count of the user that logged in.
• Depending on the settings of the job in progress, the [Interrupt] key may not appear.
• Depending on the settings of the job in progress, the [Reserve] key may appear instead of the [Interrupt] key. Unlike interrupt copy, reserve copy does not temporarily stop the job in progress. Instead, the reserve copy job begins when the job in progress is finished.
• Interrupt copy cannot be used in combination with the following special modes:
Job Build, Tandem Copy, Book Copy, Card Shot, Multi-Page Enlargement, Original Count
• If the document glass is used for an interrupt copy job, 2-sided copying, sort copying, and staple sort copying cannot be selected. If any of these functions are necessary, use the automatic document feeder.
2-137
CHECKING A PREVIEW IMAGE OF A COPY
(Preview)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
You can touch the [Preview] key so that it is highlighted in the base screen and then scan the original to check a preview image of the copy in the touch panel before printing the copy.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
Touch the [Preview] key so that it is highlighted.
2
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Plain
A4
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Preview
3
Select copy settings and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key.
After the original is scanned, a preview image of the copy appears in the touch panel. The copy is not printed until the [Start
Copy] key is touched in the preview screen.
Colour
Reset
Display Output
Function Rev.
Check the preview image and then touch the [Start Copy] key.
Copy printing begins.
For details on the preview screen, see "
"
Display Rotation
Start Copy
4
Preview
0001 /0010
If you need to change the copy settings, touch the [Reset] key.
To cancel copying...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
2-138
To cancel the operation...
Press the [CLEAR ALL] key ( ).
System Settings (Administrator): Default Preview
You can set the default state of the [Preview] key to always selected (highlighted). Enable this setting if you wish to check a preview image each time you make a copy.
2-139
PREVIEW SCREEN
The preview screen is explained below.
Preview
(1)
Colour
Reset
Display Output
Function Rev.
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Display Rotation
Start Copy
(7)
(8)
0001 /0010
(2)
(1) Preview image
An image of the selected received image appears.
If the image is cut off, use the scroll bars at the right and bottom of the screen to scroll the image. Touch a bar and slide it to scroll. (You can also touch the keys to scroll.)
(2) Change page keys
When there are multiple pages of images, use these keys to change pages.
•
•
keys: Go to the first or the last page.
keys: Go to the previous page or the next page.
• Page number display: This shows the total number of pages and the current page number. You can touch the current page number key and enter a number with the numeric keys to go to that page number.
(3) [Reset] key
Touch to change the copy settings after checking the preview image. After changing the settings, touch the
[Preview Again] key to update the preview image with the new settings.
Preview/Reset Cancel Preview Again
(4) [Display Output] key
Touch to show the selected modes and settings as icons.
Functions that are displayed are as follows:
• 2-sided copying
• Book copy
• Pamphlet copy
• Staple function
• Punch function
• Covers/Inserts
• Stamp menu
• Transparency inserts
This key can only be touched when the entire preview image is displayed in the preview screen.
(5) [Function Rev.] key
Touch to check special mode items, 2-sided copying, and output settings.
(6) Display zoom key
Use this to set the zoom ratio of the displayed image.
Changes from the left in the order "Full Page", "Twice", "4
Times", "8 Times". The setting applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(7) "Display Rotation" key
This rotates the image right or left by 90 degrees. The rotation applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(8) [Start Copy] key
Touch to start printing the copy.
Colour Mode 2-Sided Copy Output
• A preview image is an image for display on the touch panel. It will differ from the actual print result.
• The preview image reflects certain copy settings and special mode settings. Settings that are reflected in the preview image are as follows:
Copy settings: colour mode, ratio, paper size
Special modes: margin shift, edge erase, dual page copy, pamphlet copy, covers/inserts, transparency film, 2 in 1/4 in 1, book copy, card shot, image edit menu, colour adjustment (excluding sharpness and colour balance)
• Fine lines (such as borderlines printed by the 2in1/4in1 function) may not appear correctly at some zoom ratios.
2-140
JOB STATUS SCREEN
The job status screen is displayed when the [JOB STATUS] key on the operation panel is pressed. The job status screen shows the status of jobs by mode. When the [JOB STATUS] key is pressed, the job status screen of the mode that was being used before the key was pressed appears.
Example: Pressing the key in copy mode
JOB STATUS
1
2
3
4
Print Job
Job Queue
Copy
Copy
Computer01
0312345678
Scan to Fax Job
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
002 / 000
002 / 000
001 / 000
Status
Copying
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Internet Fax
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
When the hard disk drive is not installed, [Spool] is not displayed.
The job status display (A) is in the lower left corner of the touch panel. The job status display can be touched to display the job status screen. The first four jobs in the print queue (the job in progress and reserved jobs) can be checked in the job status display (B).
Ready to scan for copy.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
0 Job Status
MFP Status
020/001
Copying
002/000
Waiting
002/000
Waiting
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
001/000
Waiting
Tray1
(A) (B)
2-141
JOB QUEUE SCREEN AND COMPLETED JOB SCREEN
The job status screen consists of the job queue screen that shows copy and print jobs waiting to be printed and the job currently in progress, the completed job screen that shows jobs that have been completed, and the spool screen that shows print jobs that have been spooled and encrypted PDF jobs that are waiting for a password to be entered. This section explains the job queue screen and the completed jobs screen, which are related to copy mode. The job status screen switches between the job queue screen and the completed jobs screen each time the job status screen selector key is touched.
(1)
(2)
1
2
3
4
Print Job
Job Queue
Copy
Copy
Computer01
0312345678
Scan to Fax Job
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
Status
Copying
Internet Fax
002 / 000
002 / 000
001 / 000
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
6
7
4
5
8
1
2
3
Print Job
Jobs Completed
Computer02
Scan to
Set Time
Fax Job
Sets Status
11:00 04/01 001/001 OK
Internet Fax
Computer03
Computer04
10:33 04/01 010/010 OK
10:31 04/01 013/013 OK
1
2 file-01
Copy
Copy
Computer05
Copy
10:30 04/01 010/010 OK
10:13 04/01 001/001 OK
10:03 04/01 001/001 OK
10:01 04/01 003/003 OK
10:00 04/01 010/010 OK
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Call
(7)
(8)
(9)
(1) Mode select tabs
Use these tabs to select the mode that is shown in the job status screen.
The status of copy jobs can be checked by touching the
[Print Job] tab.
(2) Job list (job queue screen)
Jobs waiting to be printed appear in the job queue as keys. The jobs are printed in order from the top of the queue. Each job key shows information on the job and the current status of the job.
(3) Job status screen selector key
Touch this key to switch through the job queue screen, the completed jobs screen, and the spool screen.
When the hard disk drive is not installed, [Spool] is not displayed.
(4) [Detail] key (job queue screen)
Touch this key to display detailed information on a job.
(5) [Priority] key
Touch this key to give priority to a selected job.
(6) [Stop/Delete] key
Touch this key to stop or delete a selected job.
(7) Job list (completed jobs screen)
This shows up to 99 completed jobs. The result (status) of each completed job is shown. Copy jobs that used the document filing function are indicated as keys.
(8) [Detail] key (completed jobs screen)
When a job is shown as a key in the job list, the [Detail] key can be touched to show detailed information on the job.
(9) [Call] key
Touch this key to retrieve and use a copy job stored using the document filing function.
When the hard disk drive is not installed, this key is not displayed.
2-142
Job key display
Each job key shows the position of the job in the job queue and the current status of the job.
2 Copy 002/000 Waiting
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Indicates the number (position) of the job in the job queue.
When the job currently being printed is finished, the job moves up one position in the job queue.
This number does not appear in keys in the completed jobs screen.
(2) Mode icon
The icon appears when the job is a copy job. In the completed jobs screen, a colour bar appears next to the icon to indicate whether the job was executed in colour or black & white. (However, the colour bar icon does not appear in the key of a job that used document filing or in the key of a transmission/reception job that was cancelled.)
(3) Job name
"Copy" appears for a copy job.
When user authentication is enabled, the name of the user that performed the job appears.
(4) Number of copies (sets) entered
This shows the number of copies (sets) specified.
(5) Number of completed copies
This shows the number of copies (sets) completed. "000" appears while the job is waiting in the job queue.
(4) (5) (6)
(6) Status
Shows the job status.
Message
"Copying"
"Waiting"
"Toner
Empty"
"Paper
Empty"
"Limit"
"Error"
Status
Copying is in progress.
The job is waiting to be executed.
The toner cartridge is out of toner.
Replace the toner cartridge with a new cartridge.
The paper used for the job has run out. Add paper or change to a different paper tray.
The copy page limit has been exceeded. Check with the administrator of the machine.
An error occurred while the job was being executed. Clear the error condition.
2-143
CANCELLING A JOB THAT IS WAITING IN THE QUEUE
A copy job that is waiting to be printed can be cancelled.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
(1) (2)
1
2
3
4
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Copy
Computer02
0312345678
Scan to Fax Job
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
Internet Fax
Status
Printing
002 / 000
002 / 000
001 / 000
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(3) (4)
Cancel the job.
(1) Touch the [Print Job] tab.
(2) Change the print job status mode to [Job
Queue].
Touch this key to change modes. The selected mode will be highlighted.
(3) Touch the key of the copy job that you wish to cancel.
(4) Touch the [Stop/Delete] key.
(5) A message appears to confirm the cancellation. Touch the [Yes] key.
Delete the job?
Copy
No Yes
The selected job key is deleted and printing is cancelled.
If the job in progress is a copy job, you can also press the [STOP] key ( ) to display the above screen.
To cancel, touch the [Yes] key.
If you do not want to cancel the selected print job...
Touch the [No] key in step (5).
2-144
GIVING PRIORITY TO A JOB IN THE QUEUE
If a copy job is begun when there are already multiple jobs in the queue, the copy job will appear at the end of the queue.
However, if you have an urgent copy job, you can give priority to the job and have it executed first.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
(1) (2)
1
2
3
4
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Copy
Computer02
0312345678
Scan to
002 / 000
001 / 000
Fax Job
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
002 / 000
Internet Fax
Status
Printing
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(3) (4)
Give the desired job priority.
(1) Touch the [Print Job] tab.
(2) Change the print job status mode to [Job
Queue].
Touch this key to change modes. The selected mode will be highlighted.
(3) Touch the key of the copy job to which you want to give priority.
(4) Touch the [Priority] key.
The job being printed stops and the job selected in (3) is printed.
2-145
CHECKING INFORMATION ON A COPY JOB WAITING
IN THE QUEUE
Detailed information can be displayed on a copy job waiting in the queue.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
(1) (2)
1
2
3
4
Print Job
Job Queue
Copy
Copy
Computer01
0312345678
Scan to
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
Fax Job
Status
Copying
Internet Fax
002 / 000
002 / 000
001 / 000
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(3) (4)
Checking job details
(1) Touch the [Print Job] tab.
(2) Change the print job status mode to [Job
Queue].
Touch this key to change modes. The selected mode will be highlighted.
(3) Touch the key of the job that you wish to check.
(4) Touch the [Detail] key.
The job check screen of the job selected in (3) appears.
OK Detail
Copy
Colour / B/W: Full Colour
002 / 000
Exposure: 1 3 5
Paper:
A4
Plain
Copy Ratio:
Paper Select
X100% Y100%
Waiting
2-Sided
Copy:
Output:
Special
Modes:
[Paper Select] key
If a copy job is stopped because the paper ran out, the [Paper Select] key can be pressed to change to a different paper tray.
When the [Paper Select] key is pressed, the paper tray selection screen appears.
☞
Touch the key of the tray that has the size of paper that you wish to use and then touch the [OK] key. The stopped copy job will resume.
2-146
STORING COPY OPERATIONS (Job Programs)
A job program is a group of copy settings stored together. When copy settings are stored in a job program, the settings can be retrieved and used for a copy job by means of a simple operation.
For example, suppose A3 (11" x 17") size CAD drawings are copied once a month for archive purposes using the following settings:
A3 (11" x 17") size CAD drawings
Copies
(1) The A3 (11" x 17") size CAD drawings are reduced to A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size.
(2) The drawings have fine lines that do not show clearly, and thus a dark exposure setting (level 4) is used.
(3) To reduce paper use by half, 2-sided copying is used.
(4) Margin shift is used so that holes can be punched for filing.
When a job program is not stored
Set A3 (11" x 17") to A4 (8-1/2" x 11") reduction
When a job program is stored
Press the [#/P] key ( ).
Change the exposure setting
Select 2-sided copying
Select margin shift
Select punch hole settings
Job Programs
Press program number.
1
4
7
10
2
5
8
11
3
6
9
12
Recall Store/Delete
Touch the stored program key.
Exit
1
4
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Considerable time is required to copy the drawings each month because the above settings must be selected.
In addition, mistakes are occasionally made when selecting the settings, so some copies must be redone.
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
The settings are stored in a job program, so they can be selected by the touch of a key. This is simple and takes no time.
In addition, the settings are all stored so there are no chances for mistakes, and thus no need to redo copies due to setting mistakes.
• Up to 48 job programs can be stored. The job programs are retained even if an interruption occurs in the power supply.
• Job programs can also be stored in the Web pages. Click [Job program] and then [Copy] in the Web page menu to store a job program.
2-147
STORING (EDITING/DELETING) A JOB PROGRAM
The procedures for storing copy settings in a job program and deleting a job program are explained below.
Press the [#/P] key ( ).
1
LOGOUT
Touch the [Store/Delete] tab.
2
Job Programs
Press program number.
1
4
7
10
Recall
2
5
8
11
3
6
9
12
Store/Delete
Exit
1
4
3
Job Programs
Press program number.
1
4
7
10
Recall
2
5
8
11
3
6
9
12
Store/Delete
Exit
1
4
Touch a numeric key.
Numeric keys in which job programs are already stored are highlighted.
• To store a job program, touch a numeric key that is not highlighted.
• To edit or delete a job program, touch the key in which the job program is stored (highlighted key).
Editing or deleting a job program...
When a highlighted numeric key is touched, the following screen appears.
The [Store] key can be touched to delete the stored settings and store new settings. Go to the next step.
When the [Delete] key is touched, the stored settings are deleted. After the deletion is finished, touch the [Exit] key to return to the base screen.
A job program has been already stored in this location.
Cancel Delete Store
When "Disabling Deletion of Job Programs" is enabled in the system settings, a stored job program cannot be edited or deleted.
2-148
4
To store, make selections and press
[OK], to delete, press [Cancel].
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Cancel
Plain
A4
OK
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
Program Name
Preview
The number of copies cannot be stored.
Select the copy settings that you wish to store in the job program and touch the
[OK] key.
To assign a name to the program, touch the [Program Name] key. A text entry screen will appear.
Up to 10 characters can be entered for the name.
When you have finished, touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen with the stored information reflected in the screen.
2-149
APPENDIX
Examples of covers and inserts
The relations between the originals and finished copies when covers or inserts are inserted are shown on the following pages.
Covers
• 1-sided copying of 1-sided originals
• 1-sided copying of 2-sided originals
• 2-sided copying of 1-sided originals
• 2-sided copying of 2-sided originals
Inserts
• 1-sided copying of 1-sided originals
• 1-sided copying of 2-sided originals
• 2-sided copying of 1-sided originals
• 2-sided copying of 2-sided originals
Symbols used for covers and inserts
The following symbols are used to make the explanations easier to understand.
The numbers that appear indicate what original a copy corresponds to, and will vary depending on the settings.
Symbol Meaning
Icon appearing in display
Symbol Meaning
Icon appearing in display
Front cover when not copied on.
Insert when not copied on.
1
1
1
5
Front cover when one side is copied on.
Front cover when a 2-sided original is copied on one side of the cover. (One page is not copied.)
Front cover when both sides are copied on.
Back cover when not copied on.
Back cover when a 1-sided original is copied on one side of the back cover.
Back cover when a 2-sided original is copied on one side of the back cover.
(One page is not copied.)
Back cover when both sides are copied on.
3
3
3
1
1
6
5
Insert when one side is copied on.
Insert when a 2-sided original is copied on one side of the insert. (One page is not copied.)
Insert when both sides are copied on.
1-sided original or output page of regular 1-sided copying.
2-sided original or output page of regular 2-sided copying.
1-sided original or output page of regular 1-sided copying.
Output page of 2-sided copying when only 1 side is copied on due to lack of originals.
2-150
Covers (1-sided copying of 1-sided originals)
1-sided copies are made of the following 1-sided originals.
1st page 2nd page 3rd page 4th page 5th page
1 2 3 4 5
6th page
6
Cover copying condition
Front cover Back cover
No copying No copying
1 2
Resulting copies
3 4 5
1-sided copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
2-sided copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
No copying
1
No copying
1
No copying
No copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
1-sided copying
1
2-sided copying
1
1-sided copying
1
2-sided copying
1
2 3 4 5 6
3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
2 3 4 5
2 3 4 5
3 4 5
3 4 5
6
2-151
Covers (2-sided copying of 1-sided originals)
2-sided copies are made of the following 1-sided originals.
1st page 2nd page 3rd page 4th page 5th page
1 2 3 4 5
6th page
6
Cover copying condition
Front cover Back cover
No copying No copying
1
Resulting copies
3 5
1-sided copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
2-sided copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
No copying
1
No copying
1
No copying
No copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
1-sided copying
1
2-sided copying
1
1-sided copying
1
2-sided copying
1
2 4 6
3 5
1 3 5
1 3 5
2 4
2 4 5
3 5
3 5
2-152
Covers (1-sided copying of 2-sided originals)
1-sided copies are made of the following 2-sided originals.
1st page 2nd page 3rd page
1 3 5
Cover copying condition
Front cover Back cover
No copying No copying
1 2
Resulting copies
3 4 5
1-sided copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
2-sided copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
No copying
1
No copying
1
No copying
No copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
1-sided copying
1
2-sided copying
1
1-sided copying
1
2-sided copying
1
2 3 4 5 6
3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
2 3 4 5
2 3 4 5
3 4 5
3 4 5
6
2-153
Covers (2-sided copying of 2-sided originals)
2-sided copies are made of the following 2-sided originals.
1st page 2nd page 3rd page
1 3 5
Cover copying condition
Front cover Back cover
No copying No copying
1
Resulting copies
3 5
1-sided copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
2-sided copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
No copying
1
No copying
1
No copying
No copying
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
1-sided copying
1
2-sided copying
1
1-sided copying
1
2-sided copying
1
3 5
3 5
1 3
1 3 5
3
3 5
3
3 5
2-154
Inserts (copying of 1-sided originals)
1-sided and 2-sided copying of the following 1-sided originals. The example of adding an insert at the 3rd sheet is shown. (when "Insertion Page" is set to "3" in the insertion settings of the insert settings in the special modes)
1st page 2nd page 3rd page 4th page 5th page 6th page
1 2 3 4 5 6
Insert copying condition
No copying
1
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
1
1
2
Resulting copies (1-sided copying)
3 4 5 6
2
2
3 4 5 6
3 5 6
1
Resulting copies
(2-sided copying)
3 5
1 3 4 6
1 3 5
Inserts (copying of 2-sided originals)
1-sided and 2-sided copying of the following 2-sided originals. The example of adding an insert at the 3rd sheet is shown. (when "Insertion Page" is set to "3" in the insertion settings of the insert settings in the special modes)
1st page 2nd page 3rd page
1 3 5
Insert copying condition
No copying
1
1-sided copying
2-sided copying
1
1
2
Resulting copies (1-sided copying)
3 4 5 6
2
2
3 4 5 6
3 5 6
1
Resulting copies
(2-sided copying)
3 5
1 3 5
1 3 5
2-155
CHAPTER 3
PRINTER
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the printer function.
PRINTER FUNCTION OF THE MACHINE . . . . . . . . 3-3
PRINTING FROM WINDOWS
BASIC PRINTING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
• SELECTING THE PAPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
• PRINTING ON ENVELOPES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
AUTHENTICATION FUNCTION IS ENABLED . . . . 3-8
VIEWING PRINTER DRIVER HELP. . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12
• SAVING SETTINGS AT THE TIME OF
PRINTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12
• USING SAVED SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14
DEFAULT SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15
PRINTING FROM A MACINTOSH
BASIC PRINTING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
• SELECTING PAPER SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
• PRINTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18
• SELECTING THE PAPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
• PRINTING ON ENVELOPES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21
AUTHENTICATION FUNCTION IS ENABLED . . . 3-22
FREQUENTLY USED FUNCTIONS
SELECTING THE COLOUR MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24
SELECTING A PRINT MODE SETTING . . . . . . . . 3-26
TWO-SIDED PRINTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
FITTING THE PRINT IMAGE TO THE PAPER . . . 3-29
PRINTING MULTIPLE PAGES ON ONE
PAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30
STAPLING OUTPUT/PUNCHING HOLES IN
OUTPUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32
CONVENIENT PRINTING FUNCTIONS
CONVENIENT FUNCTIONS FOR CREATING
PAMPHLETS AND POSTERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34
• CREATING A PAMPHLET (Pamphlet). . . . . . . 3-34
• INCREASING THE MARGIN (Margin Shift) . . . 3-36
• CREATING A LARGE POSTER (Poster
Printing) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37
FUNCTIONS TO ADJUST THE SIZE AND
ORIENTATION OF THE IMAGE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38
• ROTATING THE PRINT IMAGE 180
DEGREES (Rotate 180 degrees) . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38
• ENLARGING/REDUCING THE PRINT
IMAGE (Zoom/XY-Zoom) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39
PRINTING (Line Width Settings) . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40
• REVERSING THE IMAGE (Mirror Image) . . . . 3-41
COLOUR MODE ADJUSTMENT FUNCTION . . . . 3-42
• ADJUSTING THE BRIGHTNESS AND
Adjustment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-42
• PRINTING FAINT TEXT AND LINES IN
BLACK (Text To Black/Vector To Black) . . . . . 3-43
• SELECTING COLOUR SETTINGS TO
MATCH THE IMAGE TYPE (Advanced
Colour) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-44
• PRINTING IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE
COLOUR BALANCE OF THE MACHINE. . . . . 3-46
FUNCTIONS THAT COMBINE TEXT AND
IMAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47
• ADDING A WATERMARK TO PRINTED
PAGES (Watermark) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47
• PRINTING AN IMAGE OVER THE PRINT
DATA (Image Stamp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-48
DATA (Overlays) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-49
3-1
PRINTER
PURPOSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-50
DIFFERENT PAPER (Different Paper). . . . . . . 3-50
• ADDING INSERTS WHEN PRINTING ON
TRANSPARENCY FILM (Transparency
Inserts) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-52
• PRINTING A CARBON COPY (Carbon
Copy) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-53
• PRINTING TEXT ON TABS OF TAB
PAPER (Tab Paper Print/Tab Paper
Settings) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54
• TWO-SIDED PRINTING WITH SPECIFIC
PAGES PRINTED ON THE FRONT SIDE
(Chapter Inserts). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-57
CONVENIENT PRINTER FUNCTIONS . . . . . . . . . 3-58
• USING TWO MACHINES TO PRINT A
LARGE PRINT JOB (Tandem Print). . . . . . . . . 3-58
• SAVING AND USING PRINT FILES
(Retention/Document Filing) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-59
PRINTING WITHOUT THE PRINTER
DRIVER
DIRECTLY PRINTING FROM THE MACHINE. . . . 3-62
• DIRECTLY PRINTING A FILE ON AN FTP
SERVER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-63
• DIRECTLY PRINTING A FILE IN USB
MEMORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-64
• DIRECTLY PRINTING A FILE IN A
NETWORK FOLDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-66
DIRECTLY PRINTING FROM A COMPUTER . . . . 3-69
• SUBMIT PRINT JOB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-69
• FTP PRINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-69
• E-MAIL PRINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-70
CHECKING THE PRINT STATUS
JOB STATUS SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-71
SCREEN/COMPLETED JOB SCREEN . . . . . . 3-72
PRINTING AN ENCRYPTED PDF FILE. . . . . . . . . 3-74
PRIORITY/CANCELLING A PRINT JOB . . . . . . . . 3-75
• GIVING A PRINT JOB PRIORITY . . . . . . . . . . 3-75
• CANCELLING A PRINT JOB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-76
CHANGING TO ANOTHER PAPER SIZE AND
PRINTING WHEN PAPER RUNS OUT . . . . . . . . . 3-77
APPENDIX
PRINTER DRIVER SPECIFICATION LIST . . . . . . 3-78
PRINTER SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-80
3-2
PRINTER FUNCTION OF THE MACHINE
The machine is equipped standard with a full colour printing function. To enable printing from your computer, a printer driver must be installed.
See the table below to determine which printer driver to use in your environment.
Environment
Windows
Macintosh
Printer driver type
SAPL-c
This is the SHARP proprietary printer driver. The printer driver compresses the data in each print job before sending the job to the machine, enabling smooth printing. (SAPL is an acronym for "Sharp
Advanced Printing Language".)
PCL6
The machine supports the Hewlett-Packard PCL6 printer control languages. It is recommended that you use the PCL6 printer driver.
PS
This printer driver supports the PostScript 3 page description language developed by Adobe Systems Incorporated, and enables the machine to be used as a PostScript 3 compatible printer.
(A PPD file is available if it is desired to use the Windows standard PS printer driver.)
* Cannot be used when the printer expansion kit is installed.
Remarks
Can be used in the standard machine configuration.*
The printer expansion kit is required.
The printer expansion kit and PS3 expansion kit are required.
Installing the printer driver in a Windows environment
To install the printer driver and configure settings in a Windows environment, see "2. SETUP IN A WINDOWS
ENVIRONMENT" in the Software Setup Guide.
The explanations in this manual of printing in a Windows environment generally use the screens of the PCL6 printer driver.
The printer driver screens may differ slightly depending on the printer driver that you are using.
Installing the printer driver in a Macintosh environment
In a Macintosh environment, the printer expansion kit and PS3 expansion kit must be installed to use the machine as a network printer.
To install the printer driver and configure settings in a Macintosh environment, see "3. SETUP IN A MACINTOSH
ENVIRONMENT" in the Software Setup Guide.
3-3
PRINTING FROM WINDOWS
BASIC PRINTING PROCEDURE
The following example explains how to print a document from "WordPad", which is a standard accessory program in
Windows.
Select [Print] from the [File] menu of
WordPad.
If you are using Windows 7, click the button.
1
2
The menu used to execute printing may vary depending on the software application.
Open the printer driver properties window.
(1) Select the printer driver of the machine.
• If the printer drivers appear as icons, click the icon of the printer driver to be used.
• If the printer drivers appear as a list, select the name of the printer driver to be used from the list.
(2) Click the [Preferences] button.
If you are using Windows 2000, the [Preferences] button does not appear. Click a tab on the "Print" dialog box to adjust the settings on that tab.
(1) (2)
The button that is used to open the printer driver properties window (usually [Properties] or [Printing Preferences]) may vary depending on the software application.
3-4
(1) (2)
Select print settings.
(1) Click the [Paper] tab.
(2) Select the paper size.
To select settings on other tabs, click the desired tab and then select the settings.
(3) Click the [OK] button.
3
4
(3)
• Make sure the paper size is the same as the paper size set in the software application.
• Up to eight custom paper sizes can be stored. Storing a custom paper size makes it easy to specify that size each time you need to use it.
To store a paper size, select [Custom Paper] or one of [User1] to [User7] from the pull-down menu and click the
[Custom] button.
Click the [Print] button.
Printing begins.
3-5
SELECTING THE PAPER
This section explains how to configure the "Paper Selection" setting on the [Paper] tab of the printer driver properties window.
Before printing, check the paper sizes, paper types, and paper remaining in the machine's trays. To view the most recent tray information, click the [Tray Status] button.
• When [Auto Select] is selected in "Paper Source"
The tray that has the size and type of paper selected in "Paper Size" and "Paper Type" on the [Paper] tab is automatically selected.
• When other than [Auto Select] is selected in "Paper Source"
The specified tray is used for printing regardless of the "Paper Size" setting.
When [Bypass Tray] is selected
The "Paper Type" must also be selected. Check the bypass tray and make sure that the desired type of paper is loaded, and then select the appropriate "Paper Type" setting.
• Special media such as envelopes can also be placed in the bypass tray. For the procedure for loading paper and other media in the bypass tray, see "
LOADING PAPER IN THE BYPASS TRAY " (page 1-32) in "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE".
• When "Enable Detected Paper Size in Bypass Tray" (disabled by factory default) or "Enable Selected Paper Type in
Bypass Tray" (enabled by factory default) is enabled in the system settings (administrator), printing will not take place if the paper size or paper type specified in the printer driver is different from the paper size or paper type specified in the settings of the bypass tray.
• When [Auto Select] is selected in "Paper Type"
A tray with plain paper or recycled paper of the size specified in "Paper Size" is automatically selected. (The factory default setting is plain paper only.)
• When other than [Auto Select] is selected in "Paper Type"
A tray with the specified type of paper and the size specified in "Paper Size" is used for printing.
System Settings (Administrator): Exclude Bypass-Tray from Auto Paper Select
When [Auto Select] is selected in "Paper Selection", specify whether or not the paper in the bypass tray will be excluded from the paper that can be selected. This setting is disabled by factory default, and thus paper in the bypass tray is included in the paper that can be automatically selected. If special media are frequently loaded in the bypass tray, it is recommended that this setting be enabled.
3-6
PRINTING ON ENVELOPES
The bypass tray can be used to print on special media such as envelopes. The procedure for printing on an envelope from the printer driver properties screen is described below.
For the types of paper that can be used in the bypass tray, see "
IMPORTANT POINTS ABOUT PAPER " (page 1-27) in
THE BYPASS TRAY " (page 1-32) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
Select the envelope size in the appropriate settings of the application ("Page Settings" in many applications) and then perform the following steps.
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Click the [Paper] tab.
(2) Select the envelope size from the "Paper
Size" menu.
(3) Select [Bypass Tray] from the "Paper
Source" menu of "Paper Selection".
(4) Select [Envelope] from the "Paper Type" menu.
Set the paper type of the bypass tray to [Envelope] and make sure the envelope is loaded in the bypass tray.
(4)
• It is recommended that you do a test print to check the print result before using an envelope.
• In the case of media that can only be loaded in a certain orientation such as an envelope, you can rotate the image 180
"
• For more information on "Paper Selection", see "
SELECTING THE PAPER " (page 3-6).
3-7
PRINTING WHEN THE USER
AUTHENTICATION FUNCTION IS ENABLED
When the user authentication function is enabled in the machine's system settings (administrator), your user information
(login name, password, etc.) must be entered in the printer driver properties window before you can print. The information that must be entered varies depending on the authentication method being used, so check with the administrator of the machine before printing.
Open the printer driver properties window from the print window of the software application.
(1) Select the printer driver of the machine.
(2) Click the [Preferences] button.
1
(1) (2)
The button that is used to open the printer driver properties window (usually [Properties] or [Printing Preferences]) may vary depending on the software application.
3-8
2
(1) (2)
(4) (3)
Enter your login name and password.
(1) Click the [Job Handling] tab.
(2) Enter your user information.
• When authentication is by login name/password
Select the [Login Name] and [Password] checkboxes so that checkmarks appear, and enter your login name and password. Enter 1 to 32 characters for the password.
• When authentication is by user number
Click the [User Number] checkbox and enter a user number (5 to 8 digits).
When [User Authentication] has been checked on [Printing Policy] in the [Configuration] tab, you cannot enter the user information.
Enter the user information in the dialog box whenever you print.
(3) Enter the user name and job name as necessary.
• User Name
Click the [User Name] checkbox and enter your user name (maximum of 32 characters). Your entered user name will appear at the top of the operation panel. If you do not enter a user name, your computer login name will appear.
• Job Name
Click the [Job Name] checkbox and enter a job name (maximum of 30 characters). The entered job name will appear at the top of the operation panel as a file name. If you do not enter a job name, the file name set in the software application will appear.
(4) Click the [OK] button.
To have a confirmation window appear before printing starts, select the [Auto Job Control Review] checkbox so that a
Start printing.
3
3-9
• When user authentication is enabled in the system settings (administrator), printing is possible without entering user information if black and white printing is set in the printer driver. For black and white print settings, see "
functions may be restricted. For more information, ask your administrator.
• The machine's user authentication function cannot be used when the PPD file* is installed and the Windows standard PS printer driver is used. For this reason, printing will not be possible if printing by invalid users is prohibited in the system settings (administrator).
* The PPD file enables the machine to print using the standard PS printer driver of the operating system.
System Settings (Administrator): Disabling of Printing by Invalid User
This is used to prohibit printing of print jobs by users whose user information is not stored in the machine. When this function is enabled, printing is not allowed when user information is not entered or incorrect information is entered.
3-10
VIEWING PRINTER DRIVER HELP
When selecting settings in the printer driver, you can display Help to view explanations of the settings.
Open the printer driver properties window from the print window of the software application.
(1) Select the printer driver of the machine.
(2) Click the [Preferences] button.
1
(1) (2)
The button that is used to open the printer driver properties window (usually [Properties] or [Printing Preferences]) may vary depending on the software application.
Click the [Help] button.
The Help window will open to let you view explanations of the settings on the tab.
To view Help for settings in a dialog box, click the underlined text at the top of the Help window.
2
Pop-up help
Help can be displayed for a setting by clicking the setting and pressing the [F1] key.
* To view Help for a setting in Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003, click the button in the upper right-hand corner of the printer driver properties window and then click the setting.
Information icon
Some restrictions exist on the combinations of settings that can be selected in the printer driver properties window.
When a restriction exists on a selected setting, an information icon ( ) will appear next to the setting. Click the icon to view an explanation of the restriction.
3-11
SAVING FREQUENTLY USED PRINT
SETTINGS
Settings configured on each of the tabs at the time of printing can be saved as user settings. Saving frequently used settings or complex colour settings under an assigned name makes it easy to select those settings the next time you need to use them.
SAVING SETTINGS AT THE TIME OF PRINTING
Settings can be saved from any tab of the printer driver properties window. Settings configured on each tab are listed at the time of saving, allowing you to check the settings as you save them.
Open the printer driver properties window from the print window of the software application.
(1) Select the printer driver of the machine.
(2) Click the [Preferences] button.
1
2
(1) (2)
The button that is used to open the printer driver properties window (usually [Properties] or [Printing Preferences]) may vary depending on the software application.
Save the print settings.
(1) Configure print settings on each tab.
(2) Click the [Save] button.
(1) (2)
3-12
4
5
3
(1) (2)
Check and save the settings.
(1) Check the displayed settings.
(2) Enter a name for the settings (maximum of 20 characters).
(3) Click the [OK] button.
(3)
Click the [OK] button.
Start printing.
• Up to 30 sets of user settings can be saved.
• The following items cannot be saved in user settings.
- A watermark that you created
- Paper insertion settings
- Overlay file
- [Tab Paper Print] settings on the [Special Modes] tab (PCL6 only)
- The login name, password, user name, and job name entered in the [Job Handling] tab
3-13
USING SAVED SETTINGS
Open the printer driver properties window from the print window of the software application.
(1) Select the printer driver of the machine.
(2) Click the [Preferences] button.
1
(1) (2)
The button that is used to open the printer driver properties window (usually [Properties] or [Printing Preferences]) may vary depending on the software application.
Select the print settings.
(1) Select the user settings that you wish to use.
(2) Click the [OK] button.
2
(1) (2)
Start printing.
3
Deleting saved settings
Select the user settings that you want to delete in (1) of step 2 above, and click the [Delete] button.
3-14
CHANGING THE PRINTER DRIVER
DEFAULT SETTINGS
The default settings of the printer driver can be changed using the procedure below. The settings selected using this procedure are saved and become the default settings when printing from a software application. (Settings selected in the printer driver properties window when printing from an application remain in effect only while the application is in use.)
1
Click the [Start] button ( ) and select [Control Panel] and then [Printer].
• In Windows 7, click the [start] button and then click [Devices and Printers].
• In Windows XP/Server 2003, click the [start] button and then click [Printers and Faxes].
• In Windows 2000, click the [Start] button, point to [Settings], and then select [Printers].
In Windows XP, if [Printers and Faxes] does not appear in the [start] menu, select [Control Panel], select [Printers and
Other Hardware], and then select [Printers and Faxes].
2
(2) (1)
Open the printer properties window.
(1) Click the icon of the printer driver of the machine.
In Windows 7, right-click the icon of the printer driver of the machine. Go to step (3).
(2) Click the [Organize] menu.
In Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003, click the [File] menu.
(3) Select [Properties].
In Windows 7, click the [Printer properties] menu.
(3)
Click the [Printing Preferences] button on the [General] tab.
In Windows 7, click the [Preferences] button on the
[General] tab.
3
3-15
4
Configure the settings and click the
[OK] button.
For explanations of the settings, see printer driver Help.
3-16
PRINTING FROM A MACINTOSH
BASIC PRINTING PROCEDURE
The following example explains how to print a document from the standard accessory program "TextEdit" in Mac OS X
("SimpleText" in Mac OS 9).
To use the machine as a printer for the Macintosh, the printer expansion kit and PS3 expansion kit must be installed in the machine and the machine must be connected to a network. To install the PPD file and configure printer driver settings, see
"3. SETUP IN A MACINTOSH ENVIRONMENT" in the Software Setup Guide.
SELECTING PAPER SETTINGS
Select paper settings in the printer driver before selecting the print command.
Select [Page Setup] from the [File] menu of TextEdit.
In Mac OS 9, select [Page Setup] from the [File] menu of
SimpleText.
1
2
(1)
Select paper settings.
(1) Make sure that the correct printer is selected.
(2) Select paper settings.
The paper size, paper orientation, and enlarge/reduce can be selected.
(3) Click the [OK] button.
(2) (3)
The machine name that appears in the "Format for" menu is normally [SCxxxxxx]. ("xxxxxx" is a sequence of characters that varies depending on your machine model.)
3-17
PRINTING
Select [Print] from the [File] menu of
TextEdit.
In Mac OS 9, select [Print] from the [File] menu of
SimpleText.
1
The menu used to execute printing may vary depending on the software application.
Make sure that the correct printer is selected.
2
3
The machine name that appears in the "Printer" menu is normally [SCxxxxxx]. ("xxxxxx" is a sequence of characters that varies depending on the machine model.)
Select print settings.
• In Mac OS X, click next to [Copies & Pages] and select the settings that you wish to configure from the pull-down menu. The corresponding setting screen will appear. If the settings do not appear in Mac OS X v10.5 to 10.5.8 and 10.6 to 10.6.2, click " " next to the printer name.
• In Mac OS 9, click next to [General] and select the settings that you wish to configure from the pull-down menu. The corresponding setting screen will appear.
3-18
4
Click the [Print] button.
Printing begins.
3-19
SELECTING THE PAPER
This section explains the [Paper Feed] settings ("Paper Source" setting in [General] in Mac OS 9) in the print settings window.
• When [Auto Select] is selected
A tray with plain paper or recycled paper (the factory default setting is plain paper only) of the size specified in "Paper
Size" in the page settings window is automatically selected.
• When a paper tray is selected
The specified tray is used for printing regardless of the "Paper Size" setting in the page settings window.
For the bypass tray, a paper type can also be specified. Make sure that the paper type setting for the bypass tray is correct and that the set type of paper is actually loaded in the bypass tray, and then select the appropriate bypass tray
(paper type).
• Special media such as envelopes can also be placed in the bypass tray. For the procedure for loading paper and other media in the bypass tray, see "
LOADING PAPER IN THE BYPASS TRAY " (page 1-32) in "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE".
• When "Enable Detected Paper Size in Bypass Tray" (disabled by factory default) or "Enable Selected Paper Type in
Bypass Tray" (enabled by factory default) is enabled in the system settings (administrator), printing will not take place if the paper size or paper type specified in the printer driver is different from the paper size or paper type specified in the settings of the bypass tray.
• When a paper type is selected
A tray with the specified type of paper and the size specified in "Paper Size" in the page settings window is used for printing.
System Settings (Administrator): Exclude Bypass-Tray from Auto Paper Select
When [Auto Select] is used for printing, this setting determines whether or not the paper in the bypass tray will be excluded from the paper that can be selected. This setting is disabled by factory default, and thus paper in the bypass tray is included in the paper that can be automatically selected. If special media are frequently loaded in the bypass tray, it is recommended that this setting be enabled.
3-20
PRINTING ON ENVELOPES
The bypass tray can be used to print on special media such as envelopes. The procedure for printing on an envelope from the printer driver properties screen is described below.
For the types of paper that can be used in the bypass tray, see "
IMPORTANT POINTS ABOUT PAPER " (page 1-27) in
THE BYPASS TRAY " (page 1-32) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
Select the envelope size in the appropriate settings of the application ("Page Settings" in many applications) and then perform the following steps.
(1)
Select the paper size.
(1) Select the envelope size from the "Paper
Size" menu on the page setup screen.
In Mac OS 9, select the envelope size from the
"Paper" menu on the page setup screen.
(2) Click the [OK] button.
1
2
(2)
In the case of media that can only be loaded in a certain orientation such as an envelope, you can rotate the image
180 degrees if needed. For more information, see "
ROTATING THE PRINT IMAGE 180 DEGREES (Rotate 180 degrees) " (page 3-38).
(1)
(2)
Select the bypass tray.
(1) Select [Paper Feed] on the print screen.
In Mac OS 9, select [General].
(2) Select [Bypass Tray(Envelope)] from the
"All pages from" menu.
• In Mac OS 9, select [Bypass Tray(Envelope)] from the "All pages from" menu of "Paper Source".
• Set the paper type of the bypass tray to [Envelope] and make sure the envelope is loaded in the bypass tray.
For more information on "Paper Feed", see "
SELECTING THE PAPER " (page 3-20).
It is recommended that you do a test print to check the print result before using an envelope.
3-21
PRINTING WHEN THE USER
AUTHENTICATION FUNCTION IS ENABLED
When the user authentication function is enabled in the machine's system settings (administrator), you must enter your user information (login name, password, etc.) in order to print. The information that must be entered varies depending on the authentication method being used, so check with the administrator of the machine before printing.
Select [Print] from the application's
[File] menu.
1
2
The menu used to execute printing may vary depending on the software application.
(1)
Display the job handling screen.
(1) Make sure that the machine's printer name is selected.
(2) Select [Job Handling].
• In Mac OS X v10.5 to 10.5.8 and 10.6 to 10.6.2, select [Job Handling] and then click the
[Authentication] tab in the screen that appears.
• In Mac OS 9, select [User Authentication].
(2)
The machine name that appears in the "Printer" menu is normally [SCxxxxxx]. ("xxxxxx" is a sequence of characters that varies depending on the machine model.)
3-22
3
(1) (2) (3)
Start printing.
(1) Enter your user information.
• When authentication is by login name/password
Enter your login name in "Login Name" and your password in "Password" (1 to 32 characters).
• When authentication is by user number
Enter your user number (5 to 8 digits) in "User
Number".
(2) Enter the user name and job name as necessary.
• User Name
Enter your user name (maximum of 32 characters).
Your entered user name will appear at the top of the operation panel. If you do not enter a user name, your computer login name will appear.
• Job Name
Enter a job name (maximum of 30 characters). The entered job name will appear at the top of the operation panel as a file name. If you do not enter a job name, the file name set in the software application will appear.
(3) Click the [Print] button.
In Mac OS X, you can click the (lock) button after entering your login name and password, or user number, to simplify operation the next time you wish to print based on the same user authentication.
When user authentication is enabled in the system settings (administrator), printing is possible without entering user information if black and white printing is set in the printer driver. For black and white print settings, see "
may be restricted. For more information, ask your administrator.
System Settings (Administrator): Disabling of Printing by Invalid User
This is used to prohibit printing of print jobs by users whose user information is not stored in the machine. When this function is enabled, printing is not allowed when user information is not entered or incorrect information is entered.
3-23
FREQUENTLY USED FUNCTIONS
This section explains frequently used functions.
•
•
TWO-SIDED PRINTING (page 3-27)
•
FITTING THE PRINT IMAGE TO THE PAPER
•
PRINTING MULTIPLE PAGES ON ONE PAGE
•
STAPLING OUTPUT/PUNCHING HOLES IN
The explanations assume that the paper size and other basic settings have already been selected. For the basic procedure for printing and the steps for opening the printer driver properties window, see the following section:
☞
Windows:
BASIC PRINTING PROCEDURE (page 3-4)
☞
Macintosh: BASIC PRINTING PROCEDURE (page 3-17)
In Windows, view printer driver Help for details on printer driver settings for each printing function.
SELECTING THE COLOUR MODE
This section explains how to select the colour mode in the printer driver properties window. The following three selections are available for the colour mode:
Automatic: The machine automatically determines whether each page is colour or black and white and prints the page accordingly. Pages with colours other than black and white are printed using Y (Yellow), M
(Magenta), C (Cyan) and Bk (Black) toner. Pages that are only black and white are printed using Bk
(Black) toner only. This is convenient when printing a document that has both colour and black and
Color: white pages, however, the printing speed is slower.
All pages are printed in colour. Both colour data and black and white data are printed using Y (Yellow),
M (Magenta), C (Cyan) and Bk (Black) toner.
Black and White: All pages are printed in black and white. Colour data such as images or materials for a presentation are printed using black toner only. This mode helps conserve colour toner when you do not need to print in colour, such as when proofreading or checking the layout of a document.
When "Color Mode" is set to [Automatic]
Even if the print result is black and white, the following types of print jobs will be counted as 4-colour (Y (Yellow), M
(Magenta), C (Cyan), and Bk (Black)) print jobs. To be always counted as a black and white job, select [Black and White].
• When the data is created as colour data.
• When the application treats the data as colour data even though the data is black and white.
• When an image is hidden under a black and white image.
Windows
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Color] tab.
(2) Select the "Color Mode" that you wish to use.
3-24
BLACK AND WHITE PRINTING
[Black and White] can be selected on the [Main] tab as well as on the [Color] tab. Click the [Black and White Print] checkbox on the [Main] tab so that a checkmark appears.
The [Black and White Print] checkbox on the [Main] tab and the "Color Mode" setting on the [Color] tab are linked. When the [Black and White Print] checkbox is selected on the [Main] tab, [Black and White] is also selected on the [Color] tab.
Macintosh
(2) (1)
(1) Select [Color].
(2) Select the "Color Mode" that you wish to use.
3-25
SELECTING A PRINT MODE SETTING
This section explains the procedure for selecting a print mode setting. The "Print Mode Settings" consist of the following two items:
Normal: This mode is suitable for printing data such as regular text or a table.
High Quality: The print quality of colour photos and text is high.
Windows
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Advanced] tab.
(2) Select the "Print Mode".
Macintosh
(2) (1)
(1) Select [Color].
(2) Select the "Print Mode".
3-26
TWO-SIDED PRINTING
The machine can print on both sides of the paper. This function is useful for many purposes, and is particularly convenient when you want to create a simple pamphlet. Two-sided printing also helps conserve paper.
Paper orientation
Print results
Windows
2-Sided(Book)
Macintosh
Long-edged binding
(Flip on long edge)
Windows
2-Sided(Tablet)
Macintosh
Short-edged binding
(Flip on short edge)
Vertical
Horizontal
Windows
2-Sided(Book)
Macintosh
Short-edged binding
(Flip on short edge)
Windows
2-Sided(Tablet)
Macintosh
Long-edged binding
(Flip on long edge)
Windows
(1)
The pages are printed so that they can be bound at the side.
The pages are printed so that they can be bound at the top.
(2)
(1) Configure the settings on the [Main] tab.
(2) Select [2-Sided(Book)] or [2-Sided(Tablet)].
3-27
Macintosh
(1)
(2)
(1) Select [Layout].
(2) Select [Long-edged binding] or
[Short-edged binding].
• In Mac OS X v10.2.8, select the settings in
[Advanced].
• In Mac OS 9, select [Output/Document Style] and then select [Flip on long edge] or [Flip on short edge].
3-28
FITTING THE PRINT IMAGE TO THE PAPER
This function is used to automatically enlarge or reduce the printed image to match the size of the paper loaded in the machine.
This is convenient for such purposes as enlarging an A4 or letter size document to A3 or ledger size to make it easier to view, and to print when the same size of paper as the document image is not loaded in the machine.
A4 or Letter A3 or Ledger
The following example explains how to print an A4 size document on A3 size paper.
Windows
(1) (3) (2) (4)
(1) Click the [Paper] tab.
(2) Select the size of the print image (for example: A4).
(3) Select [Fit To Paper Size].
(4) Select the actual paper size to be used for printing (for example: A3).
Macintosh
(This function can only be used in Mac OS X v10.4.11, v10.5 to 10.5.8 and 10.6 to 10.6.2.)
(1) (2)
(1) Select [Paper Handling].
(2) Check the size of the print image (for example: A4).
To change the print image size, use the "Paper Size" menu that appears when [Page Setup] is selected.
(3) Select [Scale to fit paper size].
(4) Select the actual paper size to be used for printing (for example: A3).
(3) (4)
3-29
PRINTING MULTIPLE PAGES ON ONE PAGE
This function can be used to reduce the print image and print multiple pages on a single sheet of paper.
This is convenient when you want to print multiple images such as photos on a single sheet of paper, and when you want to conserve paper. This function can also be used in combination with two-sided printing for maximum conservation of paper.
For example, when [2-Up] (2 pages per sheet) and [4-Up] (4 pages per sheet) are selected, the following print results will be obtained, depending on the order selected.
N-Up
(Pages per sheet)
Left To Right
Print results
Right To Left
Top To Bottom
(When the print orientation is landscape)
2-Up
(2 pages per sheet)
N-Up
(Pages per sheet)
4-Up
(4 pages per sheet)
Right, and Down Down, and Right Left, and Down Down, and Left
• The page orders for 6-Up, 8-Up, 9-Up, and 16-Up are the same as for 4-Up.
• In a Windows environment, the page order can be viewed in the print image in the printer driver properties window.
In a Macintosh environment, the page orders are displayed as selections.
• In a Macintosh environment, the number of pages that can be printed on a single sheet is 2, 4, 6, 9, or 16.
3-30
Windows
(1)
(1) Configure the settings on the [Main] tab.
(2) Select the number of pages per sheet.
(3) If you wish to print borderlines, click the
[Border] checkbox so that a checkmark appears.
(4) Select the order of the pages.
(2) (3)
Macintosh
(4)
(1) (2)
(1) Select [Layout].
(2) Select the number of pages per sheet.
(3) Select the order of the pages.
(4) If you wish to print borderlines, select the desired type of borderline.
(4) (3)
3-31
STAPLING OUTPUT/PUNCHING HOLES IN
OUTPUT
Staple function
The staple function can be used to staple output.
This function saves considerable time when preparing handouts for a meeting or other stapled materials. The staple function can also be used in combination with two-sided printing to create materials with a more sophisticated appearance.
Stapling positions and the number of staples can be selected to obtain the following stapling results.
Staples Left Right Top
1 Staple*
2 Staples
* The staple orientation varies depending on the size and orientation of the paper.
Punch function
The punch function can be selected to punch holes in printed output. Punch hole positions can be set by selecting the binding edge.
Left Right Top
• To use the staple function, a finisher is required.
• To use the punch function, a punch module must be installed on the finisher.
• The number of holes that can be punched and the spacing between the holes varies depending on the installed punch module.
• For the maximum number of sheets that can be stapled, see "SPECIFICATIONS" in the Start Guide.
The maximum number of sheets that can be stapled at once includes any covers and/or inserts that are inserted.
• The staple function cannot be used in combination with the offset function, which offsets the position of each output job from the previous job.
• When the finisher is disabled in the machine's system settings (administrator), the staple function and punch function cannot be used.
• When the staple function or the punch function is disabled in the machine's system settings (administrator), stapling or punching is not possible.
3-32
Windows
(1) (3) (2)
(1) Configure the settings on the [Main] tab.
(2) Select the "Binding Edge".
(3) Select the staple function or the punch function.
• For the staple function, select the number of staples in the "Staple" menu.
• For the punch function, click the [Punch] checkbox so that a checkmark appears.
Macintosh
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Select [Printer Features].
(2) Select the "Binding Edge".
(3) Select the staple function or the punch function.
• For the staple function, select the number of staples in the "Staple" menu.
• For the punch function, click the [Punch] checkbox so that a checkmark appears.
• In Mac OS X v10.2.8, select the settings in
[Advanced].
• In Mac OS 9, select the settings in
[Output/Document Style].
3-33
CONVENIENT PRINTING FUNCTIONS
This section explains convenient functions for specific printing objectives.
•
CONVENIENT FUNCTIONS FOR CREATING
•
FUNCTIONS TO ADJUST THE SIZE AND
ORIENTATION OF THE IMAGE (page 3-38)
•
COLOUR MODE ADJUSTMENT FUNCTION (page
•
•
FUNCTIONS THAT COMBINE TEXT AND IMAGES
•
PRINT FUNCTIONS FOR SPECIAL PURPOSES
CONVENIENT PRINTER FUNCTIONS (page 3-58)
The explanations assume that the paper size and other basic settings have already been selected. For the basic procedure for printing and the steps for opening the printer driver properties window, see the following section:
☞
Windows:
BASIC PRINTING PROCEDURE (page 3-4)
☞
Macintosh: BASIC PRINTING PROCEDURE (page 3-17)
In Windows, view printer driver Help for details on printer driver settings for each printing function.
CONVENIENT FUNCTIONS FOR CREATING
PAMPHLETS AND POSTERS
CREATING A PAMPHLET (Pamphlet)
The pamphlet function prints on the front and back of each sheet of paper so that the sheets can be folded and bound to create a pamphlet. This is convenient when you wish to compile printed output into a pamphlet.
Windows
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Configure the settings on the [Main] tab.
(2) Select [Pamphlet Style]
(3) Select the "Binding Edge".
3-34
Macintosh
(1)
(2)
(1) Select [Printer Features].
(2) Select the "Binding Edge".
(3) Select [Tiled Pamphlet] or [2-Up Pamphlet].
• In Mac OS X v10.2.8, select from the "2-Side
Printing" and "Binding Edge" menus in [Advanced].
• In Mac OS 9, select the settings in
[Output/Document Style].
(3)
3-35
INCREASING THE MARGIN (Margin Shift)
This function is used to shift the print image to increase the margin at the left, right, or top of the paper. This is convenient when you wish to staple or punch the output but the binding area overlaps the text. When a finisher is installed, the staple function or the punch function can be used with this function.
Windows
(1) (2)
(1) Configure the settings on the [Main] tab.
(2) Select the "Binding Edge".
(3) Select the "Margin Shift".
Select from the "Margin Shift" menu. If you wish to configure another numeric setting, select the setting from the pull-down menu and click the [Settings] button. Click the button or directly enter the number.
Macintosh
(1) (2)
(3)
(1) Select [Printer Features].
(2) Select the "Binding Edge".
(3) Select the "Margin Shift".
• In Mac OS X v10.2.8, select from the "Binding
Edge" and "Margin Shift" menus in [Advanced].
• In Mac OS 9, select [Advanced] and then select the binding edge and margin shift from the margin shift menu.
(3)
3-36
CREATING A LARGE POSTER (Poster Printing)
(This function is only available in Windows.)
One page of print data can be enlarged and printed using multiple sheets of paper (4 sheets (2 x 2), 9 sheets
(3 x 3) or 16 sheets (4 x 4)). The sheets can then be attached together to create a large poster. To enable precise alignment of the edges of the sheets during attachment, borderlines can be printed and overlapping edges can be created (overlap function).
Windows
(This function can be used when the PCL6 or PS printer driver is used.)
(1)
(1) Click the [Paper] tab.
(2) Select the [Poster Printing] checkbox and click the [Poster Settings] button.
(3) Select poster settings.
Select the number of sheets of paper to be used from the pull-down menu. If you wish to print borderlines and/or use the overlap function, select the corresponding checkboxes .
(2)
(3)
3-37
FUNCTIONS TO ADJUST THE SIZE AND
ORIENTATION OF THE IMAGE
ROTATING THE PRINT IMAGE 180 DEGREES
(Rotate 180 degrees)
This feature rotates the image 180 degrees so that it can be printed correctly on paper that can only be loaded in one orientation (such as envelopes or paper with punch holes). (In Mac OS X, a portrait image cannot be rotated
180 degrees.)
ABCD
ABCD
Windows
(1) (2)
(1) Select the setting on the [Main] tab.
(2) Select the [Rotate 180 degrees] checkbox
.
Macintosh
(1) (2)
3-38
(1) Select [Page Setup] from the [File] menu and click the button.
In Mac OS 9, select [Page Setup] from the [File] menu and select [PostScript Options]. Then select the [Flip
Horizontal] and [Flip Vertical] checkbox .
(2) Click the [OK] button.
ENLARGING/REDUCING THE PRINT IMAGE
(Zoom/XY-Zoom)
This function is used to enlarge or reduce the image to a selected percentage. This allows you to enlarge a small image or add margins to the paper by slightly reducing an image.
When using the PS printer driver (Windows), you can set the width and length percentages separately to change the proportions of the image. (XY-Zoom)
Windows
(1)
(1) Click the [Paper] tab.
(2) Select [Zoom] and click the [Settings] button.
The actual paper size to be used for printing can be selected from the pull-down menu.
(3) Select the zoom ratio.
Directly enter a number (%) or click the button to change the ratio in increments of 1%. You can also select
[Upper Left] or [Center] for the base point on the paper.
(2)
(3)
Macintosh
(1) Select [Page Setup] from the [File] menu and enter the ratio (%).
In Mac OS 9, select [Page Setup] from the [File] menu and enter the ratio (%).
(2) Click the [OK] button.
(1) (2)
3-39
ADJUSTING LINE WIDTHS WHEN PRINTING
(Line Width Settings)
(This function is only available in Windows.)
When lines in special applications such as CAD cannot be printed correctly, this setting can be used to adjust line widths, such as making overall line widths wider.
(This setting is only effective for vector data; raster data such as bitmap images cannot be adjusted.) When the data includes lines of varying widths, you can also print all lines at the minimum width. (Only for black and white printing.)
Windows
(This function can be used when the PCL6 and SAPL-c printer driver is used.)
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Advanced] tab.
(2) Adjust the line width.
Select a number from the pull-down menu.
• The units of line-width adjustment can be set to
"Fixed Width" or "Ratio". Click the [Compatibility] button and select the units from the "Line Width
Unit" menu.
• To print all lines in the data at the minimum line width, click the [Compatibility] button and select the
[Minimum Line Width] checkbox ( ).
3-40
REVERSING THE IMAGE (Mirror Image)
The image can be reversed to create a mirror image.
This function can be used to conveniently print a design for a woodblock print or other printing medium.
B B
Windows
(This function can be used when the PS printer driver is used.)
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Advanced] tab.
(2) Select a mirror image setting.
If you wish to reverse the image horizontally, select
[Horizontal]. If you wish to reverse the image vertically, select [Vertical].
Macintosh
(This function can only be used in Mac OS 9.)
(1) (2)
(1) Select [Page Setup] from the [File] menu and select [PostScript Options].
(2) Select "Visual Effects".
To reverse the image horizontally, select [Flip Horizontal].
To reverse the image vertically, select [Flip Vertical].
(3) Click the [OK] button.
(3)
3-41
COLOUR MODE ADJUSTMENT FUNCTION
ADJUSTING THE BRIGHTNESS AND CONTRAST OF
THE IMAGE (Colour Adjustment)
The brightness and contrast can be adjusted in the print settings when printing a photo or other image. These settings can be used for simple corrections when you do not have image editing software installed on your computer.
Windows
(1)
(1) Click the [Color] tab.
(2) Click the [Color Adjustment] button.
(3) Adjust the colour settings.
To adjust a setting, drag the slide bar
or button.
or click the
(2)
(3)
Macintosh
(This function can only be used in Mac OS X v10.3.9 and v10.4.11.)
(1)
(1) Select [Color].
(2) Click the [Color Adjustment] button.
(3) Select the [Color Adjustment] checkbox and adjust the colour.
Adjust the settings by dragging the slide bars .
(3)
(2)
3-42
PRINTING FAINT TEXT AND LINES IN BLACK
(Text To Black/Vector To Black)
(This function is only available in Windows.)
When printing a colour image in greyscale, colour text and lines that are faint can be printed in black. (Raster data such as bitmap images cannot be adjusted.) This allows you to bring out colour text and lines that are faint and difficult to see when printed in greyscale.
• [Text To Black] can be selected to print all text other than white text in black.
• [Vector To Black] can be selected to print all vector graphics other than white lines and areas in black.
ABCD ABCD
Windows
(1)
(1) Click the [Color] tab.
(2) Select the [Text To Black] checkbox and/or the [Vector To Black] checkbox .
(2)
3-43
SELECTING COLOUR SETTINGS TO MATCH THE
IMAGE TYPE (Advanced Colour)
Preset colour settings are available in the machine's printer driver for various uses. These enable printing using the most suitable colour settings for the colour image type.
Advanced colour settings can also be configured to match the objective of the colour image, such as colour management settings and the screening setting for adjustment of colour tone expression.
Windows
(1)
(3)
(2)
(1) Click the [Color] tab.
(2) Select the "Image Type".
A document type to match the data to be printed can be selected from the pull-down menu.
• Standard (for data that includes text, photos, graphs, etc.)
• Graphics (for data with many drawings or illustrations)
• Photo (for photo data or data that uses photos)
• CAD (for engineering drawing data)
• Scan (for data scanned by a scanner)
• Colorimetric (Data which needs to be printed in almost the same colours as those on the screen)
• Custom (for data to be printed with special settings)
(3) Select advanced colour settings.
If you wish to select advanced settings, click the
[Advanced Color] button.
If you wish to perform colour management using
Windows ICM* in your operating system, select [Custom] for the image type at step (2) and then select the
[Windows ICM] checkbox . To configure advanced colour management settings such as "Source Profile", select the desired settings from the menus.
*Cannot be selected when using the PS printer driver on
Windows Vista/Server 2008/7.
3-44
Macintosh
(2)
(1)
(3)
(4)
(1) Select [Color].
(2) Select colour print settings.
To use the Mac OS Color Management function, select the [ColorSync] checkbox . When this is done, "Image
Type" cannot be selected.
(3) Select the colour image type.
An image type to match the data to be printed can be selected from the pull-down menu.
• Standard (for data that includes text, photos, graphs, etc.)
• Graphics (for data with many drawings or illustrations)
• Photo (for photo data or data that uses photos)
• CAD (for engineering drawing data)
• Scan (for data scanned by a scanner)
• Colorimetric (Data which needs to be printed in almost the same colours as those on the screen)
• Custom (for data to be printed with special settings)
[Neutral Gray] can be used when [Custom] is selected.
(4) Select advanced colour settings.
If you wish to select detailed settings, click the [Advanced
Color] button.
To configure colour management settings, select the desired settings from the menus. To use "CMYK
Simulation", select the [CMYK Simulation] checkbox and then select the desired setting.
• In Mac OS X v10.5 to 10.5.8 and v10.6 to 10.6.2, click the [Advanced] tab to configure advanced colour settings.
• In Mac OS X v10.2.8, select the colour image type from the "Image Type" menu.
• In Mac OS 9, select [Color], [Color2], and [Color3] to configure colour print settings.
The following colour management settings are available.
(There may be certain settings that cannot be configured depending on your OS and type of printer driver.)
• Windows ICM checkbox: Colour management method in a Windows environment
• ColorSync checkbox:
• Source Profile:
• Rendering Intent:
Colour management method in a Macintosh environment
Select the colour profile used to display the image on the computer screen.
• Output Profile:
• CMYK Correction:
Standard value used when converting the colour balance of the image displayed on the computer screen to a colour balance that can be printed by the machine.
Selecting a colour profile for the image to be printed
When printing a CMYK image, you can correct the image to obtain the optimum result.
• Screening:
• Neutral Gray:
• Pure Black Print:
• Trapping:
• Sharpness:
• Black Overprint:
• CMYK Simulation:
• Simulation Profile:
Select the most suitable image processing method for the image being printed.
Select the toner colour used to print grey areas.
Data in black colour can be printed with a black toner only.
Facilitates the prevention of white splotches on the circumference of the colour.
It makes the outline of the image clearer and smooth.
Prevents whitening of the outline of black text.
The colour can be adjusted to simulate printing using the process colours used by printing presses.
Selecting a process colour
3-45
PRINTING IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE COLOUR
BALANCE OF THE MACHINE
(This function is only available in Windows.)
When printing in colour or greyscale, if the colour information of the machine is different from the colour information when the data is processed on the computer, a satisfactory print result may not be obtained.
If you feel that the colour of the print result is not correct, it is recommended that you perform "Output Level".
In the following cases in particular, be sure to perform "Output Level" to obtain the machine's colour information before printing.
• When printing for the first time after installing the printer driver.
• After you have performed colour balance adjustment on the machine.
• After you have performed Print Density Level on the machine.
Windows
(This function can be used when the SAPL-c printer driver is used.)
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Color] tab.
(2) Click the [Output Level] button.
(3) Click the [OK] button.
(3)
3-46
FUNCTIONS THAT COMBINE TEXT AND
IMAGES
ADDING A WATERMARK TO PRINTED PAGES
(Watermark)
Faint shadow-like text can be added to the background of the printed image as a watermark. The size, colour, density, and angle of the watermark text can be adjusted. The text can be selected from a pre-stored list, or entered to create an original watermark.
CONFIDENTIAL
Windows
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Watermarks] tab.
(2) Select the watermark settings.
Select a stored water mark from the pull-down menu. You can click the [Edit] button to edit the font colour and select other detailed settings.
If you wish to create a new watermark...
Enter the text of the watermark in the "Text" box and click the [Add] button.
Macintosh
(2) (1)
(1) Select [Watermarks].
(2) Click the [Watermark] checkbox and configure watermark settings.
Detailed watermark settings can be configured such as selection of the text and editing of the font and colour.
Adjust the size and angle of the text by dragging the slide bar .
In Mac OS 9, select [Watermark] and configure the settings.
3-47
PRINTING AN IMAGE OVER THE PRINT DATA
(Image Stamp)
(This function is only available in Windows.)
A bitmap or JPEG image stored on your computer can be printed over the print data. The size, position, and angle of the image can be adjusted. This feature can be used to "stamp" the print data with a frequently used image or an icon of your own creation.
MEMO
MEMO
Windows
(This function can be used when the PCL6 or PS printer driver is used.)
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Watermarks] tab.
(2) Select the image stamp setting.
If an image stamp has already been stored, it can be selected from the pull-down menu.
If you have not stored an image stamp, click the [Image
File], select the file you wish to use for the image stamp, and click the [Add] button.
3-48
CREATING OVERLAYS FOR PRINT DATA (Overlays)
(This function is only available in Windows.)
The print data can be printed in a previously created overlay. By creating table rulings or a decorative frame in an application different from that of the text file and registering the data as an overlay file, an attractive print result can be easily obtained without the need for complex manipulations.
XXXX
XXX
XXXX
XXX
XXXX
1 100
10 150
0 120
10 250
XXXX
XXX
XXXX
XXX
XXXX
1 100
10 150
0 120
10 250
Overlay file
Windows
(This function can be used when the PCL6 or PS printer driver is used.)
Create an overlay file.
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Advanced] tab.
Configure the printer driver settings from the software application that you wish to use to create the overlay file.
(2) Click the [Edit] button.
(3) Create an overlay file.
Click the [Create Overlay] button and specify the name and folder to be used for the overlay file that you wish to create. The file will be created when the settings are completed and printing is started.
(3) • When printing is started, a confirmation message will appear. The overlay file will not be created until the [Yes] button is clicked.
• To register a previously existing overlay file, click the [Load Overlay] button.
Printing with an overlay file
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Advanced] tab.
Configure the printer driver settings from the application from which you wish to print using the overlay file.
(2) Select the overlay file.
A previously created or stored overlay file can be selected from the pull-down menu.
3-49
PRINT FUNCTIONS FOR SPECIAL
PURPOSES
PRINTING SPECIFIED PAGES ON DIFFERENT PAPER
(Different Paper)
• Using this function in a Windows environment
The front and back cover and specified pages of a document can be printed on paper that is different from the other pages. Use this function when you wish to print the front and back cover on heavy paper, or insert coloured paper or a different paper type at specified pages. You can also insert paper as an insert without printing on it. (Only a cover can be inserted when the SAPL-c printer driver is used.)
• Using this function in a Macintosh environment
The front cover and last page can be printed using paper that is different from the other pages. This function can be used, for example, when you want to print only the front cover and last page on thick paper.
1
2
3
4
5
Windows
(1) (2)
(3)
(1) Click the [Special Modes] tab.
(2) Select [Different Paper] and click the
[Settings] button.
(3) Select paper insertion settings.
Select the insertion position, paper source, and printing method from the corresponding menus. Click the [Add] button to show the selected settings in "Information".
When you have completed the settings, click the [Save] button in "User Settings" to save the settings.
• When [Bypass Tray] is selected in "Paper Source", be sure to select the "Paper Type" and load that type of paper in the bypass tray.
• About paper insertion settings
When [Other Page] is selected for "Insert Position", the insert position can be specified by directly entering a page number. However, inserts cannot be successively inserted at the same page. When
"Printing Method" is set to [2-Sided], the specified page and the next page after it will be printed on the front and reverse side of the paper, and thus an insert setting at a page printed on the reverse side will not be effective.
3-50
Macintosh
(This function can only be used in Mac OS 9, Mac OS X v10.4.11, v10.5 to 10.5.8 and v10.6 to 10.6.2.)
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Select [Printer Features].
(2) Select [Different Paper].
(3) Select cover insertion settings.
Select the print setting, paper tray, and paper type for the cover page and last page.
In Mac OS 9, select [Different Paper] and then select the settings for the cover page and last page.
3-51
ADDING INSERTS WHEN PRINTING ON
TRANSPARENCY FILM (Transparency Inserts)
When printing on transparency film, this function helps prevent the sheets of transparency film from sticking together by inserting a sheet of paper between each sheet of film. It is also possible to print the same content on each inserted sheet of paper as is printed on the corresponding sheet of transparency film.
A
B C
Windows
(1)
(1) Click the [Special Modes] tab.
(2) Select [Transparency Inserts] and click the
[Settings] button.
(3) Select transparency insert settings.
To print the same content on the insert as is printed on the sheet of transparency film, select the [Printed] checkbox . Select the paper source and type if needed.
(2)
Set [Transparency] for the "Paper Type" of the bypass tray.
(3)
Macintosh
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Select [Printer Features].
(2) Select [Transparency Inserts].
(3) Select transparency insert settings.
To print the same content on the insert as is printed on the sheet of transparency film, select [Print] in "Transparency
Inserts". Select the paper source and type if needed.
• Set [Transparency] for the "Paper Type" of the bypass tray.
• In Mac OS X v10.2.8, select the [Transparency
Inserts] checkbox in [Advanced].
• In Mac OS 9, select [Transparency Inserts] and select from the "Transparency Inserts" menu. Select the paper source and type if needed.
3-52
PRINTING A CARBON COPY (Carbon Copy)
(This function is only available in Windows.)
This function is used to print an additional copy of the print image on paper that is the same size but from a different paper tray.
For example, if carbon copy print is selected when standard paper is loaded in tray 1 and coloured paper is loaded in tray 2, a print result similar to a carbon copy slip can be obtained with a single selection of the print command. As another example, if standard paper is loaded in tray 1 and recycled paper is loaded in tray 2,
Carbon Copy can simultaneously print one copy for presentation and one copy as a duplicate.
A
A
A
A
Windows
(This function can be used when the PCL6 or PS printer driver is used.)
(1)
(1) Click the [Special Modes] tab.
(2) Select [Carbon Copy] and click the
[Settings] button.
(3) Select the carbon copy settings.
Select the tray for the "Top Copy" and then select the tray for the carbon copy (or copies) in "Carbon Copy".
When the bypass tray is selected, be sure to select the "Paper Type".
(2)
(3)
3-53
PRINTING TEXT ON TABS OF TAB PAPER
(Tab Paper Print/Tab Paper Settings)
(This function is only available in Windows.)
This function is used to print text on the tabs of tab paper.
Tab Paper Print (PCL6 only)
You can print on each sheet of tab paper that you insert in the desired page position.
Text to be printed on tabs can be entered in [Tab Paper
Print] on the [Special Modes] tab of the printer driver properties window, and detailed settings can be configured such as the size of the tabs, the starting position, the distance between tabs, and the page numbers where tab sheets will be inserted.
Tab Paper Settings (PCL6, PS only)
Text to be printed on tab papers can be created in a software application, and then [Tab Paper Settings] on the [Advanced] tab of the printer driver properties window can be used to specify how far the text needs to be shifted for tab printing.
Original image Printed on the tab paper
3-54
Windows
Tab Paper Print (PCL6 only)
Open the data that you wish to print on the tab paper and then select the settings.
(1) (2)
(1) Click the [Special Modes] tab.
(2) Select [Tab Paper Print] and click the
[Settings] button.
(3) Select the tab position settings.
For commercially available tab paper, you can use the existing settings in "User Settings" such as [A4-5tab-D].
For other types of tab paper, the position of the first tab, the distance between tabs, and the horizontal and vertical dimensions of the tab can be directly entered or changed using the button. In addition, the size of the tab paper can be selected in "Paper Size".
(4) Select the page settings.
Specify the pages where you wish to insert tab paper and enter the text that you wish to print on the tabs. You can also select the font and adjust the layout.
(3)
(4)
• Set [Tab Paper] for the "Paper Type" of the bypass tray.
• The tab paper settings can be stored and a stored file opened in "User Settings".
3-55
Tab Paper Settings (PCL6, PS only)
When you have finished preparing the data to be printed on the tabs in the software application, select the following settings:
(1) Click the [Advanced] tab.
(4) (1)
(2) Click the [Tab Paper Settings] button.
(3) Select the tab paper settings.
To shift the image, directly enter a number or click the
button.
(4) Select the paper source and type.
Click the [Paper] tab, and select [Bypass Tray] for "Paper
Source" and [Tab Paper] for "Paper Type".
(2)
Set [Tab Paper] for the "Paper Type" of the bypass tray.
(3)
3-56
TWO-SIDED PRINTING WITH SPECIFIC PAGES PRINTED
ON THE FRONT SIDE (Chapter Inserts)
(This function is only available in Windows.)
You can have specific pages printed on the front side of the paper.
When a page (such as the first page of a chapter) is specified as a front side page, the page will be printed on the front side of the paper even if would normally be printed on the reverse side (the reverse side will be left blank and the page will be printed on the front side of the next sheet of paper).
Example:
When pages 4 and 8 are specified as page settings.
Back is blank
Windows
(This function can be used when the PCL6 printer driver is used.)
(1)
(2)
(1) Click the [Special Modes] tab.
(2) Select [Chapter Inserts] and click the
[Settings] button.
(3) Select the chapter settings.
Enter the page numbers that are to begin chapters in
"Page Settings". Click the [Add] button and your settings will appear in "Information". When you have finished selecting settings, click the [Save] button in "User
Settings" to save the settings.
(3)
3-57
CONVENIENT PRINTER FUNCTIONS
USING TWO MACHINES TO PRINT A LARGE PRINT
JOB (Tandem Print)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
Two machines are required to use this function.
Tandem Print allows you to divide a large print job between two machines connected to your network.
The machines simultaneously print each half of the job, making it possible to shorten the printing time when printing a large number of sets.
Example: Printing 4 sets of copies
To use Tandem Print, the IP address of the slave machine configured in "Tandem Connection Setting" in the machine's system settings (administrator) must be configured in the printer driver. In a Windows environment, this can be accomplished automatically by clicking the [Auto Configuration] button on the
[Configuration] tab of the printer driver. In a Macintosh environment, this can be accomplished automatically by clicking the [Tandem Settings] button.
2 sets of copies
2 sets of copies
Windows
(This function can be used when the PCL6 or PS printer driver is used.)
(1) Click the [Advanced] tab.
(1) (2)
(2) Select the [Tandem Print] checkbox .
The tandem print function can be used only when the printer driver is installed using a "Custom installation" with "LPR Direct Print (Specify Address/Auto Search)" and checking "Yes" for "Do you want to use 'Tandem
Print' function?"
Macintosh
(This function can only be used in Mac OS X.)
(2) (1)
3-58
(1) Select [Tandem Print].
(2) Select the [Tandem Print] checkbox .
To use the tandem print function, the protocol to be used must be selected in accordance with the message that appears in the left screen when adding the printer driver with the "Printer Setup Utility" ("Print
Center" in Mac OS X v10.2.8).
SAVING AND USING PRINT FILES
(Retention/Document Filing)
This function is used to store a print job as a file on the machine's hard drive, allowing the job to be printed from the operation panel when needed. The location for storing a file can be selected to prevent the file from being mixed together with files of other users.
When printing from a computer, a password (5 to 8 digits) can be set to maintain the secrecy of information in a stored file.
When a password is set, the password must be entered to print a stored file from the machine.
HDD
Hold Only
This setting is used to hold a print job on the machine's hard drive without printing it.
Hold After Print
This setting is used to hold a print job on the machine's hard drive after it is printed.
Sample Print
When a print job is sent to the machine, only the first set of copies is printed. After checking the contents of the first set of copies, you can print the remaining sets from the operation panel of the machine. This prevents the occurrence of excessive misprints.
FILING".
3-59
Windows
(1) (2)
(3)
(1) Click the [Job Handling] tab.
(2) Select the retention setting.
Click the [Retention] checkbox . Select the retention method in "Retention Settings". To enter a password (5 to
8 digit number), click the [Password] checkbox .
(3) Select document filing settings.
Select the folder for storing the file in "Document Filing
Settings". If you selected [Custom Folder], click the
[Stored to] button to select the folder.
• When [Quick File] is selected, "Retention Settings" will be set to [Hold After Print] only.
• When [Quick File] is selected, the password entered in "Retention Settings" is cleared and cannot be used.
• To store a file in a custom folder, the custom folder must first be created using "Document Filing
Control" in the system settings (administrator). If a password has been established for a custom folder, enter the "Folder Password" in the folder selection screen.
• When [Retention] has been checked on [Printing
Policy] on the [Configuration] tab, the [Retention] checkbox is always checked and you cannot change the checkbox.
• In an IPV6 environment, files can only be stored in the main folder.
3-60
Macintosh
(2) (1)
(1) Select [Job Handling].
(2) Select the retention setting.
Click the [Retention] checkbox . Select the retention method in "Retention Settings". To simplify operation the next time the same password is set, click the (lock) button after entering the password (5 to 8 digit number).
(3) Select document filing settings.
Select the folder for storing the file in "Document Filing
Settings". If you selected [Custom Folder], click the
[Stored to] button to select the folder.
(3)
• When [Quick File] is selected, "Retention Settings" will be set to [Hold After Print] only.
• When [Quick File] is selected, the password entered in "Retention Settings" is cleared and cannot be used.
• To store a file in a custom folder, the custom folder must first be created using "Document Filing
Control" in the system settings (administrator). If a password has been established for a custom folder, enter the "Folder Password" in the folder selection screen.
• In Mac OS X v10.5 to 10.5.8 and v10.6 to 10.6.2, if you wish to store document filing settings in a custom folder, click the [Custom Folder] tab.
• In Mac OS 9, select [Job Handling] and then select the retention setting. (The document filing function cannot be used.)
Automatically print all stored data
When user authentication is enabled in the system settings (administrator), all retained (stored) print jobs of a user who logs in can be printed automatically after log in.
After all jobs are printed, the files are deleted.
To use the print all function, the following steps are necessary:
• "Automatically print stored jobs after login" must be enabled in the system settings (administrator) of the machine.
• At the time of retention print, in addition to user authentication information, the user name stored in the machine must be entered in "User Name" of the job ID in the printer driver.
☞
Windows:
PRINTING WHEN THE USER AUTHENTICATION FUNCTION IS ENABLED (page 3-8)
☞
Macintosh:
PRINTING WHEN THE USER AUTHENTICATION FUNCTION IS ENABLED (page 3-22)
(1) Log into the machine.
Enter your user number or login name and password in the user authentication screen of the machine.
(2) Perform print all.
A confirmation prompt will appear. Touch the [OK] key. The print files stored in the quick file folder, main folder, and custom folder will be printed automatically and then deleted.
Files with a password and files that are protected by the document filing function of the machine will not be printed. Files in a folder (excluding My Folder) that has a password will also not be printed.
If you do not wish to "print all"...
Touch the [Cancel] key in step (2).
3-61
PRINTING WITHOUT THE PRINTER
DRIVER
This function requires the hard disk drive.
When you do not have the printer driver installed on your computer, or when the software application used to open a file that you wish to print is not available, you can print directly to the machine without using the printer driver.
To print a file directly to the machine, the printer expansion kit must be installed.
The file types (and corresponding extensions) that can be printed directly are shown below.
File Type
Extension
TIFF tiff, tif
JPEG jpeg, jpg, jpe, jfif
PCL pcl
PDF/
Encrypted
PDF pdf
PS ps
XPS xps
• Even if the print result is black and white, the following types of print jobs will be counted as 4-colour (Y (Yellow), M (Magenta), C
(Cyan), and Bk (Black)) print jobs. To be always counted as a black and white job, select black and white printing.
- When the data is created as colour data.
- When the application treats the data as colour data even though the data is black and white.
- When an image is hidden under a black and white image.
• To print PDF and PS files, the PS3 expansion kit must be installed.
• To print XPS files, the XPS expansion kit must be installed.
• Depending on the file type, it may not be possible to print some files in the above table.
DIRECTLY PRINTING FROM THE MACHINE
This function requires the hard disk drive.
A file on an FTP server, in a network folder or in a USB memory device connected to the machine can be selected and printed from the operation panel of the machine without using the printer driver.
3-62
DIRECTLY PRINTING A FILE ON AN FTP SERVER
This function requires the hard disk drive.
When an FTP server is configured in the machine's Web pages, you can specify and print a file on the FTP server from the operation panel of the machine. This saves you the trouble of downloading the file and printing it from a computer.
For the procedure for accessing the Web pages, see the Start Guide.
To configure FTP server settings, click [Application Settings] and then [Setting for Print from the MFP(FTP)] in the Web page menu. (Administrator rights are required.) Up to 20 FTP servers can be configured.
1
COPY IMAGE SEND
(1)
DOCUMENT
FILING
(2)
File Retrieve Scan to HDD
External Data Access
HDD Status Ex Data Access
(3)
FTP
USB Memory
Network Folder
Access the FTP server.
(1) Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key.
(2) Touch the [Ex Data Access] tab.
(3) Touch the [FTP] key.
The [FTP] key cannot be touched when any FTP server has not been configured.
2
File Retrieve
FTP
Scan to HDD
Server 1
Server 2
Server 3
Server 4
Server 5
Server 6
Server 7
HDD Status Ex Data Access
1
3
Back
Touch the key of the FTP server that you wish to access.
3
Server 1
File or Folder Name
File-01.tiff
Folder01
File-02.tiff
File-03.tiff
Folder02
File-04.tiff
File-05.tiff
1
1
Touch the key of the file that you wish to print.
• The icon appears to the left of keys of files that can be printed.
• The icon is displayed to the left of keys of folders on the
FTP server. To display the files and folders in a folder, touch the key of the folder.
• A total of 100 keys of files and folders can be displayed.
• Touch the key to move up one folder level.
• When you move down a folder level by touching a folder key, the key appears in the top right corner of the screen. Touch this key to return to the file or folder name selection screen.
• Touch the [File or Folder Name] key to change the order of the files and folders displayed on the screen. The order switches between ascending order and descending order each time you touch the key.
3-63
4
File-01.tiff
Paper Select
Auto
Output
2-Sided
Quick File
Number of Prints
1
(1 999)
(1)
B/W Print
Fit To Page
(2)
Cancel
Print the selected file.
(1) Select print conditions.
If you selected a file (PCL, PS, or XPS) in step 3 that includes print settings, the settings will be applied.
(2) Touch the [Print] key.
Printing begins. When the message appears in the touch panel, touch the [OK] key.
When you select a PDF file that has a password, you must enter the password in the job status screen to begin printing.
☞
PRINTING AN ENCRYPTED PDF FILE (page 3-74)
DIRECTLY PRINTING A FILE IN USB MEMORY
This function requires the hard disk drive.
A file in a USB memory device connected to the machine can be printed from the operation panel of the machine without using the printer driver. When the printer driver of the machine is not installed on your computer, you can copy a file into a commercially available USB memory device and connect the device to the machine to print the file directly.
Connect the USB memory device to the machine.
1
Use a FAT32 USB memory with a capacity of no more than 32 GB.
3-64
2
COPY IMAGE SEND
(1)
DOCUMENT
FILING
(2)
File Retrieve Scan to HDD
External Data Access
HDD Status Ex Data Access
(3)
FTP
USB Memory
Network Folder
Access the USB memory device.
(1) Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key.
(2) Touch the [Ex Data Access] tab.
(3) Touch the [USB Memory] key.
System Settings(Administrator) : Disabling of USB Memory Direct Print
This setting is used to disable printing of files in a USB memory.
When this setting is enabled, [USB Memory] key cannot be touched.
3
USB Memory
File or Folder Name
File-01.tiff
Folder01
File-02.tiff
File-03.tiff
Folder02
File-04.tiff
File-05.tiff
1
1
Touch the key of the file that you wish to print.
• The icon appears to the left of keys of files that can be printed.
• The icon is displayed to the left of keys of folders in the
USB memory. To display the files and folders in a folder, touch the key of the folder.
• A total of 100 keys of files and folders can be displayed.
• Touch the key to move up one folder level.
• When you move down a folder level by touching a folder key, the key appears in the top right corner of the screen. Touch this key to return to the file or folder name selection screen.
• Touch the [File or Folder Name] key to change the order of the files and folders displayed on the screen. The order switches between ascending order and descending order each time you touch the key.
4
File-01.tiff
Paper Select
Auto
Output
2-Sided
Quick File
Number of Prints
1
(1 999)
B/W Print
Fit To Page
(2)
Cancel
Print the selected file.
(1) Select print conditions.
If you selected a file (PCL, PS, or XPS) in step 3 that includes print settings, the settings will be applied.
(2) Touch the [Print] key.
Printing begins after the selected file is transferred. When the message appears in the touch panel, touch the [OK] key.
(1)
To cancel printing...
To cancel printing while the file is being transferred, touch the [Cancel] key in the message screen that appears in the touch panel.
3-65
Remove the USB memory device from the machine.
5
When you select a PDF file that has a password, you must enter the password in the job status screen to begin printing.
☞
PRINTING AN ENCRYPTED PDF FILE (page 3-74)
DIRECTLY PRINTING A FILE IN A NETWORK FOLDER
This function requires the hard disk drive.
You can use the machine's operation panel to select and print a file on a server or in a shared folder of an individual's computer on the same network as the machine.
1
COPY IMAGE SEND
(1)
DOCUMENT
FILING
(2)
File Retrieve Scan to HDD
External Data Access
HDD Status Ex Data Access
(3)
FTP
USB Memory
Network Folder
Access the network.
(1) Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key.
(2) Touch the [Ex Data Access] tab.
(3) Touch the [Network Folder] key.
System Settings(Administrator) : Disabling of Network Folder Direct Print
This setting is used to disable printing of files in a network folder.
When this setting is enabled, [Network Folder] key cannot be touched.
3-66
Select workgroup.
Workgroup
Workgroup Name
Work 1
Work 2
Work 3
Work 4
Work 5
Work 6
2
Select server.
Server
Work 1
Server Name
Server 1
Server 2
Server 3
Server 4
Server 5
Server 6
Select network folder.
Network Folder
\\Server 1
Network Folder Name
User 1
User 2
User 3
User 4
User 5
User 6
Search
1
17
Search
1
17
Search
1
17
Access the network folder.
(1) Touch the key of the workgroup that you wish to access.
(2) Touch the key of the server or computer that you wish to access.
If a screen appears prompting you to enter a user name and password, check with your server administrator and enter the appropriate user name and password.
(3) Touch the key of the network folder.
• You can touch the [Search] key and enter a keyword to search for a workgroup, server, or network folder. For the procedure for entering text, see "
ENTERING TEXT " (page 1-67) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
• Up to 100 workgroups, 100 servers, and 100 network folders can be displayed.
• Touch the key to move up one folder level.
• To return to the workgroup selection screen, touch the key.
• To change the sorting order of the displayed keys, touch the key that shows or in each screen. The order switches between ascending order and descending order each time you touch the key.
• To go to a particular page, touch the
1
key that shows the current page number and enter the desired page number.
3-67
3
\\Server 1\User 1
File or Folder Name
File-01.tiff
Folder01
File-02.tiff
File-03.tiff
Folder02
File-04.tiff
File-05.tiff
1
15
Touch the key of the file that you wish to print.
• The icon appears to the left of keys of files that can be printed.
• The icon is displayed to the left of keys of folders in the network folder. To display the files and folders in a folder, touch the key of the folder.
• A total of 100 keys of files and folders can be displayed.
• Touch the key to move up one folder level.
• To return to the network folder selection screen, touch the key.
• Touch the [File or Folder Name] key to change the order of the files and folders displayed on the screen. The order switches between ascending order and descending order each time you touch the key.
4
File-01.tiff
Paper Select
Auto
Output
2-Sided
Quick File
Number of Prints
1
(1 999)
(1)
B/W Print
Fit To Page
(2)
Cancel
Print the selected file.
(1) Select print conditions.
If you selected a file (PCL, PS, or XPS) in step 3 that includes print settings, the settings will be applied.
(2) Touch the [Print] key.
Printing begins after the selected file is transferred. When the message appears in the touch panel, touch the [OK] key.
When you select a PDF file that has a password, you must enter the password in the job status screen to begin printing.
☞
PRINTING AN ENCRYPTED PDF FILE (page 3-74)
3-68
DIRECTLY PRINTING FROM A COMPUTER
This function requires the hard disk drive.
Settings can be configured in the Web pages of the machine to enable direct printing from a computer without using the printer driver. For the procedure for accessing the Web pages, see the Start Guide.
SUBMIT PRINT JOB
You can specify a file to be printed directly without using the printer driver.
In addition to a file on your computer, this procedure can be used to print any file that can be accessed from your computer, such as a file on another computer connected to the same network.
To directly print a file on a computer, click [Document Operations] and then [Submit Print Job] in the Web page menu.
FTP PRINT
You can print a file from your computer by simply dragging and dropping the file onto the FTP server of the machine.
• Configuring settings
To enable FTP Print, click [Application Settings] and then [Setting for Print from the PC] in the Web page menu, and configure the port number. (Administrator rights are required.)
• Performing FTP Print
Type "ftp://" and then the IP address of the machine in the address bar of your computer's Web browser as shown below.
(Example) ftp://192.168.1.28
Drag and drop the file that you wish to print onto the "lp" folder that appears in your Web browser. The file will automatically begin printing.
• If you printed a file (PCL, PS, or XPS) that includes print settings, the settings will be applied.
• When user authentication is enabled in the system settings (administrator) of the machine, the print function may be restricted. For more information, ask your administrator.
3-69
E-MAIL PRINT
An e-mail account can be configured in the machine to have the machine periodically check your mail server and automatically print received e-mail attachments without using the printer driver.
• Configuring settings
To use E-mail Print, you must first configure an e-mail account in the machine. To configure an account, click
[Application Settings] and then [E-mail Print Settings] in the Web page menu. (Administrator rights are required.)
For the procedure for accessing the Web pages, see the Start Guide.
• Using E-mail Print
To print a file using E-mail Print, use your e-mail program on your computer to send the file as an attachment to the machine's e-mail address.
Control commands can be entered in the message of the e-mail to specify the number of copies and print format.
Commands are entered in the format "command name = value".
As an example, the control commands include the following:
Example Function
Copies
Staples* 1
Punch* 2
Output
2-sided print
Account number* 3
File type
Command name
COPIES
STAPLEOPTION
PUNCH
COLLATE
DUPLEX
ACCOUNTNUMBER
1-999
NONE, ONE, TWO
Values
OFF, ON
OFF, ON
OFF, TOP, LEFT, RIGHT
Number (5 to 8 digits)
Paper
Document Filing
Quick File
Output tray
LANGUAGE
PAPER
FILE
FOLDERNAME
QUICKFILE
OUTTRAY
PCL, PCLXL, POSTSCRIPT, PDF, TIFF,
JPG, XPS
Name of available paper (A4, LETTER, etc.)
OFF, ON
Maximum of 28 characters
OFF, ON
CENTER, RIGHT
Black & white printing
B/W PRINT OFF, ON
Fit to page FITIMAGETOPAGE OFF, ON
*1 Only effective when a finisher is installed.
*2 Only effective when a punch module is installed on a finisher.
*3 Can be omitted except when authentication is by user number.
COPIES=2
DUPLEX=LEFT
ACCOUNTNUMBER=11111
PAPER=A4
B/W PRINT=ON
• Enter the commands in Plain Text format. If entered in Rich Text format (HTML), the commands will have no effect.
• To receive a list of the control commands, enter the command "Config" in the e-mail message.
• If nothing is entered in the body text (message) of the e-mail, printing will take place according to the "Printer Default
Settings" in the system settings. If you printed a file (PCL, PS, or XPS) that includes print settings, the settings will be applied.
• Only enter a "File type" when you are specifying a page-description language. Normally there is no need to enter a file type.
3-70
CHECKING THE PRINT STATUS
JOB STATUS SCREEN
The job status screen is displayed when the [JOB STATUS] key on the operation panel is pressed. The job status screen shows the status of jobs by mode. When the [JOB STATUS] key is pressed, the job status screen of the mode that was being used before the key was pressed appears.
JOB STATUS
2
3
4
1
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Copy
Copy
0312345678
Scan to Fax Job
Sets / Progress
002 / 001
Internet Fax
Status
Printing
Waiting 002 / 000
020 / 000
001 / 000
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
The job status display (A) is in the lower left corner of the touch panel. The job status display can be touched to display the job status screen. You can check the first four print jobs in the print queue (the job in progress and reserved jobs) in the job status display (B).
Ready to scan for copy.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Job Status
MFP Status
002/001
Printing
Output
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
File
Quick File
002/000
Waiting
020/000
Waiting
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
001/000
Waiting
Tray1
(A) (B)
3-71
SPOOL SCREEN/JOB QUEUE SCREEN/COMPLETED
JOB SCREEN
The job status screen consists of the job queue screen that shows copy and print jobs waiting to be printed and the job currently in progress, the completed job screen that shows jobs that have been completed, and the spool screen that shows print jobs that have been spooled and encrypted PDF jobs that are waiting for a password to be entered.
(1)
(3)
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Computer02
Computer03
Computer04
Computer05
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Sets / Progress
020 / ---
Status
Ripping
020 / ---
--- / ---
--- / ---
002 / ---
Spooling
Spooling
Spooling
Encrypt PDF
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
(2)
Stop/Delete
(4)
1
2
3
4
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Copy
Copy
0312345678
Scan to
Sets / Progress
002 / 001
002 / 000
020 / 000
001 / 000
Fax Job
Status
Printing
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(5)
(6)
(7)
(1) Mode select tabs
Use these tabs to select the mode that is shown in the job status screen.
The status of print jobs can be checked by touching the
[Print Job] tab.
(2) Job status screen selector key
Touch this key to switch through the job queue screen, the completed jobs screen, and the spool screen.
When the hard disk drive is not installed, [Spool] is not displayed.
(3) Job list (spool screen)
Spooled print jobs and encrypted PDF print jobs that require a password to be entered are displayed.
(4) Job list (job queue screen)
Jobs waiting to be printed appear in the job queue as keys. The jobs are printed in order from the top of the queue. Each job key shows information on the job and the current status of the job.
(5) [Detail] key (job queue screen)
Touch this key to display detailed information on a job.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Print Job
Jobs Completed
Computer02
Computer03
Computer04 file-01
Copy
Copy
Computer05
Copy
Scan to Fax Job
Set Time Sets Status
11:00 04/01 001/001 OK
10:33 04/01 010/010 OK
10:31 04/01 013/013 OK
10:30 04/01 010/010 OK
10:13 04/01 001/001 OK
10:03 04/01 001/001 OK
10:01 04/01 003/003 OK
10:00 04/01 010/010 OK
Internet Fax
1
2
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Call
(8)
(9)
(10)
(6) [Priority] key
Touch this key to give priority to a selected job.
(7) [Stop/Delete] key
Touch this key to stop or delete a selected job.
(8) Job list (completed jobs screen)
This shows up to 99 completed jobs. The result (status) of each completed job is shown.
(9) [Detail] key (completed jobs screen)
When a job is shown as a key in the job list, the [Detail] key can be touched to show detailed information on the job.
(10) [Call] key
Touch this key to retrieve and use a print job stored using the document filing function.
When the hard disk drive is not installed, [Spool] is not displayed.
3-72
Job key display
Each job key shows the position of the job in the job queue and the current status of the job.
2 Computer01 002/000 Waiting
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Indicates the number (position) of the job in the job queue.
When the job currently being printed is finished, the job moves up one position in the job queue.
This number does not appear in keys in the completed jobs screen.
(2) Mode icon
The icon appears when the job is a print job. In the completed jobs screen, a colour bar appears next to the icon to indicate whether the job was executed in colour or black & white. (However, the colour bar icon does not appear in the key of a job that used document filing or in the key of a transmission/reception job that was cancelled.)
(3) User name
The computer login name of the user will appear in the print job.
A "User Name" can be entered in the printer driver to display the name of the user who executed the job.
(4) Number of sets entered
This shows the number of sets specified.
(5) Number of completed sets
This shows the number of sets completed. "000" appears while the job is waiting in the job queue.
(4) (5) (6)
(6) Status
Shows the job status.
Message
"Printing"
"Waiting"
"Toner
Empty"
Status
Printing is in progress.
The job is waiting to be executed.
The toner cartridge is out of toner.
Replace the toner cartridge with a new cartridge.
"Paper
Empty"
"Limit"
"Error" An error occurred while the job was being executed. Clear the error condition.
"Rendering" Analyzing print data.
"Spooling"
The paper used for the job has run out. Add paper or change to a different paper tray.
The printing page limit has been exceeded. Check with the administrator of the machine.
"Encrypt
PDF"
Print data is being received or a job is waiting for analysis after being spooled.
Upon analysis, if a spooled job is found to be an encrypted PDF, it changes to the password entry wait state.
3-73
PRINTING AN ENCRYPTED PDF FILE
Encrypted PDF is used to protect a PDF file by requiring the entry of a password to print or edit the file. To directly print an encrypted PDF file on an FTP server or in a USB memory device, etc. connected to the machine, follow the steps below to enter the password and begin printing.
The pritner expansion kit and PS3 expansion kit is required to use this function.
JOB STATUS
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
1
2
(1) (3) (2)
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Computer02
Computer03
Computer04
Computer05
Scan to Fax Job
Sets / Progress
020 / ---
020 / ---
--- / ---
--- / ---
002 / ---
Internet Fax
Status
Rendering
Spooling
Spooling
Spooling
Encrypt PDF
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Stop/Delete
Select the encrypted PDF print job.
(1) Touch the [Print Job] tab.
(2) Change the print job status mode to
[Spool].
Touch this key to change modes. The selected mode will be highlighted.
(3) Touch the print job key of the PDF file that has the password.
Enter the password?
Touch the [Yes] key.
A text entry screen appears. Enter the password (32 characters or less) and touch the [OK] key. The print job is released and moved to the [Job Queue].
No Yes 3
When both a master password and a user password (which is used to open the file) have been set, enter the master password.
• To print an encrypted PDF file using the printer driver, enter the password when opening the file on your computer.
• Printing is not possible if you do not know the password for an encrypted PDF file. To delete a spooled print job, touch the
[No] key in the screen of step 3 and touch the [Stop/Delete] key.
• Encrypted PDF versions that can be directly printed are 1.6 (Adobe ® Acrobat ® 7.0) and earlier.
3-74
GIVING A PRINT JOB
PRIORITY/CANCELLING A PRINT JOB
GIVING A PRINT JOB PRIORITY
When the machine is busy copying or printing a received fax or other job, you can give priority to a print job that is waiting to be printed and print it ahead of the other jobs.
JOB STATUS
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
1
2
(1) (2)
Print Job
Copy
Copy
Copy
Copy
Copy
Job Queue
Computer01
Computer02
0312345678
Scan to Fax Job
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
020 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
Internet Fax
Status
Printing
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(3) (4)
Give the desired job priority.
(1) Touch the [Print Job] tab.
(2) Change the print job status mode to [Job
Queue].
Touch this key to change modes. The selected mode will be highlighted.
(3) Touch the key of the print job to which you want to give priority.
(4) Touch the [Priority] key.
The job being printed stops and the job selected in (3) is printed.
To check print information on the selected job, touch the [Detail] key.
3-75
CANCELLING A PRINT JOB
A job being printed, a job waiting to be printed, or a spooled job can be cancelled.
JOB STATUS
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
1
2
(1) (2)
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Computer02
0312345678
Copy
Copy
Copy
Copy
Copy
Scan to Fax Job
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
020 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
002 / 000
Internet Fax
Status
Printing
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(3) (4)
Cancel the job.
(1) Touch the [Print Job] tab.
(2) Change the print job status mode to [Spool] or [Job Queue].
Touch this key to change modes. The selected mode will be highlighted.
(3) Touch the key of the print job that you wish to cancel.
(4) Touch the [Stop/Delete] key.
(5) A message appears to confirm the cancellation. Touch the [Yes] key.
Delete the job?
Computer02
No Yes
The selected job key is deleted and printing is cancelled.
It is also possible to cancel printing with the [STOP] key ( ) on the operation panel. When the [STOP] key ( ) is pressed, a message will appear asking you if you want to cancel the job.
If you do not want to cancel the selected print job...
Touch the [No] key in step (5).
3-76
CHANGING TO ANOTHER PAPER SIZE AND
PRINTING WHEN PAPER RUNS OUT
If printing stops because the machine ran out of paper, or if the size of paper specified in the printer driver is not loaded in the machine, a message will appear in the touch panel. Printing will begin automatically when the [OK] key is touched and paper is loaded in the machine. If you wish to print on paper in another tray because the desired size of paper is not immediately available, follow the steps below.
JOB STATUS
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
1
2
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Scan to
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
Fax Job Internet Fax
Status
Paper Empty
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
(1) (2)
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
Display details on the print job for which there is no paper.
(1) Touch the key of the job for which "Paper
Empty" appeared.
(2) Touch the [Detail] key.
Touch the [Paper Select] key.
3
Detail
Computer01
Data : File-01.tiff
020 / 000
Colour / B/W : Full Colour
Paper :
A3
Plain
Paper Select
Paper Empty
Document
Style:
2-Sided
(Book)
Output :
Special
Modes:
OK
4
Detail
Computer01
Paper Select
020 / 000
1.A4
2.A4R
3.B4
4.A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Paper Empty
Bypass Tray
A4
Plain
OK
Touch the key of the tray that has the paper you wish to use.
Printing begins.
If you changed to a different paper size, printing may not take place correctly; for example part of the text or image may run off the paper.
3-77
APPENDIX
PRINTER DRIVER SPECIFICATION LIST
Available functions and output results may vary depending on the type of printer driver being used.
Frequently used functions
Function SAPL-c
1-999
Yes
PCL6
1-999
Yes
PS
1-999
Yes
Windows
PPD *1
1-999
Yes
Macintosh
PPD *1
1-999
Yes
Paper
Convenient printer functions
Copies
Orientation
N-Up Number of pages
Order
2-Sided Print
Border
Fit To Page
Binding Edge
Black and White Print
Staple* 3
Punch* 3
Paper Size
Custom Paper
Paper Selection
Output tray
Pamphlet
Margin Shift
Poster Printing
Rotate 180 degrees
Zoom/XY-Zoom
Line Width Settings
Mirror Image
2,4,6,8,9,16
Selectable
On/Off
Yes
Yes
Selectable
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 size
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes* 4
Yes
No
2,4,6,8,9,16
Selectable
On/Off
Yes
Yes
Selectable
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 size
Yes
Yes
Yes
0 mm to
30 mm
Yes
Yes
Yes* 4
Yes
No
2,4,6,8,9,16
Selectable
On/Off
Yes
Yes
Selectable
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 size
Yes
Yes
Yes
0 mm to
30 mm
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
2,4,6,9,16
Selectable
Yes
Yes
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes* 4
No
Yes
2,4,6,9,16
Selectable
Selectable
Yes
Yes* 2
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes* 4
No
Yes* 5
3-78
Function
Special functions Different Paper
Transparency Inserts
Carbon Copy
Tab Printing
Chapter Inserts
Page Interleave
Tandem Print* 14
Colour mode adjusting function
Retention
Document Filing
Colour Adjustment
Text To Black/
Vector To Black
Functions to combine text and images
Advanced Colour
Watermark
Image Stamp
Overlay
Image Quality Print Mode
SAPL-c
Yes* 6
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
PCL6
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
PS
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes* 8
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Windows
PPD *1
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
Macintosh
PPD *1
Yes *6,7
Yes
No
No
No
No
Yes *9
Yes
Yes *9
Yes *9,10,11
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Normal/
High Quality
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Normal/
High Quality
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Normal/
High Quality
Yes
Yes
No
No
Normal/
High Quality
Yes
Yes
No
No
Normal/
High Quality
Font
Graphics Mode
Selection
Toner Save* 12
Resident font
Selectable download font
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
Yes
80 fonts bitmap,
TrueType,
Graphics
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
136 fonts bitmap,
TrueType,
Type1
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
136 fonts bitmap,
TrueType,
Type1
No
No
No
Yes
35 fonts
No* 13
Other functions Auto Configuration
User Authentication
Yes
Yes
Yes *10
Yes
*1 The specifications of each function in Windows PPD and Macintosh PPD vary depending on the operating system version and the software application.
*2 Only Mac OS X v10.4.11, v10.5 to 10.5.8 and v10.6 to 10.6.2 can be used.
*3 Can be used when a finisher is installed. (To use the punch function, a punch module must be also installed.)
*4 The horizontal and vertical proportion cannot be set separately.
*5 Only Mac OS 9.0 to 9.2.2 can be used.
*6 Only covers can be inserted.
*7 Cannot be used in Mac OS X v10.2.8 or v10.3.9.
*8 Only the amount of the shift of the text string data created in the software application can be set.
*9 Cannot be used in Mac OS 9.0 to 9.2.2.
*10 Cannot be used in Mac OS X v10.2.8.
*11 Cannot be used in Mac OS X v10.5 to 10.5.1.
*12 This setting may not operate in some software applications and operating systems.
*13 True Type and Type1 can be selected in some versions of LaserWriter.
*14 This function requires the hard disk drive.
3-79
PRINTER SPECIFICATIONS
Type
Continuous printing speed
Printing resolution
Printer driver type
Supported protocols
Supported client PC operating systems
Built-in
23 pages/min (When printing same document continuously on A4 (8-1/2"x11") plain paper in non-offset mode, excluding processing time.)
600x600 dpi, 9600 equivalent x 600dpi
SAPL-c, PCL6* 1 , PostScript 3 compatible* 2 , XPS* 4
TCP/IP, IPX/SPX, NetBEUI, EtherTalk* 2
See "VERIFYING SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS" in the Software Setup Guide.
Fonts
Interface port
Memory
Print area
PCL6* 1
PostScript 3 compatible* 2
80 European fonts, 28 barcode fonts*
136 European fonts
LAN connectivity: 10Base-T / 100Base-TX / 1000Base-T
USB connectivity: Supports USB 2.0 (Hi speed)
3 , 1 bitmap font
Standard system memory: 1GB
Expansion memory: 1GB* 5
Entire page excluding margin of 4.2mm (11/64") at each edge. The actual print area may vary depending on the printer driver and the software application.
*1 Printer expansion kit is required.
*2 When the PS3 expansion kit is installed and the machine is used as a PostScript printer.
*3 Barcode font kit is required.
*4 When the XPS expansion kit is installed.
*5 Required when there is insufficient memory to handle certain print data. Must be used when the XPS expansion kit is installed.
3-80
CHAPTER 4
FACSIMILE
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the fax function.
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE AS A FAX
PREPARATIONS FOR FAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
LINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
• SETTING THE TELEPHONE LINE TYPE . . . . . 4-5
• MAKE SURE THE MAIN POWER SWITCH
IS IN THE "ON" POSITION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
• CHECKING THE DATE AND TIME . . . . . . . . . . 4-6
• STORING THE SENDER FAX NUMBER . . . . . 4-6
BASE SCREEN OF FAX MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
• BASE SCREEN OF FAX MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8
• ADDRESS BOOK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
BOOK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12
FAX TRANSMISSION SEQUENCE . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
ENTERING DESTINATIONS
ENTERING A FAX NUMBER WITH THE
NUMERIC KEYS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
RETRIEVING A FAX NUMBER FROM THE
ADDRESS BOOK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18
• RETRIEVING A STORED DESTINATION . . . . 4-19
• CHECKING AND DELETING ENTERED
DESTINATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE
A DESTINATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM A
GLOBAL ADDRESS BOOK. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
USING THE RESEND FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
CHAIN DIALLING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
BASIC TRANSMISSION METHODS
TRANSMISSION METHODS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
• PLACEMENT ORIENTATION OF THE
ORIGINAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
TRANSMITTED IMAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
• TRANSMITTABLE ORIGINAL SIZES . . . . . . . 4-29
• THE SIZE OF THE PLACED ORIGINAL . . . . . 4-29
• WHEN THE LINE IS BUSY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
OCCURS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
• FAX DESTINATION CONFIRMATION
MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
FEEDER FOR TRANSMISSION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
• USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT
FEEDER TO SEND A FAX IN DIRECT
TRANSMISSION MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33
TRANSMISSION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
SEND A FAX IN DIRECT TRANSMISSION
MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37
TRANSMISSION USING THE SPEAKER . . . . . . . 4-39
SENDING THE SAME FAX TO MULTIPLE
DESTINATIONS (Broadcast Transmission) . . . . 4-40
COMPUTER (PC-Fax) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45
IMAGE SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
Original) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47
• SPECIFYING THE SCAN SIZE AND
SEND SIZE (Enlarge/Reduce) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48
• CHANGING THE EXPOSURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55
• CHANGING THE RESOLUTION . . . . . . . . . . . 4-56
TRANSMITTED (Preview) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57
• PREVIEW CHECK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58
4-1
FACSIMILE
FAX RECEPTION
RECEIVING FAXES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
• RECEIVING A FAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-60
• RECEIVING A FAX MANUALLY . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61
PRINTING A PASSWORD-PROTECTED FAX
(Hold Setting For Received Data Print) . . . . . . . . 4-62
CHECKING THE IMAGE BEFORE PRINTING . . . 4-63
FORWARDING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64
• IMAGE CHECK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66
FORWARDING RECEIVED FAXES (Fax Data
Forward) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-67
FORWARDING RECEIVED FAXES TO A
NETWORK ADDRESS (Inbound Routing
Settings) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-68
SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-68
SPECIAL MODES
SPECIAL MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72
STORING FAX OPERATIONS (Program). . . . . . . 4-74
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS ON THE
IMAGE (Erase) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76
TRANSMITTING AN ORIGINAL AS TWO
SEPARATE PAGES (Dual Page Scan). . . . . . . . . 4-78
SENDING A FAX AT A SPECIFIED TIME
(Timer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-80
SENDING TWO PAGES AS A SINGLE PAGE
(2in1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82
SENDING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD AS A
SINGLE PAGE (Card Shot) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-85
SENDING A LARGE NUMBER OF PAGES
(Job Build) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-88
TRANSMITTING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT
SIZES (Mixed Size Original) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-90
FAXING THIN ORIGINALS (Slow Scan Mode). . . 4-92
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
TRANSMISSION (Original Count) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94
STAMPING SCANNED ORIGINALS (Verif.
Stamp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96
CHANGING THE PRINT SETTINGS FOR THE
TRANSACTION REPORT (Transaction
Report) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-98
ADDING YOUR SENDER INFORMATION TO
FAXES (Own number sending) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
• TEMPORARILY CHANGING THE SENDER
INFORMATION (Own Name Select) . . . . . . . . 4-101
CALLING A FAX MACHINE AND INITIATING
RECEPTION (Polling) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-102
• INITIATING POLLING RECEPTION
MANUALLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-104
MACHINE POLLS YOUR MACHINE (Polling
Memory) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-105
(Polling security) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-105
POLLING MEMORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-106
• CHECKING THE DOCUMENT IN THE
PUBLIC BOX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-108
• DELETING A DOCUMENT FROM THE
PUBLIC BOX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-109
PERFORMING F-CODE COMMUNICATION
F-CODE COMMUNICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-110
• HOW F-CODES WORK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-110
• CREATING MEMORY BOXES IN THE
COMMUNICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-111
• F-CODE DIALLING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-111
CONFIDENTIAL COMMUNICATION USING
F-CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-112
TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-113
F-CODE CONFIDENTIAL RECEPTION . . . . 4-114
POLLING RECEPTION USING F-CODES. . . . . . 4-116
POLLING MEMORY TRANSMISSION USING
F-CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-118
TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-118
• CHECKING THE DOCUMENT IN THE
F-CODE MEMORY POLLING BOX . . . . . . . . 4-121
• DELETING A DOCUMENT STORED FOR
F-CODE POLLING TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . 4-122
RELAY REQUEST TRANSMISSION USING
F-CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-123
USING F-CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-125
4-2
USING AN EXTENSION PHONE
CONNECTING AND USING AN EXISTING
PHONE (Extension Phone Connection) . . . . . . 4-126
• RECEIVING A FAX AFTER ANSWERING
(Remote Reception) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-127
CALLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-127
CHECKING THE STATUS OF FAX JOBS
JOB STATUS SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-128
• JOB QUEUE SCREEN AND COMPLETED
JOB SCREEN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-129
• OPERATION WHEN A JOB IN THE JOB
QUEUE IS COMPLETED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-132
• CHECKING A RESERVED JOB OR THE
JOB IN PROGRESS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-133
• CHECKING COMPLETED JOBS . . . . . . . . . . 4-134
CANCELLING A FAX IN PROGRESS OR A
RESERVED FAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-135
GIVING PRIORITY TO A RESERVED FAX
JOB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-136
CHECKING THE ACTIVITY LOG (Image
Sending Activity Report) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-137
• IMAGE SENDING ACTIVITY REPORT . . . . . 4-137
• INFORMATION APPEARING IN THE
RESULT COLUMN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-138
FACSIMILE SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-139
FACSIMILE
4-3
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE AS A
FAX
This section provides information that you should know before using the machine as a fax machine.
PREPARATIONS FOR FAX
To use the machine as a fax, the telephone line must be connected and the type of line set.
CONNECTION TO THE TELEPHONE LINE
Be sure to use the provided telephone line cord to connect the machine to the wall telephone socket. Connect the end of the line cord that has the core to the "LINE" socket on the machine. Insert the other end (the end without the core) into a telephone line socket.
Click!
"LINE" socket
In some countries, an adapter is required to connect the telephone line cable to the wall telephone socket, as shown in the illustration.
Core
Insert the end of the cord with the core into the "LINE" socket.
For United
Kingdom,
Malaysia
For Australia
Wall socket
Adapter
For New Zealand
4-4
SETTING THE TELEPHONE LINE TYPE
The machine's dial mode setting must be set to the type of telephone line you are using.
If the setting is not correct, dialling will not be possible.
Touch the [Auto Select] key in "Dial Mode Setting" in the system settings (administrator). The machine will automatically set the dial mode to the type of line you are using.
You can also set the "Dial Mode Setting" manually.
• This Setting can only be activated in Canada.
• After setting the dial mode, do not change the setting unless you have a specific reason for changing it.
MAKE SURE THE MAIN POWER SWITCH IS IN THE
"ON" POSITION
When the main power indicator on the operation panel is lit, the main power is on.
If the main power indicator light is not lit, the main power is "off". Switch the main power switch to the "on" position and press the [POWER] key ( ) on the operation panel.
If the fax function will be used, and in particular if reception or timer transmission will take place at night, always keep the main power switch in the "on" position.
When the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) indicator light is blinking, the machine is in auto power shut-off mode. If the [POWER
SAVE] key ( ) is pressed when the indicator is blinking, the indicator will turn off and the machine will return to the ready state after a brief interval.
Main power switch
Main power indicator
"On" position
[POWER SAVE] key/indicator
4-5
CHECKING THE DATE AND TIME
Verify that the correct date and time are set in the machine.
The date and time are set in the system settings of the machine. When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed, the system settings menu screen appears on the touch panel. Select [Default Settings], [Clock], and [Clock Adjust], and set the year, month, day, hour, and minute.
If "Disabling of Clock Adjustment" has been enabled in the system settings (administrator), the date and time cannot be set.
STORING THE SENDER FAX NUMBER
Store the user name and fax number in "Sender Data Registration".
Be sure to configure this information, as it is required for communication.
System Settings (Administrator): Sender Data Registration
Use this setting to program the sender name and sender fax number.
4-6
BASE SCREEN OF FAX MODE
To use the fax function, select settings and operations in the base screen of fax mode. To display the base screen of fax mode, touch the [IMAGE SEND] key and then touch the [Fax] tab.
COPY
Ready to send.
IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Resolution
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Address Review Special Modes
Speaker Resend
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
This screen only appears when the fax function and
Internet fax function have been installed.
The contents of the screen will vary depending on the devices that are installed.
Each of the other modes that can be displayed by touching the [IMAGE SEND] key (scan, Internet fax, USB memory,
PC scan and data entry modes) also have base screens.
Transmission destinations can be stored in one-touch keys in the address book and retrieved from the address book screen when you need to use them. The address book is shared by fax mode, scan mode, Internet fax mode and data entry mode.
To display the address book screen, touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen. To display the base screen, touch the [Condition Settings] key in the address book screen. This chapter refers to the base screen of fax mode as the "base screen".
Base screen of fax mode Address book screen
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
Preview
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
The procedures in this chapter begin from the base screen of fax mode.
System Settings (Administrator): Default Display Settings
One of the following screens can be selected for the initial screen that appears when the [IMAGE SEND] key is touched.
• Base screen of each mode (scan, Internet fax, fax, or data entry mode)
• Address book screen
4-7
BASE SCREEN OF FAX MODE
This screen is used to select settings and operations in fax mode.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
COPY
Ready to send.
Scan
Address Book
IMAGE SEND
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure
DOCUMENT
FILING
Fax
Speaker Resend
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto Scan:
Auto Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Resolution Standard
Special Modes
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
(14) (15)
(1) Mode select keys
Use these keys to switch between copy, image send, and document filing modes.
To switch to fax mode, touch the [IMAGE SEND] key.
(2) This shows various messages and the destinations that have been entered.
The icon on the left indicates fax mode.
(3) Send mode tabs
Use these keys to change the mode of the image send function.
Tabs of modes that cannot be used because the appropriate options are not installed do not appear.
If the [Fax] tab does not appear, touch the tab to move the screen.
☞
BASE SCREEN OF FAX MODE (page 4-7)
(4) [Address Book] key
Touch this key to dial using a one-touch key or group key. When the key is touched, the address book screen appears.
☞
RETRIEVING A FAX NUMBER FROM THE
(5) [Direct TX] key
Touch this key to send a fax by direct transmission.
When the [Direct TX] key is not highlighted, normal transmission (memory TX mode) is selected.
☞
To fax a large number of sheet originals, use the automatic document feeder.
☞
(6) [Sub Address] key
Touch this key to enter a sub-address and passcode for
F-code transmission.
☞
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(16)
(7) Customized keys
The keys that appear here can be changed to show settings or functions that you prefer.
☞
Customizing displayed keys (page 4-9)
(8) [Preview] key
Touch to check the image that will be sent in the touch panel before transmission.
☞
CHECKING THE IMAGE TO BE TRANSMITTED
This function requires the hard disk drive.
(9) [Speaker] key / [Pause] key / [Space] key
Touch this key to dial using the speaker.
When entering a fax number to be dialled, the key changes to the [Pause] key. When entering a sub-address, the key changes to the [Space] key.
☞
TRANSMISSION USING THE SPEAKER (page 4-39)
(10) [Resend] key / [Next Address] key
Touch this key to redial a fax number. When entering a fax number to be dialled, this key changes to the [Next
Address] key.
☞
USING THE RESEND FUNCTION (page 4-24)
(11) Image settings
Image settings (original size, exposure, resolution) can be selected.
☞
(12) key
This key appears when a special mode or 2-sided scanning is selected. Touch the key to display the selected special modes.
☞
Checking what special modes are selected (page 4-9)
(13) [Special Modes] key
Touch this key to use a special mode.
☞
(14) key
Touch this key to dial a fax destination using a search number.
☞
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE A
4-8
(15) / / key
When "Hold Setting for Received Data Print" or
"Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), this will appear when a fax is received.
: Only "Hold Setting for Received Data Print" is enabled
: Only "Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled
: Both settings are enabled
☞
PRINTING A PASSWORD-PROTECTED FAX (Hold
Setting For Received Data Print) (page 4-62)
☞
CHECKING THE IMAGE BEFORE PRINTING
(page
(16) This shows the currently selected fax reception mode and the amount of free memory remaining.
☞
Customizing displayed keys
Special mode keys and other keys can be displayed in the base screen. You can assign frequently used functions to these keys to access the functions with a single touch. To change the function that is assigned to a key, use "Customize Key
Setting" in the Web pages. The following keys appear by factory default:
• [Address Review] key
Touch this to view a list of the destinations that have been selected in the address book and the numbers that have been directly entered with the numeric keys. This is the same key as the [Address Review] key in the address book screen.
• [File] key, [Quick File] key
Touch either key to use Quick File or File in document filing mode.
This function requires the hard disk drive.
Example: When "Dual Page Scan", "Job Build", and "Mixed Size Original" are assigned to the customized keys.
These 3 keys can be changed as desired.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Direct TX
Sub Address
Dual Page
Scan
Job Build
Mixed Size
Original
Preview
Resolution
Special Modes
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Displaying a program key in the base screen will enable you to call up the program by simply touching the key.
☞
STORING FAX OPERATIONS (Program) (page 4-74)
System Settings (Administrator): Customize Key Setting
Registration is performed in [System Settings] - [Operation Settings] - "Customize Key Setting" in the Web page menu.
To register a customized key setting, an optional feature may be required. Please refer to the respective descriptions of individual functions for details.
Checking what special modes are selected
The key appears in the base screen when a special mode or 2-sided scanning is selected.
The key can be touched to display the selected special modes. To close the screen, touch the [OK] key.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
Function Review
Erase :
Edge:10mm
Centre:10mm
:
Day of the Week:Monday
Time: 21:30
Timer
Mixed Size
Original
: On
OK
1
1
The special mode settings cannot be changed from the function review screen. To change a setting, touch the [OK] key to close the function review screen and then touch the [Special Modes] key and select the setting that you wish to change.
4-9
[R] key
When the machine is connected to a PBX, the "PBX Setting" can be enabled to automatically connect to the outside line each time you dial normally. When the PBX setting is enabled, the [R] key appears in the base screen. To dial a number inside your PBX, touch the [R] key before dialling to temporarily cancel the "PBX Setting".
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
USB Mem. Scan
Auto Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
R
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
• This Setting can only be activated in Germany.
• The [R] key can be included in a fax number stored in an one-touch key.
• When the [Speaker] key is touched, the "PBX Setting" is temporarily cancelled and the [R] key does not appear.
• When the [R] key is touched before dialling, an F-code (sub-address and passcode) cannot be used. Likewise, an one-touch key in which an F-code (sub-address and passcode) is stored cannot be used.
System Settings (Administrator): PBX Setting
This is used to enable PBX Setting.
4-10
ADDRESS BOOK SCREEN
This screen is used to select a destination from the list of stored destinations.
(10) (11)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(9)
CCC CCC
0123456789
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
Sort Address
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
(14)
(1) This shows the destination that has been selected.
(2) Number of displayed items selector key
Touch to change the number of destinations (one-touch keys) displayed in the address book screen. Select 5, 10, or 15 destinations.
(3) [Condition Settings] key
Touch this key to select transmission settings and operations. When the key is touched, the base screen appears.
☞
BASE SCREEN OF FAX MODE (page 4-8)
(4) [Address Review] key
Touch this key to view a list of the selected destinations.
The selected destinations can be changed.
☞
(5) [Address Entry] key
Not used in fax mode.
(6) [Global Address Search] key
When the use of an LDAP server has been enabled in the machine's Web page, a fax number can be obtained from a global address book.
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM A GLOBAL
(7) [Sub Address] key
Touch this key to enter a sub-address and passcode for
F-code transmission.
☞
(12)
(13)
(8) [Sort Address] key
Touch this key to change the index tabs to custom indexes or to display one-touch keys by send mode.
☞
CHANGING THE DISPLAY OF ONE-TOUCH KEYS
IN THE ADDRESS BOOK SCREEN (page 4-12)
(9) [Preview] key
Touch to check the image that will be sent in the touch panel before transmission.
☞
This function requires the hard disk drive.
(10) [To] key
Touch this key to enter a selected destination (one-touch key).
☞
RETRIEVING A STORED DESTINATION (page
(11) [Cc] key
Not used in fax mode.
(12) One-touch key display
This shows the one-touch keys of the destinations that have been stored in the address book. This chapter refers to keys in which single destinations and groups are stored as one touch keys. Keys that have fax numbers stored are indicated by .
☞
RETRIEVING A STORED DESTINATION (page
(13) Index tabs
Touch this to change indexes.
☞
RETRIEVING A STORED DESTINATION (page
(14) key
Touch this key to retrieve a destination using a search number.
☞
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE A
4-11
When using the network scanner function or the Internet fax function, a different icon will appear in the one-touch key display if a non-fax destination (address) is stored.
☞
RETRIEVING A FAX NUMBER FROM THE ADDRESS BOOK (page 4-18)
•
System Settings: Address Book (page 7-16)
This is used to store fax numbers in one-touch keys.
• System Settings (Administrator): The Number of Direct Address Keys Displayed Setting
This is used to change the default setting for the number of one-touch keys displayed in the address book screen.
• System Settings (Administrator): Default Display Settings
One of the following screens can be selected for the initial screen that appears when the [IMAGE SEND] key is touched.
- Base screen of each mode (scan, Internet fax, fax, or data entry mode)
- Address book screen
• System Settings (Administrator): Address Book Default Selection
The following settings are available for the method of sorting the addresses that appear in the address book.
- Index type (alphabetical, custom)
- Address type (all, group, E-mail, FTP/Desktop, Network Folder, Internet fax, fax)
CHANGING THE DISPLAY OF ONE-TOUCH KEYS IN
THE ADDRESS BOOK SCREEN
You can show only destinations of a specific transmission mode in the address book screen, or change the displayed index tabs from the alphabetical tabs to the custom tabs. The procedure for selecting destinations does not change.
1
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
Touch the [Sort Address] key.
2
Sort Address
Tab Switch
ABC
User
(1) (2)
OK
Address Type
All
Internet Fax
Group
FTP/Desktop Network Folder
Fax
Change the display mode.
(1) Touch the key of the mode or tab that you wish to display.
• To show only the one-touch keys of a particular send mode, touch the desired mode key under "Address
Type".
• To change the index tabs to the custom indexes, touch the [User] key under "Tab Switch".
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
4-12
Index display
Indexes make it easy to search for a destination (one-touch key). The destinations are displayed separately using alphabetical search characters and index numbers. To display a stored destination, touch the appropriate index tab. It is convenient to store frequently used destinations in the [Freq.] index. Specify that a destination be displayed in the [Freq.] index when you store the destination.
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
Index tabs
The destinations can be displayed in alphabetical order by their initials.
Each time the displayed index tab is touched, the display order changes in the following order: search numbers (page
the other index tabs also changes.
Ordered by search number (default) Ascending names Descending names
Freq.
Freq.
Freq.
ABCD ABCD ABCD
Index names can be changed using "Custom Index" in the system settings, allowing you to create groups of one-touch keys that can be easily recognized.
System Settings:
Storing group keys (page 7-18)
This is used to store custom index names. The custom index where a one-touch key appears is specified when the transmission destination is stored in the key.
Narrowing the search letter range
An alphabet tab on an index tab can be touched to display keys to further narrow the search range. For example, when the [ABCD] tab is touched, keys from "A" to "D" appear. If the [B] key is touched, only destinations starting with the letter
"B" will appear. To cancel, touch the key again. Note that the search letter range cannot be narrowed on the [Freq.] tab, the [etc.] tab, or on a user index tab.
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
BBB AAA
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
BBB CCC
BBB EEE
BBB GGG
BBB III
Sort Address
Freq.
Preview
ABCD
Cc
BBB BBB
BBB DDD
BBB FFF
BBB HHH
BBB JJJ
1
2
EFGH
A B
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
C D
4-13
FAX TRANSMISSION SEQUENCE
This section explains the basic procedure for sending a fax.
Place the original.
Place the original in the document feeder tray of the automatic document feeder, or on the document glass.
Enter the destination fax number
Ready to send.
Speaker
USB Mem. Scan Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto A4 Send:
Resend
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100% or
• [Address Book] key: Select a destination that is stored in the address book or look up a destination in a global address book.
☞
•
key: Use a search number to specify a destination stored in the address book.
☞
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE
• [Resend] key: Select a fax number from the last eight destinations used for transmission.
☞
USING THE RESEND FUNCTION (page
• Numeric keys: Enter a fax number.
☞
ENTERING A FAX NUMBER WITH THE
4-14
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
Select image settings.
Select settings for the original to be faxed.
• [Original] key: Use this key to select the original size, the original send size, and 2-sided original scanning.
☞
(page
(2-Sided Original) (page 4-47)
• [Exposure] key: Use this key to adjust the exposure of the image.
☞
• [Resolution] key: Use this key to adjust the resolution of the image.
☞
Special mode settings
Touch the [Special Modes] key to select special modes such as timer transmission and the erase function.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
4-15
Begin transmission
Scan the original and send the fax.
If the original is placed on the document glass, follow these steps to start scanning and transmission:
When sending a fax normally (memory transmission)
(1) Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
(2) When scanning is finished, replace the original with the next original.
(3) Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
(4) Repeat steps (2) and (3) until all originals have been scanned.
(5) Touch the [Read-End] key.
When sending a fax in direct transmission mode
Multiple originals cannot be scanned in direct transmission mode.
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to start transmission.
When transmission ends, image settings and convenient special mode settings are cleared.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
System Settings (Administrator): Default Display Settings
The settings can be kept in effect a fixed period of time after scanning is completed.
4-16
ENTERING DESTINATIONS
This section explains how to enter destination fax numbers.
Destination fax numbers can be entered using the numeric keys, or by retrieving a previously stored fax number using the address book or a search number.
ENTERING A FAX NUMBER WITH THE
NUMERIC KEYS
Enter the destination fax number with the numeric keys.
Take care to enter the correct number.
If an incorrect number is entered...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) to clear the number and then enter the correct number.
Entering a pause between digits of the number
Enter a pause after the number used to dial out from a PBX (for example, after "0"), or after the country code when dialling an international number.
Pause Next Address
1234567890-
Scan Internet Fax
Address Book Original
Exposure Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution Standard
Special Modes
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
Touch the [Pause] key.
A hyphen "-" is entered when the [Pause] key is touched once.
System Settings (Administrator): Pause Time Setting
This is used to set the length of pauses. The default setting is 2 seconds.
4-17
RETRIEVING A FAX NUMBER FROM THE
ADDRESS BOOK
The address book screen shows stored destinations as one-touch keys.
A destination fax number is retrieved by simply touching the one-touch key of that destination. This is called "one-touch dialling". It is also possible to store multiple fax numbers in a one-touch key, allowing you to retrieve all the numbers by simply touching the key. This is called "group dialling". This dialling method is convenient when you wish to send a fax to
(or poll) multiple fax destinations.
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
When destinations of other scan modes are stored in addition to fax destinations, an icon indicating the mode appears together with the name of the destination in each one-touch key.
Icon Mode
Fax
Scan to E-mail
Internet fax (Direct SMTP)
Scan to FTP
Scan to Network Folder
Scan to Desktop
Group key with multiple destinations
System Settings:
This is used to store destinations (names and fax numbers) in the address book.
4-18
RETRIEVING A STORED DESTINATION
A destination fax number is retrieved by simply touching the one-touch key of that destination.
Touch the [Address Book] key.
1
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
2
(2)
CCC CCC
0123456789
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
Sort Address
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
Pause Next Address
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
(1)
Select the destination.
(1) Touch the index tab where the destination is stored.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
If you select an incorrect destination, touch the key again to cancel the selection.
• Frequently used destinations can be displayed in the [Freq.] index. Specify that a destination be displayed in the
[Freq.] index when you store the destination.
• To continue specifying other destinations...
Touch the [Next Address] key and repeat (1) and (2) of this step.
• System Settings (Administrator): Must Input Next Address Key at Broadcast Setting
This setting determines whether or not the [Next Address] key can be omitted before specifying the next destination.
Factory default setting: The [Next Address] key can be omitted.
• System Settings (Administrator): Disable Switching of Display Order
This is used to disable switching of the order of display of the one-touch keys in the address book screen. The currently selected display order will be the order that is used after this setting is enabled.
4-19
CHECKING AND DELETING ENTERED DESTINATIONS
When multiple destinations have been entered, you can display and check the destinations. You can also delete a destination (cancel selection of the destination).
1
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Touch the [Address Review] key.
2
Address Review
001 CCC CCC
003 LLL LLL
005 NNN NNN
007 PPP PPP
009 RRR RRR
011 TTT TTT
To
OK
Check the destinations and then touch the [OK] key.
002 KKK KKK
004 MMM MMM
006 OOO OOO
008 QQQ QQQ
010 SSS SSS
012 UUU UUU
Cc
1
2
To delete a destination...
Touch the one-touch key of the destination that you wish to delete. A message will appear to confirm the deletion.
Touch the [Yes] key. Touch the [Detail] key to check the specified destination type and name.
Deselect the address?
BBB BBB
Detail No Yes
4-20
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE
A DESTINATION
A destination stored in the address book can be retrieved using the key. This can be done in the base screen of any of the modes or in the address book screen.
Touch the key.
1
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
2
Enter the 4-digit search number of the address with the numeric keys.
When the 4-digit search number is entered, the stored address is retrieved and specified as a destination.
• The search number is programmed when the destination is stored in the address book.
• If you do not know the search number, print the one-touch address list using "Sending Address List" in the system settings.
• When entering search numbers such as "0001" and "0011", "0" can be omitted. For example, to enter "0001", enter
"1" and touch the key or the [Next Address] key.
If an incorrect search number is entered...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) to clear the number and enter the correct number.
4-21
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM A
GLOBAL ADDRESS BOOK
If an LDAP server is stored in the Web pages, you can look up a destination fax number in a global address book.
1
(2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Open the global address search screen.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the [Global Address Search] key.
2
Server Change
Server 1
Server 2
Server 3
Server 4
Server 5
Server 6
Server 7
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
Search for the destination.
If only one LDAP server has been stored, (1) and (2) are not necessary. Go directly to (3). If an authentication screen for the
LDAP server appears, enter your user name and password.
(1) Touch the key of the LDAP server that you wish to use.
If an authentication screen for the LDAP server appears, enter your user name and password.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
(3) Search for the destination in the search screen.
Enter search characters for the destination and touch the
[Search] key. The search results will appear after a brief interval.
For the procedure for entering text, see " ENTERING
TEXT " (page 1-67) in "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE".
How to search
Enter a maximum of 64 characters for the search characters. The system will look for names starting with the entered letters.
An asterisk can be used as follows:
XXX :
XXX:
Names beginning with "XXX".
Names that end with "XXX".
XXX : Names that include "XXX".
AA XX: Names that start with "AA" and end with "XX".
4-22
(2)
To
Condition
Settings
Address Review
XXX
XXX AAA
Search Again
XXX BBB
XXX CCC
Address Book XXX DDD
XXX EEE
XXX FFF
Cc
(1)
0123456789
9876543210
0612345678
0687654321
0676543210
0601234567
Detail
1
2
Select the destination.
(1) Touch the key of the desired destination.
If no names are found that match the search letters, a message will appear. Touch the [OK] key to close the message and touch the [Search Again] key to search again.
(2) Touch the [To] key.
This enters the selected destination.
If you wish to select another destination, repeat steps (1) and (2) above.
3
• If 30 or more matches are found, a message will appear in the screen. Touch the [OK] key to close the message. A maximum of 300 search results are displayed. If the desired destination was not found, touch the [Search Again] key to add more search letters.
• To check the information stored in a destination...
Touch the key of the destination and then touch the [Detail] key. The information stored for the selected destination will appear. Check the information and then touch the [OK] key to return to the search results screen.
• If a screen for selecting the item to be used appears...
If the selected destination includes an E-mail address or other address in addition to the fax number or telephone number, you will need to select which item you wish to use. Touch the [Fax] key to retrieve the fax number.
Storing a destination from a global address book in the machine's address book
A destination from a global address book can be stored in the machine's address book as a one-touch key.
Touch the [Detail] key in the search results screen of the global address book (the screen of step 3 above) to display information on the selected destination. Touch the [Register] key in the detailed information screen and then touch the item to be used (the [Fax] key in this case). The following screen will appear.
Exit
Direct Address / Individual
E-mail Internet Fax
Search Number 001
Name
Initial
AAA AAA
A
0123456789 Fax No.
Key Name AAA AAA
Mode
33.6 kbps/None
Index
Fax
User 1
The information stored in the global address book is automatically entered. (The settings can be changed if needed. For detailed information on each item, see "
Address Control " (page 7-16) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS".) However, configure
the items below manually. To complete the storing procedure, touch the [Exit] key.
• [Initial] key: Touch this key to enter the initials that determine where the destination will appear in the alphabetical index and the order of one-touch key display. Enter up to 10 characters for the initials.
• [Index] key: Touch this key to select the custom index in which the address will appear. You can also select whether or not the destination will be included on the [Freq.] tab of the address book.
• [Mode] key: Touch this key to configure the "Transmission Speed" and "International Correspondence Mode" settings. These settings have already been configured, however, if the destination is an international destination, or if you find that communication errors frequently occur when communicating with that destination, you can try changing the settings.
4-23
USING THE RESEND FUNCTION
The destinations of the most recent 8 transmissions by fax, Scan to E-mail, and/or Internet fax are stored. One of these can be selected to resend to that destination.
Touch the [Resend] key.
1
Ready to send.
Speaker Resend
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
2
Resend
No.01
AAA AAA
No.03
CCC CCC
No.05
EEE EEE
No.07
GGG GGG
No.02
BBB BBB
No.04
DDD DDD
No.06
FFF FFF
No.08
HHH HHH
Cancel
Touch the key of the fax destination that you wish to redial.
The last 8 transmission destinations appear.
• If numeric keys were pressed during the previous transmission, the [Resend] key may not dial the correct number.
• The fax addresses below are not stored as addresses for which resend is possible.
- A one-touch key in which multiple destinations are stored (group key).
- Broadcast destinations
- Destinations transmitted to using a program
System Settings (Administrator): Disable [Resend] on Fax/Image Send Mode
This prohibits use of the resend function. When this setting is enabled, the [Resend] key cannot be used in the base screen of image send mode.
4-24
CHAIN DIALLING
Number sequences entered with the numeric keys and/or one-touch keys can be linked together with pauses and dialled as a single number.
Use chain dialling to dial a long number (such as an international number) when the country code and/or area code are stored separately in one-touch keys.
Example: Using chain dialling to dial an international number
Number to be dialled
Entry
Number to access international telephone service
XXX
Using the numeric keys
XXX
Pause
010
Country code
010 00
CCC CCC
Area code
Number of other party
XX XXXX
Using a one-touch key
System Settings (Administrator): Pause Time Setting
This is used to set the length of pauses. The default setting is 2 seconds.
4-25
BASIC TRANSMISSION METHODS
This section explains the basic procedures for sending a fax.
TRANSMISSION METHODS
The methods that can be used to send a fax from the machine are explained below. Select the method that best suits your needs.
To fax a large number of sheet originals, use the automatic document feeder.
The originals will be scanned into memory and then transmitted (memory transmission).
When memory transmission is selected and multiple originals are placed in the automatic document feeder (and the line is free), transmission will begin as soon as the first page is scanned and will take place while the remaining pages are being scanned (Quick Online transmission).
If transmission cannot begin immediately because the line is in use, all pages will be scanned into memory and the transmission will be reserved.
☞
USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER FOR TRANSMISSION (page 4-32)
When a fax transmission or reception is already in progress, the following procedure can be performed to reserve a transmission job. To check reserved transmission jobs, display the job status screen.
☞
CHECKING THE STATUS OF FAX JOBS (page 4-128)
1
1
1
1
Transmission
1
1
1
1
• If memory becomes full while the first original page is being scanned, transmission will stop.
• In the following situations, the transmission will be automatically reserved (memory transmission)
- When the line is busy or a communication error occurs and automatic resending is enabled.
☞
WHEN THE LINE IS BUSY (page 4-30), WHEN A COMMUNICATION ERROR OCCURS (page 4-30)
- The machine is already using the line to send or receive a fax.
- Another fax transmission was reserved ahead of your fax.
- One of the following functions is being used for transmission.
Broadcast transmission, F-code transmission, timer transmission, Dual Page Scan, 2in1, Card Shot, Job Build, Original
Count
- The document glass is being used (except when the speaker is being used to dial).
• Up to 94 transmission jobs can be reserved.
• When the transmission is finished, the scanned original pages are cleared from memory. However, when the document filing function is used, the transmitted fax is stored.
System Settings (Administrator): Quick On Line Sending
This is used to disable Quick Online transmission. In this case, fax transmissions will be sent by memory transmission
(reserved and then transmitted).
4-26
To fax thick originals or pages of a book, use the document glass.
☞
USING THE DOCUMENT GLASS FOR TRANSMISSION (page 4-35)
1
Transmission
When the document glass is being used for a transmission, Quick Online transmission will not operate.
If you wish to send a fax ahead of other previously reserved fax transmissions, use direct transmission mode.
The original is transmitted directly to the receiving fax machine without being scanned into memory.
When direct transmission mode is used, transmission will begin as soon as the transmission in progress is completed
(ahead of any previously reserved transmissions).
To send a fax by direct transmission, touch the [Direct TX] key in the base screen.
☞
USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER TO SEND A FAX IN DIRECT TRANSMISSION MODE (page 4-33)
☞
USING THE DOCUMENT GLASS TO SEND A FAX IN DIRECT TRANSMISSION MODE (page 4-37)
Scan
Address Book
Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Transmission
• When transmission in direct transmission mode ends, the mode automatically changes back to memory transmission mode.
• When the document glass is used, multiple original pages cannot be scanned.
4-27
PLACEMENT ORIENTATION OF THE ORIGINAL
When an A4 (8-1/2" x 11") original is placed in vertical orientation ( ), the image is automatically rotated 90 degrees and transmitted in horizontal orientation ( ) (Rotation Sending). If the original is placed in horizontal orientation ( ), it is transmitted in that orientation ( ) without being rotated.
Transmission
A4 (8-1/2" x 11") Rotated to A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R) orientation
A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R) image is transmitted.
A4R, B5 and A5 (8-1/2" x 11"R and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size originals are not rotated for transmission.
System Settings (Administrator): Rotation Sending Setting
The factory default setting is rotate before transmission. If this setting is disabled, the original will be transmitted in the orientation in which it is placed.
AUTOMATIC REDUCTION OF THE TRANSMITTED
IMAGE
If the width of the transmitted image is larger than the width of the paper in the receiving machine, the image will be automatically reduced to fit the receiving machine's paper width.
Example: Reduced sizes and reduction ratios
Transmitted image width
A3
A3 (11" x 17")
B4
Receiving machine's paper width
A4
Reduced size
B4 B4
A4 (8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11") A4R (8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11"R)
A4R
Ratio
1 : 0.84
1 : 0.71
1 : 0.84
System Settings (Administrator): Auto Reduction Sending Setting
The factory default setting is automatic reduction enabled. If this setting is disabled, the image will be sent at full size and part of the image may be cut off.
4-28
TRANSMITTABLE ORIGINAL SIZES
The following original sizes can be transmitted.
Using the automatic document feeder
Using the document glass
Minimum original size
131 mm (height) x 140 mm (width)
(5-1/8" (height) x 5-1/2" (width))
–
Maximum original size
297 mm (height) x 1000 mm* (width)
(11-5/8" (height) x 39-3/8"* (width))
297 mm (height) x 432 mm (width)
(11-5/8" (height) x 17" (width))
*A long original can be transmitted.
THE SIZE OF THE PLACED ORIGINAL
When a standard size original is placed, the original size is automatically detected and displayed in "Scan" in the base screen.
When the automatic original detection function is operating and the original is a non-standard size, the closest standard size may be displayed or the original size may not appear. In this event, manually set the correct original size.
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by paper size) (page 4-49)
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by numerical values) (page 4-51)
STANDARD SIZES
Standard sizes are sizes that the machine can automatically detect. The standard sizes are set in "Original Size
Detector Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
List of original size detector settings
Selections
AB-1
AB-2
AB-3
AB-4
AB-5
Inch-1
Inch-2
Inch-3
Standard sizes (detected original sizes)
Document glass
Document feeder tray
(automatic document feeder)
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 330 mm
(8-1/2" x 13")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
8-1/2" x 14", 11" x 17"
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")
A4, A4R, A5, B4, 8K, 16K, 16KR
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 340 mm
(8-1/2" x 13-2/5")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 343 mm
(8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R,
5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13" (216 mm x 330 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, 8K, 16K, 16KR, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 340 mm (8-1/2" x 13-2/5")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R,
5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A4, A3
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13" (216 mm x 330 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A4, A3
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A4, A3
4-29
WHEN THE LINE IS BUSY
If the line is busy when you send a fax, transmission will be re-attempted automatically after a preset interval. This function only operates in memory transmission mode. In direct transmission mode or manual transmission mode, the transmission will be cancelled. Wait briefly and then try sending the fax again.
To cancel transmission...
Cancel the transmission from the job status screen.
☞
CANCELLING A FAX IN PROGRESS OR A RESERVED FAX (page 4-135)
System Settings (Administrator): Recall in Case of Line Busy
This is used to set the number of recall attempts and the interval between attempts when the connection cannot be established because the line is busy.
WHEN A COMMUNICATION ERROR OCCURS
If a communication error occurs or the other fax machine does not answer the call within a preset period of time, transmission will be re-attempted automatically after a preset interval. This function only operates in memory transmission mode.
To cancel transmission...
Cancel the transmission from the job status screen.
☞
CANCELLING A FAX IN PROGRESS OR A RESERVED FAX (page 4-135)
System Settings (Administrator): Recall in Case of Communication Error
This is used to set the number of recall attempts and the interval between attempts when a transmission fails due to an error.
4-30
FAX DESTINATION CONFIRMATION MODE
The fax destination confirmation mode displays a destination confirmation message when a fax transmission is performed to prevent accidental transmission to the wrong destination. This function is enabled in the system settings
(administrator). When the function is enabled, a message will appear to confirm the destination when the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key is pressed to begin fax transmission.
The message that appears will vary depending on the method used to specify the destination.
Destination specified by one-touch key/search number
Destination specified by the numeric keys, [Resend] key, or [Global Address Search] key
Number Confirmation
BBB BBB
0312345678
Cancel
Enter the number again and press the Start key.
OK OK
Make sure that the destination indicated in the message is correct and touch the [OK] key. Scanning will begin.
If the destination is not correct, touch the [Cancel] key and select the destination again.
Touch the [OK] key, re-enter the destination with the numeric keys, and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
If the re-entered destination is correct, scanning will begin.
If the re-entered destination is not correct, a message will appear. Touch the [OK] key and re-enter the destination. If an incorrect number is entered for confirmation 3 times in a row, the screen will revert to the base screen.
• If the [Sub Address] key was used to enter a sub-address and passcode, the fax number must be re-entered during confirmation. After re-entering the fax number, touch the [Sub Address] key and enter the sub-address and passcode.
• If chain dialling was used, touch the [Pause] key to enter "-" during confirmation.
Functions that cannot be used
When the fax destination confirmation function is enabled, only one destination is allowed, and thus the following functions cannot be used.
• Broadcast transmission to multiple destinations including fax destinations
Group keys and program keys that contain multiple fax destinations cannot be used. After one destination is specified, keys such as another one-touch key, the [Next Address] key, the [Address Entry] key, and the [Global Address
Search] key cannot be touched.
• Transmission using the speaker key
A destination cannot be specified after the [Speaker] key is pressed.
System Settings (Administrator): Fax Dest. Confirmation Mode
This setting is used to have a destination confirmation message appear when a fax is sent.
4-31
USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT
FEEDER FOR TRANSMISSION
This function requires the automatic document feeder to be installed.
This section explains how to use the automatic document feeder to send a fax.
1
Indicator line
Place the originals face up in the document feeder tray with the edges aligned evenly.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
When sending a multi-page fax, the automatic document feeder and the document glass cannot both be used to scan the original pages.
2
(2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
In addition to specification by one-touch key, a destination can also be specified using a search number. You can also directly enter a fax number with the numeric keys or look up a destination in a global address book. For more information, see "
ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 4-17).
3
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
When scanning is completed, the machine sounds a beep.
When scanning is completed, "Job stored." will be displayed together with a job control number. This number can be used to locate the job in the Transaction Report or in the Image Sending Activity Report.
• If a fax is being received when the transmission operation is performed, the transmission will be reserved and transmitted after fax reception is completed.
• If the memory becomes full while the originals are being scanned, a message will appear and scanning will stop. If Quick
Online transmission is taking place, the originals that were scanned will be transmitted. If Quick Online is not enabled, the transmission will be cancelled.
System Settings (Administrator): Scan Complete Sound Setting
The scan complete sound can be selected.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
4-32
USING THE AUTOMATIC DOCUMENT FEEDER TO
SEND A FAX IN DIRECT TRANSMISSION MODE
1
Indicator line
Place the originals face up in the document feeder tray with the edges aligned evenly.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
2
(3) (2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
(3) Touch the [Condition Settings] key.
• Only one destination can be entered. A one-touch key in which multiple destinations are stored (group key) cannot be used.
• In addition to specification by one-touch key, a destination can also be specified using a search number. You can also directly enter a fax number with the numeric keys or look up a destination in a global address book. For more information, see "
ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 4-17).
Touch the [Direct TX] key.
3
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Transmission begins.
To cancel transmission...
While "Dialling. Press [ ] to cancel." appears or while the fax is being transmitted, press the [STOP] key ( ).
4-33
• The following functions cannot be used with direct transmission:
Program, Timer Transmission, 2in1, Card Shot, Job Build, Polling Memory, Original Count, File, Quick File, Memory Box,
2-Sided Original Scanning, Global Address Search
• Resending will not take place when a direct transmission is not successful due to a communication error or other reason.
• If a fax transmission is already in progress when the direct transmission operation is performed, the direct transmission will wait until the previous transmission is finished. When the previous transmission is completed, the direct transmission will begin. While the direct transmission is waiting, the [JOB STATUS] key can be pressed to display the job status screen. No other operations are possible.
☞
CHECKING THE STATUS OF FAX JOBS (page 4-128)
4-34
USING THE DOCUMENT GLASS FOR
TRANSMISSION
To fax a thick original or other original that cannot be fed through the automatic document feeder, open the automatic document feeder and place the original on the document glass.
Original size detector
Open the automatic document feeder, place the original face down on the document glass, and then gently close the automatic document feeder.
Document glass scale
mark
Document glass scale
mark
1
A5
(5-1/2" x 8-1/2")
B5
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
B5R
A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R)
B4 (8-1/2" x 14")
A3 (11" x 17")
• Align the corner of the original with the tip of the arrow mark
on the document glass scale.
• Place the original in the appropriate position for its size as shown above.
Do not place any objects under the original size detector. Closing the automatic document feeder with an object underneath may damage the original size detector plate and prevent correct detection of the document size.
• When faxing a multi-page original, scan each page in order starting from the first page.
• When sending a multi-page fax, the automatic document feeder and the document glass cannot both be used to scan the original pages.
2
(2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
In addition to specification by one-touch key, a destination can also be specified using a search number. You can also directly enter a fax number with the numeric keys or look up a destination in a global address book. For more information, see "
ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 4-17).
4-35
3
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
4
If you have another page to scan, change pages and then press the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key.
Repeat until all originals have been scanned.
If no action is taken for one minute, scanning automatically ends and the transmission is reserved.
Place next original. (Pg.No.x)
Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Configure Read-End
Touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep sounds.
Open the automatic document feeder and remove the original.
5
• When scanning is completed, "Job stored." will be displayed together with a job control number.
This number can be used to locate the job in the Transaction Report or in the Image Sending Activity Report.
• If no action is taken for one minute after the confirmation screen appears, scanning automatically ends and the transmission is reserved.
• The [Configure] key can be touched to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size for each original page scanned. However, when "2in1" or "Card Shot" is selected in the special modes, only the exposure can be changed, and this can only be done when scanning each even page number of the original pages.
To cancel transmission...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) before the [Read-End] key is touched.
• If a fax is being received when the transmission operation is performed, the transmission will be reserved and transmission will take place after fax reception is completed.
• If the memory becomes full while the originals are being scanned, a message will appear and transmission will be cancelled.
4-36
USING THE DOCUMENT GLASS TO SEND A FAX IN
DIRECT TRANSMISSION MODE
When sending a fax from the document glass in direct transmission mode, only one page can be transmitted.
Original size detector
Open the automatic document feeder, place the original face down on the document glass, and then gently close the automatic document feeder.
Document glass scale
mark
Document glass scale
mark
1
A5
(5-1/2" x 8-1/2")
B5
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
B5R
A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R)
B4 (8-1/2" x 14")
A3 (11" x 17")
• Align the corner of the original with the tip of the arrow mark
on the document glass scale.
• Place the original in the appropriate position for its size as shown above.
Do not place any objects under the original size detector. Closing the automatic document feeder with an object underneath may damage the original size detector plate and prevent correct detection of the document size.
2
(3) (2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
(3) Touch the [Condition Settings] key.
• Only one destination can be entered. A one-touch key in which multiple destinations are stored (group key) cannot be used.
• In addition to specification by one-touch key, a destination can also be specified using a search number. You can also directly enter a fax number with the numeric keys or look up a destination in a global address book. For more information, see "
ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 4-17).
4-37
Touch the [Direct TX] key.
3
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Transmission begins.
To cancel transmission...
While "Dialling. Press [ ] to cancel" appears in the display, press the [STOP] key ( ).
• The following functions cannot be used with direct transmission:
Program, Timer Transmission, 2in1, Card Shot, Job Build, Polling Memory, Original Count, File, Quick File, Memory Box,
2-Sided Original Scanning, Global Address Search
• Resending will not take place when a direct transmission is not successful due to a communication error or other reason.
• If a fax transmission is already in progress when the direct transmission operation is performed, the direct transmission will wait until the previous transmission is finished. When the previous transmission is completed, the direct transmission will begin. While the direct transmission is waiting, the [JOB STATUS] key can be pressed to display the job status screen. No other operations are possible.
☞
CHECKING THE STATUS OF FAX JOBS (page 4-128)
4-38
TRANSMISSION USING THE SPEAKER
When the speaker is used to dial, the fax is sent after the number is dialled and the connection is established. If a person answers, you will be able to hear his or her voice, but you will not be able to speak.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
When the document glass is used, only one page can be transmitted.
2
(3) (1)
Telephone mode.
Speaker Resend
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Speaker Volume
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Fax Manual
Reception
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Speaker] key.
You will hear the dial tone through the machine's speaker.
(2) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(3) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
A group key cannot be used.
• In addition to specification by one-touch key, a destination can also be specified using a search number. You can also directly enter a fax number with the numeric keys or look up a destination in a global address book. For more information, see "
ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 4-17).
• After touching the [Speaker] key, you can touch the [Speaker Volume] key to adjust the volume of the speaker. The speaker volume changes each time the [Speaker Volume] key is touched. Adjust the volume to the desired level.
3
Wait until the connection is made and then press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Transmission begins.
To cancel transmission...
Touch the [Speaker] key before the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed. The line will be disconnected and transmission will stop.
• When the speaker is used, transmission takes place without scanning the original into memory.
• A destination that includes an F-code (sub-address and passcode) cannot be used.
• A one-touch key that has multiple destinations or has a non-fax destination cannot be used.
System Settings (Administrator): Speaker Settings
The default volume level of the speaker can be changed in the "Speaker Settings".
4-39
SENDING THE SAME FAX TO MULTIPLE
DESTINATIONS (Broadcast Transmission)
This function is convenient when you need to send the same fax to multiple destinations, such as sending a report to branch offices in different regions. A single broadcast operation allows transmissions to a maximum of 500 destinations.
Transmission
Originals
It is convenient to store destinations to which you frequently send faxes by broadcast transmission in group keys. Group dialling allows you to retrieve multiple fax numbers stored in a one-touch key by simply pressing the one-touch key. To store group keys, see "
Address Control " (page 7-16) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS".
When a group key is used to dial, the number of fax numbers that are dialled is the number of destinations that are stored in the group key. When a group key that has 10 destinations is used, 10 fax numbers are dialled.
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
1
4-40
2
(2)
CCC CCC
0123456789
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
Pause Next Address
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
(3) Repeat step (2) until all destinations are selected.
• In addition to specification by one-touch key, a destination can also be specified using a search number. You can also directly enter a fax number with the numeric keys or look up a destination in a global address book. For more information, see "
ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 4-17).
• It is convenient to use a group key to enter the destinations.
• After entering a destination with the numeric keys, if you wish to enter another destination with the numeric keys, touch the [Next Address] key before entering the next destination. The [Next Address] key can be omitted before or after a destination entered using a one-touch key. However, if "Must Input Next Address Key at Broadcast Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), the [Next Address] key must be touched before entering the next destination.
Fax number entered with the numeric keys
[Next Address] key
Fax number entered with the numeric keys
[Next Address] key
Destination entered with a one-touch key
Cannot be omitted Can be omitted*
* Cannot be omitted if "Must Input Next
Address Key at Broadcast Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator).
System Settings (Administrator): Must Input Next Address Key at Broadcast Setting
This setting is used to prohibit omission of the [Next Address] key when entering destinations for broadcast transmissions.
3
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
Touch the [Address Review] key.
4-41
4
Address Review
001 CCC CCC
003 LLL LLL
005 NNN NNN
007 PPP PPP
009 RRR RRR
011 TTT TTT
To
002 KKK KKK
004 MMM MMM
006 OOO OOO
008 QQQ QQQ
010 SSS SSS
012 UUU UUU
Cc
OK
1
2
Check the destinations and then touch the [OK] key.
To cancel a specified destination...
Touch the key of the destination that you wish to cancel. A message will appear to confirm the deletion. Touch the
[Yes] key.
☞
CHECKING AND DELETING ENTERED DESTINATIONS (page 4-20)
5
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• A broadcast transmission takes place by memory transmission only.
• A broadcast transmission can be used in combination with the timer transmission function to transmit at night or any other desired time. A broadcast transmission can also be used in combination with other convenient functions.
• The broadcast transmission can include Scan to E-mail and Internet fax destinations. In this case, the image sent to the
Scan to E-mail and Internet fax destinations will be black and white.
4-42
Resending to unsuccessful broadcast transmission destinations
The results of a completed broadcast transmission can be checked in the job status screen. If transmission to any of the destinations failed, resend the fax to those destinations.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
1
2
3
4
5
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
Scan to
Set Time
Fax Job
Pages Status
Internet Fax
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
0123456789
AAA AAA
10:05 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting
1
1
BBB BBB
Broadcast 10:33 04/01 000/010 Waiting
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
Touch the [Complete] key.
If the job status screen of fax mode does not appear, touch the
[Fax Job] tab.
3
If the broadcast transmission included destinations of different modes, the same broadcast transmission key will appear in each of those modes.
(1)
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
Scan to
Start Time
Fax Job
Pages Status
10:00 04/01 010/003 NG000000
Broadcast0002
CCC CCC
0123456789
10:05 04/01 001/001 Send OK
10:22 04/01 004/004 Send OK
10:30 04/01 010/010 Send OK
(2)
1
1
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Call
Display details on the broadcast transmission.
(1) Touch the key of the completed broadcast transmission.
(2) Touch the [Detail] key.
"Broadcastxxxx" will appear as the destination of the broadcast job key. The job control number that appeared in the touch panel when scanning ended appears in "xxxx".
4-43
Detail
Broadcast0001
002
010
Address
DDD DDD
EEE EEE
Start Time Status
10:01 04/01
10:10 04/01
NG00000
NG00000
OK
Retry
1
1
Resend to unsuccessful destinations.
(1) Touch the [Failed] tab.
(2) Touch the [Retry] key.
4
File Failed
(1) (2)
All Destinations
• The procedure after the [Retry] key is touched varies depending on whether or not the document filing function was used.
Not using document filing
You will return to the base screen with the unsuccessful destinations entered. Place the original and perform the broadcast transmission operation.
Using document filing
The document filing operation selection screen will appear with the unsuccessful destinations entered. Perform the document filing resend procedure. (There is no need to rescan the original.)
If the job was stored in a confidential folder or was stored as confidential file, a password entry screen will appear after you touch the [Retry] key. Enter the password.
• If the [All Destinations] key is touched in (1), all destinations will be displayed. The [Retry] key that appears in the screen can be touched to resend to all destinations.
4-44
SENDING A FAX DIRECTLY FROM A
COMPUTER (PC-Fax)
A document in a computer can be transmitted via the machine as a fax. Faxes are sent using the PC-Fax function in the same way as documents are printed. Select the PC-Fax driver as the printer driver on your computer and then select the
Print command in the software application. Image data for transmission will be created and sent as a fax.
Fax transmission
For more information on using PC-Fax, see the Help file for the PC-Fax driver.
• To use the PC-Fax function, the PC-Fax driver must be installed. For more information, see "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE".
• This function can only be used on a Windows ® computer.
• This function can only be used for transmission. Faxes cannot be received to your computer.
4-45
IMAGE SETTINGS
Settings for scanning the original are selected in the base screen of each mode. The current state of each setting appears to the right of the key used to select the setting.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
(1)
(2)
(3)
(1) [Original] key
Touch this key to set the scan size, send size, and orientation of the original, and select 2-sided scanning settings.
☞
AUTOMATICALLY SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF
AN ORIGINAL (2-Sided Original) (page 4-47)
☞
SPECIFYING THE SCAN SIZE AND SEND SIZE
(2) [Exposure] key
Touch this key to select the exposure for scanning.
☞
CHANGING THE EXPOSURE (page 4-55)
(3) [Resolution] key
Touch this key to select the scanning resolution.
☞
CHANGING THE RESOLUTION (page 4-56)
4-46
AUTOMATICALLY SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF AN
ORIGINAL (2-Sided Original)
The automatic document feeder will automatically scan both sides of the document.
Transmission
2-sided original Front and back are sent as two pages
1
Touch the [Original] key.
☞
2
Fax/Original
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
(1)
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
Image Orientation
(2)
OK
(3)
Specify the binding style of the 2-sided original (book or tablet) and the orientation in which the original is placed.
(1) Touch the [2-Sided Booklet] key or the
[2-Sided Tablet] key.
A book and a tablet are bound as shown below.
Booklet Tablet
A
E
J
C
G
L
A B
E F
K L
When a document cover is installed the [2-Sided Booklet] key and the [2-Sided Tablet] key are not displayed.
(2) Touch the appropriate [Image Orientation] key.
If the wrong orientation is selected here, the image may not be sent properly.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
To cancel 2-sided scanning, touch the highlighted key so that it is no longer highlighted.
• 2-sided scanning automatically turns off after the transmission operation is completed.
• 2-sided scanning is not possible when direct transmission or speaker transmission is performed.
4-47
SPECIFYING THE SCAN SIZE AND SEND SIZE
(Enlarge/Reduce)
When the original is placed, its size is automatically detected and displayed in the base screen.
The size of the placed original is indicated as the scan size, and the size to be transmitted is indicated as the send size.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
In the above screen, the scan size (the placed original) is A4 (8-1/2" x 11") and the send size is auto. If, for example, the scan size were A4 (8-1/2" x 11") and the send size were B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2"), the image would be reduced before transmission.
"Scan Size"
Transmission
"Send Size" is set to
B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2")
A4 (8-1/2" x 11") The image is reduced to B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") before transmission
• Only standard original sizes can be automatically detected.
☞
• When the original size is a non-standard size, or if the size is not detected correctly, manually specify the original scan size.
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by paper size) (page 4-49)
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by numerical values) (page 4-51)
4-48
Specifying the original scan size (by paper size)
If the original is a non-standard size or you wish to change the scan size, touch the [Original] key to specify the original size manually. Place the original in the document feeder tray or on the document glass and follow the steps below.
1
Touch the [Original] key.
The automatically detected original size appears to the right of the [Original] key.
☞
Touch the [Scan Size] key.
Fax/Original OK
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
2
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
3
Fax/Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Size Input
Manual
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
(1)
B4
A3
Long Size
(2)
OK
AB
Inch
Specify the scan size.
(1) Touch the appropriate original size key.
When the document cover is installed, the [Long size] key is not displayed.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
• If you are sending a long original, touch the [Long Size] key. Use the automatic document feeder to scan a long original. The maximum length that can be scanned is 1000 mm (39-3/8") (the maximum height is 297 mm
(11-5/8")).
☞
TRANSMITTABLE ORIGINAL SIZES (page 4-29)
• To specify an Inch size for the scan size, touch the [AB Inch] key to highlight the [Inch] side and then specify the scan size.
4-49
4
Fax/Original
Scan Size
B5
100% Send Size
Auto
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
OK
Touch the [OK] key.
When [Long Size] is selected, the 2-sided scanning setting and send size cannot be changed.
4-50
Specifying the original scan size (by numerical values)
When scanning a non-standard size original such as a postcard or card, follow these steps to specify the original size.
The width can be from 25 mm to 432 mm (1" to 17"), and the height can be from 25 mm to 297 mm (1" to 11-5/8").
1
Touch the [Original] key.
The automatically detected original size appears to the right of the [Original] key.
☞
Touch the [Scan Size] key.
Fax/Original OK
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
2
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
3
Fax/Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Size Input
A4
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
B4
A3
Long Size
OK
AB
Inch
Touch the [Size Input] key.
4
Fax/Original
Size Input
(1), (2)
Cancel
X 420
(25 432) mm
Y 297
(25 297) mm
(3)
OK
OK
Enter the scan size.
(1) Touch the X (width) numeric value display key and enter the width.
(2) Touch the Y (height) numeric value display key and enter the height.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
To complete the setting and return to the screen of step 3, touch the [OK] key next to the [Cancel] key.
You can also touch the keys to change the number.
4-51
5
Fax/Original
Scan Size
X420 Y297
Send Size
Auto
Image Orientation
OK
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
Touch the [OK] key.
The specified size appears in the [Scan Size] key.
• When the scan size is specified by numerical values, the send size cannot be specified.
• When the automatic document feeder is used, an original longer that 432 mm (17") can be scanned (maximum width
1000 mm (39-3/8")). In this case, touch the [Long Size] key in the screen of step 3.
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by paper size) (page 4-49)
☞
TRANSMITTABLE ORIGINAL SIZES (page 4-29)
4-52
Specifying the send size of the original
Specify the send size as a paper size. If a send size bigger than the scan size is selected, the image will be enlarged. If a send size smaller than the scan size is selected, the image will be reduced.
The send size cannot be specified when [Long Size] is selected for the scan size, or when the scan size is specified by numerical values.
1
Touch the [Original] key.
☞
2
Fax/Original
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
OK
Touch the [Send Size] key.
3
(1)
Fax/Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Manual
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
B4
A3
(2)
OK
Specify the send size.
(1) Touch the desired send size key.
When the document cover is installed, the [Long size] key is not displayed.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
AB
Inch
• Depending on the "Scan Size" setting, it may not be possible to select some sizes for the "Send Size". Size keys that cannot be specified for the "Send Size" are greyed out to prevent selection.
• To specify an Inch size for the send size, touch the [AB Inch] key to highlight the [Inch] side and then specify the send size.
4-53
4
(1) (2)
OK Fax/Original
Scan Size
Auto A4
141% Send Size
A3
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
Specify the orientation in which the original is placed.
(1) Touch the appropriate [Image Orientation] key.
If the wrong orientation is selected here, the image may not be sent properly when using enlargement/reduction.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
The ratio used for reduction or enlargement of the original will appear between the "Scan Size" and the "Send Size".
4-54
CHANGING THE EXPOSURE
The exposure can be changed to match the darkness of the original.
Refer the following tables to select appropriate settings.
Exposure settings
Auto
Manual
Exposure
1-2
3
4-5
When to select
This setting automatically adjusts the exposure for light and dark parts of the original.
Select this setting when the original consists of dark text.
Select this setting for a normal original (neither dark nor light).
Select this setting when the original consists of faint text.
1
Touch the [Exposure] key.
The current exposure setting appears to the right of the [Exposure] key.
☞
2
Fax/Exposure
(1) (2)
Auto
Manual
1 3 5
(3)
OK
Select the exposure.
(1) Touch the [Manual] key.
(2) Adjust the exposure with the keys.
When the exposure is set to [Auto], the cannot be used.
keys
The exposure darkens when the and lightens when the
key is touched,
key is touched.
To return to auto exposure adjustment, touch the [Auto] key.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
When using the document glass to scan multiple original pages, the exposure setting can be changed each time you change pages. When using the automatic document feeder, the exposure setting cannot be changed once scanning has begun.
(However, when "Job Build" in the special modes is used, the exposure can be changed each time a new set of originals is inserted.)
System Settings (Administrator): Default Exposure Settings
This is used to change the default exposure setting.
4-55
CHANGING THE RESOLUTION
The resolution can be selected to match the characteristics of the original, such as text or photo, the size of the text, and the darkness of the image.
Refer the following tables to select appropriate settings.
Resolution settings
Standard
Fine
Resolution
Super Fine
Ultra Fine
Half Tone
When to select
Select this setting when your original consists of normal-sized text (like the text in this manual).
Select this setting when your original has small text or diagrams with fine lines.
The original will be scanned at twice the resolution of the [Standard] setting.
Select this setting when your original has intricate pictures or diagrams.
A higher-quality image will be produced than with the [Fine] setting.
Select this setting when your original has intricate pictures or diagrams.
This setting gives the best image quality. However, transmission will take longer than with the other settings.
Select this setting when your original is a photograph or has gradations of colour (such as a colour original).
This setting will produce a clearer image than [Fine], [Super Fine], or [Ultra Fine] used alone.
Halftone cannot be selected when [Standard] is used.
1
Touch the [Resolution] key.
The current resolution setting appears to the right of the [Resolution] key.
☞
Fax/Resolution
(1) (2)
OK
Select the resolution.
(1) Touch the key of the desired resolution.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
2
Standard
Fine
Super Fine
Ultra Fine
Half Tone
When [Fine], [Super Fine], or [Ultra Fine] is selected, the [Half Tone] key can be touched to select halftone.
• When using the document glass to scan multiple original pages, the resolution setting can be changed each time you change pages.
When using the automatic document feeder, the resolution setting cannot be changed once scanning has begun. (However, when
"Job Build" in the special modes is used, the resolution can be changed each time a new set of originals is inserted.)
• When a fax is sent at [Ultra Fine], [Super Fine], or [Fine] resolution, a lower resolution will be used if the receiving machine does not have that resolution.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Resolution Setting
This is used to change the default resolution setting.
4-56
CHECKING THE IMAGE TO BE TRANSMITTED
(Preview)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
If you touch the [Preview] key before scanning the original, you can check the scanned image in the touch panel before sending the image.
* The factory default setting is disabled.
Depending on the size of the transmission data, part of the preview image may not appear in the preview screen in the touch panel.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
Touch the [Preview] key to highlight it.
2
Scan
Address Book
Direct TX
Sub Address
Address Review
Internet Fax
Original
Fax
Scan:
Auto Exposure
Resolution Standard
Special Modes
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
3
Select transmission settings and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
"Originals are being read" appears while the originals are being scanned, and when scanning is finished, the preview screen appears on the touch panel. Transmission will not take place until you touch the [Start Sending] key in the preview screen.
4
Preview
B/W
Sender Info
Function Rev.
Check the preview image and then touch the [Start Sending] key.
Transmission begins.
For information on the preview screen, see "
Display Rotation
Start
Sending
0001 /0010
System settings (administrator): Default Preview
You can specify whether or not the [Preview] key function will be enabled in the base screens of the image send modes and in the address book.
4-57
PREVIEW CHECK SCREEN
This section explains the preview check screen.
Preview
B/W
Sender Info
Function Rev.
(3)
(4)
(1)
Display Rotation
Start
Sending
(5)
(6)
(7)
0001 /0010
(2)
(1) Preview image
A preview of the scanned original appears.
If the image is cut off, use the scroll bars at the right and bottom of the screen to scroll the image. Touch a bar and slide it to scroll. (You can also touch the keys to scroll.)
(2) Change page keys
•
•
When there are multiple pages, use these keys to change pages.
keys: Go to the first or the last page.
keys: Go to the previous page or the next page.
• Page number display:
This shows the total number of pages and the current page number. You can touch the current page number key and enter a number with the numeric keys to go to that page number.
(3) [Sender Info] key
Touch to display the sender information for fax own number.
This key can only be touched when the entire preview image is displayed in the preview screen.
(4) [Function Rev.] key
Touch to check special mode settings or scan settings for two-sided originals.
(5) Display zoom key
Use this to set the zoom ratio of the displayed image.
Changes from the left in the order "Full Page", "Twice",
"4 Times", "8 Times". The setting applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(6) "Display Rotation" key
This rotates the image right or left by 90 degrees. The rotation applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(7) [Start Sending] key
Touch to begin transmission.
• A preview image is an image for display on the touch panel. It will differ from the actual send result.
• The preview image reflects certain scanning and special mode settings.
Settings reflected in the preview image are as follows:
Scanning settings: Original
Special modes: Erase, Dual Page Scan, Card Shot, 2in1
4-58
FAX RECEPTION
This section explains the basic procedures for receiving faxes.
RECEIVING FAXES
When the reception mode is set to "Auto Reception", the machine will receive and print faxes automatically. The fax reception mode is displayed in the base screen.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
This shows the current fax reception mode and the amount of free memory remaining.
• When fax reception is in progress, it is possible to reserve a transmission by performing the transmission in memory transmission mode.
☞
TRANSMISSION METHODS (page 4-26)
• To print received faxes, make sure that the required paper is loaded in the machine's paper trays. It is not necessary to load A4 (8-1/2" x 11") paper and B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") paper in both the vertical ( ) and horizontal ( ) orientations.
Differences in orientation are automatically adjusted when faxes are received.
When a fax smaller than A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size is received, the size of the paper used for printing will vary depending on the orientation (vertical or horizontal) in which the sender placed the original.
•
System Settings: Receive Setting (page 7-105)
This is used to change the fax reception mode. "Auto Reception" should normally be used.
Select "Manual Reception" when an extension phone is connected to the machine.
• System Settings (Administrator): Allow/Reject Number Setting
You can store numbers and specify whether or not reception is allowed from those numbers.
4-59
RECEIVING A FAX
When a fax is transmitted to the machine, the machine automatically receives and prints the fax.
Beep
The machine rings and fax reception begins automatically.
A beep sounds when reception ends.
1
• System Settings (Administrator): Speaker Settings
This is used to change the volume and tone of the reception beep.
• System Settings (Administrator): Number of Calls in Auto Reception
This is used to change the number of rings on which fax reception begins automatically. To receive faxes without the machine ringing, select "0" rings.
The fax is automatically printed.
2
• If a password entry screen appears...
A password must be entered to print the received fax. When the correct password is entered, the received fax is printed.
☞
PRINTING A PASSWORD-PROTECTED FAX (Hold Setting For Received Data Print) (page 4-62)
• The output tray and stapling (when a finisher is installed) can be selected.
The number of copies of received faxes that are printed and the output tray can be selected. When a finisher is installed, the number of copies printed, the output tray, and stapling can be selected.
• If printing of a copy job or print job is in progress when a fax is received, the fax will not be printed until the previously reserved job is completed.
• Received faxes will not be printed when the machine cannot print due to an error condition such as out of paper, out of toner, or a paper misfeed. The faxes will be printed automatically when the error condition is cleared. (If the machine ran out of paper, touch the [OK] key in the touch panel after loading paper.
• When received faxes cannot be printed, the faxes can be forwarded to another fax machine.
☞
FORWARDING RECEIVED FAXES (Fax Data Forward) (page 4-67)
• System Settings (Administrator): Duplex Reception Setting
This is used to have received faxes printed on both sides of the paper.
• System Settings (Administrator): Receiving Date & Time Print
Use this to select whether or not the date and time of reception is added when a received image is printed.
4-60
RECEIVING A FAX MANUALLY
A fax can be received manually using the touch panel. While the machine rings, touch the [Speaker] key in the base screen and then touch the [Fax Manual Reception] key that appears.
Telephone mode.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Speaker Volume Exposure
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution Standard
Special Modes Address Review
File
Quick File
Auto
Speaker
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
Resend
PC Scan
Auto
Fax Memory:100%
Fax Manual
Reception
• When a call is answered by touching the [Speaker] key, you will be able to hear the other party, however, you will not be able to speak.
• Even when you use an extension phone to answer a call, you can touch the [Fax Manual Reception] key in the touch panel to begin fax reception. You can also use the extension phone to begin fax reception.
☞
RECEIVING A FAX AFTER ANSWERING A CALL ON THE EXTENSION PHONE (Remote Reception) (page 4-127)
4-61
PRINTING A PASSWORD-PROTECTED FAX
(Hold Setting For Received Data Print)
"Hold Setting for Received Data Print" can be enabled in the system settings (administrator) to have faxes received to memory without being printed. To print the faxes, a password must be entered. When this function is used, a password entry screen appears in the touch panel when a fax is received.
Received data is stored.
Enter password via the 10-key.
Cancel
When the previously programmed 4-digit password is entered with the numeric keys, printing begins.
The [Cancel] key can be touched to close the password entry screen. If this is done, the data in memory key ( blink in the touch panel. The password entry screen will reappear when you touch the blinking key (
) will
) or change modes.
When "Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), a password can be entered to display the received data list screen. If you wish to check an image before printing it, continue from step 2 on the next page.
• The received faxes will be retained in memory regardless of whether they were received automatically or manually.
• If "Fax Data Receive/Forward" is executed in the system settings to forward received faxes to another machine, faxes retained in memory will also be forwarded. At that time, the same password entry screen as for printing will appear.
Forwarding will not take place unless the password is entered.
System Settings (Administrator): Hold Setting for Received Data Print
Enable this setting to have received faxes retained in memory until a password is entered. This setting is also used to program the password.
4-62
CHECKING THE IMAGE BEFORE PRINTING
This function requires the hard disk drive.
When "Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled* in the system settings (administrator), you can check a received image in the touch panel before printing it out. When this function is enabled, follow the steps below to print a received image.
* The factory default setting is disabled.
Depending on the size of the received data, part of the image in the image check screen on the touch panel may not appear.
1
The memory has received data.
Check the data?
No Yes
2
Received Data List
Thumbnail
0123456789
BBB BBB
9876543210
CCC CCC
Image Check
(1)
Forward
Back
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
Select All
10:28 Not checked
10:14 Checked 1
5
10:12 Not checked 04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
10:08
10:00
10:00
Checked
Not checked
Checked
Delete Print
(2)
When an image is received, a confirmation prompt will appear. Touch the [Yes] key.
If this message appears while you are configuring settings of any type and you touch the [Yes] key, the settings that you are configuring will be cancelled. If this message appears in another mode, you will return to the base screen of image send mode after checking the image.
Select the received image
(1) Touch the key of the received image that you want to check.
Multiple received images can be checked.
(2) Touch the [Image Check] key.
• To show thumbnails of the received images, touch the
[Thumbnail] key.
• To delete an image that has been selected, touch the
[Delete] key. To print an image that has been selected, touch the [Print] key.
3
Image Check
0123456789 04/04/2010 10:28
0001 /0010
Back
1 / 3
Display Rotation
Check the received image and then touch the [Print] key.
Printing begins.
For information on the image check screen, see "
If the screen of step 1 appears when you are configuring settings in the setting screens of any of the modes, the configured settings will be cancelled if you view the image. After viewing the image, you will return to the base screen of image send mode, regardless of which mode you were in previously.
System Settings (Administrator): Received Data Image Check Setting
Use this to specify whether or not a received fax can be viewed before it is printed.
4-63
CHECKING THE IMAGE BEFORE
FORWARDING
This function requires the hard disk drive.
When "Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabledin the system settings (administrator), you can select the received data from the list and forward it to the addresses recorded in the address book. When this function is enabled, follow the steps below to forward the received image.
* The factory default setting is disabled.
Depending on the size of the received data, part of the image in the image check screen on the touch panel may not appear.
1
The memory has received data.
Check the data?
No Yes
2
Received Data List
Thumbnail
0123456789
BBB BBB
9876543210
CCC CCC
Image Check
(1)
Forward
Back
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
Select All
10:28 Not checked
10:14 Checked 1
5
10:12 Not checked 04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
10:08
10:00
10:00
Checked
Not checked
Checked
Delete Print
(2)
When an image is received, a confirmation prompt will appear. Touch the [Yes] key.
If this message appears while you are configuring settings of any type and you touch the [Yes] key, the settings that you are configuring will be cancelled. If this message appears in another mode, you will return to the base screen of image send mode after checking the image.
Select the received image
(1) Touch the key of the received image that you want to check.
Multiple received images can be checked.
(2) Touch the [Forward] key.
• To show thumbnails of the received images, touch the
[Thumbnail] key.
• To check a receieved image, touch the [Image Check] key.
☞
IMAGE CHECK SCREEN (Page 4-66)
3
5 10 15 To Cc
Address Review
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
Freq.
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Start forward.
Touch the Forward Destination from the address book to select it.
Multiple forwarding addresses can be checked.
4-64
4
5 10 15 To Cc
Address Review
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
Freq.
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Start forward.
Start forward
Touch the [Start forward.] key.
If the screen of step 1 appears when you are configuring settings in the setting screens of any of the modes, the configured settings will be cancelled if you view the image. After viewing the image, you will return to the base screen of image send mode, regardless of which mode you were in previously.
System Settings (Administrator): Received Data Image Check Setting
Use this to specify whether or not a received Internet fax can be viewed before it is printed.
4-65
IMAGE CHECK SCREEN
This function requires the hard disk drive.
This section explains the image check screen.
Image Check
0123456789 04/04/2010 10:28
Back
1 / 3
Display Rotation
0001 0010
(3) (1) (2)
(1) Information display
This shows information on the displayed image.
(2) Preview image
An image of the selected received image appears.
If the image is cut off, use the scroll bars at the right and bottom of the screen to scroll the image. Touch a bar and slide it to scroll. (You can also touch the keys to scroll.)
(3) Change page keys
•
•
When there are multiple pages, use these keys to change pages.
keys: Go to the first or the last page.
keys: Go to the previous page or the next page.
• Page number display: This shows the total number of pages and the current page number. You can touch the current page number key and enter a number with the numeric keys to go to that page number.
(4) (5) (6) (7)
(4) "Display Rotation" key
This rotates the image right or left by 90 degrees. The rotation applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(5) [Print] key
Touch to start printing.
(6) Display zoom key
Use this to set the zoom ratio of the displayed image.
Changes from the left in the order "Full Page", "Twice",
"4 Times", "8 Times". The setting applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(7) Image select key
When multiple images are selected for preview display, use this to change the displayed images.
A preview image is an image for display on the touch panel. It will differ from the actual print result.
4-66
FORWARDING RECEIVED FAXES
(Fax Data Forward)
When the machine cannot print because it is out of paper or out of toner, received faxes can be forwarded to another previously programmed fax machine.
This function is convenient in an office or work area that has two or more telephone lines and another fax machine is connected to a different line than the machine.
The machine cannot print The machine
Forwarding destination
Forwarding
Printing
Received fax
Forwarding of received faxes is executed in the system settings of the machine. Press the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key on the operation panel to display the system setting menu screen in the touch panel. Select [Fax Data Receive/Forward] -
[Fax Settings], and then touch the key that executes received fax forwarding.
• If some pages of a fax that is being forwarded were successfully printed, only those pages that were not printed will be forwarded.
• A forwarded fax becomes a fax transmission job. If transmission does not take place because the transmission was cancelled or an error occurred, the fax will be held in memory until it can be printed.
• All faxes received are forwarded. Note, however, that faxes received to an F-code confidential memory box cannot be forwarded.
• If a password entry screen appears after touching the [OK] key, "Hold Setting for Received Data Print" has been enabled.
Enter the password with the numeric keys to begin forwarding.
☞
PRINTING A PASSWORD-PROTECTED FAX (Hold Setting For Received Data Print) (page 4-62)
•
System Settings: Fax Data Receive/Forward (page 7-22)
Use this to forward received faxes when the machine is unable to print.
• System Settings (Administrator): Set the Telephone Number for Data Forwarding
This is used to store the forwarding fax number.
4-67
FORWARDING RECEIVED FAXES TO A
NETWORK ADDRESS
(Inbound Routing Settings)
You can have received faxes automatically forwarded to an e-mail address, file server address, desktop address, or network folder address. This function can be used to forward received faxes to a specified address without printing them.
The machine
Forwarding
Received fax
• This function cannot be used for faxes received by confidential reception.
• When faxes forwarded using this function are printed at the forwarding destination, the date and time of reception cannot be printed on the faxes. ("Receiving Date & Time Print" is disabled.)
CONFIGURING INBOUND ROUTING SETTINGS
All inbound routing settings are configured in the Web pages. For the procedure for accessing the Web pages, see the
Start Guide.
The following explanation assumes that the Web pages have been accessed with administrator rights.
To configure inbound routing settings, follow the steps below.
Enabling the inbound routing function.
(1) In the Web page menu, click [Application
Settings], [Inbound Routing Settings], and then [Administration Settings].
(2) Select [Enable] in "Inbound Routing" and click the [Submit] button.
1
Users without administrator rights can be prohibited from storing, editing, and deleting forwarding tables in this screen, and from specifying which table is used. To do so, select the checkboxes below .
• Disable Registration of Forward Table • Disable Change/Delete of Forward Table • Disable Change of Forward
Approval
When inbound routing is enabled, you can also specify whether or not you wish the machine to print the forwarded faxes.
To have all received faxes printed before being forwarded, select "Print Out All Report" in "Print Style Setting". To have received faxes printed only when an error prevents forwarding, select "Print at Error".
If an error occurs when [Not Print and Forward to the Following E-mail Address at Error] is selected, received data is not printed, but is forwarded to the specified e-mail address.
After configuring the settings, be sure to click the [Submit] button.
4-68
2
Storing sender addresses.
If you wish to have only faxes from specified addresses forwarded, store the desired sender addresses. Send addresses stored here can be selected from a list when you store a forwarding table.
(1) Click [Sender Number/Address
Registration] in the [Inbound Routing
Settings] menu in the Web page.
(2) Enter the sender address in "Internet Fax
Address" or "Fax Number" as appropriate, and click the [Add to List] button.
The entered address will be added to the "Address to be
Entered" list.
• Specify whether the address will be directly entered
(maximum of 1500 characters) or selected from a global address book by clicking the [Global Address
Search] button.
• To store multiple addresses, repeat this step.
(3) When you have finished adding addresses, click the [Submit] button.
• A maximum of 500 sender numbers/addresses can be stored.
• To delete an entered address, select the address in "Address to be Entered" and click the [Delete] button.
4-69
3
(8)
(2)
(7) (6)
(3) (4)
(5)
Store a forwarding table.
Follow the steps below to store a forwarding table that combines a specified sender and forwarding address.
(1) Click [Inbound Routing Settings] in the Web page menu and click the [Add] button.
(2) Enter a "Table Name".
(3) Select the line used for reception.
(4) Select the sender whose faxes will be forwarded.
• To forward all received faxes, select [Forward All
Received Data].
• To forward only data received from specific senders, select [Forward Received Data from Below Sender]. To forward all data except data from specific senders, select [Forward Received Data from Senders except
Below]. Select the appropriate senders from the list and click the [Add] button.
(5) Select the forwarding conditions.
• To always forward received data, select [Always
Forward].
• To specify a day and time on which received data will be forwarded, select [Forward on Selected Day & Time] and select the checkbox of the desired day of the week. To specify a time, select the [Set Forwarding
Time] checkbox and specify the time.
(6) Select the file format.
The format can be set separately for each forwarding address (for each of forwarding addresses 1, 2, and 3 in the table).
(7) Select the forwarding address.
Forwarding addresses can be selected from the machine's address book. (Multiple addresses can be selected.) A maximum of 1000 forwarding addresses can be stored (a combined maximum of 100 file server, desktop, and network folder addresses can be stored).
(8) Click [Submit].
• When selecting senders from the "Sender Number/Address Setting" list, you can use the [Shift] key or the [Ctrl] key on your keyboard to select multiple senders.
• A maximum of 50 forwarding tables can be stored.
• Images sent in TIFF format may not display correctly in some recipient environments. In this event, change the file format to PDF.
• Up to three forwarding day and time settings can be set for one forwarding table, and a forwarding destination can be set for each set time. To configure these settings, use the forwarding list tabs to access each setting.
4-70
4
(2)
Specifying forwarding tables to be used.
To use the inbound routing function, enable the forwarding tables that you wish to use from among the stored tables.
(1) Click [Inbound Routing Settings] in the Web page menu.
(2) Select [Always Forward] or [Forward on
Selected Day & Time] from the forwarding table.
The forwarding permission settings that appear here are linked to the forwarding conditions set in step 3. If you wish to use different forwarding conditions than those set in step 3, set the forwarding permission settings.
(3) Click [Submit].
(3)
To delete a forwarding table, click the checkbox next to the table name so that it is selected and click [Delete].
4-71
SPECIAL MODES
This section explains special modes that can be used for fax transmission.
SPECIAL MODES
When the [Special Modes] key is touched in the base screen, the special modes menu screen appears. The special modes menu consists of two screens. Touch the key to switch between the two screens. When the [OK] key is touched in the special modes screen, the selected settings are entered and the base screen reappears.
1st screen
Fax/Special Modes
(1)
(4)
(7)
(10)
Program
Timer
(2)
(5)
Erase
2in1
(3)
Dual Page
Scan
(6)
Card Shot
(8)
Job
Build
Original
Count
(11)
Mixed Size
Original
File
(9)
Slow Scan
Mode
(12)
Quick File
OK
1
2
2nd screen
Fax/Special Modes
(13)
Verif.
Stamp
(15)
Own Name
Select
(14)
Transaction
Report
(16)
Memory Box
(17)
Polling
OK
2
2
(1) [Program] key
☞
STORING FAX OPERATIONS (Program) (page
(2) [Erase] key
☞
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS ON THE
(3) [Dual Page Scan] key
☞
TRANSMITTING AN ORIGINAL AS TWO
SEPARATE PAGES (Dual Page Scan) (page 4-78)
(4) [Timer] key
☞
SENDING A FAX AT A SPECIFIED TIME (Timer)
(5) [2in1] key
☞
SENDING TWO PAGES AS A SINGLE PAGE (2in1)
(6) [Card Shot] key
☞
SENDING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD AS A SINGLE
(7) [Job Build] key
☞
SENDING A LARGE NUMBER OF PAGES (Job
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(8) [Mixed Size Original] key
☞
TRANSMITTING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT
SIZES (Mixed Size Original) (page 4-90)
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(9) [Slow Scan Mode] key
☞
FAXING THIN ORIGINALS (Slow Scan Mode) (page
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(10) [Original Count] key
☞
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
ORIGINAL SHEETS BEFORE TRANSMISSION
(11) [File] key
Touch this to use the File function of document filing mode.
This function requires the hard disk drive.
(12) [Quick File] key
Touch this to use the Quick File function of document filing mode.
This function requires the hard disk drive.
(13) [Verif. Stamp] key*
☞
STAMPING SCANNED ORIGINALS (Verif. Stamp)
4-72
(14) [Transaction Report] key
☞
CHANGING THE PRINT SETTINGS FOR THE
TRANSACTION REPORT (Transaction Report)
(15) [Own Name Select] key
☞
TEMPORARILY CHANGING THE SENDER
INFORMATION (Own Name Select) (page 4-101)
(16) [Memory Box] key
☞
SENDING A FAX WHEN ANOTHER MACHINE
POLLS YOUR MACHINE (Polling Memory) (page
(17) [Polling] key
☞
CALLING A FAX MACHINE AND INITIATING
RECEPTION (Polling) (page 4-102)
* Does not appear when the automatic document feeder and the stamp unit are not installed.
Special modes can generally be combined with other special modes, however, there are some combinations that are not possible. If a prohibited combination is selected, a message will appear in the touch panel.
[OK] key and [Cancel] key
In some cases two [OK] keys and one [Cancel] key will appear in the special mode screens. The keys are used as follows:
Fax/Special Modes
Erase Cancel
OK
OK
(A)
(B)
(C)
Edge
Erase
Centre
Erase
Edge+Centre
Erase
Edge
10
(0~20) mm
Side Erase
(A) Enter the selected special mode setting and return to the base screen.
(B) Enter the selected special mode setting and return to the special modes menu screen. Touch this key when you wish to continue selecting other special mode settings.
(C) During selection of special mode settings, this key returns you to the special modes menu screen without saving the settings. When settings have been completed, this cancels the settings and returns you to the special modes menu screen.
4-73
STORING FAX OPERATIONS (Program)
A program is a group of transmission settings stored together. When transmission settings are stored in a program, the settings can be retrieved and used for a fax job by means of a simple operation.
For example, suppose that the same A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size documents are distributed to branch offices in various regions once a month.
(1) The same documents are faxed to each branch office
(2) To save paper, two document pages are faxed as a single page
(3) Smudges on the edges of the documents are erased before transmission
A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size documents to be distributed
Fax received by recipients.
1 2
1 2
When a job program is not stored
Enter the fax numbers of the branch offices
1 2
When a job program is stored
Retrieve the stored program.
Select the 2in1 function.
Select erase settings
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
The originals are scanned and transmitted.
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
The originals are scanned and transmitted.
Considerable time is required to send the documents each month because the above settings must be selected.
In addition, mistakes may occasionally be made when selecting the settings, so incorrect transmissions may occur.
When a program is stored, settings are selected with ease by simply pressing the program key.
In addition, transmission takes place based on the stored settings so there are no chances for mistakes.
• Programs are stored, edited, and deleted using "Address Control" in the system settings. See "
" (page
7-21) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS".
• Programs can also be stored using the Web pages. Click [Job Programs] and then [Image Send] in the Web page menu.
• The settings stored in a program will be retained even after the program is used for transmission. The same settings can be used repeatedly for transmission.
• The following settings can be stored in programs.
Destinations: One-touch keys, group keys, search numbers
Image settings:
Special modes:
Original scan size, original orientation, duplex scanning, exposure, resolution
Polling reception, Erase, Dual Page Scan, Job Build, Mixed Size Original, Slow Scan Mode,
Original Count, Verif. Stamp, 2in1
F-code communication: A destination that includes an F-code can be stored to perform an F-code operation.
• Up to 48 programs can be stored.
• Up to 500 destinations can be stored in each program.
4-74
1
Place the original.
Place the original in the document feeder tray or on the document glass as appropriate for the functions stored in the program.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Program] key.
☞
(1) (2)
OK
Retrieve the stored program.
(1) Touch the desired program key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
3
Program
Program A
Program C
Program E
Program G
Program I
Program K
Program B
Program D
Program F
Program H
Program J
Program L
1
2
4
Program : Program C
0123456789
Scan Internet Fax
Address Review
Original
Fax
Scan:
Auto Exposure
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
Select additional settings.
When a program is used, the following settings can be additionally specified:
• Image settings: Original scan size*, send size
• Special modes: Timer Transmission, Card Shot, File, Quick
File, Own Name Select, Transaction Report
* When stored in the program, this cannot be additionally specified.
• The screen that appears will vary depending on the destination stored in the program.
• The mode cannot be changed here.
• Functions stored in the program cannot be cancelled here.
5
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
4-75
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS ON THE
IMAGE (Erase)
The erase function is used to erase shadows on images produced when scanning thick originals or books. (This function erases the parts of the image where shadows tend to form. The function does not detect shadows and erase only the shadows.)
Scanning a thick book
Not using the erase function
Using the erase function
Shadows appear here.
Erase modes
Edge Erase Centre Erase
Shadows appear in the image.
No shadows appear.
Edge + Centre Erase Side Erase
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Erase] key.
☞
4-76
4
Fax/Special Modes
Erase
(1)
Edge
Erase
Centre
Erase
Edge+Centre
Erase
Side Erase
Cancel
(2) (3)
OK
OK
Edge
10
(0~20) mm
Select the erase settings.
(1) Touch the desired erase mode.
Select one of the 4 erase modes.
Touch the [Side Erase] key to open the following screen.
Erase
Side Erase
Up
Cancel OK
Erase position for Original Side 2
Left Right
Same Side as
Side 1
Different Side from Side 1
Down
Touch the checkbox of the edge that you wish to erase and make sure that a checkmark ( ) appears.
When performing two-sided scanning, set the erase edge on the reverse side.
• If you touch the [Same Side as Side 1] key, the edge in the same position as on the front side will be erased.
• If you touch the [Different Side from Side 1], the edge in the position opposite to the erased edge on the front side will be erased.
When you have completed the settings, touch the [OK] key.
keys.
(2) Set the erasure width with the
0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 1") can be entered.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
5
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
When the erase function is used, erase takes place at the edges of the original image. If you also use a reduction or an enlargement setting, the erase width will change according to the selected ratio. For example, if the erase width setting is
20 mm (1") and the image is reduced to 50%, the erase width will be 10 mm (1/2").
To cancel an erase setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
System Settings (Administrator): Erase Width Adjustment
The default erase width setting is linked to the copy mode system setting, and can be set from 0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 1"). The factory default setting is 10 mm (1/2").
4-77
TRANSMITTING AN ORIGINAL AS TWO
SEPARATE PAGES (Dual Page Scan)
The left and right sides of an original can be transmitted as two separate pages. This function is useful when you wish to fax the left and right pages of a book or other bound document as separate pages.
Example: Faxing the left and right pages of a book
1
Book or bound document
The left and right pages are sent as two pages.
Example:
Original scan size
A3 (11" x 17") x 1 page
• When using dual page scan, the original must be placed on the document glass.
• The send size cannot be changed.
Transmitted image
A4 (8-1/2" x 11") x 2 pages
Place the original face down on the document glass.
Align the centre of the original with the appropriate size mark
.
Size mark
Centreline of
A3 original
Centreline of
11" x 17" original
The page on this side is scanned first.
Centreline of original
A3
(11" x 17")
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
4-78
3
Fax/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
(2)
Erase
2in1
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
1
2
(3)
OK
Select Dual Page Scan.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [Dual Page Scan] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• To erase shadows caused by the binding of a book or other bound document, use the erase function. (Note, however, that
"Centre Erase" and "Edge + Centre Erase" cannot be used.)
• When the scan size of the original is specified by numerical values, this function cannot be used.
To cancel Dual Page Scan...
Touch the [Dual Page Scan] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
4-79
SENDING A FAX AT A SPECIFIED TIME
(Timer)
When this function is used, transmission takes place automatically at a specified time.
The timer transmission function makes it easy to perform reserved transmissions, broadcast transmissions and other transmissions at night or other times when phone rates are low.
A timer setting can also be specified for polling reception to receive a fax when you are not present.
During the day, set up a broadcast transmission to take place at 20:00
At 20:00, the broadcast transmission begins automatically
(Transmission to the first destination takes place)
• When a timer transmission is set, keep the main power switch "on". Transmission will not take place if the main power is turned off at the specified time.
• When performing a timer transmission, you must scan the original into memory when you set up the transmission. It is not possible to leave the document in the auto document feeder or on the document glass and have it scanned at the reserved time of transmission.
• Settings selected for a timer transmission (exposure, resolution, special modes, etc.) are automatically cleared after the transmission is finished. (However, when the document filing function is used, the scanned original and settings are stored on the built-in hard drive.)
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Timer] key.
☞
4-80
4
Fax/Special Modes
Timer
(1)
Cancel
(2) (3)
OK
OK
Day of the Week
---
Time
10 hh.
00 mm.
Set the time with the keys.
(1) Specify the day.
If you do not wish to specify a day, select [---]. In this case, transmission will begin when the time specified in
(2) arrives.
(2) Specify the time (hour, minute)
Select the time in 24-hour format.
You can also directly touch a numeric display key to change the setting with the numeric keys.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
When this screen is opened, the setting will show the current time. If the time is not correct, press the [CLEAR ALL] key ( ) to cancel the operation. Correct the time in the system settings and then perform the timer transmission procedure.
☞
CHECKING THE DATE AND TIME (page 4-6)
5
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• The time can be specified up to a week in advance.
• Up to 94 timer transmissions can be stored at once.
• Only one timer polling operation can be stored at once. If you wish to poll multiple machines, store a serial polling timer operation.
• If another transmission is in progress when the specified time arrives, the timer operation will begin after that transmission is finished.
• Other operations can be performed after a timer transmission is set up.
• This function cannot be used in direct transmission mode or when the speaker is used to dial.
• If a timer transmission is given priority in the job status screen, the time specification is cancelled. The transmission will begin as soon as the job in progress is completed.
☞
GIVING PRIORITY TO A RESERVED FAX JOB (page 4-136)
To cancel timer transmission...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
4-81
SENDING TWO PAGES AS A SINGLE PAGE
(2in1)
Two original pages can be reduced and sent as a single page. This function is convenient when you have a large number of original pages and wish to reduce the number of pages sent.
Portrait-oriented originals
Transmission
1 2
1 2
Landscape-oriented originals Transmission
1 2
1
2
1
Place the original.
When placing the originals, orient them as shown below.
Originals
Document feeder tray
Place the originals face up.
Portrait orientation
1
1 2
Landscape orientation
1 2
1
Document glass
Place the originals face down.
1
1
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
4-82
3
Fax/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
(2)
Erase
2in1
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
1
2
(3)
OK
Select 2in1.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [2in1] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
4
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
Special Modes
Standard
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
5
Fax/Original
(1) (2)
OK
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
Touch the [Original] key.
Specify the orientation in which the original is placed.
(1) Touch the appropriate [Image Orientation] key.
If this setting is not correct, a suitable image may not be transmitted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
6
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
The [Configure] key can be touched in the scan-end confirmation screen to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size. (However, when scanning each even-numbered page of the original, only the exposure can be changed.)
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
4-83
• Transmission is not possible at a size smaller than the original size.
• This function cannot be used in direct transmission mode or when the speaker is used to dial.
• The 2in1 function cannot be used when the original is other than A4, B5 or A5 (8-1/2" x 11" or 5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size.
• When the scan size of the original is specified by numerical values, this function cannot be used.
To cancel 2in1...
Touch the [2in1] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
4-84
SENDING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD AS A
SINGLE PAGE (Card Shot)
This function lets you send the front and reverse sides of a card as a single page, without the need to send each side separately.
Transmitted image
Originals
Transmission
Front
Back
Example of an A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size portrait scan transmission
Example of an A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size landscape scan transmission
When using card shot, the original must be scanned on the document glass.
Place the original face down on the document glass.
1
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Card Shot] key.
☞
4-85
4
Fax/Special Modes
Card Shot
(1) (A)
Cancel
(B) (2)
OK
OK
X
Y
86
(25~210) mm
54
(25~210) mm
Fit to
Send Size
Size Reset
Specify the original size.
(1) Enter the original size.
• Touch the X (width) numeric value display key and enter the width.
• Touch the Y (height) numeric value display key and enter the height.
(A) To return the original size to the default size, touch the [Size Reset] key.
(B) To automatically enlarge or reduce the image size to the send size, touch the [Fit to Send Size] key. Do not touch this key if you wish to scan the original at the original size that you entered.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
Y
X
• You can also touch the keys to change the number.
• The send size is automatically selected based on the original size you entered.
• After selecting Card Shot, you can touch the [Original] key in the base screen to change the original scan size or the send size. In this case, the screen of step 3 appears when you touch the scan size key. For the procedure for
setting the send size, see " Specifying the send size of the original " (page 4-53).
5
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to scan the front of the card.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
6
Turn the card over so that the back is face down, and press the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key to scan the back of the card.
Before scanning the back of the card, you can touch the [Configure] key in the touch panel to change the exposure.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
4-86
7
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Place next original. (Pg.No.x)
Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Configure Read-End
If you will continue by scanning the front of the card, you can touch the [Configure] key to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size.
• The ratio cannot be specified and "Rotation Sending Setting" cannot be selected.
• This function cannot be used in direct transmission mode or when the speaker is used to dial.
To cancel Card Shot...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
4-87
SENDING A LARGE NUMBER OF PAGES
(Job Build)
This function requires the automatic document feeder to be installed.
This function lets you separate an original consisting of numerous pages into sets, scan each set using the automatic document feeder, and transmit the pages in a single transmission. Use this function when there are more original pages than can be placed at once in the auto document feeder.
When scanning originals that are separated into sets, scan the set that has the first page first. The settings that you select for the first set can be used for all remaining sets.
Originals Originals are scanned in separate sets.
Transmission
1
1 1
101
Up to 999 pages can be scanned. Note that when the memory is being used for other jobs, fewer pages can be scanned.
1
Indicator line
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
Fax/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
(2)
Erase
2in1
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(3)
OK
1
2
Select job build mode.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [Job Build] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
4-88
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to scan the first set.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
5
Insert the next set of originals and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat this step until all originals have been scanned.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ). All scanned data will be cleared.
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Place next original. (Pg.No.x)
Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Configure Read-End
6
• If no action is taken for one minute after the confirmation screen appears, scanning automatically ends and the transmission is reserved.
• The [Configure] key can be touched to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size for each original page scanned. However, when Job Build is used in combination with 2in1 in the special modes, only the exposure can be changed when scanning each even-numbered page of the original pages.
• If the memory becomes full during scanning, a message will appear and the transmission will be cancelled.
• This function cannot be used in direct transmission mode or when the speaker is used to dial.
To cancel Job Build....
Touch the [Job Build] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
4-89
TRANSMITTING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT
SIZES (Mixed Size Original)
This function requires the automatic document feeder to be installed.
This feature lets you scan and transmit originals of different sizes at the same time; for example, B4 (8-1/2" x 14") size originals mixed together with A3 (11" x 17") size originals. When scanning the originals, the machine automatically detects the size of each original.
B4
A3
B4
A3
This feature can only be used with the following combinations of original sizes:
• A3 and B4
• A4R and B5
• A3 and B5
• B4 and A4R
• 11" x 17" and 8-1/2" x 14"
• B4 and A4
• B4 and A5
• A4 and B5
• B5 and A5
• 11" x 17" and 8-1/2" x 13" • 11" x 17" and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
1
B4
(8-1/2" x 14")
Place the originals with the corners aligned together in the far left corner.
B4
(8-1/2" x 14")
A3 (11" x 17")
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals with the corners aligned together in the far left corner of the document feeder tray.
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
Fax/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
(2)
Erase
2in1
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
1
2
(3)
OK
Select the mixed size original setting.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [Mixed Size Original] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
If an original scan size has been specified, a message will appear when the [Mixed Size Original] key is touched. To enable the Mixed Size Original setting, change the scan size setting to auto and then touch the [Mixed Size Original] key again.
4-90
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins. A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
• Once mixed size originals has been selected, an original scan size cannot be specified.
• When mixed size originals are set, automatic duplex scanning cannot be used.
• When the mixed size original setting is selected, rotation sending does not operate.
To cancel the mixed size original setting...
Touch the [Mixed Size Original] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Original Feeding Mode
The original feeding mode can be set to always scan mixed size originals.
4-91
FAXING THIN ORIGINALS (Slow Scan Mode)
This function requires the automatic document feeder to be installed.
Use this function when you wish to scan thin originals using the automatic document feeder. This function helps prevent thin originals from misfeeding.
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Adjust the document guides slowly.
1
If the originals are inserted with too much force, they may crumple and misfeed.
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
Fax/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
Erase
2in1
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(2) (3)
OK
1
2
Select slow scan mode.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [Slow Scan Mode] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
4-92
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins. A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
When this function is selected, automatic 2-sided scanning is not possible.
To cancel slow scan mode...
Touch the [Slow Scan Mode] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is not highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Original Feeding Mode
This is used to have scanning always take place using slow scan mode.
4-93
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
ORIGINAL SHEETS BEFORE TRANSMISSION
(Original Count)
The number of scanned original sheets can be counted and displayed before transmission. Checking the number of scanned original sheets before transmission helps prevent transmission mistakes.
1
Indicator line
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
Fax/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
(2)
Erase
2in1
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(3)
OK
1
2
Select the original count function.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the [Original Count] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation. All scanned data will be cleared.
4-94
5
(A)
XX pages of original have been scanned. (P.x)
Send the scanned data?
Cancel
(B)
OK
When scanning ends, check the number of original sheets scanned and touch the
[OK] key.
Transmission will begin.
• When Job Build mode is used, the confirmation message will appear after the [Read-End] key is touched.
• The message on the screen shows the number of sheets scanned in (A), and the number of pages (sheet sides) scanned in (B). For example, if both sides of one original sheet are scanned, "1" will appear in (A) and "2" will appear in (B).
If this step is not performed for one minute while the above confirmation screen appears, the scanned image and settings will be cleared and the base screen will reappear. Scanning will not be completed automatically and the image will not be reserved for transmission.
If the displayed number of original sheets is different from the actual number of sheets...
Touch the [Cancel] key and then touch the [OK] key in the message screen to clear all scanned data. Scan settings and destination settings will not be cleared. Insert the original sheets in the automatic document feeder again and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to re-scan.
When original count is enabled, it is enabled in other modes as well.
To cancel the Original Sheet Count function...
Touch the [Original Count] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is no longer highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Original Count Setting
This can be enabled to have the number of original sheets always counted. The setting can be enabled separately for each mode.
4-95
STAMPING SCANNED ORIGINALS (Verif. Stamp)
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
This function stamps each original that is scanned using the automatic document feeder, allowing you to verify that all originals were correctly scanned.
Position of stamp
1
Originals
Originals are scanned
1
An "O" mark is stamped in fluorescent pink.
To use this function, the optional stamp unit must be installed.
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
1
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
(3)
Fax/Special Modes
Verif.
Stamp
Own Name
Select
Transaction
Report
Memory Box
(2) (4)
OK
Polling
2
2
Select "Verif. Stamp".
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the screens.
keys to switch through the
(3) Touch the [Verif. Stamp] key so that it is highlighted.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
4-96
4
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins. A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• When two-sided originals are used, the front of each original is stamped twice.
• If an error occurs during scanning, an original that was not scanned may be stamped.
• When the "O" mark that is stamped on originals starts to become faint, replace the stamp cartridge. For the procedure for replacing the stamp cartridge, see "
REPLACING THE STAMP CARTRIDGE " (page 1-66) in "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE".
To cancel the stamp function...
Touch the [Verif. Stamp] key in the screen of step 3 so that it is no longer highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Default Verification Stamp
This setting is used to always have originals stamped.
4-97
CHANGING THE PRINT SETTINGS FOR THE
TRANSACTION REPORT
(Transaction Report)
A transaction report is automatically printed out to alert you when a transmission fails or when a broadcast transmission is performed. The transaction report contains a description of the transmission (date, start time, name of other party, time required, number of pages, result, etc.).
☞
INFORMATION APPEARING IN THE RESULT COLUMN (page 4-138)
Transaction reports are printed based on conditions set in the system settings; however, you can temporarily select different conditions for a transmission. To change the transaction report print conditions at the time of transmission, follow the steps below.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Transaction Report] key.
☞
Fax/Special Modes
Transaction Report
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
OK
Select print conditions.
(1) Select the print conditions.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
Always Print
Print Original Image
Print at Error Do not Print
4
• The print conditions for a transaction report are as follows:
"Always Print": A transaction report is printed no matter whether the transmission succeeds or fails.
"Print at Error": A transaction report is printed when transmission fails.
"Do not Print": Do not print a transaction report.
• When the [Print Original Image] checkbox is selected , part of the transmitted original is included on the transaction report.
• Even if the [Print Original Image] checkbox is selected , the original cannot be printed when speaker dialling, direct transmission, polling reception, or F-code transmission is used.
4-98
5
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
For a broadcast transmission, changes to the transaction report print conditions apply to all destinations.
To cancel the transaction report setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
• System Settings (Administrator): Transaction Report Print Select Setting
This is used to set the conditions for printing transaction reports.
The factory default setting is
Single Sending: Print Out All Report/
.
Print Out Error Report Only
/No Printed Report
Broadcasting:
Receiving:
Print Out All Report /Print Out Error Report Only/No Printed Report
Print Out All Report/Print Out Error Report Only/
No Printed Report
Confidential Reception (fax mode): Print Out Notice Page /No Printed Report
• System Settings (Administrator): Original Print on Transaction Report
This is used to have part of the transmitted original printed on the transaction report.
4-99
ADDING YOUR SENDER INFORMATION TO
FAXES (Own number sending)
Your sender information (date, time, sender name, sender fax number, number of pages) is automatically added to the top of each fax page you transmit.
Example of the sender information printed
04/APR/2010/Sat 3:00 PM AAAAA FAX No. 0123456789 P.001/001
(1) (2) (3) (4)
(1) Date, time:
(4) Page numbers:
The date and time of transmission.
(2) Sender name: The sender name programmed in the machine.
(3) Sender fax number: The sender fax number programmed in the machine.
Page number / total pages (the total page number is only printed when the fax is sent by memory transmission.)
Information programmed in Own Number Sending
Date, time: Adjust the setting in "Clock Adjust" in the system settings.
Sender name, sender fax number: Program the sender name and fax number in "Sender Data Registration" in the system settings (administrator). If you intend to use own number sending, be sure to configure
Page numbers: this information.
Select whether or not to include page numbers in "Printing Page Number at Receiver" in the system settings (administrator).
Page numbers appear in the format "page number / total pages". Only the page number is printed when manual transmission or quick online transmission is used.
System Settings (Administrator): Date/Own Number Print Position Setting
This is used to set the position where the sender information is printed. The sender information can be printed outside the scanned original image or inside the scanned original image.
Outside scanned image (factory default setting) Inside scanned image
Sender information
Originals
Sender information
Originals
The transmitted image length will be: length of sender information + length of original image. When the fax is printed by the receiving machine, it may be reduced or divided onto two pages.
The sender information is printed inside the original image, and thus the transmitted image length is the length of the original. Note that the sender information will overlap part of the original image (the overlapped part of the original image will not appear).
4-100
TEMPORARILY CHANGING THE SENDER
INFORMATION (Own Name Select)
You can select the sender information printed on a transmitted fax from a list of stored senders.
1
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Own Name Select] key.
☞
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
Select the sender information.
(1) Touch the desired sender information key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
2
Own Name Select
AAAAA
CCCCC
EEEEE
GGGGG
IIIII
KKKKK
BBBBB
DDDDD
FFFFF
HHHHH
JJJJJ
LLLLL
1
2
Touch the [OK] key.
3
Fax/Special Modes
Verif.
Stamp
Own Name
Select
Transaction
Report
Memory Box Polling
2
2
OK
System Settings (Administrator): Registration of Own Name Select
This is used to store sender information for Own Name Select.
4-101
CALLING A FAX MACHINE AND INITIATING
RECEPTION (Polling)
The Polling function allows the receiving machine to call the transmitting machine and initiate reception of a document in that machine.
Because the receiving machine initiates reception of a document, this is called "Polling Reception".
(1) Requests fax transmission.
Transmission
(3) The fax is received.
(2) The previously prepared document is transmitted.
Make sure that an original is not placed in the machine when using the polling reception function.
1
Fax/Special Modes
Verif.
Stamp
Own Name
Select
Transaction
Report
Memory Box
(3) (2) (4)
OK
Polling
2
2
Select polling reception.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the screens.
keys to switch through the
(3) Touch the [Polling] key so that it is highlighted.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
2
Enter the destination fax number.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 4-17)
• Multiple fax numbers can be entered.
Polling will take place in the order that the numbers were entered.
Polling multiple machines is called "Serial Polling".
Up to 500 fax numbers can be entered. In this procedure, one-touch keys that have a sub-address and passcode cannot be used.
• To enter multiple fax numbers, touch the [Next Address] key after entering a fax number and enter the next fax number.
4-102
3
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Your machine will call the other machine and initiate reception of the fax.
• Polling reception can be used in combination with the timer function to poll at any specified time, such as at night or when you are not present (Only one timer polling reception can be set.).
• This function can only be used when the other machine is Super G3 or G3 compatible and has a polling function.
• The receiving machine bears the expense (phone charges) of the polling reception.
To cancel polling reception...
Touch the [Polling] key in the screen of step 1 so that it is not highlighted.
4-103
INITIATING POLLING RECEPTION MANUALLY
Use this procedure when you must start polling after listening to a recorded greeting, such as when using a fax information service.
• Make sure that an original is not placed in the machine when using the polling reception function.
• This function cannot be used to poll multiple machines (serial polling).
1
(3) (1)
Telephone mode.
Speaker Resend
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Speaker Volume
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Fax Manual
Reception
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Speaker] key.
You will hear the dial tone through the machine's speaker.
(2) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(3) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
A group key cannot be used.
• In addition to specification by one-touch key, a destination can also be specified using a search number. You can also directly enter a fax number with the numeric keys or look up a destination in a global address book. For more information, see "
ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 4-17).
• After touching the [Speaker] key, you can touch the [Speaker Volume] key to adjust the volume of the speaker. The speaker volume changes each time the [Speaker Volume] key is touched. Adjust the volume to the desired level.
2
Fax/Special Modes
Verif.
Stamp
Own Name
Select
Transaction
Report
Memory Box
(3) (2)
OK
Polling
2
2
Receive the fax.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the screens.
keys to switch through the
(3) When you hear the fax tone, touch the
[Polling] key.
The fax is received.
• This function can only be used when the other machine is Super G3 or G3 compatible and has a polling function.
• The receiving machine bears the expense (phone charges) of the polling reception.
4-104
SENDING A FAX WHEN ANOTHER
MACHINE POLLS YOUR MACHINE
(Polling Memory)
Sending a document that has been scanned into memory when another machine polls your machine is called "Polling
Memory".
Prior to polling, the document that will be faxed to the other machine must be scanned into a polling memory box.
This function can only be used when the other machine is Super G3 or G3 compatible and has a polling function.
(1) Requests fax transmission.
Polling memory box
(2) The document in the memory box is transmitted.
Transmission
(3) The fax is received.
RESTRICTING POLLING ACCESS (Polling security)
To only allow specified machines to poll your machine, you can restrict polling to machines whose programmed sender fax number matches a fax number stored in your machine as a polling passcode number. This is called "Polling
Security".
To use this function, first store polling passcode numbers (the sender fax numbers programmed in the other machines) in the machine's system settings, and then enable polling security.
Up to 10 fax numbers can be stored as polling passcode numbers.
System Settings (Administrator): Fax Polling Security
This is used to enable polling security. This is used to store fax numbers as polling passcode numbers.
4-105
SCANNING A DOCUMENT INTO POLLING MEMORY
Follow these steps to scan a document into the memory box for polling transmission (Public Box).
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Memory Box] key.
☞
Touch the [Data Store] key.
Memory Box Exit
3
Data Store
Polling Memory
Data Check Delete Data
Confidential
Reception
Data Check
4
Memory Box - Data Store
Box 1
Box 3
Box 5
Box 7
Box 9
Box 11
Box 2
Box 4
Box 6
Box 8
Box 10
Box 12
Public Box
Back
1
2
Touch the [Public Box] key.
5
Memory Box - Data Store
(1)
Once
Unlimited
(2)
OK
Specify the number of polling times.
(1) Touch the key for the desired number of times.
Touch the [Once] key if you want the document cleared from memory after it is transmitted. Touch the [Unlimited] key to allow polling an unlimited number of times.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
4-106
Memory Box - Data Store
Memory Box
List
Original
Exposure
Scan:
Auto
Resolution Standard
Special Modes
Auto A4
Send:
Auto
Select image settings and special modes.
6
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
• A program, timer setting, transaction report, polling, verif. stamp and document filing cannot be selected.
• To return to the screen of step 4, touch the [Memory Box List] key.
7
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) while the original is being scanned.
If another document remains in the memory box (Public Box), the newly scanned document is added to the previous document. In this case, the number of polling times will be the number set for the newly scanned document.
4-107
CHECKING THE DOCUMENT IN THE PUBLIC BOX
You can check the document stored in the machine's public box for memory polling.
1
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Memory Box] key.
☞
Touch the [Data Check] key.
Memory Box Exit
2
Data Store
Polling Memory
Data Check Delete Data
Confidential
Reception
Data Check
3
Memory Box - Data Check
Box 1
Box 3
Box 5
Box 7
Box 9
Box 11
Box 2
Box 4
Box 6
Box 8
Box 10
Box 12
Public Box
Back
1
2
Touch the [Public Box] key.
4
When nothing is stored in the Public Box, the [Public Box] key will be greyed out.
Press [Image Check] to check data.
Press [Print] to output data.
Cancel Print Image Check
Touch the [Image Check] key.
The content of the document can be viewed in the image check screen. For information on the image check screen, see
"
IMAGE CHECK SCREEN " (page 4-66).
The [Image Check] function requires the hard disk drive.
To print the document, touch the [Print] key.
4-108
DELETING A DOCUMENT FROM THE PUBLIC BOX
Delete a document from the Public Box when it is no longer needed.
1
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Memory Box] key.
☞
Touch the [Delete Data] key.
Memory Box Exit
2
Data Store
Polling Memory
Data Check Delete Data
Confidential
Reception
Data Check
3
Memory Box - Delete Data
Box 1
Box 3
Box 5
Box 7
Box 9
Box 11
Box 2
Box 4
Box 6
Box 8
Box 10
Box 12
Public Box
Back
1
2
Touch the [Public Box] key.
4
When nothing is stored in the Public Box, the [Public Box] key will be greyed out.
Delete the data in the memory box?
Press [Image Check] to check data.
Image Check No Yes
Touch the [Yes] key.
• The document is deleted and you return to the screen of step 3.
• You can touch the [Image Check] key to check the image in the touch panel before deleting it. For information on the image check screen, see "
The [Image Check] function requires the hard disk drive.
To cancel the deletion...
Touch the [No] key. You will return to the screen of step 3.
4-109
PERFORMING F-CODE
COMMUNICATION
This section explains how to perform F-code communication operations. F-code communication is possible with machines of other manufacturers that also support F-code communication.
F-CODE COMMUNICATION
Exchange of confidential documents (confidential communication), retrieval (polling) and distribution (polling memory) of information, distribution of information to multiple destinations (relay broadcast transmission) are possible with other machines that support F-code communication.
An F-code* is specified in each communication, enabling a higher level of security.
* F-code is a communication function based on the G3 standard of the ITU-T.
The ITU-T is a United Nations organization that establishes communications standards. It is a department of the International
Telecommunication Union (ITU), which coordinates global telecommunications networks and services.
HOW F-CODES WORK
A fax that is transmitted with an F-code is received to the memory box in the receiving machine specified by the F-code
(sub-address and passcode). If the F-code sent by the transmitting machine does not match the F-code in the receiving machine, reception will not take place.
The fax is received to the memory box specified by the
F-code
Memory box for F-code communication
Box name: BBBB
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
Fax number of other machine
+
F-code
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
The products of other manufacturers may use different terms for "sub-address" and "passcode". If you need to contact the operator of another machine regarding sub-addresses and passcodes, refer to the terms used by the ITU-T in the table below.
The machine ITU-T
Sub Address
Passcode
F-code polling memory box
SEP
PWD
F-code confidential box
SUB
SID
F-code relay broadcast memory box
SUB
SID
An F-code consists of a sub-address and passcode, and cannot be longer than 20 digits.
4-110
CREATING MEMORY BOXES IN THE MACHINE FOR
F-CODE COMMUNICATION
Before the F-code communication function can be used, special memory boxes must be created using "F-Code Memory
Box" in the system settings.
A box name and F-code (sub-address and passcode) are programmed in each box, and an F-code communication function is assigned to each box.
After you have created a memory box, inform the other party of the sub-address and passcode of the box.
Memory box for F-code communication • Box Name
• Sub Address
• Passcode
• End receiving machines (only in an
F-code relay broadcast memory box)
• Print PIN (only for F-code confidential reception)
To use the following F-code communication functions, F-code memory boxes must be created in your machine.
F-code confidential reception, F-code polling memory, F-code relay broadcast transmission
To use the following F-code communication functions, F-code memory boxes must be created in the other machine.
F-code confidential transmission, F-code polling reception, F-code relay request transmission
System Settings:
F-Code Memory Box (page 7-103)
This is used to configure memory boxes for F-code communication.
• Up to 100 memory boxes can be created.
• The memory box name cannot be longer than 18 characters, and the sub-address and passcode cannot be longer than 20 digits.
F-CODE DIALLING
When performing an F-code operation, the F-code (sub-address and passcode) is appended to the fax number that is dialled. Check the F-code (sub-address and passcode) programmed in the memory box in the other machine before you perform an F-code transmission. It is convenient to store an F-code together with the fax number in a one-touch key or group key.
0123456789 /
AAAAAAAA
/
XXXXXXXX
Fax number of other machine
* Sub Address * Passcode
When the following F-code functions are used, your machine dials the other machine.
F-code confidential transmission, F-code polling reception, F-code relay request transmission
When the following F-code functions are used, the other machine dials your machine.
F-code confidential reception, F-code polling memory, F-code relay broadcast transmission
* Touch the [Sub Address] key in the screen to enter
"/".
• If the destination machine does not have a passcode configured in the F-code, do not enter a passcode when dialling that machine.
• F-code communication cannot be performed when using the speaker or performing manual transmission.
System Settings:
This is used to store and edit one-touch keys and group keys.
4-111
CONFIDENTIAL COMMUNICATION USING
F-CODES
By sending a fax to an F-code memory box (confidential) in the receiving machine (your machine or the other machine), the sender can direct the transmission specifically to the user of the box.
This is convenient for sending sensitive documents that you do not wish people other than the recipient to see, or when the receiving machine is shared by multiple departments.
To print an F-code confidential fax, the print passcode must be entered.
Sender
Receiver
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
Transmission with an
F-code
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
Reception in F-code Memory Box
Print passcode: Enter BBBB
The fax is printed.
The F-code (sub-address and passcode) of the memory box to be used should be verified by the sender and the recipient before the fax is sent.
System Settings:
F-Code Memory Box (page 7-103)
This is used to create memory boxes for F-code confidential communication (confidential reception).
A memory box name, sub-address, passcode, and print passcode are programmed in each box.
4-112
F-CODE CONFIDENTIAL TRANSMISSION
Follow the steps below to send a confidential fax by adding an F-code to the fax number.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
(2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
Sort Address
Preview
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
(3), (5)
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
If the destination is not stored in the address book, enter the fax number with the numeric keys.
If the sub-address and passcode are stored in the one-touch key, the following sub-steps are not necessary. Go to step 3.
(3) Touch the [Sub Address] key.
"/" appears.
(4) Enter the sub-address with the numeric keys.
(5) Touch the [Sub Address] key.
"/" appears.
(6) Enter the passcode with the numeric keys.
If a passcode has been omitted in the memory box of the other machine, (5) and (6) are not necessary.
3
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
This function can be used in combination with a broadcast transmission or timer transmission. This function can also be stored in a program.
4-113
CHECKING FAXES RECEIVED BY F-CODE
CONFIDENTIAL RECEPTION
When an F-code confidential fax is sent to your machine, the fax is received to the memory box specified by the F-code.
To check received faxes, enter the print passcode.
The machine rings and the fax is received.
A beep sounds when reception ends.
1
Beep
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Memory Box] key.
☞
Touch the [Data Check] key.
Memory Box Exit
3
Data Store
Polling Memory
Data Check Delete Data
Confidential
Reception
Data Check
4
Memory Box - Confidential Reception
Box 1
Box 3
Box 5
Box 2
Box 4
Box 6
Public Box
Back
1
1
Touch the key of the memory box containing the confidential fax.
" " appears in the keys of memory boxes that have received faxes. The keys of memory boxes that have not received faxes are greyed out and cannot be selected.
4-114
5
6
Enter PIN via the 10-key.
Enter the print passcode with the numeric keys.
As each digit is entered, "–" changes to " ".
Cancel
Take care to enter the correct print passcode. If you make a mistake, a message will appear and you will return to the entry screen. You can touch the [Cancel] key to return to step 4.
Press [Image Check] to check data.
Press [Print] to output data.
Cancel Print Image Check
Touch the [Image Check] key.
The content of the document can be viewed in the image check screen. For information on the image check screen, see
"
IMAGE CHECK SCREEN " (page 4-66).
The [Image Check] function requires the hard disk drive.
To print the document, touch the [Print] key.
• The confidential fax is automatically given priority in the print job queue.
• The fax is automatically cleared from the memory box after printing.
• If you forget the print passcode...
There is no way to check a forgotten passcode on the machine. Take care not to forget the passcode. In the event that you forget the passcode or need to verify the passcode, contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
System Settings (Administrator): Transaction Report Print Select Setting
This setting can be used to have a transaction report printed automatically when an F-code confidential fax is received.
4-115
POLLING RECEPTION USING F-CODES
This function enables your machine to call another machine and initiate reception of a fax stored in an F-code memory box (polling memory) in the other machine. During the polling operation, your machine must correctly specify the F-code
(sub-address and passcode) configured in the other machine or polling reception will not take place.
Transmission request (polling) using an F-code
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX The machine
The other machine
F-code polling memory box
1
Transmission
Box name: BBBB
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
• Verify the F-code (sub-address and passcode) of the memory box in the other machine before you perform F-code polling reception.
• Do not place an original in the automatic document feeder or on the document glass when using this function.
• The receiving machine bears the phone charges of the transmission.
Fax/Special Modes
Verif.
Stamp
Own Name
Select
Transaction
Report
Memory Box
(3) (2) (4)
OK
Polling
2
2
Select polling.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
(2) Touch the screens.
keys to switch through the
(3) Touch the [Polling] key so that it is highlight.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
4-116
2
(2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
Sort Address
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
(3), (5)
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
If the destination is not stored in the address book, enter the fax number with the numeric keys.
If the sub-address and passcode are stored in the one-touch key, the following sub-steps are not necessary. Go to step 3.
(3) Touch the [Sub Address] key.
"/" appears.
(4) Enter the sub-address with the numeric keys.
(5) Touch the [Sub Address] key.
"/" appears.
(6) Enter the passcode with the numeric keys.
If a passcode has been omitted in the memory box of the other machine, (5) and (6) are not necessary.
3
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Your machine will call the other machine and initiate reception of the fax.
• Polling multiple machines (serial polling) is not possible.
• F-code polling reception can be used in combination with a timer setting. Only one polling reception operation with a timer setting can be stored at a time.
☞
SENDING A FAX AT A SPECIFIED TIME (Timer) (page 4-80)
To cancel polling...
Touch the [Polling] key in the screen of step 1 so that it is not highlighted.
4-117
POLLING MEMORY TRANSMISSION USING
F-CODES
When your machine receives a transmission request from another machine, this function sends a fax stored in an
F-code memory box (polling memory) in your machine to that machine. The other machine must correctly specify the
F-code configured in your machine or transmission will not take place.
The document to be transmitted must be scanned into an F-code polling memory box.
The other machine
Transmission request (polling) using an F-code
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX The machine
F-code polling memory box
Box name: BBBB
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
Transmission
System Settings:
F-Code Memory Box (page 7-103)
This is used to create memory boxes (polling memory) for F-code polling memory transmission.
A memory box name, sub-address, and passcode are programmed in each box.
SCANNING A DOCUMENT INTO A MEMORY BOX FOR
F-CODE POLLING TRANSMISSION
Follow these steps to scan a document into a memory box (polling memory) for F-code polling transmission.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Memory Box] key.
☞
4-118
3
Memory Box
Data Store
Polling Memory
Data Check Delete Data
Exit
Confidential
Reception
Data Check
Touch the [Data Store] key.
4
Memory Box - Data Store
Box 1
Box 3
Box 5
Box 7
Box 9
Box 11
Box 2
Box 4
Box 6
Box 8
Box 10
Box 12
Public Box
Back
1
2
Touch the key of the F-code memory polling box.
5
Memory Box - Data Store
(1)
Once
Unlimited
(2)
OK
Specify the number of polling times.
(1) Touch the key for the desired number of times.
Touch the [Once] key if you want the document cleared from memory after it is transmitted. Touch the [Unlimited] key to allow polling an unlimited number of times.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
6
Memory Box - Data Store
Memory Box
List
Original
Exposure
Resolution Standard
Special Modes
Scan:
Auto
Auto A4
Send: Auto
Select image settings and special modes.
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
• A program, timer setting, transaction report, polling, verif. stamp and document filing cannot be selected.
• To return to the screen of step 4, touch the [Memory Box List] key.
4-119
7
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) while the original is being scanned.
• If other documents have already been stored in the memory box, the document is added to the previously stored documents.
• The factory default setting for the number of polling times is "Once" (after the document is transmitted to the receiving machine, it is automatically cleared).
4-120
CHECKING THE DOCUMENT IN THE F-CODE MEMORY
POLLING BOX
You can check the document stored in the F-code memory polling box.
A document in a memory box cannot be printed while the document is being transmitted.
1
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Memory Box] key.
☞
Touch the [Data Check] key.
Memory Box Exit
2
Data Store
Polling Memory
Data Check Delete Data
Confidential
Reception
Data Check
3
Memory Box - Data Check
Box 1
Box 3
Box 5
Box 7
Box 9
Box 11
Box 2
Box 4
Box 6
Box 8
Box 10
Box 12
Public Box
Back
1
2
Touch the key of the F-code memory polling box where the document you wish to print is stored.
appears in keys that have documents stored.
4
Press [Image Check] to check data.
Press [Print] to output data.
Cancel Print Image Check
Touch the [Image Check] key.
The content of the document can be viewed in the image check screen. For information on the image check screen, see
"
IMAGE CHECK SCREEN " (page 4-66).
The [Image Check] function requires the hard disk drive.
To print the document, touch the [Print] key.
4-121
DELETING A DOCUMENT STORED FOR F-CODE
POLLING TRANSMISSION
When a document in an F-code memory polling box is no longer needed, follow the steps below to delete it.
A document in a memory box cannot be deleted while the document is being transmitted.
1
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(3) Touch the [Memory Box] key.
☞
Touch the [Delete Data] key.
Memory Box Exit
2
Data Store
Polling Memory
Data Check Delete Data
Confidential
Reception
Data Check
3
Memory Box - Delete Data
Box 1
Box 3
Box 5
Box 7
Box 9
Box 11
Box 2
Box 4
Box 6
Box 8
Box 10
Box 12
Public Box
Back
1
2
Touch the key of the F-code memory polling box that has the document you wish to delete.
appears in keys that have documents stored.
4
Delete the data in the memory box?
Press [Image Check] to check data.
Image Check No Yes
Touch the [Yes] key.
• The document is deleted and you return to the screen of step 3.
• Printing will begin.
You can touch the [Image Check] key to check the image in the touch panel before deleting it. For information on the image check screen, see "
The [Image Check] function requires the hard disk drive.
To cancel the deletion...
Touch the [No] key. You will return to the screen of step 3 without deleting the document.
4-122
RELAY REQUEST TRANSMISSION USING
F-CODES
This function is used to send a fax to an F-code relay broadcast memory box in another machine and have that machine relay the fax to multiple end receiving machines.
When the end receiving machines are far from your machine, sending the fax to a relay machine that is close to the end receiving machines can help reduce phone charges. A relay request transmission can be used in combination with the timer transmission function to further reduce phone costs.
☞
SENDING A FAX AT A SPECIFIED TIME (Timer) (page 4-80)
The fax is transmitted to each of the end receiving machines programmed in the F-code relay broadcast memory box.
End receiving machines
Relay machine
F-code relay broadcast memory box
The machine
Transmission
Transmission specifying an F-code
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
Box name: BBBB
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
End receiving machines are programmed in this box
• Verify the F-code (sub-address and passcode) and end receiving machines programmed in the relay broadcast memory box in the relay machine before you perform an F-code relay request transmission.
• Before this function can be used, the end receiving machines must be programmed in the F-code relay broadcast memory box in the relay machine.
• The end receiving machines do not need to support F-code communication.
• This function can be used in combination with a broadcast transmission or timer transmission. An F-code relay request transmission can also be stored in a program.
• Your machine (the machine that requests a relay broadcast transmission) only bears the cost of sending the fax to the relay machine. The relay machine bears the cost of sending the fax to each of the end receiving machines.
• When faxes forwarded using this function are printed at the forwarding destination, the date and time of reception cannot be printed on the faxes. ("Receiving Date & Time Print" is disabled.)
System Settings: F-Code Memory Box (page 7-103)
This is used to create memory boxes for F-code relay broadcast transmission.
A memory box name, sub-address, passcode, and end receiving machines are programmed in each box.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
4-123
2
(2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Sub Address
Sort Address
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Preview
(3), (5)
Enter the destination fax number.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
If the destination is not stored in the address book, enter the fax number with the numeric keys.
If the sub-address and passcode are stored in the one-touch key, the following sub-steps are not necessary. Go to step 3.
(3) Touch the [Sub Address] key.
"/" appears.
(4) Enter the sub-address with the numeric keys.
(5) Touch the [Sub Address] key.
"/" appears.
(6) Enter the passcode with the numeric keys.
If a passcode has been omitted in the memory box of the other machine, (5) and (6) are not necessary.
3
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
When the relay machine receives the fax, it will automatically transmit the fax to each of the end receiving machines programmed in the memory box.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) while the original is being scanned.
4-124
RELAY BROADCAST TRANSMISSION
USING F-CODES
When your machine receives an F-code relay request transmission, the fax is received to an F-code relay broadcast memory box in your machine. Your machine then relays the fax to each of the end receiving machines programmed in the memory box. Transmission to the end receiving machines takes place automatically.
The other machine
The machine
F-code relay broadcast memory box
The fax is transmitted to each of the end receiving machines programmed in the F-code relay broadcast memory box.
Transmission
End receiving machines
Transmission specifying an F-code
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
Box name: BBBB
Sub-address: AAAAAAAA
Passcode: XXXXXXXX
End receiving machines are programmed in this box
• Prior to the operation, inform the requesting party of the sub-address and passcode of the relay broadcast memory box in your machine.
• Program the end receiving machines in the F-code relay broadcast memory box when you create the box in your machine.
☞
CREATING MEMORY BOXES IN THE MACHINE FOR F-CODE COMMUNICATION (page 4-111)
• The end receiving machines do not need to support F-code communication.
• The machine that requests a relay broadcast transmission only bears the cost of sending the fax to your machine (the relay machine). Your machine bears the cost of sending the fax to each of the end receiving machines.
• When faxes forwarded using this function are printed at the forwarding destination, the date and time of reception cannot be printed on the faxes. ("Receiving Date & Time Print" is disabled.)
4-125
USING AN EXTENSION PHONE
This section explains how to use an extension phone to make voice calls and receive a fax after talking with the other party.
CONNECTING AND USING AN EXISTING
PHONE (Extension Phone Connection)
You can connect an existing extension phone to the machine.
The phone can be used for voice calls and to start fax reception on the machine.
As an example, you can make a phone call using the existing phone, speak to the other party, and then press the
[BLACK & WHITE START] key to fax an original that has been placed to that party. You can also press the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key when an original is not placed to receive a fax.
Connect the extension phone as shown below.
Extension phone socket
Core
Click!
Existing extension phone (example)
Attach the provided core to your extension telephone cord and then connect the cord to the machine.
Make sure you hear a "click" sound indicating that the cord is securely connected.
Click!
• Connect an extension phone that has a modular socket. Use standard phone line cable to connect the phone. If other than a standard phone line cable is used, the connection may not work correctly.
• If the plug on the telephone line cord does not fit into the socket on your extension phone, contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
4-126
RECEIVING A FAX AFTER ANSWERING A CALL ON
THE EXTENSION PHONE (Remote Reception)
Follow the steps below if you need to start fax reception after answering a call and speaking on the extension phone.
If you are on a pulse-dial (rotary) line, set the extension phone to issue tone signals.
When you hear ringing, answer the call on the extension phone.
1
Signal the machine to start fax reception.
Press on the keypad of the extension phone.
2
Replace the extension phone.
The machine sounds a beep when reception ends.
3
If the extension phone is still lifted when fax transmission ends, an alarm signal will sound and a message will appear in the touch panel. The alarm and message will stop when the extension phone is replaced.
•
System Settings: Receive Setting (page 7-105)
To use remote fax reception, set this setting to "Manual Reception".
• System Settings (Administrator): Remote Reception Number Setting
This is used to change the number used for remote fax reception. The factory default setting is "5".
MAKING AND RECEIVING PHONE CALLS
You can make and receive calls like normal on your extension phone. A phone call can also be made by dialling on the machine.
4-127
CHECKING THE STATUS OF FAX
JOBS
This section explains how to check the status of reserved transmission jobs and received faxes.
JOB STATUS SCREEN
The job status screen is displayed when the [JOB STATUS] key on the operation panel is pressed. The job status screen shows the status of jobs by mode. When the [JOB STATUS] key is pressed, the job status screen of the mode that was being used before the key was pressed appears.
Reserved transmissions and received faxes are referred to as jobs here.
Example: Pressing the key in fax mode
JOB STATUS
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
0123456789
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
Broadcast
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Set Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
10:05 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting
10:33 04/01 000/010 Waiting
1
1
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
The job status display is in the lower left corner of the touch panel. The job status display can be touched to display the job status screen.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Direct TX
Sub Address
Exposure
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution Standard
Special Modes
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
File
Quick File
Preview
Sending
Auto Reception
Fax Memory:100%
4-128
JOB QUEUE SCREEN AND COMPLETED JOB SCREEN
The job status screen consists of two screens: the job queue screen, which shows reserved jobs and the job currently in progress, and the completed jobs screen. To switch between the two screens, touch the job status screen selector key
((2) below).
Job queue screen
(1)
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
Scan to
Set Time
Fax Job
Pages Status
Internet Fax
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
0123456789
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
Broadcast
10:05
10:22
10:30
10:33
04/01 000/004 Waiting
04/01 000/004 Waiting
04/01 000/010 Waiting
04/01 000/010 Waiting
1
1
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(1) Mode select tabs
Use these tabs to select the job status screen of each mode.
(2) Job status screen selector key
Touch this key to switch between the job queue screen and the completed jobs screen.
(3) Job queue screen [Detail] key
This shows detailed information on a broadcast transmission or serial polling job that is reserved or in progress. Select the key of the desired job in the job queue screen (6) and then touch the [Detail] key.
☞
CHECKING A RESERVED JOB OR THE JOB IN
(4) [Priority] key
Touch this key to give priority to a selected job.
☞
GIVING PRIORITY TO A RESERVED FAX JOB
(5) [Stop/Delete] key
Touch this key to stop or delete a selected job.
☞
CANCELLING A FAX IN PROGRESS OR A
Completed job screen
(1)
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
Scan to
Start Time
Fax Job
Pages Status
Internet Fax
10:00 04/01 010/003 NG000000
Broadcast0002
CCC CCC
0123456789
10:05 04/01 001/001 Send OK
10:22 04/01 004/004 Send OK
10:30 04/01 010/010 Send OK
1
1
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Call
(2)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(6) Job queue screen
Jobs are shown as keys in the order they were reserved.
Each key shows information on a job and its current status.
☞
(7) Completed jobs screen [Detail] key
This function requires the hard disk drive.
This shows detailed information on the results of completed broadcast transmission jobs, completed serial polling jobs, and completed jobs that used the document filing function. Select the key of the desired job in the completed jobs screen (9) and then touch the [Detail] key.
From the details screen, it is possible to resend the fax to destinations to which transmission was not successful.
☞
CHECKING COMPLETED JOBS (page 4-134)
(8) [Call] key
Touch this key to retrieve and use a transmission or reception job that was stored using the document filing function.
(9) Completed jobs screen
This shows up to 99 completed transmission/reception jobs. A description of each job and the result (status) are shown.
Broadcast transmission jobs, serial polling jobs, received fax forwarding jobs, and transmission/reception jobs that used the document filing function are indicated as keys.
4-129
Job key display
The following information is shown in the job queue keys and completed job keys that appear in the job status screen.
3 AAA AAA 10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Indicates the number (position) of the job in the job queue.
When the job currently being transmitted is finished, each job moves up one position in the job queue.
This number does not appear in keys in the completed jobs screen.
(2) Mode icon
This indicates the type of job. In the completed jobs screen, a colour bar indicating black & white will appear next to the icon. (However, the colour bar icon does not appear in the key of a job that used document filing or in the key of a transmission/reception job that was cancelled.)
Icon Job type
Fax transmission
Fax reception
Broadcast transmission, Serial polling or Inbound routing
PC-Fax transmission
(3) Name of other party
For a transmission, the name or fax number of the destination. For a reception, the fax number of the sending party.
In the case of a broadcast transmission or serial polling operation, "Broadcast" or "Multi Polling" appears together with a broadcast control number (4-digits).
(4) (5) (6)
(4) Time reserved / Time started
In the job queue screen, the date and time the job was reserved. In the completed jobs screen, the date and time the job was started.
(5) Number of pages
Shows the number of pages transmitted / total number of original pages.
(6) Status
Shows the job status.
• Job in progress
Message
"Connecting"
"Sending"
"Receiving"
"Tel"
Status
Connecting
Sending
Receiving
Speaking with the other party using an extension phone
"Stopped" The job has been stopped.
"Error" An error occurred while the job was being executed.
• Job waiting to be executed
Message
"Waiting"
"Retry Mode"
The day and time are displayed.
Status
The job is waiting to be executed.
The job is being re-attempted due to a communication error or other problem.
Timer transmission job (the specified time is displayed)
4-130
• Completed job
Message
"Send OK"
"In Memory"
"Received"
"Forward OK" The received fax has been forwarded.
"Stopped" The job was stopped.
"Delete"
"Number of successful transmission destinations /
Total destinations
OK"
"No response"
"Busy"
Status
Transmission completed.
Reception completed but the fax has not been printed.
Printed received fax data.
Deleted received data in the image check screen.
Completion of a broadcast transmission, serial polling or inbound routing operation.
If transmission to 3 destinations was successful out of a total of 5,
"003/005" will appear.
An error occurred because there was no response from the destination.
An error occurred because the other party was busy.
"Reject
Reception"
"NGxxxxxx"
"Error"
A fax was sent from a party that has been blocked by the anti junk fax function.
Transmission/reception was not successful because a communication error occurred (a
6-digit error code appears in xxxxxx.)
An error occurred while the job was being executed.
4-131
OPERATION WHEN A JOB IN THE JOB QUEUE IS
COMPLETED
When a normal transmission job is completed, it moves to the completed jobs screen and "Send OK" appears in the status column.
Received faxes, timer transmission jobs, retry jobs, and forwarding jobs are handled in the job status screen as explained below.
Fax reception jobs
While a fax is being received, "Receiving" appears in the job queue screen.
When reception is completed, the job moves to the completed jobs screen and "In Memory" appears.
After the fax is printed, the status changes to "Printed".
Timer transmission jobs
A timer transmission job appears at the bottom of the job queue screen until the specified time arrives.
When the specified time arrives, the job is executed. If another job is in progress, the timer job is started when the other job is completed.
Retry jobs
A retry job appears at the bottom of the job queue screen. When the set retry interval elapses, the job is executed. If there are jobs reserved ahead of the retry job, the retry job is reserved at the bottom of the job queue and executed when its turn arrives.
Fax reception jobs when Inbound Routing is enabled
When Inbound Routing is enabled in the Web pages, fax reception jobs are handled as follows depending on the print setting.
☞
FORWARDING RECEIVED FAXES TO A NETWORK ADDRESS (Inbound Routing Settings) (page 4-68)
• Received fax is not printed
"Receiving" appears in the job queue screen while the fax is being received. When reception is completed, the job moves to the job queue of the job status screen of scan mode.
• Received fax is printed
When reception is completed, the job moves to the completed jobs screen and "In Memory" appears. After the fax is printed, "Printed" appears. In addition, the job is added to the job queue of the job status screen of scan mode. When forwarding is finished, "Forward OK" appears.
4-132
CHECKING A RESERVED JOB OR THE JOB IN
PROGRESS
The detailed contents of a broadcast transmission or serial polling job can be displayed. Select (touch) the key of the job that you wish to check and touch the [Detail] key. The job details screen will appear (see below).
OK Detail
Broadcast0001
Fax No. : 0123456789
Progress: 050/100
Name:
Number:
AAA AAA
050 Pages: 005/010
Fax Connecting Fax Waiting Failed All Destinations
The job name and progress (number of completed destinations / total destinations) appear at the top of the screen.
Touch a tab to display the information that appears on that tab. The following information appears on each tab.
Tab name
Fax Connecting
Fax Waiting
Failed
All Destinations
Information displayed
Information on the current destination appears.
Fax No.: The fax number of the destination.
Name: The name of the destination.
Number: The broadcast control number (3-digits).
Pages: Number of pages completed / total number of pages
This shows information on the destinations that are waiting. A broadcast control number (3-digits) appears in front of each destination.
Address: The name of the other destination.
Status: The status of communication.
This shows information on destinations for which communication failed. A broadcast control number (3-digits) appears in front of each destination.
Address: The name or fax number of each destination.
Start Time: The time when communication began.
Status: The status of communication.
This shows all destinations specified in the job. A broadcast control number (3-digits) appears in front of each destination.
Address: The name or fax number of the destination.
Start time: The time at which communication began.
Status: The status of communication.
4-133
CHECKING COMPLETED JOBS
You can check a list of the destinations, the destinations for which transmission failed, and other detailed information on completed broadcast transmission jobs, received fax forwarding jobs, serial polling jobs, and jobs that used document filing. Touch the key of the desired job in the completed jobs screen and touch the [Detail] key. The job detail screen
(see below) will appear.
Detail
Broadcast0001
002
010
Address
DDD DDD
EEE EEE
Start Time
10:01 04/01
Status
NG000000
10:10 04/01 NG000000
OK
Retry
1
1
File Failed All Destinations
The job name appears at the top of the job detail screen.
To view details on the job, touch one of the tabs. The following information appears on each tab.
Tab name
File
Information displayed
Information on a transmission/reception that used document filing.
To retrieve the file and use it, touch the [Call] key.
The File tab does not appear when the hard disk drive is not installed.
Failed This shows information on destinations for which communication failed. A broadcast control number (3-digits) appears in front of each destination.
Address: The name or fax number of each destination.
Start time: Time at which communication began.
Status: Description of failure (error)
The [Retry] key can be touched to re-attempt transmission to that destination.*
All Destinations Shows all addresses specified in the job. A broadcast control number (3-digits) appears in front of each destination.
Address: The name or fax number of each destination.
Start time: Time at which communication began.
Status: Communication result
The [Retry] key can be touched to transmit to all destinations again.*
* Recalling is not possible for a broadcast transmission that includes a Scan to FTP address, Scan to Network Folder address, or Scan to Desktop address.
4-134
CANCELLING A FAX IN PROGRESS OR A
RESERVED FAX
Follow the steps below to cancel a fax transmission that is in progress or a reserved fax job.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2 4
5
1
2
3
Print Job
Address
Broadcast
0123456789
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
Broadcast
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Set Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
10:05 04/01 000/004 Waiting 1
1
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting
10:33 04/01 000/010 Waiting
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(1) (2)
Select the fax job that you wish to cancel.
(1) Touch the key of the fax job to be cancelled.
(2) Touch the [Stop/Delete] key.
Touch the [Yes] key.
Delete the job?
BBB BBB 10:30 04/01
No Yes 3
If you do not wish to cancel the selected fax job...
Touch the [NO] key.
Printing of received faxes and forwarding jobs set using "Inbound Routing Settings" cannot be cancelled.
☞
FORWARDING RECEIVED FAXES TO A NETWORK ADDRESS (Inbound Routing Settings) (page 4-68)
4-135
GIVING PRIORITY TO A RESERVED FAX
JOB
When multiple jobs are waiting to be transmitted, the jobs are normally transmitted in the order they were reserved.
If you need to give priority to a job and send it ahead of the other jobs, follow the steps below.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
Print Job
Address
Broadcast
0123456789
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
Broadcast
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Set Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
10:05 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting
10:33 04/01 000/010 Waiting
1
1
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(1) (2)
Select the fax job to which you wish to give priority.
(1) Touch the key of the desired job.
(2) Touch the [Priority] key.
The selected job moves up to the position immediately following the job in progress. The job will be executed when the job in progress is completed.
If the job in progress is a broadcast transmission job or a serial polling job, the priority job will be transmitted between destinations of the broadcast transmission or serial polling job. However, if the priority job is a broadcast transmission job or a serial polling job, it will be executed after the current job is completed.
4-136
CHECKING THE ACTIVITY LOG
(Image Sending Activity Report)
IMAGE SENDING ACTIVITY REPORT
You can have the machine print a log of recent image sending activity (date, name of other party, time required, result, etc.). The Image Sending Activity Report contains useful information such as the types of errors that occurred.
The most recent 200 transactions are included in the report.
You can have the machine print the Image Sending Activity Report each time the number of transactions reaches 201, or at a specified time (once a day only).
The contents of the Image Sending Activity Report are erased when the report is printed, and thus it cannot be reprinted.
System Settings (Administrator): Activity Report Print Select Setting
This is used to set the conditions for printing activity reports. The factory default setting is not to print.
The Image Sending Activity Report can be set to print each time the number of transactions reaches 201, or at a specified time (once a day only).
4-137
INFORMATION APPEARING IN THE RESULT COLUMN
Error types and other information are printed in the result column of transaction and activity reports. When a transaction report or activity report is printed, check the result of the transaction in the result column and take action as needed.
Examples of messages that are printed in the result column
Message
OK
G3
ECM
SG3
Forwarding
NO RESPONSE
BUSY
CANCEL
MEMORY OVER
MEM.FULL
LENGTH OVER
ORIGINAL ERROR
PASS# NG
NO RX POLL
RX POLL FAIL
NO F-CODE POLL
RX POLL# NG
F POLL PASS# NG
BOX NO. NG
F PASS# NG
RX NO F-CODE POLL
NO F FUNC
NO F-CODE
M. BOX: [xxxxxx]
FAIL xx (xxxx)
REJECTED
Explanation
The transaction was completed normally.
Communication took place in G3 mode.
Communication took place in G3 ECM mode.
Communication took place in Super G3 mode.
The received data was forwarded.
No response from the receiving party.
Transmission was not possible because the other party was already using the line.
The transmission was cancelled while in progress.
The memory became full during quick on-line transmission.
The memory became full during reception.
The transmitted fax was over 1.5 m (59") long and therefore could not be received.
Direct transmission or manual transmission was not successful because a misfeed occurred.
The connection was broken because the polling passcode was not correct.
The machine that was polled does not have a polling function.
The other machine refused the polling operation, or your machine broke the connection when polled because no data was in memory.
The other machine refused an F-code polling operation, or your machine broke the connection when polled because no data was in its F-code memory polling box.
The connection was broken because the sub-address for F-code polling memory was not valid.
The connection was broken because the passcode for F-code polling memory was not valid.
Your machine broke the connection because the specified sub-address for an F-code memory box does not exist.
Your machine broke the connection because the other machine sent an incorrect passcode for
F-code communication.
F-code polling was attempted, however, the other machine did not have an F-code polling memory box.
F-code communication was attempted, however, the other machine does not support F-code communication.
F-code communication was refused by the other machine because of an incorrect sub-address or other reason.
Data was received to a confidential or relay broadcast memory box, or data was sent from a memory polling box.
The name of the memory box appears in [xxxxxx], and the type of F-code operation (relay request reception, polling memory transmission, or confidential reception) appears in .
The transaction failed due to a communication error.
First 2 digits of communication error number: Error code from 00 to 99.
Last 4 digits of communication error number: Code for use by service technicians.
A fax was sent from a party from which reception is blocked.
4-138
FACSIMILE SPECIFICATIONS
Model MX-FX11
Applicable telephone line Public switched telephone network, PBX
Scanning resolution
(supports ITU-T standards)
8 x 3.85 lines/mm (Standard), 8 x 7.7 lines/mm (Fine, Fine-Halftone), 8 x 15.4 lines/mm (Super
Fine, Super Fine - Halftone), 16 x 15.4 lines/mm (Ultra Fine, Ultra Fine - Halftone)
Transmission speed
Compression method
33.6 kbps down to 2.4 kbps Automatic fallback
MH / MR / MMR / JBIG
Transmission modes
Super G3, G3 (the machine can only send faxes to and receive faxes from machines that support
G3 or Super G3)
Input document size
Paper sizes
Transmission time * 1
AB sizes: A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5, 216 mm x 340 mm, 216 mm x 343 mm
Inch sizes: 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5", 8-1/2" x 13", 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R,
5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
Long originals (max. width 297 mm (11-45/64") x max. length 1000 mm (39-23/64") can be transmitted using the automatic document feeder. Scanning one side is possible.)
A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5R (11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5", 8-1/2" x 13", 8-1/2" x 11",
8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R)
Approx. 2 seconds (Super G3 mode/33.6 kbps, JBIG)
Approx. 6 seconds (G3 ECM mode/14.4 kbps)
Supplied from the machine Power supply
Dimensions
Weight
192 mm (W) x 52 mm (D) x 215 mm (H) (7-9/16" (W) x 2-3/64" (D) x 8-15/32" (H))
Approx. 1.0 k g (2.2 lbs.)
Remarks
Extension telephone connection Possible (1 telephone)
Number of one-touch keys for storing destinations* 2
Maximum number of keys: 1000
Number of destinations that can be stored in a group (1 key)* 2
Maximum number of destinations in one group
(1 key): 500
Timer transmission
Program function
F-code transmission
Image memory
Yes
Yes (48 programs)
Supported (SUB/SEP (sub-address) and
SID/PWD (passcode) signals can be transmitted / received)
1 GB
*1 Transmission speed is for an A4 or 8-1/2" x 11" document with approximately 700 characters at standard resolution
(8 x 3.85 lines/mm) sent in high speed mode (33.6 kbps (JBIG) or 14.4 kbps). This is only the time required to transmit the image information; the time required to send protocol signals is not included. Actual transmission times will vary depending on the contents of the document, the receiving machine type, and telephone line conditions.
*2 Total number of all destinations (Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, Scan to Network folder, Internet Fax,
Fax and Group)
4-139
CHAPTER 5
SCANNER/INTERNET FAX
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the scanner function and the Internet fax function.
USB memory mode can be used without installing a peripheral device.
To use the Internet fax function, the Internet fax expansion kit and the hard disk drive are needed.
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE AS A
NETWORK SCANNER
NETWORK SCANNER FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
PREPARATIONS FOR USE AS A NETWORK
SCANNER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
• MAKE SURE THE MAIN POWER SWITCH
IS IN THE "ON" POSITION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
• CHECKING THE DATE AND TIME . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
• STORING SENDER INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . 5-5
• SETTINGS REQUIRED IN THE WEB
PAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
• STORING DESTINATION ADDRESSES
ADDRESS BOOK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
• STORING A DESTINATION FOR SCAN
TO DESKTOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
• BEFORE SENDING TO A DIRECT SMTP
ADDRESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
BASE SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
• ADDRESS BOOK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
BOOK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
SCAN SEND SEQUENCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15
ORIGINAL SIZES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17
• TRANSMITTABLE ORIGINAL SIZES . . . . . . . 5-17
• THE SIZE OF THE PLACED ORIGINAL . . . . . 5-17
ENTERING DESTINATIONS
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM THE
ADDRESS BOOK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18
• RETRIEVING A DESTINATION . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
SELECTED DESTINATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE
A DESTINATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21
ENTERING AN ADDRESS MANUALLY . . . . . . . . 5-22
• SPECIFYING A NETWORK FOLDER . . . . . . . 5-23
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM A
GLOBAL ADDRESS BOOK. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25
USING THE RESEND FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-27
5-1
TRANSMITTING AN IMAGE
SENDING AN IMAGE IN SCAN MODE . . . . . . . . . 5-28
• CHANGING THE SUBJECT, FILE NAME,
REPLY-TO, AND BODY TEXT. . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-32
SENDING AN IMAGE IN USB MEMORY
MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-35
• SPECIFY THE FOLDER IN WHICH THE
FILE WILL BE STORED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-39
• ENTERING A FILE NAME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
SENDING A FAX IN INTERNET FAX MODE. . . . . 5-41
• CHANGING THE SUBJECT, FILE NAME,
AND BODY TEXT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-44
SENDING THE SAME IMAGE TO MULTIPLE
DESTINATIONS (Broadcast Transmission) . . . . 5-47
• BROADCAST TRANSMISSIONS THAT
DESTINATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-50
SENDING AN INTERNET FAX FROM A
COMPUTER (PC-I-Fax) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-52
IMAGE SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-53
Original) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-54
• SPECIFYING THE ORIGINAL SCAN SIZE
AND SEND SIZE (Enlarge/Reduce) . . . . . . . . . 5-55
ORIGINAL IMAGE TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-61
• CHANGING THE RESOLUTION . . . . . . . . . . . 5-63
• CHANGING THE FILE FORMAT . . . . . . . . . . . 5-64
• CHANGING THE COLOUR MODE . . . . . . . . . 5-68
TRANSMITTED (Preview) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-69
• PREVIEW CHECK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-70
SCANNER/INTERNET FAX
SPECIAL MODES
SPECIAL MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-71
STORING SCAN OPERATIONS (Programs) . . . . 5-73
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS ON THE
IMAGE (Erase) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-75
SEPARATE PAGES (Dual Page Scan). . . . . . . . . 5-77
SENDING AN IMAGE AT A SPECIFIED TIME
(Timer Transmission) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-79
WHITENING FAINT COLOURS IN THE
IMAGE (Suppress Background). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-81
SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD ONTO
A SINGLE PAGE (Card Shot) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-83
SCANNING MANY ORIGINALS AT ONCE (Job Build) . . . 5-86
SCANNING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT
SIZES (Mixed Size Original) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-88
SCANNING THIN ORIGINALS (Slow Scan Mode) . . . . 5-90
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
TRANSMISSION (Original Count) . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-92
STAMPING SCANNED ORIGINALS (Verif. Stamp) . . . 5-94
ELIMINATING BLANK PAGES FROM A
TRANSMISSION (Blank Page Skip) . . . . . . . . . . . 5-96
SENDING TWO PAGES AS A SINGLE PAGE
(2in1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-98
CHANGING THE PRINT SETTINGS FOR THE
TRANSACTION REPORT (Transaction Report) . . 5-101
CHECKING THE STATUS OF
TRANSMISSION/RECEPTION JOBS
JOB STATUS SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-103
• JOB QUEUE SCREEN AND COMPLETED
JOB SCREEN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-104
• OPERATION WHEN A JOB IN THE JOB
QUEUE IS COMPLETED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-107
• CHECKING COMPLETED JOBS . . . . . . . . . . 5-108
TRANSMITTED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-109
TRANSMISSION JOB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-110
CHECKING THE INTERNET FAX ACTIVITY
LOG (Image Sending Activity Report) . . . . . . . . 5-111
• IMAGE SENDING ACTIVITY REPORT . . . . . 5-111
• INFORMATION APPEARING IN THE
RESULT COLUMN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-111
5-2
INTERNET FAX RECEPTION FUNCTIONS
RECEIVING AN INTERNET FAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-112
FAXES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-113
PRINTING A PASSWORD-PROTECTED FAX
(Hold Setting For Received Data Print) . . . . . . . 5-114
CHECKING THE IMAGE BEFORE PRINTING . . 5-115
FORWARDING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-116
• IMAGE CHECK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-118
(Inbound Routing Settings) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-119
SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-119
SCANNING FROM A COMPUTER (PC
Scan Mode)
BASIC SCANNING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-123
METADATA DELIVERY
METADATA DELIVERY (Data Entry) . . . . . . . . . 5-128
TRANSMISSION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-129
• SETTINGS REQUIRED IN THE WEB
PAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-129
• METADATA TRANSMISSION FOR SCAN
TO DESKTOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-129
TRANSMITTING METADATA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-130
• METADATA FIELDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-132
NETWORK SCANNER / INTERNET FAX
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-133
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-133
BEFORE USING THE MACHINE AS A
NETWORK SCANNER
This section provides information that you should know before using the machine as a network scanner.
NETWORK SCANNER FUNCTION
The network scanner function of the machine can be used to scan an original, create an image file, and send the file over a network to a computer, FTP server, or other destination. Scanning is also possible from your computer using a
TWAIN-compliant application.
The network scanner function provides the following scanning modes.
Scan modes
☞
SENDING AN IMAGE IN SCAN MODE (page 5-28)
Scan to E-mail
The scanned file is sent to an e-mail address.
Scan to FTP
The scanned file is sent to a specified directory of an FTP server.
When the file is sent, it is also possible to send an e-mail to a previously stored e-mail address to inform the recipient of the location of the file. (This is called "Scan to FTP
(Hyperlink)".)
Scan to Desktop
The scanned file is sent to a specified folder on your computer.
To use Scan to Desktop, software must be installed from the "Sharpdesk/Network Scanner
Utilities" CD-ROM that accompanies the machine. For the system requirements of the software, see the manual (PDF format) or the Readme file on the CD-ROM. For the procedures for installing the software, see the "Sharpdesk Installation Guide".
Scan to Network Folder
The scanned file is sent to a network folder on a Windows computer on the same network as the machine.
5-3
USB memory mode
☞
SENDING AN IMAGE IN USB MEMORY MODE (page 5-35)
USB Memory Scan
The scanned file is sent to and stored in a USB memory device connected to the machine.
Internet fax mode
To use the Internet fax function, the hard disk drive and Internet fax expansion kit must be installed.
☞
SENDING A FAX IN INTERNET FAX MODE (page 5-41)
Internet fax transmission
The scanned file is sent as an Internet fax. Reception of Internet faxes is also possible.
The machine supports Direct SMTP, which lets you directly send Internet faxes within your company without using a mail server.
PC scan mode
This function requires the hard disk drive.
☞
SCANNING FROM A COMPUTER (PC Scan Mode) (page 5-123)
PC Scan
A TWAIN-compliant application on a computer connected to the same network as the machine is used to scan a document or image.
To use PC Scan, the scanner driver must be installed from the "Software CD-ROM" that accompanies the machine.
Operating systems that can be used are Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista/
Server 2008/7.
Data entry mode
The hard disk drive and application integration module are required to use the metadata transmission function.
☞
METADATA DELIVERY (page 5-128)
Metadata delivery
The application integration module can be combined with the network scanner function to append a metadata* file to a scanned image file. (This is called metadata delivery.)
Information entered using the touch panel or automatically generated by the machine can be sent to a directory on an
FTP server or an application on a computer as a metadata file in XML format.
* Metadata is information about a file, how it is to be processed, and its relation to other objects.
5-4
PREPARATIONS FOR USE AS A NETWORK
SCANNER
MAKE SURE THE MAIN POWER SWITCH IS IN THE
"ON" POSITION
The main power is "on" when the main power indicator on the right side of the operation panel is lit.
If the main power indicator is not lit, the main power is "off". Switch the main power switch to the "on" position and press the [POWER] key ( ) on the operation panel.
If the Internet fax function will be used, and in particular if reception or timer transmission will take place at night, always keep the main power switch in the "on" position.
When the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) indicator light is blinking, the machine is in auto power shut-off mode. If the [POWER
SAVE] key ( ) is pressed when the indicator is blinking, the indicator will turn off and the machine will return to the ready state after a brief interval.
Main power switch
Main power indicator
"On" position
[POWER SAVE] key/indicator
CHECKING THE DATE AND TIME
Verify that the correct date and time are set in the machine.
The date and time are set in the system settings of the machine. When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed, the system settings menu screen appears on the touch panel. Select [Default Settings], [Clock], and [Clock Adjust], and set the year, month, day, hour, and minute.
If "Disabling of Clock Adjustment" has been enabled in the system settings (administrator), the date and time cannot be set.
STORING SENDER INFORMATION
Be sure to configure this information, as it is required for communication.
Before using Scan to E-mail
Store a default sender name in "Sender Name" and a reply e-mail address in "Reply E-mail Address". These will be used when a sender is not selected.
System Settings (Administrator): Default Sender Set
This is used to store the sender name and e-mail address that is used when a sender is not selected.
Before using Internet fax
Store a sender name in "Sender Name" and a sender Internet fax address in "Own Address".
System Settings (Administrator): Sender Data Registration
Use this setting to program the sender name and sender address.
5-5
SETTINGS REQUIRED IN THE WEB PAGES
To use scan mode and Internet fax mode, the basic network scanner settings, server settings such SMTP and DNS server settings, and sender addresses must be configured in the Web pages.
• Server settings
To configure server settings, click [Network Settings] and then [Services Settings] in the Web page menu.
(Administrator rights are required.)
• Basic network scanner settings
To configure network scanner settings, click [Application Settings] and then [Network Scanner Settings] in the Web page menu. (Administrator rights are required.)
• Internet fax settings
To configure the network scanner settings, click [Application Settings] and then [Internet Fax Settings] in the Web page menu. (Administrator rights are required.)
STORING DESTINATION ADDRESSES FOR EACH
SCAN MODE IN THE ADDRESS BOOK
To use Scan to FTP or Scan to Desktop, the destination must be stored in the address book. For Scan to E-mail,
Internet Fax, and Scan to Network Folder, the destination can be directly entered or looked up in a global address book at the time of transmission, however, the procedure is simpler when the destination is stored in the address book. Store each type of destination as explained below.
Types of transmission in scanner mode
• Scan to FTP: Click [Address Book] in the Web page menu and then click the [Add] button. Select [FTP] in
[Address Type] and store an address.
• Scan to Network Folder: Click [Address Book] in the Web page menu and then click the [Add] button. Select [Network
Folder] in [Address Type] and store an address.
• Scan to E-mail: Click [Address Book] in the Web page menu and then click the [Add] button. Select [E-mail] in [Address Type] and store an address. Addresses can also be stored in the system settings.
• Scan to Desktop: See "
STORING A DESTINATION FOR SCAN TO DESKTOP " (page 5-7). Scan to Desktop
destinations can also be stored in the Web pages. Click [Address Book] in the Web page menu and then click the [Add] button. Select [Desktop] in [Address Type] and store an address.
A total of 1000 addresses can be stored. Among these, a combined maximum of 200 Scan to Network Folder, Scan to FTP, and Scan to Desktop addresses can be stored.
Transmission in Internet fax mode:
Click [Address Book] in the Web page menu and then click the [Add] button. Select [Internet
Fax] or [Direct SMTP] for the [Address Type], and store the address. Addresses can also be stored in the system settings.
System Settings:
This is used to store destination addresses for Scan to E-mail and Internet fax.
5-6
STORING A DESTINATION FOR SCAN TO DESKTOP
To store your computer in the machine as a destination for Scan to Desktop, Network Scanner Tool must be installed from the "Sharpdesk/Network Scanner Utilities" CD-ROM that accompanies the machine. To scan an image to your computer, Network Scanner Tool must be running on your computer.
INSTALLING NETWORK SCANNER TOOL
To install Network Scanner Tool, see the "Sharpdesk Installation Guide" that accompanies the machine. When a standard installation is performed, Network Scanner Tool is installed with Sharpdesk.
When you restart your computer after installing Network Scanner Tool, the Setup Wizard will start automatically. Follow this wizard to set up Network Scanner Tool. This will store your computer in the machine as a destination for Scan to
Desktop. The stored destination will be displayed as a one-touch key in the address book screen.
The following window appears while Network Scanner Tool is being set up. The item selected in "My Profiles" (C) will be the name of the one-touch key.
(A)
(B)
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
File
Quick File
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution 200X200dpi
File Format PDF
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Auto/Greyscale
Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Preview
(C)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
Comp-DESKTOP
AAA DDD
AAA FFF
AAA HHH
Preview
Cc
AAA BBB
AAA CCC
AAA EEE
AAA GGG
AAA III
1
2
Freq.
ABCD EFGH
A B
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
C D
(B)
(D)
The profile name is determined by the combination of the text entered in "Prefix" (A) and the profile*.
The one-touch key is assigned to an index tab in the address book screen based on the text entered in "Initial" (B).
* This defines how an image sent to your computer is processed. For more information, see profile explanation (D).
ADDING DESTINATIONS
For the number of computers that can be stored in the machine as destinations of Scan to Desktop, see the number of licences indicated in the "Sharpdesk Installation Guide". To store more destinations, a licence kit is required. Store Scan to Desktop destinations by installing Network Scanner Tool on each computer.
5-7
BEFORE SENDING TO A DIRECT SMTP ADDRESS
The machine supports Direct SMTP, which lets you directly send Internet faxes within your company without using a mail server. For the procedure for storing a Direct SMTP address in the address book, see "
ADDRESSES FOR EACH SCAN MODE IN THE ADDRESS BOOK " (page 5-6). Stored Direct SMTP addresses are
included in the address book for Internet fax mode.
If the destination is busy
If the destination is busy, the machine will wait briefly and then automatically resend.
To cancel transmission...
Cancel the transmission from the job status screen.
☞
STOPPING A SCAN JOB BEING TRANSMITTED OR WAITING TO BE TRANSMITTED (page 5-109)
System Settings (Administrator): Recall in Case of Line Busy
This is used to set the number of recall attempts and the interval between attempts when the connection cannot be established because the line is busy.
When a communication error occurs
If a communication error occurs or the other fax machine does not answer the call within a preset period of time, transmission will be re-attempted automatically after a preset interval.
To cancel transmission...
Cancel the transmission from the job status screen.
☞
STOPPING A SCAN JOB BEING TRANSMITTED OR WAITING TO BE TRANSMITTED (page 5-109)
System Settings (Administrator): Recall in Case of Communication Error
This is used to set the number of recall attempts and the interval between attempts when a transmission fails due to an error.
5-8
(1)
(2)
(3)
(14)
(15)
BASE SCREEN
Scan mode, USB memory mode, Internet fax mode, and PC scan mode are used by selecting operations and settings in the base screens of those modes. To display the base screen of a mode, touch the [IMAGE SEND] key in the touch panel and then touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
Base screen of scan mode
(1)
COPY IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Ready to send.
Scan
Address Book
Address Entry
Send Settings
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure
Resolution
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Send:
Resend
PC Scan
Auto
(9)
(10)
Address Review File Format PDF PDF
(7) File
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Auto/Greyscale Mono2
(11)
(8) Preview
Base screen of USB memory mode
(12) (13)
Base screen of Internet fax mode
(8)
COPY
Ready to send.
IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
Scan
Stored to
File Name
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure
Resolution
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
File Format
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Auto/Greyscale
Mono2
Preview
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(10)
(5)
(6)
(13)
(7)
(8)
COPY
Ready to send.
Scan
Address Book
Address Entry
IMAGE SEND
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure
Scan:
DOCUMENT
FILING
Fax
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
Resend
PC Scan
Auto
Auto
Send Settings Resolution 200X100dpi
Address Review
File
File Format TIFF-F
Special Modes
Quick File
Preview
I-Fax Manual
Reception
(9)
(10)
(13)
(12)
(16)
(17)
(1) Mode select keys
Use these keys to switch between copy, image send, and document filing modes.
To use scan mode, USB memory mode, Internet fax mode, PC scan mode, or data entry mode, touch the
[IMAGE SEND] key.
(2) Various messages are displayed here.
The icon of the selected mode appears on the left.
(3) Send mode tabs
Touch one of these tabs to change the image send mode.
Tabs of modes that cannot be used because the corresponding options are not installed do not appear.
If the [USB Mem. Scan] and [PC Scan] tabs do not appear, touch the tab to move the screen.
If the [Scan], [Internet Fax], [Fax], and [Data Entry] tabs do not appear, touch the screen.
tab move the
The [Data Entry] tab appears when the application integration module is installed. For information on metadata delivery using the [Data Entry] tab, see
"
METADATA DELIVERY " (page 5-128).
(4) [Address Book] key
Touch this key to use a one-touch key or a group key. When the key is touched, the address book screen appears.
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM THE
(5) [Address Entry] key
Touch this key to manually enter an destination address instead of using a one-touch key.
☞
ENTERING AN ADDRESS MANUALLY (page 5-22)
(6) [Send Settings] key
Touch this key to select or enter the subject, file name, sender name, or body text, which has been previously stored in the Web page.
Scan modes:
☞
CHANGING THE SUBJECT, FILE NAME,
REPLY-TO, AND BODY TEXT (page 5-32)
Internet fax mode:
☞
CHANGING THE SUBJECT, FILE NAME, AND
5-9
(7) Customized keys
The keys that appear here can be changed to show settings or functions that you prefer.
☞
Customizing displayed keys (page 5-11)
(8) [Preview] key
Touch to check the image that will be sent in the touch panel before transmission.
☞
CHECKING THE IMAGE TO BE TRANSMITTED
This function requires the hard disk drive.
(9) [Resend] key/[Next Address] key
The destinations of the most recent 8 transmissions by Scan to E-mail, fax and/or Internet fax are stored. Touch this key to select one of these destinations. After a destination is selected, this key changes to the [Next Address] key.
☞
USING THE RESEND FUNCTION (page 5-27)
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION (page 5-19)
(10) Image settings
Image settings (original size, exposure, resolution, file format, and colour mode) can be selected.
☞
(11) key
This key appears when a special mode or 2-sided scanning is selected. Touch the key to display the selected special modes.
☞
Checking what special modes are selected (page 5-11)
(12) key
Touch this key to specify a destination using a search number * .
* 4-digit number assigned to a destination when it is stored.
☞
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE A
(13) [Special Modes] key
Touch this key to use a special mode.
☞
(14) [Stored to] key
Touch to select the folder in USB memory where a file will be stored.
☞
SPECIFY THE FOLDER IN WHICH THE FILE WILL
(15) [File Name] key
Touch this key to enter a file name when storing a file to
USB memory.
☞
ENTERING A FILE NAME (page 5-40)
(16) / / key
When "Hold Setting for Received Data Print" or
"Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), this will appear when an
Internet fax is received.
: Only "Hold Setting for Received Data Print" is enabled
: Only "Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled
: Both settings are enabled
☞
PRINTING A PASSWORD-PROTECTED FAX
(Hold Setting For Received Data Print) (page 5-114)
☞
CHECKING THE IMAGE BEFORE PRINTING
(17) [I-Fax Manual Reception] key
Touch this key to receive an Internet fax manually.
☞
MANUALLY RECEIVING INTERNET FAXES (page
When sending an image, you can retrieve and use a stored transmission destination from the address book screen. The address book screen is shared by scan mode, Internet fax mode, fax mode and data entry mode.
Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen to switch to the address book screen. Touch the [Condition Settings] key in the address book screen to switch to the base screen.
Base screen of scan mode
Scan Internet Fax Fax USB Mem. Scan
Address Book Original Scan: Auto Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Exposure Auto Text Address Entry
Send Settings
Address Review
File
Quick File
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Auto/Greyscale
Mono2
Preview
Address book screen
To 5 10 15
Condition
Settings
AAA AAA
Cc
Address Review
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
• This chapter uses the base screen of scan mode as an example when operations common to all modes are explained.
• The procedures in this chapter assume that the base screen of scan mode appears when the [IMAGE SEND] key is touched.
System Settings (Administrator): Default Display Settings
One of the following screens can be selected for the initial screen that appears when the [IMAGE SEND] key is touched.
• Base screen of each mode (scan, Internet fax, fax, or data entry mode)
• Address book screen
5-10
Customizing displayed keys
Special mode keys and other keys can be displayed in the base screen. Set these keys to functions that you frequently use to access the functions with a single touch. The customized keys are configured using "Customize Key Setting" in the Web pages. The following keys appear by factory default:
• [Address Review] key
Touch this key to display a list of the destinations that have been selected in the address book. This is the same key as the [Address Review] key in the address book screen.
• [File] key, [Quick File] key
Touch either of these keys to use the File function or Quick File function of document filing mode.
This function requires the hard disk drive.
In USB memory mode...
Customized keys do not initially appear, however, up to three keys can be added.
Example: When "Dual Page Scan", "Job Build", and "Mixed Size Original" are assigned to the customized keys
These three keys can be changed as desired.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Dual Page
Scan
Job Build
Mixed Size
Original
Preview
File Format
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Fax
Scan:
Resolution
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Auto/Greyscale
Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
• Displaying a program key in the base screen will enable you to retrieve the program by simply touching the key.
☞
STORING SCAN OPERATIONS (Programs) (page 5-73)
• The functions that can be selected for the customized keys vary depending on the mode.
System Settings (Administrator): Customize Key Setting
Registration is performed in [System Settings] - [Operation Settings] - "Customize Key Setting" in the Web page menu.
Checking what special modes are selected
The key appears in the base screen when a special mode or 2-sided scanning is selected.
The key can be touched to display the selected special modes. To close the screen, touch the [OK] key.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
File Auto/Greyscale
Mono2
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Preview
Function Review
Erase
Timer
Mixed Size
Original
Edge:10mm
Centre:10mm
Day of the Week:Monday
Time:21:30
On
OK
1
1
The special mode settings cannot be changed from the review screen. To change a setting, touch the [OK] key to close the review screen and then touch the [Special Modes] key and select the setting that you wish to change.
5-11
ADDRESS BOOK SCREEN
This screen is used to select transmission destinations.
(9)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(10) (11)
AAA AAA [email protected]
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
To
AAA AAA
Address Review
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD
Preview
EFGH
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
Bcc
1
2
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
(14)
(1) This shows the selected destination.
(2) Number of displayed items selector key
Touch this key to change the number of destinations
(one-touch keys) displayed in the address book screen.
Select 5, 10, or 15 keys.
(3) [Condition Settings] key
Touch this key to select transmission settings. When the key is touched, the base screen appears.
☞
(4) [Address Review] key
Touch this key to view a list of the selected destinations.
Destination selections can be changed.
☞
CHECKING AND DELETING THE SELECTED
(5) [Address Entry] key
Touch this key to manually enter a destination address instead of using a one-touch key.
☞
ENTERING AN ADDRESS MANUALLY (page 5-22)
(6) [Global Address Search] key
When the use of an LDAP server has been enabled in the machine's Web pages, a transmission address can be obtained from a global address book.
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM A GLOBAL
(7) [Sort Address] key
Touch to change the index tabs to custom indexes or to display one-touch keys by send mode.
☞
CHANGING THE DISPLAY OF ONE-TOUCH KEYS
IN THE ADDRESS BOOK SCREEN (page 5-13)
(12)
(13)
(8) [Preview] key
Touch to check the image that will be sent in the touch panel before transmission.
This function requires the hard disk drive.
☞
CHECKING THE IMAGE TO BE TRANSMITTED
(9) [To] key
Touch this key to enter the selected destination
(one-touch key).
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION (page 5-19)
(10) [Cc] key
When using Scan to E-mail, touch the [Cc] key when you wish to send a "Carbon copy" of the e-mail to an additional destination.
(11) [Bcc] key
When using Scan to E-mail, touch the [Bcc] key when you wish to send a "Blind carbon copy" of the e-mail to an additional destination.
When an address is specified as a Bcc recipient, other recipients will not know that the address is a recipient.
This key only appears when Bcc has been enabled using
"Bcc Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
(12) One-touch key display
The destinations (one-touch keys) stored in each index are displayed. This chapter refers to keys in which destinations and groups are stored as one-touch keys.
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION (page 5-19)
(13) Index tabs
Touch this to change the displayed index tab.
☞
(14) key
Touch this key to specify a destination using a search number * .
* A 4-digit number assigned to a one-touch key or group key when it is stored.
☞
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE A
5-12
• Icons appear in the one-touch keys in the address book to indicate which mode is used for transmission.
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM THE ADDRESS BOOK (page 5-18)
• For information on storing addresses in the address book, see "
STORING DESTINATION ADDRESSES FOR EACH
SCAN MODE IN THE ADDRESS BOOK " (page 5-6).
• For information on storing destinations for Scan to Desktop, see "
STORING A DESTINATION FOR SCAN TO DESKTOP "
•
System Settings: Address Book (page 7-16)
This is used to store Scan to E-mail and Internet fax addresses in one-touch keys.
• System Settings (Administrator): The Number of Direct Address Keys Displayed Setting
This is used to change the default setting for the number of one-touch keys displayed in the address book screen.
• System Settings (Administrator): Bcc Setting
This setting enables or disables Bcc delivery. When enabled, the [Bcc] key appears in the address book screen.
• System Settings (Administrator): Default Display Settings
One of the following screens can be selected for the initial screen that appears when the [IMAGE SEND] key is touched.
- Base screen of each mode (scan, Internet fax, fax, or data entry mode)
- Address book screen
"Default Display Settings" can be set on the displayed screen by touching [Image Send Settings] - [Operation Settings] -
[Other Settings].
• System Settings (Administrator): Address Book Default Selection
The following settings are available for the method of sorting the addresses that appear in the address book.
- Index type (alphabetical, custom)
- Address type (all, group, E-mail, FTP/Desktop, Network Folder, Internet fax, fax)
CHANGING THE DISPLAY OF ONE-TOUCH KEYS IN
THE ADDRESS BOOK SCREEN
You can show destinations of only a specific transmission mode in the address book screen, or change the displayed index tabs from the alphabetical tabs to the custom tabs. The procedure for selecting destinations does not change.
Touch the [Sort Address] key.
1
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
ABCD
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
2
Sort Address
Tab Switch
ABC
User
(1) (2)
OK
Address Type
All
Internet Fax
Group
FTP/Desktop
Fax
Network Folder
Change the display mode.
(1) Touch the key of the mode or tab that you wish to display.
• To show only the one-touch keys of a particular send mode, touch the desired mode key under "Address
Type".
• To change the index tabs to the custom indexes, touch the [User] key under "Tab Switch".
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
5-13
Index display
Indexes make it easy to search for a destination (one-touch key). The destinations are displayed separately using alphabetical search characters and index numbers. To display a stored destination, touch the appropriate index tab. It is convenient to store frequently used destinations in the [Freq.] index. Specify that a destination be displayed in the [Freq.] index when you store the destination.
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Index tabs
The destinations can also be displayed in alphabetical order by initial.
Each time the displayed index tab is touched, the display order changes in the following order: search numbers (page
tabs also changes.
Ordered by search number (default) Ascending names Descending names
Freq.
ABCD Freq.
ABCD Freq.
ABCD
Index names can be changed using "Custom Index" in the system settings, allowing you to create groups of one-touch keys that can be easily recognized.
System Settings:
Storing group keys (page 7-18)
This setting is used to store custom index names. The custom index where a one-touch key appears is specified when the transmission destination is stored in the key.
Narrowing the search letter range
An alphabet tab on an index tab can be touched to display keys to further narrow the search range. For example, when the [ABCD] tab is touched, keys from "A" to "D" appear. If the [B] key is touched, only destinations starting with the letter
"B" will appear. To cancel, touch the key again. Note that the search letter range cannot be narrowed on the [Freq.] tab, the [etc.] tab, or on a user index tab.
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
BBB AAA
BBB CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
BBB EEE
BBB GGG
BBB III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
ABCD
Cc
BBB BBB
BBB DDD
BBB FFF
BBB HHH
BBB JJJ
1
2
EFGH
A B
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
C D
5-14
SCAN SEND SEQUENCE
This section explains the basic procedure for scanning and transmission. Select settings in the order shown below to ensure smooth transmission.
For the detailed procedures for selecting the settings, see the explanation of each setting in this chapter.
Place the original.
Place the original in the document feeder tray of the automatic document feeder, or on the document glass.
☞
SENDING AN IMAGE IN SCAN MODE (page 5-28)
SENDING AN IMAGE IN USB MEMORY MODE (page
☞
SENDING A FAX IN INTERNET FAX MODE (page 5-41)
Ready to send.
File
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Resend
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
Auto/Greyscale Mono2
Preview
Enter the destination
Specify the destination of the scan transmission.
• [Address Book] key:
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM THE ADDRESS
☞
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM A GLOBAL
•
• [Address Entry] key:
☞
ENTERING AN ADDRESS MANUALLY (page 5-22)
key:
☞
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE A
• [Resend] key:
☞
USING THE RESEND FUNCTION (page 5-27)
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
File
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution 200X200dpi
File Format PDF
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Auto/Greyscale
A4 Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Preview
Select settings
Settings can be selected for scanning the original.
• Original (2-sided original, scan size, send size)
• Exposure • Resolution • File Format • Colour Mode
☞
• Send Settings (File Name)
Scan mode, Data entry mode:
☞
CHANGING THE SUBJECT, FILE NAME, REPLY-TO,
USB memory mode:
☞
ENTERING A FILE NAME (page 5-40)
Internet fax mode:
☞
CHANGING THE SUBJECT, FILE NAME, AND BODY
5-15
Special mode settings
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Address Entry
Send Settings Resolution
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
Address Review
File
File Format
Colour Mode
Auto/Greyscale
Mono2
Quick File Special Modes
Preview
Special modes can be selected.
☞
Start scanning and transmission
Start scanning and transmission.
If the original is placed on the document glass, follow these steps to start scanning and transmission:
(1) Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
(2) When scanning is finished, replace the original with the next original.
(3) Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
(4) Repeat (2) and (3) until all originals have been scanned.
(5) Touch the [Read-End] key.
• The [COLOUR START] key cannot be used in Internet fax mode.
• After the original is scanned, the settings revert to the default settings.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
System Settings (Administrator): Default Display Settings
The settings can be kept in effect a fixed period of time after scanning is completed.
5-16
ORIGINAL SIZES
TRANSMITTABLE ORIGINAL SIZES
The following original sizes can be transmitted
Using the automatic document feeder
Minimum original size
131 mm (height) x 140 mm (width)
(5-1/8" (height) x 5-1/2" (width))
Maximum original size
297 mm (height) x 1000 mm* (width)
(11-5/8" (height) x 39-3/8"* (width))
Using the document glass
–
297 mm (height) x 432 mm (width)
(11-5/8" (height) x 17" (width))
* A long original can be transmitted. (When only scan destinations are selected for scan transmission or metadata transmission, scanning will take place in Mono2 at a resolution of 300X300dpi or less. When a resolution of 600X600dpi is used for Internet fax transmission, the maximum original size is 800 mm (31-1/2").)
THE SIZE OF THE PLACED ORIGINAL
When a standard size original is placed, the original size is automatically detected and displayed in "Scan" in the base screen.
When the automatic original detection function is operating and the original is a non-standard size, the closest standard size may be displayed or the original size may not appear. In this event, manually set the correct original size.
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by paper size) (page 5-56)
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by numerical values) (page 5-57)
STANDARD SIZES
Standard sizes are sizes that the machine can automatically detect. The standard sizes are set in "Original Size
Detector Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
List of original size detector settings
Selections
AB-1
AB-2
AB-3
AB-4
AB-5
Inch-1
Inch-2
Inch-3
Standard sizes (detected original sizes)
Document glass
Document feeder tray
(automatic document feeder)
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
8-1/2" x 14", 11" x 17"
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 330 mm
(8-1/2" x 13")
A4, A4R, A5, B4, 8K, 16K, 16KR
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 340 mm
(8-1/2" x 13-2/5")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 343 mm
(8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R,
5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13" (216 mm x 330 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, 8K, 16K, 16KR, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 340 mm (8-1/2" x 13-2/5")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 8-1/2" x 11",
11" x 17", 216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R,
5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A4, A3
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13" (216 mm x 330 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A4, A3
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A4, A3
5-17
ENTERING DESTINATIONS
This section explains how to specify destination addresses, including selecting an address from the address book and retrieving an address by entering a search number.
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM THE
ADDRESS BOOK
The address book screen shows stored destinations as one-touch keys.
The destinations are displayed in order by search number.
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
ABCD
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
The address book screen shows the destinations of all modes of the image send function. Each one-touch key shows the name of the destination and an icon indicating the mode to be used.
Icon Mode
Fax
Scan to E-mail
Internet fax (Direct SMTP)
Scan to FTP
Scan to Network Folder
Scan to Desktop
Group key with multiple destinations
• For information on storing addresses in the address book, see "
STORING DESTINATION ADDRESSES FOR EACH
SCAN MODE IN THE ADDRESS BOOK " (page 5-6).
System Settings:
This is used to store Scan to E-mail and Internet fax addresses in one-touch keys.
5-18
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION
A destination is retrieved by selecting its one-touch key.
Touch the [Address Book] key.
1
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Address Entry
Send Settings Resolution
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
Address Review
File
File Format
Colour Mode
Auto/Greyscale
Mono2
Quick File Special Modes
Preview
2
(3) (2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
(1)
Specify the destination.
(1) Touch the index tab where the destination is stored.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
If you select an incorrect destination, touch the key again to cancel the selection.
(3) Touch the [To] key.
This enters the selected destination.
• It is convenient to store frequently used destinations in the [Freq.] index. Specify that a destination be displayed in the [Freq.] index when you store the destination.
• To continue specifying other destinations...
It is possible to specify multiple scan mode (Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, Scan to Network
Folder), Internet fax, and fax mode destinations when performing a broadcast transmission (maximum of 500 destinations). To specify multiple destinations, repeat (1) through (3) of this step.
When performing Scan to E-mail, you can select a one-touch key and then touch the [Cc] key or the [Bcc] key to send Cc or Bcc copies of the e-mail.
• System Settings (Administrator): Bcc Setting
This setting enables or disables Bcc delivery. When enabled, the [Bcc] key appears in the address book screen.
• System Settings (Administrator): Must Input Next Address Key at Broadcast Setting
This setting determines whether or not the [Next Address] key can be omitted before specifying the next destination.
Factory default setting: the [Next Address] key can be omitted.
• System Settings (Administrator): Disable Switching of Display Order
This is used to disable switching of the order of display of the one-touch keys in the address book screen. The currently selected display order will be the order that is used after this setting is enabled.
5-19
CHECKING AND DELETING THE SELECTED
DESTINATIONS
When multiple destinations have been selected, you can display and check the destinations. You can also delete a destination from the list (cancel selection of the destination).
1
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Touch the [Address Review] key.
2
Address Review
001 AAA AAA
003 KKK KKK
005 MMM MMM
007 OOO OOO
009 QQQ QQQ
011 SSS SSS
To
002 BBB BBB
004 LLL LLL
006 NNN NNN
008 PPP PPP
010 RRR RRR
012 TTT TTT
Cc
OK
1
2
Check the destinations and then touch the [OK] key.
To check Cc or Bcc destinations, touch the corresponding tab.
To cancel selection of a destination...
Touch the one-touch key of the destination that you wish to cancel. A message will appear to confirm the deletion.
Touch the [Yes] key. Touch the [Detail] key to check the specified destination type and name.
Deselect the address?
AAA AAA
Detail No Yes
5-20
USING A SEARCH NUMBER TO RETRIEVE
A DESTINATION
A destination stored in the address book can be retrieved using the key. This can be done in the base screen of any of the modes or in the address book screen.
Touch the key.
1
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
File
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Auto/Greyscale
A4 Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Preview
2
Enter the 4-digit search number of the address with the numeric keys.
When the 4-digit search number is entered, the stored address is retrieved and specified as a destination.
• The search number is programmed when the destination is stored in the address book.
• If you do not know the search number, print the one-touch address list using "Sending Address List" in the system settings.
• When entering search numbers such as "0001" and "0011", "0" can be omitted. For example to enter "0001", enter
"1" and touch the key or the [Next Address] key.
If an incorrect search number is entered...
Press the [CLEAR] key ( ) to clear the number and enter the correct number.
5-21
ENTERING AN ADDRESS MANUALLY
Scan to E-mail, Internet fax, Network Folder and data entry mode addresses can be manually entered.
1
(2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Freq.
ABCD
Preview
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Display the address input screen.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
Before touching the [Address Entry] key in the base screen, touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Address Entry] key.
2
Select the destination type.
Internet Fax
Network Folder
Direct SMTP
Enter the destination address.
(1) Touch the key of the desired delivery method.
• Touch the [E-mail] key to open the delivery method selection screen. Normally the [To] key is touched.
• Touch the [Network Folder] key to open the network folder entry screen. To specify a network folder, see
"
SPECIFYING A NETWORK FOLDER " (page 5-23).
• If you touched the [Address Entry] key in the base screen in step 1, the delivery methods that can be selected vary depending on the mode being used.
(2) Enter the destination address in the text entry screen that appears.
Enter the destination address and touch the [OK] key.
For the procedure for entering text, see " ENTERING
TEXT " (page 1-67) in "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE".
• If you wish the destination to be a Cc destination, touch the [Cc] key.
• The [Bcc] key only appears when Bcc has been enabled using "Bcc Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
If you wish the destination to be a Bcc destination, touch the [Bcc] key.
• When Internet fax mode is selected, the base screen appears after the destination address is entered. However, if
"I-Fax Reception Report On/Off Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), the reception report request screen will appear. If you wish to receive a report, touch the [Yes] key. If not, touch the [No] key. (When
Direct SMTP is used, transmission confirmation is not performed.)
• System Settings (Administrator): I-Fax Reception Report On/Off Setting
This setting is used to request a reception report when an Internet fax is sent. When the destination is specified by directly entering the address, a message will appear asking you if you wish to receive a report. (When Direct SMTP is used, transmission confirmation is not performed.)
• System Settings (Administrator): Bcc Setting
This setting enables or disables Bcc delivery. When enabled, the [Bcc] key appears in the address book screen and the delivery type selection screen.
5-22
SPECIFYING A NETWORK FOLDER
A network folder on a server or computer connected to the same network as the machine can be directly specified.
Select [Network Folder] in step 2 on the previous page and follow the steps below.
1
Network Folder
Folder Path
User Name
Password
Cancel OK
Browse
Touch the [Browse] key.
• To directly enter a folder, touch the [Folder Path] key. A text entry screen will appear.
• If a user name and password are required, check with the administrator of the server and enter the user name and password.
For the procedure for entering text, see "
ENTERING TEXT " (page 1-67) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
5-23
2
(1)
Select workgroup.
Workgroup
Workgroup Name
Work 1
Work 2
Work 3
Work 4
Work 5
Work 6
(2)
Select server.
Server
Work 1
Server Name
Server 1
Server 2
Server 3
Server 4
Server 5
Server 6
Select network folder.
Network Folder
\\Server 1
Network Folder Name
User 1
User 2
User 3
User 4
User 5
User 6
(3)
Cancel
Search
OK
Cancel
Search
OK
Cancel
(4)
Search
OK
1
16
1
16
1
3
Access the network folder.
(1) Touch the key of the workgroup that you wish to access.
(2) Touch the key of the server or computer that you wish to access.
If a screen appears prompting you to enter a user name and password, check with your server administrator and enter the appropriate user name and password.
(3) Touch the key of the network folder.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the screen of step 1. Touch the [OK] key again to enter the folder.
• You can touch the [Search] key and enter a keyword to search for a workgroup, server, or network folder. For the procedure for entering text, see "
ENTERING TEXT " (page 1-67) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
• Up to 100 workgroups, 100 servers, and 100 network folders can be displayed.
• To move up one level, touch the key.
• The [Cancel] key can be pressed to return to the screen of step 1.
• To change the sorting order of the displayed keys, touch the key that shows or in each screen. The order switches between ascending order and descending order each time you touch the key.
• To go to a particular page, touch the
1
key that shows the current page number and enter the desired page number.
5-24
RETRIEVING A DESTINATION FROM A
GLOBAL ADDRESS BOOK
When an LDAP server is configured in the Web pages, you can look up an address in a global address book and retrieve the address for Scan to E-mail or Internet fax transmission (excluding Direct SMTP addresses).
1
(2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Open the global address search screen.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the [Global Address Search] key.
2
Server Change
Server 1
Server 2
Server 3
Server 4
Server 5
Server 6
Server 7
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
Search for the destination.
If only one LDAP server has been stored, (1) and (2) are not necessary. Go directly to (3). If an authentication screen for the
LDAP server appears, enter your user name and password.
(1) Touch the key of the LDAP server that you wish to use.
If an authentication screen for the LDAP server appears, enter your user name and password.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
(3) Search for the destination in the search screen.
Enter search characters for the destination and touch the
[Search] key. The search results will appear after a brief interval.
For the procedure for entering text, see " ENTERING
TEXT " (page 1-67) in "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE".
How to search
Enter the search characters (maximum of 64 characters). The system will look for names starting with the entered letters.
An asterisk can be used as follows:
XXX : Names beginning with "XXX".
XXX: Names that end with "XXX".
XXX : Names that include "XXX".
AA XX: Names that start with "AA" and end with "XX".
5-25
(2)
To
Condition
Settings
Address Review
Search Again
XXX
XXX AAA
XXX BBB
Address Book
XXX CCC
XXX DDD
XXX EEE
XXX FFF
Cc
(1)
Detail
1
2
Select the destination.
(1) Touch the key of the desired destination.
If no names are found that match the search characters, a message will appear. Touch the [OK] key to close the message and touch the [Search Again] key to search again.
(2) Touch the [To] key.
This enters the selected destination.
If you wish to enter another destination, repeat (1) and (2) of this step.
3
• If 30 or more matches are found, a message will appear in the screen. Touch the [OK] key to close the message. Up to 300 matches can appear. If no names are found that match the search letters, touch the [Search Again] key to search again using more search letters.
• To check the information stored in a destination...
Touch the key of the destination and then touch the [Detail] key. The information stored for the selected destination will appear. Check the information and then touch the [OK] key to return to the search results screen.
• If a screen for selecting the item to be used appears...
If the selected destination includes a fax number, telephone number, or other contact information in addition to the e-mail address or Internet fax address, you will need to select which item you wish to use. Touch the [E-mail] key or the [Internet Fax] key to retrieve the address for Scan to E-mail or Internet fax transmission.
Storing a destination from a global address book in the machine's address book
A destination address obtained from a global address book can be stored as a destination (one-touch key) in the address book of the machine.
Touch the [Detail] key in the search results screen of the global address book (the screen of step 3 above) to display information on the selected destination. Touch the [Register] key in the detailed information screen and then touch the item to be used (the [E-mail] key or the [Internet Fax] key). The following screens will appear.
E-mail address registration screen Internet fax address registration screen
Direct Address / Individual
E-mail Internet Fax
Search Number 001
Name
Initial
AAA AAA
A Index
Address
Key Name
AAA AAA
File Format Colour/Greyscale:PDF/Medium
B/W :PDF/MMR(G4)
Fax
User 1
Exit Direct Address / Individual
E-mail Internet Fax
Search Number 001
Name
Initial
Address
AAA AAA
A
Key Name AAA AAA
Compression MH (G3)
I-Fax Report Off
Index
Fax
User 1
Exit
The information stored in the global address book is automatically entered. (The settings can be changed if needed. For detailed information on each item, see "
Address Control " (page 7-16) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS".) However, configure
the items below manually. To complete the storing procedure, touch the [Exit] key.
• [Initial] key: Touch this key to enter the initials that determine where the destination will appear in the alphabetical index and the order of one-touch key display. Enter up to 10 characters for the initials.
• [Index] key: Touch this key to select the custom index in which the address will appear. You can also select whether or not the destination will be included on the [Freq.] tab of the address book.
• [File Format] key: Set the format for Scan to E-mail. Default format settings have already been configured; however, selecting format settings when you store a destination saves you the trouble of selecting the settings each time you transmit to that destination.
• [Compression] key: Touch this key to set the compression mode when sending an Internet fax.
• [I-Fax Report] key: Touch this key to request a reception report when sending an Internet fax.
5-26
USING THE RESEND FUNCTION
The destinations of the most recent 8 transmissions by Scan to E-mail, Internet fax (including Direct SMTP addresses) and/or fax are stored. One of these can be selected to resend to that destination.
Touch the [Resend] key.
1
Ready to send.
Scan
Address Book
Address Entry
Send Settings
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
PDF Address Review
File Auto/Greyscale
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Mono2
Resend
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
Preview
Cancel
Touch the key of the desired address.
The last 8 addresses used for transmission are displayed.
2
Resend
No.01
No.03
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
No.05
EEE EEE
No.07
GGG GGG
No.02
No.04
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
No.06
No.08
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
• When the [Resend] key is touched and a destination selected, the mode of the selected destination is automatically selected.
• The following types of addresses are not stored for resending.
- A one-touch key in which multiple destinations are stored (group key).
- Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, and Scan to Network Folder addresses.
- Broadcasting destinations
- Addresses used only for BCC delivery
- Destinations transmitted to using a program
System Settings (Administrator): Disable [Resend] on Fax/Image Send Mode
This prohibits use of the resend function. When this setting is enabled, the [Resend] key cannot be used in the base screen of image send mode.
5-27
TRANSMITTING AN IMAGE
SENDING AN IMAGE IN SCAN MODE
This section explains the basic procedure for transmission in scan mode (Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, Scan to
Desktop, and Scan to Network Folder).
When a default address is configured in "Default Address Setting" in the system settings (administrator), the mode cannot be changed, the destination cannot be changed, and destinations cannot be added. If you wish to change the mode or destination, touch the [Cancel] key in the touch panel and then follow the procedure below.
When "Default Address Setting" is set to "Apply E-mail address of the user for login.", pressing the [Add Address] key on the touch panel switches modes and adds addresses.
Original size detector
Place the original.
Do not place any objects under the original size detector.
Closing the automatic document feeder with an object underneath may damage the original size detector plate and prevent correct detection of the document size.
1
• When placing the originals, orient them as shown below.
Originals
Document feeder tray
Place the original face up.
Portrait orientation*
1
1
Document glass
Place the original face down and align the corner with the tip of the arrow mark in the top left corner of the document glass scale.
1
Landscape orientation
1
1
1
* To place a large portrait-oriented original, place it as shown above in "Landscape orientation" and specify the placement orientation in step 3.
• Place A5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size originals in portrait (vertical) orientation ( ). If placed in landscape (horizontal) orientation ( ), an incorrect size will be detected. For a A5R (5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R) size original, enter the original size manually.
• Originals cannot be scanned in succession from both the automatic document feeder and the document glass and sent in a single transmission.
5-28
2
(4) (3) (2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Specify the destination.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
The icon on the key indicates the type of destination stored in the key.
: Scan to E-mail
: Scan to FTP
: Scan to Network Folder
: Scan to Desktop
(3) Touch the [To] key.
The destination is specified.
(4) Touch the [Condition Settings] key.
• After a one-touch key is touched, if the screen is changed without touching the [To] key, the destination is automatically specified.
• When performing Scan to E-mail, you can also send Cc or Bcc copies to other destinations. Touch the desired destination and then touch the [Cc] key or the [Bcc] key.
• Multiple destinations can be specified. To specify multiple destinations, repeat steps (2) and (3).
• You can also select multiple one-touch keys and then touch the [To] key (or the [Cc] or [Bcc] key) to specify all selected keys at once.
• In addition to specification by a one-touch key, a destination can also be specified by a search number. Destinations for Scan to E-mail and Scan to Network Folder can also be manually entered or looked up in a global address book.
For more information, see " ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 5-18).
System Settings (Administrator): Bcc Setting
This setting enables or disables Bcc delivery. When enabled, the [Bcc] key appears in the address book screen.
Switch to scan mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the [Scan] tab.
(2) Touch the [Original] key.
3
(1) (2)
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
File
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Auto/Greyscale
A4 Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Preview
The current settings for [Original], [Exposure], [Resolution], [File Format], and [Colour Mode] are indicated at the right of each key. To change a setting, touch the appropriate key.
☞
AUTOMATICALLY SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF AN ORIGINAL (2-Sided Original) (page 5-54),
THE ORIGINAL SCAN SIZE AND SEND SIZE (Enlarge/Reduce) (page 5-55),
AND ORIGINAL IMAGE TYPE (page 5-61),
CHANGING THE RESOLUTION (page 5-63),
(page 5-68), SPECIAL MODES (page 5-71)
5-29
4
Scan/Original
2-Sided
Booklet
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
2-Sided
Tablet
(1) (2)
OK
Image Orientation
The original orientation is initially set to necessary.
Specify the orientation in which the original is placed.
To enable the original to be scanned in the correct orientation
(the orientation of the top edge of the original that is shown at the top of the display), specify the orientation in which the original was placed in step 1.
(1) Touch the appropriate orientation key.
If the top edge of the original is up, touch the the top edge of the original is to the left, touch the
key. If key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the screen of step 2.
. If the original was placed with the top edge up, this step is not
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If the original is placed on the document glass, the [Read-End] key appears in the touch panel. If the original is only one page, go to step 7. To scan more pages, go to the next step.
• If the original was inserted in the document feeder tray, a beep will sound when scanning is completed and transmission will take place.
• To scan in full colour, press the [COLOUR START] key. To scan in black and white, press the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key. If the colour mode of the [COLOUR START] key is set to [Auto], the colour of the original will be detected automatically and scanning in full colour, greyscale or Mono2 will take place.
• If Encrypt PDF is selected for the file format ([PDF] is selected in the format settings screen and the [Encry.] checkbox is set to ), you will be prompted to enter a password when you press the [START] key.
Please enter encrypt PDF password.
Cancel Entry
Touch the [Entry] key to open the keyboard screen, enter a password (maximum of 32 characters), and touch the
[OK] key. The recipient must use the password entered here to open the Encrypt PDF file.
To cancel Encrypt PDF, touch the [Cancel] key. The format settings screen will appear to let you change the file type. Select a new file type and press the [START] key to begin transmission.
6
If the original was placed on the document glass, replace it with the next original and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat until all originals have been scanned.
5-30
7
Touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that the operation is completed.
Open the automatic document feeder and remove the original.
Place next original. (Pg.No.x)
Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Configure Read-End
• If no action is taken for one minute after the confirmation screen appears, scanning automatically ends and the transmission is reserved.
• The [Configure] key can be touched to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size for each original page scanned. However, when "Card Shot" is selected in the special modes, only the exposure can be changed when scanning an even-numbered original page.
• When all originals have been scanned, "Job stored." will be displayed together with a job control number. This number can be used to locate the job in the Transaction Report or in the Image Sending Activity Report. If the job is a broadcast transmission, this number will also appear in the key of the job in the job status screen. For this reason, making a note of the number is useful for checking the result.
• If the memory becomes full while the originals are being scanned, a message will appear and scanning will stop.
• When performing Scan to E-mail, take care not to send a file that is too large. In particular, multi-page files tend to be large.
When sending a multi-page file or other large file, it may be necessary to reduce the number of scanned pages or reduce the send size.
• Storing a mail signature
You can have preset text automatically added at the end of e-mail messages as a mail signature. This is convenient when you wish to have a corporate policy or other preset text appear at the bottom of e-mail messages. To store the text for the mail signature, click [Application Settings], [Network Scanner Settings] and then [Administration Settings] in the Web page menu. (Administrator rights are required.) Up to 900 characters can be entered. (The mail signature is not included in the maximum number of characters that can be entered in the e-mail message.)
Use "Pre-Setting Mail Signature" in the system settings (administrator) to specify whether or not a mail signature is added.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• System Settings (Administrator): Image Send Settings
Use this to configure scanner transmission settings, including the default resolution and exposure settings, the default colour mode and file format, the file compression method for broadcasting, the file size limit for Scan to E-mail, and the default sender and destination.
• System Settings (Administrator): Pre-Setting Mail Signature
Use this setting to specify whether or not a mail signature is added at the end of e-mail messages. By factory default, a mail signature is not added.
5-31
CHANGING THE SUBJECT, FILE NAME, REPLY-TO,
AND BODY TEXT
The subject, file name, reply-to, and body text can be changed when performing a scan transmission. Preset items can be selected or text can be directly entered.
To change the body text, the hard disk drive is required.
• When performing Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, or Scan to Network Folder, only the file name is used.
• If the subject and file name are not changed, the settings in the Web page are used.
• If the sender name is not changed, the name set in "Default Sender Set" in the system settings is used. If this is not configured, the reply address in [Network Settings] - [Services Settings] - [SMTP Settings] in the Web pages is used.
(Administrator rights are required.)
• Selections for the subject, file name, and body text are configured by clicking [Application Settings] and then [Network
Scanner Settings] in the Web page menu.
1
Touch the [Send Settings] key in the base screen.
☞
If you are sending to a Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, or Scan to Network Folder destination, go to step 4.
OK
To change the subject, touch the
[Subject] key.
2
Send Settings
Subject
File Name
Reply-To
Body Text
Add 'Reply to' to Cc
3
(1) (2)
Subject Cancel
Direct Entry
No.01 Sub: Schedule coordination No.02 Sub: Monthly Schedule
No.03 Sub: Minutes of planning m No.04
No.05
No.07
No.06
No.08
No.09
No.11
No.10
No.12
OK
1
5
Enter the subject.
(1) Touch a Pre-Set text key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
• If you wish to directly enter the text, touch the [Direct Entry] key to open the text entry screen. Enter the text and touch the [OK] key.
• The text in a pre-set text key can be edited by touching the pre-set text key and then the [Direct Entry] key. The text entry screen will appear with the selected pre-set text entered. (When a destination is stored using the Web pages, up to 80 characters can be entered. However, only 54 characters can be entered in the touch panel.)
5-32
4
Send Settings
Subject
File Name
Reply-To
Body Text
Sub: Schedule coordination meeting
Add 'Reply to' to Cc
OK
To change the file name, touch the [File
Name] key.
• The file name is entered in the same way as the subject.
• If you are sending to a Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, or
Scan to Network Folder destination, go to step 9.
5
Send Settings
Subject
File Name
Reply-To
Body Text
Sub: Schedule coordination meeting
Material for planning meeting
Add 'Reply to' to Cc
OK
To change "Reply-To", touch the
[Reply-To] key.
If user authentication is being used, the information of the user that logged in will be applied, and thus "Reply-To" cannot be changed.
6
Reply-To
6 12 18
Global
Address Search
Address Entry
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
ABC
User
Cancel OK
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
1
3
III III
KKK KKK
All
JJJ JJJ
LLL LLL
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Specify a user for "Reply-To" and touch the [OK] key.
• Touch the key that you wish to use for "Reply-To".
• You can touch the [Global Address Search] key to specify a user stored in a global address book for "Reply-To". You can also touch the [Address Entry] key to directly enter an e-mail address.
• To specify the return address, you can touch the key and enter a user number that has been previously stored using "User List" in the system settings (administrator).
• A key can only be selected for the return address if an e-mail address has been stored for that user in "User List" in the system settings (administrator).
5-33
7
Send Settings
Subject
File Name
Reply-To
Body Text
Sub: Schedule coordination meeting
Material for planning meeting
AAA AAA
Add 'Reply to' to Cc
OK
To change the body text, touch the
[Body Text] key.
• This function requires the hard disk drive.
• Please go to Step 9.
Body Entry Clear All OK
Thank you for your continuous support. We have attached scanned data, which you have requested.
Enter the body text and touch the [OK] key.
• To select a pre-set text previously stored in the Web page, touch the [Pre-Set Select] key.
• To directly enter the body text, touch the [Edit] key.
8
Pre-Set Select Edit
• 1800 characters can be entered. (A line break counts as one character.)
• To clear all entered text, touch the [Clear All] key. When this key is touched, the entire body of the message is erased immediately; not just the selected line.
• Each line of the entered text can be selected with the keys. To edit the selected line, touch the [Edit] key.
The text entry screen will appear with the selected text entered.
9
Send Settings OK
Subject
File Name
Reply-To
Body Text
Sub: Schedule coordination meeting
Material for planning meeting
AAA AAA
Thank you for your continuous support. We have attached sca
Add 'Reply to' to Cc
Touch the [OK] key.
The [Add 'Reply to' to Cc] checkbox can be selected to send a Cc copy to the sender.
When storing pre-set text for the subject and file name in the Web pages, up to 80 characters can be entered.
• System Settings (Administrator): The Number of File Name/Subject/Body Keys Displayed Setting
The setting for the number of subject keys and file name keys displayed in one screen can be changed to 6, 12, or 18.
• System Settings (Administrator): Default Sender Set
This is used to store the sender name and e-mail address that is used when a sender is not selected.
5-34
SENDING AN IMAGE IN USB MEMORY MODE
Follow the steps below to send a scanned image to a commercially available USB memory device that has been connected to the machine. This stores the file in the USB device.
• Use a FAT32 USB memory with a capacity of no more than 32 GB.
• When a default address is configured in "Default Address Setting" in the system settings (administrator), the mode cannot be changed. To switch to USB memory mode, touch the [Cancel] key in the touch panel and then follow the steps below.
Connect the USB memory to the USB connector (Type A) on the machine.
1
Original size detector
Place the original.
Do not place any objects under the original size detector.
Closing the automatic document feeder with an object underneath may damage the original size detector plate and prevent correct detection of the document size.
2
• When placing the originals, orient them as shown below.
Originals
Document feeder tray
Place the original face up.
Portrait orientation*
1
1
Document glass
Place the original face down and align the corner with the tip of the arrow mark in the top left corner of the document glass scale.
1
Landscape orientation
1
1 1
* To place a large portrait-oriented original, place it as shown above in "Landscape orientation" and specify the placement orientation in step 4.
• Place A5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size originals in portrait (vertical) orientation ( ). If placed in landscape (horizontal) orientation
( ), an incorrect size will be detected. For a A5R (5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R) size original, enter the original size manually.
• Originals cannot be scanned in succession from both the automatic document feeder and the document glass and sent in a single transmission.
5-35
3
(2) (1)
Scan
Stored to
File Name
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Auto
Resolution 200X200dpi
File Format
Colour Mode
Text
Auto/Greyscale
Special Modes
Fax
Scan: Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Preview
Switch to USB memory mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the [USB Mem. Scan] tab
If the [USB Mem. Scan] tab does not appear, touch the
tab to move the screen.
(2) Touch the [Original] key.
• When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination.
• If a destination of another mode has been previously specified, a message will appear when you change to USB memory mode indicating that the destination setting will be cleared. Touch the [OK] key in the message screen and go to the next step.
• The current settings for [Original], [Exposure], [Resolution], [File Format], and [Colour Mode] are indicated at the right of each key. To change a setting, touch the appropriate key.
☞
AUTOMATICALLY SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF AN ORIGINAL (2-Sided Original) (page 5-54),
THE ORIGINAL SCAN SIZE AND SEND SIZE (Enlarge/Reduce) (page 5-55),
(page 5-61), CHANGING THE RESOLUTION (page 5-63),
CHANGING THE COLOUR MODE (page 5-68),
4
USB Mem. Scan/Original
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
(1) (2)
OK
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
Image Orientation
The original orientation is initially set to necessary.
Specify the orientation in which the original is placed.
To enable the original to be scanned in the correct orientation
(the orientation in which the top edge of the original appears at the top of the display), specify the orientation in which the original was placed in step 2.
(1) Touch the appropriate orientation key.
If the top edge of the original is up, touch the the top edge of the original is to the left, touch the
key. If key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the screen of step 3.
. If the original was placed with the top edge up, this step is not
5-36
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If the original is placed on the document glass, the [Read-End] key appears in the touch panel. If the original is only one page, go to step 7. To scan more pages, go to the next step.
• If the original was inserted in the document feeder tray, a beep will sound when scanning is completed and transmission will begin. Go to step 8.
Do not disconnect the USB memory until "Sending data has been completed." appears in the touch panel.
• To scan in full colour, press the [COLOUR START] key. To scan in black and white, press the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key. If the colour mode of the [COLOUR START] key is set to [Auto], the colour of the original will be detected automatically and scanning in full colour, greyscale or Mono2 will take place.
• If Encrypt PDF is selected for the file format ([PDF] is selected in the format settings screen and the [Encry.] checkbox is set to ), you will be prompted to enter a password when you press the [START] key.
Please enter encrypt PDF password.
Cancel Entry
Touch the [Entry] key to open the keyboard screen, enter a password (maximum of 32 characters), and touch the
[OK] key. The recipient must use the password entered here to open the Encrypt PDF file.
To cancel Encrypt PDF, touch the [Cancel] key. The format settings screen will appear to let you change the file type. Select a new file type and press the [START] key to begin transmission.
6
If the original was placed on the document glass, replace it with the next original and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat until all originals have been scanned.
Place next original. (Pg.No.x)
Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Configure Read-End
Touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that the operation is completed.
Open the automatic document feeder and remove the original.
7
• If no action is taken for one minute after the confirmation screen appears, scanning automatically ends and the transmission is reserved.
• The [Configure] key can be touched to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size for each original page scanned. However, when "Card Shot" is selected in the special modes, only the exposure can be changed when scanning an even-numbered original page.
5-37
When "Sending data has been completed." appears in the touch panel, disconnect the USB memory.
8
Do not disconnect the USB memory while "Processing data." or "Sending data." appears in the touch panel.
• When transmission to USB memory is completed, "Sending data has been completed." is displayed. After a brief interval the message is cleared and the base screen of image send mode reappears. (The base screen of image send mode is the screen that appears when the [IMAGE SEND] key is touched.)
• If the USB memory becomes full during scanning...
A message will appear and scanning will stop. The scanned data will not be stored. However, if the file format is set to
JPEG and the [Specified Pages per File] checkbox is selected, files for which scanning is completed will be stored in USB memory.
• To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• To cancel scanning to USB memory...
While scanned data is being stored in the USB memory, the message "Sending data." and the [Cancel] key appear in the touch panel. To cancel the storing operation, touch the [Cancel] key.
•
System Settings: USB-Device Check (page 7-27)
This is used to check the connection of a USB device to the machine.
• System Settings (Administrator): Scan Settings
This is used to set the default colour mode and file format.
• System Settings (Administrator): Disable Scan Function
The use of PC scan mode and USB memory mode can be prohibited.
5-38
SPECIFY THE FOLDER IN WHICH THE FILE WILL BE
STORED
When sending a file to USB memory, a folder can be specified in USB memory. A new folder can also be created in USB memory.
If a folder is not specified, the file will be stored on the first level of the USB memory.
1
Scan
Stored to
File Name
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
Resolution 200X200dpi
File Format PDF
Auto/Greyscale Colour Mode
Special Modes
Mono2
Preview
Touch the [Stored to] key.
2
(A)
Stored to
\
Folder Name
Folder 1
Folder 2
Folder 3
Folder 4
(1)
Cancel
New Folder
(2)
OK
1
1
Select the folder.
(1) Touch the key of the folder in which you wish to store the file.
If the selected folder contains another folder, you can select that folder. The current folder level appears in (A).
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen. The [Stored to] key will be highlighted.
• To create a new folder on the currently displayed level, touch the [New Folder] key. A text entry screen will appear.
Enter a folder name and touch the [OK] key. For the procedure for entering text, see "
1-67) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
• To move up one level, touch the key. This key appears when a folder on the second level or lower is selected.
• To change the order of the keys that appear in a screen, touch the key that shows or . Each time the key is touched, the order changes between ascending and descending.
Specify a folder name and file name that are within the allowed number of display characters of your operating system. If the file name or folder name exceeds the allowed number of characters, it may not be possible to display the scanned file.
5-39
ENTERING A FILE NAME
The file name can be directly entered when performing a scan transmission.
• If the file name is not entered, the settings in the Web page are used.
Scan
Stored to
File Name
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure
Resolution
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
File Format
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Auto/Greyscale
Mono2
Preview
(A)
Touch the [File Name] key. A text entry screen will appear. Enter the file name and touch the [OK] key. Enter the file name and touch the [OK] key. The entered file name will appear in (A).
5-40
SENDING A FAX IN INTERNET FAX MODE
The basic procedure for sending a fax in Internet fax mode is explained below. This procedure can also be used to perform direct transmission by Direct SMTP.
When a default address is configured in "Default Address Setting" in the system settings (administrator), the mode cannot be changed, the destination cannot be changed, and destinations cannot be added. To switch to Internet fax mode, touch the
[Cancel] key in the touch panel and follow the steps below.
When "Default Address Setting" is set to "Apply E-mail address of the user for login.", pressing the [Add Address] key on the touch panel switches to Internet fax mode.
1
Original size detector
Place the original.
• Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
• Do not place any objects under the original size detector.
Closing the automatic document feeder with an object underneath may damage the original size detector plate and prevent correct detection of the document size.
• Place A5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size originals in portrait (vertical) orientation ( ). If placed in landscape (horizontal) orientation
( ), an incorrect size will be detected. For an A5R (5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R) size original, enter the original size manually.
• Image rotation
A4, B5R, and A5R (8-1/2" x 11" and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R) originals are rotated 90 degrees and transmitted in A4R, B5, or A5 (8-1/2" x 11"R or 5-1/2" x 8-1/2") orientation. (A4R, B5, and A5 (8-1/2" x 11"R and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2") originals cannot be rotated for transmission.)
Transmission
2
• Originals cannot be scanned in succession from both the automatic document feeder and the document glass and sent in a single transmission.
System Settings (Administrator): Rotation Sending Setting
This is used to select whether or not a scanned original image is rotated before transmission.
The default setting is: rotate A4 to A4R, B5R to B5, and A5R to A5 (8-1/2" x 11" to 8-1/2" x 11"R, and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R to 5-1/2" x 8-1/2").
(4) (3) (2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
ABCD
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Specify the destination.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the key of the desired destination.
The icon appears in one-touch keys in which Internet fax addresses are stored.
(3) Touch the [To] key.
The destination is specified.
(4) Touch the [Condition Settings] key.
• After a one-touch key is touched, if the screen is changed without touching the [To] key, the destination is automatically specified.
• In addition to specification by a one-touch key, a destination can also be specified by a search number. You can also manually enter a destination or look up a destination in a global address book. For more information, see
"
ENTERING DESTINATIONS " (page 5-18).
5-41
3
(1) (2)
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Exposure Address Entry
Send Settings Resolution
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X100dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Address Review
File
File Format TIFF-F
Special Modes
Quick File
Preview
I-Fax Manual
Reception
Switch to Internet fax mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the [Internet Fax] tab.
(2) Touch the [Original] key.
The current settings for [Original], [Exposure], [Resolution], and [File Format] are indicated at the right of each key. To change a setting, touch the appropriate key.
☞
AUTOMATICALLY SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF AN ORIGINAL (2-Sided Original) (page 5-54),
THE ORIGINAL SCAN SIZE AND SEND SIZE (Enlarge/Reduce) (page 5-55),
AND ORIGINAL IMAGE TYPE (page 5-61),
CHANGING THE RESOLUTION (page 5-63),
4
Internet Fax/Original
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
(1) (2)
OK
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
Image Orientation
The original orientation is initially set to necessary.
Specify the orientation in which the original is placed.
When specifying the orientation of the image to be transmitted, specify the orientation of the original placed in step 1.
(1) Touch the appropriate orientation key.
If the top edge of the original is up, touch the the top edge of the original is to the left, touch the
key. If key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the screen of step 2.
. If the original was placed with the top edge up, this step is not
5
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If the original is placed on the document glass, the [Read-End] key appears in the touch panel. If the original is only one page, go to step 7. To scan more pages, go to the next step.
• If the original was inserted in the document feeder tray, a beep will sound when scanning is completed and transmission will take place.
6
If the original was placed on the document glass, replace it with the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat until all originals have been scanned.
5-42
7
Touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that the operation is completed.
Open the automatic document feeder and remove the original.
Place next original. (Pg.No.x)
Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Configure Read-End
• If no action is taken for one minute after the confirmation screen appears, scanning automatically ends and the transmission is reserved.
• The [Configure] key can be touched to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size for each original page scanned. However, when "2in1" or "Card Shot" is selected in the special modes, only the exposure can be changed when scanning an even-numbered original page.
• When all originals have been scanned, "Job stored." will be displayed together with a job control number. This number can be used to locate the job in the Transaction Report or in the Image Sending Activity Report. If the job is a broadcast transmission, this number will also appear in the key of the job in the job status screen. For this reason, making a note of the number is useful for checking the result.
• If the memory becomes full while the originals are being scanned, a message will appear and scanning will stop.
• Storing a mail signature
You can have preset text automatically added at the end of e-mail messages as a mail signature. This is convenient when you wish to have a corporate policy or other preset text appear at the bottom of e-mail messages. To store the text for the mail signature, click [Application Settings], [Network Scanner Settings] and then [Administration Settings] in the Web page menu. (Administrator rights are required.) Up to 900 characters can be entered. (The mail signature is not included in the maximum number of characters that can be entered in the e-mail message.)
Use "Pre-Setting Mail Signature" in the system settings (administrator) to specify whether or not a mail signature is added.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• System Settings (Administrator): I-Fax Send Settings
This is used to select Internet fax transmission settings such as the receive report setting, rotation setting, size restriction setting, and sender information attachment setting.
• System Settings (Administrator): Pre-Setting Mail Signature
Use this setting to specify whether or not a mail signature is added at the end of e-mail messages. By factory default, a mail signature is not added.
5-43
CHANGING THE SUBJECT, FILE NAME, AND BODY
TEXT
The subject, file name, and body text can be changed when performing an Internet fax transmission. Preset items can be selected or text can be directly entered.
To change the body text, the hard disk drive is required.
• If the subject and file name are not changed, the settings in the Web page are used.
• Selections for the subject, file name, and body text are configured by clicking [Application Settings] and then [Network
Scanner Settings] in the Web page menu.
1
Touch the [Send Settings] key in the base screen.
☞
OK
To change the subject, touch the
[Subject] key.
2
Send Settings
Subject
File Name
Body Text
3
(1) (2)
Subject Cancel
Direct Entry
No.01 Sub: Schedule coordination No.02 Sub: Monthly Schedule
No.03 Sub: Minutes of planning m No.04
No.05
No.07
No.06
No.08
No.09
No.11
No.10
No.12
OK
1
5
Enter the subject.
(1) Touch a pre-set text key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
• If you wish to directly enter the text, touch the [Direct Entry] key to open the text entry screen. Enter the text and touch the [OK] key.
• The text in a pre-set text key can be edited by touching the pre-set text key and then the [Direct Entry] key. The text entry screen will appear with the selected pre-set text entered. (When a destination is stored using the Web page, up to 80 characters can be entered. However, only 54 characters can be entered in the touch panel.)
5-44
4
Send Settings
Subject
File Name
Sub: Schedule coordination meeting
Body Text
OK
To change the file name, touch the [File
Name] key.
The file name is entered in the same way as the subject.
5
Send Settings
Subject
File Name
Sub: Schedule coordination meeting
Material for planning meeting
Body Text
OK
To change the body text, touch the
[Body Text] key.
Body Entry Clear All OK
Thank you for your continuous support. We have attached scanned data, which you have requested.
Enter the body text and touch the [OK] key.
• To select a pre-set message previously stored in the Web page, touch the [Pre-Set Select] key.
• To directly enter the message, touch the [Edit] key.
6
Pre-Set Select Edit
• 1800 characters can be entered. (A line break counts as one character.)
• To clear all entered text, touch the [Clear All] key. When this key is touched, the entire body of the message is erased immediately; not just the selected line.
• Each line of the entered text can be selected with the keys. To edit the selected line, touch the [Edit] key.
The text entry screen will appear with the selected text entered.
5-45
7
Send Settings
Subject
File Name
Sub: Schedule coordination meeting
Material for planning meeting
OK
Body Text Thank you for your continuous support. We have attached sca
Touch the [OK] key.
When storing pre-set text for the subject and file name in the Web pages, up to 80 characters can be entered.
System Settings (Administrator): The Number of File Name/Subject/Body Keys Displayed Setting
The setting for the number of subject keys and file name keys displayed in one screen can be changed to 6, 12, or 18.
5-46
SENDING THE SAME IMAGE TO MULTIPLE
DESTINATIONS (Broadcast Transmission)
The same scanned image can be sent to multiple scan modes, Internet fax mode, and fax mode destinations in a single operation. Up to 500 destinations can be selected in one broadcast operation.
Transmission
Originals
1
If you frequently use broadcasting to send images to the same group of destinations, it is convenient to store those destinations in a group key.
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
5-47
2
(3) (2)
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Specify the destination.
(1) Touch the [Address Book] key in the base screen.
(2) Touch the one-touch key of the desired destination.
(3) Touch the [To] key.
The destination is specified.
(4) Repeat steps (2) and (3) until all destinations are selected.
• To add Cc or Bcc recipients, select a recipient and touch the [Cc] key or the [Bcc] key.
• If "Must Input Next Address Key at Broadcast Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), touch the
[Next Address] key before specifying the next destination.
• One-touch keys that cannot be used for broadcast transmission are greyed out to prevent selection.
• If a Scan to FTP (Hyperlink) address is specified in a broadcast transmission, hyperlink e-mail transmission will not take place.
• If you frequently use broadcasting to send images to the same group of destinations, it is convenient to store those destinations in a group key.
3
5 10 15
Condition
Settings
Address Review
To
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
Address Entry
Global
Address Search
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
Preview
Freq.
Cc
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Touch the [Address Review] key.
4
Address Review
001 AAA AAA
003 KKK KKK
005 MMM MMM
007 OOO OOO
009 QQQ QQQ
011 SSS SSS
To
002 BBB BBB
004 LLL LLL
006 NNN NNN
008 PPP PPP
010 RRR RRR
012 TTT TTT
Cc
OK
1
2
Check the destinations and then touch the [OK] key.
If the transmission includes Cc or Bcc destinations, touch the [Cc] tab or the [Bcc] tab to check those destinations.
To cancel a specified destination...
Touch the one-touch key of the destination that you wish to cancel. A message will appear to confirm the deletion.
Touch the [Yes] key.
☞
CHECKING AND DELETING THE SELECTED DESTINATIONS (page 5-20)
5-48
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning of one page finishes, replace it with the next page and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
If Internet fax or fax destinations are included in the broadcast transmission, the [COLOUR START] key cannot be pressed. Scanning will take place in Mono2.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
5-49
BROADCAST TRANSMISSIONS THAT INCLUDE
INTERNET FAX DESTINATIONS
When a broadcast transmission includes both scan mode and Internet Fax mode destinations, the Internet Fax mode settings (original orientation and other various settings) are given priority. When performing this type of broadcast transmission, note the information below.
Original placement orientation
Send size
Exposure
Resolution
File compression mode
Colour scanning
Special modes
Scan file size
2in1
The orientation of Internet fax mode is given priority. When "Rotation Sending Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), the image is rotated 90 degrees. For this reason, in some cases the image may not be displayed in the correct orientation.
When the file format is set to [TIFF-S] in Internet fax mode, transmission is only possible in A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R) size.
The Internet fax settings are given priority.
When the file format is set to [TIFF-S] in Internet fax mode and a high resolution setting is selected in scan mode, the resolution will be changed to [200X200dpi].
The compression mode will be changed to the compression mode set in
"Compression Mode at Broadcasting" in the system settings (administrator).
Scanning will take place in Mono2 regardless of the colour mode setting.
This cannot be selected in scan mode, however, if selected in Internet fax mode, it will also be applied to scan destinations.
If a broadcast transmission is performed that includes destinations for which an attachment size limit has been set using "Maximum Size of E-mail Attachments
(E-mail)" or "Maximum Size of Data Attachments (FTP/Desktop/Network Folder)" in the system settings (administrator), the limit will also apply to destinations for which a limit is not set. (The limitation setting of Scan to E-mail or Internet fax is given priority.)
Resending to unsuccessful broadcast transmission destinations
The results of a completed broadcast transmission can be checked in the job status screen. If transmission to any of the addresses failed, resend the image to those addresses.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
(1) (1) (2)
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Set Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
10:05 04/01 000/001 Waiting 1
1
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting CCC CCC
DDD DDD 10:33 04/01 000/010 Waiting
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
Display the jobs completed screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to display.
(2) Touch the [Complete] key.
If the broadcast transmission included destinations of different modes, the same broadcast transmission key will appear in each of those modes.
5-50
3
(1)
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
Broadcast0002
Broadcast0003
DDD DDD
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Start Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 010/003 NG000000
10:05 04/01 001/001 Send OK 1
1
10:22 04/01 004/004 Send OK
10:30 04/01 010/010 Send OK
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
(2)
Call
Display details on the broadcast transmission.
(1) Touch the key of the completed broadcast transmission.
(2) Touch the [Detail] key.
"Broadcastxxxx" will appear as the address of the broadcast job key. The job control number that appeared in the touch panel when scanning ended appears in "xxxx".
Detail
Broadcast0001
Address
EEE EEE 002
010 FFF FFF
Start Time Status
10:01 04/01 NG000000
10:10 04/01 NG000000
OK
Retry
1
1
Resend the image to the unsuccessful destinations.
(1) Touch the [Failed] tab.
(2) Touch the [Retry] key.
4
File Failed
(1)
All Destinations
(2)
• The steps to follow after the [Retry] key is touched differ depending on whether or not the document filing function is used.
Not using document filing
You will return to the base screen with the unsuccessful destinations entered. Place the original and perform the steps of the broadcast transmission.
Using document filing
You will return to the document filing resend screen with the unsuccessful destinations entered. Perform the document filing resend procedure. (There is no need to rescan the original.)
• If the [All Destinations] tab is touched in (1), all destinations will be displayed. The [Retry] key that appears in the screen can be touched to resend to all the destinations.
5-51
SENDING AN INTERNET FAX FROM A
COMPUTER (PC-I-Fax)
A file on a computer can be sent via the machine as an Internet fax (PC-I-Fax function). Internet faxes are sent using the
PC-I-Fax function in the same way as documents are printed. Select the PC-Fax driver as the printer driver for your computer and then select the Print command in the software application. Image data for transmission will be created and sent as an Internet fax.
PC-I-Fax transmission
For the procedures for using this function, see the PC-Fax driver Help.
• To send an Internet fax using the PC-I-Fax function, the PC-Fax driver must be installed and then updated using the
CD-ROM that accompanies the Internet fax expansion kit. For more information, see the Software Setup Guide.
• This function can only be used on a Windows computer.
• This function can only be used for transmission. Internet faxes received on the machine cannot be received to a computer that is connected to the machine.
5-52
IMAGE SETTINGS
Settings for scanning the original are selected in the base screen of each mode. The current state of each setting appears to the right of the key used to select the setting.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
USB Mem. Scan
Auto Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Text
File Auto/Greyscale
Mono2
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Preview
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(1) [Original] key
Touch this key to set the scan size, send size, and orientation of the original, and select 2-sided scanning settings.
☞
AUTOMATICALLY SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF
AN ORIGINAL (2-Sided Original) (page 5-54),
SPECIFYING THE ORIGINAL SCAN SIZE AND
SEND SIZE (Enlarge/Reduce) (page 5-55)
(2) [Exposure] key
Touch this key to select the exposure for scanning.
☞
CHANGING THE EXPOSURE AND ORIGINAL
(3) [Resolution] key
Touch this key to select the resolution for scanning.
☞
CHANGING THE RESOLUTION (page 5-63)
(4) [File Format] key
Touch this key to change the format (file type) of the scanned image file.
☞
CHANGING THE FILE FORMAT (page 5-64)
(5) [Colour Mode] key
Touch this key to select the colour mode for scanning.
This key does not appear in Internet fax mode.
☞
CHANGING THE COLOUR MODE (page 5-68)
5-53
AUTOMATICALLY SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF AN
ORIGINAL (2-Sided Original)
The automatic document feeder can be used to automatically scan both sides of an original.
Scan transmission
2-sided original Front and reverse sides are scanned
1
Select the mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Original] key.
☞
2
Scan/Original
2-Sided
Booklet
(1)
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
2-Sided
Tablet
Image Orientation
(2)
(3)
OK
Specify the binding style of the 2-sided original (book or tablet) and the orientation in which the original is placed.
(1) Touch the [2-Sided Booklet] key or the
[2-Sided Tablet] key.
A book and a tablet are bound as shown below.
Book Tablet
A
E
J
C
G
L
A B
E F
K L
When a document cover is installed the [2-Sided Booklet] key and the [2-Sided Tablet] key are not displayed.
(2) Touch the appropriate [Image Orientation] key.
If this setting is not correct, a suitable image may not be transmitted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
To cancel 2-sided scanning, touch the highlighted key so that it is no longer highlighted.
2-sided scanning automatically turns off after the transmission operation is completed.
5-54
SPECIFYING THE ORIGINAL SCAN SIZE AND SEND
SIZE (Enlarge/Reduce)
When the original is placed, its size is automatically detected and displayed in the base screen.
The size of the placed original is indicated as the scan size, and the size to be transmitted is indicated as the send size.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
File
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution 200X200dpi
File Format PDF
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Auto/Greyscale
A4 Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Preview
In the above screen, the scan size (the placed original) is A4 (8-1/2" x 11") and the send size is auto. For example, if the scan size is A4 (8-1/2" x 11") and the send size is B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2"), the image will be reduced before transmission.
"Scan Size"
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
"Send Size" is set to B5
(5-1/2" x 8-1/2")
Transmission
The image is reduced to B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") before transmission
• Only standard original sizes can be automatically detected.
☞
• When the original size is a non-standard size, or if the size is not detected correctly, manually specify the original scan size.
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by paper size) (page 5-56)
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by numerical values) (page 5-57)
5-55
Specifying the original scan size (by paper size)
If the original is a non-standard size or you wish to change the scan size, touch the [Original] key to specify the original size manually. Place the original in the document feeder tray or on the document glass and follow the steps below.
1
Select the mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Original] key.
The automatically detected original size appears to the right of the [Original] key.
☞
Touch the [Scan Size] key.
Scan/Original OK
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
2
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
3
Scan/Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Size Input
Manual
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
(1)
B4
A3
Long Size
(2)
OK
AB
Inch
Specify the scan size.
(1) Touch the appropriate original size key.
When the document cover is installed, the [Long size] key is not displayed.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
4
• If you are sending a long original, touch the [Long Size] key. Use the automatic document feeder to scan a long original. The maximum width that can be scanned is 1000 mm (39-3/8") (the maximum height is 297 mm (11-5/8")).
☞
TRANSMITTABLE ORIGINAL SIZES (page 5-17)
• To specify an Inch size for the scan size, touch the [AB Inch] key to highlight the [Inch] side and then specify the scan size.
Touch the [OK] key.
Scan/Original OK
Scan Size
B5
100% Send Size
Auto
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
When [Long Size] is selected, the 2-sided scanning setting and send size cannot be changed. In addition, when only scan destinations are selected for scan transmission or metadata transmission, scanning will take place in Mono2.
5-56
Specifying the original scan size (by numerical values)
When scanning a non-standard size original such as a card, follow these steps to specify the original size. The width can be from 25 mm to 432 mm (1" to 17"), and the height can be from 25 mm to 297 mm (1" to 11-5/8").
1
Select the mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Original] key.
The automatically detected original size appears to the right of the [Original] key.
☞
Touch the [Scan Size] key.
Scan/Original OK
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
2
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
3
Scan/Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Size Input
A4
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
B4
A3
Long Size
OK
Touch the [Size Input] key.
AB
Inch
4
Scan/Original
Size Input
(1), (2)
Cancel
X 420
(50 432) mm
Y 297
(50 297) mm
(3)
OK
OK
Enter the scan size (original size).
(1) Touch the X (width) numeric value display key and enter the width.
(2) Touch the Y (height) numeric value display key and enter the height.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
Touch the [OK] key next to the [Cancel] key to complete the setting and return to the screen of step 3.
You can also touch the keys to change the number.
5-57
5
Scan/Original
Scan Size
X420 Y297
Send Size
Auto
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
OK
Touch the [OK] key.
The specified size appears in the [Scan Size] key.
• When the scan size is specified by numerical values, the send size cannot be specified.
• When the automatic document feeder is used, an original longer than 432 mm (17") can be scanned (maximum width
1000 mm (39-3/8")). In this case, touch the [Long Size] key in the screen of step 3.
☞
Specifying the original scan size (by paper size) (page 5-56)
☞
TRANSMITTABLE ORIGINAL SIZES (page 5-17)
5-58
Specifying the send size of the image
Specify the send size as a paper size. If a send size bigger than the scan size is selected, the image will be enlarged. If a send size smaller than the scan size is selected, the image will be reduced.
• The send size cannot be specified when [Long Size] is selected for the scan size, or when the scan size is specified by numerical values.
• The send size cannot be specified when [TIFF-S] is selected for the format in Internet fax mode. (The send size is fixed at
A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R).)
1
Select the mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Original] key.
☞
Touch the [Send Size] key.
Scan/Original OK
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
2
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
3
(1)
Scan/Original
Auto
Manual
A5
A5R
B5
216x340
Manual
B5R
A4
A4R
216x343
B4
A3
(2)
OK
Specify the send size.
(1) Touch the desired send size key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
AB
Inch
• Depending on the paper size specified for the "Scan Size", it may not be possible to select some sizes for the "Send
Size". Size keys that cannot be specified for the "Send Size" are greyed out to prevent selection.
• To specify an Inch size for the send size, touch the [AB Inch] key to highlight the [Inch] side and then specify the send size.
5-59
4
Scan/Original
Scan Size
Auto A4
141% Send Size
A3
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
(2)
OK
Specify the orientation in which the original is placed.
(1) Touch the appropriate [Image Orientation] key.
If this setting is not correct when sending an image with a changed ratio, a suitable image may not be transmitted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
(1)
The ratio used for reduction or enlargement of the original will appear between the "Scan Size" and the "Send Size".
5-60
CHANGING THE EXPOSURE AND ORIGINAL IMAGE
TYPE
The exposure and original image type can be set appropriately for the original to enable optimum scanning.
Refer the following tables to select appropriate settings.
How to select the exposure
Auto
Manual
Exposure
1-2
3
4-5
When to select
This setting automatically adjusts the exposure for light and dark parts of the original.
Select this setting when the original consists of dark text.
Select this setting for a normal original (neither dark nor light).
Select this setting when the original consists of faint text.
How to select the original image type (Scan mode, USB memory mode and Data entry mode)
Auto
Manual
Setting
Text/Prtd. Photo
Text/Photo
Text
Photo
Printed Photo
Map
Description
The original image type is automatically selected to match the original.
This mode provides the best balance for scanning an original which contains both text and printed photographs, such as a magazine or catalogue.
This mode provides the best balance for scanning an original which contains both text and photographs, such as a text document with a photo pasted on.
Use this mode for regular text documents.
Use this mode to scan photos.
This mode is best for scanning printed photographs, such as photos in a magazine or catalogue.
This mode is best for scanning the colour shading and fine details found on most maps.
1
Select the mode and display the exposure settings screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Exposure] key.
☞
When Fax/I-Fax address is included, exposure setting shared is selected, and Original Image Type is disabled.
Read the displayed message and touch the [OK] key.
This message does not appear in USB memory mode or
Internet fax mode. Go to the next step.
2 OK
If a broadcast transmission is performed that includes both scan mode destinations and Internet fax destinations, the exposure settings for Internet fax mode will have priority.
5-61
Scan mode, USB memory mode, Data entry mode
(2) (1) (3)
OK Scan/Exposure
Auto
Manual
1 3 5
Original Image Type
Text
Text/
Prtd.Photo
Printed
Photo
Photo
Text/Photo
Map
Moiré Reduction
3
Internet fax mode
(1)
Internet Fax/Exposure
(2) (3)
OK
Auto
Manual
1 3 5
Select the exposure and original image type.
(1) Select the original image type.
Touch the original image type key that matches the original image type.
(2) Adjust the exposure with the keys.
The exposure darkens when the and lightens when the
key is touched,
key is touched.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
(1) Touch the [Manual] key.
(2) Adjust the exposure with the keys.
The exposure darkens when the and lightens when the
key is touched,
key is touched.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
• In Internet fax mode, the original image type and moiré reduction cannot be selected.
• To reduce the occurrence of line patterns (moiré effect) when scanning printed matter, touch the [Moiré Reduction] checkbox so that a checkmark appears.
When using the document glass to scan multiple original pages, the exposure setting can be changed each time you change pages. When using the automatic document feeder, the exposure setting cannot be changed once scanning has begun.
(However, when "Job Build" is used in the special modes, the exposure can be changed each time a new set of originals is inserted.)
System Settings (Administrator): Default Exposure Settings
This is used to change the default exposure setting.
5-62
CHANGING THE RESOLUTION
The resolution setting can be selected.
1
Select the mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Resolution] key.
☞
Select the resolution.
(1) Touch the key of the desired resolution.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
Scan mode, USB memory mode, Data entry mode
(1) (2)
Scan/Resolution OK
100X100dpi
200X200dpi
300X300dpi
400X400dpi
600X600dpi
2
Internet fax mode
Internet Fax/Resolution
(1) (2)
OK
200X100dpi
200X200dpi
200X400dpi
400X400dpi
600X600dpi
Half Tone
In Internet fax mode, the [Half Tone] key can be touched to select halftone (except when [200X100dpi] is selected).
When the original has many gradations of light and dark such as a photo or colour illustration, halftone provides a more attractive image than regular transmission.
5-63
How to select the resolution
For normal text originals, 200X200dpi (200X100dpi in Internet fax mode) produces an image that is sufficiently legible.
For photos and illustrations, a high resolution setting (600X600dpi, etc.) will produce a sharp image. However, a high resolution setting will result in a large file, and if the file is too large, transmission may not be possible. In this event, reduce the number of pages scanned or take other measures to decrease the file size.
☞
☞
Specifying the send size of the image (page 5-59)
• When using the document glass to scan multiple original pages, the resolution setting can be changed each time you change pages. When using the automatic document feeder, the resolution setting cannot be changed once scanning has begun. (However, when "Job Build" is used in the special modes, the resolution can be changed each time a new set of originals is inserted.)
• When [TIFF-S] is selected for the format in Internet fax mode, only [200X100dpi] or [200X200dpi] can be selected.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Resolution Setting
This is used to change the default resolution setting.
CHANGING THE FILE FORMAT
Changing the format
(Scan mode, USB memory mode and Data entry mode)
The file format (file type and compression mode/compression ratio) for sending a scanned image can be changed at the time of transmission. In addition, if the scanned originals are divided into separate files, the number of pages per file can be changed.
The file format for sending a scanned image is specified when the destination is stored in a one-touch key; however, you can change the format at the time of transmission.
1
Select the mode and display the image settings screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [File Format] key.
☞
2
Select a file format to apply it to all scan destinations.
Read the displayed message and touch the [OK] key.
The message does not appear in USB memory mode. Go to the next step.
OK
5-64
3
(1)
Scan/File Format
File Type
Encry.
TIFF
XPS
Programmed
Specified Pages per File
(2)
OK
Compression Mode
None
MH (G3)
MMR (G4)
B/W
Colour/Grey
(1-99)
Set the format.
● Scanning in Mono2
(1) Select the file type.
To send a file using Encrypt PDF, touch the [Encry.] checkbox to select it ( ).
(2) Select the compression mode.
(2)
Scan/File Format
File Type
Encry.
TIFF
XPS
JPEG
Programmed
Specified Pages per File
(3) (1)
OK
Compression Ratio
Low
Medium
High
B/W
Colour/Grey
(1-99)
●
Scanning in colour/greyscale
(1) Touch the indicated key to select
[Colour/Grey] mode.
When [Colour/Grey] is highlighted, [Colour/Grey] mode is selected.
(2) Select the file type.
To send a file using Encrypt PDF, touch the [Encry.] checkbox to select it ( ).
(3) Select the compression ratio.
• High results in a smaller file size, however, the image quality is slightly degraded.
• When [High] is selected in the file format settings, the compression ratio cannot be selected.
• The [Programmed] key does not appear in USB memory mode.
• When this screen is displayed, the setting screen of [B/W] mode initially appears.
• The format setting for [B/W] mode is the file format that is used when the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed with the B/W mode set to [Mono2].
• The format setting for [Colour/Grey] mode is the file format that is used when the [COLOUR START] key is pressed, or when the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed with the B/W mode set to [Greyscale].
• The file type of [B/W] mode and the file type of [Colour/Grey] mode are linked. The file type cannot be set separately for each. (When [JPEG] is selected for [Colour/Grey] mode, [TIFF] is automatically selected for [B/W] mode.)
5-65
4
(3)
Scan/File Format
File Type
Encry.
TIFF
XPS
JPEG
Programmed
Specified Pages per File
Compression Ratio
Low
Medium
High
1
(1-99)
OK
B/W
Colour/Grey
(1) (2)
To change the number of pages per file, enter the number of pages and exit the format settings.
(1) Touch the [Specified Pages per File] checkbox so that a checkmark appears.
(2) Set the number of pages per file with the
keys.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
• When a checkmark does not appear in the [Specified Pages per File] checkbox , one file is created for all scanned pages.
• When [Specified Pages per File] is selected, consecutive numbers are added to the created file names.
• When [JPEG] is selected for the file type, one file is created for each page (a file cannot be created for multiple pages). For this reason, the [Specified Pages per File] checkbox does not appear.
• When the file format is set to Encrypt PDF ([PDF] is selected in the format settings screen and the [Encry.] checkbox is set to ), a screen prompting you to enter a password will appear when the [START] key is pressed to start scan send transmission.
• Touch the [Entry] key in the displayed screen to open the keyboard screen. Enter a password (maximum of 32 characters) and touch the [OK] key. Scanning and transmission will begin.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial File Format Setting
This sets the default file format setting for scanner transmission.
5-66
Changing the format (Internet fax mode)
The file format for sending an Internet fax is normally set to [TIFF-F]. If the destination Internet fax machine does not support full mode (it only supports simple mode), follow the steps below to select [TIFF-S].
1
Switch to Internet fax mode and display the file format settings screen.
(1) Touch the [Internet Fax] tab.
(2) Touch the [File Format] key.
☞
2
Internet Fax/File Format
(1)
TIFF-S
File Type
TIFF-F
Compression Mode
MH (G3)
MMR (G4)
(2)
OK
Select the file format.
(1) Touch the key of the desired format.
If you selected [TIFF-F], select the compression mode.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
When [TIFF-S] is selected, the transmission settings are restricted as follows:
• Resolution: The selections are [200X100dpi] and [200X200dpi]. If [TIFF-S] is selected after [200X400dpi],
[400X400dpi] or [600X600dpi] is selected, the resolution automatically changes to [200X200dpi].
• Send size: Always A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R). If [TIFF-S] is selected after the send size is changed, the send size is automatically changed to A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R). If a size larger than A4 (8-1/2" x 11") is scanned, the size will automatically be reduced to A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R). When this format is included in a broadcast transmission, the image will be transmitted to all destinations at A4R (8-1/2" x 11"R).
• Special modes: When a ratio setting is selected and the original size is entered, Dual Page Scan, Card Shot, 2in1, and
Mixed Size Original cannot be used.
System Settings (Administrator): Compression Setting
This is used to set the default compression mode for Internet fax transmission.
5-67
CHANGING THE COLOUR MODE
This procedure is used to change the colour mode used to scan the original when the [COLOUR START] key or the
[BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed.
This function cannot be used in Internet fax mode.
Start key Mode
[COLOUR START] key
Auto
Full Colour
[BLACK & WHITE
START] key
Mono2
Greyscale
Scanning method
The machine detects whether the original is colour or black and white and automatically selects full colour or black and white (Mono2 or Greyscale) scanning.
The original is scanned in full colour. This mode is best for full colour originals such as catalogues.
Colours in the original are scanned as black or white. This mode is best for text-only originals.
The colours in the original are scanned in black and white as shades of grey (greyscale).
1
Select the mode and display the colour mode settings screen.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Colour Mode] key.
☞
2
Scan/Colour Mode
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Auto
B/W Mode
(1)
Mono2
(2)
Mono2
Greyscale
Greyscale
OK
(3)
Select the colour mode.
(1) Touch the key of the mode to be used when the [COLOUR START] key is pressed.
You can select whether black & white scanning will take place in Mono2 or greyscale when [Auto] is selected and a black and white original is scanned. Note that if the file format is set to JPEG, scanning will take place in greyscale.
(2) Touch the key of the mode to be used when the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
• System Settings (Administrator): Default Colour Mode Settings
The default colour mode can be changed.
• System Settings (Administrator): Disable Change of B/W Setting in Auto Mode
This prohibits selection of the black and white original scanning setting when [Auto] is selected for the colour mode.
5-68
CHECKING THE IMAGE TO BE
TRANSMITTED (Preview)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
If you touch the [Preview] key before scanning the original, you can check the scanned image in the touch panel before sending the image.
* The factory default setting is disabled.
Depending on the size of the transmission data, part of the preview image may not appear in the preview screen in the touch panel.
1
Place the original.
Place the original in the document feeder tray or on the document glass as appropriate for the functions stored in the program.
Touch the [Preview] key to highlight it.
2
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Resolution Send Settings
Address Review
File
File Format
Colour Mode
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Auto/Greyscale
A4 Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Quick File Special Modes
Preview
3
Select transmission settings and touch the [COLOUR START] key or the
[BLACK & WHITE START] key.
"Originals are being read" appears while the originals are being scanned, and when scanning is finished, the preview screen appears on the touch panel. Transmission will not take place until you touch the [Start Sending] key in the preview screen.
4
Preview
B/W
Function Rev.
Check the preview image and then touch the [Start Sending] key.
Transmission begins.
For information on the preview screen, see "
Display Rotation
Start
Sending
0001 /0010
System settings (administrator): Default Preview
You can specify whether or not the [Preview] key function will be enabled in the base screens of the image send modes and in the address book.
5-69
PREVIEW CHECK SCREEN
This section explains the preview check screen.
Preview
B/W
Sender Info
Function Rev.
(3)
(4)
(1)
Display Rotation
Start
Sending
(5)
(6)
(7)
0001 /0010
(2)
(1) Preview image
A preview of the scanned original appears.
If the image is cut off, use the scroll bars at the right and bottom of the screen to scroll the image. Touch a bar and slide it to scroll. (You can also touch the keys to scroll.)
(2) Change page keys
•
•
When there are multiple pages, use these keys to change pages.
keys: Go to the first or the last page.
keys: Go to the previous page or the next page.
• Page number display:
This shows the total number of pages and the current page number. You can touch the current page number key and enter a number with the numeric keys to go to that page number.
(3) [Sender Info] key
When Internet fax mode is selected, touch to display the sender information for I-fax own address send.
This key can only be touched when the entire preview image is displayed in the preview screen.
(4) [Function Rev.] key
Touch to check special mode settings or scan settings for two-sided originals.
(5) Display zoom key
Use this to set the zoom ratio of the displayed image.
Changes from the left in the order "Full Page", "Twice",
"4 Times", "8 Times". The setting applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(6) "Display Rotation" key
This rotates the image right or left by 90 degrees. The rotation applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(7) [Start Sending] key
Touch to begin transmission.
• A preview image is an image for display on the touch panel. It will differ from the actual print result.
• The preview image reflects certain scanning and special mode settings.
Settings reflected in the preview image are as follows:
Scanning settings: Original
Special modes: Erase, Dual Page Scan, Card Shot, 2in1, Blank Page Skip
5-70
SPECIAL MODES
This section explains special modes that can be used in scan send mode.
SPECIAL MODES
When the [Special Modes] key is touched in the base screen, the special modes menu screen appears. The special modes menu consists of two screens. Touch the key to switch between the two screens. When the [OK] key is touched in the special modes screen, the selected settings are entered and the base screen reappears.
☞
Scan mode, USB memory mode, Data entry mode
1st screen 2nd screen
OK Scan/Special Modes
(1)
(4)
(7)
(10)
(2) (3)
Program Erase
Dual Page
Scan
Timer
Job
Build
(5)
Suppress
Background
(8)
Original
Count
(11)
(6)
Card Shot
Mixed Size
Original
File
(9)
Slow Scan
Mode
(12)
Quick File
OK
1
2
Scan/Special Modes
(13)
Verif.
Stamp
(14)
Blank Page
Skip
2
2
(1) [Program] key* 1, 2
☞
STORING SCAN OPERATIONS (Programs) (page 5-73)
(2) [Erase] key
☞
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS ON THE
(3) [Dual Page Scan] key
☞
SCANNING AN ORIGINAL AS TWO SEPARATE
PAGES (Dual Page Scan) (page 5-77)
(4) [Timer] key* 1
☞
SENDING AN IMAGE AT A SPECIFIED TIME
(Timer Transmission) (page 5-79)
(5) [Suppress Background] key
☞
WHITENING FAINT COLOURS IN THE IMAGE
(Suppress Background) (page 5-81)
(6) [Card Shot] key
☞
SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD ONTO A
SINGLE PAGE (Card Shot) (page 5-83)
(7) [Job Build] key
☞
SCANNING MANY ORIGINALS AT ONCE (Job
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(8) [Mixed Size Original] key
☞
SCANNING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT SIZES
(Mixed Size Original) (page 5-88)
*1 Does not appear in USB memory mode and when the hard disk drive is not installed.
*2 Does not appear in data entry mode.
*3 Does not appear when the automatic document feeder and stamp unit are not installed.
In USB memory mode, this appears in the 1st screen.
5-71
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(9) [Slow Scan Mode] key
☞
SCANNING THIN ORIGINALS (Slow Scan Mode)
When the document cover is installed, this key is not displayed.
(10) [Original Count] key* 1
☞
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
ORIGINAL SHEETS BEFORE TRANSMISSION
(11) [File] key* 1
Touch this to use the File function of document filing mode.
This function requires the hard disk drive.
(12) [Quick File] key* 1
Touch this to use the Quick File function of document filing mode.
This function requires the hard disk drive.
(13) [Verif. Stamp] key* 3
☞
STAMPING SCANNED ORIGINALS (Verif. Stamp)
(14) [Blank Page Skip] key
☞
ELIMINATING BLANK PAGES FROM A TRANSMISSION
Internet fax mode
The keys explained below can only be used in Internet fax mode. The other keys are the same as those explained in
" Scan mode, USB memory mode, Data entry mode " (page 5-71).
1st screen 2nd screen
Internet Fax/Special Modes OK OK Internet Fax/Special Modes
Verif.
Stamp
(2)
Transaction
Report
Program Erase
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
(1)
2in1
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
1
2
2
2
(1) [2in1] key
☞
SENDING TWO PAGES AS A SINGLE PAGE (2in1)
(2) [Transaction Report] key
☞
CHANGING THE PRINT SETTINGS FOR THE
TRANSACTION REPORT (Transaction Report)
Special modes can generally be combined with other special modes, however, there are some combinations that are not possible. If a prohibited combination is selected, a message will appear in the touch panel.
[OK] key and [Cancel] key
In some cases two [OK] keys and one [Cancel] key will appear in the special mode screens. The keys are used as follows:
Scan/Special Modes
Erase Cancel
OK
OK
(A)
(B)
(C)
Edge
Erase
Centre
Erase
Edge+Centre
Erase
Edge
10
(0~20) mm
Side Erase
(A) Enter the selected special mode setting and return to the base screen.
(B) Enter the selected special mode setting and return to the special mode menu screen. Touch this key when you wish to continue selecting other special mode settings.
(C) During selection of special mode settings, this key returns you to the special mode menu screen without saving the settings. When settings have been completed, this cancels the settings and returns you to the special mode menu screen.
5-72
STORING SCAN OPERATIONS (Programs)
A destination, original settings, and functions can be stored in a program. When you wish to use those settings to send an image, they can be retrieved with ease.
For example, suppose A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size documents are scanned into a file and sent to each branch office once a month.
(1) The same documents are sent to each branch office
(2) Each page of a bound document is successively transmitted
(3) Smudges on the edges of the documents are erased before transmission
When a job program is not stored
Enter the address of each branch office.
When a job program is stored
Touch a stored program key.
Select Dual Page Scan
Select Erase settings
Press the [START] key.
The originals are scanned and transmitted.
Press the [START] key.
The originals are scanned and transmitted.
Considerable time is required to send the documents each month because the above settings must be selected.
In addition, mistakes may occasionally be made when selecting the settings, so incorrect transmissions may occur.
When a program is used, settings are selected with ease by simply pressing the stored key.
In addition, transmission takes place based on the stored settings so there are no chances for mistakes.
• Programs are stored, edited, and deleted using "Address Control" in the system settings. See "
" (page
7-21) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS".
• Programs can also be stored in the Web pages. Click [Job Programs] and then [Image Send] in the Web page menu.
• The settings stored in a program will be retained even after the program is used for transmission. The same settings can be used repeatedly for transmission.
• The following settings can be stored in programs.
Image send mode: Scan, Internet fax
Destinations
Image settings: Original scan size, original orientation, duplex scanning, exposure, resolution
Special modes: Erase, Dual Page Scan, Suppress Background, Job Build, Mixed Size Original, Slow Scan Mode, Original
Count, Verif. Stamp, Blank Page Skip, 2in1
• Up to 48 programs can be stored.
• Up to 500 destinations can be stored in one program.
• This function cannot be used in USB memory mode or data entry mode.
1
Place the original.
Place the original in the document feeder tray or on the document glass as appropriate for the functions stored in the program.
5-73
2
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(2) Touch the [Program] key.
☞
(1) (2)
OK
3
Program
Program 1
Program 3
Program 5
Program 7
Program 9
Program 11
Program 2
Program 4
Program 6
Program 8
Program 10
Program 12
1
2
Retrieve the stored program.
(1) Touch the desired program key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
4
Program:Program 1 [email protected]
Scan Internet Fax
Original
Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
File
Quick File
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Auto/Greyscale
A4 Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Preview
Select additional settings.
When a program is used, the following settings can be additionally specified:
• Image Settings: Original scan size*, send size, file format, colour mode
• Send settings
• Special modes: Timer Transmission, Card Shot, File, Quick
File, Transaction Report
* When stored in the program, this cannot be additionally specified.
• The screen that appears will vary depending on the destination stored in the program.
• The mode cannot be changed here.
• Functions stored in the program cannot be cancelled here.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
5-74
ERASING PERIPHERAL SHADOWS ON THE
IMAGE (Erase)
The erase function is used to erase shadows on images produced when scanning thick originals or books. (This function erases the parts of the image where shadows tend to form. The function does not detect shadows and erase only the shadows.)
Scanning a thick book
Not using the erase function
Using the erase function
Shadows appear here
Erase modes
Edge Erase Centre Erase
Shadows appear in the image.
No shadows appear.
Edge + Centre Erase Side Erase
• Shadows at the edges of the original can also be erased when the automatic document feeder is used.
• When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(3) Touch the [Erase] key.
☞
5-75
4
Scan/Special Modes
Erase
(1)
Edge
Erase
Centre
Erase
Edge+Centre
Erase
Side Erase
Cancel
(2) (3)
OK
OK
Edge
10
(0~20) mm
Select the erase settings.
(1) Touch the desired erase mode.
Select one of the 4 erase modes.
Touch the [Side Erase] key to open the following screen.
Erase
Side Erase
Up
Cancel OK
Erase position for Original Side 2
Left Right
Same Side as
Side 1
Different Side from Side 1
Down
Touch the checkbox of the edge that you wish to erase and make sure that a checkmark ( ) appears.
When performing two-sided scanning, set the erase edge on the reverse side.
• If you touch the [Same Side as Side 1] key, the edge in the same position as on the front side will be erased.
• If you touch the [Different Side from Side 1], the edge in the position opposite to the erased edge on the front side will be erased.
When you have completed the settings, touch the [OK] key.
keys.
(2) Set the erasure width with the
0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 1") can be entered.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning of one page finishes, replace it with the next page and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then press the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
If the destination is an Internet fax destination, press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
When the erase function is used, erase takes place at the edges of the original image. If you also use a reduction or an enlargement setting, the erase width will change according to the selected ratio. For example, if the erase width setting is
20 mm (1") and the image is reduced to 50%, the erase width will be 10 mm (1/2").
To cancel the erase setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
System Settings (Administrator): Erase Width Adjustment
The default erase width setting is linked to the copy mode system setting, and can be set from 0 mm to 20 mm (0" to 1"). The factory default setting is 10 mm (1/2").
5-76
SCANNING AN ORIGINAL AS TWO
SEPARATE PAGES (Dual Page Scan)
The left and right sides of an original can be scanned as two separate pages. This function is useful when you wish to successively scan each page of a book or other bound document.
Example: Scanning the left and right pages of a book
1
Book or bound document
The pages are scanned as two separate pages.
Example:
Original scan size
A3 (11" x 17") x 1 page
Transmitted image
A4 (8-1/2" x 11") x 2 pages
• When using dual page scan, the original must be placed on the document glass.
• The send size cannot be changed.
• When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
Place the original face down on the document glass.
Align the centre of the original with the appropriate size mark .
Size mark
Centreline of
A3 original
Centreline of
11" x 17" original
The page on this side is scanned first.
Centreline of original
A3
(11" x 17")
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
5-77
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
Select Dual Page Scan.
(1) Press the [Dual Page Scan] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
4
(1)
Scan/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
Erase
Suppress
Background
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(2)
OK
1
2
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
If the destination is an Internet fax destination, press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• To erase shadows caused by the binding of a book or other bound document, use the erase function. (Note, however, that
"Centre Erase" and "Edge + Centre Erase" cannot be used.)
• When the scan size of the original is specified by numerical values, this function cannot be used.
To cancel the dual page scan setting...
Touch the [Dual Page Scan] key in the screen of step 4 so that it is no longer highlighted, and touch the [OK] key.
5-78
SENDING AN IMAGE AT A SPECIFIED TIME
(Timer Transmission)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
This function lets you specify a time at which a transmission or broadcast transmission will automatically take place.
Transmission begins automatically at the specified time.
Set a transmission to take place at 20:00
At 20:00, the transmission begins automatically
• When a timer transmission is stored, keep the main power switch in the "on" position. If the main power switch is in the "off" position at the specified time, transmission will not take place.
• When performing a timer transmission, you must scan the original into memory when you set up the transmission. It is not possible to leave the document in the auto document feeder or on the document glass and have it scanned at the specified time of transmission.
• Settings selected for a timer transmission (exposure, resolution, special modes, etc.) are automatically cleared after the transmission is finished. (However, when the document filing function is used, the scanned original and settings are stored on the built-in hard drive.)
• This function cannot be used in USB memory mode.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(3) Touch the [Timer] key.
☞
5-79
4
Scan/Special Modes
Timer
(1) (2)
Cancel
Day of the Week Time
10 hh.
00 mm.
(3)
OK
OK
Set the time with the keys.
(1) Specify the day.
If you do not wish to specify a day, select [---]. In this case, transmission will begin when the time specified in
(2) arrives.
(2) Specify the time (hour, minute)
Select the time in 24-hour format.
You can also directly touch a numeric display key to change the setting with the numeric keys.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
When this screen is opened, the setting will show the current time. If the time is not correct, press the [CLEAR ALL] key
( ) to cancel the operation. Correct the time in the system settings and then perform the timer transmission procedure.
☞
CHECKING THE DATE AND TIME (page 5-5)
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If the destination is an Internet fax destination, press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
• The original is scanned into memory. The original cannot be scanned at a specified time.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• The time can be specified up to a week in advance.
• Up to 94 timer transmissions can be stored at once.
• If another transmission is in progress when the specified time arrives, the timer transmission will begin after that transmission is finished.
• Other transmissions can be performed as usual after a timer transmission is stored.
• A timer transmission can be deleted in the job status screen.
• If a timer transmission is given priority in the job status screen, the time specification is cancelled. The transmission will begin as soon as the job in progress is completed.
☞
GIVING PRIORITY TO A SCAN TRANSMISSION JOB (page 5-110)
To cancel timer transmission...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
5-80
WHITENING FAINT COLOURS IN THE IMAGE
(Suppress Background)
This feature is used to suppress light background areas.
Level [+]
The lightness level at which suppression takes place can be adjusted.
Level [-]
• This function cannot be used in Internet fax mode.
• When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(3) Touch the [Suppress Background] key.
Read the message that appears and then touch the [OK] key.
☞
5-81
4
(1)
Scan/Special Modes
Suppress Background
Cancel
Light areas of the original may be suppressed as background.
(2)
OK
OK
1 3
Select the suppress background setting.
(1) Adjust the background suppression level.
Touch the [+] key to suppress only faint background.
Touch the [-] key to suppress faint to dark background.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
When the colour mode setting of the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is [Mono2], the suppress background function will not operate if the [BLACK & WHITE START] key is pressed.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
To cancel the background suppression setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
5-82
SCANNING BOTH SIDES OF A CARD ONTO
A SINGLE PAGE (Card Shot)
This function lets you send the front and reverse sides of a card as a single page, without the need to send each side separately.
Scanned image
Originals
Transmission
Front
Back
Example of an A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size portrait scan transmission
Example of an A4 (8-1/2" x 11") size landscape scan transmission
• When using card shot, the original must be placed on the document glass.
• When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
Place the original face down on the document glass.
1
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(3) Touch the [Card Shot] key.
☞
5-83
4
Scan/Special Modes
Card Shot
(1) (A)
Cancel
(B) (2)
OK
OK
X
Y
86
(25~210) mm
54
(25~210) mm
Fit to
Send Size
Size Reset
Specify the original size.
(1) Enter the original size.
• Touch the X (width) numeric value display key and enter the width.
• Touch the Y (height) numeric value display key and enter the height.
(A) To return the original size to the default size, touch the
[Size Reset] key.
(B) To automatically enlarge or reduce the image to fit the send size, touch the [Fit to Send Size] key. If you wish to scan the original at the entered original size, there is no need to touch this key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
Y
X
• You can also touch the keys to change the number.
• The send size will be selected automatically based on the entered original size.
• After selecting Card Shot, you can touch the [Original] key in the base screen to change the original scan size or the send size. In this case, the screen of this step appears when you touch the scan size key. For the procedure for
setting the send size, see " Specifying the send size of the image " (page 5-59).
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to scan the front side of the card.
If the destination is an Internet fax destination, press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
6
Turn the card over and press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key to scan the reverse side of the card.
Press the same [START] key that was used to scan the front side.
Before scanning the back of the card, you can touch the [Configure] key in the touch panel to change the exposure.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
5-84
7
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Place next original. (Pg.No.x)
Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Configure Read-End
If you will continue by scanning the front of the card, you can touch the [Configure] key to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size.
The ratio cannot be specified and "Rotation Sending Setting" cannot be selected.
To cancel Card Shot...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
5-85
SCANNING MANY ORIGINALS AT ONCE
(Job Build)
This function requires the automatic document feeder to be installed.
This function lets you separate an original consisting of numerous pages into sets, scan each set using the automatic document feeder, and transmit the pages in a single transmission. Use this function when the number of originals that you wish to scan exceeds the maximum number of sheets that can be inserted in the automatic document feeder at once.
When scanning originals that are separated into sets, scan the set that has the first page first. The settings that you select for the first set can be used for all remaining sets.
Originals
Originals are scanned in separate sets.
Transmission
1
1 1
101
• Up to 999 pages can be scanned. Note that when the memory is being used for other jobs, fewer pages can be scanned.
• When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
1
Indicator line
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
5-86
4
(1)
Scan/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
Erase
Suppress
Background
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(2)
OK
1
2
Select job build mode.
(1) Touch the [Job Build] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key to scan the first set of originals.
If the destination is an Internet fax destination, press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
6
Insert the next set of originals and press the [COLOUR START] key or the
[BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Press the [START] key pressed in step 5.
Repeat until all originals have been scanned.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation. All scanned data will be cleared.
Touch the [Read-End] key.
Place next original. (Pg.No.x)
Press [Start].
When finished, press [Read-End].
Configure Read-End
7
• If no action is taken for one minute after the confirmation screen appears, scanning automatically ends and the transmission is reserved.
• The [Configure] key can be touched to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size for each original page scanned. However, when Job Build is used in combination with "2in1" in the special modes, only the exposure can be changed when scanning each even-numbered page of the original pages.
If the memory becomes full during scanning, a message will appear and the transmission will be cancelled.
To cancel the job build function....
Touch the [Job Build] key in the screen of step 4 so that it is not highlighted.
5-87
SCANNING ORIGINALS OF DIFFERENT
SIZES (Mixed Size Original)
This function requires the automatic document feeder to be installed.
This feature lets you scan originals of different sizes at the same time; for example, B4 (8-1/2" x 14") size originals mixed together with A3 (11" x 17") size originals. When scanning the originals, the machine automatically detects the size of each original.
Originals
(B4 (8-1/2" x 14") original mixed in with A3 (11" x 17") originals)
Files created
1st page 2nd to 4th pages
B4
A3
B4
Scanned in at
B4 (8-1/2" x 14") size
A3
Scanned in at
A3 (11" x 17") size
This feature can only be used with the following combinations of original sizes:
• A3 and B4
• A4R and B5
• A3 and B5
• B4 and A4R
• 11" x 17" and 8-1/2" x 14"
• B4 and A4
• B4 and A5
• A4 and B5
• B5 and A5
• 11" x 17" and 8-1/2" x 13" • 11" x 17" and 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
1 B4
(8-1/2" x 14")
Place the originals with the corners aligned together in the far left corner.
B4
(8-1/2" x 14")
A3 (11" x 17")
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals with the corners aligned together in the far left corner of the document feeder tray.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
5-88
4
(1)
Scan/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
Erase
Suppress
Background
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(2)
OK
1
2
Select the mixed size original setting.
(1) Touch the [Mixed Size Original] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
If an original scan size has been specified, a message will appear when the [Mixed Size Original] key is touched. To enable the Mixed Size Original setting, change the scan size setting to auto and then touch the [Mixed Size Original] key again.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins. A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
If the destination is an Internet fax destination, press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• Once mixed size originals has been selected, an original scan size cannot be specified.
• When mixed size originals are set, automatic duplex scanning cannot be used.
• Rotate cannot be used when Mixed Size Original is enabled.
To cancel the Mixed Size Original setting...
Touch the [Mixed Size Original] key in the screen of step 4 so that it is not highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Original Feeding Mode
The original feeding mode can be set to always scan mixed size originals.
5-89
SCANNING THIN ORIGINALS
(Slow Scan Mode)
This function requires the automatic document feeder to be installed.
Use this function when you wish to scan thin originals using the automatic document feeder. This function helps prevent thin originals from misfeeding.
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Adjust the original guides slowly.
1
If the originals are inserted with too much force, they may crumple and misfeed.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
5-90
4
Scan/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
Erase
Suppress
Background
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(1) (2)
OK
1
2
Select slow scan mode.
(1) Touch the [Slow Scan Mode] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins. A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
If the destination is an Internet fax destination, press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• When this function is selected, automatic 2-sided scanning is not possible.
• Rotate cannot be used when Mixed Size Original is enabled.
To cancel slow scan mode...
Touch the [Slow Scan Mode] key in the screen of step 4 so that it is not highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Original Feeding Mode
This is used to have scanning always take place in slow scan mode.
5-91
CHECKING THE NUMBER OF SCANNED
ORIGINAL SHEETS BEFORE TRANSMISSION
(Original Count)
The number of scanned original sheets can be counted and displayed before transmission. Checking the number of scanned original sheets before transmission helps prevent transmission mistakes.
• This function cannot be used in USB memory mode.
• The setting can be enabled separately for each mode.
1
Indicator line
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
Insert the originals all the way into the document feeder tray.
Multiple originals can be placed in the document feeder tray.
The stack of originals must not be higher than the indicator line on the tray.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
Select the original count function.
(1) Touch the [Original Count] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
4
(1)
Scan/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
Erase
Suppress
Background
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(2)
OK
1
2
5-92
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation. All scanned data will be cleared.
6
(A)
XX pages of original have been scanned. (P.x)
Send the scanned data?
Cancel
(B)
OK
When scanning ends, check the number of original sheets scanned and touch the
[OK] key.
Transmission will begin.
• When Job Build mode is used, the confirmation message will appear after the [Read-End] key is touched.
• The message on the screen shows the number of sheets scanned in (A), and the number of pages (sheet sides) scanned in (B). For example, if both sides of one original sheet are scanned, "1" will appear in (A) and "2" will appear in (B).
If this step is not performed for one minute while the above confirmation screen appears, the scanned image and settings will be cleared and the base screen will reappear. Scanning will not be completed automatically and the image will not be reserved for transmission.
If the displayed number of original sheets is different from the actual number of sheets...
Touch the [Cancel] key and then touch the [OK] key in the message screen to clear all scanned data. Scan settings and destination settings will not be cleared. Insert the original sheets in the automatic document feeder again and press the [START] key to re-scan.
When a broadcast transmission is performed, if the original count function is selected in any of the modes, the function will operate for all destinations.
To cancel the Original Sheet Count function...
Touch the [Original Count] key in the screen of step 4 so that it is no longer highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Initial Original Count Setting
This can be enabled to have the number of original sheets always counted. The setting can be enabled separately for each mode.
5-93
STAMPING SCANNED ORIGINALS (Verif. Stamp)
This function stamps each original that is scanned using the automatic document feeder, allowing you to verify that all originals were correctly scanned.
Position of stamp
1
Originals
Originals are scanned
1
An "O" mark is stamped in fluorescent pink.
• To use this function, the automatic document feeder and optional stamp unit must be installed.
• When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
1
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
5-94
4
(2)
Scan/Special Modes
Verif.
Stamp
Blank Page
Skip
(1) (3)
OK
Select "Verif. Stamp".
(1) Touch the screens.
keys to switch through the
(2) Touch the [Verif. Stamp] key so that it is highlighted.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins. A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• When two-sided originals are used, the front of each original is stamped twice.
• If an error occurs during scanning, an original that was not scanned may be stamped.
• When the "O" mark that is stamped on originals starts to become faint, replace the stamp cartridge. For the procedure for replacing the stamp cartridge, see "
REPLACING THE STAMP CARTRIDGE " (page 1-66) in "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE".
To cancel the stamp function...
Touch the [Verif. Stamp] key in the screen of step 4 so that it is no longer highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Default Verification Stamp
This setting is used to always have originals stamped.
5-95
ELIMINATING BLANK PAGES FROM A
TRANSMISSION (Blank Page Skip)
When blank pages are included in originals scanned using the automatic document feeder, the blank pages can be detected and automatically eliminated from transmission.
Blank pages are not sent
Blank pages
Send
1
• This function requires the automatic document feeder.
• This function cannot be used in Internet fax mode.
• Depending on the original, some pages that are not blank may be detected as blank pages and thus not sent, and some pages that are blank may not be detected as blank and thus sent.
• When using USB memory mode, connect the USB memory device to the machine before performing the procedure below.
Insert the originals face up in the document feeder tray.
This function cannot be used when the document glass is used for scan send.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
When scanning to USB memory, there is no need to specify the destination. Go to step 3.
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the tab of the mode that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(3) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(4) Touch the [Blank Page Skip] key.
☞
5-96
4
Scan/Special Modes
Blank Page Skip
Skip Blank Page
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
OK
Skip Blank and Back Shadow
Set blank page skipping.
(1) Select the type of blank page to be skipped.
Select from two types.
To include blank pages on which the content on the opposite side shows through, touch [Skip Blank and Back
Shadow].
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
5
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins. A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
6
(A) (B)
(C)
XX pages of original have (P.x) been scanned.
YY sheets of original will be Perform the job?
Cancel OK
When scanning is completed, check the number of original sheets and the number of sheets to be sent, and touch
[OK].
Scanning begins.
• When Job Build mode is used, the confirmation message will appear after the [Read-End] key is touched.
• The number of scanned original sheets appears in (A), the number of scanned sides in (B), and the number of sheets to be sent excluding blank pages in (C). For example, if five original sheets that include two blank pages are scanned by duplex scanning, (A) will show "5", (B) will show "10", and (C) will show "8".
If this step is not performed for one minute while the above confirmation screen appears, the scanned image and settings will be cleared and the base screen will reappear. Scanning will not be completed automatically and the image will not be reserved for transmission.
When "Default Preview" is enabled in the system settings (administrator) and the skip blank pages function is used to scan original pages, you can check the pages, including the blank pages, in the preview screen. For more information, see
"
PREVIEW CHECK SCREEN " (page 5-70).
To cancel the Blank Page Skip function...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4 so that it is no longer highlighted.
System settings (administrator): Original Feeding Mode
Use this setting to always skip blank pages when sending.
5-97
SENDING TWO PAGES AS A SINGLE PAGE
(2in1)
Two original pages can be reduced to half their original size and sent together as a single page.
Portrait-oriented originals
Transmission
1 2
1 2
Landscape-oriented originals
Transmission
1 2
1
2
This function cannot be used in scan mode, USB memory mode, or data entry mode.
1
Place the original.
When placing the originals, orient them as shown below.
Originals
Document feeder tray
Place the originals face up.
Portrait orientation
1
1 2
Landscape orientation
1 2
1
Document glass
Place the originals face down.
1
1
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
5-98
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Internet Fax] tab.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
☞
4
(1)
Internet Fax/Special Modes
Program
Timer
Job
Build
Original
Count
Erase
2in1
Mixed Size
Original
File
Dual Page
Scan
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode
Quick File
(2)
OK
1
2
Select 2in1.
(1) Touch the [2in1] key so that it is highlighted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
5
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Send Settings
Address Review
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution 200X100dpi
File Format TIFF-F
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
A4 Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Special Modes File
Quick File
Preview
I-Fax Manual
Reception
Touch the [Original] key.
6
Internet Fax/Original
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Send Size
Auto
Image Orientation
(2)
OK
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
(1)
Specify the orientation in which the original is placed.
(1) Touch the "Image Orientation" key with the same orientation as the original image.
If this setting is not correct, a suitable image may not be transmitted.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
5-99
7
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
The [Configure] key can be touched in the scan-end confirmation screen to change the exposure, resolution, scan size, and send size. (However, when scanning each even-numbered page of the original, only the exposure can be changed.)
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
• Transmission is not possible at a size smaller than the original size.
• The 2in1 function cannot be used when the original is other than A4, B5, or A5 (8-1/2" x 11" or 5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size.
• When the scan size of the original is specified by numerical values, this function cannot be used.
To cancel 2in1...
Touch the [2in1] key in the screen of step 4 so that it is not highlighted.
5-100
CHANGING THE PRINT SETTINGS FOR THE
TRANSACTION REPORT
(Transaction Report)
A transaction report is automatically printed out to alert you when an Internet fax transmission fails or when a broadcast transmission is performed. The transaction report contains a description of the transmission (date, start time, name of other party, time required, number of pages, result, etc.).
☞
INFORMATION APPEARING IN THE RESULT COLUMN (page 5-111)
This function cannot be used in scan mode, USB memory mode, or data entry mode.
Transaction reports are printed based on conditions set in the system settings; however, you can temporarily select different conditions for a transmission. To change the transaction report print conditions at the time of transmission, follow the steps below.
1
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
2
Specify the destination.
☞
ENTERING DESTINATIONS (page 5-18)
3
Select the special modes.
(1) Touch the [Internet Fax] tab.
(2) Touch the [Special Modes] key.
(3) Touch the keys to switch through the screens.
(4) Touch the [Transaction Report] key.
☞
Internet Fax/Special Modes
Transaction Report
(1)
Cancel
(2)
OK
OK
Select print conditions.
(1) Select the print conditions.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
Always Print
Print Original Image
Print at Error Do not Print
4
• The print conditions for a transaction report are as follows:
"Always Print": A transaction report is printed no matter whether the transmission succeeds or fails.
"Print at Error": A transaction report is printed when transmission fails.
"Do not Print": Do not print a transaction report.
• When the [Print Original Image] checkbox is selected , part of the transmitted original is included on the transaction report.
5-101
5
Press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
Scanning begins.
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
• If you are scanning the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning finishes, place the next original and press the [BLACK & WHITE START] key. Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then touch the [Read-End] key.
A beep will sound to indicate that scanning is finished.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ) to cancel the operation.
For a broadcast transmission, changes to the transaction report print conditions apply to all destinations.
To cancel the transaction report setting...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 4.
• System Settings (Administrator): Transaction Report Print Select Setting
This is used to set the conditions for printing transaction reports.
The factory default setting is
Single Sending: Print Out All Report/
.
Print Out Error Report Only
Broadcasting:
Receiving:
/No Printed Report
Print Out All Report /Print Out Error Report Only/No Printed Report
Print Out All Report/Print Out Error Report Only/
No Printed Report
• System Settings (Administrator): Original Print on Transaction Report
This is used to have part of the transmitted original printed on the transaction report.
5-102
CHECKING THE STATUS OF
TRANSMISSION/RECEPTION JOBS
This section explains how to check the status of reserved transmission jobs and received Internet faxes.
JOB STATUS SCREEN
The job status screen is displayed when the [JOB STATUS] key on the operation panel is pressed. The job status screen shows the status of jobs by mode. When the [JOB STATUS] key is pressed, the job status screen of the mode that was being used before the key was pressed appears.
Reserved transmissions and received Internet faxes are referred to as jobs here.
Example: Pressing the tab in scan mode
JOB STATUS
2
3
1
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Set Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
4
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
CCC CCC
10:05 04/01 000/001 Waiting
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting
1
1
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
The job status display is in the lower left corner of the touch panel. The job status display can be touched to display the job status screen.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Resolution Send Settings
Address Review
File
File Format
Colour Mode
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Text
Auto/Greyscale
Send:
Mono2
PC Scan
Auto
Quick File Special Modes
Preview
Sending
5-103
JOB QUEUE SCREEN AND COMPLETED JOB SCREEN
The job status screen consists of two screens: the job queue screen that shows reserved jobs and the job currently in progress, and the completed jobs screen. To switch between the two screens, touch the job status screen selector key
((2) below).
Job queue screen
(1)
2
3
4
1
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Set Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
CCC CCC
10:05 04/01 000/001 Waiting
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting
1
1
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Complete screen
(1)
Print Job
Address
Broadcast0001
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Start Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 010/003 NG000000
Broadcast0002
Broadcast0003
10:05 04/01 001/001 Send OK
10:22 04/01 004/004 Send OK
1
1
DDD DDD 10:30 04/01 010/010 Send OK
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Call
(2)
(7)
(8)
(6)
(1) Mode switch tabs
Use these tabs to change the job status screen mode.
(2) Job status screen selector key
Touch this key to switch between the job queue screen and the completed jobs screen.
(3) Job queue screen [Detail] key
This shows detailed information on broadcast transmission jobs and the status of jobs. Select the key of the desired job in the job queue screen (6) and then touch the [Detail] key.
(4) [Priority] key
Touch this key to give priority to a selected job.
☞
GIVING PRIORITY TO A SCAN TRANSMISSION
(5) [Stop/Delete] key
Touch this key to stop or delete a selected job.
☞
STOPPING A SCAN JOB BEING TRANSMITTED
OR WAITING TO BE TRANSMITTED (page 5-109)
(9)
(6) Job queue screen
Jobs are shown as keys in the order they were reserved.
Each key shows information on the job and its current status.
☞
(7) Completed jobs screen [Detail] key
This shows detailed information on the results of completed broadcast transmissions and jobs that used the document filing function. Select the key of the desired job in the completed jobs screen (9) and then touch the
[Detail] key.
This key does not appear if the had disk drive is not installed.
☞
CHECKING COMPLETED JOBS (page 5-108)
(8) [Call] key
Touch this key to call up and use a transmission or reception job stored with the document filing function.
This key does not appear if the had disk drive is not installed.
(9) Completed jobs screen
This shows up to 99 completed transmission or reception jobs in each mode. A description of the job and the result
(status) are shown.
Jobs that used document filing function, broadcast transmission jobs, and received Internet fax forwarding jobs are indicated as keys.
5-104
Job key display
The following information is shown in the job queue keys and completed job keys that appear in the job status screen.
Direct SMTP information is also included in Internet fax transmission/reception information.
3 AAA AAA 10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
(1) (2) (3)
(1) Displays the number (position) of the job in the job queue.
When the job currently being transmitted is finished, the job moves up one position in the job queue.
This number does not appear in keys in the completed jobs screen.
(2) Mode icon
This indicates the type of job. In the completed jobs screen, a colour bar appears next to the icon to indicate whether the job was executed in colour or black & white.
(However, the colour bar icon does not appear in the key of a job that used document filing or in the key of a transmission/reception job that was cancelled.)
Icon Job type
Scan to E-mail
Scan to FTP
Scan to Network Folder
Scan to Desktop
Internet fax transmission
Internet fax reception
PC-I-Fax transmission
Broadcast transmission or Inbound routing
Metadata transmission
(3) Name of communicating party (address)
For a transmission, the name or address of the destination.
For a reception, the address of the sending party.
In the case of a broadcast transmission, "Broadcast" appears together with a broadcast control number
(4-digits).
(4) (5) (6)
(4) Time reserved/Time started
In the job queue screen, the date and time the job was reserved. In the completed jobs screen, the date and time the job was started.
(5) Number of pages
Shows the number of pages transmitted/total number of original pages.
(6) Status
Shows the job status.
• Job in progress
Display
"Connecting"
"Sending"
"Receiving"
Status
Connecting to the destination.
Sending data.
Receiving an Internet fax.
"Stopped" The job has been stopped.
"Error" An error occurred while the job was being executed.
• Job waiting to be executed
Display
"Waiting"
"Retry Mode"
"Report Wait"
A day and time is displayed
Status
The job is waiting to be executed.
The job is being re-attempted due to a communication error or other problem.
An Internet fax has been sent for which a receive report was requested, and the machine is waiting for the receive report.
Timer transmission job (the specified time is displayed)
5-105
• Completed job
Display
"Send OK"
"In Memory"
"Received"
"Forward OK" A received Internet fax has been forwarded.
"Stopped" The job was stopped.
"Delete"
"Number of successful transmission destinations/
Total destinations
OK"
"No
Response"
"OK Report"
Status
Transmission was completed.
An Internet fax has been received but has not yet been printed.
Printed received fax data.
Deleted received data in the image check screen.
Completion of a broadcast transmission or inbound routing operation.
If transmission to 3 destinations was successful out of a total of 5,
"003/005 OK" will appear.
An error occurred because there was no response from the destination.
A receive report was requested for a transmission, the transmission was completed normally, and the receive report was received from the destination.
"NG Report"
"No Report"
"Received"
"Rejected"
A receive report was requested for a transmission, however, the transmission did not take place correctly and a transmission failed report was received.
An e-mail was received without an attached file and thus printing was not possible.
An e-mail was received, however, the attached file was not a TIFF-F file or there was no attached file, and thus printing was not possible.
An Internet fax was sent from a party that is blocked.
"NGxxxxxx"
"Error"
Transmission/reception was not successful because a communication error occurred (a
6-digit error code appears in xxxxxx.)
An error occurred while the job was being executed.
5-106
OPERATION WHEN A JOB IN THE JOB QUEUE IS
COMPLETED
When a normal transmission job is completed, it moves to the completed jobs screen and "Send OK" appears in the status column.
Received Internet faxes, timer transmission jobs, and forwarding jobs are handled in the job status screen as explained below.
Internet fax reception jobs
While an Internet fax is being received, "Receiving" appears.
When reception is completed, the job moves to the completed jobs screen and "In Memory" appears.
When printing ends, the status changes to "Printed" and the job is completed.
Timer transmission jobs
A timer transmission job appears at the bottom of the job queue until the specified time arrives.
When the specified time arrives, the job is executed. If another job is in progress, the timer job is started when the other job is completed.
Internet fax transmission jobs that request a receive report
After completion of an Internet fax transmission job (excluding Direct SMTP transmission jobs) that requests a receive report, the job is placed on standby at the bottom of the job queue screen. "Report Wait" appears in the status column.
When the receive report is received from the destination, or if the report is not received within the timeout time, the job moves to the completed jobs screen.
Reception jobs when "Inbound Routing Settings" are enabled
When "Inbound Routing Settings" are enabled, reception jobs are handled as follows depending on the print setting.
☞
FORWARDING RECEIVED INTERNET FAXES TO A NETWORK ADDRESS (Inbound Routing Settings) (page 5-119)
• Received Internet fax is not printed
"Receiving" appears while the Internet fax is being received. When reception is completed, the job moves to the job queue of the job status screen of scan mode.
• Received Internet fax is printed
When reception is completed, the job moves to the completed jobs screen and "In Memory" appears. When printing ends, the status changes to "Printed" and the job is completed. In addition, the job is added to the job queue of the job status screen of scan mode. When forwarding received Internet faxes is finished, "Forward OK" appears.
5-107
CHECKING COMPLETED JOBS
This function requires the hard disk drive.
You can check a list of the destinations, the destinations for which transmission failed, and other detailed information on completed jobs that used document filing function, broadcast transmission jobs, and received Internet fax forwarding jobs. Touch the key of the job for which you wish to display information in the completed jobs screen and touch the
[Detail] key. The job detail screen (see below) will appear.
Detail
Broadcast0001
Address
002
010
EEE EEE
FFF FFF
Start Time Status
10:01 04/01 NG000000
10:10 04/01 NG000000
OK
Retry
1
1
File Failed All Destinations
The job name appears at the top of the job detail screen.
To view details on the job, touch one of the tabs. The following information appears on each tab.
File
Failed
Tab name Information displayed
Shows information on a transmission/reception that used document filing function.
To call up the file and use it, touch the [Call] key.
Shows information on addresses for which communication failed.
Address: Address name or number
Start time: Time at which communication began.
Status: Description of failure (error)
The [Retry] key can be touched to re-attempt transmission to that address.*
All Destinations Shows all addresses specified in the job.
Address: Address name or number
Start time: Time at which communication began.
Status: Communication result
The [Retry] key can be touched to transmit to all addresses again.*
* Recalling is not possible for a broadcast transmission that includes a Scan to FTP address, Scan to Network Folder address, or Scan to Desktop address.
5-108
STOPPING A SCAN JOB BEING
TRANSMITTED OR WAITING TO BE
TRANSMITTED
Follow the steps below to stop a job that is being transmitted or is waiting to be transmitted.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
(1) (1)
2
3
1
Print Job
Address
Broadcast
4
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
CCC CCC
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Set Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
10:05 04/01 000/001 Waiting 1
1
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(2) (3)
Select the job that you wish to stop.
(1) Touch the mode tab of the job to be stopped.
(2) Touch the key of the job to be stopped.
(3) Touch the [Stop/Delete] key.
Touch the [Yes] key.
Delete the job?
CCC CCC 10:31 04/01
No Yes 3
If you do not want to stop the selected job...
Touch the [No] key.
Printing of a received Internet fax cannot be stopped.
5-109
GIVING PRIORITY TO A SCAN
TRANSMISSION JOB
When multiple jobs are waiting to be transmitted, the jobs are normally transmitted in the order they were reserved. If you need to give priority to a job and send it ahead of the other jobs, follow the steps below.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
(1) (1)
2
3
4
1
Print Job
Address
Broadcast
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
CCC CCC
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Set Time Pages Status
10:00 04/01 020/003 Connecting
10:05 04/01 000/001 Waiting
10:22 04/01 000/004 Waiting
10:30 04/01 000/010 Waiting
1
1
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
(2) (3)
Select the job to which you wish to give priority.
(1) Touch the mode tab of the job to be given priority.
(2) Touch the key of the job to be given priority.
(3) Touch the [Priority] key.
The selected job moves up to the position immediately following the job in progress. The job will be executed when the job in progress is completed.
5-110
CHECKING THE INTERNET FAX ACTIVITY
LOG (Image Sending Activity Report)
IMAGE SENDING ACTIVITY REPORT
You can have the machine print a log of recent image sending activity (date, name of other party, time required, result, etc.). The Image Sending Activity Report contains useful information such as the types of errors that occurred.
The most recent 200 transactions are included in the report.
You can have the machine print the Image Sending Activity Report each time the number of transactions reaches 201, or at a specified time (once a day only).
The contents of the Image Sending Activity Report are erased when the report is printed, and thus it cannot be reprinted.
System Settings (Administrator): Activity Report Print Select Setting
This is used to set the conditions for printing activity reports. The factory default setting is not to print.
The Image Sending Activity Report can be set to print each time the number of transactions reaches 201, or at a specified time (once a day only).
INFORMATION APPEARING IN THE RESULT COLUMN
Error types and other information are printed in the result column of transaction and activity reports. When a transaction report or activity report is printed, check the result of the transaction in the result column and take action as needed.
Examples of messages that are printed in the result column
Message
OK
OK REPORT
CANCEL
MEM. FULL
REJECTED
NG REPORT
NO REPORT
NG LIMIT
RECEIVED
FAIL xx (xxxx)
Explanation
The transaction was completed normally.
A receive report was requested for a transmission, the transmission was completed normally, and the receive report was received from the destination.
A transmission was stopped while in progress, or a reserved transmission job was cancelled.
The memory became full during reception.
An Internet fax was sent from a party that is blocked.
A receive report was requested for a transmission, however, the transmission did not take place correctly and a transmission failed report was received.
A receive report was requested for a transmission, however, a report was not received within the timeout time.
Transmission was not possible because the file size exceeded the machine's file size limit setting.
An e-mail was received, however, the attached file was not a TIFF-F file or there was no attached file, and thus printing was not possible.
The transaction failed due to a communication error.
First 2 digits of communication error number: Error code from 00 to 99.
Last 4 digits of communication error number: Code for use by service technicians.
5-111
INTERNET FAX RECEPTION FUNCTIONS
This section explains the basic procedures for receiving Internet faxes.
RECEIVING AN INTERNET FAX
The Internet fax function periodically* connects to the mail server (POP3 server) and checks whether or not Internet faxes have been received. When faxes have been received, the faxes are automatically retrieved and printed.
* The default setting is once every 5 minutes.
If faxes will be received at night, keep the main power switch in the "on" position.
Internet faxes are received automatically.
A beep sounds when reception ends.
Beep
1
The faxes are printed automatically.
2
If the machine is out of paper or there is no paper that matches the size of the received fax, a message will appear in the touch panel. Follow the instructions in the message to load an appropriate size of paper.
•
System Settings: Fax Data Receive/Forward (page 7-22)
When printing is not possible because the machine has run out of paper or toner, received Internet faxes can be forwarded to and printed by another previously stored Internet fax machine.
• System Settings (Administrator): I-Fax Default Settings
These settings are used to select how received faxes are handled when the [POWER] key ( ) is "off" (the main power switch is "on"), the volume of the beep that sounds when reception ends, and whether or not received e-mail messages are printed.
• System Settings (Administrator): I-Fax Receive Settings
Settings related to Internet fax reception can be configured such as the interval for checking for received faxes, duplex reception, output settings, auto reduction printing, and storing allow/reject reception addresses.
• System Settings (Administrator): Allow/Reject Mail or Domain Name Setting
This setting is used to allow/refuse reception from stored addresses and domains.
• System Settings (Administrator): Receiving Date & Time Print
Use this to select whether or not the date and time of reception is added when a received image is printed.
5-112
MANUALLY RECEIVING INTERNET FAXES
If the interval for checking for received faxes is somewhat long and you wish to check immediately, you can manually initiate reception.
Touch the [I-Fax Manual Reception] key to connect to the mail server and retrieve received faxes.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Fax
Scan:
Auto
Resolution 200X100dpi Send Settings
Address Review
File
File Format TIFF-F
Special Modes
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Quick File
Preview
I-Fax Manual
Reception
If POP3 server settings are not configured in the Web pages, the [I-Fax Manual Reception] key is greyed out to prevent selection.
System Settings:
Fax Data Receive/Forward (page 7-22)
This setting is used to hide the [I-Fax Manual Reception] key that appears in the base screen of Internet Fax mode. When the
[I-Fax Manual Reception] key is hidden, manual reception is initiated by touching the [Reception Start] key in the screen that appears when "Fax Data Receive/Forward" - "I-Fax Settings" is selected.
5-113
PRINTING A PASSWORD-PROTECTED FAX
(Hold Setting For Received Data Print)
"Hold Setting for Received Data Print" in the system settings (administrator) can be enabled to have faxes received to memory without being printed. To print the faxes, a password must be entered. When this function is enabled, a password entry screen appears in the touch panel when received Internet faxes are retrieved.
Received data is stored.
Enter password via the 10-key.
Cancel
When the previously programmed 4-digit password is entered with the numeric keys, printing begins.
The [Cancel] key can be touched to close the password entry screen; however, the data in memory key ( ) will blink in the touch panel. The password entry screen will reappear when you touch the blinking key ( ) or change modes.
When "Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), a password can be entered to display the received data list screen. If you wish to check an image before printing it, continue from step 2 on the next page.
• The received faxes will be retained in memory regardless of whether they were received automatically or manually.
• If "Fax Data Receive/Forward" is enabled in the system settings so that received faxes are forwarded to another machine, faxes retained in memory are also forwarded. At that time, the same password entry screen will appear as for printing.
Forwarding will not take place unless the password is entered.
System Settings (Administrator): Hold Setting for Received Data Print
Enable this setting to have faxes received to memory without being printed. This setting is also used to program the password that must be entered to print the faxes.
5-114
CHECKING THE IMAGE BEFORE PRINTING
This function requires the hard disk drive.
When "Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled* in the system settings (administrator), you can check a received image in the touch panel before printing it out. When this function is enabled, follow the steps below to print a received image.
* The factory default setting is disabled.
Depending on the size of the received data, part of the image in the image check screen on the touch panel may not appear.
1
The memory has received data.
Check the data?
No Yes
2
(1)
Received Data List
Thumbnail
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
0123456789
CCC CCC
Image Check Forward
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
Back
Select All
10:28 Not checked
10:14 Checked
Not checked 10:12
10:08 Checked
10:00 Not checked
1
5
10:00 Checked
Delete Print
(2)
When an image is received, a confirmation prompt will appear. Touch the [Yes] key.
If this message appears while you are configuring settings of any type and you touch the [Yes] key, the settings that you are configuring will be cancelled. If this message appears in another mode, you will return to the base screen of image send mode after checking the image.
Select the received image
(1) Touch the key of the received image that you want to check.
Multiple received images can be checked.
(2) Touch the [Image Check] key.
• To show thumbnails of the received images, touch the
[Thumbnail] key.
• To delete an image that has been selected, touch the
[Delete] key. To print an image that has been selected, touch the [Print] key.
3
Image Check
AAA AAA 04/04/2010 10:28
0001 /0010
Back
1 / 3
Display Rotation
Check the received image and then touch the [Print] key.
Printing begins.
For information on the image check screen, see "
If the screen of step 1 appears when you are configuring settings in the setting screens of any of the modes, the configured settings will be cancelled if you view the image. After viewing the image, you will return to the base screen of image send mode, regardless of which mode you were in previously.
System Settings (Administrator): Received Data Image Check Setting
Use this to specify whether or not a received Internet fax can be viewed before it is printed.
5-115
CHECKING THE IMAGE BEFORE
FORWARDING
When "Received Data Image Check Setting" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), you can select the received data from the list and forward it to the addresses recorded in the address book. When this function is enabled, follow the steps below to forward the received image.
* The factory default setting is disabled.
Depending on the size of the received data, part of the image in the image check screen on the touch panel may not appear.
1
The memory has received data.
Check the data?
No Yes
2
(1)
Received Data List
Thumbnail
AAA AAA
BBB BBB
0123456789
CCC CCC
Image Check Forward
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
Back
Select All
10:28 Not checked
10:14 Checked
Not checked 10:12
10:08 Checked
10:00 Not checked
1
5
10:00 Checked
Delete Print
(2)
When an image is received, a confirmation prompt will appear. Touch the [Yes] key.
If this message appears while you are configuring settings of any type and you touch the [Yes] key, the settings that you are configuring will be cancelled. If this message appears in another mode, you will return to the base screen of image send mode after checking the image.
Select the received image
(1) Touch the key of the received image that you want to check.
Multiple received images can be checked.
(2) Touch the [Forward] key.
• To show thumbnails of the received images, touch the
[Thumbnail] key.
• The receieved image can be checked by touching the
[Image Check] key.
This function requires the hard disk drive.
☞
IMAGE CHECK SCREEN (Page 5-118)
3
5 10 15 To Cc
Address Review
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
Freq.
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Start forward.
Touch the Forward Destination from the address book to select it.
Multiple forwarding addresses can be checked.
5-116
4
5 10 15 To Cc
Address Review
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Sort Address
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
1
2
Freq.
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Start forward.
Start forward
Touch the [Start forward.] key.
If the screen of step 1 appears when you are configuring settings in the setting screens of any of the modes, the configured settings will be cancelled if you view the image. After viewing the image, you will return to the base screen of image send mode, regardless of which mode you were in previously.
System Settings (Administrator): Received Data Image Check Setting
Use this to specify whether or not a received Internet fax can be viewed before it is printed.
5-117
IMAGE CHECK SCREEN
This function requires the hard disk drive.
This section explains the image check screen.
Image Check
AAA AAA 04/04/2010 10:28
Back
1 / 3
Display Rotation
0001 0010
(3) (1) (2)
(1) Information display
This shows information on the displayed image.
(2) Preview image
An image of the selected received image appears.
If the image is cut off, use the scroll bars at the right and bottom of the screen to scroll the image. Touch a bar and slide it to scroll. (You can also touch the keys to scroll.)
(3) Change page keys
•
•
When there are multiple pages, use these keys to change pages.
keys: Go to the first or the last page.
keys: Go to the previous page or the next page.
• Page number display: This shows the total number of pages and the current page number. You can touch the current page number key and enter a number with the numeric keys to go to that page number.
(4) (5) (6) (7)
(4) "Display Rotation" key
This rotates the image right or left by 90 degrees. The rotation applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(5) [Print] key
Touch to start printing.
(6) Display zoom key
Use this to set the zoom ratio of the displayed image.
Changes from the left in the order "Full Page", "Twice",
"4 Times", "8 Times". The setting applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(7) Image select key
When multiple images are selected for preview display, use this to change the displayed images.
A preview image is an image for display on the touch panel. It will differ from the actual print result.
5-118
FORWARDING RECEIVED INTERNET
FAXES TO A NETWORK ADDRESS
(Inbound Routing Settings)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
Received Internet faxes can be automatically forwarded to an e-mail address, file server address, desktop address, or network folder address. When this function is enabled, you can also have received Internet faxes forwarded without printing them.
The machine
Forwarding
Received Internet fax
When faxes forwarded using this function are printed at the forwarding destination, the date and time of reception cannot be printed on the faxes. ("Receiving Date & Time Print" is disabled.)
CONFIGURING INBOUND ROUTING SETTINGS
All inbound routing settings are configured in the Web pages. For the procedure for accessing the Web pages, see the
Start Guide.
The following explanation assumes that the Web pages have been accessed with administrator rights.
To configure inbound routing settings, follow the steps below.
Enabling the inbound routing function.
(1) In the Web page menu, click [Application
Settings], [Inbound Routing Settings], and then [Administration Settings].
(2) Select [Enable] in "Inbound Routing" and click the [Submit] button.
1
Users without administrator rights can be prohibited from storing, editing, and deleting forwarding tables in this screen, and from specifying which table is used. To do so, select the checkboxes below .
• Disable Registration of Forward Table • Disable Change/Delete of Forward Table • Disable Change of Forward Approval
When inbound routing is enabled, you can also specify whether or not you wish the machine to print the forwarded faxes.
To have all received faxes printed before being forwarded, select "Print Out All Report" in "Print Style Setting". To have received faxes printed only when an error prevents forwarding, select "Print at Error".
If an error occurs when [Not Print and Forward to the Following E-mail Address at Error] is selected, received data is not printed, but is forwarded to the specified e-mail address.
After configuring the settings, be sure to click the [Submit] button.
5-119
2
Storing sender addresses.
If you wish to have only faxes from specified addresses forwarded, store the desired sender addresses. Send addresses stored here can be selected from a list when you store a forwarding table.
(1) Click [Sender Number/Address
Registration] in the [Inbound Routing
Settings] menu in the Web page.
(2) Enter the sender address in "Internet Fax
Address" or "Fax Number" as appropriate, and click the [Add to List] button.
The entered address will be added to the "Address to be
Entered" list.
• Specify whether the address will be directly entered
(maximum of 1500 characters) or selected from a global address book by clicking the [Global Address
Search] button.
• To store multiple addresses, repeat this step.
(3) When you have finished adding addresses, click the [Submit] button.
• A maximum of 500 sender numbers/addresses can be stored.
• To delete an entered address, select the address in "Address to be Entered" and click the [Delete] button.
5-120
3
(8)
(2)
(7) (6)
(3) (4)
(5)
Store a forwarding table.
Follow the steps below to store a forwarding table that combines a specified sender and forwarding address.
(1) Click [Inbound Routing Settings] in the Web page menu and click the [Add] button.
(2) Enter a "Table Name".
(3) Select the line used for reception.
(4) Select the sender whose faxes will be forwarded.
• To forward all received faxes, select [Forward All
Received Data].
• To forward only data received from specific senders, select [Forward Received Data from Below Sender]. To forward all data except data from specific senders, select [Forward Received Data from Senders except
Below]. Select the appropriate senders from the list and click the [Add] button.
(5) Select the forwarding address.
• To always forward received data, select [Always
Forward].
• To specify a day and time on which received data will be forwarded, select [Forward on Selected Day & Time] and select the checkbox ( ) of the desired day of the week. To specify a time, select the [Set Forwarding
Time] checkbox ( ) and specify the time.
(6) Select the file format.
The format can be set separately for each forwarding address (for each of forwarding addresses 1, 2, and 3 in the table).
(7) Select the forwarding address.
Forwarding addresses can be selected from the machine's address book. (Multiple addresses can be selected.) A maximum of 1000 forwarding addresses can be stored (a combined maximum of 100 file server, desktop, and network folder addresses can be stored).
(8) Click [Submit].
• When selecting senders from the "Sender Number/Address Setting" list, you can use the [Shift] key or the [Ctrl] key on your keyboard to select multiple senders.
• A maximum of 50 forwarding tables can be stored.
• Images sent in TIFF format may not display correctly in some recipient environments. In this event, change the file format to PDF.
• Up to three forwarding day and time settings can be set for one forwarding table, and a forwarding destination can be set for each set time. To configure these settings, use the forwarding list tabs to access each setting.
5-121
4
(2)
Specifying forwarding tables to be used.
To use the inbound routing function, enable the forwarding tables that you wish to use from among the stored tables.
(1) Click [Inbound Routing Settings] in the Web page menu.
(2) Select [Always Forward] or [Forward on
Selected Day & Time] from the forwarding table.
The forwarding permission settings that appear here are linked to the forwarding conditions set in step 3. If you wish to use different forwarding conditions than those set in step 3, set the forwarding permission settings.
(3) Click [Submit].
(3)
To delete a forwarding table, click the checkbox next to the table name so that it is selected and click [Delete].
5-122
SCANNING FROM A COMPUTER
(PC Scan Mode)
This function requires the hard disk drive.
BASIC SCANNING PROCEDURE
You can install the scanner driver on your computer from the CD-ROM that accompanies the machine, and use a
TWAIN* compliant application to scan an image using your computer.
Scanning from your computer is most useful for scanning a single original such as a photo, particularly when you want to adjust scan settings as you scan. By contrast, scanning at the machine is most useful for continuous scanning of multiple originals.
* An interface standard used for scanners and other image input devices. When the scanner driver is installed on your computer, you can use any TWAIN-compliant application to scan an image.
• Scanning in PC scan mode is only possible when the scanner driver has been installed from the "Software CD-ROM" using the integrated installer. For the procedures for installing the scanner driver and configuring settings, see the
Software Setup Guide.
• This function cannot be used when it has been disabled using "Disable Scan Function" in the system settings (administrator).
• The procedures for selecting the scanner driver and starting scanning vary depending on the TWAIN-compliant application. For more information, see the manual for the application or Help.
• When a large image is scanned at high resolution, the amount of data will be very large and scanning will take a long time.
Be sure to select appropriate scan settings for the original (text, photo, etc.).
As an example, the procedure for scanning from the "Sharpdesk" application that accompanies the machine is explained below.
[At the machine]
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
1
2
Scan Internet Fax Fax USB Mem. Scan PC Scan
This machine is in the PC scan mode.
Do not remove the original.
Scanner IP address:250.160.102.106
Exit
Touch the [PC Scan] tab to switch to PC
Scan mode.
If the [PC Scan] tab does not appear, touch the to move the screen.
tab
When PC scan mode is selected, only the [Exit] key displayed in the touch panel can be used on the machine; no other keys can be used.
5-123
[At your computer]
3
Start the TWAIN-compliant application on your computer and select [Select
Scanner] from the [File] menu.
4
(1)
Select the scanner driver of the machine.
(1) Select [SHARP MFP TWAIN K].
(2) Click the [Select] button.
(2)
Select [Acquire Image] from the [File] menu.
The scanner driver opens.
5
5-124
6
(1) (2) (3)
Preview the image.
(1) Select the location where the original is placed.
"Scanning Source" menu:
• If the original is a one-sided original and is placed in the document feeder tray, select [SPF(Simplex)].
• If the original is a 2-sided original and is placed in the document feeder tray, select [SPF(Duplex - Book)] or
[SPF(Duplex - Tablet)] depending on whether the original is a book-style or tablet-style original. In addition, select [Left edge is fed first] or [Top edge is fed first] depending on the orientation of the original.
(2) Select scan settings.
"Scanning Mode" menu:
Switch between the "Standard" screen and the
"Professional". In the "Standard" screen, select "Monitor",
"Photo", "FAX" or "OCR" depending on the original type and your scanning purpose.
If you wish to change the initial settings of any of the four buttons or select the resolution or other advanced settings, change to the "Professional" screen.
"Image Area" menu:
Select the scan area. If "Auto" is selected, the original size detected by the machine will be scanned. You can also set the scanning area in the preview window with your mouse.
(3) Click the [Preview] button.
The preview image will appear in the scanner driver.
If you are not satisfied with the preview image, repeat (2) and (3).
If the [Zoom Preview] checkbox is selected before the
[Preview] button is clicked, the selected area will be enlarged in the preview window. If the checkmark is removed, the preview image will return to normal. Note that if SPF is selected in the "Scanning Source" menu, the
[Zoom Preview] function cannot be used.
• For further information on the scan settings, click the button in the preview image screen of step 7 to open scanner driver Help.
• If the [Preview] button is clicked when scanning from the document feeder tray, only one original page will be scanned for the preview image. If you wish to include that original in the scan, return it to the document feeder tray.
5-125
7
Select scanning settings while viewing the image.
[Rotate] button:
Each time this button is clicked, the preview image rotates 90 degrees. This lets you change the orientation of the image without picking up and placing the original again. The image file will be created using the orientation that appears in the preview window.
[Image Size] button:
Click this button to specify the scan area by entering numerical values. Pixels, mm, or inches can be selected for the units of the numerical values. If a scanning area has already been specified, the entered numbers will change the area relative to the top left corner of the specified area.
button:
When a preview image is displayed and a scanning area is not specified, you can click the button to automatically set the scanning area to the entire preview image.
• For further information on the scan settings, click the button to open scanner driver Help.
• If the originals are placed in the document feeder tray, only the top page will be previewed. The top page will be delivered to the original exit tray. Be sure to return the previewed page to the document feeder tray before previewing again or scanning.
Click the [Scanning] button.
Scanning begins. The image appears in your application.
Assign a file name to the scanned image and save it as appropriate in the software application you are using.
8
5-126
[At the machine]
9
This machine is in the PC scan mode.
Do not remove the original.
Scanner IP address:250.160.102.106
Exit
Touch the [Exit] key in the touch panel.
Touch the [Yes] key.
10
PC scan in progress.
Finish PC scan mode?
No Yes
5-127
METADATA DELIVERY
This section explains metadata delivery, which can be used when the hard disk drive and application integration module kit is installed.
METADATA DELIVERY (Data Entry)
When the application integration module kit is installed and an image file is generated for a scan send transmission, metadata (data indicating the attributes of the image file and how it is to be processed) can be generated based on pre-stored information and transmitted as a separate file. The metadata file is created in XML format. By linking the metadata with applications such as document management software, a workflow application, or an encryption server, a sophisticated document solution environment can be built.
Scan to
Desktop
Metadata
(XML file)
Client PC that uses Network
Scanner Tool
Image file
Server
Fax server, document management software, workflow application, encryption server, etc.
Scan to E-mail
Scan to FTP
Scan to Network Folder
Using the application integration module kit, information on a generated image file can be entered at the touch panel and transmitted along with the image as an XML file.
5-128
PREPARATIONS FOR METADATA
TRANSMISSION
SETTINGS REQUIRED IN THE WEB PAGES
All settings related to metadata are configured in the Web pages. (Administrator rights are required.)
To configure metadata settings, click [Application Settings] and then [Metadata Settings] in the Web page menu.
When configuring settings, be sure to enable metadata transmission.
Storing Metadata Sets
Store the items (the metadata set) that are written to the XML file that is generated during scanning. Up to 10 metadata items can be configured in a metadata set. A stored metadata set can be selected at the time of transmission.
Addresses specified in "Address Type Allowing Metadata Entry" when a metadata set is stored can be selected as transmission destinations at the time of transmission using one-touch keys, manual entry, and/or a global address book search. (Addresses for which metadata entry is not allowed cannot be specified as transmission destinations.)
METADATA TRANSMISSION FOR SCAN TO DESKTOP
When Network Scanner Tool is used in its factory default configuration, a file will be generated with a new file name on the computer. When Network Scanner Tool is used as a means of sending a metadata file to a third party software application, this setting must be disabled to allow cross referencing between the image file and XML file by means of the file name generated by the computer. (When setting the file name in [Send Settings], to ensure that a previously existing file on a computer is not overwritten by a transmitted file of the same name, be sure to configure the file name so that name duplication cannot occur; for example, by including a unique extension (the date, etc.) in the generated file name.
If the file name setting is left blank, the machine will automatically generate a file name that is unique.)
• It is recommended that you use Network Scanner Tool to receive metadata. For more information, see the Network
Scanner Tool User's Guide (PDF format) on the "Sharpdesk/Network Scanner Utilities" CD-ROM.
• For information on the licence agreement and how to use the CD-ROM that accompanies the application integration module, see the separate "Sharpdesk licence kit" manual.
• Using third party software applications
Various types of third party software applications exist. Some applications can start automatically from Network Scanner
Tool and some cannot. When the auto-run function of an application is enabled, Network Scanner Tool will start the application with the ".exe" command using the file name as a parameter. Normally an application is started twice, once for the image file and once for the XML file. For example, when Network Scanner Tool is set to start the application
"APP.EXE", the following commands are applied when the two files "IMG.TIF" and "IMG.XML" are received.
APP.EXE IMG.TIF
APP.EXE IMG.XML
5-129
TRANSMITTING METADATA
Follow the steps below to select a metadata set, enter each item, and perform metadata transmission.
1
(1)
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry Exposure
Resolution Send Settings
Address Review
File
File Format
Colour Mode
Fax
Scan:
Auto
200X200dpi
Auto
Data Entry
Text
Auto/Greyscale
A4 Send:
Mono2
Quick File Special Modes
Preview
Auto
Metadata Entry
(2)
Switch to data entry mode and display the metadata set screen.
(1) Touch the [Data Entry] tab.
(2) Touch the [Metadata Entry] key.
• If no metadata sets have been stored, the [Data Entry] tab cannot be selected. Store a metadata set in the Web pages and then perform the transmission procedure.
• If a specific metadata set has been specified as the default set, go to step 3.
2
Metadata Set
Set Name:Metadata 1
Metadata 1
Metadata 3
Metadata 5
Metadata 7
Metadata 9
(1)
Metadata 2
Metadata 4
Metadata 6
Metadata 8
Metadata 10
Cancel
(2)
OK
Select a metadata set.
(1) Touch the key of the metadata set that you wish to use.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
3
Data Entry
Set Name:Metadata 1 appUserId fromName replyTo documentPassword appUserPassword billCode1
Metadata Set Cancel OK
1
2
The keys of the items stored in the metadata set will appear. Touch the key of the item that you want to enter.
If you accidentally selected the wrong metadata set or wish to use a different metadata set when a default metadata set has been set, touch the [Metadata Set] key. Touch the [OK] key in the message screen that appears. You will return to the screen of step 1. Metadata items entered to that point will be cancelled.
5-130
4
Data Entry
User ID
6 12 18
Value 1
Value 3
Value 5
Value 7
Value 9
Value 11
(1) (2)
Value 2
Value 4
Value 6
Value 8
Value 10
Value 12
Cancel
Direct Entry
OK
1
2
Enter the selected metadata item.
(1) Touch the key of the value that you wish to enter.
• When the entry values of the metadata item are in the form of selections, the selections are shown as keys.
When a value is editable, you can touch the [Direct
Entry] key to manually enter the value.
• If the metadata item requires the entry of text, a text entry screen will appear. Enter the required information.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
• To change the number of keys displayed in the screen, touch the number of displayed items selector key. Select 6,
12, or 18 keys.
• For the procedure for entering text, see "
ENTERING TEXT " (page 1-67) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
OK
When you have finished entering all items, touch the [OK] key.
5
Data Entry
Set Name:Metadata 1 appUserId Value 1
Metadata Set fromName replyTo xxxx xxxx [email protected]
documentPassword xxxx xxxx appUserPassword billCode1 xxxxxx xxxxxx
Cancel
1
2
6
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax
Original
Address Entry
Send Settings
Address Review
File
Fax
Scan: Auto
Data Entry
Exposure
Resolution
Auto Text
File Format
Colour Mode
200X200dpi
Auto/Greyscale
A4 Send:
Mono2
Quick File Special Modes
Preview
Auto
Metadata Entry
Select image settings and any other settings, and perform the scan send procedure.
• The procedures for selecting settings and performing transmission are the same as in the other modes.
• To make changes to entered values, touch the [Metadata
Entry] key once again. The entry screen of the selected metadata set will appear.
• Transmission cannot be performed if the [Data Entry] tab is displayed and no metadata settings have been configured. To perform transmission without sending metadata, switch to a different mode by touching the tab of that mode and then perform transmission.
• Before configuring metadata settings, you can specify addresses in all modes to be used. After metadata settings have been configured, only addresses in modes that are allowed in the selected metadata set can be specified.
• When metadata settings have been configured or an address is specified in the [Data Entry] tab, it will not be possible to switch to another mode.
• Metadata delivery is possible using the document filing function. The [Data Entry] tab appears in the transmission settings screen of document filing mode to allow metadata delivery. In addition, metadata delivery using document filing can be performed in [Document Operations] in the Web pages.
5-131
METADATA FIELDS
The following three types of metadata are included in the XML file that is transmitted.
• Data automatically generated by the machine: These data are always included in the XML file and are automatically
• Previously defined fields: stored on your computer.
These fields are automatically recognized by the machine and
• User defined fields: assigned to appropriate XML tags. These fields are selectable, and can only be included in the XML file if enabled in the Web pages.
Custom fields can be added to the XML file. These fields are selectable and can be defined in the Web pages.
If a defined metadata field is one of the following fields, a message will appear informing you that the field cannot be entered. Enter appropriate information in the related items of the send settings.
Name entered in metadata field fromName
Description Where entered
[Reply-To]
(Sender name of selected sender) replyTo documentSubject fileName
Name of the user who sent the job. If the name is not entered as metadata, the sender name determined by the usual rules for determining the sender name will be applied as metadata.
E-mail address to which the transmission result will be sent.
Job name appearing in the e-mail "Subject" line, or job name on the fax cover sheet.
When the user enters a [Subject] in the send settings screen in the touch panel, the entered value is applied as metadata.
Enter the file name of the image to be sent.
[Reply-To]
(E-mail address of selected sender)
[Subject]
(Blank until a value is set in the send settings screen.)
[File Name]
(Only when the [Allow Custom Filenames] checkbox is selected in the metadata settings screen in the Web pages.)
(Blank until a value is set in the send settings screen.)
5-132
NETWORK SCANNER / INTERNET FAX* 1
SPECIFICATIONS
Type Built-in
Scanning resolution (dpi)
Scanning speed
100 x 100, 200 x 200, 300 x 300, 400 x 400, 600 x 600
Internet Fax: 200 x 100, 200 x 200, 200 x 400, 400 x 400, 600 x 600 (200 x 100, 200 x 200 when file type is TIFF-S) Halftone can be selected for resolutions other than 200 x 100 dpi.
Colour (A4 / 8-1/2" x 11") One-sided: 50 pages/min. (200 x 200 dpi),
Two-sided: 20 pages/min. (200 x 200 dpi)
Black and white (A4 / 8-1/2" x 11") One-sided: 50 pages/min. (200 x 200 dpi),
Two-sided: 20 pages/min. (200 x 200 dpi)
LAN connectivity: 10Base-T / 100Base-TX / 1000Base-T Interface port
Supported protocols TCP/IP (IPv4)
Colour
(including greyscale)
File types:TIFF, JPEG, PDF, Encrypted PDF, XPS
Compression ratio:High / Medium / Low
File formats
Remarks
Black and white
Internet Fax
(black and white only)
File types:TIFF, PDF, Encrypted PDF, XPS
Compression modes:None / Medium (G3) / High (G4)
File types:TIFF-FX (TIFF-F, TIFF-S)
Compression modes:Medium (G3) / High (G4)
Number of one-touch keys for storing destinations* 2
Maximum number of keys: 1000
Number of destinations that can be stored in a group (1 key)* 2
Maximum number of destinations in one group (1 key): 500
Scan destinations Scan to E-mail / Scan to FTP / Scan to Desktop / Scan to
Network Folder
*1 The hard disk expansion kit and the Internet fax expansion kit are required.
*2 Total number of all destinations (Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, Scan to Network folder, Internet Fax,
Fax, and Group)
PULL SCAN FUNCTION (TWAIN)
SPECIFICATIONS
Supported protocol
Supported client PC operating systems
Colour modes
TCP/IP (IPv4)
Windows 2000 / XP / Server 2003 / Vista / Server 2008/7
Resolution settings
Full Colour, Greyscale, Mono Diffusion, Mono 2 gradation
75 dpi, 100 dpi, 150 dpi, 200 dpi, 300 dpi, 400 dpi, 600 dpi
(The resolution can be specified by entering a numerical value from 50 to 9600 dpi. However, when a high resolution is specified, it is necessary to reduce the scanning area.)
Maximum: A3 (11" x 17") Scanning area
5-133
CHAPTER 6
DOCUMENT FILING
This function requires the hard disk drive.
This chapter provides detailed explanations of the procedures for using the document filing function. The document filing function allows you to save the document data of a copy or fax job, or the data of a print job, as a file on the machine's hard drive. The file can be called up as needed.
This chapter assumes that you are already familiar with copy mode, scanner mode, and the other modes of the machine.
For information on procedures of copy, scanner and other modes that remain the same when those modes are used in conjunction with the document filing function, see the chapters for those modes.
DOCUMENT FILING
OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
• TYPES OF DOCUMENT FILING . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
• USES OF DOCUMENT FILING . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
• BEFORE USING DOCUMENT FILING . . . . . . . 6-4
DOCUMENT FILING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7
• USING DOCUMENT FILING IN EACH
MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
BASE SCREEN OF DOCUMENT FILING
MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
SAVING FILES WITH DOCUMENT FILING
SAVING A FILE WITH "Quick File" . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
SAVING A FILE WITH "File" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
• FILE INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
SAVING A DOCUMENT FILE ONLY (Scan to
HDD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18
• "Scan to HDD" SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18
• PERFORMING "Scan to HDD". . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23
USING STORED FILES
SEQUENCE FOR USING A STORED FILE. . . . . . 6-24
FOLDER AND FILE SELECTION SCREENS . . . . 6-26
• FOLDER SELECTION SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . 6-26
• FILE SELECTION SCREEN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27
SELECTING A FILE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29
• JOB SETTINGS SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-30
PRINTING A STORED FILE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-31
• PRINT SETTINGS SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32
• MULTI-FILE PRINTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33
SENDING A STORED FILE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37
• SEND SETTINGS SCREEN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-38
PROPERTIES OF STORED FILES . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-39
• FILE PROPERTIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-39
• CHANGING THE PROPERTY . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-39
MOVING A STORED FILE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-41
DELETING A STORED FILE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43
CHECKING AN IMAGE OF A STORED FILE . . . . 6-44
• IMAGE CHECK SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45
RETRIEVING AND USING A FILE FROM THE
JOB STATUS SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46
SEARCHING FOR A STORED FILE . . . . . . . . . . . 6-47
6-1
DOCUMENT FILING
This section provides information that you should know before using the document filing function, including an overview of document filing, the features and functions of document filing, and points to keep in mind when using document filing.
OVERVIEW
The document filing function allows you to save the document image of a copy or image send job, or the data of a print job, as a file on the machine's hard drive.
The stored file can be retrieved and printed or transmitted as needed.
Saving a file
Internet Fax
Retrieving and using a stored file
Print Send
Scan
Fax
Copy
Hard drive Hard drive Scan to HDD
Document information used in any of the modes is saved to the hard drive as a file.
A stored file can be printed. A stored file can also be sent as a fax or sent to another computer over a network. A stored file can also be kept for archive purposes.
TYPES OF DOCUMENT FILING
There are three ways to save a file using document filing: "Quick File", "File", and "Scan to HDD".
Quick File
File
Scan to HDD
As a copy, scan send, or other job is performed, this function saves the document data to the hard drive. Use this function when you want to quickly and easily store document data without specifying a file name or other information.
The stored file can also be used by other people. Do not use this method to save files that you do not want others to use, such as files containing sensitive or confidential information.
As a copy, scan send, or other job is performed, this function saves the document data to the hard drive. Unlike Quick File, various types of information can be appended to the file when the file is saved to enable efficient file management.
A password can also be established to prevent the file from being retrieved up by others.
This function scans a document and stores it as a file. Like File, various types of information can be appended to the file when it is stored.
6-2
USES OF DOCUMENT FILING
Quickly using a file
Example: You prepared handouts consisting of numerous pages for a meeting, however, another handout is needed for a newly added participant.
The handout was not saved using document filing The handout was saved using document filing
Ratio, colour mode, and special mode settings must be reselected.
The numerous original pages must all be rescanned.
The stored file is simply retrieved and printed.
Not likely to be completed in time for the meeting...
Printing is accomplished quickly and the handout is ready in time for the meeting!
Copy settings must be reselected and the original must be rescanned.
As indicated above, to obtain another set of output, the settings must be selected all over again. If you don't remember the settings, much effort may be expended to get the same output result as the previous time.
By retrieving a job stored using document filing, there is no need to reselect copy settings or rescan the original.
The job can be retrieved and printed using the same settings quickly and easily.
As shown in the example, storing a job with the document filing function frees you of the need to rescan the original and select settings, saving considerable time.
Convenient for managing frequently used documents
Example: Managing a large number of business forms
Not using document filing
It takes time to find the form you need.
Using document filing
The required form can be easily retrieved from the document filing list, and document management is much more efficient.
Paid holida y forms?
Daily repor
Business tr ip forms?
t forms?
File Retrieve
Main Folder
Scan to HDD
File Name
Paid holiday forms
Daily report forms
Business trip forms
Daily report forms
Daily report forms
Switch Display All Files
HDD Status Ex Data Access
Search
User Name
Name 1
Name 1
Name 1
Name 1
Name 1
Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
1
2
04/04/2010
Multi-File Print
Application forms, report forms, and other business forms can be stored on the hard drive for easy retrieval, letting you print the number of copies you need when you need them.
6-3
BEFORE USING DOCUMENT FILING
This section provides information that you should know before using the document filing function.
Folders
Three types of folders are used to store files by document filing.
Folders on the hard drive
Quick File
Folder
Main Folder
Custom Folder
Quick File Folder
Documents scanned using the [Quick File] key are stored in this folder. A user name and file name are automatically assigned to each job.
Main Folder
Documents scanned using the [File] key are stored in this folder.
When you store a job in the Main folder, you can specify a previously stored user name and assign a file name.
A password can also be set when storing a file ([Confidential] save).
Custom Folder
Folders with custom names can be created inside this folder.
When a document is scanned using the [File] key and a folder is selected, the document is stored in the specified folder.
Like the Main folder, a custom folder allows you to specify a previously stored user name and assign a file name when storing a job.
Passwords can be established for custom folders and for files saved in custom folders.
A maximum of 1000 custom folders can be created on the hard drive.
Items convenient to store
When storing a job using "File" or "Scan to HDD", it is convenient to store the items below. These settings are not needed when storing a job using "Quick File".
User Name
This is necessary if you will be assigning a user name to stored files. User names are stored in "User List" in the system settings (administrator). A user name is also used as a search condition when searching for a file.
Custom Folder
My Folder
The Main folder is initially available as a location for storing files by "File" and "Scan to HDD". When custom folders have been created using "Document Filing Control" in the system settings, a custom folder can be specified as a location for storing files. A password can also be established for a custom folder to restrict access to the folder.
"My Folder" is specified using "User List" in the system settings (administrator). A previously created custom folder can be selected as "My Folder", or a new folder created as "My Folder". When "My
Folder" has been configured and user authentication is used, "My Folder" will always be selected as the destination of "File" and "Scan to HDD".
•
System Settings: Document Filing Control (page 7-26)
This is used to create custom folders for document filing. A password can also be established for a custom folder.
• System Settings (Administrator): User List
This is used to store a user name and specify a folder as "My Folder".
6-4
Approximate number of pages and files that can be stored by document filing
Combined total number of pages and total number of files that can be stored in custom folders and in the Main folder
Examples of original types Number of pages* Number of files
Full colour original
(Text and photo example)
Size:
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
Max. 4500
Max. 3000
Black & white original
(Text)
Max. 10000
Size:
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
Number of pages and number of files that can be stored in the Quick File folder
Examples of original types Number of pages* Number of files
Full colour original
(Text and photo example)
Size:
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
Max. 800
Max. 1000
Black & white original
(Text)
Max. 2000
Size:
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
* The indicated numbers are guidelines for the number of pages that can be stored when all pages are full colour, and when all pages are black & white.
Copying in sort mode uses the same memory area as the Quick File folder. For this reason, when too much data has been stored in the Quick File folder, it may not be possible to perform a large copy job using sort mode. Delete unneeded files.
The original types above are examples to make the explanation easier to understand. The actual number of pages and number of files that can be stored will vary depending on the contents of the original images and the settings when the files are stored.
6-5
Automatic deletion of files
You can have document filing data in specified folders automatically deleted at regular intervals by specifying the folders and the time. Periodic deletion of files stored in the machine helps to prevent the leaking of sensitive information and frees space on the hard drive.
Every day, every week, or every month can be selected for the deletion cycle, and a time can be set for each selection.
For example, you can set file deletion to take place every week on Friday at 6:00 PM.
Automatic file deletion settings are configured in "Automatic Deletion of File Settings" in the system settings
(administrator).
To check the settings, print the following list in the system settings.
To check information on the deletion cycle: Print the "Administrator Settings List" in the system settings (administrator).
To check information on the folders selected for file deletion: Print the "Document Filing Folder List" in the system settings.
When "Automatic Deletion of File Settings" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), all files in the specified folders will be deleted when the set time arrives. Take care not to store files that you wish to keep in folders specified for file deletion.
•
System Settings: Document Filing Control (page 7-26)
This shows a list of the folder names for document filing.
• System Settings (Administrator): Automatic Deletion of File Settings
Configure settings for automatic deletion at regular intervals of files stored using the document filing function.
• System Settings (Administrator): Administrator Settings List
Use this to print a list of the administrator settings, including document filing settings.
6-6
Files
When a file is saved using "File", the following information can be appended.
User Name: Name 1
File Name: Meeting handout
Password: 12345678
"Meeting minutes" folder
Saving a file with this information allows you to distinguish it from other files.
User name: Use this to specify the owner of the file. The user name must first be stored in "User List" in the system settings.
File Name: A file name can be entered.
Folder: Select which folder the file will be saved in.
Confidential: A password (5 to 8 digits) can be established to prevent others from using the file.
The above information cannot be specified when a file is saved with Quick File.
System Settings (Administrator): User List
This is used to store user names.
IMPORTANT POINTS WHEN USING DOCUMENT FILING
Note the following when using document filing:
• Files saved using "Quick File" are assigned the "Sharing" property. "Sharing" files can be retrieved and printed or transmitted by anyone, and thus Quick File should not be used to save sensitive or confidential documents that you do not wish others to use.
• When saving a file with "File", use the "Confidential" property. A password can be set for a "Confidential" file to prevent the file from being used by other people. Take care to keep the password of a stored "Confidential" file secret.
• The property of a stored "Confidential" file can be changed to "Sharing" by "Property Change" when the file is used.
Do not store sensitive documents or documents that you do not want to be used by others.
• Except in cases provided for by law, SHARP Corporation bears no responsibility for any damages that result from the leaking of sensitive information due to manipulation by a third party of any data saved using the Quick File function or
File function, or incorrect operation of the Quick File function or File function by the operator that saves the data.
6-7
USING DOCUMENT FILING IN EACH MODE
In copy or image send mode, the original can be saved as a file on the hard drive at the same time it is copied or transmitted. In addition, Scan to HDD can be used to save the scanned data of an original to the hard drive without copying or transmitting the data.
Copy mode
The original is saved as an image file at the same time it is copied.
(1)
COPY IMAGE SEND
Ready to scan for copy.
DOCUMENT
FILING
(2)
(1) Touch the [COPY] key.
(2) Touch the [File] key or the [Quick File] key.
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Plain
A4
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Copy Ratio
100%
Original
Auto
A4
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Preview
Image Send mode
Example: Base screen of scan mode
The original is saved as an image file at the same time it is scanned and transmitted.
(2) (1)
COPY
Ready to send.
Scan
Address Book
IMAGE SEND
Internet Fax
Original Scan:
DOCUMENT
FILING
Fax
Resend
Auto
USB Mem. Scan
Send:
PC Scan
Auto
Address Entry Exposure Auto
Send Settings
Address Review
Resolution 200X200dpi
File Format PDF PDF
File
Quick File
Colour Mode
Special Modes
Auto/Greyscale Mono2
Preview
(3)
(1) Touch the [IMAGE SEND] key.
(2) Touch the [Scan] tab.
(3) Touch the [File] key or the [Quick File] key.
6-8
Scan to HDD mode
The scanned original is saved as an image file. Neither printing nor transmission are performed when Scan to HDD is used.
(1) Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key.
(2) Touch the [Scan to HDD] tab.
(2) (1)
COPY IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
Ready to scan to HDD.
Press [Start] to scan original.
Scan to HDD File Retrieve
File
Information
Original
HDD Status
Scan: Auto
Ex Data Access
Store:
Exposure Auto
Resolution 200X200dpi
Comp. Ratio Medium
Colour Mode Auto
Special Modes
Mono2
Preview
Auto
[File] key and [Quick File] key
The "File" key and/or "Quick File" key will not appear in the base screen of copy mode or image send mode if one or both of the keys has been changed to a different function using "Customize Key Setting" in the Web page menu. In this case, touch the [Special Modes] key in the base screen of either mode. Document filing can be performed by touching the [Quick File] key or [File] key in the special modes menu.
Using document filing in print mode
To use document filing in print mode, select document filing in the printer driver. For more information on using document
filing in print mode, see " CONVENIENT PRINTER FUNCTIONS " (page 3-58) in "3. PRINTER".
Using document filing in PC-Fax/PC-I-Fax mode
To use document filing in PC-Fax or PC-I-Fax mode, select document filing settings in the PC-Fax driver. For more information, see Help in the PC-Fax driver.
System Settings (Administrator): Customize Key Setting
Registration is performed in [System Settings] - [Operation Settings] - "Customize Key Setting" in the Web page menu.
6-9
BASE SCREEN OF DOCUMENT FILING
MODE
Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key in the touch panel to open the base screen of document filing mode.
Files stored on the hard drive in the machine can be retrieved from this screen.
When user authentication is used and My Folder is configured, the file selection screen of My Folder will appear.
If the user that logged in does not have My Folder configured, the folder selection screen will appear.
☞
FOLDER SELECTION SCREEN (page 6-26)
☞
FILE SELECTION SCREEN (page 6-27)
(1)
COPY IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
(2)
(3)
File Retrieve
Folder Select
Scan to HDD HDD Status Ex Data Access
Search
(4)
(5)
(6)
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
All Folders ABCD EFGHI
Quick File Folder
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
1
2
(7)
(1) Mode switch keys
Use these keys to switch between copy, image send, and document filing modes.
To switch to document filing mode, touch the
[DOCUMENT FILING] key.
(2) [File Retrieve] tab
Touch this tab to retrieve a file stored by document filing.
The folder selection screen will appear.
☞
FOLDER SELECTION SCREEN (page 6-26)
(3) [Scan to HDD] tab
Touch this key to select Scan to HDD. Neither printing nor transmission are performed.
The file will be stored in the Main folder or a custom folder.
☞
SAVING A DOCUMENT FILE ONLY (Scan to HDD)
(4) [HDD Status] tab
Touch this key to check how much of the machine's hard drive is being used.
The amount used is shown as a percentage.
HDD Status
Main Folder:10%
Custom Folder:40%
0 25
Quick File Folder:20%
50
0 25 50
75
75
Free Space:50%
100%
Free Space:80%
100%
(5) [External Data Access] tab
This can be selected when an FTP server is stored or a
USB memory device is connected to the machine.
☞
"
DIRECTLY PRINTING FROM THE MACHINE "
(6) [Search] key
Touch this key to search for a file stored in a folder.
You can search using the user name, file name, or folder name.
☞
SEARCHING FOR A STORED FILE (page 6-47)
(7) When retrieving a stored file, use this to select the folder where the file is stored.
☞
FOLDER SELECTION SCREEN (page 6-26)
6-10
SAVING FILES WITH DOCUMENT
FILING
This chapter explains how to save an original as an image file using the Quick File, File, and Scan to HDD functions of document filing mode.
SAVING A FILE WITH "Quick File"
When copying, printing or transmitting a document in copy mode, print mode, or image send mode (excluding USB memory scan mode), "Quick File" can be selected to save an image of the document to the Quick File folder.
The image can retrieved at a later time, allowing you to print or transmit the document without having to locate the original.
As an example, the procedure for storing a document in the Quick File folder while copying is explained below.
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
1
2
3
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Plain
A4
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Preview
Touch the [Quick File] key.
Scanned data is automatically stored in the quick file folder. Do not store confidential data to the folder.
OK
Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode and the [Quick
File] key will be highlighted.
To cancel Quick File...
Touch the [Quick File] key in the screen of step 2 so that it is not highlighted after you touch the [OK] key.
6-11
4
Select copy settings and then press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key.
• Copying begins and the scanned document image is saved to the hard drive.
The selected copy settings are also saved.
• To prevent accidental saving of the document, the message "The scanned data is stored in the quick file folder." appears for 6 seconds (default setting) after the [START] key is pressed.
The message display time can be changed using "Message Time Setting" in the system settings (administrator).
• If you inserted the original pages in the document feeder tray, all pages are scanned.
• If you placed the original on the document glass, scan each page one page at a time.
When scanning of one page finishes, replace it with the next page and press the same [START] key that you pressed initially.
Repeat until all pages have been scanned and then press the [Read-End] key.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
When a file is stored using Quick File, the following user name and file name are automatically assigned to the file.
User Name: User Unknown
File Name: Mode_Day-Month-Year_Hour-Minute-Second
(Example: Copy_04042010_112030)
Stored to: Quick File Folder
When user authentication is used, the user name that was used for login is automatically selected.
Only the file name and location of a file stored in the Quick File Folder can be changed.
To cancel Quick File...
Touch the [Quick File] key in the screen of step 2 so that it is no longer highlighted.
System Settings (Administrator): Delete All Quick Files
With the exception of protected files, all files in the quick file folder can be deleted at once.
Settings can be configured to delete all files by key operation and to have all files automatically deleted when the power is turned on.
6-12
SAVING A FILE WITH "File"
When copying, printing or transmitting a document in copy mode, print mode, or image send mode (excluding USB memory scan mode), "File" can be selected to save an image of the document to the Main folder or a previously created custom folder. The image can retrieved at a later time, allowing you to print or transmit the document without having to locate the original.
As an example, the procedure for using "File" while copying is explained below.
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
1
2
3
Colour Mode
Full Colour
Exposure
Auto
Copy Ratio
100%
Plain
A4
Original
Auto
A4
1.
2.
3.
4.
A4
A4R
B4
A3
Paper Select
Auto
A4
Plain
Special Modes
2-Sided Copy
Output
File
Quick File
Preview
Touch the [File] key.
(1)
File Information
Confidential
Password
User Name User Unknown
File Name
Stored to
Copy_04042010_112030
Main Folder
Cancel
(2)
OK
Select the "File" settings.
(1) Select file information settings.
To select the user name, file name, folder, and
confidential setting, see " FILE INFORMATION " (page
•
Specifying a user name : page 6-15
•
Assigning a file name : page 6-16
•
Specifying the folder : page 6-16
•
Storing a file as a confidential file : page 6-17
After configuring the above settings, you will return to this screen. Go to the next step.
If you do not wish to assign a user name or other information to the file, go to the next step.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
You will return to the base screen of copy mode and the
[File] key will be highlighted.
6-13
4
Select copy settings and then press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK &
WHITE START] key.
• Copying begins and the scanned document image is saved to the hard drive.
The selected copy settings are also saved.
• For the procedure for placing the original, see step 4 of "
SAVING A FILE WITH "Quick File" " (page 6-11).
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
When a file is stored using File without appending file information, the following user name and file name are automatically assigned to the file.
User Name: User Unknown
File Name: Mode_Day-Month-Year_Hour-Minute-Second
(Example: Copy_04042010_112030)
Stored to: Main Folder
When user authentication is used, the user name that was used for login is automatically selected.
To cancel the File operation...
Touch the [Cancel] key in the screen of step 3.
6-14
FILE INFORMATION
This section explains the settings that are configured in step 3 of "
SAVING A FILE WITH "File" " (page 6-13). Specifying
a user name, file name, folder, and confidential setting makes it easier to manage and search for a file. In addition, when confidential is selected and a password is established, other people will not be able to view the file without permission.
Specifying a user name
1
File Information
Confidential
Password
User Name
File Name
Stored to
User Unknown
Copy_04042010_112030
Main Folder
Cancel OK
Touch the [User Name] key.
When user authentication is used, the user name that was used for login is automatically selected. In this case, this step is not needed.
The user name must be previously stored in "User List" in the system settings (administrator).
2
(B) (A) (2)
User Name
6 12 18
ABC
User
Cancel OK
Name 1
Name 3
Name 5
Name 7
Name 9
Name 11
All
Name 2
Name 4
Name 6
Name 8
Name 10
Name 12
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Touch the desired user name in the list of user names that is displayed.
(1) Select the user name.
There are two ways to select the user name:
(A) Touch the key of the user name.
The touched user name is highlighted.
If you accidentally select the wrong user name, touch the key of the correct name.
(B) Touch the key.
An area for entering the "Registration No." [----] appears in the message display. Enter the
"Registration No." set during user registration. This will allow you to select the user name.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
The user name that you touched is selected and you return to the screen of step 1. The selected user name appears.
6-15
Assigning a file name
A file name can be assigned to the file.
File Information
Confidential
Password
User Name User Unknown
File Name
Stored to
Copy_04042010_112030
Main Folder
Cancel OK
Touch the [File Name] key.
A text entry screen will appear. Enter the file name and touch the [OK] key.
A maximum of 30 characters can be entered.
Specifying the folder
1
File Information
Confidential
Password
User Name
File Name
Stored to
Name 1 file-01
Main Folder
Cancel OK
Touch the [Stored to:] key.
2
If a user name with a "My Folder" setting is selected, "My Folder" of that user will automatically be selected.
(1)
Stored to:
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
All Folders ABCD EFGHI JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
(2)
OK
1
2
Select the folder in which you want to store the file.
(1) Touch the key of the folder where you want to store the file.
If a password has been set for the folder, a password entry screen appears. Enter the password of the touched folder with the numeric keys (5 to 8 digits) and touch the
[OK] key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
6-16
Storing a file as a confidential file
A password can be set for the file to prevent others from viewing it. Set a password (5 to 8 digits) with the numeric keys.
1
File Information
Confidential
Password
User Name Name 1
File Name
Stored to file-01
User 1
(1) (2)
Cancel OK
Enable the confidential property.
(1) Select the [Confidential] checkbox so that a
Confidential mode is enabled and a password can be entered.
(2) Touch the [Password] key.
2
Password Cancel OK
Enter password via the 10-Key pad.
Enter a password (5 to 8 digits) with the numeric keys and touch the [OK] key.
As each digit is entered, "-" changes to " ".
6-17
SAVING A DOCUMENT FILE ONLY (Scan to HDD)
Scan to HDD is used to store a scanned document in the Main folder or a custom folder. Neither printing nor transmission are performed.
"Scan to HDD" SCREEN
The following screen appears when the [Scan to HDD] tab is touched in document filing mode. Touch the keys below to select Scan to HDD settings.
The current setting of each key appears to the right of the key.
(1)
(2)
(3)
COPY IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
Ready to scan to HDD.
Press [Start] to scan original.
Scan to HDD HDD Status File Retrieve
File
Information
Original
Scan:
Ex Data Access
Auto A4
Store:
Exposure Auto
Resolution 200X200dpi
Comp. Ratio
Medium
Colour Mode Auto
Special Modes
Mono2
Preview
Auto
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(1) [File Information] key
Information can be appended to a file stored by Scan to
HDD. The settings are configured in the same way as file information for "File".
☞
(2) [Special Modes] key
Use this key to select special modes for Scan to HDD.
☞
Special modes screen for Scan to HDD (page 6-21)
(3) [Preview] key
Touch to check the image to be stored before performing
Scan to HDD.
☞
Checking the image before storing it (Preview) (page 6-22)
(4) [Original] key
Touch this key to set the scanning size, storing size and orientation of the original, and select 2-sided scanning settings.
☞
(5) [Exposure] key
Touch this key to select the exposure for scanning.
(6) [Resolution] key
Use this to select the resolution that will be used when the file is transmitted.
When "Long Size" is specified, only resolution settings of
300 X 300 dpi and under can be selected.
(7) [Comp. Ratio] key
Use this to select the colour compression ratio that will be used when the file is stored in colour.
(8) [Colour Mode] key
Use this key to select the colour mode when storing a document.
☞
(9) key
This key appears when a special mode or 2-sided scanning is selected. Touch the key to display the selected special modes.
6-18
[Original] key
When the [Original] key is touched, the following screen appears. This screen is used to change the original size and select scanning settings for 2-sided originals.
(1) (2) (4)
Scan to HDD/Original OK
Scan Size
Auto A4
100% Store Size
Auto
Original
Image Orientation
2-Sided
Booklet
2-Sided
Tablet
(3)
(1) Touch the [Scan Size] key.
If the original is a non-standard size that cannot be detected by auto original size detection, touch the [Scan Size] key and specify the original size.
(2) Touch the [Store Size] key.
If you wish to store the file at a different size than the original size, touch the [Store Size] key and change the store size.
(3) Touch the appropriate orientation key.
If the top edge of the original is up, touch the key. If the top edge of the original is to the left, touch the key.
If the original is a 2-sided original, touch the [2-Sided Booklet] key or the [2-Sided Tablet] key as appropriate for the original type.
(4) Touch the [OK] key.
The settings are stored and you return to the Scan to HDD screen.
[Exposure] key
To adjust the exposure, touch the [Exposure] key.
Select an appropriate exposure mode for the original and touch the
When finished, touch the [OK] key.
or key to adjust the exposure level.
(3)
OK
Exposure
Scan to HDD/Exposure
Auto
Manual
1 3 5
Original Image Type
Text
Text/
Prtd.Photo
Printed
Photo
Photo
Text/Photo
Map
Moiré
Reduction
(2) (A) (1)
(1) Select the appropriate original type for the original to be scanned.
(2) Select [Auto] or [Manual].
If you selected [Manual], touch the lighter image, touch the key.)
When the exposure is set to [Auto], the
or key to adjust the exposure. (For a darker image, touch the
keys cannot be used.
key. For a
(A): Moirè Reduction
To reduce the moirè effect when scanning printed matter, touch the [Moirè Reduction] checkbox so that a checkmark appears.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
The settings are stored and you return to the Scan to HDD screen.
6-19
[Colour Mode] key
Touch the [Colour Mode] key to open the colour mode setting screen for Scan to HDD.
Scan to HDD/Colour Mode
Colour Mode
Full Colour
OK
Colour Mode
Auto
2 Colour
B/W Mode
Mono2 Greyscale
The following settings can be selected for the scanning colour when the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key is pressed.
Start key Mode
Full Colour
Scanning method
The original is scanned in full colour. This mode is best for full colour originals such as catalogues.
Even when the original is black and white, it is scanned as a full colour original.
[COLOUR START] key Auto
2 Colour
The machine detects whether the original is colour or black and white and automatically selects full colour or black and white (greyscale) scanning.
Only the red areas of the original are changed to the selected colour; colours other than red are scanned in black.
Red, green, blue, cyan, magenta, or yellow can be selected.
Mono 2
Colours in the original are scanned as black or white. This mode is best for text-only originals.
[BLACK & WHITE
START] key
Greyscale
The colours in the original are scanned in black and white as shades of grey (greyscale).
When you have finished selecting the mode, touch the [OK] key.
6-20
Special modes screen for Scan to HDD
When the [Special Modes] key is touched, the following screen appears. For more information on each setting, see
" SPECIAL MODES " (page 5-71) in "5. SCANNER / INTERNET FAX".
(1) (2) (3)
Scan to HDD/Special Modes OK
Dual Page
Scan
Mixed Size
Original
Card Shot
Slow Scan
Mode Special Modes
Erase
Job
Build
Original
Count
(4)
(1) [Erase] key
The erase function is used to erase shadow lines on images produced when scanning thick originals or books on the document glass.
(2) [Dual Page Scan] key
The left and right sides of an original can be scanned as two separate pages. This function is useful when you wish to successively scan each page of a book or other bound document.
(3) [Card Shot] key
This function lets you store the front and reverse sides of a card as a single file.
(4) [Job Build] key
This function lets you separate a many-page original into sets, scan each set using the automatic document feeder, and store all pages as a single file. Use this function when there are more original pages than can be placed at once in the auto document feeder.
(5) (6) (7)
(5) [Original Count] key
When using the automatic document feeder to scan an original, you can check whether or not the correct number of pages were scanned before storing the document.
(6) [Mixed Size Original] key
This feature lets you scan originals of different sizes at the same time; for example, B4 (8-1/2" x 14") size originals mixed together with A3 (11" x 17") size originals. When scanning the originals, the machine automatically detects the size of each original.
Originals of mixed widths and sizes can be scanned (A3 and B4, A3 and B5, A4 and B4, A4 and B5, B4 and A4R,
B4 and A5, B5 and A4R, B5 and A5 (11" x 17" and
8-1/2" x 14", 11" x 17" and 8-1/2" x 13", 11" x 17" and
5-1/2" x 8-1/2")).
(7) [Slow Scan Mode] key
Use this function when you wish to scan thin originals using the automatic document feeder. This function helps prevent thin originals from misfeeding.
6-21
Checking the image before storing it (Preview)
If you touch the [Preview] key and then start Scan to HDD, the screen below appears.
Before the scanned data is stored, you can check a preview of the scanned image in this screen and return to the Scan to HDD settings screen to change settings
Preview
Colour
Reset
Function Rev.
Display Rotation
0001 0010
(1) (2)
(1) Preview image
This shows an image of the selected file.
If the image is cut off, use the scroll bars at the right and bottom of the screen to scroll the image. Touch a bar and slide it to scroll. (You can also touch the keys to scroll.)
(2) Change page keys
•
•
When there are multiple pages, use these keys to change pages.
keys: Go to the first or the last page.
keys: Go to the previous page or the next page.
• Page number display:This shows the total number of pages and the current page number.
You can touch the current page number key and enter a number with the numeric keys to go to that page number.
Start Storing
(3) (4) (5) (6) (7)
(3) "Display Rotation" key
This rotates the image right or left by 90 degrees. The rotation applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(4) [Start Storing] key
This starts Scan to HDD.
(5) Display zoom key
Use this to set the zoom ratio of the displayed image.
Changes from the left in the order "Full Page", "Twice",
"4 Times", "8 Times". The setting applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
(6) [Function Rev.] key
Use this to check special mode settings and original settings.
(7) [Reset] key
Use this key if you need to change settings after checking an image or settings. You will return to the setting screen.
Only the original settings can be changed after the preview image is viewed.
• A preview image is an image for display on the touch panel. Differs from the actual storage result.
• Depending on the size of the image, part of the image may be clipped off in the preview screen on the touch panel.
6-22
PERFORMING "Scan to HDD"
Place the original.
Place the original face up in the document feeder tray, or face down on the document glass.
1
2
(4) (2) (1) (3)
COPY IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
Ready to scan to HDD.
Press [Start] to scan original.
Scan to HDD File Retrieve
File
Information
Original
HDD Status
Scan: Auto
Ex Data Access
A4 Store:
Exposure Auto
Resolution 200X200dpi
Comp. Ratio Medium
Colour Mode Auto
Special Modes
Mono2
Preview
Auto
Switch to document filing mode and select Scan to HDD settings.
(1) Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key.
(2) Touch the [Scan to HDD] tab.
If you do not wish to select settings, go to the next step.
(3) Select the original size, exposure, resolution, compression ratio, colour mode, and special modes.
See " "Scan to HDD" SCREEN " (page 6-18).
(4) Touch the [File Information] key.
The settings are the same as for "File". See "
If the original is 2-sided, be sure to touch the [Original] key and then touch the [2-Sided Booklet] key or the [2-Sided
Tablet] key as appropriate for the original.
3
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key .
Scanning begins.
For the procedure for placing the original, see step 4 of "
SAVING A FILE WITH "Quick File" " (page 6-11).
When Preview is enabled, the preview screen appears.
☞
Checking the image before storing it (Preview) (page 6-22)
A beep will sound to indicate that Scan to HDD is completed.
To cancel scanning...
Press the [STOP] key ( ).
When Scan to HDD is performed without appending file information, the following user name and file name are automatically assigned to the file.
User Name: User Unknown
File Name: Mode_Day-Month-Year_Hour-Minute-Second
(Example: HDD_04042010_112030)
Stored to: Main Folder
When user authentication is used, the user name that was used for login is automatically selected.
6-23
USING STORED FILES
This section explains how to retrieve a file stored by document filing and print or transmit the file.
SEQUENCE FOR USING A STORED FILE
This section explains the basic procedure for retrieving and using a stored file. The screens and procedures differ depending on whether or not user authentication is enabled.
See the sequence that applies to your situation.
For information on user authentication procedures, see "
USER AUTHENTICATION " (page 1-17) in "1. BEFORE USING
" (page
7-47) in "7. SYSTEM SETTINGS".
Files stored by document filing can also be retrieved and used from the Web pages. Click [Document Operation] and then
[Document Filing] in the Web page menu, and select the folder that contains the file you wish to use.
You can also show a preview of a stored file in the web pages.
COPY IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
Change the mode.
Switch to document filing mode.
☞
BASE SCREEN OF DOCUMENT FILING MODE (page
File Retrieve
Folder Select
Scan to HDD
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
All Folders ABCD
HDD Status Ex Data Access
EFGHI
Quick File Folder
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
Search
1
2
6-24
File Retrieve
Main Folder
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03.tiff
file-04 file-05.tiff
Switch Display
Scan to HDD
All Files
HDD Status
Select the file that you wish to retrieve.
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
Ex Data Access
Search Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
1
2
Multi-File Print
• Select the folder in the folder selection screen.
When the folder is selected, the files in the folder will appear. Select the file that you wish to retrieve.
• Thumbnail images of the stored files can be displayed for file selection.
☞
FILE SELECTION SCREEN (page 6-27)
☞
• The search function can be used to retrieve a file.
☞
SEARCHING FOR A STORED FILE (page 6-47)
Job Settings file-01
Select the job.
Move
Send
Delete
Name 1
Property
Change
A4
Select the operation.
Cancel
F. Colour
Image Check
Detail
Select the desired operation and configure settings.
☞
JOB SETTINGS SCREEN (page 6-30)
☞
PRINTING A STORED FILE (page 6-31)
☞
SENDING A STORED FILE (page 6-37)
☞
PROPERTIES OF STORED FILES (page 6-39)
☞
MOVING A STORED FILE (page 6-41)
☞
DELETING A STORED FILE (page 6-43)
☞
CHECKING AN IMAGE OF A STORED FILE (page 6-44)
6-25
FOLDER AND FILE SELECTION SCREENS
To use a file stored by document filing, the folder and file must be selected. The folder selection screen and file selection screen are explained below.
FOLDER SELECTION SCREEN
Two different screens appear depending on whether or not user authentication is enabled on the machine.
When user authentication is not enabled
(1) (2) (3)
Folder Select
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
All Folders ABCD EFGHI
Quick File Folder
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
Search
1
2
When user authentication is enabled
(1) (2) (3) (5)
Folder Select
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
All Folders ABCD
My Folder
EFGHI
Quick File Folder
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
Search
1
2
(4) (4)
(1) [Main Folder] key
Touch this key to retrieve a file from the Main folder. The files in the Main folder will appear.
(2) Custom folder keys
The custom folders that have been created using
"
Document Filing Control " (page 7-26) in system settings
are displayed. Touch a key to display the files in that folder.
If a password has been set for a custom folder, a password entry screen will appear when the folder is touched. The password must be entered.
(3) [Quick File Folder] key
Touch this key to retrieve a file from the Quick File folder.
The files in the Quick File folder will appear.
☞
SAVING A FILE WITH "Quick File" (page 6-11)
(4) Index tabs
All folders appear on the [All Folders] tab.
Touch a tab to display the custom folders whose initials
(set in "Document Filing Control" in the system settings) match the letters on the tab.
(5) [My Folder] key
This key appears when user authentication is enabled.
Touch the key to display the file selection screen of "My
Folder". When user authentication is enabled but "My
Folder" is not configured, this key will be greyed out to prevent selection.
6-26
FILE SELECTION SCREEN
The file selection screen of the Quick File folder, Main folder, and custom folders is explained below.
The file selection screen can be displayed in "List screen" format or "Thumbnail screen" format. (To select the format, see "(5) [Switch Display] key" below.)
This chapter assumes that the "List screen" format is selected.
(1) (2) (3) (4) (1) (3) (4)
File Retrieve
Main Folder
Scan to HDD
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03.tiff
file-04 file-05.tiff
Switch Display All Files
HDD Status Ex Data Access
Search
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
1
2
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
Multi-File Print
File Retrieve
Main Folder
Scan to HDD aaa.tiff
eee.tiff
Switch Display bbb.tiff
fff.tiff
All Files
HDD Status Ex Data Access
Search ccc ggg.tiff
Back ddd
1
2 hhh.tiff
Multi-File Print
Date
Sort Order
8
Display Items
(5) (6)
[List screen]
(1) File keys
The stored files are displayed. An icon showing which mode the file was stored from, the file name, the user name, and the date the file was stored appear in each file key.
When a file is touched, the job setting screen appears.
Job icons
Copy
Internet fax transmission
Direct SMTP transmission
Fax transmission
Scan to
FTP
Scan to
Scan to
Desktop
Scan to
HDD
Scan to
Network
Folder
PC-Fax transmission
PC-I-Fax transmission
Thumbnail screen
The first page of thumbnail images of the stored files appears.
The confidential icon ( ) will appear instead of a thumbnail image for files stored as confidential files.
(2) [File Name] key, [User Name] key, [Date] key
Use these keys to change the order of display of the file keys. When one of the keys is touched, or appears in the key.
• When appears in the [File Name] key or [User
Name] key, the files appear by file name or user name in ascending order.
When appears in the [Date] key, the files appear in order from the oldest date.
• When appears in the [File Name] key or [User
Name] key, the files appear by file name or user name in descending order.
When appears in the [Date] key, the files appear in order from the most recent date.
6-27
(5)
[Thumbnail screen]
(3) [Back] key
(6) (7)
Touch this key to return to the base screen of document filing mode.
☞
FOLDER SELECTION SCREEN (page 6-26)
(4) Page key
When multiple pages exist, use this key to enter the number of a page that you want to display. When the key is touched, a page number entry screen appears. Enter the desired page number (3 digits) with the numeric keys.
For example, to display page 3, enter "003".
(5) [Switch Display] key
The displayed file keys can be changed by job type and can be displayed as thumbnail images. The currently selected job type appears to the right of the [Switch Display] key. [All
Files] is initially selected. When the [Switch Display] key is touched, the following screen appears.
Switch Display
Filter by Job
All Files
Copy
Scan
Internet Fax
Fax
OK
Scan to HDD
Printer
Display Style
List Thumbnail
If you wish to display only the file keys of a specific job type, select the job type from the job type display at the top of the screen.
To display thumbnail images of the files, touch the
[Thumbnail] key. To change from the thumbnail screen to the list screen, touch the [List] key. When finished, touch the [OK] key.
(6) [Multi-File Print] key
Touch this to select multiple files in a folder for printing.
☞
MULTI-FILE PRINTING (page 6-33)
(7) Sort Order / Display Items
This can be used in the thumbnail screen.
The order of display of the file thumbnails can be changed in "Sort Order".
Select "Date ", "Date ", "File Name ", "File Name
", "User Name ", or "User Name ".
The number of displayed file thumbnails can be changed in "Display Items".
Select 2 thumbnails or 8 thumbnails.
6-28
SELECTING A FILE
This section explains how to select a file to be used.
1
COPY
(2)
IMAGE SEND
(1)
DOCUMENT
FILING
File Retrieve
Folder Select
Scan to HDD
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
All Folders ABCD
HDD Status Ex Data Access
EFGHI
Quick File Folder
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
Search
1
2
Select the folder that contains the file you wish to use.
(1) Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key.
The folder selection screen will appear. If a different tab appears, touch the [File Retrieve] tab.
When user authentication is enabled and "My Folder" is configured in "User List" in the system settings, the custom folder specified as "My Folder" opens. To display the folder selection screen, touch the [Back] key.
(2) Touch the key of the folder that contains the desired file.
If a password is set for the selected folder, a password entry screen will appear.
Enter the password with the numeric keys (5 to 8 digits) and touch the [OK] key.
2
Main Folder
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03.tiff
file-04 file-05.tiff
Switch Display All Files
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
Search Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
1
2
Multi-File Print
Touch the key of the desired file.
If a password is set for the selected file, a password entry screen will appear.
Enter the password with the numeric keys (5 to 8 digits) and touch the [OK] key.
• Touch the [Switch Display] key to display the keys of a particular mode such as copy or scanner mode, or to display thumbnail images of the files.
The [Switch Display] key allows you to quickly find a file.
• You can touch the [File Name] key, the [User Name] key, or the [Date] key to change the order of display of the files.
• The [Multi-File Print] key can be touched to select multiple files in a folder for printing.
☞
MULTI-FILE PRINTING (page 6-33)
• When "Display only the Files of Logged-in Users" is enabled under System Settings (Administrator): Authority
Group List (Document Filing), only files saved by the currently logged-in user are displayed.
6-29
JOB SETTINGS SCREEN
When a file key is touched, the following screen appears. Touch the key of the operation that you wish to perform and select settings.
(1) (2)
File Retrieve
Main Folder
Scan to HDD
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03.tiff
file-04 file-05.tiff
Switch Display All Files
HDD Status Ex Data Access
Search
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
1
2
04/04/2010
Multi-File Print
Job Settings file-01
Select the job.
Move
Send
Delete
Name 1
Property
Change
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Image Check
Detail
(3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9)
(1) File display
This shows information on the currently selected file (job icon, file name, user name, store size, and colour mode).
(2) [Cancel] key
Touch this key to cancel the operation and return to the file selection screen.
(3) [Print] key
Touch this key to print the selected file.
☞
PRINTING A STORED FILE (page 6-31)
(4) [Move] key
Use this procedure to change the location of a file (move a file to a different folder).
☞
MOVING A STORED FILE (page 6-41)
(5) [Send] key
This is used to send a stored file by fax, Internet fax, scan send, or other method.
☞
SENDING A STORED FILE (page 6-37)
(6) [Delete] key
Touch this key to delete a file that is no longer needed.
☞
DELETING A STORED FILE (page 6-43)
(7) [Property Change] key
Use this key to change the property ("Sharing", "Protect", or "Confidential") of a stored file.
☞
PROPERTIES OF STORED FILES (page 6-39)
(8) [Image Check] key
An image of the stored file appears.
☞
CHECKING AN IMAGE OF A STORED FILE
(page
(9) [Detail] key
Touch this key to show detailed information on the selected file.
When this key is touched, the following screen appears.
OK
Job Settings / Detail
File Name file-01
Folder:Main Folder
Size:A4
Date:04/04/2010 11:20
Data Size:40B
Document
Style:
Output:
Name 1
Resolution:600X600dpi
Colour / B/W:Full Colour
Pages:10
Special
Modes:
File Type:
If you wish to change the file name, touch the [File Name] key in this screen.
A text entry screen will appear. Enter the desired file name.
The key appears when a special mode is selected.
Touch the key to display the special mode selection confirmation screen.
6-30
PRINTING A STORED FILE
A file stored using document filing can be retrieved and printed when needed. The settings used when the file was stored are also stored, and thus the file can be printed again using those settings. The file can also be modified before printing by changing the print settings.
After selecting the desired file, follow the steps below.
☞
Touch the [Print] key.
1
Job Settings file-01
Select the job.
Move
Send
Delete
Name 1
Property
Change
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Image Check
Detail
2
Job Settings / Print file-01
Paper Select
Auto
Output
2-Sided
Special Modes
Name 1 A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Number of Prints
1
(1 999) Print and Delete the Data
Print and Save the Data
B/W Print
Touch the [Print and Delete the Data] key or the [Print and Save the Data] key.
If the [Print and Delete the Data] key is touched, the files will be automatically deleted after printing.
If the [Print and Save the Data] key is touched, the files will be saved after printing.
Output settings, 2-sided printing, special modes, the number of copies, and other settings can be selected. For more information, see "
PRINT SETTINGS SCREEN " (page 6-32).
• A file saved in black and white or greyscale cannot be printed in colour.
• When a long size document is stored from Scan to HDD or scan mode, the file cannot be printed. A file stored from scan mode that included fax mode or Internet fax mode destinations in a broadcast transmission can be printed.
• If print settings are changed when a stored file is printed, the only changed setting that can be stored is the number of copies.
• The printing speed may be somewhat slow depending on the resolution and exposure mode settings of the stored file.
6-31
PRINT SETTINGS SCREEN
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Job Settings / Print file-01
Paper Select
Auto
Output
2-Sided
Special Modes
Name 1 A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Number of Prints
1
(1 999) Print and Delete the Data
Print and Save the Data
B/W Print
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(1) [Paper Select] key
Use this key to set the paper size.
(2) [Output] key
Use this key to select Sort, Group or Staple Sort, and to select the output tray.
(3) [2-Sided] key
Use this key to select the orientation of the image on the reverse side of the paper for 2-sided printing. To have the front and back images oriented in the same direction, touch the [2-Sided Booklet] key. To have the front and back images oriented opposite to each other, touch the
[2-Sided Tablet] key. Note that the size and orientation of the saved image may cause these keys to have the opposite effect. If neither of these keys is selected
(neither is highlighted), 1-sided printing will take place.
(4) [Special Modes] key
Touch this key to select "Margin Shift", "Pamphlet Style",
"2in1 / 4in1", "Tandem Print", or "Stamp".
This key does not appear if the file was saved from print mode.
(5) key
Use these keys to set the number of copies. The number of copies can also be selected by directly touching the numeric display and changing the number with the numeric keys.
(6) [Print and Delete the Data] key
Printing begins when this key is touched. When printing is finished, the file will be automatically deleted.
(7) [Print and Save the Data] key
Printing begins when this key is touched. The file will not be deleted after printing.
(8) [B/W Print] checkbox
Select this checkbox if the file was saved in colour and you wish to print it in black & white.
When the file is saved in black & white, this checkbox does not appear.
6-32
MULTI-FILE PRINTING
Multiple files in a folder can be selected for printing.
1
Main Folder
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03 file-04 file-05
Switch Display All Files
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
Search Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
1
2
Multi-File Print
Touch the [Multi-File Print] key.
To select files of a particular job type, touch the [Switch
Display] key, select the job type from the screen that appears, and touch the [OK] key.
Touch the [Switch Display] key to show only files of a selected job type.
2
Multi-File Print
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03 file-04 file-05
Switch Display All Files
Select All
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
OK Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
Batch Print
1
2
Select the keys of the files that you wish to print.
Touch the keys of the files that you wish to print. Touched file keys will be highlighted to indicate that they have been selected.
To cancel the selection of a file, touch the highlighted file key so that it is no longer highlighted.
To select all displayed file keys except those of confidential files, touch the [Select All] key.
The [Batch Print] key can be used to print all files of a particular user in a folder or all files that have the same password in a
folder. For more information, see " Batch printing " (page 6-35).
• Multi-file printing of confidential files is not possible.
• A file in the currently selected folder cannot be selected simultaneously with a file in a different folder.
• If the job type is changed with the [Switch Display] key or the screen is changed with the [Back] key while a file is selected, the selection of the file will be cancelled.
• When the [Select All] key is touched, it will change into the [Cancel All] key. To cancel the selection of all files that was made with the [Select All] key, touch the [Cancel All] key.
• If all files are selected without using the [Select All] key, the key will not change into the [Cancel All] key. If selection of all files is cancelled without using the [Cancel All] key, the key will remain the [Cancel All] key.
Touch the [OK] key
The selected file is entered and the screen changes to the print screen.
3
Multi-File Print
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03 file-04 file-05
Switch Display All Files
Select All
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
OK Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
Batch Print
1
2
6-33
4
(1)
Job Settings / Print
Number of Selected Files: 5
Number of Prints
1
(1 999)
(2) (3)
Cancel
Print and Delete the Data
Print and Save the Data
Apply the Number from Stored Setting of
Each Job.
Printing a selected file.
The number of selected files appears in the number of selected files display.
If you wish to use the number of copies that was stored with the file, go to step (3).
(1) Touch the [Apply the Number from Stored
Setting of Each Job] checkbox so that it is not selected ( ).
(2) Set the number of copies with the keys.
You can also directly touch the numeric display and change the number with the numeric keys.
(3) Touch the [Print and Delete the Data] key or the [Print and Save the Data] key.
If the [Print and Delete the Data] key is touched, the files will be automatically deleted after printing.
If the [Print and Save the Data] key is touched, the files will be saved after printing.
6-34
Batch printing
All files in a folder that have the same user name and password can be printed at once. When the [Multi-File Print] key is touched, it changes into the [Batch Print] key.
Touch the [Batch Print] key.
1
Multi-File Print
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03 file-04 file-05
Switch Display All Files
Select All
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
OK Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
Batch Print
1
2
2
Batch Print
User 1/ All Files
User Name
Password
Delete the
Data
Cancel
Print and Delete the Data
Print and Save the Data Change PRT.No.
Touch the [User Name] key.
When user authentication is used, the user name that was used for login is automatically selected.
When "Display only the Files of Logged-in Users" is enabled under System Settings (Administrator): Authority Group List
(Document Filing), the user name of the currently logged-in user is selected and other user names cannot be selected.
3
(C) (B)(D) (A)
User Name
6 12 18
Cancel OK
Default User
Direct Entry
ABC
User
Name 1
Name 3
Name 5
Name 7
Name 9
Name 11
All
Name 2
Name 4
Name 6
Name 8
Name 10
Name 12
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Select the user name.
There are four ways to select the user name:
(A) Touch the key of the user name.
The touched user name is highlighted.
If you accidentally select the wrong user name, touch the key of the correct name.
(B) Touch the [Default User] key.
The user name can be selected from the factory stored users.
(C) Touch the key.
An area for entering the "Registration No." [----] appears in the message display. Enter the "Registration No." set during user registration. This will allow you to select the user name.
(D) Touch the [Direct Entry] key.
A text entry screen appears. Directly enter the user name.
After selecting the user name, touch the [OK] key.
When [Selection of [All Users] is not allowed.] checkbox and [Selection of [User Unknown] is not allowed.] checkbox are disabled in the system settings (administrator), the [All Users] key and [User Unknown] key can be selected.
The [All Users] key can be touched to select all files in the folder (the files of all users).
The [User Unknown] key can be touched to select all files in the folder that do not have a user name.
6-35
4
Batch Print
User 1/ All Files
User Name
Password
Name 1
Delete the
Data
Cancel
Print and Delete the Data
Print and Save the Data Change PRT.No.
If a password has been established, touch the [Password] key.
Enter the password with the numeric keys (5 to 8 digits) and touch the [OK] key. Only files that have the same password will be selected.
If you do not wish to enter a password, go to the next step.
Batch Print
User 1/ All Files
User Name
Password
Name 1
Delete the
Data
Cancel
Print and Delete the Data
Print and Save the Data Change PRT.No.
5
Batch Print
Change Print Number
Cancel
Cancel
OK
1
(1 999)
Apply the Number from Stored Setting of
Each Job.
(1) (2) (3)
To set the number of copies, touch the
[Change PRT.No.] key.
If you wish to use the number of copies stored with each file, go to step 6.
(1) Touch the [Apply the Number from Stored
Setting of Each Job] checkbox so that it is not selected ( ).
(2) Set the number of copies with the keys.
You can also directly touch the numeric display and change the number with the numeric keys.
(3) Touch the [OK] key.
6
Batch Print
User 1/ All Files
User Name Name 1
Password
Delete the
Data
Cancel
Print and Delete the Data
Print and Save the Data Change PRT.No.
Touch the [Print and Delete the Data] key or the [Print and Save the Data] key.
If the [Print and Delete the Data] key is touched, the files will be automatically deleted after printing.
If the [Print and Save the Data] key is touched, the files will be saved after printing.
If there are no files that match the search conditions, you will return to the file list screen.
All files that match the current search conditions can be deleted by touching the [Delete the Data] key.
6-36
SENDING A STORED FILE
A file stored by document filing can be retrieved and transmitted whenever needed. The settings used when the file was stored are also stored, and thus the file can be transmitted using those settings. If needed, you can also change the transmission settings to modify the retrieved file.
After selecting the desired file, follow the steps below.
☞
Touch the [Send] key.
1
Job Settings file-01
Select the job.
Move
Send
Delete
Name 1
Property
Change
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Image Check
Detail
2
Address Book
Address Entry
Send Settings file-01
F. Colour
Resolution
File Format
200X200dpi
Special Modes
Name 1
Select transmission settings.
For information on the settings, see "
3
Press the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
If you are sending a fax or an Internet fax, only the [BLACK & WHITE START] key can be used.
• A file saved in black and white or greyscale cannot be transmitted in colour.
• A stored print job cannot be transmitted.
• These transmission methods require installation of the corresponding options.
• If any of the following special modes were included in the saved file, the file cannot be transmitted.
"Pamphlet Copy", "Covers/Inserts", "Photo Repeat", "Multi-Page Enlargement", "Multi Shot" for copying.
• If any of the following special modes were included in the saved file, the file can be transmitted but the special modes will not be executed.
"Margin Shift", "Transparency Inserts", "Book Copy", "Tab Copy", "Stamp", all "Colour Adjustments" menu items, "Centring"
• Depending on the reduction or enlargement ratio used when storing a file, it may not be possible to send the stored file using a selected resolution setting. In this event, try changing the resolution.
However, when sending a stored file by Internet fax, transmission may not be possible even if the resolution is changed.
6-37
SEND SETTINGS SCREEN
SCREEN OF FAX MODE " (page 4-7) in "4. FACSIMILE" and "
BASE SCREEN " (page 5-9) in "5. SCANNER /
INTERNET FAX".
Example of scan mode
(6)
(7)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Ready to send.
Scan
Address Book
Internet Fax file-01
F. Colour
Address Entry
Send Settings Resolution
File Format
Special Modes
Fax
200X200dpi
Name 1
Cancel
(8)
(9)
(5)
(1) Send mode tabs
Touch the appropriate tab to select fax mode, scan mode, Internet fax mode, etc.
(2) [Address Book] key
Touch this key to display the destinations stored in the address book.
(3) [Address Entry] key or [Sub Address] key
Use this key to directly enter an address when sending a file in scan mode or Internet Fax mode.
In fax mode this appears as the "Sub Address" key. Use this key to enter a sub-address and password for F-code communication.
(4) [Send Settings] key
This key appears in scan mode and Internet fax mode.
Touch the key to enter a subject and a file name when performing a transmission. In scan mode, a sender can also be specified.
(5) key
The 4-digit search number that was assigned to a one-touch key or group key when the key was stored can be entered to specify a destination.
(6) [Next Address] key
This key appears when at least one address has been entered. Use this key when you are sending a file to multiple destinations.
(7) [Cancel] key
This returns you to the job settings screen.
(8) File name / User name display
This shows the icon of the file to be sent, the file name, the user name, and the colour mode (colour/black & white).
(9) Any of these keys can be touched to change the corresponding settings of the file to be sent. The settings that can be selected vary by mode.
• Scan mode
[Resolution] key
Use this to select the resolution. A resolution setting higher than the resolution at which the file was stored cannot be selected.
[File Format] key
This lets you select the file type, compression ratio, and colour mode.
[Special Modes] key
This displays the [Timer] key.
• Internet fax mode
[Resolution] key
Use this to select the resolution. A resolution setting higher than the resolution at which the file was stored cannot be selected.
[File Format] key
Use this to select the file type and compression ratio.
[Special Modes] key
This displays the [Timer] and [Transaction Report] keys.
• Fax mode
[Resolution] key
Use this to select the resolution. A resolution setting higher than the resolution at which the file was stored cannot be selected.
[Special Modes] key
This displays the [Timer], [Own Name Select], and
[Transaction Report] keys.
6-38
PROPERTIES OF STORED FILES
FILE PROPERTIES
A protect setting can be selected for files saved with the document filing function. This prevents a file from being moved, or automatically or manually deleted.
Three properties are available for saved files: [Sharing], [Protect], and [Confidential]. When saved with the [Sharing] property, a file is not protected. When saved with the [Protect] or [Confidential] property, a file is protected.
Files saved to the Quick File folder are all saved as [Sharing] files. When a file is saved to the Main folder or a custom folder, [Sharing] or [Confidential] can be selected.
Sharing
Protect
Confidential
A [Sharing] file can be changed to [Protect] or [Confidential] using [Property Change] in the Job Settings.
"Protect" prevents a file from being moved or deleted. A password cannot be established. The icon appears with the mode icon in the file key of a protected file.
To protect a "Confidential" file, a password is set. (The password must be entered to retrieve the file.) The icon appears with the mode icon in the file key of a confidential file.
CHANGING THE PROPERTY
After selecting the desired file, follow the steps below.
☞
Touch the [Property Change] key.
1
Job Settings file-01
Select the job.
Move
Send
Delete
Name 1
Property
Change
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Image Check
Detail
2
(1)
Job Settings / Property Change file-01 Name 1
Cancel
A4
(2)
OK
F. Colour
Sharing
Protect
Confidential
Password
Select the property.
(1) Touch the key of the desired property.
When the [Confidential] key is touched, the [Password] key can be touched.
Touch the [Password] key, enter a password (5 to 8 digits) with the numeric keys, and touch the [OK] key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
6-39
Restrictions on changing the property
• A file that is set to "Sharing" can be changed to "Protect" or "Confidential". However, a "Sharing" file that is saved in the
Quick File folder can only be changed to "Protect".
• A file that is set to "Protect" can be changed to "Sharing" or "Confidential". However, a "Protect" file that is saved in the
Quick File folder can only be changed to "Sharing".
• A file that is saved in the Quick File folder cannot be changed to "Confidential". If the file is moved to the Main folder or a custom folder, the property can be changed to "Confidential".
• Two properties cannot be selected for a single file.
6-40
MOVING A STORED FILE
Use this procedure to change the location of a file (move a file to a different folder).
After selecting the desired file, follow the steps below.
☞
Touch the [Move] key.
1
Job Settings file-01
Select the job.
Move
Send
Delete
Name 1
Property
Change
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Image Check
Detail
Touch the [Move to:] key.
Job Settings / Move file-01 Name 1
Select the folder the file is moved to.
File Name
Move to: file-01
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
2
Move
• A file cannot be moved to the Quick File Folder. With this procedure, the original name is changed and the file is moved to the specified folder. (Unlike the "Save As" command on a computer, the file is not copied to the specified folder with the original file remaining in the original location.)
• To change the file name, touch the [File Name] key.
(1) (2)
OK Job Settings / Move
3
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
All Folders ABCD EFGHI JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
The above screen shows the custom folders as an example.
1
2
Select the destination folder.
(1) Touch the key of the folder to which you want to move the file.
If a password is set for the selected folder, a password entry screen will appear.
Enter the password with the numeric keys (5 to 8 digits) and touch the [OK] key.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
6-41
4
Job Settings / Move file-01 Name 1
Select the folder the file is moved to.
File Name
Move to: file-01
User 2
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Move
Touch the [Move] key.
A file whose property is "Protect" cannot be moved. To move a protected file, change its property to "Sharing" or
"Confidential".
6-42
DELETING A STORED FILE
Stored files that are no longer needed can be deleted.
Select the file that you wish to delete and touch the [Delete] key.
☞
Touch the [Delete] key.
1
Job Settings file-01
Select the job.
Move
Send
Delete
Name 1
Property
Change
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Image Check
Detail
Check the file and then touch the [Yes] key.
2
Delete the file data?
Name 1 file-01
No Yes
A file whose property is "Protect" cannot be deleted. To delete a protected file, change its property to "Sharing" or
"Confidential".
6-43
CHECKING AN IMAGE OF A STORED FILE
You can check an image of a file stored using document filing.
Select the desired file and touch the [Image Check] key.
☞
Depending on the size of the image, part of the image may be clipped off in the image check screen on the touch panel.
1
Job Settings file-01
Select the job.
Move
Send
Delete
Name 1
Property
Change
A4
Cancel
F. Colour
Image Check
Detail
Touch the [Image Check] key.
2
Image Check file-01 Name 1 A4 F. Colour
Back
Check the image of the file.
For information on each of the items, see " IMAGE CHECK
Display Rotation
Detail
0001 0010
6-44
IMAGE CHECK SCREEN
This section explains the image check screen.
Image Check file-01 Name 1 A4 F. Colour
Back
Display Rotation
0001 0010
(3) (1) (2)
(1) Information display
This shows information on the displayed image.
(2) Preview image
This shows an image of the selected file.
If the image is cut off, use the scroll bars at the right and bottom of the screen to scroll the image. Touch a bar and slide it to scroll. (You can also touch the keys to scroll.)
(3) Change page keys
•
•
When there are multiple pages, use these keys to change pages.
keys: Go to the first or the last page.
keys: Go to the previous page or the next page.
• Page number display: This shows the total number of pages and the current page number. You can touch the current page number key and enter a number with the numeric keys to go to that page number.
For a print file, only an image of the first page of the file is shown; the displayed page cannot be changed.
Detail
(4) (5) (6)
(4) "Display Rotation" key
This rotates the image right or left by 90 degrees. The rotation applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
A print file cannot be rotated.
(5) [Detail] key
This shows the detailed information screen.
☞
FILE SELECTION SCREEN (page 6-27)
(6) Display zoom key
Use this to set the zoom ratio of the displayed image.
Changes from the left in the order "Full Page", "Twice",
"4 Times", "8 Times". The setting applies to all pages in the file, not just the displayed page.
A preview image is an image for display on the touch panel. It will differ from the actual print result.
6-45
RETRIEVING AND USING A FILE FROM THE
JOB STATUS SCREEN
Files stored using File and Quick File appear as keys in the job status complete screen.
This is convenient when you need to quickly print the saved data of a copy job or quickly send a saved fax to another destination.
Press the [JOB STATUS] key.
JOB STATUS
1
2
3
4
1
2
Print Job
Job Queue
Computer01
Scan to Fax Job Internet Fax
Sets / Progress Status
002/001 Printing
0312345678
0312345678
Copy
002/000
002/000
002/000
Waiting
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
Touch the job status selector key so that
[Complete] is highlighted.
3
Print Job
Computer04
Scan to Fax Job
Jobs Completed Set Time
Computer02
Sets Status
11:00 04/04 001/001 OK
Computer03 10:33 04/04 010/010 OK
10:31 04/04 013/013 OK
Internet Fax
1
1 file-01
Copy
Copy
Computer05
Copy
10:30 04/04 010/010 OK
10:13 04/04 001/001 OK
10:03 04/04 001/001 OK
10:01 04/04 003/003 OK
10:00 04/04 010/010 OK
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Call
(1) (2)
Select the desired file in the completed jobs.
(1) Touch the key of the desired file.
(2) Touch the [Call] key.
The job settings screen appears.
Select and perform the desired operation.
☞
JOB SETTINGS SCREEN (page 6-30)
☞
PRINTING A STORED FILE (page 6-31)
☞
SENDING A STORED FILE (page 6-37)
☞
PROPERTIES OF STORED FILES (page 6-39)
☞
MOVING A STORED FILE (page 6-41)
☞
DELETING A STORED FILE (page 6-43)
☞
CHECKING AN IMAGE OF A STORED FILE
(page
• To view information on a file, select the file and then touch the [Detail] key.
• If user authentication is enabled, and the [Call] key is touched when no users are logged in, the user authentication screen will appear to let you log in.
• When "Display only the Files of Logged-in Users" is enabled under System Settings (Administrator): Authority
Group List (Document Filing), it is not possible to reuse a file if its user name does not match the user name of the logged-in user.
6-46
SEARCHING FOR A STORED FILE
When there are many stored files, it may take time to find a file. The search function of document filing mode can be used to find a file quickly.
This section explains how to search for a file or folder on the machine's hard drive.
Searching is possible even when you only know part of the file name or folder name. A folder can also be specified as a search range.
Example: Only part of a file name is known: "Meeting"
[Hard drive]
For individuals Quick File
Main
For meeting s
Regular meeting Text 1
Report Meeting graphs
When you search using "Meeting"...
For meeting s
Regular meeting
Meeting graphs
All folders and files that include "Meeting" will be listed.
[Search results]
1
COPY IMAGE SEND
(1)
DOCUMENT
FILING
(2)
File Retrieve
Folder Select
Scan to HDD
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
All Folders ABCD
HDD Status Ex Data Access
EFGHI
Quick File Folder
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
Search
1
2
Open the file search screen.
(1) Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key.
(2) Touch the [Search] key.
2
Search
User Name
File or Folder Name
Password
Cancel Start Search
Touch the [User Name] key or the [File or Folder Name] key.
If you know the user name, touch the [User Name] key and go to "
Using the user name to search " in step 3.
If you know the file name, touch the [File or Folder Name] key and go to "
Using the file name or folder name to search
" in step
3.
When "Display only the Files of Logged-in Users" is enabled under System Settings (Administrator): Authority Group List
(Document Filing), the user name of the currently logged-in user is selected and other user names cannot be selected.
6-47
3
(C) (B)(D) (A)
User Name
6 12 18
Cancel OK
Default User
Direct Entry
ABC
User
Name 1
Name 3
Name 5
Name 7
Name 9
Name 11
All
Name 2
Name 4
Name 6
Name 8
Name 10
Name 12
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Using the user name to search
There are four ways to select the user name:
(A) Touch the key of the user name.
The touched user name is highlighted.
If you accidentally select the wrong user name, touch the key of the correct name.
(B) Touch the [Default User] key.
The user name can be selected from the factory stored users.
(C) Touch the key.
An area for entering the "Registration No." [----] appears in the message display. Enter the "Registration No." set during user registration. This will allow you to select the user name.
(D) Touch the [Direct Entry] key.
A text entry screen appears. Directly enter the user name.
Searching is possible even if you only enter the first several letters of the user name.
After selecting the user name, touch the [OK] key.
After the user name is selected, the [Password] key can be touched. To search for files of the selected user name that have a certain password, touch the [Password] key and enter the password.
(It is not possible to search using a password only.)
Using the file name or folder name to search
Enter the file name or folder name in the text entry screen that appears and touch the [OK] key.
6-48
4
Search
User Name Name 1
File or Folder Name
Password file-01
Cancel Start Search
Touch the [Start Search] key.
The search results will appear in a screen similar to the following screen. A list of the files that match your search criteria will appear. Select the desired file from the list. The job settings screen will appear.
Search
File or Folder Name file-01
User Name
Name 1
Cancel Search Again
Date
04/04/2010
1
1
To return to the base screen of document filing mode, touch the
[Cancel] key.
To return to the file search screen, touch the [Search Again] key.
• When you search using [File or Folder Name], custom folders that match the search characters will also appear in the list. When a folder key is touched, a list of the files in the folder appears. Touch the desired file in the list.
• You can also use the Web pages to search for a file. Click [Document Operations], [Document Filing], and then
[Search] in the Web page menu.
6-49
Searching within a folder
You can specify a folder to restrict the search range to that folder. To search within a specified folder, follow the steps below.
1
COPY
(2) (1)
IMAGE SEND
DOCUMENT
FILING
File Retrieve
Folder Select
Scan to HDD
Main Folder
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
All Folders ABCD
HDD Status Ex Data Access
EFGHI
Quick File Folder
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
JKLMN OPQRST UVWXYZ
Search
1
2
Open the folder that you wish to search.
(1) Touch the [DOCUMENT FILING] key.
(2) Touch the key of the folder that you wish to search.
If a password is set for the selected folder, a password entry screen will appear.
Enter the password with the numeric keys (5 to 8 digits) and touch the [OK] key.
2
Main Folder
File Name file-01 file-02 file-03.tiff
file-04 file-05.tiff
Switch Display All Files
User Name
Name 1
Name 2
Name 3
Name 4
Name 5
Search Back
Date
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
04/04/2010
1
2
Multi-File Print
Touch the [Search] key.
3
Search
User Name
File or Folder Name
Password
Search within Current Folder
Cancel Start Search
Touch the [User Name] key or the [File or Folder Name] key.
If you know the user name, touch the [User Name] key and go to "
Using the user name to search " in step 4.
If you know the file name, touch the [File or Folder Name] key and go to "
Using the file name or folder name to search
" in step
4.
When "Display only the Files of Logged-in Users" is enabled under System Settings (Administrator): Authority Group List
(Document Filing), the user name of the currently logged-in user is selected and other user names cannot be selected.
6-50
4
(C) (B)(D) (A)
User Name
6 12 18
Cancel OK
Default User
Direct Entry
ABC
User
Name 1
Name 3
Name 5
Name 7
Name 9
Name 11
All
Name 2
Name 4
Name 6
Name 8
Name 10
Name 12
1
2
ABCD EFGH IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Using the user name to search
There are four ways to select the user name:
(A) Touch the key of the user name.
The touched user name is highlighted.
If you accidentally select the wrong user name, touch the key of the correct name.
(B) Touch the [Default User] key.
The user name can be selected from the factory stored users.
(C) Touch the key.
An area for entering the "Registration No." [----] appears in the message display. Enter the "Registration No." set during user registration. This will allow you to select the user name.
(D) Touch the [Direct Entry] key.
A text entry screen appears. Directly enter the user name.
Searching is possible even if you only enter the first several letters of the user name.
After selecting the user name, touch the [OK] key.
After the user name is selected, the [Password] key can be touched. To search for files of the selected user name that have a certain password, touch the [Password] key and enter the password.
(It is not possible to search using a password only.)
Using the file name or folder name to search
Enter the file name in the text entry screen that appears and touch the [OK] key.
6-51
5
Search
User Name Name 1
File or Folder Name
Password file-01
Search within Current Folder
(1)
Cancel
(2)
Start Search
Start searching.
(1) Touch the [Search within Current Folder] checkbox so that it is selected .
To search only files that are in the current folder, select the [Search within Current Folder] checkbox .
Use this method to search for a file in a confidential folder.
(2) Touch the [Start Search] key.
The search results will appear in a screen similar to the following screen. A list of the files that match your search criteria will appear. Select the desired file from the list.
The job settings screen will appear.
Search
File or Folder Name file-01
User Name
Name 1
Cancel Search Again
Date
04/04/2010
1
1
To return to the base screen of document filing mode, touch the [Cancel] key.
To return to the file search screen, touch the [Search
Again] key.
6-52
CHAPTER 7
SYSTEM SETTINGS
This chapter explains the system settings, which are used to configure a variety of parameters to suit the aims and needs of your workplace. The current selections that have been made for the settings can be viewed or printed out.
To quickly check where a setting is located in the system settings menu, see "
SYSTEM SETTINGS MENU " (page 7-115),
" Accessing the System Settings (General)
" (page 7-5), or " Accessing the System Settings (Administrator) " (page 7-28).
Settings for Fax (Administrator) List " (page 7-106).
SYSTEM SETTINGS
System Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Common Operation Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
SYSTEM SETTINGS (GENERAL)
Accessing the System Settings (General) . . . . . . 7-5
System Settings (General) List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Total Count . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
• Job Count . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
• Device Count . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
Default Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
• Clock Adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
• Keyboard Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
List Print (User) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
Paper Tray Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
• Tray Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
• Paper Type Registration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
• Auto Tray Switching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
• Custom Size Registration (Bypass) . . . . . . . . . 7-15
Address Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16
• Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16
• Custom Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-20
• Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-21
Fax Data Receive/Forward . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-22
• I-Fax Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-22
Printer Condition Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-23
• Printer Default Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-23
• PCL Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-24
• PostScript Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-25
Document Filing Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-26
USB-Device Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-27
User Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-27
• Amend User Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-27
SYSTEM SETTINGS (ADMINISTRATOR)
(Administrator) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-28
• When User Authentication is not Enabled . . . . 7-28
• When User Authentication is Enabled . . . . . . . 7-29
System Settings (Administrator) List . . . . . . . . . 7-31
User Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-47
• User Authentication Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-47
• Other Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-48
• User List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-51
• Page Limit Group List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-53
• Authority Group List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-54
• Favourite Operation Group List . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-57
• User Count . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-59
Energy Save. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-61
Operation Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-62
• Other Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-62
• MFP Display Pattern Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-64
• Customize Key Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-64
• Home Screen Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-64
• Preview Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-66
• Remote Operation Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-66
• Soft Keyboard Template Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . 7-66
Device Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-67
• Other Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-67
• Original Size Detector Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-68
• Disabling of Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-69
• Fusing Control Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-69
Copy Function Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-70
• Initial Status Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-70
• Other Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-71
• Colour Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-73
7-1
Network Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-74
Printer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-75
• Default Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-75
• Interface Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-76
• Auto Colour Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-77
Image Send Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-78
• Operation Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-78
• Scan Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-82
• I-Fax Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-84
Document Filing Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-88
• Other Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-88
• Document Output Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-90
• Automatic Deletion of File Settings. . . . . . . . . . 7-90
List Print (Administrator) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-91
Security Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-92
Enable/Disable Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-93
Change Administrator Password . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-96
Product Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-96
Data Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-97
Storing/Calling of System Settings . . . . . . . . . . . 7-98
Sharp OSA Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-99
SYSTEM SETTINGS FOR FAX
System Settings for Fax (General) List . . . . . . . 7-100
Address Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-101
• Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-101
• F-Code Memory Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-103
Fax Data Receive/Forward . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-105
• Fax Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-105
System Settings for Fax (Administrator) List . . 7-106
Image Send Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-108
• Fax Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-108
SYSTEM SETTINGS MENU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-115
SYSTEM SETTINGS
7-2
SYSTEM SETTINGS
System Settings
The system settings are used to configure a variety of parameters to suit the aims and needs of your workplace. The system settings are also used to display or print out the current settings and status of the machine. The system settings allow you to make the machine easier to use.
The system settings consist of settings that are used by general users, and settings that can only be configured by an administrator of the machine. These two groups of settings are distinguished in this manual as follows.
System Settings (General)
System settings that can be configured by general users
(including the administrator). For example, the following settings can be configured:
System Settings (Administrator) *Login Required
System settings that can be configured by the administrator.
To configure these settings, login as an administrator is required. For example, the following settings can be configured:
• Date and time settings
• Paper tray settings (paper size and paper type)
• Storing destinations for the fax and scanner functions
• Settings related to the printer function
• Creating folders for document filing
• Displaying the number of pages printed, scanned, and faxed.
For more information, see "
"
• Storing users of the machine
• Energy save settings
• Settings related to the operation panel
• Settings for peripheral devices installed on the machine.
• Settings related to the copy function
• Network connection settings
• Transmission/reception settings for faxes and scanned images
• Advanced settings for the document filing function
For more information, see " SYSTEM SETTINGS
(ADMINISTRATOR) " (page 7-28).
Settings for general users
Settings for administrators
• Administrator password
To maintain security, the administrator of the machine should promptly change the password after the machine is purchased. (For the factory default administrator password, see "TO THE ADMINISTRATOR OF THE MACHINE" in the
Start Guide.) To change the password, see "
Change Administrator Password " (page 7-96).
*To ensure a high level of security, change the password at regular intervals.
• The above groupings of "General" and "Administrator" are used as a convenient means of clarifying the functions of the settings. These groupings do not appear in the touch panel.
• For fax settings, see "
SYSTEM SETTINGS FOR FAX " (page 7-100).
• Web pages
The system settings can also be configured from the Web pages. To configure the system settings from the Web pages, click [System Settings] in the Web page menu.
In addition to the system settings, network and security settings can also be configured in the Web pages. For information on the settings, see Help in the Web pages.
7-3
Common Operation Methods
This section explains special operation methods that are common to all system settings.
Be sure to read this section, as the information is omitted in the explanations of some of the individual settings.
Example: Address book screen
(1)
Address Book
Add New
Index Switch
ABC
Sorting Order
Search Number
(2)
(3)
Sort Address
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Freq.
ABCD
Back
All
EFGH IJKL
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
1
2
(4)
(5)
System Settings
Address Control
Address Type:
(6)
(7)
(8)
Search Number:
Address Name (Required):
Initial (Optional):
Key Name:
Custom Index:
(1-1000)
User 1
Register this Address to be added to the [Frequent Use] index.
Cancel OK
(9)
(10)
(11)
(1) "Sort"
Use this to select the method of displaying destinations and the index type.
Example: In the "Address Book" screen, the display can be switched between the following three methods:
• Alphabetical/User index
• Display by mode
• Ascending/Descending/Number order
(2) Index keys
Touch an index key to display the corresponding destinations. The index keys that appear vary depending on the "Sort" setting.
(3) (Search number entry box)
To search for an address, touch number.
and enter a search
When a user is searched for, the icon changes to .
(4) [Back] key
Returns you to the previous screen.
(5) Select box
Touch to display a list of the items that can be selected. Touch an item in the list to select it.
(6) Text box (numerical)
Touch this box to enter a number. Numbers are entered with the numeric keys.
If you make a mistake, press the [CLEAR] key ( ) to clear the incorrect number.
(7) Text box
Touch this box to open a text entry screen. When you have finished entering text in the screen, the text will appear in the text box.
(8) Checkbox
This switches between and each time you touch it. To enable the corresponding setting, touch the checkbox so that a checkmark appears . To disable the setting, clear the checkmark .
Radio buttons ( ) are also used to select settings in this way. (However, radio buttons are used to select a single item out of several.)
(9) [Cancel] key
This cancels a setting and returns you to the previous screen.
(10) [OK] key
Touch this to store the current settings.
(11) Scroll bar
Use this to scroll the screen up and down.
Touch the bar and slide it up or down to move the screen.
You can also move the screen up and down with the
keys.
7-4
SYSTEM SETTINGS (GENERAL)
This section describes the system settings that can be configured by general users of the machine.
Accessing the System Settings (General)
JOB STATUS PRINT
READY
DATA
SYSTEM
SETTINGS IMAGE SEND
LINE
DATA
HOME
LOGOUT
Make sure that the machine is in the standby state and then press the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key on the operation panel.
When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed, the following menu screen appears on the touch panel.
System Settings
Total Count
Paper Tray
Settings
Printer Condition
Settings
Default Settings
Address Control
Document Filing
Control
Admin Password Exit
List Print
(User)
Fax Data
Receive/Forward
USB-Device Check
Touch the item in this screen that you wish to configure.
For detailed explanations of each of the settings, see the following pages of this chapter.
• To quit the system settings, touch the [Exit] key in the top right corner of the screen.
• For the procedure to follow when user authentication is enabled, see "
USER AUTHENTICATION " (page 1-17) in
"1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
7-5
System Settings (General) List
When the system settings are accessed with general rights, the following items appear. For items that can only be
accessed with administrator rights, see " System Settings (Administrator) List " (page 7-31).
• Depending on the machine specifications and peripheral devices installed, it may not be possible to use some settings.
• For explanations of settings related to the fax function, see "
SYSTEM SETTINGS FOR FAX " (page 7-100).
Total Count
Item
■
●
●
Default Settings
Item
■
●
X
Clock Adjust
Specify Time Zone
Date & Time Settings
Synchronize with Internet Time Server
X
Daylight Saving Time Setting
Select Setting Type
Start Time
Completing Time
Adjustment Time
X
Date Format
●
List Print (User)
Item
■
● All Custom Setting List
●
Printer Test Page
● Sending Address List
●
Document Filing Folder List*
* When the hard disk drive is installed.
–
–
–
–
–
–
Factory default setting
Factory default setting
–
–
Disable
Varies depending on country and region
Varies depending on country and region
Varies depending on country and region
Varies depending on country and region
Varies depending on country and region
Varies depending on country and region
Varies depending on country and region
Factory default setting
Page
Page
Page
7-6
Paper Tray Settings
Item
■
●
X
Tray 1
X
Tray 2*
X
Tray 3*
X
Tray 4*
X
Bypass
Select Similar Sizes for Auto Detection
●
●
●
Custom Size Registration (Bypass)
* When a paper drawer is installed.
Address Control
Item
■
●
●
●
Fax Data Receive/Forward
Item
■
●
*
X
Reception Start
X
Manual Reception Key in Initial Screen
X
Forward Received Data
* When the Internet fax expansion kit is installed.
Factory default setting Page
Plain, A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
Plain, Auto-AB (Auto-Inch)
Plain, Auto-AB (Auto-Inch)
Auto-AB: 216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")
Auto-Inch: 8-1/2" x 14"
–
Enabled
Custom 1: X=432 mm (17"),
Y=297 mm (11")
Custom 2: X=432 mm (17"),
Y=297 mm (11")
Custom 3: X=432 mm (17"),
Y=297 mm (11")
Factory default setting
–
User 1
–
Page
–
Enabled
–
Factory default setting Page
7-7
Printer Condition Settings
Item
■
1
●
X
Copies
X
Orientation
X
Default Paper Size
X
Default Output Tray
X
Default Paper Type
X
Initial Resolution Setting
X
Disable Blank Page Print
X
Line Thickness
X
2-Sided Print
X
Colour Mode
X
N-Up Print
X
Fit To Page
X
Output
Print per Unit
X
Quick File
●
X
PCL Symbol Set Setting
X
PCL Font Setting
X
PCL Line Feed Code
X
Wide A4
●
2
X
Print PS Errors
X
Binary Processing
*1 When the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.
*2 When the PS3 expansion kit is installed.
Factory default setting Page
1
Portrait
A4 (8-1/2" x 11")
Varies depending on the machine configuration
Plain Paper
600dpi (High Quality)
Disabled
5
1-Sided
Auto
1-Up
Enabled
Varies depending on the machine configuration
Enabled
Disabled
PC-8
Internal Font, 0: Courier
0.CR=CR; LF=LF; FF=FF
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
7-8
Document Filing Control *
Item
■
* When the hard disk expansion kit is installed.
USB-Device Check
Item
■
Factory default setting
–
Factory default setting
Page
Page
User Control
Item Factory default setting Page
■
*
●
–
* When user authentication is enabled and the logged-in user does not have the authority to configure the system settings
(administrator) (excluding factory default users).
7-9
Total Count
This function shows the page count in each mode. Touch the [Total Count] key.
Job Count
This displays or prints out the counts of all jobs.
• A3 (11" x 17") size paper is counted as two sheets.
• Each sheet of paper used for automatic two-sided copying is counted as two pages (A3 (11" x 17") paper is counted as four pages).
• An entered paper size of 384 mm (15-1/8") or larger is counted as two pages.
• Pages printed directly from the machine such as list prints are included in the "Other Prints" count.
• The items displayed (or printed) will vary depending on the machine specifications and peripheral devices installed.
Device Count
This is used to display or print the counts of the peripheral devices installed on the machine.
• Document feeder
Each sheet is counted as two pages when two-sided scanning is performed.
• Stapler (when a finisher is installed)
Two-position stapling and pamphlet stapling are counted as "2".
• The items displayed (or printed) will vary depending on the machine specifications and peripheral devices installed.
7-10
Default Settings
The default settings for operation of the machine can be configured. Touch the [Default Settings] key and select the settings.
Clock Adjust
Use this to set the date and time in the machine's built-in clock.
Set the time.
Item
Specify Time Zone
Date&Time Settings
Synchronize with Internet Time Server
Settings
If your region is ahead of GMT (Greenwich Mean Time), select [+]. If your region is behind GMT, select [-]. Next, specify the time difference between your region and
GMT in hours and minutes.
Select and set the year, month, day, hour, and minute.
This can be used when the machine is connected to the Internet. The machine's time is automatically adjusted to the time of an Internet time server.
Daylight Saving Time Setting
Enable daylight saving time.
Start Time
Item
Daylight Saving Time Setting
Select Setting Type
Settings
Select whether or not the Daylight Saving Time Setting is enabled. If disabled, the following settings will not be possible.
Specify whether the starting and ending day of daylight saving time are to be set using the day of the week or the date.
Set the starting time of daylight saving time. Set the starting month. If you selected "Day of the Week" in "Select Setting Type", set the starting week of daylight saving time and then the starting day. If you selected "Date" in "Select Setting Type", set the starting date.
Set the hour and minute and the UTC (Coordinated Universal Time) setting.
Completing Time
Set the ending time of daylight saving time in the same way as you set the starting time.
Adjustment Time Set the time that adjustment will take place when daylight saving time begins.
When this function is used, the time changes at the beginning and end of daylight saving time as indicated in the table below.
Europe*
Area Standard time ➞ Daylight saving time
Last Sunday in March, 1:00 to 2:00 AM
Daylight saving time ➞ Standard time
Last Sunday in October, 1:00 to 0:00 AM
Australia, New Zealand Last Sunday in October, 2:00 to 3:00 AM Last Sunday in March 3:00 to 2:00 AM
Other countries Select the [Daylight Saving Time Setting] checkbox so that a checkmark appears. The clock setting is configured to normal time plus one hour. When the is selected, clock returns to normal time.
* In some countries, the starting and ending times of daylight saving time may be different than the times set in the machine.
7-11
Date Format
The format used to print the date on lists and other output can be changed.
Item
Current Setting
Format
Separator
Day-Name Position
Time Display
Settings
The current time appears in the format set in the date format settings.
Set the order of display of the year, month, and day.
Select one of three symbols or a blank space for the separator used in the date.
Select whether the day name appears before or after the date.
Select 12-hour format or 24-hour format for the time.
12-Hour Display: 12:00AM to 11:59AM/12:00 to 11:59PM
24-Hour Display: 00:00 to 24:00
cannot be set.
Keyboard Select
The layout of the keyboard that appears in text entry screens can be changed.
The keyboard layouts that can be selected are shown below.
English (US)
Norwegian
English (UK)
Finnish
Japanese
Danish
French
Russian
German
Greek
Swedish
Turkish
List Print (User)
Lists showing the settings and information stored in the machine can be printed. Touch the [List Print (User)] key and select the settings.
List name
All Custom Setting List
Description
This list shows the hardware status, software status, printer condition settings, paper tray settings, and total counts.
Printer Test Page
Sending Address List
This is used to print the PCL Symbol Set List, various font lists, and the NIC page
(network interface settings, etc.).
• PCL Symbol Set List
• PCL Internal Font List
• PCL Extended Font List
• PS Font List
• PS Extended Font List
• NIC Page
Lists can be printed of various addresses stored in the machine.
• Individual List
• Group List
• Program List
• Memory Box List
• All Sending Address List
Document Filing Folder List * This shows the folder names for document filing.
* When the hard disk expansion kit is installed.
• The items that appear will vary depending on the functions that have been added to the machine.
to print a test page.
7-12
Paper Tray Settings
Paper tray and paper type settings are explained in this section. Touch the [Paper Tray Settings] key to configure the settings.
Tray Settings
These settings specify the paper type, paper size, and functions allowed for each paper tray.
When the [Tray Settings] key is touched, a list appears showing the trays and the current settings.
Tray Settings Back
Type
Size
Fixed Paper Side
Tray 1
Plain
A4
Paper Property
Disable Duplex Disable Staple
Change
Disable Punch
1
6
Feeding Approved Job
Fax I-Fax Copy Doc. Filing
Settings of each tray
Touch the [Change] key in the above screen to change the settings.
The following settings can be configured.
Item
Type
Size
Feeding Approved Job
Description
Select the type of paper that is loaded in the tray.
The paper types that can be selected vary by paper tray. For more information, see
"
To store a new paper type, see " Paper Type Registration " (page 7-15).
Select the paper size from the list. The paper sizes that can be selected vary by tray.
The sizes that can be selected may also be restricted by the paper type selected above. For more information, see "
If the desired size does not appear in the list, select [Custom Size] and directly enter the size (only for the bypass tray). For more information, see "
Select the modes that can be used. If there is a function that you do not wish to be used with the selected tray, disable the function.
When the "Type" is other than plain paper, recycled paper, coloured paper, or a user type, [Fax] and [Internet Fax] cannot be selected.
• If the paper size specified here is different from the size of paper that is loaded in a tray, a problem or misfeed may result when printing.
To change the paper size in a tray, see "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
• Paper properties such as "Fixed Paper Side" are automatically set when the paper type is selected. The paper tray properties cannot be changed in this screen.
(except for the bypass tray) cannot be configured.
7-13
Tray Settings
Paper Tray
Tray 1
Paper Type
Plain, Pre-Printed,
Recycled, Letter Head,
Pre-Punched, Colour,
Heavy Paper 1* 1 , User
Type
Auto-AB (A3, A4, A4R, B4, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 330 mm(8-1/2" x 13")),
Auto-Inch (11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R,
7-1/4" x 10-1/2"R)
8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2"), 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R, A5R,
8K, 16K, 16KR
Size
A3, A4, A4R, A5R, B4, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13"),
216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2"),
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm), 8-1/2" x 11",
8-1/2" x 11"R, 7-1/4" x 10-1/2"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R, 8K, 16K, 16KR
Tray 2
(When a paper drawer is installed.)
Tray 3
(When a paper drawer is installed.)
Tray 4
(When a paper drawer is installed.)
Bypass
In addition to the paper types of trays 1 to 4,
Heavy Paper 2*
Thin Paper,
Glossy Paper
Labels
1 ,
Auto-AB (A3W, A3, B4, A4, A4R, A5R, B5, B5R, 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 11",
216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")* 2 , 216 mm x 340 mm
(8-1/2" x 13-2/5")* 2 , 216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2")* 2 ) ,
Auto-Inch (12" x 18", 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14"* 2 , 8-1/2" x 13-2/5"
(216 mm x 340 mm)* 2 , 8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 7-1/4" x 10-1/2"R,
5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R, A3, A4, B4, B5) ,
Size Input-AB (X=140 mm (When a finisher is installed, 148 mm) to
432 mm, Y=90 mm to 297 mm),
Size Input-Inch (X=5-1/2" (When a finisher is installed, 5-7/8") to 17",
Y=3-5/8" to 11-5/8"),
8K, 16K, 16KR, Custom 1, Custom 2, Custom 3
Auto-AB (A4, A4R, B5, B5R), Auto-Inch (8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R),
Custom Size
Transparency
Tab Paper
Auto-AB (A4, A4R), Auto-Inch (8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R)
Auto-AB (A4), Auto-Inch (8-1/2" x 11")
Envelope Com-10, Monarch, DL, C5
*1 Heavy Paper 1:106 g /m 2 to 209 g /m 2 (28 lbs bond to 110 lbs index) heavy paper
Heavy Paper 2:210 g /m 2 to 256 g /m 2 (110 lbs index to 140 lbs index) heavy paper
*2 The size that is automatically detected is set in "
Select Similar Sizes for Auto Detection " in the bypass tray settings screen (see below).
Select Similar Sizes for Auto Detection
"Select Similar Sizes for Auto Detection" in the bypass tray settings screen is used to select the paper size that is automatically detected from similar sizes when automatic paper size detection takes place.
Select one of two sizes when "Auto-Inch" is set. Select one of three sizes when "Auto-AB" is set.
When paper that is the same size as one of the paper sizes in the settings is placed in the bypass tray, the size that is selected in the settings will be automatically detected.
Auto-AB
Auto-Inch
216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13"), 216 mm x 340 mm (8-1/2" x 13-2/5"),
216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm)
7-14
Paper Type Registration
Store a paper type when the desired paper type does not appear as a selection or when you wish to create a new set of paper properties.
Up to 7 paper types can be stored.
Item
Type Name
Fixed Paper Side
Disable Duplex
Disable Staple
Disable Punch
Description
Store any name.
The factory default names are "User Type 1" - "User Type 7".
Enable this setting when paper with a front and reverse side is used.
Enable this setting when paper is loaded that cannot used for two-sided printing.
Enable this setting when paper is used that cannot be stapled.
Enable this setting when paper is used that cannot be punched.
The settings that can be selected vary depending on the peripheral devices installed.
Auto Tray Switching
When a tray runs out of paper during printing, this determines whether or not another tray with the same size and type of paper is automatically selected and printing continues.
Custom Size Registration (Bypass)
If you frequently use a special non-standard paper size in the bypass tray, you can store that paper size.
Storing the paper size saves you the trouble of setting the size each time you need to use it.
Up to three paper sizes can be stored.
Touch the key ([Custom 1] to [Custom 3]) in which you wish to store or change a paper size. The following screen will appear:
System Settings
Custom 1 Cancel OK
Size Input-AB
Size Input-Inch
X 432
mm (148-432)
Y 297
mm (100-297)
Select whether you wish to enter the size in mm ("Size Input-AB") or inches ("Size Input-Inch"), and then set the X and Y dimensions of the paper.
"Size Input-AB"
The X dimension can be set to a value from 140 mm (when a finisher is installed, 148 mm) to 432 mm. The factory default setting is 420 mm.
The Y dimension can be set to a value from 90 mm to 297 mm. The factory default setting is 297 mm.
"Size Input-Inch"
The X dimension can be set to a value from 5-1/2" (when a finisher is installed, 5-7/8") to 17". The factory default setting is 17".
The Y dimension can be set to a value from 3-5/8" to 11-5/8". The factory default setting is 11".
7-15
Address Control
Address Control is used to store, edit, and delete one-touch keys, group keys, program keys, and custom indexes.
Touch the [Address Control] key to configure the settings.
• The settings that can be selected vary depending on the peripheral devices installed.
• For explanations of settings related to the fax function, see "
SYSTEM SETTINGS FOR FAX " (page 7-100).
Address Book
Destinations can be stored in the address book for easy retrieval.
When the [Address Book] key is touched, the following screen appears.
Address Book
Add New
Index Switch
ABC
Sorting Order
Search Number
Sort Address
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Freq.
ABCD
Back
All
EFGH IJKL
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
1
2
• [Add New] key
Use this to add a new address.
• List display
This displays a list of the currently stored addresses.
An address can be selected to open an edit/delete screen for the address.
Storing addresses
Touch the [Add New] key in the above screen to store an address. Up to 1000 addresses can be programmed.
For more information, see "
• When "
Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel " (page 7-79) is enabled in the system settings
(administrator) for a function, addresses cannot be stored for that function.
• To store addresses for Scan to FTP, Scan to Network Folder, and Scan to Desktop...
Store Scan to FTP and Scan to Network addresses in the Web pages. Store Scan to Desktop addresses using Network
Scanner Tool. A combined maximum of 200 addresses can be stored for these three scanning methods.
Editing and deleting addresses
An address can be selected from the list in the above screen to open an edit/delete screen for the address.
For more information, see "
Delete an address with the [Delete] key.
• If you cannot edit or delete a one-touch individual or group key...
Individual keys and group keys cannot be edited or deleted in the following situations:
- The key is used in a reserved transmission or a transmission in progress.
- The key is included in a group key.
- The key is included in a program.
- The key is specified as a forwarding destination in the "
Default Address Setting " (page 7-83) or "Inbound Routing
Settings" / "Document Administration Function" (in the Web pages).
- When "
Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel " (page 7-79) is enabled.
If the key is used in a reserved transmission or a transmission that is in progress, cancel the transmission or wait until it is completed and then edit or delete the key.
If the key is included in a group, first delete the key from the group and then edit or delete the key.
If the key is specified as a forwarding destination, cancel the forwarding destination setting and then edit or delete the key. If
"Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel" has been enabled, clear this function and then edit or delete the key.
7-16
Settings
Item
Items stored in all modes
Description
Address Type
Search Number
Select the type of address to be stored in the address book.
• E-mail: Store an e-mail address in a one-touch key.
• Internet Fax: Store an Internet fax address in a one-touch key.
• Direct SMTP:Store a Direct SMTP address in a one-touch key.
• Fax:
• Group:
Store a fax number in a one-touch key.
Store multiple addresses as a group for a broadcast transmission.
Set a search number. The lowest available number is automatically entered. To change the number, enter a number from 0001 to 1000. A search number that has already been stored cannot be used.
Address Name
Initial
Key Name
Enter a maximum of 36 characters for the address name.
Enter up to 10 characters for the initials. The initials you enter here determine the position of the one-touch key in the alphabetical index.
Enter the name that you wish to appear in the address book (this is different from the address name).
Select the custom index in which the address will appear.
Custom Index
Register this Address to be added to the
[Frequent Use] index.
File Format
Frequently used addresses can be stored in the [Frequent Use] index.
Items appearing when an e-mail address is stored
E-mail Address Enter an e-mail address (max. 64 characters).
Specify the format of the file to be generated and the compression mode for black & white mode and colour mode.
• File Type: Set the format of the file to be generated.
• Compression Mode (Black & White): Select the compression mode for black & white transmission.
• Compression Ratio (Colour/Greyscale):Select the compression ratio for colour/greyscale transmission.
Items appearing when an Internet fax address is stored
I-Fax Address Enter an Internet fax address (max. 64 characters).
File Format
Request Internet Fax Reception Report
Compression Mode: Select the compression mode for transmission.
Select whether or not you wish to receive a reception report by e-mail after transmission is completed.
7-17
Item Description
Items appearing when a Direct SMTP address is stored
• Direct SMTP Address
• Add Hostname or IP Address Too
• Hostname or IP Address
File Format
Use these three settings to set an address for Direct SMTP transmission.
In many cases, transmission is possible using method (1).
A maximum of 64 characters each can be entered in the "Direct SMTP Address" and
"Hostname or IP Address" text boxes.
(1) Using the IPv4 address of the receiving machine in the domain part of the e-mail address
Enter the e-mail address of the receiving machine in the [Direct SMTP Address] text box with the IPv4 address substituted for the domain.
Example:When the e-mail address of the receiving machine is
"user@sample_domain.com" and the IPv4 address is "192.168.123.45"
Enter " [email protected]
" in the [Direct SMTP Address] text box.
(2) Using the host name in the domain part of the e-mail address of the receiving machine
Enter the e-mail address of the receiving machine in the [Direct SMTP Address] text box with the host name substituted for the domain.
Example:When the e-mail address of the receiving machine is
"user@sample_domain.com" and the host name is "HOST"
Enter " user@HOST " in the [Direct SMTP Address] text box.
(3) When the receiving machine is set to only receive e-mail from specific addresses
Enter the specified specific e-mail address in the [Direct SMTP Address] text box.
Select the "Add Hostname or IP Address Too" checkbox and enter the host name or IPv4 address of the receiving machine in the [Hostname or IP Address] text box.
Example:When the e-mail address of the receiving machine is
"user@sample_domain.com" and the IPv4 address is "192.168.123.45"
Enter " user@sample_domain.com
" in the [Direct SMTP Address] text box and enter " 192.168.123.45
" in the [Hostname or IP Address] text box.
Compression Mode: Select the compression mode for transmission.
Items appearing when a group is stored
Address
• Address:
• Direct Entry:
Select addresses from the address book to be stored in the group.
An address that is not stored in the address book can be directly entered. Enter the address in the same way as when storing an address for a mode. Note that when an Internet fax address is directly entered, the compression mode and reception report cannot be selected.
• Address Review: This displays a list of the selected addresses. Addresses can be deleted from this list if needed.
Storing group keys
This section explains the procedure for storing group keys.
Touch the [Address Control] key.
1
7-18
Touch the [Address Book] key.
2
3
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
Touch the [Add New] key.
Select "Group" from the [Address Type] list.
4
5
6
(1-1000)
(1-1000)
Set the [Group Name], [Initial], and [Key
Name] settings. (Other settings can be adjusted as necessary.)
Use the scroll bar to display the lower part of the screen, and touch the
[Address Book] key.
Touch the [Direct Entry] key to store an address that is not stored in a one-touch key.
7-19
Touch the one-touch keys that you want to add to the group. (Three keys are added in this example.)
7
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
Touch the [OK] key.
8
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
Touch the [OK] key.
(1-1000) 9
Touch the [OK] key on the dialog box that appears.
10
11
The group key registration screen appears. If you want to finish, touch [Cancel] key to return to the previous screen.
The procedure is complete.
Custom Index
The name of a custom index can be changed for greater ease of use.
Delete the previously entered name and enter a new name (maximum of 6 characters).
The factory default names for the custom indexes are "User 1" to "User 6".
7-20
Program
If you frequently use the same settings and/or functions to transmit to the same destination or destinations, the settings and destinations can be stored in a program. This allows the settings and destinations to be selected by simply selecting the program.
When the [Program] key is touched, the following screen appears.
System Settings
Program
Add New
Back
Program 1
Program 3
Program 5
Program 7
Program 9
Program 11
Program 2
Program 4
Program 6
Program 8
Program 10
Program 12
• [Add New] key
Use this to add a new program.
• List display
This displays a list of the currently stored programs. A program can be selected to open an edit/delete screen for the program.
Storing a program
Touch the [Add New] key in the above screen to open a registration screen. Up to 48 programs can be stored.
For more information, see "
• A timer setting cannot be included in a program.
• At least one one-touch key must be specified in a program or the program cannot be stored.
Editing and deleting programs
A program can be selected from the list in the above screen to open an edit/delete screen for the program.
For more information, see "
Delete a program with the [Delete] key.
Settings
Program Number
Program Name
Address
Address Book screen
Condition Settings
Address Mode Setting
Mode Settings
Item Description
Set the number to be assigned to the program. The lowest available number is automatically entered. To change the number, enter a number from 01 to 48.
A number that has already been stored cannot be used.
Enter a maximum of 18 characters for the program name.
Select the address(es) to be used in the program from the address book. Up to 500 destinations can be stored in one program.
This displays a list of the currently stored addresses.
Touch the [Setup] key to open the condition settings screen for an address.
Select the mode in which the address is used (Internet fax, scan, etc.) When a mode is selected, the settings for that mode appear.
Frequently used settings can be stored in the same way as when they are selected for a mode.
7-21
Fax Data Receive/Forward
This section explains settings for reception and forwarding. Touch the [Fax Data Receive/Forward] key and configure the settings.
For explanations of settings related to the fax function, see "
SYSTEM SETTINGS FOR FAX " (page 7-100).
I-Fax Settings
These settings can be configured when the hard disk drive and Internet fax expansion kit are installed.
Reception Start
Touch this key to immediately connect to your mail server (POP3 server) and check for received Internet faxes. If you have received Internet faxes, the faxes will be retrieved and printed.
To use this function, POP3 server settings must be configured. Configure these settings in the screen that appears when
[Application Settings] - [Internet Fax Settings] is selected in the Web page menu.
Manual Reception Key in Initial Screen
This displays the [I-Fax Manual Reception] key in the base screen of Internet fax mode.
Forward Received Data
When the machine cannot print because it is out of paper or out of toner, received faxes can be forwarded to another
Internet fax machine.
• To store a forwarding address, see "
Set Address for Data Forwarding " (page 7-86) in the system settings (administrator).
• If forwarding was not successful because the transmission was cancelled or a communication error occurred, the faxes that were to be forwarded will return to the print queue on the machine.
• If the initial pages of a fax were successfully printed, only those pages that were not printed will be forwarded.
• Forwarding is not possible if no faxes were received or a forwarding address is not programmed.
correct password with the numeric keys.
To cancel forwarding...
Press the [JOB STATUS] key, and then cancel the forwarding job in the same way as a transmission job.
7-22
Printer Condition Settings
The Printer Condition Settings are used to configure basic printer settings and settings for printing from a DOS application. To configure the settings, touch the [Printer Condition Settings] key.
These settings can be used when the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.
Printer Default Settings
The default settings are used to set advanced print conditions for printing in an environment where the print driver is not used (such as printing from MS-DOS or from a computer that does not have the provided print driver installed).
When printing using the printer driver, the printer driver settings take precedence over the printer condition settings.
Settings
Copies
Orientation
Default Paper Type
Initial Resolution Setting
Disable Blank Page Print
Line Thickness* 2
2-Sided Print
Colour Mode
N-Up Print* 3
Fit To Page* 4
Output
Item
Default Paper Size
Default Output Tray
Selections
1 - 999 sets
• Portrait
• Horizontal
A3, B4, A4, B5, A5, 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 13", 8-1/2" x 11", 7-1/4" x 10-1/2",
5-1/2" x 8-1/2", 8k, 16k
• Centre Tray
• Offset Tray* 1
• Right Tray
•
•
Plain Paper, Letter Head, Pre-Printed, Pre-Punched, Recycle Paper, Colour
• 600 dpi
• 600 dpi (High Quality)
(Disabled)
(Enabled)
0-9
• 1-Sided
• 2-Sided (Book)
• 2-Sided (Tablet)
• Auto
• Black & White
•
•
• 1-Up
• 2-Up
• 4-Up
(Use Fit to Page)
(Do not use Fit to Page)
•
•
•
(Use Print per Unit)
• (Do not use Print per Unit)
• Staple Position* 1 : None, 1 Staple at Back, 2 Staples, 2 Staples (Top)
(Use Punch)
(Do not use Punch)
7-23
Item Selections
Quick File
•
•
(Disabled)
(Enabled)
*1 When a finisher is installed.
*2 This setting is used to adjust the line width of vector graphics (black & white printing only). Except for CAD and other specialized uses, there is normally no need to change this setting. When "0" is selected, all lines are printed at a width of 1 dot.
*3 Paper sizes that can be used with this function are A3, B4, A4, 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", and 8-1/2" x 11". (This function may not take effect with some print methods.)
*4 Only effective when printing PDF, JPEG, and TIFF files.
PCL Settings
This is used to set the symbol sets, fonts, and line feed code used in a PCL environment.
Settings
Item
PCL Symbol Set Setting
PCL Font Setting
PCL Line Feed Code
Wide A4
Description
Specify the symbol set used for printing.
Use this to select the font used for printing.
This setting is used to select how the printer responds when a line feed command is received.
Selections
Select from 35 items.
•
•
• Internal Font
• Extended Font
(List of internal fonts when extended fonts are not installed.)
• 0.CR=CR; LF=LF; FF=FF
• 1.CR=CR+LF; LF=LF;FF=FF
• 2.CR=CR; LF=CR+LF; FF=CR+FF
• 3.CR=CR+LF; LF=CR+LF; FF=CR+FF
(Enabled)
(Disabled)
When this is enabled, 80 characters per line can be printed on A4 size paper using a 10-pitch font. (When this setting is disabled, up to 78 characters can be printed per line.)
7-24
PostScript Setting
When an error occurs during PostScript printing, these settings determine whether or not an error notice is printed and whether or not the PostScript data is received in binary format.
Settings
Print PS Error
Item
Binary Processing
Description
When a PS (PostScript) error occurs during PostScript printing, this setting determines whether or not an error notice is printed.
Receive PostScript data in binary format.
•
•
•
•
(Enabled)
(Disabled)
(Enabled)
(Disabled)
Selections
This setting can be configured when the PS3 expansion kit is installed.
7-25
Document Filing Control
This function requires the hard disk drive.
Document Filing Control is used to create, edit, and delete custom folders for document filing. Touch the [Document
Filing Control] key to configure the settings.
When the [Document Filing Control] key is touched, the following screen will appear.
Folder List Back
Add New
Sort Up
All Folders
User 1
User 3
User 5
User 7
User 9
ABCD EFGHI JKLMN
User 2
User 4
User 6
User 8
User 10
OPQRST UVWXYZ
1
2
• [Add New] key
Use this to add a new custom folder.
• List display
This displays a list of the currently configured custom folders. A folder can be selected to open an edit/delete screen for the folder.
Creating a custom folder
Touch the [Add New] key in the above screen to open a registration screen. Up to 1000 custom folders can be created.
For more information, see "
Editing/deleting a custom folder
A custom folder can be selected from the list in the above screen to open an edit/delete screen for the folder.
For more information, see "
Delete a folder with the [Delete] key.
• If the folder has a password, the correct password must be entered before a file can be deleted.
• A folder that contains files cannot be deleted. Either move the files to a different folder or delete them before deleting the folder.
Settings
Item
Folder Name
Initial of Folder
Password of Folder
Select User Name
Description
Enter a name (maximum of 28 characters) for the custom folder to be created. A name cannot be stored if it is already being used for another folder.
Enter up to 10 characters for the initials. The initials you enter here determine the position of the one-touch key in the alphabetical index.
To set a password for the folder, enter the desired number (5 to 8 digits).
Select the desired user name from the user list.
7-26
USB-Device Check
This lets you check the connection when a USB device is connected to the machine. Touch the [USB-Device Check] key to check the connection.
The status of a USB device that is not compatible with the machine will not appear.
User Control
This section explains settings for user control. Touch the [User Control] key to configure the settings.
• User Control settings can only be configured when "
User Authentication Setting " (page 7-47) is enabled.
• Depending on the user that logged in, it may not be possible to use the settings below.
Amend User Information
The information of the currently logged in user can be edited.
Settings
User Name
Initial
Index
Login Name
Item
Password
My Folder
E-mail Address
Authentication Settings
Pages Limit Group
Authority Group
Favourite Operation Group
User Number
Deleting an account
Description
Edit the name of the user (max. 32 characters). This user name is used as the key name in the login screen, the document filing user name, and the sender name. (The user name must be unique.)
Edit the initials (maximum of 10 characters). The initials determine where the user name will appear in the user name list.
Select the desired custom index. The custom index names are the same as those in the address book.
This cannot be edited.
Enter the password used for user authentication by login name and password (1 to
32 characters). (The password can be omitted.)
This cannot be edited.
This cannot be edited.
This cannot be edited.
This cannot be edited.
This cannot be edited.
The favourite operation group that will be applied at login appears.
Check with your administrator for the settings of the Favourite Operation Groups.
This cannot be edited.
This cannot be edited.
The items that appear will vary depending on the user authentication method that is enabled.
7-27
SYSTEM SETTINGS
(ADMINISTRATOR)
This section explains the system settings that are configured by the administrator of the machine.
Accessing the System Settings (Administrator)
To access the system settings (administrator), the administrator must log in as explained below.
When User Authentication is not Enabled
Touch the [Admin Password] key.
1
System Settings
Total Count
Paper Tray
Settings
Printer Condition
Settings
Default Settings
Address Control
Document Filing
Control
Admin Password Exit
List Print
(User)
Fax Data
Receive/Forward
USB-Device Check
2
System Settings
Admin Password
Enter the administrator password. (From 5 to 32 characters)
Cancel
Password
Press here for keyboard.
OK
Log in.
(1) Touch the [Password] text box and enter the administrator password.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
(1) (2)
This completes the administrator login procedure. The system settings (administrator) can be used.
• User authentication is initially disabled (factory default setting).
• To logout...
Touch the [Logout] key in the top right corner of the screen. You can also touch the [Exit] key to quit the system settings.
(If Auto Clear activates, logout will automatically take place.)
7-28
When User Authentication is Enabled
When " User Authentication Setting " (page 7-47) is enabled, follow the procedure below to log in.
When auto login is enabled, the login screen will not appear.
When user authentication is by login name and password (and e-mail address)
Administrator login is performed in the user selection screen. For more information on the login procedure when user authentication is enabled, see "
USER AUTHENTICATION " (page 1-17) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
1
Device Account Mode User Selection
6 12 18
Admin Login
Direct Entry
Name 1
Name 3
Name 5
Name 7
Name 9
Name 11
All ABCD
ABC
User
EFGH
Back
Name 2
Name 4
Name 6
Name 8
Name 10
Name 12
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
Touch the [Admin Login] key.
2
(1)
User Authentication
Login Name
User Name
Password
Administrator
Auth to: Login Locally
OK
Log in.
(1) Touch the [Password] key.
Enter the administrator password in the administrator password entry screen.
(2) Touch the [OK] key.
(2)
• If login name / password / e-mail address is selected for the authentication method, the [E-mail Address] key will appear below the "User Name".
• For the factory default administrator password, see "TO THE ADMINISTRATOR OF THE MACHINE" in the Start
Guide.
• This completes the administrator login procedure. The system settings (administrator) can be used.
7-29
Login by user number
User Authentication OK
Touch the [Admin Login] key.
Enter the administrator password in the administrator password entry screen.
This completes the administrator login procedure. The system settings (administrator) can be used.
Admin Login
• In addition to login by touching the [Admin Login] key, the system settings (administrator) can also be accessed when login is performed by selecting a user with administrator rights from the user list or by entering a user number with administrator rights. For more information on login procedures when user authentication is enabled, see "
(page 1-17) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
• To logout...
Press the [LOGOUT] ( ) key. (Except when entering a fax number.)
(If Auto Clear activates, logout will automatically take place.)
7-30
System Settings (Administrator) List
The system settings that appear following administrator login are shown below. The default setting for each item is also shown.
• Depending on the machine specifications and peripheral devices installed, it may not be possible to use some settings.
• For information on the general settings, see "
System Settings (General) List " (page 7-6).
• For explanations of settings related to the fax function, see "
SYSTEM SETTINGS FOR FAX " (page 7-100).
User Control
Item Factory default setting
■
●
X
X
Disabled
Authenticate a User by Login Name and Password
X
●
X
Actions when the Limit of Pages for Output Jobs
Disabled
Job is Completed even when the Limit of Pages is Reached
X
The Number of User Name Displayed Setting
X
X
Disabling of Printing by Invalid User
X
Automatically print stored jobs after login
X
Default Network Authentication Server Setting
X
Perform LDAP server access control.
X
Display Usage Status after Login
X
●
●
●
●
Favourite Operation Group List *
1
X
Favourite Operation Group Registration *
1
X
1
●
●
* 2
X
Card Reader Device Registration
12
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
–
Disabled
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
*1 This cannot be set on the machine. Set this in "User Control" in the Web pages.
*2 When the HID card reader is available.
Page
7-31
Energy save
Item
■
●
X
X
Copy*
●
●
●
* This function is not available in some countries and regions.
Operation Settings
Item
■
●
X
Key Touch Sound at Initial Point
X
Cancel Auto Clear Timer
X
X
X
X
Disabling of Job Priority Operation
X
X
Disable Auto Key Repeat
X
X
Disabling of Covers/Inserts Mode
X
X
Initial Original Count Setting
●
●
1
X
Copy
Customize 1
Customize 2
Customize 3
7-32
Factory default setting
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Fix transition time.
1 min.
Page
Factory default setting
Middle
Disabled
60 sec.
Disabled
6 sec.
Varies depending on country and region
Off
Disabled
Disabled
0.0 sec.
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Varies depending on country and region
All disabled
Pattern 4
Page
File
Quick File
–
X
Scan
Customize 1
Customize 2
Customize 3
X
Internet Fax* 2
(Same as Scan)
X
Fax* 3
(Same as Scan)
X
USB Memory Scan
Customize 1
Customize 2
Customize 3
X
Data Entry* 4
(Same as Scan)
●
* 1
X
* 1
●
X
Default Preview
X
Default Preview Display
Copy
Image Send
Item
Doc. Filing
X
Received Data Image Check Setting
X
Default List/Thumbnail Display
●
X
Remote Software Operation
Operational Authority
View Password Entry Screen
Page Factory default setting
Address Review
File
Quick File
–
–
–
–
–
All disabled
Full Page
Scan Send: Full Page
Internet Fax Send: Full Page
Fax Send: Full Page
Data Entry: Full Page
USB Memory: Full Page
Reception Data: Twice
Memory Box: Twice
Image Check: Twice
Scan to HDD: Full Page
Disabled
List
Prohibited
Display in Both PC and MFP
7-33
Item Factory default setting
X
Operation from Specified PC
Operational Authority
Hostname or IP Address of PC
View Password Entry Screen
Prohibited
–
Display in Both PC and MFP
X
Operation by User who Has Password
Operational Authority
View Password Entry Screen
●
Soft Keyboard Template Setting
Prohibited
Display in Both PC and MFP
–
*1 This cannot be set on the machine. Set this in the system settings in the Web pages.
*2 When the Internet fax expansion kit is installed.
*3 When the facsimile expansion kit is installed.
*4 When the application integration module is installed.
*5 When the hard disk expansion kit is installed.
Device Control
Item
■
●
X
X
X
IP Address of Slave Machine
Port Number
Disabling of Master Machine Mode
Disabling of Slave Machine Mode
X
Detect Standard in Auto Colour Mode
X
X
X
*
●
Original Size Detector Setting
X
Original Detection Size Combination
X
Cancel Detection at Document Glass
●
X
Disabling of Document Feeder *
1
X
X
Disabling of Optional Paper Drawer
* 3
X
X
4
–
–
Factory default setting
All Disabled
Plain Paper
0.0.0.0
50001
Disabled
Disabled
3
Page
Varies depending on country and region
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Page
7-34
Item
X
X
* 4
X
* 5
X
* 6
●
*1 When the hard disk drive is installed.
*2 When the automatic document feeder is installed.
*3 When a paper drawer is installed.
*4 When a finisher is installed.
*5 When a punch module is installed.
*6 When a colour-related problem has occurred.
Copy Function Settings
Item
■
●
X
Colour Mode
X
Paper Tray
X
Exposure Type
X Copy Ratio
X
2-Sided Copy
X
Output
●
X
Colour
Black & White
X
X
Add or Change Extra Preset Ratios
X
Setting a Maximum Number of Copies
X
Side 1
Side 2
X
Edge Clearance Width
Centre Clearance Width
X
Original Size
Fit to Page
Factory default setting
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
60 - 89 g /m 2 (16 - 23 lbs.)
Page
7-35
Factory default setting Page
Full Colour
Varies depending on the machine configuration
Auto
100%
1-Side to 1-Side
–
5
5
Enabled
–
999
10 mm (1/2")
10 mm (1/2")
10 mm (1/2")
10 mm (1/2")
X: 86 mm (3-3/8"), Y: 54 mm (2-1/8")
Disabled
Item
X
X
Disabling Deletion of Job Programs
X
Disabling of Bypass-Tray in Duplex Copy
X
Disabling of Auto Paper Selection
X
Auto Selection Setting of Tray that is Supplied the Paper
X
B/W 600dpi x 600dpi Scanning Mode for Document Feeder *
X
B/W Quick Scan from Document Glass
X
Auto Clear Before Copy Job Execution
●
X
Initial Colour Balance Setting
X
* When the automatic document feeder is installed.
Network Settings
Item
■
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Factory default setting
10 mm (1/2")
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Factory default state
–
Factory default setting
DHCP
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
–
–
Page
Page
7-36
Printer Settings
Item
■
●
X
X
X
X
Colour
Black & White
X
X
Enable Detected Paper Size in Bypass Tray
Enable Selected Paper Type in Bypass Tray
Exclude Bypass-Tray from Auto Paper Select
X
X
Disabling of USB Memory Direct Print
*
X
Disabling of Network Folder Direct Print *
●
X
X
X
X
*
X
X
Network Port Emulation Switching *
X
●
* When the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.
Image Send Settings
Item
■
●
X
• Hold settings for a while after scanning has been completed
Address Book Default Selection
3
3
0
Factory default setting
Enabled
Disabled
Varies depending on country and region
Page
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
60 sec.
Enabled
Auto
Enabled
Auto
Switch at End of Job
–
Factory default setting
Scan (fax when fax is installed)
Disabled
Tab Switch: ABC, Address Type: All
Page
7-37
Page Item
• Scan
• Internet Fax* 1
• Fax* 2
• Original Image Type
• Moiré Reduction
Must Input Next Address Key at Broadcast Setting
The Number of File Name/Subject/Body Keys Displayed
The Number of Direct Address Keys Displayed Setting
Disable Switching of Display Order
Hold Setting for Received Data Print
• Edge Clearance Width
• Centre Clearance Width
X
Settings to Disable Registration
Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel
Disable Registering Destination on Web Page *
3
Disable Registration of Program
Disable Registration of Memory Box
Disable Destination Registration Using Global Address
3
Disable Registration Using Network Scanner Tool
* 3
X
Settings to Disable Transmission
Disable [Resend] on Image Send Mode
Disable Selection From Address Book
Disable PC-I-Fax Transmission *
1
2
Factory default setting
10 mm (1/2")
10 mm (1/2")
All disabled
All disabled
All disabled
All disabled
All disabled
Disabled
Disabled
All disabled
All disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Apply the Resolution Set when
Stored: Disabled
200 X 200 dpi
Apply the Resolution Set when
Stored: Disabled
200 X 100 dpi
Apply the Resolution Set when
Stored: Disabled
Standard
Auto
Text
Disabled
Disabled
Middle
12
10
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
7-38
Page Item
X
• Sender Name
• Sender Fax Number
• I-Fax Own Address
Registration of Own Name Select
●
X
• Black & White
• Colour Mode
• Disable Change of B/W Setting in Auto Mode
• File Type
• Black & White
• Colour/Greyscale
• Specified Pages per File
• Number of Pages
Compression Mode at Broadcasting
• Black & White
• Colour/Greyscale
Maximum Size of E-mail Attachments (E-mail)
Maximum Size of Data Attachments (FTP/Desktop/Network
• Enable Bcc
• Display Bcc Address on the Job Status Screen
• USB Memory Scan
• PC Scan
X
●
1
X
–
–
–
–
–
Factory default setting
Mono 2
Auto, Greyscale
Disabled
MMR (G4)
Medium
Disabled
Disabled
MH (G3)
Medium
Unlimited
Unlimited
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
MH (G3)
7-39
Item
• Receive Signal
• Communication Error Signal
Original Print on Transaction Report
Transaction Report Print Select Setting
• Single Sending
• Broadcasting
• Receiving
Activity Report Print Select Setting
• Auto Print at Memory Full
• Print Daily at Designated Time
Body Text Print Select Setting
X
I-Fax Reception Report On/Off Setting
I-Fax Reception Report Request Timeout Setting
Number of Resend Times at Reception Error
Maximum Size of E-mail Attachments
Printing Page Number at Receiver
Recall in Case of Communication Error
X
Set Address for Data Forwarding
• Direct SMTP
• Add Hostname or IP Address Too
• Hostname or IP Address
4
* 4
POP3 Communication Timeout Setting
Reception Check Interval Setting
X
Allow/Reject Mail or Domain Name Setting
*1 When the hard disk drive and Internet fax expansion kit are installed.
*2 When the facsimile expansion kit is installed.
*3 When network connection is enabled.
*4 This function is not available in some countries and regions.
7-40
Factory default setting
–
Middle
Middle
Print Out Error Report Only
Page
Print Out Error Report Only
Print Out All Report
No Printed Report
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
1 hour
2
Unlimited
All Enabled
Enabled
Times: 2, Interval 3 min.
Times: 2, Interval 3 min.
Enabled
Disabled
–
Disabled
Disabled
–
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
60 sec.
5 min.
Varies depending on the machine configuration
All Invalid
Document Filing Settings *4
Item
■
●
X
X
X
Administrator Authority Setting
Delete File
Delete Folder
Change Password
X
Delete
Delete quick files at power up (protected files excluded)
X
Colour
Black & White
X
Original Image Type
Moiré Reduction
X
X
Colour Data Compression Ratio Setting
X
X
1
X
X
Selection of [All Users] is not allowed.
Selection of [User Unknown] is not allowed.
X
Edge Clearance Width
Centre Clearance Width
X
Original Size
Fit to Store Size
Factory default setting
Sharing Mode
Date
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
–
Enabled
Auto
Mono 2
Auto
Text
Disabled
600 x 600 dpi
Medium
Middle
Varies depending on the machine configuration
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
10 mm (1/2")
10 mm (1/2")
X: 86 mm (3-3/8"), Y: 54 mm (2-1/8")
Disabled
Page
7-41
Item
●
X
Copy
Scan Send
Internet Fax Send (Incl. PC-I-Fax)* 2
Fax Send (Incl. PC-Fax)* 3
Scan to HDD
X
Scan Send
Copy
Scan Send
Internet Fax Send (Incl. PC-I-Fax)* 2
Fax Send (Incl. PC-Fax)* 3
Scan to HDD
X
Internet Fax Send* 2
Copy
Scan Send
Internet Fax Send (Incl. PC-I-Fax)
Fax Send (Incl. PC-Fax)
Scan to HDD
X
Fax Send* 3
Copy
Scan Send
Internet Fax Send (Incl. PC-I-Fax)* 2
Fax Send (Incl. PC-Fax)* 3
Scan to HDD
●
Automatic Deletion of File Settings
*1 When the exit tray unit is installed.
*2 When the Internet fax expansion kit is installed.
*3 When the facsimile expansion kit is installed.
*4 When the hard disk expansion kit is installed.
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
All invalid
Enabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Factory default setting Page
7-42
List Print (Administrator)
Item
■
●
●
●
●
* 1
●
* 2
*1 When network connection is enabled.
*2 When the hard disk drive and application integration module are installed.
–
–
–
–
–
Factory default setting
Security Settings
Item
■
●
X
Server Port
HTTPS
IPP-SSL
Redirect HTTP to HTTPS in Device Web Page Access
X
Client Port
HTTPS
FTPS
SMTP-SSL
POP3-SSL
LDAP-SSL
Level of Encryption
●
●
●
Initialize Private Data/Data in Machine
* When the hard disk drive is installed.
Factory default setting
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Low
Disabled
Disabled
–
Page
Page
7-43
Enable/Disable Settings
Item Factory default setting
■
●
X
(When the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.)
Disabled
●
X
Disabling of Printing by Invalid User
Disabled
●
X
X
Disabling of Job Priority Operation
X
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
X
X
X
Disabling of Covers/Inserts Mode *
1
●
X
Disabling of Document Feeder *
1
X
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
X
Disabling of Optional Paper Drawer
* 2
X
X
3
X
X
* 3
X
* 4
X
* 5
X
Disabling of Master Machine Mode
X
Disabling of Slave Machine Mode
●
X
Disabling Deletion of Job Programs
X
Disabling of Bypass-Tray in Duplex Copy
X
Disabling of Auto Paper Selection
●
X
X
X
Exclude Bypass-Tray from Auto Paper Select
X
Disabling of USB Memory Direct Print
* 6
X
Disabling of Network Folder Direct Print *
6
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Page
7-44
Item
●
X
Disable Switching of Display Order
• PC Scan
• USB Memory Scan
X
Settings to Disable Registration
Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel
Disable Registering Destination on Web Page *
7
Disable Registration of Program
Disable Registration of Memory Box
Disable Destination Registration Using Global Address
7
Disable Registration Using Network Scanner Tools *
7
X
Settings to Disable Transmission
Disable [Resend] on Image Send Mode
Disable Selection from Address Book
Disable PC-I-Fax Transmission *
8
9
●
* 10
X
X
Selection of [All Users] is not allowed.
Selection of [User Unknown] is not allowed.
*1 When the automatic document feeder is installed.
*2 When a paper drawer is installed.
*3 When a finisher is installed.
*4 When a punch module is installed.
*5 When a colour-related problem has occurred.
*6 When the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.
*7 When network connection is enabled.
*8 When the Internet fax expansion kit is installed.
*9 When the facsimile expansion kit is installed.
*10When the hard disk drive is installed.
Change Administrator Password
Item
■
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
All disabled
All disabled
All disabled
All disabled
All disabled
Disabled
Disabled
All disabled
All disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Factory default setting Page
Factory default setting
See "TO THE ADMINISTRATOR OF
THE MACHINE" in the Start Guide.
Page
7-45
Product Key
Item Factory default setting
■
●
●
●
●
●
●
Application Integration Module
●
Application Communication Module
●
●
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
* It may not be possible to use some settings, depending on the peripheral devices installed.
Data Backup
Item Factory default setting
■
●
●
Storing/Calling of System Settings
Item
■
Storing/Calling of System Settings
●
●
●
Sharp OSA Settings
–
–
–
–
–
Factory default setting
Item Factory default setting
■
●
X
X
Enable Authentication by External Server
●
X
Disabled
Disabled
Internal driver
X
X
Internal driver
None
●
Printing
* When the hard disk drive and external account module or application communication module are available.
Page
Page
Page
Page
7-46
User Control
User Control is used to configure settings for user authentication. Touch the [User Control] key to configure the settings.
User Authentication Setting
These settings enable or disable user authentication and specify the authentication method.
When user authentication is enabled, each user of the machine is registered. When a user logs in, settings for that user are applied. This function allows greater control of security and cost management than on previous machines.
In addition, even if the user information is not stored in the machine, it is possible to log in by directly entering user information stored on an LDAP server. In this case, the login user will be the factory-stored "User". For more information,
see " Factory-stored users " (page 7-51).
• For the procedure for storing users, see " User List " (page 7-51).
• For more information on login procedures when user authentication is enabled, see "
1-17) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
User Authentication
When [User Authentication] is enabled, the login screen appears before an operation is begun in any mode except the job status screen*. You must log in as one of the stored users. (After logging in, you can move freely through the modes.)
* The login screen appears when a document filing file is used or when a broadcast transmission is reattempted from the job status screen.
Authentication Method Setting
This selects the authentication method. When using user authentication, be sure to configure this setting first. The items configured for users stored after the user authentication method is set vary depending on the selected authentication method.
Authenticate a User by Login Name and Password
Standard authentication method using a login name and password.
Authenticate a User by Login Name, Password and
E-mail Address
In addition to a login name and password, this authentication method also requires the entry of an e-mail address.
Authenticate a User by User Number Only
This can be used as a simple authentication method when network authentication is not used.
• The login screen will vary depending on the authentication method that is selected. For more information, see "
1-17) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
• When "Authenticate a User by User Number Only" is selected for the authentication method, network authentication cannot be used.
7-47
Device Account Mode Setting
A specific user can be stored as an auto login user.
When this setting is enabled, login can be performed automatically.
This function eliminates the bother of logging in but still allows the settings of the selected user (network settings, favourite operations, etc.) to be applied.
You can also allow users other than the auto login user to temporarily log in and work using their own authority and settings. To allow other users to log in temporarily when [Device Account Mode] is enabled, select [Allow
Login by Different User].
As an example, this enables uses such as
"authentication for colour copying only".
• If auto login fails for some reason when auto login is enabled, or the login user does not have administrator rights, all system settings or the system settings (administrator) will lock. In this event, the administrator should touch the [Admin
Password] key in the system settings screen and log in again.
• To log in as a user other than the auto login user when [Allow Login by Different User] is enabled, press the [LOGOUT] key ( ) to cancel the auto user login state. The user authentication screen will appear to let you log in. After using the machine, press the [LOGOUT] key ( ) to log out.
Other Settings
Actions when the Limit of Pages for Output Jobs
This setting determines whether or not a job will be completed if the page limit is reached while the job is in progress.
The following selections are available.
• Job is Stopped when the Limit of Pages is Reached
• Job is Completed even when the Limit of Pages is
Reached
Automatically print stored jobs after login
This function requires the hard disk drive.
When retention is enabled in the printer driver and print data has been spooled to the machine, you can have the spooled print data automatically print out when the user who enabled retention logs in.
The Number of User Name
Displayed Setting
The number of users that are displayed in the user selection screen can be selected (6, 12, or 18 users).
This setting also applies to the user selection screen of document filing and the sender selection screen.
A Warning when Login Fails
This setting is used to display a warning and prohibit login for five minutes if login fails three times in a row.
This prevents an unauthorised person from attempting to guess a password. (The number of failed login attempts is retained even if the power is turned off.)
Locking of the operation panel for 5 minutes can be cancelled by clicking [User Control] - [Default Settings]
- [Release the Lock on Machine Operation Panel] in the Web page menu.
Default Network Authentication
Server Setting
Use this to set the default network authentication server.
When a user logs in from the Web page or sends a print job to the machine using user information that is not stored on the machine, the authentication server is not known. This setting is used to specify one of the LDAP servers stored on the machine as the authentication server.
When login is performed by network authentication using user information that is not stored in the machine, the login user will be the factory-stored
"User". For more information, see " Factory-stored users " (page 7-51).
Disabling of Printing by Invalid
User
Printing by users whose information is not stored in the machine, such as printing without entering valid user information in the printer driver or printing of a file on an
FTP server from the Web pages, can be prohibited.
When a print job is executed by a user that is not stored in the machine, the factory-stored "Other User" is used as the login user. For more information, see
"
Factory-stored users " (page 7-51).
7-48
Perform LDAP server access control.
Access control information for page count limits, authorities, and favourite operations can be stored on an
LDAP server, and by using this LDAP server for network authentication, user authentication based on the stored access control information can be performed.
This can be used when user authentication is performed by network authentication using an LDAP server or a directory service (Active Directory, etc.).
Before using this function, configure settings for authentication by LDAP server, obtain control numbers for the "Pages Limit Group", "Authority Group",
"Favourite Operation Group", and "My Folder" (including base settings for each group), and associate these with the control numbers registered in the machine.
To use this function, attributes associated with "Pages
Limit Group", "Authority Group", "Favourite Operation
Group", and "My Folder" must be added to the directory information of the LDAP server used for user authentication.
The attribute information is indicated below. Settings previously stored in the machine cannot be changed.
Attribute
Pages Limit
Group
Name of attribute in factory default state pagelimit
Setting
Authority
Group
Favourite
Operation
Group authority favourite
Registration number of pages limit group stored in the machine, or group name previously stored in the machine.
Unlimited: unlimited
Registration number of authority group stored in the machine, or group name previously stored in the machine.
Admin: admin
User: user
Guest: guest
Registration number of favourite operation group stored in the machine, or group name previously stored in the machine.
Following the System
Settings: system settings
Attribute
My Folder
Name of attribute in factory default state myfolder
Setting
Folder name of user folder stored in the machine.
Do not enter if the default folder is specified.
The names of attributes that the machine obtains from the LDAP server can be changed in "Pages Limit
Group", "Authority Group", "Favourite Operation Group", and "My Folder" in "Network Settings" > "LDAP Settings" on the Web page.
The "Pages Limit Group", "Authority Group", and
"Favourite Operation Group" information that is stored in each machine determines the authority and settings that the user is actually granted. To use this function to ensure that users are granted the same authority and settings on any machine, the same "Pages Limit Group",
"Authority Group", and "Favourite Operation Group" information must be stored in each machine using the same registration numbers.
For "My Folder", the same folder name must be stored in
"Custom Folder" in each machine.
The directory information of the LDAP server that is used cannot be changed from the machine. Consult the administrator of the LDAP server.
Users auto-registered
When access control is enabled and login is performed by network authentication, the user information in the
LDAP server is automatically stored in the machine.
The information stored is as follows:
Item
User Name
Description
Information is acquired from the
LDAP server.*
Initial
Index
Password
Authentication
Settings
Authentication
Server
–
–
1
User 1
Network Authentication
7-49
Item
E-mail Address
My Folder
Description
Information is acquired from the
LDAP server.
Pages Limit
Group
Authority Group
Favourite
Operation
Group
* If the user name cannot be acquired, the first 16 characters of the text string entered as the user name for network authentication is used.
If the login name is different but the user name received from the LDAP server is the same, or if the user name is already registered on the machine, "Can not login because the user name entered has been previously registered" will appear and login will not be possible. In this case, the user name stored on the LDAP server or the user name stored on the machine must be changed.
Consult the administrator of the machine.
If automatic registration by LDAP authentication is attempted when 1000 users are already stored, the following message will appear and login will not be possible: "Maximum entries for User Name is 1000.
Please delete old or unused user name." Consult the administrator of the machine.
Display Usage Status after Login
When user authentication is enabled, this setting specifies whether or not the page counts of a user appear when the user logs in.
User Information Print
The following lists can be printed.
• User List
• List of Number of Pages Used
• Page Limit Group List*
• Authority Group List
• Favourite Operation Group List*
• All User Information Print
Touch the key of the desired list to begin printing.
* Cannot be printed when no groups are stored.
• If access control information cannot be obtained from the LDAP server used for authentication, user authentication cannot take place.
• If a user that is registered in the machine is authenticated by network authentication, the user registration settings in the machine will be given priority for the page count limit group, authority group, favourite operations group, and my folder.
• If the access control obtained from the LDAP server is not registered in the machine, the factory default user authority will be applied.
• When this function is not enabled and a user is authenticated by network authentication as a non-registered user, the factory default user authority will be applied.
7-50
User List
This is used to store, edit, and delete users when user authentication is enabled.
When the [User List] key is touched, the following screen appears.
User List
Add New
Index Switch
ABC
Sorting Order
Search Number
Back
Delete All Users
Administrator
Other User
*Name 2
*Name 4
Name 6
All ABCD EFGH
Delete All Users Auto-Registered
User
Name 1
Name 3
Name 5
Name 7
IJKL MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
1
2
• [Add New] key
Use this to add a new user.
• [Delete All Users] key
Use this to delete all stored users. (Excluding factory stored users.) This operation can only be performed by an administrator.
• Delete All Users Auto-Resistered
Delete all auto-registered users.
☞
Users auto-registered (page 7-49)
• User List
This shows the factory-stored users and the currently stored users. An asterisk [*] appears in front of the user name of auto-registered users.
A user can be selected to open an edit/delete screen for the user.
Storing a user
Touch the [Add New] key in the above screen to open a registration screen. Up to 1000 users can be stored.
For more information, see "
Editing/deleting a user
A user can be selected from the list in the above screen to open an edit/delete screen for the user.
For more information, see "
Delete a user with the [Delete] key.
• When auto login is enabled, "Delete All Users" cannot be used.
• The factory-stored users cannot be deleted.
Factory-stored users
The following users are stored in the machine at the factory.
• Administrator: Factory-stored account for the administrator of the machine.
• User: This is used when network authentication is used and a login name not stored in the machine is directly entered. (This cannot be selected in the login user screen.)
• Other User: This is used when a print job is executed using invalid user information. (This cannot be selected in the login user screen.)
For settings related to each of the users, see the following table.
Administrator User Other User User Name
Login Name
Password
My Folder
Authentication Settings admin
(See the Start Guide.)* 1
Main Folder
Login Locally users users* 1
Other
–
–
7-51
Pages Limit Group
Authority Group* 2
Unlimited* 1
Admin User* 1 Guest* 1
Favourite Operation Group Following the System Settings* 1
*1 Items that can be changed.
Settings
User Name
Item Description
Store the name of the user (max. 32 characters). This user name is used as the key name in the login screen, the document filing user name, and the sender name. (The user name must be unique.)
Apply User Name to Log-in
Name* 1
Touch this key to enter the entered user name in the login name.
Initial
Index
User Number*
Login Name*
Password*
My Folder
1
1, 3
2
E-mail Address
This determines where the user name will appear in the user list. Up to 10 characters can be entered.
Select the desired custom index. The custom index names are the same as those in the address book.
Enter a user number (5 to 8 digits).
Enter the login name used when authentication by login name/password is enabled
(maximum of 255 characters). (The login name must be unique.)
Enter the password used when authentication by login name/password is enabled (1 to 32 characters). (The password can be omitted.)
Enter the e-mail address used in the sender list and for LDAP authentication (maximum of 64 characters).
A folder ("My Folder") can be specified as the folder used by the user for document filing. A previously created folder can be selected or you can create and select a new folder.
Authentication Settings*
Authentication Server
Pages Limit Group
Authority Group
1
Select [Login Locally] or [Network Authentication] (when LDAP is enabled) for "Authenticate to:".
When [Network Authentication] is selected, select the server to be used for user authentication from the list of LDAP servers stored in the Web pages.
Specify page limits for the user by selecting one of the stored page limit groups. The factory default setting is [Unlimited].
For more information, see " Page Limit Group List " (page 7-53).
Specify the authority of the user by selecting one of the stored authority groups. The factory default setting is [User].
For more information, see " Authority Group List " (page 7-54).
Favourite Operation Group
The favourite operation group that will be applied at login appears. The factory default setting is [Following the System Settings].
The setting can be changed in the [User Control] menu in the Web pages.
*1 Does not appear when "User Number" is selected for the authentication method.
*2 Only appears when "User Number" is selected for the authentication method.
*3 Not required when network authentication is used, as the password stored in the LDAP server is used.
7-52
Page Limit Group List
This is used to store groups of Account Limit Settings. The page limits for each user are specified by selecting one of these stored groups when the user is stored.
When the [Page Limit Group List] key is touched, the following screen appears.
System Settings
Page Limit Group List
Add New
Back
Group 1
Group 3
Group 5
Group 7
Group 9
Group 11
Group 2
Group 4
Group 6
Group 8
Group 10
Group 12
• [Add New] key
Use this to add a new group.
• List display
This shows the currently stored groups. A group name can be selected to open an edit/delete screen for that group.
Storing a page limit group
Touch the [Add New] key in the above screen to open a registration screen. Up to 20 groups can be stored.
For more information, see "
Editing a page limit group
A group can be selected from the list in the above screen to open an edit/delete screen for the group.
For information on the settings, see "
To return a group to the factory default state, set "Select the Group Name to be the Registration Model" to "Unlimited" in the editing screen.
Settings
Item
Group Name
Select the Group Name to be the Registration Model
Function names
Page Limit
Description
Store the name of the group (max. 32 characters).
Select one of the previously stored groups for use as a template for the new group. When selected, the group's settings are applied.
The names of the functions that can be configured are displayed. Set a limit for each function.
When [Prohibited] is selected for a mode, input and output from the mode are prohibited.
When [Unlimited] is selected for a mode, there is no limit to the number of pages that can be input/output in that mode.
When [Limited] is selected, enter a limit (1 to 99999999 pages).
7-53
Authority Group List
Use this to store groups of user authority settings. The authority of each user is specified by selecting one of these stored groups when the user is stored.
When the [Authority Group List] key is touched, the following screen appears.
System Settings
Authority Group List
Add New
Back
Group 1
Group 3
Group 5
Group 7
Group 9
Group 11
Group 2
Group 4
Group 6
Group 8
Group 10
Group 12
• [Add New] key
Use this to add a new group.
• List display
This shows the currently stored groups. A group name can be selected to open an edit/delete screen for that group.
Storing an authority group
Touch the [Add New] key in the above screen to open a registration screen. Up to 20 groups can be stored.
For information on the settings, see "
List of settings and factory default settings of template groups " (page 7-55).
Editing an authority group
A group can be selected from the list in the above screen to open an edit/delete screen for the group. For information on the settings, see "
List of settings and factory default settings of template groups " (page 7-55).
To return a group to the factory default state, select [Return to Administrator Authority], [Return to User Authority], or
[Return to Guest Authority].
7-54
List of settings and factory default settings of template groups
Item
Group Name
Select the Group Name to be the
Registration Model
Description
Store the name of the group (max. 32 characters).
Select one of the previously stored groups for use as a template for the new group. When selected, the group's settings are applied.
The factory default groups and their settings are shown below.
Admin User Guest
Copy
Colour Mode Approval Setting
Special Modes Usage
Printer
Colour Mode Approval Setting
All allowed
Allowed
Allowed
All allowed
Allowed
Allowed
Only Black & White
Allowed
Prohibited
Allowed
Allowed
Allowed
Only Black & White
Allowed
Prohibited
Prohibited
Prohibited
FTP Pull Print
USB Memory Direct Print
Network Folder Pull Print
Image Send
Approval Settings for Each Mode
• FTP
• Desktop
• Network Folder
• USB Memory
• PC Scan
• Internet Fax Send
• PC-I-Fax Send
• Fax Send
• PC-Fax Send
Colour Scan
Special Modes Usage
Approval Setting for Addressing
• Approval Setting for Direct Entry
• Approval Setting to Use a Local Address Book
• Approval Settings to Use a Global
Address Book
Document Filing
Scan to HDD
Allowed
Allowed
Allowed
All allowed
Allowed
Allowed
All allowed
All allowed
Allowed
Allowed
All allowed
All allowed
Prohibited
Prohibited
All allowed
• Colour Mode Approval Setting
• Special Modes Usage
All allowed
Allowed
All allowed
Allowed
Only Black & White
Allowed
Prohibited
7-55
Item
Prints (Document Filing)
• Colour Mode Approval Setting
Description
All allowed All allowed
• Special Modes Usage
• Document Filing Image Check
• Display only the Files of Logged-in
Users
Common Functions
Allowed
Allowed
Prohibited
Allowed
Allowed
Prohibited
Approval Settings for 2-Sided Print
[1-Sided/2-Sided
Approved]
All allowed
[1-Sided/2-Sided
Approved]
All allowed Output Approval Settings
MFP Settings
System Settings Operational Authority
System Settings* 1 Allowed* 2
Only user authority settings are allowed
Web Settings Operational Authority
Display of Device /Network Status
Power Reset
Machine Identification
Network Settings
Application Settings (Excluding
Registration of Pre-set Text/Forward
Table)
Registration of Pre-set Text/Forward Table
Allowed
Prohibited
Prohibited
Prohibited
Prohibited
E-mail Alert and Status
Job Log Setting
Port Control/ Filter Settings
Storage Backup
Allowed
Allowed
Prohibited
Prohibited
Prohibited
Prohibited
Custom Link Setting Prohibited
Operation Manual Download Allowed
*1 For information on each setting, see the system settings (general/administrator) lists.
*2 All allowed except "Change Administrator Password".
Only Black & White
Allowed
Prohibited
Prohibited
Prohibited
[1-Sided/2-Sided
Approved]
All prohibited
All settings prohibited
Prohibited
Depending on the machine specifications and peripheral devices installed, it may not be possible to use some settings.
7-56
Favourite Operation Group List
This is used to store favourite operation groups and My Menu.
Some settings may not be configured depending on the connecting state of peripheral devices.
This setting can only be configured in the Web pages. It cannot be configured in the touch panel of the machine.
Favourite Operation Group Registration
Sets of preferred settings can be as groups. For example, a user who speaks a different language would normally have to change the display language each time he or she uses the machine; however, by storing the language in a favourite operation group, the language is automatically selected when the user logs in.
Settings
Item
Group Name
Select the Group Name to be the Registration Model
Copy
Initial Status Settings
Description
Store the name of the group (max. 32 characters).
Select one of the previously stored groups for use as a template for the new group. When selected, the group's settings are applied.
Select settings for Colour Mode, Paper Tray, Exposure Type, Copy Ratio, Duplex, and
Output.
Image Send
Initial Status Settings Select settings for Resolution, Exposure, Colour Mode, File Format, and Original Image Type.
Store the default fax sender name and number.
Document Filing
Scan to HDD: Initial Status
Settings
Prints (Document Filing)
System Settings
Original Size Detector Setting
Display Language Setting
Key Operation Setting
Keys Touch Sound
Keyboard Select
MFP Display Pattern Setting
Automatically print stored jobs after login
Select settings for Colour Mode, Resolution, Exposure, Original Image Type and
Compression Ratio.
Set the default output tray for document filing print.
Select whether AB sizes or inch sizes are detected, or disable detection on the document glass.
Select the display language.
Set the key input time and Auto Key Repeat setting.
Set the sound made when keys are touched.
Set the language that appears on the keyboard.
Select the colour pattern used in the touch panel.
When retention is enabled in the printer driver and print data has been spooled to the machine, you can have the spooled print data automatically print out when the user who enabled retention logs in.
Select the My Menu.
My Menu Settings
Preview Setting
Default Preview Display Image Send: Set the zoom ratio of the preview that can be displayed when an image is received and in the memory box.
Document Filing: Set the zoom ratio of the preview that can be displayed when a stored file is opened.
Select whether the default display format is list or thumbnails.
Default List/Thumbnail Display
Customize Key Setting
Customize Key Setting Set customized keys for each mode.
7-57
My Menu List
Home screen settings must be previously stored. Select a My Menu when storing a favourite operation group.
Settings
Item
My Menu Name
Select the My Menu to be the
Registration Model
Display Title
Title
Display User Name
Display Date
Background Image
Select Template
Key Layout of the Screen
Key Number
Key Name
Link Item
Description
Enter a maximum of 32 characters for the My Menu name.
Select one of the previously stored My Menus as a template for the new My Menu. When selected, the My Menu's settings are applied.
Show a title on the My Menu.
Enter a maximum of 70 characters for the title name.
Show the currently logged-in user name on the My Menu.
Show the date and time on the My Menu.
Select the image that appears in the background of the My Menu.
A template for the design of the My Menu can be selected from the list. A sample of the selected template can be viewed.
The layout of the keys in the My Menu is displayed.
Select the number of the key that you want to set, referring to "Key Layout of the Screen".
The name of the key selected in "Key Number" can be changed (maximum of 48 characters).
Specify the function that you want to use in the key selected in "Key Number".
7-58
User Count
This displays the total number of pages printed by each user.
When the [User Count] key is touched, the following screen appears.
User Count
Index Switch
ABC
Sorting Order
Search Number
Back
Select All Users
Administrator
Other User
*Name 2
*Name 4
Name 6
All ABCD EFGH
Show
IJKL
User
Name 1
Name 3
Name 5
Name 7
MNOP
Delete
QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
1
2
• [Select All Users] key
This selects all users.
• [Show] key
This shows the counts of the selected user.
• [Delete] key
Use this to reset the counts of the selected user.
• User List
This shows the factory-stored users and the currently stored users. To select a user, select the user name.
Showing user count
Select a user in the above screen and touch the [Show] key. The counts of that user will appear.
Next
Previous
Show Counts
Page Limit
Item Settings
This shows the next user (in the order of the registration numbers).
This shows the previous user (in the order of the registration numbers).
The counts and the number of pages remaining of the selected user are shown by function.
The page limit set for the user appears in parentheses below the count.
• Counts of devices that are not installed do not appear.
• A user count can be saved in the screen that appears when [User Control] - [User Count] - [Save User Count] is selected in the Web page menu.
7-59
Resetting user counts
Select a user in the setting screen and touch the [Reset] key. A count reset screen for that user will appear.
The reset screen will vary depending on whether a single user or multiple users were selected. The items displayed in each case are described in the table below.
When a single user is selected
Next
Previous
Show Counts
Item
Clear Count
Clear All Counts
Description
This shows the next user (in the order of the registration numbers).
This shows the previous user (in the order of the registration numbers).
The counts and the number of pages remaining of the selected user are shown by function.
Reset the count of the selected item to "0".
Reset all items of the selected user to "0".
When multiple users are selected
Show Counts
Item
Clear Count
Clear All Count
Description
The counts and the number of pages remaining of the selected users are shown by function.
Reset the count of the selected item to "0".
Reset all items of the selected users to "0".
Card Setting
(when the HID card reader is available.)
Configure this setting if user authentication will be performed using a Sharp OSA external authentication application and an HID card.
Card Reader Device Registration
In this setting, the product ID and vender ID of the connected HID card reader are displayed. To store the HID card reader, touch the [Read] key.
* For settings that enable an HID card to be used, consult your service technician.
7-60
Energy Save
The Energy Save settings help reduce power costs. From an environmental perspective, these settings also help reduce pollution and conserve natural resources. Touch the [Energy Save] key to configure the settings.
Toner Save Mode
You can reduce the amount of toner used for printing.
Print data
Print example when "Toner
Save Mode" is enabled
• [Print] in Toner Save Mode is only effective when the machine's printer driver is not used. When the printer driver is used, the printer driver setting takes precedence.
This function may not operate in some applications and operating systems.
• [Copy] in Toner Save Mode is not available in
United Kingdom.
Auto Power Shut-Off
This setting enables or disables Auto Power Shut-Off.
Remove the checkmark if you prefer that Auto Power
Shut-Off does not operate.
When the set duration of time elapses after printing ends, Auto Power Shut-Off activates and causes to machine to go on standby at a minimal level of power consumption.
This function reduces your power costs, and at the same time helps conserve natural resources and reduce pollution.
It is recommended that you understand the objective behind the energy save functions and instead of using the machine in the state where the Auto Power Shut-Off function is disabled, adjust the settings such that the time till Auto Power Shut-Off is enabled is a little longer or set a time zone for Auto Power Shut-Off. (Settings that depend on the usage conditions, such as the time till
Auto Power Shut-Off is enabled can be configured in the following "
Auto Power Shut-Off Timer
Settings that depend on the usage conditions, such as the time till Auto Power Shut-Off is enabled or the time zone for Auto Power Shut-Off can be configured. In case of "Fix transition time", it can be set to "Earliest" or within a range of 1 to 240 minutes.
When "As soon as the remote job is finished, enter Auto power shut off mode" is enabled, Auto Power Shut-Off happens in a short while after the print job or fax reception is complete.
In case of settings that depend on the usage conditions, select "Change transition time by time of day".
As per the default settings, the time zone is set automatically depending on the application conditions of the machine. When it is to be selected manually, you can select from the following.
• All Day "Energy Save Priority2" : To be set when you want Auto Power Shut-Off to be enabled in minimum time in any time zone.
• 8:00-18:00 "Energy Save Priority1": To be set when this machine is to be used more frequently in this time zone than other time zones.
• 8:00-18:00 "Job Start Priority1": To be set when the frequency of use of this machine in this time zone is significantly more.
• Settings edited to match the usage conditions, combining the three patterns given above can also be selected.
Preheat Mode Setting
The time until Preheat Mode activates can be set to any number of minutes from 1 to 240.
Preheat Mode will activate when the set duration of time elapses after printing ends and no further operations are performed. This function reduces your power costs, and at the same time helps conserve natural resources and reduce pollution.
Select the time that best suits the needs of your workplace.
Preheat mode cannot be disabled.
7-61
Operation Settings
Settings related to machine operation can be configured. Touch the [Operation Settings] key to configure the settings.
Other Settings
Keys Touch Sound
This setting is used to adjust (or turn off) the volume of the beep that sounds when you touch a key. You can also have three beeps sound at initial values when setting the ratio in copy mode or when adjusting the exposure in any mode.
Screen in which setting is effective
Initial value
Ratio setting screen in base screen of copy mode
Exposure adjustment screen in base screen of copy mode
Exposure adjustment screen in base screen of fax, Internet fax, and network scanner modes
Exposure adjustment screen for Scan to
HDD in document filing mode
Ratio 100%
Exposure level:
3 (medium)
Default Display Settings
Set the screen that appears after auto clear and login.
You can select the base screen of copy, fax / image send, or document filing mode, the home screen, or the
Sharp OSA screen*.
* When the application communication module is installed.
Disabling of Job Priority Operation
This disables the job priority function and hides the
[Priority] key in the job status screen.
Auto Clear Setting
The time until Auto Clear activates can be set to any number of minutes from 10 to 240.
If the machine is not used for the duration of time set here, the auto clear function will clear any settings that have been selected and return the screen to the base screen of copy mode or the job status screen.
Cancel Auto Clear Timer
This is used to disable the auto clear function.
Message Time Setting
The duration of time that messages appear in the touch panel (the time until a message is automatically cleared) can be set to any number of seconds from 1 to 12.
Disabling of Bypass Printing
This is used to disable bypass printing (printing other jobs ahead of a job that has been stopped* because the paper required for the job is not in any of the trays).
* This does not include cases where the paper ran out during the job.
Key Operation Setting
This setting determines how long a key in the touch panel must be touched until the key input is registered.
The time can be set from 0 to 2 seconds in increments of
0.5 seconds.
By lengthening the time setting, key input can be prevented when a key is touched accidentally. Keep in mind, however, that when a longer setting is selected more care is required when touching keys to ensure that key input is registered.
Disable Auto Key Repeat
This is used to disable key repeat.
Key repeat causes a setting to change continuously while a key is touched, not only each time the key is touched.
Display Language Setting
The language that appears in the touch panel can be changed.
When user authentication is enabled and a display language is specified in the favourite operation group, that setting is given priority.
7-62
Disabling of Clock Adjustment
This setting is used to prohibit changing of the date and time.
Disabling of Covers/Inserts Mode
(When the automatic document feeder is installed.)
This setting is used to prohibit the use of the covers and inserts function.
Set Keyboard Priority
When an external keyboard is connected, you can select whether the soft keyboard or the external keyboard is used.
Initial Original Count Setting
This specifies whether or not "Original Count" in the special functions is enabled for each function.
Copy
• Copy
Image Send
• Scan
• Internet Fax
• Fax Job
• Data Entry
Document Filing
• Scan to HDD
7-63
MFP Display Pattern Setting
One of six colour patterns can be selected for the colour pattern in the touch panel.
A sample of the selected pattern can be viewed.
Customize Key Setting
Short-cuts to functions that are frequently used can be displayed in the base screen of each mode.
For information on customize keys, see the chapters for each function.
The settings are shown below.
Item
Customized Keys 1 - 3
Item
Return to the Defaults
Description
Enter a name for the customized key (maximum of 14 characters).
Select the function that you want to assign to the key. The functions that can be selected vary by mode.
This returns all customized keys to their factory default state.
This setting can only be configured in the Web pages. It cannot be configured in the touch panel of the machine.
Home Screen Settings
Use this to configure the home screen that appears when the [HOME] key is pressed.
The settings are shown below.
Mode Keys
Item
Key Name
Application Keys
Image
Background Image
Description
When [Custom] is selected, any key name (maximum of 16 characters) can be entered.
When [Use Custom Image] is selected, the Mode Key image can be changed using a gif file of up to 10 KB in size.
A shortcut to the Sharp OSA application and keys that appear in "My Menu" can be stored (a total of eight keys can be stored).
When [Use Custom Image] is selected, the background of the home screen can be changed using a 392 x 800 dot gif, png, jpg, or bmp file of up to 310 KB in size.
This setting can only be configured in the Web pages. It cannot be configured in the touch panel of the machine.
7-64
My Menu Settings
Use this to configure the My Menu screen that appears when the [My Menu] key is pressed.
The settings are shown below.
Item
Display Title
Title
Display User Name*
Display Date
Background Image
Select Template
Description
Show a title on the My Menu.
Enter a maximum of 70 characters for the title name.
Show the currently logged-in user name on the My Menu.
Show the date and time on the My Menu.
Select the image that appears in the background of the My Menu.
A template for the design of the My Menu can be selected from the list. A sample of the selected template can be viewed.
Key Layout of the Screen
Key Number
The layout of the keys in the My Menu is displayed.
Select the number of the key that you want to configure, referring to "Key Layout of the
Screen".
Key Name The name of the key selected in "Key Number" can be changed (maximum of 48 characters).
Link Item Specify the function that you want to use in the key selected in "Key Number".
* Does not appear when user authentication is not enabled.
This setting can only be configured in the Web pages. It cannot be configured in the touch panel of the machine.
7-65
Preview Setting
(When the hard disk drive is installed.)
Configure settings for the preview screen that can be used for fax / image send and document filing.
Remote Operation
Settings
Configure settings required for remote operation of the machine from a computer connected to the same network.
Default Preview
Set the selection state of the [Preview] key in each of the screens below.
Copy
Image Send
• Scan Send
• Internet Fax Send
• Fax Send
• Data Entry
• USB Memory Scan
• Address Book
Document Filing
• Scan to HDD
Remote Software Operation
Operational Authority
This is used when remote software is used to operate the machine remotely.
View Password Entry Screen
When remote software is used to operate the machine remotely, you can have a password entry screen appear on the machine, on the computer, or both.
Default Preview Display
Set the display zoom ratio of the preview screen for copy, fax / image send, and document filing.
Received Data Image Check
Setting
Select whether or not a preview of received faxes and
Internet faxes is shown.
Operation from Specified PC
Operational Authority
This is used to allow remote operation of the machine using a specified computer.
Hostname or IP Address of PC
Enter the host name or IP address of the computer that will connect to the machine.
A maximum of 127 characters can be entered.
View Password Entry Screen
When a specified computer is used to operate the machine remotely, you can have a password entry screen appear on the machine, on the computer, or both.
Default List/Thumbnail Display
Select whether the default display format of the document filing file selection screen and the received fax list screen is list or thumbnails.
Operation by User who Has
Password
Operational Authority
This is used to allow a user who has a password to operate the machine. For information on the password, consult your service technician.
View Password Entry Screen
When a user who has a password operates the machine remotely, you can have a password entry screen appear on the machine, on the computer, or both.
Soft Keyboard Template Setting
Store text that you frequently use when entering an address or domain. Up to 16 characters can be entered.
7-66
Device Control
These settings control devices installed on the machine. Touch the [Device Control] key to configure the settings.
Other Settings
Original Feeding Mode
The following original feeding modes can be set to operate by default in copy, Scan to HDD, and image send modes. When a mode is frequently used, this saves you from having to select the mode in the special modes each time you need to use it.
• Mixed Size Original (Same Width (Copy mode only)/Different Width)
• Slow Scan Mode
• Blank Page Skip (image send*)
* Excluding fax mode and Internet fax mode.
Detect Standard in Auto Colour
Mode
When the colour mode is set to auto in copy mode, the discrimination point for detecting whether originals are colour or black and white can be set to one of 5 levels.
To make it easier to detect a black and white original, adjust the setting toward [Black & White]. To make it easier to detect a colour original, adjust the setting toward [Colour].
Auto Paper Selection Setting
The paper types* that the Auto Paper Selection function will select can be specified. Select one of the following settings:
• Plain Paper
• Plain and Recycle Paper
• Recycle Paper
The Auto Paper Selection function will not select any paper types other than the paper types specified with this setting.
* The paper type set for each paper tray using " Paper
Tray Settings " (page 7-13) in the system settings
(general).
Tandem Connection Setting
(When the hard disk drive is installed.)
When two machines are used as network printers using
TCP/IP protocol, use this setting to configure the port number and IP address of the machine used as the tandem slave machine.
Disabling of Master Machine Mode
To prohibit tandem transmission, enable this setting.
(There is normally no need to enable this setting.)
Disabling of Slave Machine Mode
To prohibit tandem reception, enable this setting. (There is normally no need to enable this setting.)
Registration Adjustment
If the colours are out of place on the printed surface when colour printing is performed, the print positions of the colours can be adjusted.
To perform this adjustment, touch the [Auto Adjustment] key. A message will appear. Touch the [Execute] key.
Optimization of a Hard Disk
(When the hard disk drive is installed.)
This function optimizes the hard drive of the machine by defragmenting data. If a job is in progress, a message will appear and optimization will not begin until the job is finished. During optimization, the following operations are not possible:
• Web page access, reception of print data
• Use of keys on the operation panel
• Turning off the power with the main power switch of the machine.
• Auto Power Shut-Off
When optimization is completed, the machine will automatically restart.
When the document filing function is frequently used and output of files seems somewhat slow, optimizing the hard drive may improve performance.
• The factory default setting for the port number is
[50001]. Unless you experience difficulty with this setting, do not change the port number.
• To use the tandem function when user authentication is enabled, the same login name and password must be used on both the master machine and slave machine. If the same login name and password are not used, the page count may not be added to the appropriate user count or only the master machine may print.
7-67
Clear All Job Log Data
(When the hard disk drive is installed.)
This is used to clear the entire job log. (There is normally no need to use this function.)
A log file is kept of jobs run on the machine. The job log can be used to check general use of the machine. The job log can be written to a computer in CSV format using a Web browser.
Original Size Detector Setting
One of the 8 groups of standard original sizes shown below can be selected for detection by the original size detection function.
AB-1
AB-2
AB-3
AB-4
AB-5
Inch-1
Inch-2
Inch-3
Selections
Document glass
Detectable original sizes
Document feeder tray (automatic document feeder)*
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 330 mm
(8-1/2" x 13")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 11" x 17",
8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11"
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R,
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 11"
216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13")
A4, A4R, A5, B4, 8K, 16K, 16KR
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 340 mm
(8-1/2" x 13-2/5")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B5, B5R, 216 mm x 343 mm
(8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11",
8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
11" x 17", 216 mm x 330 mm(8-1/2" x 13"),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, 11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 11",
216 mm x 330 mm (8-1/2" x 13"), 8K, 16K,
16KR,
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 11" x 17",
8-1/2" x 11", 216 mm x 340 mm
(8-1/2" x 13-2/5")
A3, A4, A4R, A5, B4, B5, B5R, 11" x 17",
8-1/2" x 11",
216 mm x 343 mm (8-1/2" x 13-1/2")
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 14", 8-1/2" x 11",
8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A3, A4
11" x 17", 216 mm x 330 mm(8-1/2" x 13"),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A3,
A4
11" x 17", 8-1/2" x 13-2/5" (216 mm x 340 mm),
8-1/2" x 11", 8-1/2" x 11"R, 5-1/2" x 8-1/2", A3,
A4
* When the automatic document feeder is installed.
Cancel Detection at Document Glass
Original size detection on the document glass can be disabled. When this is done, all originals placed on the document glass are treated as special size originals.
7-68
Disabling of Devices
Use these settings when a peripheral device on the machine has failed or when you wish to temporarily disable a device.
Disabling of Document Feeder
(When the automatic document feeder is installed.)
Use this setting to prohibit the use of the automatic document feeder, such as when the feeder malfunctions.
(When the setting is enabled, scanning is still possible using the document glass.)
Disabling of Offset
This setting is used to disable the offset function.
Disabling of Stapler
(When a finisher is installed.)
This setting is used to prohibit stapling, such as when the stapler unit of the finisher malfunctions.
Disabling of Duplex
This is used to disable two-sided printing, such as when the duplex module malfunctions.
Disabling of Optional Paper Drawer
(When an optional paper drawer is installed.)
This setting is used to disable the optional paper drawer, such as when it malfunctions.
Disabling of Punch
(When a punch module is installed.)
This setting is used to prohibit punching, such as whenthe punch module of the finisher malfunctions.
Disabling of Tray Settings
This setting is used to prohibit tray settings (except for the bypass tray).
Disabling of Finisher
(When a finisher is installed.)
This setting is used to disable the finisher, such as when the unit malfunctions.
Disabling of Colour Mode
(When a colour-related problem has occurred.)
When a colour-related problem has occurred and printing is not possible, the use of colour mode can be temporarily prohibited. Black & white printing will still be allowed.
This function is only for use as an emergency measure. Once this setting is enabled, only a service technician can cancel the setting. Promptly contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative to have a service technician cancel the setting and resolve the colour-related problem.
Fusing Control Settings
These are used to control the toner fusing temperature according to the weight of the paper.
These settings apply to plain paper, punched paper, pre-printed paper, letterhead paper, coloured paper, and user type paper.
You can select "60 g /m 2 to 89 g /m 2 " or "90 g /m 2 to 105 g /m 2 " ("16 to 23 lbs." or "23+ to 28 lbs.").
• Be sure to use only paper that is in the same weight range as the weight range set here. Do not mix plain or other paper that is outside the range with the paper in the tray.
• When settings are changed, the changes will take effect after the machine is restarted. To restart the machine see
"
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF " (page 1-15) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE ".
7-69
Copy Function Settings
The following settings are related to copying. Touch the [Copy Function Settings] key to configure the settings.
Default settings selected with these settings apply to all functions of the machine (not just the copy function).
Initial Status Settings
The copier settings are reset when the [POWER] key ( ) is turned on, when the [CLEAR ALL] key ( ) is pressed, or when the auto clear interval has elapsed. These settings are used to change the default settings for copy mode.
The following settings can be changed:
Item
Colour Mode
Paper Tray
Exposure Type
Copy Ratio
2-Sided Copy
Output
Return to the
Defaults
Description
Configure default colour mode settings.
Specify the paper tray that is selected by default.
Configure exposure mode settings.
Specify the copy ratio that is selected by default.
Configure the 2-sided mode settings that are selected by default.
If this setting is used to change the default setting for the duplex function to other than "1-Side to 1-Side" and the duplex function or automatic document feeder fails or is disabled, the setting will revert to
"1-Side to 1-Side".
Set the print output method and output tray that are selected by default.
This returns all items to the factory default settings.
7-70
Other Settings
Copy Exposure Adjustment
This is used to adjust the exposure level when [Auto] is used for the copy exposure.
Colour
Use this to set the copy exposure level in colour mode for the document glass and for the automatic document feeder.
Black & White
Use this to set the copy exposure level in black & white mode for the document glass and for the automatic document feeder.
Initial Margin Shift Setting
This is used to set the default margin shift amount.
Specify a value from 0 mm (0") to 20 mm (1") in increments of 1 mm (1/8" ) for both the front and reverse sides.
Erase Width Adjustment
This is used to set the default erase width for erase copy. Specify a value from 0 mm (0") to 20 mm (1") in increments of 1 mm (1/8") for both edge erase and centre erase.
Rotation Copy Setting
When the original and paper are placed in different orientations, this function automatically rotates the image
90 degrees to enable correct copying on the paper.
• Image rotation can only take place when automatic paper selection or automatic ratio selection is enabled.
• The Rotation Copy setting must be enabled when copying an A5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size original on A5R
(5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R) paper.
Card Shot Settings
This is used to set the default original size for the card shot function.
Both the X (horizontal) and Y (vertical) dimensions of the original can be set from 25 mm (1") to 210 mm (8-1/2") in increments of 1 mm (1/8").
Fit to Page
Enable this setting to have the [Fit to Page] key always appear in the card shot screen.
Add or Change Extra Preset Ratios
Two enlargement preset ratios (101% to 400%) and two reduction preset ratios (25% to 99%) can be added. An added preset ratio can also be changed.
Preset ratios other than added preset ratios cannot be changed.
Initial Tab Copy Setting
This is used to set the default image shift width (tab width) for tab copying.
The default width can be set from 0 mm (0") to 20 mm
(5/8") in increments of 1 mm (1/8").
Setting a Maximum Number of Copies
This is used to set the maximum number that can be entered for the number of copies (number of continuous copies). Any number from 1 to 999 can be specified.
7-71
Disabling Deletion of Job Programs
This is used to prohibit the deletion and changing of copy settings stored in job programs.
Disabling of Bypass-Tray in
Duplex Copy
This is used to prohibit the use of the bypass tray when making two-sided copies.
The bypass tray is often used to feed label sheets, transparency film, and other special media for which two-sided copying is prohibited. If a sheet of one of these special media enters the reversing unit, a misfeed or damage to the unit may result. If special media for which two-sided copying is prohibited is often used, it is recommended that you enable this setting.
B/W 600dpi x 600dpi Scanning
Mode for Document Feeder
(When the automatic document feeder is installed.)
The resolution for copying in black and white using the automatic document feeder can be changed from 600 x
400 dpi to 600 x 600 dpi (high quality mode).
When high quality mode is used, fine print and thin lines are reproduced with greater clarity, however, the scanning speed is slower.
When high quality mode is not selected, the following conditions must be satisfied in order to scan at 600 x
400 dpi and attain the fastest speed.
• The copy ratio must be set to 100%.
• Do not select a special mode that will change the ratio.
• [Copy of Copy] must not be enabled.
• Do not copy in black and white with the [COLOUR
START] key.
Disabling of Auto Paper Selection
This setting is used to disable the Auto Paper Selection function.
When this setting is enabled, automatic selection of paper that is the same size as the original on the document glass or in the automatic document feeder does not take place.
Auto Selection Setting of Tray that is Supplied the Paper
When this setting is enabled and paper is loaded in a tray while the machine is on standby in copy mode, that tray is automatically selected.
B/W Quick Scan from Document
Glass
The resolution for copying in black and white using the document glass can be changed from 600 x 600 dpi to
600 x 300 dpi (high speed mode).
When high speed mode is selected, the first copy time is quicker, however, the copy image is not as clear.
When high speed mode is selected, the following conditions must be satisfied in order to scan at 600 x
300 dpi and attain the fastest speed.
• The copy ratio must be set to 100%.
• Do not select a special mode that will change the ratio.
• [Copy of Copy] must not be enabled.
• Do not copy in black and white with the [COLOUR
START] key.
Auto Clear Before Copy Job
Execution
When configuring copy settings, Auto Clear can be activated even if the copy job is not complete.
This prevents situations whereby the machine is left unattended with an uncompleted copy job.
7-72
Colour Adjustments
The following colour settings can be configured.
Initial Colour Balance Setting
Colour balance values obtained using "Colour Balance" in the special modes can be stored in a program (1 to
48), and those values can be retrieved and stored as the initial colour balance setting*. Use this feature when you want to repeatedly use a colour balance setting for a favourite colour or for correction when a change occurs in the colour balance.
* Preset values displayed when you select "Colour
Balance" in the special modes.
Return to the Factory Default Setting
This returns the stored colour balance values to the factory default values (all colour balance values are "0" for the 8 levels of each colour).
Auto Colour Calibration
This is used to perform automatic colour correction when the colour in colour copies is off. The machine prints a test patch, the test patch is scanned, and the colour is automatically corrected.
After the [Execute] key is touched and a test patch is printed, a message appears prompting you to begin automatic calibration. Place the test patch on the document glass as shown below (so that the thin line at the edge of the page is to the left).
Thin line
Lay copy paper (about five sheets) that is the same size as the test patch on top of the placed test patch, gently close the automatic document feeder, and touch the
[Execute] key.
• Before executing Auto Colour Calibration, check to see if the registration adjustment is correct. If the registration adjustment is not correct, perform
"
Registration Adjustment " (page 7-67).
• If the colour is still off after performing Auto Colour
Calibration, repeating Auto Colour Calibration once again may improve the colour.
7-73
Network Settings
Network settings are described below. Touch the [Network Settings] key to configure the settings.
When settings are changed, the changes will take effect after the machine is restarted. To restart the machine see
"
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF " (page 1-15) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE ".
IPv4 Settings
When using the machine on a TCP/IP (IPv4) network, use this setting to configure the IP address of the machine.
The settings are shown below.
IP Address
Enter the IP address of the machine.
IP Subnet Mask
Entry the IP Subnet Mask.
IP Gateway
Enter the IP Gateway address.
DHCP
Use this setting to have the IP address obtained automatically using DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol). When this setting is enabled, it is not necessary to manually enter an IP address.
• If the machine will be used on a TCP/IP network, be sure to enable "
• If DHCP is used, the IP address assigned to the machine may change automatically. If the IP address changes, printing will not be possible.
• If the machine will be used on a TCP/IP network, be sure to enable "
• If DHCP is used, the IP address assigned to the machine may change automatically. If the IP address changes, printing will not be possible.
• In an IPv6 environment, the machine can use LPD or IPP protocol.
Enable TCP/IP
To use the machine on a TCP/IP network, this setting must be enabled.
Enable NetWare
To use the machine on a NetWare network, this setting must be enabled.
Enable EtherTalk
To use the machine on an EtherTalk network, this setting must be enabled.
IPv6 Settings
When using the machine on a TCP/IP (IPv6) network, use this setting to configure the IP address of the machine.
The settings are shown below.
Enable IPv6 Protocol
Enable this setting.
DHCPv6
Use this setting to have the IP address obtained automatically using DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol). When this setting is enabled, it is not necessary to manually enter an IP address.
Manual Address
Enter the IP address of the machine.
Prefix Length
Enter the prefix length (0 to 128).
Default Gateway
Enter the IP Gateway address.
Enable NetBEUI
To use the machine on a NetBEUI network, this setting must be enabled.
Reset the NIC
This returns all "Network Settings" to the factory default settings.
Ping Command
Use this function to check if the machine can communicate with a computer on the network.
Specify the IP address of the desired computer and touch the [Execute] key. A message will appear indicating whether or not the computer responded.
7-74
Printer Settings
Settings related to the printer function can be configured. Touch the [Printer Settings] key to configure the settings.
Default Settings
Printer condition settings are described below.
Prohibit Notice Page Printing
This setting is used to disable printing of notice pages.
Prohibit Test Page Printing
This setting is used to disable printing of test pages.
When this setting is enabled, "Printer Test Page" in the system settings cannot be used to print test pages.
A4/Letter Size Auto Change
When printing an 8-1/2 x 11" (A4) size image, this setting allows A4 (8-1/2 x 11") size paper to be used if
8-1/2 x 11" (A4 ) size paper is not loaded.
Print Density Level
This lightens or darkens the print density of colour and black and white images. The print density can be adjusted to five levels.
Bypass Tray Settings
Enable Detected Paper Size in Bypass Tray
This is used to prohibit printing when the paper size specified for a print job is different from the paper size inserted in the bypass tray.
Enable Selected Paper Type in Bypass Tray
This is used to prohibit printing when the paper type specified for a print job is different from the paper type inserted in the bypass tray.
Exclude Bypass-Tray from Auto Paper Select
When [auto] is selected for paper type selection, the bypass tray can be excluded from the trays that can be selected. This is recommended when special media is often placed in the bypass tray.
Job Spool Queuing
(When the hard disk drive is installed.)
When this function is enabled, received print jobs are displayed in the spool queue of the job status screen.
The jobs are moved to the job queue after they have been analyzed by the machine. Multiple jobs that have not yet been analyzed can appear in the spool queue.
When this function is disabled, received print jobs are displayed in the job queue without being displayed in the spool queue. However, when an encrypted PDF job is printed, the job appears in the spool queue.
CMYK Exposure Adjustment
This is used to adjust the density of cyan (C), magenta
(M), Yellow (Y), and Black (K). The density of each colour can be adjusted to 17 levels.
Disabling of USB Memory Direct
(When the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.)
This setting is used to disable printing of files on USB memory.
When this setting is enabled, "USB Memory" in the
External Data Access screen cannot be used to print files.
7-75
Disabling of Network Folder Direct
(When the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.)
This setting is used to disable printing of files on network folders.
When this setting is enabled, "Network Folder" in the
External Data Access screen cannot be used to print files.
Interface Settings
These settings are used to control and monitor data transmitted to the USB port or network port of the machine.
Hexadecimal Dump Mode
(When the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.)
This function is used to print the print data from a computer in hexadecimal format together with the corresponding ASCII text. This allows you to check whether or not print data from the computer is being transmitted to the machine correctly.
Example of a hexadecimal dump
I/O Timeout
The I/O timeout can be set to any number of seconds from 1 to 999.
The I/O timeout function temporarily breaks the connection if the set duration of time elapses without any data being received by the port. After the connection is broken, the port is set to auto selection or the next print job is begun.
Enable Network Port
This is used to enable printing from the network port.
Network Port Emulation Switching
(When the printer expansion kit is installed.)
This setting is used to select the emulated printer language when the machine is connected by a network port.
The settings are shown below.
• Auto
• PostScript*
• PCL
* When the PS3 expansion kit is installed.
• The settings are the same as those of "
".
• Unless printer errors occur frequently, it is recommended that you use the factory default setting "Auto".
Enable USB Port
This is used to enable printing from the USB port.
USB Port Emulation Switching
(When the printer expansion kit is installed.)
If the machine is connected using the USB port, select the emulated printer language.
The settings are shown below.
• Auto
• PostScript*
• PCL
* When the PS3 expansion kit is installed.
• The settings are the same as those of "
• Unless printer errors occur frequently, it is recommended that you use the factory default setting "Auto".
Port Switching Method
This setting is used to select when port switching takes place.
Switch at End of Job
The port changes to auto selection when printing ends.
Switch after I/O Timeout
When the time set in "
" elapses, the port changes to auto selection.
The following two print ports are available on the machine:
• USB port
• Network port
7-76
Auto Colour Calibration
This is used to perform automatic colour correction when the colour in colour printing is off. The machine prints a test patch, the test patch is scanned, and the colour is automatically corrected.
After the [Execute] key is touched and a test patch is printed, a message appears prompting you to begin automatic calibration. Place the test patch on the document glass as shown below (so that the thin line at the edge of the page is to the left).
Thin line
Lay copy paper (about five sheets) that is the same size as the test patch on top of the placed test patch, gently close the automatic document feeder, and touch the [Execute] key.
• Before executing Auto Colour Calibration, check to see if the registration adjustment is correct. If the registration
adjustment is not correct, perform " Registration Adjustment " (page 7-67).
• If the colour is still off after performing Auto Colour Calibration, repeating Auto Colour Calibration once again may improve the colour.
7-77
Image Send Settings
Settings related to the image send function (scan, Internet fax, etc.) can be configured. Touch the [Image Send Settings] key to configure the settings.
For explanations of settings related to the fax function, see "
SYSTEM SETTINGS FOR FAX " (page 7-100).
Operation Settings
The operation settings below apply to all image send functions.
Other Settings
Default Display Settings
You can select one of 5 base screen types for the base screen that appears when the [IMAGE SEND] key is touched or when the [CLEAR ALL] ( ) key is pressed in image send mode.
• Address Book
• Scan
• Internet Fax
• Fax
• Data Entry
Hold settings for a while after scanning has been completed
Use this setting to hold the settings after scanning is completed (until Auto Clear Mode activates).
Initial Resolution Setting
The following settings are available for the default resolutions of scan, Internet fax, and fax mode.
Scan : 100X100 dpi, 200X200 dpi, 300X300 dpi,
400X400 dpi, 600X600 dpi
Internet fax : 200X100 dpi
200X200 dpi
200X400 dpi
400X400 dpi
600X600 dpi
Fax: Standard
Fine
Super Fine Half Tone
Ultra Fine
Half Tone
Apply the Resolution Set when Stored
When an image stored by document filing is used, this applies the resolution setting that was stored with the image.
Address Book Default Selection
One of the following screens can be specified for the initial address book screen.
Tab Switch
• ABC
• Group
Address Type
• All
• FTP/Desktop
• Network Folder
• Internet Fax (Including Direct SMTP)
• Fax
• Group
7-78
Default Exposure Settings
This is used to set the default exposure settings for scanning a document in image send mode. Select [Auto] or [Manual]. When [Manual] is selected, the exposure can be set to one of 5 levels.
Default Original Image Type
Select the original type beforehand to enable transmission at a resolution suitable for the original (only in scan mode and USB memory mode).
The settings are shown below.
• Text/Printed Photo
• Text/Photo
• Text
• Photo
•
• Printed Photo
• Map
When the exposure is set to [Auto], a default original type cannot be selected.
Moiré Reduction
This reduces the moiré effect (line pattern) that occurs when printed matter is scanned (only in scan mode and
USB memory mode).
Must Input Next Address Key at
Broadcast Setting
This setting is used to require that the [Next Address] key be touched before the next address is entered when performing a broadcast transmission.
When this setting is enabled, the [Next Address] key cannot be omitted even if the next address is entered with a one-touch key.
If a user attempts to enter the next address without touching the [Next Address] key, a double-beep alarm will sound and the entry will be rejected.
Scan Complete Sound Setting
The scan complete sound can be selected.
The Number of File Name/Subject/Body
Keys Displayed Setting
This setting is used to select the number of file name / subject keys that are displayed in the screen. The number of keys can be set to 6, 12, or 18.
The Number of Direct Address
Keys Displayed Setting
Select 5, 10, or 15 for the number of one-touch keys that appear in the address book screen.
Disable Switching of Display Order
This is used to prohibit changes to the order of display
(search number order, ascending, descending) in the address book.
When this setting enabled, touching a tab on the address book screen does not change the order. The display order will remain fixed at the order that is in effect when this setting is enabled.
Hold Setting for Received Data Print
This function holds received faxes and Internet faxes in memory without printing them. The faxes can be printed by entering a password (factory default setting: 0000) with the numeric keys.
Password
When [Hold Setting for Received Data Print] is enabled, enter the password (4-digit number).
These settings can only be configured when there is no received data in the machine's memory (excluding data in a confidential or relay broadcast memory box).
7-79
Default Verification Stamp
(When a stamp unit is installed.)
When the automatic document feeder is used, this setting can be enabled to have each original page stamped after it is scanned.
Erase Width Adjustment
This is used to set the default erase width for erase function. Specify a value from 0" (0 mm) to 1" (20 mm) in increments of 1 mm (1/8") for both edge erase and centre erase.
Settings to Disable Registration
This is used to prohibit the storing of destinations.
Storing from the machine, storing from the Web page, and storing from a computer can each be separately prohibited.
Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel
This disables address control from the machine.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• Group (Direct Entry)
• Group (Address Book)
• Individual
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Registering Destination on
Web Page
(When network connection is enabled.)
This disables address control from the Web pages.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• Group (Direct Entry)
• Group (Address Book)
• Individual
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Registration of Program
This prohibits the use of the address book when a program is stored.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• FTP
• Desktop
• Network Folder
• Internet Fax (Including Direct SMTP)
• Fax
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Registration of Memory
Box
Disable all types of memory box registration.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
Polling Memory, Confidential, Relay Broadcast (Direct
Entry), Relay Broadcast (Address Book)
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Destination Registration
Using Global Address Search
(When network connection is enabled.)
This disables address control from the global address search.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
E-mail, Internet Fax, Fax
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Registration Using
Network Scanner Tool
(When network connection is enabled.)
This disables address control from the Network Scanner
Tool.
Settings to Disable Transmission
These settings are used to disable the following transmission operations.
Disable [Resend] on Image Send
Mode
This setting disables the [Resend] key in the base screen of image send mode.
Disable Selection From Address
Book
This disables the selection of destinations from the
Address Book.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• FTP
• Desktop
• Network Folder
• Internet Fax (Including Direct SMTP)
• Fax
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Direct Entry
This prohibits the direct entry of addresses.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• Network Folder
• Internet Fax (Including Direct SMTP)
• Fax
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable PC-I-Fax Transmission
(When the Internet fax expansion kit is installed.)
This prohibits PC-I-Fax transmission.
Disable PC-Fax Transmission
(When facsimile expansion kit is installed.)
This prohibits PC-Fax transmission.
7-80
Own Name and Destination Set
Use this setting to enter the Internet fax address, fax number of the machine and the name of the user.
Sender Data Registration
Use this to store the sender name for fax and Internet fax, the sender number for fax, and the sender address for Internet fax.
The stored sender name and fax sender number or
Internet sender address will be printed at the top of the received fax.
Sender Name
Enter the sender name. A maximum of 20 characters can be entered for the sender name.
Sender Fax Number
This is used to set the sender fax number.
To insert a pause between digits of the number, touch the [-] key.
To insert a space between digits of the number, touch the [Space] key.
I-Fax Own Address
Enter a default sender address (maximum of 56 characters).
Registration of Own Name Select
Store sender names used in "Own Name Select " in the special modes. Up to 18 sender names can be stored.
Add New
Store a sender name. A maximum of 20 characters can be stored.
After entering a sender name, touch the [Store] key. The lowest unused registration number from 01 to 18 will be automatically assigned to the sender name. This number cannot be changed.
Sender Name List
This shows a list of the stored sender names.
A sender name can be selected to delete it.
7-81
Scan Settings
Settings related to scanning can be configured.
Other Settings
Default Sender Set
The information stored here is used if you do not specify
[Reply-To] in the send settings when performing Scan to
E-mail.
Sender Name
Enter a default sender name (maximum of 20 characters).
Reply E-mail Address
Enter a default reply address (maximum of 64 characters).
If only the sender name is stored, it will not be used as sender information.
Default Colour Mode Settings
Select a default colour mode setting for both colour and black & white in scan mode.
Black & White
Mono 2, Greyscale
Colour Mode
Auto (Mono 2, Greyscale*), Full Colour
* When scanning a black and white original with the colour mode set to [Auto].
Disable Change of B/W Setting in Auto Mode
This prohibits black & white settings from the base screen when the colour mode is set to Auto.
Initial File Format Setting
This is used to set the default file format for Scan to
E-mail and USB memory mode when the e-mail address is entered manually by touching the [Address Entry] key.
File Format
PDF, TIFF, JPEG*, Encrypt PDF, XPS
* When [Black & White] is selected, the format is [TIFF].
Black & White
Compression Mode: None, MH(G3), MMR(G4)
Colour/Greyscale
Compression Ratio: Low, Medium, High
Specified Pages per File
When multiple pages are scanned, this is used to generate a separate file for each scanned page (or specified number of pages).
When this setting is enabled, the number of pages per file can be specified.
Number of Pages
Any number of pages can be specified as the number of pages per file. This setting can be specified when
[Specified Pages per File] is enabled.
When [JPEG] is selected for the file type, [Specified
Pages per File] cannot be selected.
Compression Mode at Broadcasting
This is used to set the compression mode for broadcasting using Scan to E-mail or Internet fax. The compression mode set here is used for all destinations regardless of their individual compression mode settings.
Black & White
MH(G3), MMR(G4)
Colour/Greyscale
Low, Medium, High
7-82
Maximum Size of E-mail
Attachments (E-mail)
To prevent the transmission of excessively large image files by Scan to E-mail, a file size limit can be set from
1 MB to 10 MB in increments of 1 MB. If the total size of the image files created by scanning the original exceeds the limit, the image files are discarded.
If you do not wish to set a limit, select [Unlimited].
This setting is linked to " Maximum Size of E-mail
Attachments " (page 7-85) in the Internet Fax Send
Settings.
Pre-Setting Mail Signature
A signature can be automatically appended to the end of the body text of e-mail. This is convenient when it is a corporate policy to append a specific signature at the end of e-mail.
The mail signature to be appended is configured in the
Web pages. This setting simply enables or disables the signature.
This setting is linked to "
(page 7-85) in the Internet Fax Initial Settings.
Maximum Size of Data Attachments
(FTP/Desktop/Network Folder)
A limit can be set for the size of files that can be sent by
Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, and Scan to Network
Folder. Limits that can be selected are 50 MB, 150 MB, and 300 MB. If the total size of the image files created by scanning the original exceeds the limit, the image files are discarded.
If you do not wish to set a limit, select [Unlimited].
When a broadcast transmission is performed that includes both e-mail and Internet fax destinations, the limit set in "
Maximum Size of E-mail Attachments
(E-mail) " (page 7-83) is given priority.
Default Address Setting
A default address can be stored that makes it possible to transmit by simply pressing the [COLOUR START] key or the [BLACK & WHITE START] key without specifying an address. When "Apply E-mail address of the user for login." is selected, the e-mail address of the currently logged-in user can be set as the default address.
• When this setting is enabled, the base screen changes to scan mode.
• Only a single default address can be set for Scan to
E-mail, Scan to FTP, Scan to Desktop, and Scan to
Network Folder.
Bcc Setting
Enable Bcc
Enable this setting if you wish to use Bcc delivery. When the setting is enabled, the [Bcc] key will appear in the image send address book screen.
Display Bcc Address on the Job Status Screen
This displays Bcc addresses on the job status screen and address list tab.
Disable Scan Function
This is used to disable PC scan and USB memory scan.
When these modes are disabled, they are greyed out when the mode is changed in the base screen.
7-83
I-Fax Settings
These settings can be configured when the hard disk drive and Internet fax expansion kit are installed.
I-Fax Default Settings
These settings are used to configure the default settings for Internet fax.
Auto Wake Up Print
When the [POWER] key ( ) is "off" (but the main power switch is "on") and an Internet fax is received, this function activates the machine and prints the fax.
When this function is disabled, received Internet faxes are not printed until the [POWER] key ( ) is switched
"on".
Compression Setting
This is used to set the default compression mode for
Internet fax transmission.
The settings are shown below.
• MH (G3)
• MMR (G4)
Transaction Report Print Select
Setting
This is used to select whether or not a transaction report will be printed, and if printed, the condition for being printed. Select a setting for each of the following operations:
Single Sending
• Print Out All Report
• Print Out Error Report Only
• No Printed Report
Broadcasting
• Print Out All Report
• Print Out Error Report Only
• No Printed Report
Receiving
• Print Out All Report
• Print Out Error Report Only
• No Printed Report
When a transaction report is printed, you can have part of the first page of the transmitted original printed on the transaction report. For more information, see "
Print on Transaction Report ".
Speaker Volume Setting
This is used to adjust the volume of fax receive signals and communication error signals heard through the speaker.
A fax receive signal sounds after the machine checks the mail server and retrieves received faxes. A communication error signal sounds when a delivery failed e-mail is received from the destination Internet fax machine.
Original Print on Transaction
Report
When a transaction report is printed, this is used to print part of the first page of the transmitted original on the transaction report. Select one of the settings below.
• Print Out All Report
• Print Out Error Report Only
• No Printed Report
This setting will not be effective if " Transaction Report
Print Select Setting " below is set to "No Printed Report".
7-84
Activity Report Print Select Setting
This is used to have the Image Sending Activity Report stored in the machine's memory automatically print at specified times.
The Image Sending Activity Report can be set to automatically print each time the number of transactions reaches 201, and it can also be set to automatically print at a specified time (once a day only). (The settings can be simultaneously enabled.)
• If you only enable the [Print Daily at Designated
Time] setting and the number of recorded transactions exceeds 201 before the specified time, each new transaction will delete the oldest transaction (the oldest transaction will not be printed).
• The Image Sending Activity Report can also be printed manually. See "
(page 7-91) in the system settings (administrator).
I-Fax Send Settings
I-Fax Send Settings are described below.
I-Fax Reception Report On/Off
Setting
This setting is used to request a reception report when an Internet fax is sent.
The reception report is returned to the sender address
stored in " Own Name and Destination Set " (page 7-81).
I-Fax Reception Report Request
Timeout Setting
The duration of time that the machine will wait for a reception report from the destination machine can be set by any number from 1 hour to 240 hours in increments of
1 minute.
This setting is only effective when "
Report On/Off Setting " is enabled.
Body Text Print Select Setting
Image files attached to Internet faxes are normally printed. This setting can be enabled to also have the e-mail body text (subject and message) printed.
This setting also applies to printing of the body text of e-mail messages without file attachments.
A maximum of 5 pages of body text can be printed.
Number of Resend Times at
Reception Error
The number of resend attempts when an error message is received from an I-Fax recipient can be set to any number from 0 to 15.
This setting is only effective when "
Report On/Off Setting " is enabled.
Pre-Setting Mail Signature
A signature can be automatically appended to the end of the body text of e-mail. This is convenient when it is a corporate policy to append a certain signature at the end of e-mail.
The mail signature to be appended is configured in the
Web pages. This setting simply enables or disables the signature.
This setting is linked to " Pre-Setting Mail Signature "
(page 7-83) in the Scan Settings.
Maximum Size of E-mail
Attachments
To prevent the transmission of excessively large image files by Internet fax, a file size limit can be set from 1 MB to 10 MB in increments of 1 MB. If the total size of the image files created by scanning the original exceeds the limit, the image files are discarded.
If you do not wish to set a limit, select [Unlimited].
• This setting is linked to "
Attachments (E-mail) " (page 7-83) in the Scan
Settings.
• This setting does not apply to the limit for direct
SMTP transmission.
7-85
Rotation Sending Setting
When transmitting an image that is one of the following sizes, this function rotates the image counterclockwise
90 degrees. (The setting can be configured separately for each size.)
A4, B5R, A5R, 8-1/2 x 11", 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R, 16K
A4R and 8-1/2" x 11"R size images are not rotated.
Printing Page Number at Receiver
When the transmitted image is printed by the receiving machine, the page number can be added to the top of each printed page.
Recall in Case of Line Busy
(This setting is only effective for Direct SMTP transmission.)
This program is used to set the number of recall attempts and the interval between recall attempts when a transmission is not successful due to the line being busy or other reason.
Number of Times to Recall When Line is Busy
This setting specifies whether or not recalling is performed when the line is busy. When recalling is performed, you can set the number of recall attempts.
Any number from 0 to 15 can be selected.
Interval to Wait Between Recall Attempts (min.)
When Line is Busy
The interval between recall attempts can be set. Any number of minutes from 1 to 15 can be selected.
Recall in Case of Communication Error
(This setting is only effective for Direct SMTP transmission.)
This determines how many times your machine will automatically re-attempt the call if a fax transmission fails due to a communication error.
Number of Times to Recall in Case of Error
Specify how many times the machine will re-attempt the call when a communication error occurs.
Any number from 0 to 15 can be selected.
Interval to Wait Between Recall Attempts (min.) in
Case of Error
The interval between recall attempts can be set. Any number of minutes from 1 to 15 can be selected.
I-Fax Receive Settings
I-Fax Receive Settings are described below.
Auto Receive Reduce Setting
When a fax is received that includes printed information such as the sender's name and address, the received image is slightly larger than the standard size. This setting is used to automatically reduce the image to fit the standard size.
• If Auto Receive Reduce is disabled, the edges of the image outside the standard size will be cut off.
However, the image will be clearer because it will be printed at the same size as the original.
• Standard sizes are sizes such as A4 and B5
(8-1/2" x 11" and 8-1/2" x 5-1/2").
Duplex Reception Setting
This is used to select whether or not received faxes are printed on both sides of the paper.
When this setting is enabled and a fax consisting of 2 or more pages is received (the pages must be the same size), the pages are printed on both sides of the paper.
Set Address for Data Forwarding
When the machine is unable to print a received fax, the fax can be forwarded to another machine. This setting is used to configure the address of the other machine.
Forwarding to
Enter the forwarding address (maximum of 64 characters).
Direct SMTP
Select this to enable forwarding when direct SMTP is used.
Add Hostname or IP Address Too
Select this to separately enter a host name or IP address.
Hostname or IP Address
When "Add Hostname or IP Address Too " is enabled, use this setting to enter the host name or IP address
(maximum of 64 characters).
Multiple forwarding addresses cannot be stored.
7-86
Letter Size RX Reduce Print
This program is not available in Canada and Philippines.
When a letter-R (8-1/2" x 11"R) size fax is received, this setting reduces the fax to A4R size.
When this setting is enabled, A4R size faxes are also reduced.
The machine also checks the mail server (POP3 server) for received Internet faxes when the main power is switched on. (Except when 0 hours 0 minutes is specified.)
I-Fax Output Setting
This sets the output tray for received Internet faxes.
The items that appear will vary depending the machine configuration.
Receiving Date & Time Print
Enable this setting to have the date and time of reception printed.
Select [Inside the Received Image] or [Outside the
Received Image] for the position where the date and time is printed.
When [Inside the Received Image] is selected, the date and time of reception is printed on the received image.
When [Outside the Received Image] is selected, the received image is reduced and the date and time of reception is printed in the blank area that results.
[Outside the Received Image] cannot be selected for the reception date and time print setting when "
Receive Reduce Setting " (page 7-86) is not enabled.
A3 RX Reduce
When an A3 size fax is received, this function reduces the fax to ledger (11" x 17") size.
When this setting is enabled, ledger (11" x 17") size faxes are also reduced.
POP3 Communication Timeout Setting
The duration of time the machine waits until stopping reception when a response is not received from the mail server (POP3 server) can be set from 30 to 300 seconds in increments of 30 seconds.
Reception Check Interval Setting
This is used to specify the interval at which the machine automatically checks the mail server (POP3 server) for received Internet faxes. The interval can be set from 0 minutes to 8 hours in increments of 1 minute.
When 0 hours 0 minutes is specified, the machine does not automatically check the mail server for received
Internet faxes.
Allow/Reject Mail or Domain
Name Setting
This setting is used to allow or refuse reception from specified addresses/domains.
Item
Reject
Reception
Allow
Reception
All Invalid
Add New
Registered address or domain list
Description
Reception from the stored address/domain is not allowed.
Reception from the stored address/domain is allowed.
Reception from any address and domain is allowed, regardless of whether or not any addresses or domains have been stored.
Use this to add a new address or domain
(maximum of 50) from which reception is to be rejected or allowed.
Enter the address/domain (maximum of
64 characters) and touch the [Store] key.
If the first character of the entry is not
"@", the entry is identified as an address.
If the first character is "@", the entry is identified as a domain. ([email protected] is treated as an address, and
@xx.xxx.com is treated as a domain.)
Storing an address specifies only that address. Storing a domain specifies all addresses that include that domain.
This shows a list of the stored addresses and domains. An address or domain can be selected in this screen to delete it from the list.
When there are no stored anti junk mail addresses or domains, only the [Add New] key can be selected.
7-87
Document Filing Settings
This function requires the hard disk drive.
Document filing settings are described below. Touch the [Document Filing Settings] key to configure the settings.
Other Settings
Default Mode Settings
This is used to specify which mode, Sharing or
Confidential, is used as the default mode when storing a file.
When [Confidential Mode] is selected, the [Confidential] checkbox in the information screen for filing will be selected .
Default Colour Mode Settings
This sets the default settings for black & white and colour when Scan to HDD is used.
The settings are shown below.
Colour
Auto, Full Colour, 2 Colour
Black & White
Mono 2, Greyscale
Sort Method Setting
This setting is used to select the order of display of files stored in the Main Folder, Custom Folder, and Quick File
Folder. Select one of the following settings:
• File Name
• User Name
• Date
Administrator Authority Setting
For files and user folders that have a password, this setting allows the administrator password to be entered instead of the password when accessing the file or folder.
The administrator can also change the password.
Delete All Quick Files
This function deletes all files except protected files from the Quick File Folder.
Delete Now
Touch this key to start deletion of all files immediately.
Delete Quick Files at Power Up
This is used to automatically delete all files in the Quick
File Folder (with the exception of protected files) when the [POWER] key ( ) is turned "on".
Default Exposure Settings
Default exposure settings for document filing can be configured. Select [Auto] or [Manual]. If you select
[Manual], set the exposure to one of 5 levels.
Default Original Type
Select the original type beforehand to enable scanning at a resolution suitable for the original.
The settings are shown below.
• Text/Printed Photo
• Text/Photo
• Text
• Photo
• Printed Photo
•
• Map
When the exposure is set to [Auto], a default original type cannot be selected.
Moiré Reduction
This reduces the moiré effect (line pattern) that occurs when printed matter is scanned.
Initial Resolution Settings
One of the following resolutions can be selected for the default resolution for transmission.
• 100X100 dpi
• 200X200 dpi
• 300X300 dpi
• 400X400 dpi
• 600X600 dpi
7-88
Colour Data Compression Ratio
Setting
[Low], [Medium], or [High] can be selected for the default compression ratio for transmission of a stored colour file.
Scan Complete Sound Setting
This setting adjusts the volume of the beep that sounds when scanning ends. The beep can also be turned off.
Card Shot Settings
This is used to set the default original size for the card shot function.
Both the X (horizontal) and Y (vertical) dimensions of the original can be set from 25 mm (1") to 210 mm (8-1/2") in increments of 1 mm (1/8").
Fit to Store Size
Enable this setting to have the [Fit to Store Size] key always appear in the card shot screen.
Default Output Tray
(When the exit tray unit is installed.)
This setting is used to select the default output tray for printing a file stored by Scan to HDD.
The items that appear will vary depending the machine configuration.
Disable Stamp for Reprinting
When a stored file is retrieved and printed, this setting prohibits the selection of a "Stamp" setting in the special modes. If a stamp setting is already selected, it will not be possible to change the stamp setting.
This function can be used to prevent inconsistencies in the printed information, such as that of the original date in the file and the date the file is retrieved and printed.
Batch Print Settings
When printing files by batch printing, this setting is used to prohibit the selection of the [All Users] key and the
[User Unknown] key in the user selection screen.
Erase Width Adjustment
This is used to set the default erase width for erase function. Specify a value from 0 mm (0") to 20 mm (1") in increments of 1 mm (1/8") for both edge erase and centre erase.
7-89
Document Output Options
The use of a stored file can be allowed or prohibited by operation type and by the mode from which the file was stored.
The items that appear will vary depending on the functions that have been added to the machine.
Item
Scan Send
Internet Fax Send
(Incl. PC-I-Fax)
Fax Send (Incl. PC-Fax)
Description
For each mode, select whether or not printing of stored files is allowed.
For each mode, select whether or not scan send of stored files is allowed.
For each mode, select whether or not I-Fax transmission of stored files is allowed.
For each mode, select whether or not fax transmission of stored files is allowed.
Automatic Deletion of File Settings
Time and folder settings can be configured to have files in specified folders (stored by document filing) automatically deleted at a specified time. Up to 3 settings can be stored to be automatically deleted.
The procedure for using this function is as follows:
(1) Select one of [Setting 1] to [Setting 3].
(2) Set the time and date of automatic deletion.
(3) Select the desired folder.
(4) Specify whether or not protected files and confidential files are to be deleted.
(5) Enable the stored settings.
Schedule
Folders
Item
Delete Protected File
Delete Confidential File
Description
Select the automatic deletion cycle.
• Every Day: Auto deletion every day at the specified time.
• Every Week: Auto deletion at the specified time on the specified day of the week.
• Every Month: Auto deletion at the specified time on the specified day of the month.
To select the folder separately, select [Folder Select] and select the desired folder. To select all folders, including the folder currently being created, select [All Folders (Including folders registered hereafter)].
Enable this setting to include protected files in the deletion.
Enable this setting to include confidential files in the deletion.
Delete Now
When this is executed with a folder selected, all files in the folder will be immediately deleted regardless of the date and time setting.
7-90
List Print (Administrator)
This is used to print lists and reports that are only for use by the administrator of the machine. Touch the [List Print
(Administrator)] key to configure the settings.
Administrator Settings List
Lists of the administrator settings for the following modes can be printed.
• Copy
• Image Send
• Document Filing (When the hard disk drive is installed.)
• Security
• Common
• All Administrator Settings List
Image Sending Activity Report
The following Image Sending Activity Reports can each be separately printed.
• Image Sending Activity Report (Scan)
• Image Sending Activity Report (Internet Fax)
• Image Sending Activity Report (Fax)
Data Receive/Forward List
The following lists showing reception settings and forwarding settings can be printed.
• Anti Junk Fax Number List
• Anti Junk Mail/Domain Name List
• Inbound Routing List
• Document Admin List
Web Settings List
(When network connection is enabled.)
This prints a list of the settings that are configured in the
Web pages.
Metadata Set List
(When the hard disk drive and application integration module are installed.)
This prints a list of the metadata sets stored in the Web pages.
7-91
Security Settings
This function requires the hard disk drive.
The following settings are related to security. Touch the [Security Settings] key to configure the settings.
SSL Settings
SSL can be used for data transmission over a network.
SSL is a protocol that enables the encryption of information communicated over a network. Encrypting data makes it possible to transmit and receive sensitive information safely.
SSL can be enabled for the following protocols:
Server Port
• HTTPS: Apply SSL encryption to HTTP communication.
• IPP-SSL: Apply SSL encryption to IPP communication.
• Redirect HTTP to HTTPS in Device Web Page
Access:
When this setting is enabled, all communication that attempts to access the machine by HTTP is redirected to HTTPS.
Client Port
• HTTPS:
• FTPS:
Apply SSL encryption to HTTP communication.
Apply SSL encryption to FTP communication.
• SMTP-SSL: Apply SSL encryption to SMTP communication.
• POP3-SSL: Apply SSL encryption to POP3 communication.
• LDAP-SSL: Apply SSL encryption to LDAP communication.
Level of Encryption
The encryption strength can be set to one of three levels.
IPsec Settings
IPsec can be used for data transmission/reception on a network. When IPsec is used, data can be sent and received safely without the need to configure settings for
IP packet encryption in a Web browser or other higher-level application.
This setting is only used to enable or disable IPsec; detailed IPsec settings are configured in the Web pages.
Note the following points when enabling IPsec:
• A certain amount of time may be needed for the setting to be updated. During this time, it will not be possible to connect to the machine.
• If the settings in the Web page are not configured correctly, it will not be possible to connect to the machine, and printing, scanning, and Web page display may not be possible. In this event, disable the setting at the machine and then correct the settings in the Web page.
7-92
IEEE802.1X Setting
IEEE802.1X can be used to authenticate a user to allow use of the machine.
IEEE802.1X protocol defines port-based authentication for both wired and wireless networks.
Use IEEE802.1X authentication to allow only authenticated devices to use network, and protect against network abuse by third parties.
This setting is only used to enable or disable
IEEE802.1X; detailed IEEE802.1X settings are configured in the Web pages.
Some Web page settings may not allow connection to the machine, or the settings may not allow printing, scanning, or Web page display. In this case, deselect this setting and change the Web page settings.
Initialize Private Data/Data in
Machine
The system-set values can be restored to the factory default state after eliminating the data stored in the machine.
Enable/Disable Settings
The following settings are used to prohibit the use of certain functions. Touch the [Enable/Disable Settings] key to configure the settings.
The Enable/Disable Settings control the same parameters as the enable/disable settings in other settings. The settings are linked together (changing one setting changes the other).
Printer Condition Settings
(When the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.)
Disable Blank Page Print
This setting is used to disable blank page printing.
User Control
Disabling of Printing by Invalid User
Printing by users whose information is not stored in the machine, such as printing without entering valid user information in the printer driver or printing of a file on an
FTP server from the Web pages, can be prohibited.
Operation Settings
Cancel Auto Clear Timer
This setting is used to disable Auto Clear.
Disabling of Job Priority Operation
The job priority function can be disabled. When this is done, the [Priority] key will not appear in the job status screen.
Disabling of Bypass Printing
This setting is used to disable bypass printing (printing other jobs ahead of a job that has been stopped* because the paper required for the job is not in any of the trays).
* This does not include cases where the paper ran out during the job.
Disable Auto Key Repeat
This setting is used to disable the auto key repeat function.
Disabling of Clock Adjustment
This setting is used to prohibit changing of the date and time.
Disabling of Covers/Inserts Mode
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
This setting is used to prohibit the use of the covers and inserts function.
Device Control
Disabling of Document Feeder
This function requires the automatic document feeder.
Use this setting to prohibit the use of the automatic document feeder, such as when the feeder malfunctions.
(When the setting is enabled, scanning is still possible using the document glass.)
Disabling of Duplex
This is used to disable two-sided printing, such as when the duplex module malfunctions.
Disabling of Optional Paper Drawer
(When an optional paper drawer is installed.)
This setting is used to disable the optional paper drawer, such as when it malfunctions.
Disabling of Tray Setting
This setting is used to prohibit tray settings.
Disabling of Finisher
(When a finisher is installed.)
This setting is used to disable the finisher, such as when the unit malfunctions.
Disabling of Offset
This setting is used to disable the offset function.
Disabling of Stapler
(When a finisher is installed.)
This setting is used to prohibit stapling, such as when the stapler unit of the finisher malfunctions.
Disabling of Punch
(When a punch module is installed.)
This setting is used to prohibit punching, such as when the punch module of the finisher malfunctions.
7-93
Disabling of Colour Mode
(When a colour-related problem has occurred.)
When a colour-related problem has occurred and printing is not possible, the use of colour mode can be temporarily prohibited. Black & white printing will still be allowed.
This function is only for use as an emergency measure. Once this setting is enabled, only a service technician can cancel the setting. Promptly contact your dealer or nearest SHARP service department to have a service technician cancel the setting and resolve the colour-related problem.
Disabling of Master Machine Mode
This prohibits the use of the machine as a master machine for tandem printing.
(Normally this setting is not necessary.)
Disabling of Slave Machine Mode
This prohibits the use of the machine as a slave machine for tandem printing.
(Normally this setting is not necessary.)
Printer Settings
Prohibit Notice Page Printing
This setting is used to disable printing of notice pages.
Prohibit Test Page Printing
This setting is used to disable printing of test pages.
When this setting is enabled, "Printer Test Page" in the system settings cannot be used to print test pages.
Exclude Bypass-Tray from Auto Paper Select
When [Auto] is selected for paper type selection, the bypass tray can be excluded from the trays that can be selected. This is recommended when special paper is often placed in the bypass tray.
Disabling of USB Memory Direct Print
This function requires the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.
This setting is used to disable printing of files on USB memory.
When this setting is enabled, "USB Memory" in the
External Data Access screen cannot be used to print files.
Disabling of Network Folder Direct Print
This function requires the hard disk drive and printer expansion kit are installed.
This setting is used to disable printing of files on network folders.
When this setting is enabled, "Network Folder" in the
External Data Access screen cannot be used to print files.
Copy Function Settings
Disabling Deletion of Job Programs
This is used to prohibit the deletion and changing of copy settings stored in job programs.
Disabling of Bypass-Tray in Duplex Copy
This is used to prohibit the use of the bypass tray when making two-sided copies.
The bypass tray is often used to feed label sheets, transparency film, and other special media for which two-sided copying is prohibited. If a sheet of one of these special media enters the reversing unit, a misfeed or damage to the unit may result. If special media for which two-sided copying is prohibited is often used, it is recommended that you enable this setting.
Disabling of Auto Paper Selection
This setting is used to disable the Auto Paper Selection function.
When this setting is enabled, automatic selection of paper that is the same size as the original on the document glass or in the automatic document feeder does not take place.
7-94
Image Send Settings
Other Disabling
Disable Switching of Display Order
This is used to prohibit changes to the order of display
(search number order, ascending, descending) in the address book.
When this setting is enabled, touching a tab on the address book screen does not change the order. The currently selected display order will be the order that is used after the setting is selected.
Disable Scan Function
This is used to disable PC scan and USB memory scan.
When these modes are disabled, they are greyed out when the mode is changed in the base screen.
Settings to Disable Registration
Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel
This disables address control from the machine.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• Group (Direct Entry)
• Group (Address Book)
• Individual
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Registering Destination on Web Page
(When network connection is enabled.)
This disables address control from the Web pages.
• Group (Direct Entry)
• Group (Address Book)
• Individual
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Registration of Program
This prohibits the use of the address book when a program is stored.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• FTP
• Desktop
• Network Folder
• Internet Fax (Including Direct SMTP)
• Fax
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Registration of Memory Box
Disable all types of memory box registration.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
Polling Memory, Confidential, Relay Broadcast (Direct
Entry), Relay Broadcast (Address Book)
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Destination Registration Using Global
Address Search
(When network connection is enabled.)
This disables address control from the global address search.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
E-mail, Internet Fax, Fax
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Registration Using Network Scanner Tools
(When network connection is enabled.)
This disables address control from the Network Scanner
Tool.
Settings to Disable Transmission
These settings are used to disable the following transmission operations.
Disable [Resend] on Image Send Mode
This setting disables the [Resend] key in the base screen of image send mode.
Disable Selection from Address Book
This disables the selection of destinations from the address book.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• FTP
• Desktop
• Network Folder
• Internet Fax (Including Direct SMTP)
• Fax
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable Direct Entry
This prohibits the direct entry of addresses.
Configure the setting for each of the following items:
• Network Folder
• Internet Fax (Including Direct SMTP)
• Fax
Select All: Select all items.
Clear Checked: Clear all selections.
Disable PC-I-Fax Transmission
(When the Internet fax expansion kit is installed.)
This prohibits PC-I-Fax transmission.
Disable PC-Fax Transmission
(When the facsimile expansion kit is installed.)
This prohibits PC-Fax transmission.
Document Filing Settings
(When the hard disk drive is installed.)
Disable Stamp for Reprinting
When a stored file is retrieved and printed, this setting prohibits the selection of a "Stamp" setting in the special modes. If a stamp setting is already selected, it will not be possible to change the stamp setting.
This function can be used to prevent inconsistencies in the printed information, such as that of the original date in the file and the date the file is retrieved and printed.
Batch Print Settings
When printing files by batch printing, this setting is used to prohibit the selection of the [All Users] key and the
[User Unknown] key in the user selection screen.
7-95
Change Administrator Password
This is used to change the administrator password. Touch the [Change Administrator Password] key to change the password.
When changing the password, be sure to remember the new password.
It is recommended that you periodically change the administrator password.
Password
Enter the new administrator password (5 to 32 characters).
Password (confirmation)
Enter the new password once again for confirmation purposes.
For the factory default administrator password, see "TO THE ADMINISTRATOR OF THE MACHINE" in the Start Guide.
Product Key
The procedures for entering the product keys of the expansion kits are explained below. Touch the [Product Key] key to configure the settings.
• It may not be possible to use some settings, depending on the peripheral devices installed.
• For the product key to be entered, contact your dealer.
Serial Number
This displays the serial number that is required to obtain the product key.
Font Kit for Barcode
Enter the product key of the barcode font kit.
PS3 Expansion Kit
Enter the product key of the PS3 expansion kit.
Internet Fax Expansion Kit
Enter the product key of the Internet fax expansion kit.
E-mail Alert and Status
Enter the product key of e-mail alert and status.
Application Integration Module
Enter the product key of the application integration module.
Application Communication
Module
Enter the product key of the application communication module.
External Account Module
Enter the product key of the external account module.
XPS Expansion Kit
Enter the product key of the XPS expansion kit.
7-96
Data Backup
Settings and information stored in the machine can be saved to USB memory.
• This function can be enabled when a USB memory device is installed.
• This function cannot be used while the system settings are in use, while a job is being executed, or when there is a reserved job.
• For machines for which data can be imported, contact your SHARP dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
Storage Backup
Address book information and user information stored in the machine can be saved to and retrieved from USB memory.
Export
This exports data to USB memory.
Import
Use "Export" to import data written to USB memory back into the machine.
Device Cloning
Device cloning is used to save the machine's setting information in XML format and copy the information to another machine.
This function saves you the trouble of repeatedly configuring the same settings in multiple machines.
Export
This exports data to USB memory.
Import
Use "Export" to import data written to USB memory back into the machine.
The following data is not copied when device cloning is performed:
• List print and fax forwarding items.
• Count and device status display items.
• IP address of the machine, device name, administrator password, sender names for image send, and other information that is specific to the machine.
• Screen contrast, colour adjustment and other adjusted values particular to each hardware device.
7-97
Storing/Calling of System Settings
The current system settings can be stored, previously stored system settings can be retrieved, and the factory default system settings can be restored. Touch the [Storing/Calling of System Settings] key to configure the settings.
Restore Factory Defaults
This is used to return the system settings to the factory default settings. If you wish to create a record of the current settings before restoring the factory default
settings, print the current settings using " List Print
(Administrator) " (page 7-91) in the system settings
(administrator).
When settings are changed, the changes will take effect after the machine is restarted. To restart the machine see "
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF "
(page 1-15) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE ".
Store Current Configuration
This is used to store the currently configured system settings. The stored settings will be retained even if the
[POWER] key ( ) is turned off. To retrieve the stored
settings, use " Restore Configuration " below.
Items not stored
• Network Settings: These are not stored as unexpected settings may cause damage to the
• Product Keys: network.
Product Keys are not stored as reissue of keys may be necessary.
Restore Configuration
Use this to restore settings stored with "
".
The current settings will change to the retrieved settings.
7-98
Sharp OSA Settings
These settings can be used when the hard disk drive and external account module or application communication module is available.
External Account Setting
External Account Control
When this setting is enabled, the machine enters external totaling mode and the totaling function can be used via an external account application.
Enable Authentication by External Server
When this setting is enabled, the machine enters external authentication mode. Access to the machine is controlled by an external application.
When settings are changed, the changes will take effect after the machine is restarted. To restart the machine see "
TURNING THE POWER ON AND OFF "
(page 1-15) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE ".
Job Priority Preference
Set the playing speed of the animation in the Sharp OSA application.
The following settings can be configured.
• Printing
• Balanced
• LCD Animation Playback
When "LCD Animation Playback" or "Balanced" is selected, the machine's job processing speed (for print and other jobs) may become slower. If you wish to give priority to job processing speed, select
"Printing".
USB Driver Settings
When installing the external account module or application communication module, set the driver of the
USB device to be connected.
External Keyboard
Select whether the internal or external driver for the external keyboard is used.
USB Memory
Select whether the internal or external USB memory driver is used.
Level of Encryption
Select the level of encryption for communication using the external driver.
Select from none, AES-128 or AES-256.
• When the external driver is selected, the connected
USB device is treated as not connected and cannot be used.
• When settings are changed, the changes will take effect after the machine is restarted. To restart the machine see "
OFF " (page 1-15) in "1. BEFORE USING THE
MACHINE ".
7-99
SYSTEM SETTINGS FOR FAX
This section explains system settings that are specifically for the fax function.
The system settings for the fax function can only be configured when the facsimile expansion kit is installed.
System Settings for Fax (General) List
When the system settings for fax are accessed with general rights, the following items appear. For items that can only
Depending on the machine specifications and peripheral devices installed, it may not be possible to use some settings.
Address Control
Item
■
●
●
Fax Data Receive/Forward
Item
■
●
X
Receive Setting
X Multiple Set Print
X
Staple*
X Forward Received Data
* When a finisher is installed.
–
–
Factory default setting
Factory default setting
Auto Reception
Disabled
Disabled
–
Page
Page
7-100
Address Control
Address Book
This section explains items specifically used for fax in "Address Control". For items that are also used for other functions, see "
Address Control " (page 7-16).
When the [Address Book] key is touched, the following screen appears.
Address Book
Add New
Index Switch
ABC
Sorting Order
Search Number
Sort Address
AAA AAA
CCC CCC
EEE EEE
GGG GGG
III III
Freq.
ABCD
Back
All
EFGH IJKL
BBB BBB
DDD DDD
FFF FFF
HHH HHH
JJJ JJJ
MNOP QRSTU VWXYZ etc.
1
2
• [Add New] key
Use this to add a new address.
• List display
This displays a list of the currently stored addresses.
An address can be selected to open an edit/delete screen for the address.
Storing addresses
Touch the [Add New] key in the above screen to open a registration screen. Up to 1000 addresses can be stored.
For information on the settings, see "
for a function, addresses cannot be stored for that function.
Editing and deleting addresses
An address can be selected from the list in the above screen to open an edit/delete screen for the address.
For information on the settings, see "
Delete an address with the [Delete] key.
• If you cannot edit or delete a one-touch individual or group key...
Individual keys and group keys cannot be edited or deleted in the following situations:
- The key is used in a reserved transmission or a transmission in progress.
- The key is included in a group key.
- The key is included in a program.
- The key is specified as an end receiving machine in an F-code relay broadcast transmission.
- When "
Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel " (page 7-79) is enabled.
If the key is used in a reserved transmission or a transmission that is in progress, cancel the transmission or wait until it is completed and then edit or delete the key.
If the key is included in a group, first delete the key from the group and then edit or delete the key.
If the key is specified as a forwarding destination, cancel the forwarding destination setting and then edit or delete the key.
If "Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel" has been enabled, clear this function and then edit or delete the key.
7-101
Settings
Item
General items stored
Address Type
Description
Search Number
Address Name
Initial
Key Name
Custom Index
Register this Address to be added to the
[Frequent Use] index.
Fax Number
Transmission Mode
Select the type of address to be stored in the address book.
In this case, select [Fax].
Set a search number. The lowest available number is automatically entered. To change the number, enter a number from 0001 to 1000. A search number that has already been stored cannot be used.
Enter a maximum of 36 characters for the address name.
Enter up to 10 characters for the initials. The initials you enter here determine the position of the one-touch key in the alphabetical index.
Enter the name that you wish to appear in the address book (this is different from the address name).
Select the custom index in which the address will appear.
Frequently used addresses can be stored in the [Frequent Use] index.
Enter the fax number of the destination (maximum of 64 digits).
To cancel the PBX settings* temporarily when sending a fax...
Touch the [R] key before entering a fax number.
* This function is not available in some countries and regions.
Entering a pause between digits of the number
Touch the [-] key at the place where you wish to enter a pause.
To enter an F-code (sub-address and passcode)...
(1) Enter the destination fax number.
(2) Touch the [/] key.
(3) Enter the sub address (maximum of 20 digits).
(4) Touch the [/] key.
(5) Enter the passcode (maximum of 20 digits).
A passcode is not necessary if the destination machine does not use a passcode.
The destination fax number can be a maximum of 64 digits including all numbers and characters. However, only the first 32 digits will appear in the display.
Set the transmission speed and the International Correspondence Mode.
Selecting appropriate settings for these items may help eliminate communication errors.
Transmission Speed
33.6 kbps, 14.4 kbps, 9.6 kbps or 4.8 kbps can be selected for the transmission speed. Higher numbers are higher transmission speeds.
Set the transmission speed only when you know what speed is most suitable, such as when you are sending a fax to a foreign country and telephone line conditions are bad. If you do not know the line conditions, do not change this setting.
Transmission Mode
No Sound, Mode1, Mode2, or Mode3 can be selected for the International
Correspondence Mode.
When sending a fax to a foreign country, telephone line conditions can sometimes distort the fax or interrupt the transmission. If errors frequently occur when sending a fax to a foreign country, try each of modes 1 to 3 and select the mode that enables the best transmission.
7-102
F-Code Memory Box
This section explains how to store memory boxes for various types of F-code communication.
When the [F-Code Memory Box] key is touched, the following screen appears.
System Settings
F-Code Memory Box
Add New
Back
Sort Polling Memory
Box 1
Box 3
Box 5
Box 7
Box 9
Box 2
Box 4
Box 6
Box 8
Box 10
1
2
• [Add New] key
Use this to add a new memory box.
• List display
This displays a list of the currently stored memory boxes. A memory box can be selected to open an edit/delete screen for the memory box.
Storing a memory box
Touch the [Add New] key in the above screen to open a registration screen. A total of 100 F-code memory boxes for all functions (polling memory, confidential, and relay broadcast) can be stored.
For information on the settings, see "
Editing and deleting a memory box
A memory box can be selected from the list in the above screen to open an edit/delete screen for the box.
For information on the settings, see "
Delete a memory box with the [Delete] key.
7-103
Settings
Item
Items common to all types
Description
Box Type
Memory Box Name
Sub Address / Passcode
Select the type of box.
• Polling Memory: Store a memory box for F-code polling memory. The sub-address and passcode that you program in the memory box are necessary for the other machine to poll your machine
• Confidential:
(request transmission) using F-code communication.
Store a memory box for F-code confidential reception. In addition, store a "Print PIN" in the memory box to print faxes received by confidential reception. The sub-address and passcode that you program in the memory box are necessary for the other machine to send a fax to your machine by
F-code confidential transmission.
• Relay Broadcast: Store a memory box for F-code relay broadcast transmission.
Store the fax numbers of the end recipients (up to 30) in the memory box. The sub-address and passcode that you program in the memory box are necessary for the other machine to perform an F-code relay request transmission
(ask your machine to relay a fax).
Enter a name (maximum of 18 characters) for the memory box.
Enter a sub-address and passcode. A maximum of 20 digits can be entered for each.
Separate a sub-address and passcode by a slash ("/").
Items displayed when storing a confidential memory box
Print PIN Set a "Print PIN" for confidential reception. Enter a 4-digit number.
Items displayed when storing a relay broadcast memory box
Recipients
Select the end recipients of the relay broadcast. Select the recipients from the address book.
• Direct Entry: An address that is not stored in the address book can be directly entered. Enter the address in the same way as when storing an address for a mode.
• Address Review: This displays a list of the selected recipients. Addresses can be deleted from this list if needed.
• When programming a new memory box, a sub-address that is already programmed for another box cannot be used.
However, the same passcode can be used for more than one memory box.
• A passcode can be omitted.
• [ ] and [#] cannot be used in a sub-address.
• Do not forget the Print PIN. In the event that you forget the Print PIN or need to verify the Print PIN, contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
7-104
Fax Data Receive/Forward
This section explains settings for reception and forwarding.
Fax Settings
The following items appear when the "Fax Settings" are configured.
Item
Receive Setting
Multiple Set Print
Staple
Forward Received Data
Description
Set the fax reception method.
• Auto Reception: When a call comes in, the machine rings and then automatically begins fax reception.
• Manual Reception: This can be used when an existing extension phone is connected to the machine. Fax reception is begun by manual operation after answering on the extension phone.
Specify whether or not two or more copies of received faxes will be printed. The number of copies is set in "
Fax Output Settings ", (page 7-113).
Specify whether or not stapling is performed. (Only when a finisher is installed.)
Stapling settings are set in " Fax Output Settings ", (page 7-113).
When the machine cannot print because it is out of paper or out of toner, received faxes can be forwarded to another previously stored fax machine.
• If some pages of a fax that is being forwarded were successfully printed, only those pages that were not printed will be forwarded.
• A forwarded fax becomes a fax transmission job. If transmission does not take place because the transmission was cancelled or an error occurred, the fax will be held in memory until it can be printed.
• All faxes received are forwarded. Note, however, that faxes received to an F-code confidential memory box cannot be forwarded.
settings (administrator).
• Forwarding is not possible if no faxes were received or a forwarding fax number is not programmed.
correct password with the numeric keys.
7-105
System Settings for Fax (Administrator) List
When the system settings for fax are accessed with administrator rights, the following items appear. For information on the general settings, see "
System Settings for Fax (General) List " (page 7-100).
• For the procedure for using the system settings (administrator), see "
Accessing the System Settings (Administrator)
" (page
• Depending on the machine specifications and peripheral devices installed, it may not be possible to use some settings.
Image Send Settings
Item
■
●
X
*
• Speaker
• Ringer Volume
• Line Monitor
• Fax Receive Complete Signal
• Fax Send Complete Signal
• Fax Communication Error Signal
Remote Reception Number Setting
Original Print on Transaction Report
Factory default setting
Tone
Enabled
Varies depending on country and region
Disabled
Page
Volume: 5
Volume: 5
Volume: 5
Volume: 5; Tone Pattern: 3
Transmission Complete Sound Time
Setting: 3 sec.
Volume: 5; Tone Pattern: 3
Transmission Complete Sound Time
Setting: 3 sec.
Volume: 5; Tone Pattern: 3
Transmission Complete Sound Time
Setting: 0.3 sec. each
5
Print Out Error Report Only
7-106
Item
Transaction Report Print Select Setting
• Single Sending
• Broadcasting
• Receiving
• Confidential Reception
Activity Report Print Select Setting
• Auto Print at Memory Full
• Print Daily at Designated Time
X
Auto Reduction Sending Setting
Printing Page Number at Receiver
Date/Own Number Print Position Setting
Recall in Case of Communication Error
X
Number of Calls in Auto Reception
Switching from Manual to Automatic Reception *
Set the Telephone Number for Data Forwarding
X
X
* This function is not available in some countries and regions.
7-107
Factory default setting
Print Out Error Report Only
Print Out All Report
No Printed Report
Print Out Notice Page
Page
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Off
Disabled
Enabled
All Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Outside the Original Image
See " Country Differentiation Table "
See " Country Differentiation Table "
2
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Auto Size Select
–
Disabled
Off
Disabled
Varies depending on the machine configuration
All disabled
Enabled
Image Send Settings
Settings related to the image send function (scan, Internet fax, etc.) can be configured. Touch the [Image Send Settings] key to configure the settings.
Fax Settings
Fax Default Settings
The fax settings can be enabled or disabled to suit the needs of your workplace.
Dial Mode Setting
This setting can only be activated in Canada and
Taiwan.
Select the appropriate setting for your telephone line type.
Dial Mode Setting
Select the line type from the list.
Auto Select
Select this after the line has been connected to have the machine automatically detect whether your line is a pulse dial line or a tone dial line.
Pause Time Setting
Use this to change the length of pauses inserted in fax numbers.
If a hyphen "-" is entered when dialling or storing a fax number, a pause of 2 seconds is inserted.
The pause can be changed to any number of seconds from 1 to 15.
* Note that in South Africa, the machine is normally set to 4 seconds.
Fax Dest. Confirmation Mode
This setting specifies whether or not a destination verification message is displayed when sending a fax in order to prevent accidental transmission to the wrong destination.
Auto Wake Up Print
When the [POWER] key ( ) is "off" (but the main power switch is "on") and a fax is received, this function automatically activates the machine and prints the fax.
When this function is disabled, received faxes are not printed until the [POWER] key ( ) is switched "on".
Speaker Settings
Use these settings to set the sound heard from the speaker for the Speaker, Ringer Volume, Line Monitor,
Fax Receive Complete Signal, Fax Send Complete
Signal, and Fax Communication Error Signal. For the
Fax Receive Complete Signal, the Fax Send Complete
Signal, and the Fax Communication Error Signal, the
Tone Pattern and Transmission Complete Sound Time
Setting can be selected in addition to the volume.
Check on Setup Sounds
Use this to check the selected tone pattern and volume.
Remote Reception Number Setting
Fax reception can be activated from an extension phone connected to the machine by entering a 1-digit number and pressing the key twice on the phone's keypad.
This number is called the remote reception number, and you can set it to any number from "0" to "9".
7-108
Original Print on Transaction
Report
When a transaction report is printed for a memory transmission, this is used to print part of the first page of the transmitted original on the transaction report. Select one of the settings below.
• Print Out All Report
• Print Out Error Report Only
• No Printed Report
This setting will not be effective if " Transaction Report
Print Select Setting " below is set to "No Printed Report".
Transaction Report Print Select
Setting
This is used to select whether or not a transaction report will be printed, and if printed, the condition for being printed. Select a setting for each of the following operations:
Single Sending
• Print Out All Report
• Print Out Error Report Only
• No Printed Report
Broadcasting
• Print Out All Report
• Print Out Error Report Only
• No Printed Report
Receiving
• Print Out All Report
• Print Out Error Report Only
• No Printed Report
Confidential Reception
• Print Out Notice Page
• No Printed Report
When a transaction report is printed, you can have part of the first page of the transmitted original printed on the
transaction report. For more information, see " Original
".
When transaction report printing is set for "Receiving", a report will not be printed for a reception from a number specified as a reject number in "
Number Setting " (page 7-113).
Activity Report Print Select Setting
This is used to have the Image Sending Activity Report that is stored in the machine's memory printed at regular intervals.
The Image Sending Activity Report can be set to automatically print each time the number of transactions reaches 201, and it can also be set to automatically print at a specified time (once a day only). (The settings can be simultaneously enabled.)
• If you only select the "Print Daily at Designated
Time" setting and the number of recorded transactions exceeds 201 before the specified time, each new transaction will delete the oldest transaction (the oldest transaction will not be printed).
• The Image Sending Activity Report can also be printed manually. See "
ECM
Line conditions can sometimes distort a transmitted fax image. When ECM (Error Correction Mode) is turned on, pages that are distorted are automatically re-transmitted.
If the other machine supports Super G3, ECM will function regardless of this setting.
Distinctive Ring Detection
This Setting can only be activated in Canada, Australia,
New Zealand, and Hong Kong.
If multiple telephone numbers have been assigned to your telephone line, the number called can be identified by its ringing pattern. By using one number for voice calls and another number for faxes, you can tell which type of call you are receiving by the ringing pattern. You can set your machine to automatically receive faxes when your fax number is called by setting the pattern that corresponds to your fax number. (Note that in
Canada, six selections are available.)
PBX Setting
This Setting can only be activated in France and
Germany.
When the machine is used on a PBX, you can enable the PBX setting to have the machine automatically connect to the outside line. When this setting is enabled, the [R] key appears in the base screen. When the [R] key is touched, the PBX setting is temporarily cancelled.
If your PBX uses the Flash method to connect to the outside line, select the [Flash]. If your PBX uses an ID number to connect to the outside line, specify the ID number.
Select a number for the first digit and then a number or a hyphen "-" for the second and third digits.
7-109
Fax Send Settings
Settings for fax transmission can be configured.
Auto Reduction Sending Setting
This setting is used to have the size of transmitted faxes automatically reduced to match the size of the paper in the receiving machine.
If the setting is disabled, faxes are sent at full size.
Because the size is not adjusted to match the size of the printing paper, part of the received fax may be cut off.
Date/Own Number Print Position
Setting
This setting determines the position of the date and sender information printed at the top of faxes by the receiving machine. To have the information printed outside the transmitted document image, touch the [Outside the
Original Image] key. To have the information printed inside the document image, touch [Inside the Original Image] key.
For more information on the print position, see "
YOUR SENDER INFORMATION TO FAXES (Own number sending) " (page 4-100) in "4. FACSIMILE".
Rotation Sending Setting
When transmitting an image that is one of the following sizes, this function rotates the image counterclockwise
90 degrees. (The setting can be configured separately for each size.)
A4, B5R, A5R, 8-1/2" x 11", 5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R, 16K
A4R and 8-1/2" x 11"R originals are not rotated.
Quick On Line Sending
When this setting is enabled, the machine starts transmitting a fax as soon as the first page is scanned.
Transmission takes place at the same time as the remaining pages are being scanned.
If you disable this setting, transmission will not begin until all pages have been scanned. Note that this setting does not apply to manual transmission.
Printing Page Number at Receiver
This setting is used to add the page number to the top of each fax page printed by the receiving machine.
7-110
Recall in Case of Line Busy
This program is used to set the number of recall attempts and the interval between recall attempts when a transmission is not successful due to the line being busy or other reason.
Number of Times to Recall When Line is Busy
This setting specifies whether or not recalling is performed when the line is busy. When recalling is performed, you can set the number of recall attempts.
Interval to Wait Between Recall Attempts (min.)
When Line is Busy
The interval between recall attempts can be set.
The number of recall attempts and the interval between attempts that can be set in each country are shown in the following table.
Country Differentiation Table
The number of recall attempts
The interval between attempts any number of minutes from 1 to 15
(default: 3)
United Kingdom,
France,
Germany,
Sweden, Italy,
Spain,
Netherlands,
Saudi Arabia,
South Africa,
Hungary, Czech
Republic,
Slovakia,
Poland, Greece,
Russia
Canada
1 to 10
(default: 2)
1 to 14
(default: 2)
1 to 9
(default: 2)
Australia,
New Zealand,
Singapore,
Thailand,
Malaysia, India,
Philippines
Hong Kong
Taiwan
Indonesia
1 to 3
(default: 2)
1 to 15
(default: 2)
1 to 5
(default: 2) any number of minutes from 4 to 15
(default: 4)
Recall in Case of Communication Error
This determines how many times your machine will automatically re-attempt the call if a fax transmission fails due to a communication error.
Number of Times to Recall in Case of Error
Specify how many times the machine will re-attempt the call when a communication error occurs.
Interval to Wait Between Recall Attempts (min.) in
Case of Error
The interval between recall attempts can be set.
The number of recall attempts and the interval between attempts that can be set in each country are shown in the following table.
Country Differentiation Table
The number of recall attempts
The interval between attempts any number of minutes from 1 to 15
(default: 1)
United Kingdom,
France,
Germany,
Sweden, Italy,
Spain,
Netherlands,
Saudi Arabia,
South Africa,
Hungary, Czech
Republic,
Slovakia,
Poland, Greece,
Russia
Australia,
New Zealand,
Canada
1 to 5
(default: 1)
1 attempt
Singapore,
Thailand,
Malaysia, India,
Philippines
Hong Kong
1 to 9
(default: 2) any number of minutes from 1 to 15
(default: 3) any number of minutes from 1 to 15
(default: 1)
Taiwan
Indonesia
1 to 3
(default: 2)
1 to 15
(default: 2)
1 to 5
(default: 2) any number of minutes from 4 to 15
(default: 4)
When this setting is enabled, note that your machine will not re-attempt a call when manual transmission or direct transmission is used.
7-111
When this setting is enabled, note that your machine will not re-attempt a call when manual transmission or direct transmission is used.
Fax Receive Settings
Settings for fax reception can be configured.
Number of Calls in Auto Reception
This setting is used to select the number of rings on which the machine automatically receives a call and begins fax reception in auto reception mode.
The "Number of Calls in Auto Reception" that can be set in each country are shown in the following table.
Country Differentiation Table
United Kingdom, France,
Germany, Sweden, Italy, Spain,
Netherlands, Thailand, Hong Kong,
Saudi Arabia, South Africa,
Hungary, Czech Republic,
Slovakia, Poland, Greece, Russia,
Philippines, Indonesia
Australia, New Zealand
Singapore
Malaysia, India, Canada, Taiwan
The number of rings
0 to 9
2 to 4
0 to 3
0 to 15
If you select "0" for the number of rings, the machine will immediately answer and begin fax reception without ringing in auto reception mode.
Auto Receive Reduce Setting
When a fax is received that includes the sender's name and number, the received image is slightly larger than the standard size. This setting is used to automatically reduce the image to fit the standard size.
• If Auto Receive Reduce is disabled, the edges of the image outside the standard size will be cut off.
However, the image will be clearer because it will be printed at the same size as the original.
• Standard sizes are sizes such as A4 and B5
(8-1/2" x 11" and 8-1/2" x 5-1/2").
Print Style Setting
This setting determines the paper selection condition when printing received faxes. Select one of the three conditions below.
Print Actual Size Cut off Disabled
The received fax image is printed at full size without dividing it onto multiple sheets of paper. If the same size of paper or larger paper is not loaded, the fax will be received in memory and will not be printed until a suitable size of paper is loaded.
However, if the received fax is longer than A3 (11" x 17") size, it will be automatically divided onto multiple sheets of paper.
Print Actual Size Cut off Enabled
Each received image is printed at full size. If necessary, the image is divided onto multiple sheets of paper.
Auto Size Select
Each received image is printed at full size when possible. When not possible, the image is automatically reduced before printing.
Switching from Manual to
Automatic Reception
This setting can only be activated in France.
When a fax is received in manual reception mode, you have have the machine automatically switch to auto reception. The number of rings on which switching to auto reception takes place can be set to any number from 1 to 9.
Duplex Reception Setting
This is used to have received faxes printed on both sides of the paper.
When this setting is enabled and a fax consisting of 2 or more pages is received (the pages must be the same size), the pages are printed on both sides of the paper.
Set the Telephone Number for Data
Forwarding
When a problem prevents the machine from printing a received fax, the received fax can be forwarded to another fax machine. This setting is used to program the fax number of the destination fax machine. Only one forwarding fax number can be programmed (maximum of 64 digits).
To insert a pause between digits of the number, touch the [-] key.
If you wish to specify an F-code confidential memory box in the destination machine, touch the [/] key after entering the fax number and enter the F-code
(sub-address and passcode).
7-112
Letter Size RX Reduce Print
This program is not available in Canada and Philippines.
When a letter-R (8-1/2" x 11"R) size fax is received, this setting reduces the fax to A4R size.
When this setting is enabled, A4R size faxes are also reduced.
Paper Size
When a finisher is installed, select the paper used for printing of received faxes.
• This setting can only be used when the [Multiple Set
Print] and [Staple] checkboxes are selected in
"
• The maximum number of sheets that can be stapled is 50. (When the paper is oriented horizontally, the maximum number of sheets that can be stapled is
30.)
Receiving Date & Time Print
Enable this setting to have the date and time of reception printed.
Select [Inside the Received Image] or [Outside the
Received Image] for the position where the date and time is printed.
When [Inside the Received Image] is selected, the date and time of reception is printed on the received image.
When [Outside the Received Image] is selected, the received image is reduced and the date and time of reception is printed in the blank area that results.
[Outside the Received Image] cannot be selected for the reception date and time print setting when "
Receive Reduce Setting " (page 7-112) is not enabled.
A3 RX Reduce
This program can only be activated in Canada and
Philippines.
When an A3 size fax is received, this function reduces the fax to ledger (11" x 17") size.
When this setting is enabled, ledger (11" x 17") size faxes are also reduced.
Fax Output Settings
These settings are used to select the number of copies and output tray for received faxes. When a finisher is installed, the finisher tray can be selected as the output tray and stapling can be selected.
Output tray
Select the output tray for received faxes.
Number of Prints
Set the number of copies of received faxes that are printed to any number from 1 to 99.
Staple Position
When a finisher is installed, set the position at which received faxes are stapled.
Allow/Reject Number Setting
Use this setting to specify whether reception from a stored number is to be allowed or rejected.
Item
Reject
Reception
Allow
Reception
Description
Reject reception from the stored number.
Allow reception from the stored number.
All Invalid
Add New
Registration
Number List
Even if numbers have been stored, disregard the numbers and allow reception from all numbers.
Store a new number for which allow or reject will be specified (maximum of 50 numbers).
Enter the number (maximum of 20 digits) and touch the [Store] key.
A list of the stored numbers can be displayed.
A number can be selected in this screen to delete it from the list.
Reject hidden
Number
When this setting is enabled, reception from a number whose settings are not notified is rejected irrespective of the contents of the specific number reception settings.
Reject hidden Number
Reception from a number whose settings are not notified can be rejected irrespective of the contents of the specific number reception settings.
When no numbers have been stored for allow/reject specification, no keys other than [Add New] can be selected.
7-113
Fax Polling Security
The following settings are for regular polling memory using the Public Box.
Set Fax Polling Security
When the memory polling function is used, this setting determines whether any machine will be allowed to poll your machine, or only machines that have been stored in your machine.
Add New
When the Polling Security Setting is enabled, use this setting to store (or delete) the fax numbers of the machines that are allowed to poll your machine. The stored fax numbers are called passcode numbers. Up to
10 passcode numbers can be stored (maximum of 20 digits each).
Passcode Number Key List
This shows a list of the stored passcode numbers. A number can be selected to delete it.
Note that these settings do not apply to F-code polling memory.
7-114
SYSTEM SETTINGS MENU
Total Count
Default Settings
List Print (User)
Paper Tray Settings
Address Control
Fax Data Receive/Forward
Printer Condition Settings
Document Filing Control
USB-Device Check
User Control
User Control
Energy Save
Operation Settings
Device Control
Copy Function Settings
Network Settings
Printer Settings
Job Count
Clock Adjust
All Custom Setting List
Tray Settings
Address Book
Fax Settings
Printer Default Settings
PCL Settings
PostScript Settings
Amend User Information
User Authentication Setting
Other Settings
User List
Page Limit Group List
Authority Group List
Favourite Operation Group List
User Count
Card Setting
Device Count
Keyboard Select
Printer Test Page
Paper Type Registration
Custom Index
I-Fax Settings
Copies
Orientation
Default Paper Size
Default Output Tray
Default Paper Type
Sending Address List
Auto Tray Switching
Program
Initial Resolution Setting
Disable Blank Page Print
Line Thickness
2-Sided Print
Colour Mode
Document Filing Folder List
Custom Size Registration (Bypass)
F-Code Memory Box
N-Up Print
Fit To Page
Output
Quick File
Actions when the Limit of Pages for Output Jobs
The Number of User Name
Displayed Setting
A Warning when Login Fails
Disabling of Printing by Invalid User
Automatically print stored jobs after login
Default Network Authentication
Server Setting
Perform LDAP server access control.
Display Usage Status after Login
User Information Print
Toner Save Mode Auto Power Shut-Off Auto Power Shut-Off Timer Preheat Mode Setting
Other Settings
MFP Display Pattern Setting
Customize Key Setting
Home Screen Settings
Preview Setting
Remote Operation Settings
Soft Keyboard Template Setting
Keys Touch Sound
Auto Clear Setting
Message Time Setting
Display Language Setting
Default Display Setting Disabling of Clock Adjustment
Disabling of Job Priority Operation Disabling of Covers/Inserts Mode
Disabling of Bypass Printing
Key Operation Setting
Set Keyboard Priority
Initial Original Count Setting
Other Settings
Original Feeding Mode Detect Standard in Auto Colour Mode
Auto Paper Selection Setting Registration Adjustment
Clear All Job Log Data
Tandem Connection Setting Optimization of a Hard Disk
Original Size Detector Setting
Disabling of Devices
Fusing Control Settings
Initial Status Settings
Other Settings
Colour Adjustments
IPv4 Settings
IPv6 Settings
Default Settings
Disabling of Document Feeder Disabling of Finisher
Disabling of Duplex Disabling of Offset
Disabling of Optional Paper Drawer Disabling of Stapler
Disabling of Tray Settings Disabling of Punch
Disabling of Colour Mode
Copy Exposure Adjustment Card Shot Settings
B/W 600dpi x 600dpi Scanning
Mode for Document Feeder
B/W Quick Scan from Document Glass Rotation Copy Setting Initial Tab Copy Setting
Add or Change Extra Preset Ratios Disabling Deletion of Job Programs Auto Clear Before Copy Job Execution
Setting a Maximum Number of Copies Disabling of Bypass-Tray in Duplex Copy
Initial Margin Shift Setting
Erase Width Adjustment
Disabling of Auto Paper Selection
Auto Selection Setting of Tray that is
Supplied the Paper
Enable TCP/IP
Enable NetWare
Enable EtherTalk
Enable NetBEUI
Reset the NIC
Ping Command
Interface Settings
Auto Colour Calibration
Prohibit Notice Page Printing Print Density Level
Prohibit Test Page Printing
A4/Letter Size Auto Change
Job Spool Queuing
CMYK Exposure Adjustment Disabling of USB Memory Direct Print
Bypass Tray Settings
Disabling of Network Folder Direct
Hexadecimal Dump Mode
I/O Timeout
Enable USB Port
USB Port Emulation Switching Port Switching Method
Enable Network Port
Network Port Emulation Switching
7-115
Image Send Settings
Operation Settings
Scan Settings
I-Fax Settings
Fax Settings
Document Filing Settings
List Print (Administrator)
Security Settings
Enable/Disable Settings
Change Administrator Password
Product Key
Data Backup
Storing/Callling of System Settings
Sharp OSA Settings
Other Settings
Settings to Disable Registration
Default Display Settings
Address Book Default Selection
Initial Resolution Setting
Scan Complete Sound Setting Default Verification Stamp
The Number of File Name/Subject/Body
Keys Displayed Setting
The Number of Direct Address Keys
Displayed Setting
Erase Width Adjustment
Default Exposure Settings Disable Switching of Display Order
Must Input Next Address Key at
Broadcast Setting
Hold Setting for Received Data Print
Disable Registering Destination from Operation Panel
Disable Registering Destination on Web Page
Disable Registration of Program
Disable Registration of Memory Box
Disable Destination Registration
Using Global Address Search
Disable Registration Using
Network Scanner Tool
Disable [Resend] on Image Send Mode Disable Direct Entry
Disable Selection from Address Book Disable PC-I-Fax Transmission
Disable PC-Fax Transmission Settings to Disable Transmission
Own Name and Destination Set
Other Settings
Default Address Setting
I-Fax Default Settings
I-Fax Send Settings
I-Fax Receive Settings
Allow/Reject Mail or Domain
Name Setting
Fax Default Settings
Fax Send Settings
Fax Receive Settings
Allow/Reject Number Setting
Fax Polling Security
Default Sender Set Compression Mode at Broadcasting
Default Colour Mode Settings
Maximum Size of E-mail
Attachments (E-mail)
Bcc Setting
Disable Scan Function
Initial File Format Setting
Maximum Size of Data Attachments
(FTP/Desktop/Network Folder)
Pre-Setting Mail Signature
Auto Wake Up Print
Compression Setting
Speaker Volume Setting
Original Print on Transaction Report Body Text Print Select Setting
Transaction Report Print Select Setting Pre-Setting Mail Signature
Activity Report Print Select Setting
I-Fax Reception Report On/Off Setting Maximum Size of E-mail Attachments Recall in Case of Line Busy
I-Fax Reception Report Request
Timeout Setting
Number of Resend Times at
Reception Error
Rotation Sending Setting
Printing Page Number at Receiver
Recall in Case of Communication
Error
Auto Receive Reduce Setting
Duplex Reception Setting
Letter Size RX Reduce Print
Receiving Date & Time Print
POP3 Communication Timeout Setting
Reception Check Interval Setting
Set Address for Data Forwarding A3 RX Reduce I-Fax Output Setting
Dial Mode Setting Remote Reception Number Setting Distinctive Ring Detection
Auto Wake Up Print
Pause Time Setting
Original Print on Transaction Report
Transaction Report Print Select
Setting
Fax Dest. Confirmation Mode Activity Report Print Select Setting
Speaker Settings ECM
Auto Reduction Sending Setting Printing Page Number at Receiver Recall in Case of Communication Error
Rotation Sending Setting
Quick On Line Sending
Date/Own Number Print Position Setting
Recall in Case of Line Busy
Number of Calls in Auto Reception
Switching from Manual to
Automatic Reception
Print Style Setting
Set the Telephone Number for
Data Forwarding
Duplex Reception Setting Letter Size RX Reduce Print
Auto Receive Reduce Setting Receiving Date & Time Print
A3 RX Reduce
Fax Output Settings
Other Settings
Document Output Options
Automatic Deletion of File Settings
Default Mode Settings
Sort Method Setting
Default Exposure Settings
Initial Resolution Settings
Disable Stamp for Reprinting
Batch Print Settings
Administrator Authority Setting Colour Data Compression Ratio Setting Erase Width Adjustment
Delete All Quick Files Scan Complete Sound Setting
Default Colour Mode Settings Default Output Tray
Card Shot Settings
Administrator Settings List
Image Sending Activity Report Data Receive/Forward List Web Settings List Metadata Set List
SSL Settings IPsec Settings IEEE802.1X Setting
Initialize Private Data/Data in
Machine
Storage Backup Device Cloning
Restore Factory Defaults Store Current Configuration Restore Configuration
External Account Setting USB Driver Settings Job Priority Preference
7-116
CHAPTER 8
TROUBLESHOOTING
This chapter provides solutions to possible problems in a question and answer format. Locate the question that relates to your problem and use the answer to help correct the situation. If you are unable to solve a problem using this manual, please contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
System settings
Descriptions of system settings similar to the following example appear in this manual.
Example:
➞
System Settings (Administrator) > "Copy Function Settings" > "Other Settings" > "Rotation Copy Setting" >
This is an abbreviated description of the procedure for selecting the setting. ">" indicates the setting sequence and indicates the state of the setting after it has been enabled. Use these descriptions as a quick manual to help you configure the settings.
TROUBLESHOOTING PROBLEMS
FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS
• Making a copy of a non-standard size original . . . . 8-3
• I can't print from a computer... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4
• Printing on an envelope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
• Changing the paper size used for a print job . . . . 8-6
• Adjusting the volume of the ringer . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
• Checking the machine's communication record. . . . 8-7
REMOVING MISFEEDS
• REMOVING MISFEEDS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
• PAPER MISFEED ILLUSTRATIONS . . . . . . . . . 8-9
FACSIMILE
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO TRANSMISSION. . . 8-23
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO RECEPTION . . . . 8-25
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO TELEPHONE . . . . 8-26
SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-26
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO ONE-TOUCH
INDIVIDUAL KEYS / GROUP KEYS . . . . . . . . 8-27
SCANNING / INTERNET FAX
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO SCANNING /
INTERNET FAX OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28
RESULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-30
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO ONE-TOUCH
INDIVIDUAL KEYS / GROUP KEYS . . . . . . . . 8-32
REMOVING STAPLE JAMS
• FINISHER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11
DOCUMENT FILING
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO FILING . . . . . . . . . 8-34
MANAGEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-35
COPYING
OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13
RESULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15
PRINTING
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO PRINTING
OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16
RESULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19
GENERAL PROBLEMS
OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-39
FEEDING AND OUTPUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-41
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO QUALITY /
PRINT RESULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-43
• PROBLEMS RELATED TO PERIPHERAL
DEVICES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-45
• OTHER PROBLEMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-47
8-1
TROUBLESHOOTING PROBLEMS
The chart below shows the procedure to follow in the event a problem occurs. Use it as a troubleshooting guide.
Check this chapter first
You may find a solution to your problem here.
Ask the administrator for help
Inform the machine's administrator of the nature of the problem and ask for help.
Refer to other instruction manuals
You can sometimes find the solution to your problem in other chapters in this manual or in the other instruction manuals included with the machine.
Turn the power off and then on again
Turning the power off and on may solve the problem in some cases, so try doing so before attributing the problem to a malfunction.
Press the [POWER] key ( ) to turn off the power and switch the main power switch to the "off" position. Wait at least 10 seconds and then switch the main power switch and the [POWER] key ( ) back on in that order.
• When turning off the main power switch, ensure that each of the lamps on the operation panel has been turned off.
Contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
If, having tried the above steps, your problem remains unsolved, contact the dealer from whom you purchased the machine or your nearest authorised service representative.
8-2
FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS
Making a copy of a non-standard size original
The procedure for making a copy of a payment slip or other non-standard size original is explained below.
The "Centring" special mode of copy mode can be selected to position the copied image in the centre of the paper.
1 Place the originals.
If the X dimension
(width) of the document is less than
140 mm (5-1/2") or the Y dimension
(height) is less than
131 mm (5-1/8"), place the original on the document glass.
For a thin original, use "Slow Scan
Mode".
3 Place paper in the bypass tray.
The bypass tray is used here to copy onto paper that is not loaded in any of the paper trays of the machine.
Type : Recycled
Size : A4
2 Enter the original size.
From the base screen of copy mode, touch [Original] then [Size Input].
Original
Size Input Cancel
OK
OK
X
Y
200
(25-432) mm
150 (25-297) mm
4 Select the bypass tray.
From the base screen of copy mode, touch [Paper
Select] and then "Bypass tray paper type".
Paper Select
Bypass Tray Type/Size Setting
Select the paper type.
Plain
Pre-Punched
Heavy Paper 1
Envelope
Pre-Printed
Colour
Heavy Paper 2
Glossy Paper
Recycled
Thin Paper
Transparency
Letter Head
Labels
Tab Paper
Heavy Paper 1: 106 - 209 g /m 2 (28 lbs.bond, -110 lbs.index)
Heavy Paper 2: 210 - 256 g /m 2 (110 - 140 lbs.index)
Cancel
1
2
Paper Select
1.
A4
2. A4R
3. B4
4. A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Bypass Tray
A4
Recycled
OK
8-3
I can't print from a computer...
First check that the printer driver for the machine is selected when printing.
Also check that the printer driver port is set correctly.
Checking the printer name
Check here
Check that the machine is selected in the Print dialog box, and select the machine if it is not.
If your machine is not listed, the printer driver is not installed. Install the printer driver and try again.
Checking port settings in the printer driver
Display the printer driver's Properties dialog box and click the [Port] tab.
SHARP MX-XXXX
Do your port settings look like this?
SHARP MX-XXXX
Your port settings should look like this.
8-4
Printing on an envelope
The procedure for printing on an envelope is explained below. Only the name and address side of an envelope can be printed on.
It is recommended that you do a test print to check the print result before using an envelope.
1 Place paper in the bypass tray.
Print on the name and address side
2 Tray Settings.
Tray Settings
Type
Size
Fixed Paper Side
Bypass
Envelope
DL
Paper Property
Disable Duplex Disable Staple
Copy Print
Feeding Approved Job
Fax I-Fax
Change
Disable Punch
Doc. Filing
Back
5
5
Type : Envelope
Size : Select the envelope size
3 Select settings in the printer driver.
(1)
(2) (3)
(4)
(1) Click the [Paper] tab.
(2) Select the size of the envelope in
"Paper Size".
(3) Select "Bypass Tray" from "Paper
Source" in "Paper Selection".
(4) Select [Envelope] in "Paper Type".
If needed, select the "Rotate 180 degrees" checkbox ( ) in "Image Orientation" on the
[Main] tab.
(5) Click the [OK] button.
(5)
8-5
Changing the paper size used for a print job
When the size of paper specified for a print job is not loaded in any of the machine's paper trays, follow the steps below to change the paper size.
1 Check details on the job.
1
2
3
4
Print Job
Job Queue
Copy
Computer01
Copy
1234567890
Scan to
Sets / Progress
020 / 001
Fax Job
Status
Copying
Internet Fax
020 / 000
002 / 000
001 / 000
Paper Empty
Waiting
Waiting
1
1
Spool
Job Queue
Complete
Detail
Priority
Stop/Delete
Press the [JOB STATUS] key on the operation panel to display the job status screen.
Select the job whose status is [Paper Empty] and touch the [Detail] key.
To delete the job, you can press the [Stop/Delete] key.
Check the paper size specified for the job in the detail screen, and touch the [Paper Select] key.
Detail
Computer01
Colour / B/W: B/W
Paper:
A5
Plain
020 / 000
Paper Select
Paper Empty
Output:
Special
Modes:
OK
2 Change the paper size used for the job.
Paper Select
1.
A4
2. A4R
3. B4
4. A3
Paper Tray
Plain
Plain
Plain
Plain
Bypass Tray
Plain
OK
Select the paper size on which you wish to print the job from the set paper sizes.
To avoid cutting off part of the image, select a paper size that is larger than the paper size specified for the job.
8-6
Adjusting the volume of the ringer
If the ringing sound made when the machine receives a fax is too loud or too soft, follow the steps below to adjust the volume.
The fax ringer volume is adjusted in the system settings (administrator).
Press the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key on the operation panel, touch [Image Send Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Default Settings] -
[Speaker Settings] - [Ringer Volume] in that order, and then select the desired volume.
The machine starts printing when I try to forward data...
Before forwarding received fax data to a shared folder, check that destination computer is turned on.
If the computer is not turned on, the machine prints the received fax data. If data is being forwarded to several computers, received data is printed if even one of the computers is turned off.
Z
Z
Z
Z
Destination
Turn computer on
Checking the machine's communication record
To check the machine's record of communication using the image send function, follow the steps below to print the image sending activity report.
The image sending activity report is printed from the system settings
(administrator).
Press the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key on the operation panel, and then touch [List Print (Administrator)] - [Image Sending Activity Report] to print the report.
8-7
REMOVING MISFEEDS
This section explains what to do when a paper misfeed occurs in the machine.
Caution
The fusing unit is hot. Take care not to burn yourself when removing a misfeed.
• When removing misfed paper, do not touch or damage the transfer belt.
• Carefully pull the paper out without tearing it.
• A misfeed may have occurred inside the machine. Check carefully and remove the misfeed.
• If the paper tears, be sure to remove all pieces from the machine.
Fusing unit
Transfer belt
REMOVING MISFEEDS
When a paper misfeed occurs, the message "A misfeed has occurred." will appear in the touch panel and printing and scanning will stop. In this event, touch the [Information] key in the touch panel. When the key is touched, instructions for removing the misfeed will appear. Follow the instructions. When the misfeed is cleared, the message will automatically clear.
The approximate locations of possible misfeeds are indicated by blinking marks as shown below.
A misfeed has occurred.
Turning M/C off now causes data loss.
Information misfeed location
OK
• While the message appears, printing and scanning cannot be resumed.
• If the message does not clear even after the misfeed has been removed, the causes below are possible. Check once again.
- The misfeed was not correctly removed.
- A torn piece of paper remains in the machine.
- A cover or unit that was opened or moved to remove the misfeed was not returned to its original position.
8-8
PAPER MISFEED ILLUSTRATIONS
If you require more information when reading the instructions in the touch panel, see the paper misfeed illustrations below. Refer to the illustration below and then go to the appropriate illustration (1 to 10) for your situation.
☞
(1)-(3): page 8-9, (4)-(10): page 8-10
(1) (2) (3) (4) (10)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8) (9)
(1) Original misfeed
Open the document feeder cover and remove the misfed originals.
(3) Paper misfeed in the fusing unit
Rotate knob and remove the misfed paper.
Pull out the document feeder tray and remove the misfed paper.
If the misfed paper is inside the fusing area, press down on the green part to tilt the fusing unit down toward you.
Open the automatic document feeder. Rotate the transfer roller in the direction of the arrow and remove the original.
(2) Paper misfeed in the output area
Remove the misfed paper.
Caution
The fusing unit area is hot. Take care not to burn yourself. (Do not touch any metal parts.)
Unfused toner may remain on the paper that is removed. Take care that it does not soil your hands or clothing.
8-9
(4) Paper misfeed in the exit tray unit (right tray)
Remove the misfed paper.
(5) Paper misfeed in the reversing unit
Open the Paper reversing section cover and remove the misfed paper.
(9) Paper misfeed in tray 1 to tray 4 (in the tray)
Before pulling the tray out, open the right cover and check if there is a paper misfeed. If you pull the tray out without checking, you may tear misfed paper and make it more difficult to remove the pieces that remain in the machine.
☞
Paper misfeed in tray 1 to tray 4 (side)
(10) Paper misfeed in the finisher
Open the front cover.
(6) Paper misfeed in the bypass tray
Remove the misfed paper.
(7) Paper misfeed in tray 1 to tray 4 (side)
The misfeed may have occurred inside the machine.
Check carefully and remove it.
While pressing the lever over to the left, slide the finisher to the left until it stops.
Turn roller rotating knob in the direction of the arrow to remove the misfed paper.
Make sure that there is no misfed paper in the machine.
(8) Paper misfeed in the transport area
Lower the lever in the direction of the arrow to remove the misfed paper.
8-10
REMOVING STAPLE JAMS
Follow the steps below to remove a staple jam.
☞
FINISHER
Open the cover.
1
While pressing the lever over to the left, slide the finisher to the left until it stops.
Gently slide the finisher until it stops.
2
Lower the staple case release lever and remove the staple case.
Pull the staple case out to the right.
3
4
Raise the lever at the front end of the staple case and remove the jammed staple.
Remove the leading staple if it is bent. If bent staples remain, a staple jam will occur again.
Take care that a bent staple does not hurt you.
8-11
7
8
5
6
Lower the lever at the front end of the staple case.
Replace the staple case.
Push the staple case in until it clicks into place.
Slide the finisher back to the right.
Gently slide the finisher back to the right until it locks into its original position.
Close the cover.
8-12
COPYING
PROBLEMS RELATED TO COPYING OPERATION
PROBLEMS RELATED TO COPY RESULTS
• If you cannot find the item that you are looking for in the above table of contents, see "
• If you are unable to solve a problem using the solutions in this manual, switch off the [POWER] key ( ) and the main power switch. Wait at least 10 seconds, and then switch on the main power switch and the [POWER] key ( ) in that order.
When the LINE indicator is lit or the DATA indicator is lit or blinking, do not switch off the main power switch or unplug the power plug. This may damage the hard drive or cause the data being stored or received to be lost.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO COPYING OPERATION
Problem
Copying does not take place.
Auto selection of the colour mode does not take place.
Point to check
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Are you using one of the following types of originals?
Black & White is not selected
• Are there colours or colouring in the paper?
Colour is not selected
• The colour in the original is very light.
• The colour in the original is very dark, almost black.
• Is only a very small area of the original coloured?
Solution
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
Check with your administrator.
When the colour mode is set to "Auto", the machine detects whether the original is black and white or colour when the [COLOUR START] key is pressed. However, when an original similar to one of those at left is used, automatic detection may not give the correct result. In this event, specify the colour mode manually.
8-13
Problem
Image rotation does not take place.
Two-sided copying does not take place.
The paper size of a tray cannot be set.
Point to check
Did you select the paper size or copy ratio manually?
Are you copying using settings that do not allow rotate copying?
Is "Rotation Copy Setting" disabled in the system settings (administrator)?
Does the paper type setting of the selected tray specify a type of paper that cannot be used for two-sided copying?
Are you using a special size or type of paper?
Are you copying using settings that do not allow two-sided copying?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Solution
Copy using automatic paper selection and automatic ratio selection.
Rotate copying can generally be combined with other special modes, however, some combinations are not possible. If a prohibited combination is selected, a message will appear in the touch panel.
Check with your administrator.
If you are the administrator, enable "Rotation Copy
Setting".
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Copy Function
Settings" > "Other Settings" > "Rotation Copy
Setting" >
Check "Tray Settings" in the system settings. If the
[Disable Duplex] checkbox is selected , two-sided copying using that tray will not be possible. Change the paper type setting to a type that can be used for two-sided printing.
➞ System Settings > "Paper Tray Settings" > "Tray
Settings" > "Change"
For the paper types and sizes that can be used for two-sided copying, see "SPECIFICATIONS" in the Start
Guide.
Two-sided copying can generally be combined with other special modes, however, some combinations are not possible. If a prohibited combination is selected, a message will appear in the touch panel.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator). Check with your administrator.
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator). Check with your administrator.
8-14
PROBLEMS RELATED TO COPY RESULTS
Problem
The image is too light or too dark.
Colours are off.
Part of the image is cut off.
Point to check
Is the image too light or too dark?
Has an appropriate exposure mode for the original type been selected?
Did you perform "Registration
Adjustment"?
Solution
Select an appropriate exposure mode for the original being copied and adjust the exposure level manually.
Select one of the following modes depending on the original type.
• Text
Use this mode for regular text documents.
• Text/Prtd.Photo
This mode provides the best balance for copying an original which contains both text and printed photographs, such as a magazine or catalogue.
• Text/Photo
This mode provides the best balance for copying an original which contains both text and photographs, such as a text document with a photo pasted on.
• Printed Photo
This mode is best for copying printed photographs, such as photos in a magazine or catalogue.
• Photo
Use this mode to copy photos.
• Map
This mode is best for copying the light colour shading and fine text found on most maps.
• Light original
Use this mode for originals with light pencil writing.
Ask your administrator to perform "Registration
Adjustment".
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Device Control" >
"Other Settings" > "Registration Adjustment"
If the colour tones are off, perform "Auto Colour
Calibration". (If the colours are still off after calibration, repeating calibration may improve the results.)
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Copy Function
Settings" > "Colour Adjustment" > "Auto Colour
Calibration"
Select an appropriate ratio setting.
Copies come out blank.
Has an appropriate ratio been selected for the original size and paper size?
Are you using an inch (AB) size original?
Is the original placed face up or face down correctly?
When copying an inch (AB) size original, specify the original size manually.
When using the document glass, the original must be placed face down. When using the automatic document feeder, the original must be placed face up.
8-15
PRINTING
PROBLEMS RELATED TO PRINTING OPERATION
PROBLEMS RELATED TO PRINT RESULTS
• If you cannot find the item that you are looking for in the above table of contents, see "
• If you are unable to solve a problem using the solutions in this manual, switch off the [POWER] key ( ) and the main power switch. Wait at least 10 seconds, and then switch on the main power switch and the [POWER] key ( ) in that order.
When the LINE indicator is lit or the DATA indicator is lit or blinking, do not switch off the main power switch or unplug the power plug. This may damage the hard drive or cause the data being stored or received to be lost.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO PRINTING OPERATION
Problem
Printing does not take place.
Point to check
Is your computer connected correctly to the machine?
Is the machine connected to the same network (LAN, etc.) as your computer?
Solution
Make sure that the cable is connected securely to the LAN connector or the USB connector on your computer and the machine.
If you are on a network, check the connections at the hub as well.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE "
The machine must be connected to the same network as your computer.
If you do not know which network the machine is connected to, ask the network administrator.
8-16
Problem
Printing does not take place.
Point to check
Is the IP address selected correctly?
(Windows)
Are you using a printer port created using Standard TCP/IP Port?
(Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista/
Server 2008/7)
Is "Connect via" set to [Ethernet] for
AppleTalk?
(Mac OS 9.0-9.2.2)
Is your computer in an unstable state?
Is the machine specified correctly in the software application that you are using for printing?
Are the network connection devices operating normally?
Is the I/O timeout setting too short?
Solution
Check the IP address setting.
If the machine does not have a permanent IP address
(the machine receives an IP address from a DHCP server), printing will not be possible if the IP address changes. Print the "All Custom Setting List" in the system settings and check the IP address of the machine. If the IP address has changed, change the port setting in the printer driver.
➞ System Settings > "List Print (User)" > "All Custom
Setting List"
☞
Software Setup Guide
If the IP address changes frequently, it is recommended that a permanent IP address be assigned to the machine.
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Network Settings"
Check the settings of your computer.
When a port created with Standard TCP/IP Port in
Windows is used and the [SNMP Status Enabled] checkbox is , it may not be possible to print correctly.
Change the [SNMP Status Enabled] checkbox to .
☞
Software Setup Guide
Open [AppleTalk] from the [Control Panels] and make sure that [Ethernet] is selected in the
"Connect via" menu.
Printing is not possible if [Ethernet] is not selected.
Restart your computer.
Printing is sometimes not possible when you run multiple applications at once or there is insufficient memory or hard drive space.
Make sure that the printer driver of the machine is selected in the Print window of the application.
If the printer driver does not appear in the list of available printer drivers, it may not be installed correctly.
Remove the printer driver and then install it once again.
☞
Software Setup Guide
Make sure that the routers and other network connection devices are operating correctly.
If a device is not powered on or is in an error state, see the manual of the device to correct the problem.
Check with your administrator.
If the I/O timeout setting is too short, errors may occur while writing to the printer. Ask the administrator of the machine to configure an appropriate time in "I/O Timeout".
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Printer Settings" >
"Interface Settings" > "I/O Timeout"
8-17
Problem
Printing does not take place.
Colour printing does not take place.
Two-sided printing does not take place.
Point to check
Was a Notice Page printed?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Is the colour mode set to "Color"?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Does the paper type setting of the selected tray specify a type of paper that cannot be used for two-sided printing?
Are you using a special size or type of paper?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Solution
Check the printed Notice Page.
A Notice Page will be printed to indicate the cause of the problem if a print job cannot be performed as specified and the cause is not shown in the display. Read the printed page and take appropriate action.
For example, a notice page will be printed in the following situations.
• The print job is too large to fit in memory.
• A function that has been prohibited by the administrator is specified.
By factory default, Notice Pages are not printed.
Check with your administrator.
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
Check the settings of the printer driver.
Select "Automatic" or "Color" for the colour mode setting.
The colour mode setting is configured as follows:
Windows:
On the [Color] tab of the printer driver.
Macintosh:
In the [Color] menu of the print window.
In Windows, [Black and White Print] can also be selected on the [Main] tab of the printer driver. If you wish to print in colour, make sure that the [Black and
White Print] checkbox on the [Main] tab is not selected
.
Check with your administrator.
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
Check "Tray Settings" in the system settings.
If the [Disable Duplex] checkbox is selected , two-sided printing using that tray will not be possible.
Change the paper type setting to a type that can be used for two-sided printing.
➞ System Settings > "Paper Tray Settings" > "Tray
Settings" > "Change"
For the paper types and sizes that can be used for two-sided printing, see "SPECIFICATIONS" in the
Start Guide.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
8-18
Problem
Direct printing of a file in a shared folder on a computer is not possible.
Point to check
Is "IPsec Settings" enabled on the machine?
A tray, finisher, or other peripheral device installed on the machine cannot be used.
Have the peripheral devices that are installed on the machine been configured in the printer driver?
Solution
Check with your administrator.
When "IPsec Settings" is enabled in the system settings
(administrator), direct printing of a file in a shared folder may not be possible in some computer environments.
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Security Settings"
> "IPsec Settings"
Open the printer properties and click the [Auto
Configuration] button on the [Configuration] tab.
(Windows)
If auto configuration cannot be executed, see the
Software Setup Guide.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO PRINT RESULTS
Problem
The image is grainy.
The image is too light or too dark.
Colours are off.
Point to check
Are the printer driver settings appropriate for the print job?
Does the image (particularly a photo) need correction?
(Windows)
Did you perform "Registration
Adjustment"?
Text and lines are faint and difficult to see.
Was colour data printed in black and white?
(Windows)
Solution
Check the settings of the printer driver.
When selecting print settings, you can set the print mode to [Normal], [High Quality]. When you need a very clear image, select [High Quality].
Windows:
The resolution setting is selected in the [Advanced] tab of the printer driver properties window.
Macintosh:
Select the resolution in the [Advanced] menu of the print window. (In Mac OS v10.5, select the resolution on the [Color] menu in the print window.)
Check the settings of the printer driver.
Brightness and contrast can be corrected by performing
[Color Adjustment] on the [Color] tab of the printer driver. These settings can be used for simple corrections when you do not have image editing software installed on your computer.
Ask your administrator to perform "Registration
Adjustment".
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Device Control" >
"Other Settings" > "Registration Adjustment"
If the colour tones are off, perform "Auto Colour
Calibration". (If the colours are still off after calibration, repeating calibration may improve the results.)
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Printer Settings" >
"Auto Colour Calibration"
Check the settings of the printer driver.
When colour text and lines are printed in black and white, they may become faint and difficult to see. To have colour text or lines (areas) that are faint converted to black, select [Text To Black] or [Vector To Black] on the [Color] tab of the printer driver. (Raster data such as bitmap images cannot be adjusted.)
8-19
Problem
Part of the image is cut off.
The image is upside down.
Point to check
Does the paper size specified by the job match the size of paper loaded in the tray?
Is the print orientation setting (portrait or landscape) correct?
Are the margins set correctly in the layout settings of the application?
Are you using a type of paper (tab paper, punch paper, etc.) that can only be loaded in a fixed orientation?
Is the correct binding position selected for two-sided printing?
Solution
Make sure that the paper size setting matches the size of paper loaded in the tray.
The paper size setting is selected as follows:
Windows:
On the [Paper] tab of the printer driver.
If [Fit to Paper Size] is selected, check the loaded paper and the paper size setting.
Macintosh:
In the [Page Setup] menu.
Set the print orientation to match the image.
The print orientation is selected as follows:
Windows: On the [Main] tab of the printer driver.
Macintosh: In the [Page Setup] menu.
Select an appropriate paper size and margins in the layout settings of the application.
If the edge of the image extends outside the printable area of the machine, the edge will be cut off.
Rotate the image 180 degrees before printing.
When the image size and paper size are the same but the orientations are different, the orientation of the image is automatically rotated to match the paper.
However, when the paper can only be loaded in a fixed orientation, this may result in the image being printed upside down.
The 180 degree rotation setting is selected as follows:
Windows:
On the [Main] tab of the printer driver.
Macintosh:
On the [Page Setup] menu. (Landscape orientation only.)
(In Mac OS 9.0 to 9.2.2, in the [PostScript Options] menu of the [Page Setup] menu.)
Be sure to set the appropriate binding position.
When two-sided printing is performed, every other page is printed upside down when tablet binding is selected for the binding position.
The binding position is selected as follows:
Windows:
On the [Main] tab of the printer driver.
Macintosh:
In the [Layout] menu of the print window. (In Mac OS
9.0 to 9.2.2, in [Output/Document Style].)
8-20
Problem
Many nonsense characters are printed.
Point to check
Is your computer or the machine in an unstable state?
Solution
Cancel printing, restart your computer and the machine, and try printing again.
If little free space remains in the memory or hard drive of your computer, or many jobs have been spooled on the machine and it has little free memory remaining, printed text may turn into nonsense characters.
To cancel printing
Windows:
Double-click the printer icon that appears at the lower right of the task bar and click "Cancel All Documents"
(or "Purge Print Documents") in the [Printer] menu.
Macintosh:
Double-click the name of the machine in the printer list, select the job that you wish to delete, and delete it. (In Mac OS 9.0 to 9.2.2, double-click the printer icon on the desktop, select the print job that you wish to delete, and delete it.)
At the machine:
Press the [JOB STATUS] key on the operation panel, touch the [Print Job] tab to change the screen, touch the key of the print job that you wish to delete, and touch the [Stop/Delete] key. A message appears to confirm the cancellation. Touch the [Yes] key.
If nonsense characters are still printed after restarting, ask your administrator to lengthen the timeout setting of
"I/O Timeout" in the system settings (administrator).
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Printer Settings" >
"Interface Settings" > "I/O Timeout"
If nonsense characters are still printed after taking the above measures, remove and then reinstall the printer driver.
8-21
FACSIMILE
PROBLEMS RELATED TO TRANSMISSION
PROBLEMS RELATED TO AUDIBLE SIGNALS
PROBLEMS RELATED TO ONE-TOUCH INDIVIDUAL KEYS / GROUP KEYS
• If you are unable to solve a problem using the solutions in this manual, switch off the [POWER] key ( ) and the main power switch. Wait at least 10 seconds, and then switch on the main power switch and the [POWER] key ( ) in that order.
When the LINE indicator is lit or the DATA indicator is lit or blinking, do not switch off the main power switch or unplug the power plug. This may damage the hard drive or cause the data being stored or received to be lost.
8-22
PROBLEMS RELATED TO TRANSMISSION
Problem Point to check Solution
Transmission does not take place.
Is the telephone line connected securely?
Check the telephone line socket, the wall socket, and any extension adapters to make sure that all connections are secure.
☞
Is the correct dial mode set for your line?
Ask your administrator to verify that "Dial Mode
Setting" is set correctly for the line you are using.
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Default Settings" >
"Dial Mode Setting"
Is a busy signal received?
Did a communication error occur?
Does a message appear indicating that the memory is full?
Does a message appear notifying you that the original size was not detected?
If a busy signal is received, the transmission is temporarily cancelled and then automatically re-attempted after a brief interval. (Factory default setting: 2 attempts, 3 min. intervals)
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Send Settings" >
"Recall in Case of Line Busy"
To cancel the transmission, press the [JOB STATUS] key, touch the key of the job that you wish to cancel, and then touch the [Stop/Delete] key.
If an error occurs that prevents transmission, the transmission is temporarily cancelled and then automatically re-attempted after a brief interval.
(Factory default setting: 3 min. intervals)
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Send Settings" >
"Recall in Case of Communication Error"
To cancel the transmission, press the [JOB STATUS] key, touch the key of the job that you wish to cancel, and then touch the [Stop/Delete] key.
The machine supports error correction mode (ECM) and is configured to automatically resend any part of a fax that is distorted due to noise on the line.
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Default Settings" >
"ECM"
Divide the originals into sets and fax each set separately, or use direct transmission.
If the memory becomes full, the transmission will be cancelled.
Place the original again.
If the original size is still not detected correctly, specify the original size manually.
8-23
Problem
Transmission does not take place.
The transmitted fax prints out blank at the receiving side.
The transmitted fax is reduced by the receiving fax machine.
Point to check
Does the job status screen (completed jobs) or a transaction report indicate that the transmission was not successful?
Did you place a long size original on the document glass when it is scanned?
Did you place an original that is folded?
Are the sub-address and passcode correct?
(When using F-code communication)
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Is the original placed face up or face down correctly?
Solution
Perform the transmission again.
If the transmission is still not successful after recalling is performed as set in "Recall in Case of Line Busy" or
"Recall in Case of Communication Error", the transmission failure will be indicated in the job status screen and the transaction report.
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Send Settings" >
"Recall in Case of Line Busy"
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Send Settings" >
"Recall in Case of Communication Error"
Place originals in the document feeder tray of the automatic document feeder.
A long size original cannot be scanned from the document glass.
Following the instructions in the display, unfold the original, place it in the automatic document feeder again, and rescan.
If a folded original is placed in the automatic document feeder, an error will occur and scanning will be cancelled when the actual original size is detected during scanning.
Check with the operator of the other machine to make sure that the sub-address and passcode are correct.
Check with your administrator.
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
Place the original correctly and send the fax again.
When using the document glass, the original must be placed face down. When using the automatic document feeder, the original must be placed face up.
Check with the operator of the other machine.
If the receiving machine is using thermal paper, was the thermal paper loaded with the wrong side out?
Has image rotation been enabled?
Enable "Rotation Sending Settings" before transmission.
When "Rotation Sending Setting" is not enabled (the image is not rotated), an original placed in the vertical orientation may be reduced by the receiving machine.
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Send Settings" >
"Rotation Sending Setting" >
If "Mixed Size Originals" in the special modes is enabled and an original with a different width is sent, rotate transmission will be disabled.
8-24
Problem
Transmission does not begin at the specified time.
Point to check
Is the machine's clock set to the correct time?
Is a transmission in progress?
Solution
Set the clock to the correct time.
➞ System Settings > "Default Settings" > "Clock" >
"Clock Adjust"
If another transmission is in progress when the specified time arrives, the timer operation will begin after that transmission is finished.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO RECEPTION
Problem
Printing does not take place after reception.
Manual reception / polling reception are not possible.
The received image is faint.
Point to check
Does a message appear in the display instructing you to add toner or paper?
(Printing is not possible when this screen appears.)
Does a password entry screen appear?
Solution
Restore printing capability as instructed by the message.
Has cut-off printing been disabled in the system settings (administrator)?
Is forwarding (Inbound Routing function) selected in the Web page for a received fax?
Is little free memory remaining?
Is the original that was faxed also faint?
Enter the correct password with the numeric keys.
"Hold Setting for Received Data Print" is enabled.
If you do not know the password, check with your administrator.
Load the same size of paper as the received fax.
If "Print Actual Size Cut off Disabled" is enabled in "Print
Style Setting" in the system settings (administrator) and a fax is received that is larger than any paper that is loaded, the fax will be received to memory without being printed. (However, when a fax longer than
A3 (11" x 17") size is received, it will be printed using multiple sheets of paper.)
If you need to print a received fax, ask your administrator.
When the Inbound Routing function is enabled in the
Web pages, received faxes are automatically forwarded to a specified address. If "Print at Error" is selected when Inbound Routing is enabled, received faxes will only be printed when an error occurs.
Free memory by printing faxes received by confidential reception and other received data that is protected by a password, and by deleting data stored in memory boxes.
Ask the other party to send the fax again using a suitable (darker) exposure setting.
8-25
Problem
The machine does not begin fax reception.
Point to check
Has the reception mode been set to
"Manual Reception" in the system settings?
Is little free memory remaining?
Solution
Set the reception mode to "Auto Reception".
When the reception mode is set to "Manual Reception", the machine will not receive faxes automatically.
➞ System Settings > "Fax Data Receive/Forward" >
"Fax Settings" > "Receive Setting"
Increase the amount of free memory.
The amount of free memory can be increased by printing faxes received by confidential reception and other password-protected received data, and by deleting data stored in memory boxes.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO TELEPHONE
Problem
Dialling is not possible.
Point to check
Is the extension phone connected?
You cannot talk to the other party.
Did you dial using the speaker?
Solution
Check connections.
Check the telephone line socket, the extension phone socket, the wall socket, and any extension adapters to make sure that all connections are secure.
Use the extension phone.
When you dial using the speaker, you will be able to hear the voice of the other party, but he or she will not hear your voice. (When the extension phone is not installed, you cannot talk to the other party.)
PROBLEMS RELATED TO AUDIBLE SIGNALS
Problem
The volume is too low.
• Speaker
• Ringer Volume
• Line Monitor
• Fax Receive
Complete Signal
• Fax Send Complete
Signal
• Fax Communication
Error Signal
No sound is heard.
• Ringer Volume
• Line Monitor
• Fax Receive
Complete Signal
• Fax Send Complete
Signal
• Fax Communication
Error Signal
Point to check
Has the volume been set to a low level in the system settings (administrator)?
Solution
Ask your administrator to set the volumes in
"Speaker Settings" to a higher level.
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Default Settings" >
"Speaker Settings"
Has the ringer volume been turned off in the system settings (administrator)?
Ask your administrator to set the volumes in
"Speaker Settings" to other than "No Sound".
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Fax Settings" > "Fax Default Settings" >
"Speaker Settings"
8-26
PROBLEMS RELATED TO ONE-TOUCH INDIVIDUAL
KEYS / GROUP KEYS
Problem
A one-touch individual key or group key cannot be stored.
Point to check
Has the maximum number of keys been stored?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
A one-touch individual key or group key cannot be edited or deleted.
If the key is an individual key, is the key included in a group?
Solution
Delete one-touch keys and group keys that are not being used.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
Remove the key from the group and then edit or delete the key.
(If the key is included in multiple groups, it must be removed from all groups.)
➞
System Settings > "Address Control" > "Address Book"
If multiple group keys have been stored, print the Group
List in "Sending Address List" in the system settings.
The list will show where the key is stored.
➞
System Settings > "List Print (User)" > "Sending
Address List" > "Group List"
Wait until the transmission is finished or cancel the transmission and then edit or delete the key.
Is the key being used in a reserved transmission or a transmission in progress?
Is the key included in a program key?
Is the key that you wish to edit or delete stored as a relay destination of an
F-code relay broadcast transmission?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Has your administrator enabled a function that prevents editing/deleting?
Remove the key from the program and then edit or delete the key.
(If the key is included in multiple programs, it must be removed from all programs.)
➞ System Settings > "Address Control" > "Program"
If multiple program keys have been stored, print the
Program List in "Sending Address List" in the system settings. The list will show where individual and group keys are stored.
➞ System Settings > "List Print (User)" > "Sending
Address List" > "Program List"
Remove the key from the relay destinations of the
F-code relay broadcast transmission and then edit or delete the key.
An individual or group one-touch key that is stored as a relay destination cannot be edited or deleted.
➞ System Settings > "Address Control" > "F-Code
Memory Box"
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
Check with your administrator.
If your administrator has enabled settings such as
"Inbound Routing Settings" (in the Web pages), editing/deleting will not be possible.
8-27
SCANNING / INTERNET FAX
PROBLEMS RELATED TO SCANNING / INTERNET FAX OPERATION
PROBLEMS RELATED TO SCAN RESULTS
PROBLEMS RELATED TO ONE-TOUCH INDIVIDUAL KEYS / GROUP KEYS
• If you cannot find the item that you are looking for in the above table of contents, see "
• If you are unable to solve a problem using the solutions in this manual, switch off the [POWER] key ( ) and the main power switch. Wait at least 10 seconds, and then switch on the main power switch and the [POWER] key ( ) in that order.
When the LINE indicator is lit or the DATA indicator is lit or blinking, do not switch off the main power switch or unplug the power plug. This may damage the hard drive or cause the data being stored or received to be lost.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO SCANNING / INTERNET FAX
OPERATION
Problem
Transmission does not take place.
Point to check
Did you select the correct destination?
Is the correct information (e-mail address or FTP server information) stored for that destination?
Solution
Make sure that the correct destination information is stored for the destination and that the destination is correctly selected.
If delivery by e-mail (Scan to E-mail) is unsuccessful, an error message such as "Undelivered Message" may be sent to the designated administrator's e-mail address.
This information may help you determine the cause of the problem.
8-28
Problem
Transmission does not take place.
An address cannot be specified.
Mode cannot be selected.
Point to check
Does the image file exceed the e-mail attachment limit set in the system settings (administrator)?
Did the image file exceed the file attachment size limit of your mail server?
(When Scan to E-mail is used.)
Has the folder on the destination computer been set as a shared folder so that files can be sent to it?
(When using Scan to Network Folder.)
Is "IPsec Settings" enabled on the machine?
(When using Scan to Network Folder.)
Did you place a long size original on the document glass when it is scanned?
Did you place an original that is folded?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Solution
Check with your administrator.
If your administrator has set a limit on the size of transmitted files, a file that exceeds the limit cannot be transmitted.
Reduce the size of the file attachment (reduce the number of pages scanned).
The size of the file can also be reduced by scanning using a lower resolution setting. Ask your mail server administrator what the file size limit is for one e-mail transmission.
If the destination folder is not configured as a shared folder, select "share" in the folder properties.
If the folder was moved or otherwise changed, the
"share" setting may have been cancelled.
Consult your adminstrator.
When "IPsec Settings" is enabled in the system settings
(administrator), scanning to a shared folder may not be possible in some computer environments.
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Security Settings"
> "IPsec Settings"
Place originals in the document feeder tray of the automatic document feeder.
A long size original cannot be scanned from the document glass.
Following the instructions in the display, unfold the original, place it in the automatic document feeder again, and rescan.
If a folded original is placed in the automatic document feeder, an error will occur and scanning will be cancelled when the actual original size is detected during scanning.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
Auto selection of the colour mode does not take place correctly.
Are you scanning one of the following types of originals?
When Black & White is not selected:
• Are there colours or colouring in the paper?
When Colour is not selected:
• Is the colour in the original very light?
• Is the colour in the original very dark, almost black?
• Is only a very small area of the original coloured?
Specify the colour mode manually.
When the colour mode is set to "Auto", the machine detects whether the original is black and white or colour when the [COLOUR START] key is pressed; however, in the cases at left, automatic detection may not give the correct result.
8-29
Problem
The received image file cannot be opened.
Transmission takes a long time.
A destination is pre-selected.
Cannot write to USB memory.
(When using USB
Memory Scan.)
Point to check
Does the viewer program used by the recipient support the format of the received image data?
Does a message appear prompting you to enter your password?
Is the resolution setting appropriate at the time of scanning?
Is "Default Address Setting" enabled in the system settings (administrator)?
Is the connected USB device recognized correctly?
Solution
Use a software program that is capable of opening the selected file type and compression mode.
The recipient may be able to open the file if you change the file type and compression mode selected at the time of transmission.
Ask the sender for the password, or have the image sent again in a non-encrypted format.
The received file is an encrypted PDF file.
Select resolution and data compression settings that are suited to the purpose of transmission.
To create image data that is balanced in terms of resolution and file size, pay attention to the following points:
Resolution settings
The default resolution setting is [200X200dpi] in scanner and USB memory mode, and [200X100dpi] in
Internet fax mode. If the original does not contain a halftone image such as a photo or illustration, scanning at the default resolution will create a practical and useful image. A higher resolution setting or the "Half Tone" setting (in Internet fax mode) should only be selected if the original contains a photo and you wish to give priority to the quality of the photo image. Exercise caution in this case as a larger file will be created than when the default setting is used.
If you wish to send to a destination other than the default destination, touch the [Cancel] key.
If you are the administrator and wish to change or disable the default destination, change the settings as appropriate in "Default Address Setting".
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Image Send
Settings" > "Scan Settings" > "Default Address
Setting"
Use "USB-Device Check" in the system settings to check whether or not the device can be recognized.
➞ System Settings > "USB-Device Check"
If it is not recognized, connect it once again.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO SCAN RESULTS
Problem
The scanned image is clipped.
Point to check
Is the original scan size setting smaller than the actual original size?
Solution
Set the scan size to the actual original size.
If you have intentionally set a smaller size than the actual original size, note carefully the placement position of the selected scan size when placing the original. For example, when scanning an A4
(8-1/2" x 11") original using a B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") setting on the document glass, align the original using the document glass scale at the left edge to fit the area you wish to scan into the B5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") scanning area.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE " PLACING
THE ORIGINAL ON THE DOCUMENT GLASS "
8-30
Problem
The quality of the scanned image is poor.
Point to check
Is the original printed matter such as a book or magazine?
When scanning a colour or greyscale original, is the colour mode set to
"Mono2"?
Is a destination included that has
[TIFF-S] selected for the format?
The scanned image is blank.
Is the original placed face up or face down correctly?
The scanned image is upside down or on its side.
Are Internet fax addresses included in the transmission?
The [COLOUR START] key indicator is not lit.
Are Internet fax or fax destinations included?
JPEG was selected for the file type but the file was created as a TIFF file.
Did you press the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key to begin scanning?
Solution
Use the following method to reduce the occurrence of vertical patterns (moiré)
When the original is printed matter, vertical patterns
(moiré) may occur. Touch the [Exposure] key in the base screen to open the exposure setting screen. The [Moiré
Reduction] checkbox appears in this screen. This checkbox can be selected to reduce the moiré effect. (only in scan mode and USB memory scan mode)
It may also be possible to reduce the moiré effect by changing the resolution setting or shifting the original (or changing its angle) slightly on the document glass.
Setting the colour mode to "Mono2" replaces the colours in the original with either black or white. This is suitable for text-only originals; however, for originals that contain illustrations, it is best to use the [BLACK & WHITE
START] key with the colour mode set to [Greyscale], or set the colour mode of the [COLOUR START] key to [Full
Colour] or [Auto]-[Greyscale] and then scan.
If you wish to send an image scanned at high resolution to scan mode destinations, send the image in a separate transmission.
When a broadcast transmission is performed that includes both scan mode destinations and Internet fax destinations that have [TIFF-S] selected for the format, the resolution will remain fixed at [200X200dpi] even if a different resolution setting is selected.
Reload the thermal paper correctly and send the fax again.
When using the document glass, the original must be placed face down. When using the automatic document feeder, the original must be placed face up.
Send the image to the scan mode destinations in a separate transmission.
When both scan mode and Internet fax destinations are included in a broadcast transmission, the original transmission orientation of Internet fax takes precedence, and thus the file may not appear in the correct orientation when viewed on a computer.
Use the [BLACK & WHITE START] key.
If Internet fax or fax destinations are included in the destinations, only the [BLACK & WHITE START] key can be used.
Change the colour mode to [Full Colour] and then press the [COLOUR START] key.
When [JPEG] is selected for the file type and the image is scanned in Mono 2, the file will be created as a TIFF file.
8-31
Problem
The image is too light or too dark.
(When using PC
Scan.)
Point to check
Is the threshold value suitable?
Are the brightness and contrast settings suitable?
Solution
Check the "B/W Threshold" setting.
When scanning from the TWAIN driver with [Mono 2 gradation] selected from the [Colour Mode] of the
"Custom Settings" window, check the "B/W Threshold" setting. A large threshold value makes the image darker and a small threshold value makes the image brighter.
To adjust the "B/W Threshold" automatically, click the
[Auto Threshold] button on the [Image] tab of the
"Custom Settings" window.
When the brightness and contrast settings are not suitable (for example, the scanned image is too bright), click the [Auto Brightness / Contrast Adjustment] button on the [Colour] tab of the "Custom Settings" window.
You can also click the [Brightness / Contrast] button to set the brightness and contrast while viewing the scanned image.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO ONE-TOUCH INDIVIDUAL
KEYS / GROUP KEYS
Problem
A one-touch individual key or group key cannot be stored.
Point to check
Has the maximum number of keys been stored?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
A one-touch individual key or group key cannot be edited or deleted.
If the key is an individual key, is the key included in a group?
Is the key being used in a reserved transmission or a transmission in progress?
Solution
Adjust the number of stored keys.
Delete one-touch keys (or group keys) that are not being used.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
Remove the key from the group and then edit or delete the key.
(If the key is included in multiple groups, it must be removed from all groups.)
➞ System Settings > "Address Control" > "Address Book"
If multiple group keys have been stored, print the Group
List in "Sending Address List" in the system settings.
The list will show where the key is stored.
➞ System Settings > "List Print (User)" > "Sending
Address List" > "Group List"
Wait until the transmission is finished or cancel the transmission and then edit or delete the key.
8-32
Problem
A one-touch individual key or group key cannot be edited or deleted.
Point to check
Is the key included in a program key?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Has your administrator enabled a function that prevents editing/deleting?
Solution
Remove the key from the program and then edit or delete the key.
(If the key is included in multiple programs, it must be removed from all programs.)
➞ System Settings > "Address Control" > "Program"
If multiple program keys have been stored, print the
Program List in "Sending Address List" in the system settings. The list will show where individual and group keys are stored.
➞ System Settings > "List Print (User)" > "Sending
Address List" > "Program List"
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
Check with your administrator.
If your administrator has enabled "Default Address
Setting" (on the machine) or "Inbound Routing Settings"
(in the Web pages), editing/deleting will not be possible.
8-33
DOCUMENT FILING
PROBLEMS RELATED TO FILE MANAGEMENT
• If you are unable to solve a problem using the solutions in this manual, switch off the [POWER] key ( ) and the main power switch. Wait at least 10 seconds, and then switch on the main power switch and the [POWER] key ( ) in that order.
When the LINE indicator is lit or the DATA indicator is lit or blinking, do not switch off the main power switch or unplug the power plug. This may damage the hard drive or cause the data being stored or received to be lost.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO FILING
Problem
Document filing does not take place.
Point to check
Did you select document filing settings in the printer driver?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
A filed data can not be printed.
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Solution
Enable document filing settings.
In print mode, enable document filing on the [Job
Handling] tab of the printer driver.
In copy mode or image send mode, touch the [Quick
File] key or the [File] key and then use the document filing function.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator). Check with your administrator.
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator). Check with your administrator.
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use may be restricted in your user settings.
8-34
Problem
A job cannot be stored in a custom folder.
Point to check
Do custom folders appear in "Folder
Information"?
(When printing)
Does the custom folder have a password?
Solution
Click the [Get Folder Name] button in the document filing save screen of the printer driver to call up the custom folders that have been created on the machine.
Enter the password configured in the machine in the document filing save screen.
PROBLEMS RELATED TO FILE MANAGEMENT
Problem
A stored file has disappeared.
A file cannot be deleted.
The property of a file cannot be set to
[Confidential].
A confidential file or confidential folder cannot be opened.
Point to check
Did you touch the [Print and Delete the
Data] key to print a stored file?
Has automatic deletion of document filing files been enabled?
Is the property of the file set to
[Protect]?
Is the file in the Quick File folder?
Did you enter the wrong password?
A file name cannot be stored or changed.
A custom folder name cannot be stored or changed.
Does the name include characters that cannot be used in a file or folder name?
Solution
Use the [Print and Save the Data] key.
A file that is printed using the [Print and Delete the Data] key is automatically deleted after being printed.
The file property can be set to "Protect" to prevent the file from being easily deleted.
If files that you need have been deleted, consult the administrator of the machine.
When "Automatic Deletion of File Settings" is enabled in the system settings (administrator), the files in the specified folders are periodically deleted. (Even when the file property is "Confidential" or "Protect", the file may be deleted.)
Change the property to [Sharing] and then delete the file.
A file cannot be deleted when its property is set to
[Protect].
Move the file to a different folder and then specify
"Confidential".
"Confidential" cannot be specified for a file in the Quick
File folder.
(Note that "Protect" can be specified for a file in the
Quick File folder to prevent it from being easily deleted.)
Ask your administrator.
If you cannot remember the password, it is possible to change the file or folder password to a new password in the system settings (administrator).
The following characters cannot be used in a file or folder name:
\ ? / " ; : , < > ! * & # |
8-35
Problem
A file name is cut off.
Point to check
Was the file name stored in the advanced transmission settings during a scan or Internet fax transmission?
Solution
If the name was stored in the advanced transmission settings before Quick File or File settings were configured, that name will be used for the stored file. If the number of characters in the name exceeds the maximum number of characters allowed for a Quick File name (30 characters), the characters after the 30th character will be discarded.
8-36
GENERAL PROBLEMS
PROBLEMS RELATED TO MACHINE OPERATION
PROBLEMS RELATED TO PAPER FEEDING AND OUTPUT
PROBLEMS RELATED TO QUALITY / PRINT RESULTS
PROBLEMS RELATED TO PERIPHERAL DEVICES
8-37
If you are unable to solve a problem using the solutions in this manual, switch off the [POWER] key ( ) and the main power switch. Wait at least 10 seconds, and then switch on the main power switch and the [POWER] key ( ) in that order.
When the LINE indicator is lit or the DATA indicator is lit or blinking, do not switch off the main power switch or unplug the power plug. This may damage the hard drive or cause the data being stored or received to be lost.
8-38
PROBLEMS RELATED TO MACHINE OPERATION
Problem
Specified machine functions cannot be used.
Point to check
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Solution
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator). Check with your administrator.
When user authentication is enabled, the functions that you can use and page counts may be restricted in your user settings.
The operation panel cannot be used.
Is the main power indicator lit?
The operation panel cannot be used.
Did you just power on the machine?
Is the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) blinking?
Is a cover open or a device separated from the machine?
Did login fail three times in a row?
Does a message appear indicating that
Auto Login failed?
Does the message "Call for service.
Code:xx-xx*." appear in the touch panel?
*Letters and numbers appear in xx-xx.
If the main power indicator is not lit, turn on the power.
Make sure that the power plug is firmly inserted in the power outlet, switch the main power switch to the "on" position, and press the [POWER] key ( ) to turn on the power.
Wait until a message appears indicating that the machine is ready.
After the [POWER] key ( ) is turned on, the machine requires some time to complete warmup operation.
During this time functions can be selected, however, a job cannot be run.
Press the [POWER SAVE] key ( ) to turn off Auto
Power Shut off mode.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE " [POWER
Read the message and take appropriate action.
A warning message will appear when a cover is open or a device is separated from the machine.
Log in using the correct user information.
When "A Warning when Login Fails" is enabled in the system settings (administrator) and login fails 3 times in a row, a warning will be displayed and operation will lock for 5 minutes. After operation unlocks, log in using the correct user information. (If you do not know your user information, contact your administrator.)
Contact your administrator.
Auto Login failed due to a problem on the network.
If you are the administrator, touch the [Admin Password] key, log in as an administrator, and temporarily change the auto login settings in the system settings
(administrator). (Restore the changed settings to their original state after the network problem has been solved.)
Switch the power off and then restart the machine.
Make sure that the LINE indicator is not lit and that the
DATA indicator is not blinking or lit and then switch off the [POWER] key ( ) and the main power switch.
Wait at least 10 seconds and then switch the main power switch and the [POWER] key ( ) back on in that order.
If the message still appears after switching the
[POWER] key ( ) and main power switch off and on several times, it is likely that a failure has occurred that requires service. In this event, stop using the machine, unplug the power plug, and contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative. (When contacting your dealer or nearest authorised service representative, inform them of the displayed error code.)
8-39
Problem
Printing is not possible or stops during a job.
The displayed bypass tray paper size is not correct.
Point to check
Is a tray out of paper?
Is the machine out of toner?
Has a paper misfeed occurred?
Is the output tray full?
Is the waste toner box full?
In the Paper Tray Settings of the system settings, are restrictions placed on the trays that can be used in each mode
(copy, print, fax, Internet fax, and document filing)?
The original size is not automatically selected or the wrong size is selected.
Is the original curled or folded?
Did you place an original smaller than
A5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size?
Is the bypass tray extension pulled out?
Solution
Add paper as instructed by the message in the touch panel.
Replace the toner cartridge.
When toner runs low, a message will appear to inform you that the toner cartridge must be replaced. To replace the toner cartridge, see "
(page 1-49) in "1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE".
Remove the misfeed as instructed by the message in the touch panel.
☞
Remove the output from the tray and resume printing.
When the output tray becomes full, a detector activates and stops printing.
Replace the waste toner box as instructed by the message in the touch panel.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
"
Check the Paper Tray Settings and see if checkmarks appear in the checkboxes of each mode (Feeding Approved Job).
Functions without a checkmark cannot be used for printing using that tray.
➞ System Settings > "Paper Tray Settings" > "Tray
Settings" > "Change" > (Each mode)
Straighten the original.
The correct original size cannot be detected if the original is curled or folded.
Enter the original size manually.
Original sizes smaller than A5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") cannot be detected.
When scanning a small original on the document glass, it is convenient to place a blank sheet of paper on top of the original which is the same size (A4 (8-1/2" x 11"), B5
(8-1/2" x 11"R), etc.) as the paper that you wish to use for printing.
Pull out the bypass tray extension.
When loading paper in the bypass tray, be sure to pull out the extension to enable the paper size to be detected correctly.
8-40
PROBLEMS RELATED TO PAPER FEEDING AND
OUTPUT
Problem
The original misfeeds
(automatic document feeder).
Point to check
Is too much paper loaded in document feeder tray?
Is the original a long original?
The paper misfeeds.
Is the original on thin paper?
Is the feed roller dirty?
Is a torn piece of paper remaining in the machine?
Is too much paper loaded in the tray?
Are multiple sheets feeding at once?
Solution
Make sure that the stack of paper in the tray is not higher than the indicator line.
When using the automatic document feeder to scan a long original, set the scan size to [Long Size].
(Note that long originals cannot be copied using the copy function.)
Use the document glass to scan the original.
If you need to use the automatic document feeder, use slow scan mode in the special modes to scan the original.
Clean the surface of the original feed roller.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
"
Make sure all paper is removed.
☞
Make sure that the stack of paper in the tray is not higher than the indicator line.
Fan the paper well before loading it.
Are you using paper that is not within the specifications?
Has the paper in the tray absorbed moisture?
Are the bypass tray guides adjusted to the width of the paper?
Is the bypass tray extension pulled out?
Is the bypass feed roller dirty?
Use SHARP-recommended paper.
Using paper that is not supported may result in misfeeds, creases, or smudges.
☞
"SUPPLIES" in the Start Guide
For paper that is prohibited or not recommended, see
" USEABLE PAPER " (page 1-28) in "1. BEFORE USING
THE MACHINE".
If you will not be using paper in a tray for a long time, remove the paper from the tray and store it in a bag in a dark and dry location.
Adjust the bypass tray guides to the width of the paper.
When loading a large size of paper, pull out the extension.
Clean the surface of the bypass feed roller.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
"
8-41
Problem
The paper misfeeds.
Paper does not feed from the paper tray.
Point to check
Is A5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size paper loaded?
Has the correct paper size been set?
Did you add paper to the bypass tray?
Is the paper loaded correctly in the paper tray?
In the Paper Tray Settings of the system settings, are restrictions placed on the trays that can be used in each mode
(copy, print, fax, Internet fax, and document filing)?
The image on paper is skewed.
Is too much paper loaded in the bypass tray?
The automatic document feeder does not operate.
Are the bypass tray guides adjusted to the width of the paper?
Are the original guides adjusted to the width of the paper?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Solution
When loading A5 (5-1/2" x 8-1/2") size paper, place the paper in the horizontal (A5R (5-1/2" x 8-1/2"R)) orientation.
If you are using a special size, be sure to specify the paper size.
If the size of paper loaded in a tray was changed, be sure to check the paper size setting.
➞ System Settings > "Paper Tray Settings" > "Tray
Settings"
When adding paper, remove any paper remaining in the bypass tray, combine it with the paper to be added, and reload as a single stack.
If paper is added without removing the remaining paper, a misfeed may result.
Set the guides to the size of the paper.
Make sure the height of the paper does not exceed the indicator line.
Check the Paper Tray Settings and see if checkmarks appear in the checkboxes of each mode (Feeding Approved Job).
Functions without a checkmark cannot be used for printing using that tray.
➞ System Settings > "Paper Tray Settings" > "Tray
Settings" > "Change" > (Each mode)
Do not load more than the maximum number of sheets.
The maximum number of sheets varies depending on the paper type setting. For more information, see
"SPECIFICATIONS" in the Start Guide.
Adjust the bypass tray guides to the width of the paper.
Adjust the original guides to the width of the paper.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
8-42
PROBLEMS RELATED TO QUALITY / PRINT RESULTS
Problem
Lines appear in the scanned image.
Smudges appear on printed output.
Print quality is poor.
Point to check
Are the scanning areas of the document glass or automatic document feeder dirty?
Is the bypass feed roller dirty?
Are you using paper that is not within the specifications?
Are you printing on pre-punched paper?
Toner does not adhere well or creases appear in the paper.
Does a message appear indicating the need for maintenance?
Are you using paper that is not within the specifications?
Did you set the correct paper type?
Is the paper loaded so that printing takes place on the reverse side?
Is "Toner Save Mode" enabled?
Solution
Clean the scanning areas of the document glass or automatic document feeder.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
"
Clean the surface of the bypass feed roller.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
"
Use SHARP-recommended paper.
Using paper that is for other models or special paper that is not supported may result in misfeeds, creases, or smudges.
☞
"SUPPLIES" in the Start Guide
Take care that the image does not overlap the punch holes.
If the printed image overlaps the punch holes, smudges may appear on the reverse side of the paper following one-sided printing, or on both sides following two-sided printing.
Contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative as soon as possible.
Use SHARP-recommended paper.
Using paper that is for other models or special paper that is not supported may result in misfeeds, creases, or smudges.
☞
"SUPPLIES" in the Start Guide
Set the correct paper type in the tray settings.
Make sure that the following has not occurred:
• Heavy paper is being used, but a paper type other than heavy paper is selected in the tray settings. (The image may disappear if rubbed.)
• Paper other than heavy paper is being used, but heavy paper is selected in the tray settings. (This may cause creases and misfeeds.)
➞ System Settings > "Paper Tray Settings" > "Tray
Settings"
Check that the paper is loaded so that printing takes place on the correct side.
If printing takes place on the wrong side of label sheets or transparency film, the toner may not adhere well and a clear image may not be obtained.
Check with your administrator.
When "Toner Save Mode" is enabled, printing takes place using less toner and thus the print result is lighter.
8-43
Problem
Part of the image is cut off.
Printing takes place on the wrong side of the paper.
Point to check
Has the correct paper size been set?
Was the original placed in the correct position?
Is the paper loaded with the print side facing in the correct direction?
A cover or insert is not printed on the specified paper.
Has the paper type been set correctly?
Solution
If you are using a special size, be sure to specify the paper size.
If the size of paper loaded in a tray was changed, be sure to check the paper size setting.
➞ System Settings > "Paper Tray Settings" > "Tray
Settings"
If you are using the document glass, be sure to place the original in the far left corner of the document glass.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE " PLACING
THE ORIGINAL ON THE DOCUMENT GLASS "
Check that the paper is loaded so that printing takes place on the correct side.
• Trays 1 to 4:
Load the paper with the front side facing up*.
• Bypass tray and tray 5:
Load the paper with the front side facing up*.
* When the paper type is "Pre-Printed" or "Letter
Head", load the paper in the opposite way. (Except when "Disabling of Duplex" is enabled in the system settings (administrator). For the current setting, check with your administrator.)
Set the correct paper type for the tray that contains the paper specified for the cover or insert.
If the paper type set for the cover or insert is not the same as the paper type set for the tray, paper will be fed from a different tray.
➞ System Settings > "Paper Tray Settings" > "Tray
Settings"
8-44
PROBLEMS RELATED TO PERIPHERAL DEVICES
Problem
The connected USB device cannot be used.
The connected USB memory cannot be used.
Point to check
Is the USB device compatible with the machine?
Is the connected USB device recognized correctly?
Is the format of the USB memory
FAT32?
Solution
Ask your dealer if the device is compatible with the machine.
Use "USB-Device Check" in the system settings to check whether or not the device can be recognized.
➞ System Settings > "USB-Device Check"
If it is not recognized, connect it once again.
Check the USB memory device format.
If the format of the USB memory is other than FAT32, use your computer to change the format to FAT32.
Use a 32 GB or less USB memory.
The finisher does not operate.
Are you using a USB memory with a capacity of more than 32 GB?
Does a message appear indicating that you need to remove paper from the stapler compiler?
Does the following message appear in the touch panel?
"Call for service. Code:xx-xx* Finisher trouble."
*Letters and numbers appear in xx-xx.
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Stapling does not take place.
Does a message appear instructing you to check the staple unit?
Does a message appear instructing you to add staples?
Is a different width of paper mixed in?
Are there more sheets than can be stapled at once?
Is a paper size that cannot be stapled included in the print job?
Remove all remaining paper from the stapler compiler.
Check the plug of the connecting cable of the finisher.
Plug and unplug the cable and after ensuring that it has been properly plugged, restart the power supply to the machine.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
Remove jammed staples.
☞
"
REMOVING STAPLE JAMS " (page 8-11)
Replace the staple cartridge.
Do not forget to replace the staple case.
☞
"
REMOVING STAPLE JAMS " (page 8-11)
To perform mixed size stapling, use paper of the same width and select the [Same Width] setting.
Stapling is not possible when paper of different widths are mixed together.
When copying, select [Same Width] from [Mixed Size
Original] in the special modes.
For the maximum number of sheets that can be stapled, see "SPECIFICATIONS" in the Start Guide.
For the paper sizes that can be stapled, see
"SPECIFICATIONS" in the Start Guide.
8-45
Problem
Stapling does not take place.
Point to check
Is the paper type setting of the tray selected in the printer driver set to a paper type that cannot be stapled?
Punching does not take place.
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
Does a message appear instructing you to check the punch module?
Is a different size of paper mixed in?
Is a paper size that cannot be punched included in the print job?
Is the tray selected in the printer driver set to a paper type that cannot be punched?
Have functions been disabled by the administrator?
The stapling position or punch position is not correct.
Is the stapling position set correctly?
Are the punching positions set correctly?
Have the output sheets got folded?
Sheets output to the delivery tray of the finisher are scattered.
The stapled sheets are scattered.
Have the output sheets got folded?
Solution
Check the paper type settings in the machine and select a tray that has paper that can be used for stapling*.
Click the [Tray Status] button in "Paper Selection" on the [Paper] tab of the printer properties window and check the paper type setting of each tray.
* Stapling is not possible on labels, tab paper, transparency film, or envelopes. In addition, if "Disable
Staple" is selected in the user type, stapling will not be possible.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
Dispose of punch scraps.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE " PUNCH
Punching is not possible when different widths of paper are mixed together. To perform mixed size punching, use paper of the same width and select the [Same
Width] setting. When copying, select [Same Width] for
[Mixed Size Original] in the special modes.
For the paper sizes that can be punched, see
"SPECIFICATIONS" in the Start Guide.
Check the paper type settings in the machine and select a tray that has paper that can be used for punching*.
Click the [Tray Status] button in "Paper Selection" on the [Paper] tab of the printer properties window and check the paper type setting of each tray.
* Punching is not possible on labels, tab paper, transparency film, and envelopes. In addition, if
"Disable Punch" is selected in the user type, punching will not be possible.
Check with your administrator.
Some functions may have been disabled in the system settings (administrator).
Check the stapling position setting.
☞
2. COPIER " OUTPUT " (page 2-33)
Check the punch position settings.
☞
2. COPIER " OUTPUT " (page 2-33)
If the front and back side of the sheets in the paper feed tray have been reversed, in some cases it can be improved.
If the front and back side of the sheets in the paper feed tray have been reversed, in some cases it can be improved.
8-46
OTHER PROBLEMS
Problem
Preview images or thumbnail images do not appear.
The touch panel screen is difficult to view.
Point to check
Are there a number of jobs waiting to be executed?
Solution
Wait until several of the jobs have been executed.
Is the display contrast properly adjusted?
You were logged out without having performed logout yourself.
You forgot the administrator password.
Did Auto Clear activate?
Was the administrator password changed from the factory default setting?
Touch the brightness adjustment key ( system bar in the touch panel to adjust the
) on the brightness.
☞
1. BEFORE USING THE MACHINE " SYSTEM
Log in again.
When user authentication is used, the currently logged in user will be automatically logged out if Auto Clear activates. (Except when in PC scan mode.)
If you are the administrator, you can change the time setting of Auto Clear or disable Auto Clear in "Auto
Clear Setting".
➞ System Settings (Administrator) > "Operation
Settings" > "Other Settings" > "Auto Clear Setting"
Contact your dealer or nearest authorised service representative.
For the factory default administrator password, see "TO
THE ADMINISTRATOR OF THE MACHINE" in the Start
Guide. After changing the password, take special care to remember it.
8-47
Operation Guide MODEL: MX-2010U
MX-2310U
MX2010-EX-ZZ
advertisement
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Key Features
- Business Laser Mono printing
- 600 x 600 DPI
- A3 23 ppm
- Mono copying Mono scanning Mono faxing
- USB port Ethernet LAN
- Internal memory: 1024 MB
- 72.4 kg
Related manuals
advertisement
Table of contents
- 42 BEFORE USING THE MACHINE
- 110 COPIER
- 265 PRINTER
- 345 FACSIMILE
- 484 SCANNER/INTERNET FAX
- 617 DOCUMENT FILING
- 669 SYSTEM SETTINGS
- 785 TROUBLESHOOTING